home *** CD-ROM | disk | FTP | other *** search
Text File | 1993-08-26 | 1.2 MB | 21,925 lines |
Text Truncated. Only the first 1MB is shown below. Download the file for the complete contents.
-
- The Internet Wiretap Online Edition of
-
- THE VOYAGE OF THE BEAGLE
- BY CHARLES DARWIN
-
- From The Harvard Classics Volume 29
-
- Copyright, 1909
- P. F. Collier & Son, New York
-
- Prepared by John Hamm <John_Hamm@mindlink.bc.ca>
- from text scanned by Internet Wiretap
-
-
- About the online edition.
-
- The degree symbol is represented as "degs." Italics
- are represented as _italics_. Footnotes are collected
- at the end of each chapter.
-
- This text is in the PUBLIC DOMAIN, released September 1993.
-
-
-
-
- THE VOYAGE OF THE BEAGLE
-
-
-
-
- PREFACE
-
-
- I have stated in the preface to the first Edition of this work,
- and in the Zoology of the Voyage of the Beagle, that it was in
- consequence of a wish expressed by Captain Fitz Roy, of having
- some scientific person on board, accompanied by an offer from
- him of giving up part of his own accommodations, that I
- volunteered my services, which received, through the kindness of
- the hydrographer, Captain Beaufort, the sanction of the Lords of
- the Admiralty. As I feel that the opportunities which I enjoyed
- of studying the Natural History of the different countries we
- visited, have been wholly due to Captain Fitz Roy, I hope I may
- here be permitted to repeat my expression of gratitude to him;
- and to add that, during the five years we were together, I
- received from him the most cordial friendship and steady
- assistance. Both to Captain Fitz Roy and to all the Officers of
- the Beagle [1] I shall ever feel most thankful for the
- undeviating kindness with which I was treated during our long
- voyage.
-
- This volume contains, in the form of a Journal, a history of
- our voyage, and a sketch of those observations in Natural History
- and Geology, which I think will possess some interest for the
- general reader. I have in this edition largely condensed and
- corrected some parts, and have added a little to others, in order
- to render the volume more fitted for popular reading; but I trust
- that naturalists will remember, that they must refer for details
- to the larger publications which comprise the scientific results
- of the Expedition. The Zoology of the Voyage of the Beagle
- includes an account of the Fossil Mammalia, by Professor Owen;
- of the Living Mammalia, by Mr. Waterhouse; of the Birds, by
- Mr. Gould; of the Fish, by the Rev. L. Jenyns; and of the
- Reptiles, by Mr. Bell. I have appended to the descriptions of
- each species an account of its habits and range. These works,
- which I owe to the high talents and disinterested zeal of the
- above distinguished authors, could not have been undertaken, had
- it not been for the liberality of the Lords Commissioners of Her
- Majesty's Treasury, who, through the representation of the Right
- Honourable the Chancellor of the Exchequer, have been pleased
- to grant a sum of one thousand pounds towards defraying part
- of the expenses of publication.
-
- I have myself published separate volumes on the 'Structure
- and Distribution of Coral Reefs;' on the 'Volcanic Islands
- visited during the Voyage of the Beagle;' and on the 'Geology
- of South America.' The sixth volume of the 'Geological
- Transactions' contains two papers of mine on the Erratic
- Boulders and Volcanic Phenomena of South America. Messrs.
- Waterhouse, Walker, Newman, and White, have published several
- able papers on the Insects which were collected, and I trust
- that many others will hereafter follow. The plants from the
- southern parts of America will be given by Dr. J. Hooker, in
- his great work on the Botany of the Southern Hemisphere. The
- Flora of the Galapagos Archipelago is the subject of a separate
- memoir by him, in the 'Linnean Transactions.' The Reverend
- Professor Henslow has published a list of the plants collected
- by me at the Keeling Islands; and the Reverend J. M. Berkeley
- has described my cryptogamic plants.
-
- I shall have the pleasure of acknowledging the great assistance
- which I have received from several other naturalists, in the
- course of this and my other works; but I must be here allowed
- to return my most sincere thanks to the Reverend Professor
- Henslow, who, when I was an undergraduate at Cambridge, was
- one chief means of giving me a taste for Natural History, --
- who, during my absence, took charge of the collections I sent
- home, and by his correspondence directed my endeavours, -- and
- who, since my return, has constantly rendered me every
- assistance which the kindest friend could offer.
-
- DOWN, BROMLEY, KENT,
- June 9, 1845
-
- [1] I must take this opportunity of returning my sincere thanks
- to Mr. Bynoe, the surgeon of the Beagle, for his very kind
- attention to me when I was ill at Valparaiso.
-
-
-
- THE VOYAGE OF THE BEAGLE
-
-
-
- CHAPTER I
-
- ST. JAGO -- CAPE DE VERD ISLANDS
-
- Porto Praya -- Ribeira Grande -- Atmospheric Dust with
- Infusoria -- Habits of a Sea-slug and Cuttle-fish -- St.
- Paul's Rocks, non-volcanic -- Singular Incrustations --
- Insects the first Colonists of Islands -- Fernando Noronha --
- Bahia -- Burnished Rocks -- Habits of a Diodon -- Pelagic
- Confervae and Infusoria -- Causes of discoloured Sea.
-
-
- AFTER having been twice driven back by heavy southwestern
- gales, Her Majesty's ship Beagle, a ten-gun
- brig, under the command of Captain Fitz Roy, R. N.,
- sailed from Devonport on the 27th of December, 1831. The
- object of the expedition was to complete the survey of
- Patagonia and Tierra del Fuego, commenced under Captain King
- in 1826 to 1830, -- to survey the shores of Chile, Peru, and
- of some islands in the Pacific -- and to carry a chain of
- chronometrical measurements round the World. On the 6th
- of January we reached Teneriffe, but were prevented landing,
- by fears of our bringing the cholera: the next morning
- we saw the sun rise behind the rugged outline of the Grand
- Canary island, and suddenly illuminate the Peak of Teneriffe,
- whilst the lower parts were veiled in fleecy clouds. This
- was the first of many delightful days never to be forgotten.
- On the 16th of January, 1832, we anchored at Porto Praya,
- in St. Jago, the chief island of the Cape de Verd archipelago.
-
- The neighbourhood of Porto Praya, viewed from the sea,
- wears a desolate aspect. The volcanic fires of a past age,
- and the scorching heat of a tropical sun, have in most places
- rendered the soil unfit for vegetation. The country rises in
- successive steps of table-land, interspersed with some truncate
- conical hills, and the horizon is bounded by an irregular
- chain of more lofty mountains. The scene, as beheld through
- the hazy atmosphere of this climate, is one of great interest;
- if, indeed, a person, fresh from sea, and who has just
- walked, for the first time, in a grove of cocoa-nut trees, can
- be a judge of anything but his own happiness. The island
- would generally be considered as very uninteresting, but to
- anyone accustomed only to an English landscape, the novel
- aspect of an utterly sterile land possesses a grandeur which
- more vegetation might spoil. A single green leaf can
- scarcely be discovered over wide tracts of the lava plains;
- yet flocks of goats, together with a few cows, contrive to
- exist. It rains very seldom, but during a short portion of
- the year heavy torrents fall, and immediately afterwards a
- light vegetation springs out of every crevice. This soon
- withers; and upon such naturally formed hay the animals
- live. It had not now rained for an entire year. When the
- island was discovered, the immediate neighbourhood of
- Porto Praya was clothed with trees, [1] the reckless
- destruction of which has caused here, as at St. Helena, and
- at some of the Canary islands, almost entire sterility. The
- broad, flat-bottomed valleys, many of which serve during a
- few days only in the season as water-courses, are clothed
- with thickets of leafless bushes. Few living creatures inhabit
- these valleys. The commonest bird is a kingfisher (Dacelo
- Iagoensis), which tamely sits on the branches of the castor-
- oil plant, and thence darts on grasshoppers and lizards. It
- is brightly coloured, but not so beautiful as the European
- species: in its flight, manners, and place of habitation,
- which is generally in the driest valley, there is also a wide
- difference.
-
- One day, two of the officers and myself rode to Ribeira
- Grande, a village a few miles eastward of Porto Praya. Until
- we reached the valley of St. Martin, the country presented
- its usual dull brown appearance; but here, a very small rill
- of water produces a most refreshing margin of luxuriant
- vegetation. In the course of an hour we arrived at Ribeira
- Grande, and were surprised at the sight of a large ruined
- fort and cathedral. This little town, before its harbour was
- filled up, was the principal place in the island: it now
- presents a melancholy, but very picturesque appearance. Having
- procured a black Padre for a guide, and a Spaniard who
- had served in the Peninsular war as an interpreter, we visited
- a collection of buildings, of which an ancient church
- formed the principal part. It is here the governors and
- captain-generals of the islands have been buried. Some of
- the tombstones recorded dates of the sixteenth century. [2]
-
- The heraldic ornaments were the only things in this retired
- place that reminded us of Europe. The church or chapel
- formed one side of a quadrangle, in the middle of which a
- large clump of bananas were growing. On another side
- was a hospital, containing about a dozen miserable-looking
- inmates.
-
- We returned to the Venda to eat our dinners. A considerable
- number of men, women, and children, all as black as
- jet, collected to watch us. Our companions were extremely
- merry; and everything we said or did was followed by their
- hearty laughter. Before leaving the town we visited the
- cathedral. It does not appear so rich as the smaller church,
- but boasts of a little organ, which sent forth singularly
- inharmonious cries. We presented the black priest with a few
- shillings, and the Spaniard, patting him on the head, said,
- with much candour, he thought his colour made no great
- difference. We then returned, as fast as the ponies would
- go, to Porto Praya.
-
- Another day we rode to the village of St. Domingo, situated
- near the centre of the island. On a small plain which
- we crossed, a few stunted acacias were growing; their tops
- had been bent by the steady trade-wind, in a singular
- manner -- some of them even at right angles to their trunks.
- The direction of the branches was exactly N. E. by N., and S. W.
- by S., and these natural vanes must indicate the prevailing
- direction of the force of the trade-wind. The travelling had
- made so little impression on the barren soil, that we here
- missed our track, and took that to Fuentes. This we did
- not find out till we arrived there; and we were afterwards
- glad of our mistake. Fuentes is a pretty village, with a small
- stream; and everything appeared to prosper well, excepting,
- indeed, that which ought to do so most -- its inhabitants.
- The black children, completely naked, and looking very
- wretched, were carrying bundles of firewood half as big as
- their own bodies.
-
- Near Fuentes we saw a large flock of guinea-fowl --
- probably fifty or sixty in number. They were extremely
- wary, and could not be approached. They avoided us, like
- partridges on a rainy day in September, running with their
- heads cocked up; and if pursued, they readily took to the
- wing.
-
- The scenery of St. Domingo possesses a beauty totally
- unexpected, from the prevalent gloomy character of the rest
- of the island. The village is situated at the bottom of a
- valley, bounded by lofty and jagged walls of stratified lava.
- The black rocks afford a most striking contrast with the
- bright green vegetation, which follows the banks of a little
- stream of clear water. It happened to be a grand feast-day,
- and the village was full of people. On our return we overtook
- a party of about twenty young black girls, dressed in
- excellent taste; their black skins and snow-white linen being
- set off by coloured turbans and large shawls. As soon as
- we approached near, they suddenly all turned round, and
- covering the path with their shawls, sung with great energy
- a wild song, beating time with their hands upon their legs.
- We threw them some vintems, which were received with
- screams of laughter, and we left them redoubling the noise
- of their song.
-
- One morning the view was singularly clear; the distant
- mountains being projected with the sharpest outline on a
- heavy bank of dark blue clouds. Judging from the appearance,
- and from similar cases in England, I supposed that the
- air was saturated with moisture. The fact, however, turned
- out quite the contrary. The hygrometer gave a difference
- of 29.6 degs., between the temperature of the air, and the
- point at which dew was precipitated. This difference was
- nearly double that which I had observed on the previous
- mornings. This unusual degree of atmospheric dryness was
- accompanied by continual flashes of lightning. Is it not an
- uncommon case, thus to find a remarkable degree of aerial
- transparency with such a state of weather?
-
- Generally the atmosphere is hazy; and this is caused by
- the falling of impalpably fine dust, which was found to have
- slightly injured the astronomical instruments. The morning
- before we anchored at Porto Praya, I collected a little packet
- of this brown-coloured fine dust, which appeared to have
- been filtered from the wind by the gauze of the vane at the
- masthead. Mr. Lyell has also given me four packets of dust
- which fell on a vessel a few hundred miles northward of
- these islands. Professor Ehrenberg [3] finds that this dust
- consists in great part of infusoria with siliceous shields, and
- of the siliceous tissue of plants. In five little packets which
- I sent him, he has ascertained no less than sixty-seven
- different organic forms! The infusoria, with the exception of
- two marine species, are all inhabitants of fresh-water. I
- have found no less than fifteen different accounts of dust
- having fallen on vessels when far out in the Atlantic. From
- the direction of the wind whenever it has fallen, and from
- its having always fallen during those months when the harmattan
- is known to raise clouds of dust high into the atmosphere,
- we may feel sure that it all comes from Africa. It
- is, however, a very singular fact, that, although Professor
- Ehrenberg knows many species of infusoria peculiar to
- Africa, he finds none of these in the dust which I sent him.
- On the other hand, he finds in it two species which hitherto
- he knows as living only in South America. The dust falls
- in such quantities as to dirty everything on board, and to
- hurt people's eyes; vessels even have run on shore owing to
- the obscurity of the atmosphere. It has often fallen on
- ships when several hundred, and even more than a thousand
- miles from the coast of Africa, and at points sixteen hundred
- miles distant in a north and south direction. In some
- dust which was collected on a vessel three hundred miles
- from the land, I was much surprised to find particles of
- stone above the thousandth of an inch square, mixed with
- finer matter. After this fact one need not be surprised
- at the diffusion of the far lighter and smaller sporules of
- cryptogamic plants.
-
- The geology of this island is the most interesting part of
- its natural history. On entering the harbour, a perfectly
- horizontal white band, in the face of the sea cliff, may be seen
- running for some miles along the coast, and at the height of
- about forty-five feet above the water. Upon examination
- this white stratum is found to consist of calcareous matter
- with numerous shells embedded, most or all of which now
- exist on the neighbouring coast. It rests on ancient volcanic
- rocks, and has been covered by a stream of basalt, which
- must have entered the sea when the white shelly bed was
- lying at the bottom. It is interesting to trace the changes
- produced by the heat of the overlying lava, on the friable
- mass, which in parts has been converted into a crystalline
- limestone, and in other parts into a compact spotted stone
- Where the lime has been caught up by the scoriaceous fragments
- of the lower surface of the stream, it is converted into
- groups of beautifully radiated fibres resembling arragonite.
- The beds of lava rise in successive gently-sloping plains,
- towards the interior, whence the deluges of melted stone
- have originally proceeded. Within historical times, no signs
- of volcanic activity have, I believe, been manifested in any
- part of St. Jago. Even the form of a crater can but rarely
- be discovered on the summits of the many red cindery hills;
- yet the more recent streams can be distinguished on the
- coast, forming lines of cliffs of less height, but stretching
- out in advance of those belonging to an older series: the
- height of the cliffs thus affording a rude measure of the age
- of the streams.
-
- During our stay, I observed the habits of some marine
- animals. A large Aplysia is very common. This sea-slug
- is about five inches long; and is of a dirty yellowish colour
- veined with purple. On each side of the lower surface, or
- foot, there is a broad membrane, which appears sometimes
- to act as a ventilator, in causing a current of water to flow
- over the dorsal branchiae or lungs. It feeds on the delicate
- sea-weeds which grow among the stones in muddy and shallow
- water; and I found in its stomach several small pebbles,
- as in the gizzard of a bird. This slug, when disturbed, emits
- a very fine purplish-red fluid, which stains the water for the
- space of a foot around. Besides this means of defence, an
- acrid secretion, which is spread over its body, causes a
- sharp, stinging sensation, similar to that produced by the
- Physalia, or Portuguese man-of-war.
-
- I was much interested, on several occasions, by watching
- the habits of an Octopus, or cuttle-fish. Although common
- in the pools of water left by the retiring tide, these animals
- were not easily caught. By means of their long arms and
- suckers, they could drag their bodies into very narrow crevices;
- and when thus fixed, it required great force to remove
- them. At other times they darted tail first, with the rapidity
- of an arrow, from one side of the pool to the other, at the
- same instant discolouring the water with a dark chestnut-brown
- ink. These animals also escape detection by a very
- extraordinary, chameleon-like power of changing their colour.
- They appear to vary their tints according to the nature
- of the ground over which they pass: when in deep water,
- their general shade was brownish purple, but when placed on
- the land, or in shallow water, this dark tint changed into one
- of a yellowish green. The colour, examined more carefully,
- was a French grey, with numerous minute spots of bright
- yellow: the former of these varied in intensity; the latter
- entirely disappeared and appeared again by turns. These
- changes were effected in such a manner, that clouds, varying
- in tint between a hyacinth red and a chestnut-brown, [4] were
- continually passing over the body. Any part, being subjected
- to a slight shock of galvanism, became almost black: a similar
- effect, but in a less degree, was produced by scratching
- the skin with a needle. These clouds, or blushes as they may
- be called, are said to be produced by the alternate expansion
- and contraction of minute vesicles containing variously
- coloured fluids. [5]
-
- This cuttle-fish displayed its chameleon-like power both
- during the act of swimming and whilst remaining stationary
- at the bottom. I was much amused by the various arts to
- escape detection used by one individual, which seemed fully
- aware that I was watching it. Remaining for a time motionless,
- it would then stealthily advance an inch or two, like a
- cat after a mouse; sometimes changing its colour: it thus
- proceeded, till having gained a deeper part, it darted away,
- leaving a dusky train of ink to hide the hole into which it
- had crawled.
-
- While looking for marine animals, with my head about
- two feet above the rocky shore, I was more than once saluted
- by a jet of water, accompanied by a slight grating noise. At
- first I could not think what it was, but afterwards I found
- out that it was this cuttle-fish, which, though concealed in a
- hole, thus often led me to its discovery. That it possesses
- the power of ejecting water there is no doubt, and it appeared
- to me that it could certainly take good aim by directing the
- tube or siphon on the under side of its body. From the
- difficulty which these animals have in carrying their heads,
- they cannot crawl with ease when placed on the ground. I
- observed that one which I kept in the cabin was slightly
- phosphorescent in the dark.
-
- ST. PAUL'S ROCKS. -- In crossing the Atlantic we hove-to
- during the morning of February 16th, close to the island of
- St. Paul's. This cluster of rocks is situated in 0 degs. 58'
- north latitude, and 29 degs. 15' west longitude. It is 540
- miles distant from the coast of America, and 350 from the island
- of Fernando Noronha. The highest point is only fifty feet above
- the level of the sea, and the entire circumference is under
- three-quarters of a mile. This small point rises abruptly out
- of the depths of the ocean. Its mineralogical constitution
- is not simple; in some parts the rock is of a cherty, in others
- of a felspathic nature, including thin veins of serpentine. It
- is a remarkable fact, that all the many small islands, lying
- far from any continent, in the Pacific, Indian, and Atlantic
- Oceans, with the exception of the Seychelles and this little
- point of rock, are, I believe, composed either of coral or of
- erupted matter. The volcanic nature of these oceanic islands
- is evidently an extension of that law, and the effect of those
- same causes, whether chemical or mechanical, from which it
- results that a vast majority of the volcanoes now in action
- stand either near sea-coasts or as islands in the midst of the
- sea.
-
- The rocks of St. Paul appear from a distance of a brilliantly
- white colour. This is partly owing to the dung of a
- vast multitude of seafowl, and partly to a coating of a hard
- glossy substance with a pearly lustre, which is intimately
- united to the surface of the rocks. This, when examined
- with a lens, is found to consist of numerous exceedingly
- thin layers, its total thickness being about the tenth of an
- inch. It contains much animal matter, and its origin, no
- doubt, is due to the action of the rain or spray on the birds'
- dung. Below some small masses of guano at Ascension, and
- on the Abrolhos Islets, I found certain stalactitic branching
- bodies, formed apparently in the same manner as the thin
- white coating on these rocks. The branching bodies so closely
- resembled in general appearance certain nulliporae (a family
- of hard calcareous sea-plants), that in lately looking hastily
- over my collection I did not perceive the difference. The
- globular extremities of the branches are of a pearly texture,
- like the enamel of teeth, but so hard as just to scratch plate-
- glass. I may here mention, that on a part of the coast of
- Ascension, where there is a vast accumulation of shelly sand,
- an incrustation is deposited on the tidal rocks by the water
- of the sea, resembling, as represented in the woodcut, certain
- cryptogamic plants (Marchantiae) often seen on damp
- walls. The surface of the fronds is beautifully glossy; and
- those parts formed where fully exposed to the light are of a
- jet black colour, but those shaded under ledges are only grey.
- I have shown specimens of this incrustation to several
- geologists, and they all thought that they were of volcanic
- or igneous origin! In its hardness and translucency -- in
- its polish, equal to that of the finest oliva-shell -- in the
- bad smell given out, and loss of colour under the blowpipe -- it
- shows a close similarity with living sea-shells. Moreover, in
- sea-shells, it is known that the parts habitually covered and
- shaded by the mantle of the animal, are of a paler colour
- than those fully exposed to the light, just as is the case with
- this incrustation. When we remember that lime, either as a
- phosphate or carbonate, enters into the composition of the
- hard parts, such as bones and shells, of all living animals, it
- is an interesting physiological fact [6] to find substances
- harder than the enamel of teeth, and coloured surfaces as well
- polished as those of a fresh shell, reformed through inorganic
- means from dead organic matter -- mocking, also, in
- shape, some of the lower vegetable productions.
-
- We found on St. Paul's only two kinds of birds -- the
- booby and the noddy. The former is a species of gannet,
- and the latter a tern. Both are of a tame and stupid
- disposition, and are so unaccustomed to visitors, that I could
- have killed any number of them with my geological hammer.
- The booby lays her eggs on the bare rock; but the tern makes
- a very simple nest with seaweed. By the side of many of
- these nests a small flying-fish was placed; which I suppose,
- had been brought by the male bird for its partner. It was
- amusing to watch how quickly a large and active crab
- (Graspus), which inhabits the crevices of the rock, stole the
- fish from the side of the nest, as soon as we had disturbed
- the parent birds. Sir W. Symonds, one of the few persons
- who have landed here, informs me that he saw the crabs
- dragging even the young birds out of their nests, and devouring
- them. Not a single plant, not even a lichen, grows
- on this islet; yet it is inhabited by several insects and
- spiders. The following list completes, I believe, the
- terrestrial fauna: a fly (Olfersia) living on the booby, and
- a tick which must have come here as a parasite on the birds;
- a small brown moth, belonging to a genus that feeds on feathers;
- a beetle (Quedius) and a woodlouse from beneath the dung; and
- lastly, numerous spiders, which I suppose prey on these small
- attendants and scavengers of the water-fowl. The often repeated
- description of the stately palm and other noble tropical
- plants, then birds, and lastly man, taking possession of
- the coral islets as soon as formed, in the Pacific, is probably
- not correct; I fear it destroys the poetry of this story, that
- feather and dirt-feeding and parasitic insects and spiders
- should be the first inhabitants of newly formed oceanic
- land.
-
- The smallest rock in the tropical seas, by giving a foundation
- for the growth of innumerable kinds of seaweed and
- compound animals, supports likewise a large number of fish.
- The sharks and the seamen in the boats maintained a constant
- struggle which should secure the greater share of the
- prey caught by the fishing-lines. I have heard that a rock
- near the Bermudas, lying many miles out at sea, and at a
- considerable depth, was first discovered by the circumstance
- of fish having been observed in the neighbourhood.
-
- FERNANDO NORONHA, Feb. 20th. -- As far as I was enabled
- to observe, during the few hours we stayed at this place, the
- constitution of the island is volcanic, but probably not of a
- recent date. The most remarkable feature is a conical hill,
- about one thousand feet high, the upper part of which is
- exceedingly steep, and on one side overhangs its base. The
- rock is phonolite, and is divided into irregular columns. On
- viewing one of these isolated masses, at first one is inclined
- to believe that it has been suddenly pushed up in a semi-fluid
- state. At St. Helena, however, I ascertained that some
- pinnacles, of a nearly similar figure and constitution, had
- been formed by the injection of melted rock into yielding
- strata, which thus had formed the moulds for these gigantic
- obelisks. The whole island is covered with wood; but from
- the dryness of the climate there is no appearance of luxuriance.
- Half-way up the mountain, some great masses of the
- columnar rock, shaded by laurel-like trees, and ornamented
- by others covered with fine pink flowers but without a single
- leaf, gave a pleasing effect to the nearer parts of the scenery.
-
- BAHIA, OR SAN SALVADOR. BRAZIL, Feb. 29th. -- The day
- has passed delightfully. Delight itself, however, is a weak
- term to express the feelings of a naturalist who, for the first
- time, has wandered by himself in a Brazilian forest. The
- elegance of the grasses, the novelty of the parasitical plants,
- the beauty of the flowers, the glossy green of the foliage,
- but above all the general luxuriance of the vegetation, filled
- me with admiration. A most paradoxical mixture of sound
- and silence pervades the shady parts of the wood. The noise
- from the insects is so loud, that it may be heard even in a
- vessel anchored several hundred yards from the shore; yet
- within the recesses of the forest a universal silence appears
- to reign. To a person fond of natural history, such a day
- as this brings with it a deeper pleasure than he can ever hope
- to experience again. After wandering about for some hours,
- I returned to the landing-place; but, before reaching it, I
- was overtaken by a tropical storm. I tried to find shelter
- under a tree, which was so thick that it would never have
- been penetrated by common English rain; but here, in a
- couple of minutes, a little torrent flowed down the trunk.
- It is to this violence of the rain that we must attribute the
- verdure at the bottom of the thickest woods: if the showers
- were like those of a colder climate, the greater part would
- be absorbed or evaporated before it reached the ground. I
- will not at present attempt to describe the gaudy scenery
- of this noble bay, because, in our homeward voyage, we
- called here a second time, and I shall then have occasion to
- remark on it.
-
- Along the whole coast of Brazil, for a length of at least
- 2000 miles, and certainly for a considerable space inland,
- wherever solid rock occurs, it belongs to a granitic formation.
- The circumstance of this enormous area being constituted of
- materials which most geologists believe to have
- been crystallized when heated under pressure, gives rise to
- many curious reflections. Was this effect produced beneath
- the depths of a profound ocean? or did a covering of strata
- formerly extend over it, which has since been removed?
- Can we believe that any power, acting for a time short of
- infinity, could have denuded the granite over so many thousand
- square leagues?
-
- On a point not far from the city, where a rivulet entered
- the sea, I observed a fact connected with a subject discussed
- by Humboldt. [7] At the cataracts of the great rivers
- Orinoco, Nile, and Congo, the syenitic rocks are coated by
- a black substance, appearing as if they had been polished
- with plumbago. The layer is of extreme thinness; and on
- analysis by Berzelius it was found to consist of the oxides
- of manganese and iron. In the Orinoco it occurs on the
- rocks periodically washed by the floods, and in those parts
- alone where the stream is rapid; or, as the Indians say, "the
- rocks are black where the waters are white." Here the coating
- is of a rich brown instead of a black colour, and seems
- to be composed of ferruginous matter alone. Hand specimens
- fail to give a just idea of these brown burnished stones
- which glitter in the sun's rays. They occur only within the
- limits of the tidal waves; and as the rivulet slowly trickles
- down, the surf must supply the polishing power of the cataracts
- in the great rivers. In like manner, the rise and fall
- of the tide probably answer to the periodical inundations;
- and thus the same effects are produced under apparently different
- but really similar circumstances. The origin, however, of
- these coatings of metallic oxides, which seem as if
- cemented to the rocks, is not understood; and no reason, I
- believe, can be assigned for their thickness remaining the
- same.
-
- One day I was amused by watching the habits of the
- Diodon antennatus, which was caught swimming near the
- shore. This fish, with its flabby skin, is well known to possess
- the singular power of distending itself into a nearly
- spherical form. After having been taken out of water for
- a short time, and then again immersed in it, a considerable
- quantity both of water and air is absorbed by the mouth,
- and perhaps likewise by the branchial orifices. This process
- is effected by two methods: the air is swallowed, and is then
- forced into the cavity of the body, its return being prevented
- by a muscular contraction which is externally visible: but
- the water enters in a gentle stream through the mouth,
- which is kept wide open and motionless; this latter action
- must, therefore, depend on suction. The skin about the
- abdomen is much looser than that on the back; hence, during
- the inflation, the lower surface becomes far more distended
- than the upper; and the fish, in consequence, floats
- with its back downwards. Cuvier doubts whether the Diodon
- in this position is able to swim; but not only can it thus
- move forward in a straight line, but it can turn round to
- either side. This latter movement is effected solely by the
- aid of the pectoral fins; the tail being collapsed, and not
- used. From the body being buoyed up with so much air, the
- branchial openings are out of water, but a stream drawn in
- by the mouth constantly flows through them.
-
- The fish, having remained in this distended state for a
- short time, generally expelled the air and water with
- considerable force from the branchial apertures and mouth. It
- could emit, at will, a certain portion of the water, and it
- appears, therefore, probable that this fluid is taken in partly
- for the sake of regulating its specific gravity. This Diodon
- possessed several means of defence. It could give a severe
- bite, and could eject water from its mouth to some distance,
- at the same time making a curious noise by the movement
- of its jaws. By the inflation of its body, the papillae, with
- which the skin is covered, become erect and pointed. But
- the most curious circumstance is, that it secretes from the
- skin of its belly, when handled, a most beautiful carmine-red
- fibrous matter, which stains ivory and paper in so permanent
- a manner that the tint is retained with all its brightness
- to the present day: I am quite ignorant of the nature
- and use of this secretion. I have heard from Dr. Allan of
- Forres, that he has frequently found a Diodon, floating alive
- and distended, in the stomach of the shark, and that on
- several occasions he has known it eat its way, not only
- through the coats of the stomach, but through the sides of
- the monster, which has thus been killed. Who would ever
- have imagined that a little soft fish could have destroyed
- the great and savage shark?
-
- March 18th. -- We sailed from Bahia. A few days afterwards,
- when not far distant from the Abrolhos Islets, my;
- attention was called to a reddish-brown appearance in the
- sea. The whole surface of the water, as it appeared under a
- weak lens, seemed as if covered by chopped bits of hay, with
- their ends jagged. These are minute cylindrical confervae,
- in bundles or rafts of from twenty to sixty in each. Mr.
- Berkeley informs me that they are the same species
- (Trichodesmium erythraeum) with that found over large spaces
- in the Red Sea, and whence its name of Red Sea is derived. [8]
- Their numbers must be infinite: the ship passed through
- several bands of them, one of which was about ten yards
- wide, and, judging from the mud-like colour of the water,
- at least two and a half miles long. In almost every long
- voyage some account is given of these confervae. They appear
- especially common in the sea near Australia; and off
- Cape Leeuwin I found an allied but smaller and apparently
- different species. Captain Cook, in his third voyage, remarks,
- that the sailors gave to this appearance the name of
- sea-sawdust.
-
- Near Keeling Atoll, in the Indian Ocean, I observed
- many little masses of confervae a few inches square, consisting
- of long cylindrical threads of excessive thinness, so as
- to be barely visible to the naked eye, mingled with other
- rather larger bodies, finely conical at both ends. Two of
- these are shown in the woodcut united together. They vary
- in length from .04 to .06, and even to .08 of an inch in
- length; and in diameter from .006 to .008 of an inch. Near
- one extremity of the cylindrical part, a green septum, formed
- of granular matter, and thickest in the middle, may generally
- be seen. This, I believe, is the bottom of a most delicate,
- colourless sac, composed of a pulpy substance, which lines
- the exterior case, but does not extend within the extreme
- conical points. In some specimens, small but perfect spheres
- of brownish granular matter supplied the
- places of the septa; and I observed the curious process by
- which they were produced. The pulpy matter of the internal
- coating suddenly grouped itself into lines, some of which
- assumed a form radiating from a common centre; it then
- continued, with an irregular and rapid movement, to contract
- itself, so that in the course of a second the whole was
- united into a perfect little sphere, which occupied the
- position of the septum at one end of the now quite hollow case.
- The formation of the granular sphere was hastened by any
- accidental injury. I may add, that frequently a pair of these
- bodies were attached to each other, as represented above,
- cone beside cone, at that end where the septum occurs.
-
- I will add here a few other observations connected with
- the discoloration of the sea from organic causes. On the
- coast of Chile, a few leagues north of Concepcion, the Beagle
- one day passed through great bands of muddy water, exactly
- like that of a swollen river; and again, a degree south of
- Valparaiso, when fifty miles from the land, the same appearance
- was still more extensive. Some of the water placed
- in a glass was of a pale reddish tint; and, examined under
- a microscope, was seen to swarm with minute animalcula
- darting about, and often exploding. Their shape is oval,
- and contracted in the middle by a ring of vibrating curved
- ciliae. It was, however, very difficult to examine them with
- care, for almost the instant motion ceased, even while crossing
- the field of vision, their bodies burst. Sometimes both
- ends burst at once, sometimes only one, and a quantity of
- coarse, brownish, granular matter was ejected. The animal
- an instant before bursting expanded to half again its natural
- size; and the explosion took place about fifteen seconds
- after the rapid progressive motion had ceased: in a few
- cases it was preceded for a short interval by a rotatory
- movement on the longer axis. About two minutes after any
- number were isolated in a drop of water, they thus perished.
- The animals move with the narrow apex forwards, by the
- aid of their vibratory ciliae, and generally by rapid starts.
- They are exceedingly minute, and quite invisible to the
- naked eye, only covering a space equal to the square of the
- thousandth of an inch. Their numbers were infinite; for
- the smallest drop of water which I could remove contained
- very many. In one day we passed through two spaces of
- water thus stained, one of which alone must have extended
- over several square miles. What incalculable numbers of
- these microscopical animals! The colour of the water, as
- seen at some distance, was like that of a river which has
- flowed through a red clay district, but under the shade of
- the vessel's side it was quite as dark as chocolate. The line
- where the red and blue water joined was distinctly defined.
- The weather for some days previously had been calm, and the
- ocean abounded, to an unusual degree, with living creatures. [9]
-
- In the sea around Tierra del Fuego, and at no great distance
- from the land, I have seen narrow lines of water of a
- bright red colour, from the number of crustacea, which
- somewhat resemble in form large prawns. The sealers call
- them whale-food. Whether whales feed on them I do not
- know; but terns, cormorants, and immense herds of great
- unwieldy seals derive, on some parts of the coast, their
- chief sustenance from these swimming crabs. Seamen
- invariably attribute the discoloration of the water to spawn;
- but I found this to be the case only on one occasion. At
- the distance of several leagues from the Archipelago of the
- Galapagos, the ship sailed through three strips of a dark
- yellowish, or mudlike water; these strips were some miles
- long, but only a few yards wide, and they were separated
- from the surrounding water by a sinuous yet distinct margin.
- The colour was caused by little gelatinous balls, about
- the fifth of an inch in diameter, in which numerous minute
- spherical ovules were imbedded: they were of two distinct
- kinds, one being of a reddish colour and of a different shape
- from the other. I cannot form a conjecture as to what two
- kinds of animals these belonged. Captain Colnett remarks,
- that this appearance is very common among the Galapagos
- Islands, and that the directions of the bands indicate that
- of the currents; in the described case, however, the line was
- caused by the wind. The only other appearance which I
- have to notice, is a thin oily coat on the water which displays
- iridescent colours. I saw a considerable tract of the
- ocean thus covered on the coast of Brazil; the seamen
- attributed it to the putrefying carcase of some whale, which
- probably was floating at no great distance. I do not here
- mention the minute gelatinous particles, hereafter to be
- referred to, which are frequently dispersed throughout the
- water, for they are not sufficiently abundant to create any
- change of colour.
-
- There are two circumstances in the above accounts which
- appear remarkable: first, how do the various bodies which
- form the bands with defined edges keep together? In the
- case of the prawn-like crabs, their movements were as
- coinstantaneous as in a regiment of soldiers; but this cannot
- happen from anything like voluntary action with the ovules,
- or the confervae, nor is it probable among the infusoria.
- Secondly, what causes the length and narrowness of the
- bands? The appearance so much resembles that which may
- be seen in every torrent, where the stream uncoils into long
- streaks the froth collected in the eddies, that I must attribute
- the effect to a similar action either of the currents of the
- air or sea. Under this supposition we must believe that the
- various organized bodies are produced in certain favourable
- places, and are thence removed by the set of either wind
- or water. I confess, however, there is a very great difficulty
- in imagining any one spot to be the birthplace of the millions
- of millions of animalcula and confervae: for whence come
- the germs at such points? -- the parent bodies having been
- distributed by the winds and waves over the immense ocean.
- But on no other hypothesis can I understand their linear
- grouping. I may add that Scoresby remarks that green
- water abounding with pelagic animals is invariably found
- in a certain part of the Arctic Sea.
-
- [1] I state this on the authority of Dr. E. Dieffenbach, in his
- German translation of the first edition of this Journal.
-
- [2] The Cape de Verd Islands were discovered in 1449. There was
- a tombstone of a bishop with the date of 1571; and a crest of a
- hand and dagger, dated 1497.
-
- [3] I must take this opportunity of acknowledging the great
- kindness with which this illustrious naturalist has examined
- many of my specimens. I have sent (June, 1845) a full account
- of the falling of this dust to the Geological Society.
-
- [4] So named according to Patrick Symes's nomenclature.
-
- [5] See Encyclop. of Anat. and Physiol., article Cephalopoda
-
- [6] Mr. Horner and Sir David Brewster have described
- (Philosophical Transactions, 1836, p. 65) a singular
- "artificial substance resembling shell." It is deposited in
- fine, transparent, highly polished, brown-coloured laminae,
- possessing peculiar optical properties, on the inside of a
- vessel, in which cloth, first prepared with glue and then
- with lime, is made to revolve rapidly in water. It is much
- softer, more transparent, and contains more animal matter,
- than the natural incrustation at Ascension; but we here
- again see the strong tendency which carbonate of lime and
- animal matter evince to form a solid substance allied to
- shell.
-
- [7] Pers. Narr., vol. v., pt. 1., p. 18.
-
- [8] M. Montagne, in Comptes Rendus, etc., Juillet, 1844; and
- Annal. des Scienc. Nat., Dec. 1844
-
- [9] M. Lesson (Voyage de la Coquille, tom. i., p. 255) mentions
- red water off Lima, apparently produced by the same cause.
- Peron, the distinguished naturalist, in the Voyage aux Terres
- Australes, gives no less than twelve references to voyagers
- who have alluded to the discoloured waters of the sea (vol.
- ii. p. 239). To the references given by Peron may be added,
- Humboldt's Pers. Narr., vol. vi. p. 804; Flinder's Voyage,
- vol. i. p. 92; Labillardiere, vol. i. p. 287; Ulloa's Voyage;
- Voyage of the Astrolabe and of the Coquille; Captain King's
- Survey of Australia, etc.
-
-
-
- CHAPTER II
-
- RIO DE JANEIRO
-
- Rio de Janeiro -- Excursion north of Cape Frio -- Great
- Evaporation -- Slavery -- Botofogo Bay -- Terrestrial
- Planariae -- Clouds on the Corcovado -- Heavy Rain -- Musical
- Frogs -- Phosphorescent Insects -- Elater, springing powers
- of -- Blue Haze -- Noise made by a Butterfly -- Entomology --
- Ants -- Wasp killing a Spider -- Parasitical Spider --
- Artifices of an Epeira -- Gregarious Spider -- Spider with
- an unsymmetrical Web.
-
-
- APRIL 4th to July 5th, 1832. -- A few days after our
- arrival I became acquainted with an Englishman who
- was going to visit his estate, situated rather more
- than a hundred miles from the capital, to the northward of
- Cape Frio. I gladly accepted his kind offer of allowing me
- to accompany him.
-
- April 8th. -- Our party amounted to seven. The first stage
- was very interesting. The day was powerfully hot, and as
- we passed through the woods, everything was motionless,
- excepting the large and brilliant butterflies, which lazily
- fluttered about. The view seen when crossing the hills
- behind Praia Grande was most beautiful; the colours were
- intense, and the prevailing tint a dark blue; the sky and the
- calm waters of the bay vied with each other in splendour.
- After passing through some cultivated country, we entered
- a forest, which in the grandeur of all its parts could not be
- exceeded. We arrived by midday at Ithacaia; this small
- village is situated on a plain, and round the central house
- are the huts of the negroes. These, from their regular form
- and position, reminded me of the drawings of the Hottentot
- habitations in Southern Africa. As the moon rose early, we
- determined to start the same evening for our sleeping-place
- at the Lagoa Marica. As it was growing dark we passed
- under one of the massive, bare, and steep hills of granite
- which are so common in this country. This spot is notorious
- from having been, for a long time, the residence of some
- runaway slaves, who, by cultivating a little ground near the
- top, contrived to eke out a subsistence. At length they were
- discovered, and a party of soldiers being sent, the whole
- were seized with the exception of one old woman, who,
- sooner than again be led into slavery, dashed herself to
- pieces from the summit of the mountain. In a Roman
- matron this would have been called the noble love of freedom:
- in a poor negress it is mere brutal obstinacy. We
- continued riding for some hours. For the few last miles the
- road was intricate, and it passed through a desert waste of
- marshes and lagoons. The scene by the dimmed light of the
- moon was most desolate. A few fireflies flitted by us; and
- the solitary snipe, as it rose, uttered its plaintive cry. The
- distant and sullen roar of the sea scarcely broke the stillness
- of the night.
-
- April 9th. -- We left our miserable sleeping-place before
- sunrise. The road passed through a narrow sandy plain,
- lying between the sea and the interior salt lagoons. The
- number of beautiful fishing birds, such as egrets and cranes,
- and the succulent plants assuming most fantastical forms,
- gave to the scene an interest which it would not otherwise
- have possessed. The few stunted trees were loaded with
- parasitical plants, among which the beauty and delicious
- fragrance of some of the orchideae were most to be admired.
- As the sun rose, the day became extremely hot, and the
- reflection of the light and heat from the white sand was very
- distressing. We dined at Mandetiba; the thermometer in
- the shade being 84 degs. The beautiful view of the distant
- wooded hills, reflected in the perfectly calm water of an
- extensive lagoon, quite refreshed us. As the venda [1] here
- was a very good one, and I have the pleasant, but rare
- remembrance, of an excellent dinner, I will be grateful and
- presently describe it, as the type of its class. These houses
- are often large, and are built of thick upright posts, with
- boughs interwoven, and afterwards plastered. They seldom
- have floors, and never glazed windows; but are generally
- pretty well roofed. Universally the front part is open, forming
- a kind of verandah, in which tables and benches are
- placed. The bed-rooms join on each side, and here the passenger
- may sleep as comfortably as he can, on a wooden
- platform, covered by a thin straw mat. The venda stands
- in a courtyard, where the horses are fed. On first arriving
- it was our custom to unsaddle the horses and give them
- their Indian corn; then, with a low bow, to ask the senhor
- to do us the favour to give up something to eat. "Anything
- you choose, sir," was his usual answer. For the few first
- times, vainly I thanked providence for having guided us
- to so good a man. The conversation proceeding, the case
- universally became deplorable. "Any fish can you do us the
- favour of giving ?" -- "Oh! no, sir." -- "Any soup?" -- "No,
- sir." -- "Any bread?" -- "Oh! no, sir." -- "Any dried meat?"
- -- "Oh! no, sir." If we were lucky, by waiting a couple of
- hours, we obtained fowls, rice, and farinha. It not unfrequently
- happened, that we were obliged to kill, with stones,
- the poultry for our own supper. When, thoroughly exhausted
- by fatigue and hunger, we timorously hinted that we should
- be glad of our meal, the pompous, and (though true) most
- unsatisfactory answer was, "It will be ready when it is
- ready." If we had dared to remonstrate any further, we
- should have been told to proceed on our journey, as being
- too impertinent. The hosts are most ungracious and disagreeable
- in their manners; their houses and their persons
- are often filthily dirty; the want of the accommodation of
- forks, knives, and spoons is common; and I am sure no cottage
- or hovel in England could be found in a state so utterly
- destitute of every comfort. At Campos Novos, however, we
- fared sumptuously; having rice and fowls, biscuit, wine, and
- spirits, for dinner; coffee in the evening, and fish with coffee
- for breakfast. All this, with good food for the horses, only
- cost 2s. 6d. per head. Yet the host of this venda, being
- asked if he knew anything of a whip which one of the party
- had lost, gruffly answered, "How should I know? why did
- you not take care of it? -- I suppose the dogs have eaten it."
-
- Leaving Mandetiba, we continued to pass through an intricate
- wilderness of lakes; in some of which were fresh,
- in others salt water shells. Of the former kinds, I found
- a Limnaea in great numbers in a lake, into which, the inhabitants
- assured me that the sea enters once a year, and
- sometimes oftener, and makes the water quite salt. I have
- no doubt many interesting facts, in relation to marine and
- fresh water animals, might be observed in this chain of
- lagoons, which skirt the coast of Brazil. M. Gay [2] has
- stated that he found in the neighbourhood of Rio, shells of
- the marine genera solen and mytilus, and fresh water ampullariae,
- living together in brackish water. I also frequently
- observed in the lagoon near the Botanic Garden, where the
- water is only a little less salt than in the sea, a species of
- hydrophilus, very similar to a water-beetle common in the
- ditches of England: in the same lake the only shell belonged
- to a genus generally found in estuaries.
-
- Leaving the coast for a time, we again entered the forest.
- The trees were very lofty, and remarkable, compared with
- those of Europe, from the whiteness of their trunks. I see
- by my note-book, "wonderful and beautiful, flowering parasites,"
- invariably struck me as the most novel object in these
- grand scenes. Travelling onwards we passed through tracts
- of pasturage, much injured by the enormous conical ants'
- nests, which were nearly twelve feet high. They gave to the
- plain exactly the appearance of the mud volcanos at Jorullo,
- as figured by Humboldt. We arrived at Engenhodo after it
- was dark, having been ten hours on horseback. I never
- ceased, during the whole journey, to be surprised at the
- amount of labour which the horses were capable of enduring;
- they appeared also to recover from any injury much
- sooner than those of our English breed. The Vampire bat
- is often the cause of much trouble, by biting the horses on
- their withers. The injury is generally not so much owing
- to the loss of blood, as to the inflammation which the pressure
- of the saddle afterwards produces. The whole circumstance
- has lately been doubted in England; I was therefore
- fortunate in being present when one (Desmodus d'orbignyi,
- Wat.) was actually caught on a horse's back. We were
- bivouacking late one evening near Coquimbo, in Chile, when
- my servant, noticing that one of the horses was very restive,
- went to see what was the matter, and fancying he could
- distinguish something, suddenly put his hand on the beast's
- withers, and secured the vampire. In the morning the spot
- where the bite had been inflicted was easily distinguished
- from being slightly swollen and bloody. The third day
- afterwards we rode the horse, without any ill effects.
-
- April 13th. -- After three days' travelling we arrived at
- Socego, the estate of Senhor Manuel Figuireda, a relation
- of one of our party. The house was simple, and, though like
- a barn in form, was well suited to the climate. In the sitting-
- room gilded chairs and sofas were oddly contrasted with the
- whitewashed walls, thatched roof, and windows without
- glass. The house, together with the granaries, the stables,
- and workshops for the blacks, who had been taught various
- trades, formed a rude kind of quadrangle; in the centre
- of which a large pile of coffee was drying. These buildings
- stand on a little hill, overlooking the cultivated ground, and
- surrounded on every side by a wall of dark green luxuriant
- forest. The chief produce of this part of the country is
- coffee. Each tree is supposed to yield annually, on an average,
- two pounds; but some give as much as eight. Mandioca
- or cassada is likewise cultivated in great quantity. Every
- part of this plant is useful; the leaves and stalks are eaten
- by the horses, and the roots are ground into a pulp, which,
- when pressed dry and baked, forms the farinha, the principal
- article of sustenance in the Brazils. It is a curious,
- though well-known fact, that the juice of this most nutritious
- plant is highly poisonous. A few years ago a cow died at
- this Fazenda, in consequence of having drunk some of it.
- Senhor Figuireda told me that he had planted, the year before,
- one bag of feijao or beans, and three of rice; the
- former of which produced eighty, and the latter three hundred
- and twenty fold. The pasturage supports a fine stock
- of cattle, and the woods are so full of game that a deer had
- been killed on each of the three previous days. This profusion
- of food showed itself at dinner, where, if the tables did
- not groan, the guests surely did; for each person is expected
- to eat of every dish. One day, having, as I thought, nicely
- calculated so that nothing should go away untasted, to my
- utter dismay a roast turkey and a pig appeared in all their
- substantial reality. During the meals, it was the employment
- of a man to drive out of the room sundry old hounds,
- and dozens of little black children, which crawled in together,
- at every opportunity. As long as the idea of slavery could be
- banished, there was something exceedingly fascinating in
- this simple and patriarchal style of living: it was such a
- perfect retirement and independence from the rest of the
- world.
-
- As soon as any stranger is seen arriving, a large bell is set
- tolling, and generally some small cannon are fired. The
- event is thus announced to the rocks and woods, but to nothing
- else. One morning I walked out an hour before daylight
- to admire the solemn stillness of the scene; at last, the
- silence was broken by the morning hymn, raised on high by the
- whole body of the blacks; and in this manner their daily
- work is generally begun. On such fazendas as these, I have
- no doubt the slaves pass happy and contented lives. On
- Saturday and Sunday they work for themselves, and in this
- fertile climate the labour of two days is sufficient to support
- a man and his family for the whole week.
-
- April 14th. -- Leaving Socego, we rode to another estate on
- the Rio Macae, which was the last patch of cultivated ground
- in that direction. The estate was two and a half miles long,
- and the owner had forgotten how many broad. Only a very
- small piece had been cleared, yet almost every acre was
- capable of yielding all the various rich productions of a tropical
- land. Considering the enormous area of Brazil, the proportion
- of cultivated ground can scarcely be considered as
- anything, compared to that which is left in the state of
- nature: at some future age, how vast a population it will
- support! During the second day's journey we found the
- road so shut up, that it was necessary that a man should go
- ahead with a sword to cut away the creepers. The forest
- abounded with beautiful objects; among which the tree ferns,
- though not large, were, from their bright green foliage, and
- the elegant curvature of their fronds, most worthy of admiration.
- In the evening it rained very heavily, and although the
- thermometer stood at 65 degs., I felt very cold. As soon as
- the rain ceased, it was curious to observe the extraordinary
- evaporation which commenced over the whole extent of the
- forest. At the height of a hundred feet the hills were buried
- in a dense white vapour, which rose like columns of smoke
- from the most thickly wooded parts, and especially from the
- valleys. I observed this phenomenon on several occasions.
- I suppose it is owing to the large surface of foliage, previously
- heated by the sun's rays.
-
- While staying at this estate, I was very nearly being an
- eye-witness to one of those atrocious acts which can only
- take place in a slave country. Owing to a quarrel and a
- lawsuit, the owner was on the point of taking all the women
- and children from the male slaves, and selling them separately
- at the public auction at Rio. Interest, and not any
- feeling of compassion, prevented this act. Indeed, I do not
- believe the inhumanity of separating thirty families, who
- had lived together for many years, even occurred to the
- owner. Yet I will pledge myself, that in humanity and
- good feeling he was superior to the common run of men.
- It may be said there exists no limit to the blindness of interest
- and selfish habit. I may mention one very trifling anecdote,
- which at the time struck me more forcibly than any
- story of cruelty. I was crossing a ferry with a negro, who
- was uncommonly stupid. In endeavouring to make him
- understand, I talked loud, and made signs, in doing which I
- passed my hand near his face. He, I suppose, thought I was
- in a passion, and was going to strike him; for instantly,
- with a frightened look and half-shut eyes, he dropped his
- hands. I shall never forget my feelings of surprise, disgust,
- and shame, at seeing a great powerful man afraid even to
- ward off a blow, directed, as he thought, at his face. This
- man had been trained to a degradation lower than the
- slavery of the most helpless animal.
-
- April 18th. -- In returning we spent two days at Socego,
- and I employed them in collecting insects in the forest. The
- greater number of trees, although so lofty, are not more
- than three or four feet in circumference. There are, of
- course, a few of much greater dimensions. Senhor Manuel
- was then making a canoe 70 feet in length from a solid trunk,
- which had originally been 110 feet long, and of great thickness.
- The contrast of palm trees, growing amidst the common
- branching kinds, never fails to give the scene an intertropical
- character. Here the woods were ornamented by the
- Cabbage Palm -- one of the most beautiful of its family. With
- a stem so narrow that it might be clasped with the two
- hands, it waves its elegant head at the height of forty or
- fifty feet above the ground. The woody creepers, themselves
- covered by other creepers, were of great thickness: some
- which I measured were two feet in circumference. Many of
- the older trees presented a very curious appearance from
- the tresses of a liana hanging from their boughs, and resembling
- bundles of hay. If the eye was turned from the world
- of foliage above, to the ground beneath, it was attracted by
- the extreme elegance of the leaves of the ferns and mimosae.
- The latter, in some parts, covered the surface with a brushwood
- only a few inches high. In walking across these thick
- beds of mimosae, a broad track was marked by the change
- of shade, produced by the drooping of their sensitive petioles.
- It is easy to specify the individual objects of admiration in
- these grand scenes; but it is not possible to give an adequate
- idea of the higher feelings of wonder, astonishment, and
- devotion, which fill and elevate the mind.
-
- April 19th.--Leaving Socego, during the two first days,
- we retraced our steps. It was very wearisome work, as the
- road generally ran across a glaring hot sandy plain, not
- far from the coast. I noticed that each time the horse put
- its foot on the fine siliceous sand, a gentle chirping noise
- was produced. On the third day we took a different line,
- and passed through the gay little village of Madre de Deos.
- This is one of the principal lines of road in Brazil; yet it
- was in so bad a state that no wheeled vehicle, excepting the
- clumsy bullock-wagon, could pass along. In our whole journey
- we did not cross a single bridge built of stone; and
- those made of logs of wood were frequently so much out of
- repair, that it was necessary to go on one side to avoid them.
- All distances are inaccurately known. The road is often
- marked by crosses, in the place of milestones, to signify
- where human blood has been spilled. On the evening of the
- 23rd we arrived at Rio, having finished our pleasant little
- excursion.
-
- During the remainder of my stay at Rio, I resided in a
- cottage at Botofogo Bay. It was impossible to wish for
- anything more delightful than thus to spend some weeks
- in so magnificent a country. In England any person fond
- of natural history enjoys in his walks a great advantage, by
- always having something to attract his attention; but in
- these fertile climates, teeming with life, the attractions are
- so numerous, that he is scarcely able to walk at all.
-
- The few observations which I was enabled to make were
- almost exclusively confined to the invertebrate animals. The
- existence of a division of the genus Planaria, which inhabits
- the dry land, interested me much. These animals are of so
- simple a structure, that Cuvier has arranged them with the
- intestinal worms, though never found within the bodies of
- other animals. Numerous species inhabit both salt and fresh
- water; but those to which I allude were found, even in the
- drier parts of the forest, beneath logs of rotten wood, on
- which I believe they feed. In general form they resemble
- little slugs, but are very much narrower in proportion, and
- several of the species are beautifully coloured with
- longitudinal stripes. Their structure is very simple: near the
- middle of the under or crawling surface there are two small
- transverse slits, from the anterior one of which a funnel-
- shaped and highly irritable mouth can be protruded. For
- some time after the rest of the animal was completely dead
- from the effects of salt water or any other cause, this organ
- still retained its vitality.
-
- I found no less than twelve different species of terrestrial
- Planariae in different parts of the southern hemisphere. [3]
- Some specimens which I obtained at Van Dieman's Land,
- I kept alive for nearly two months, feeding them on rotten
- wood. Having cut one of them transversely into two nearly
- equal parts, in the course of a fortnight both had the shape
- of perfect animals. I had, however, so divided the body,
- that one of the halves contained both the inferior orifices,
- and the other, in consequence, none. In the course of twenty-
- five days from the operation, the more perfect half could
- not have been distinguished from any other specimen. The
- other had increased much in size; and towards its posterior
- end, a clear space was formed in the parenchymatous mass,
- in which a rudimentary cup-shaped mouth could clearly be
- distinguished; on the under surface, however, no corresponding
- slit was yet open. If the increased heat of the weather,
- as we approached the equator, had not destroyed all the
- individuals, there can be no doubt that this last step would
- have completed its structure. Although so well-known an
- experiment, it was interesting to watch the gradual production
- of every essential organ, out of the simple extremity
- of another animal. It is extremely difficult to preserve these
- Planariae; as soon as the cessation of life allows the ordinary
- laws of change to act, their entire bodies become soft
- and fluid, with a rapidity which I have never seen equalled.
-
- I first visited the forest in which these Planariae were
- found, in company with an old Portuguese priest who took
- me out to hunt with him. The sport consisted in turning
- into the cover a few dogs, and then patiently waiting to fire
- at any animal which might appear. We were accompanied
- by the son of a neighbouring farmer -- a good specimen of
- a wild Brazilian youth. He was dressed in a tattered old
- shirt and trousers, and had his head uncovered: he carried
- an old-fashioned gun and a large knife. The habit of carrying
- the knife is universal; and in traversing a thick wood
- it is almost necessary, on account of the creeping plants.
- The frequent occurrence of murder may be partly attributed
- to this habit. The Brazilians are so dexterous with the
- knife, that they can throw it to some distance with precision,
- and with sufficient force to cause a fatal wound. I have seen
- a number of little boys practising this art as a game of play
- and from their skill in hitting an upright stick, they promised
- well for more earnest attempts. My companion, the day
- before, had shot two large bearded monkeys. These animals
- have prehensile tails, the extremity of which, even after
- death, can support the whole weight of the body. One of
- them thus remained fast to a branch, and it was necessary
- to cut down a large tree to procure it. This was soon effected,
- and down came tree and monkey with an awful crash. Our
- day's sport, besides the monkey, was confined to sundry small
- green parrots and a few toucans. I profited, however, by my
- acquaintance with the Portuguese padre, for on another
- occasion he gave me a fine specimen of the Yagouaroundi
- cat.
-
- Every one has heard of the beauty of the scenery near
- Botofogo. The house in which I lived was seated close
- beneath the well-known mountain of the Corcovado. It has
- been remarked, with much truth, that abruptly conical hills
- are characteristic of the formation which Humboldt designates
- as gneiss-granite. Nothing can be more striking than
- the effect of these huge rounded masses of naked rock rising
- out of the most luxuriant vegetation.
-
- I was often interested by watching the clouds, which,
- rolling in from seaward, formed a bank just beneath the
- highest point of the Corcovado. This mountain, like most
- others, when thus partly veiled, appeared to rise to a far
- prouder elevation than its real height of 2300 feet. Mr.
- Daniell has observed, in his meteorological essays, that a
- cloud sometimes appears fixed on a mountain summit, while
- the wind continues to blow over it. The same phenomenon
- here presented a slightly different appearance. In this case
- the cloud was clearly seen to curl over, and rapidly pass
- by the summit, and yet was neither diminished nor increased
- in size. The sun was setting, and a gentle southerly breeze,
- striking against the southern side of the rock, mingled its
- current with the colder air above; and the vapour was thus
- condensed; but as the light wreaths of cloud passed over
- the ridge, and came within the influence of the warmer
- atmosphere of the northern sloping bank, they were immediately
- re-dissolved.
-
- The climate, during the months of May and June, or the
- beginning of winter, was delightful. The mean temperature,
- from observations taken at nine o'clock, both morning
- and evening, was only 72 degs. It often rained heavily, but
- the drying southerly winds soon again rendered the walks
- pleasant. One morning, in the course of six hours, 1.6 inches
- of rain fell. As this storm passed over the forests which
- surround the Corcovado, the sound produced by the drops
- pattering on the countless multitude of leaves was very
- remarkable, it could be heard at the distance of a quarter of
- a mile, and was like the rushing of a great body of water.
- After the hotter days, it was delicious to sit quietly in the
- garden and watch the evening pass into night. Nature, in
- these climes, chooses her vocalists from more humble performers
- than in Europe. A small frog, of the genus Hyla,
- sits on a blade of grass about an inch above the surface of
- the water, and sends forth a pleasing chirp: when several
- are together they sing in harmony on different notes. I had
- some difficulty in catching a specimen of this frog. The
- genus Hyla has its toes terminated by small suckers; and I
- found this animal could crawl up a pane of glass, when
- placed absolutely perpendicular. Various cicidae and crickets,
- at the same time, keep up a ceaseless shrill cry, but which,
- softened by the distance, is not unpleasant. Every evening
- after dark this great concert commenced; and often have I
- sat listening to it, until my attention has been drawn away
- by some curious passing insect.
-
- At these times the fireflies are seen flitting about from
- hedge to hedge. On a dark night the light can be seen at
- about two hundred paces distant. It is remarkable that in
- all the different kinds of glowworms, shining elaters, and
- various marine animals (such as the crustacea, medusae,
- nereidae, a coralline of the genus Clytia, and Pyrosma),
- which I have observed, the light has been of a well-marked
- green colour. All the fireflies, which I caught here, belonged
- to the Lampyridae (in which family the English glowworm
- is included), and the greater number of specimens were of
- Lampyris occidentalis. [4] I found that this insect emitted
- the most brilliant flashes when irritated: in the intervals,
- the abdominal rings were obscured. The flash was almost
- co-instantaneous in the two rings, but it was just perceptible
- first in the anterior one. The shining matter was fluid and
- very adhesive: little spots, where the skin had been torn,
- continued bright with a slight scintillation, whilst the
- uninjured parts were obscured. When the insect was decapitated
- the rings remained uninterruptedly bright, but not so brilliant
- as before: local irritation with a needle always increased
- the vividness of the light. The rings in one instance retained
- their luminous property nearly twenty-four hours after the
- death of the insect. From these facts it would appear probable,
- that the animal has only the power of concealing or
- extinguishing the light for short intervals, and that at other
- times the display is involuntary. On the muddy and wet
- gravel-walks I found the larvae of this lampyris in great
- numbers: they resembled in general form the female of the
- English glowworm. These larvae possessed but feeble luminous
- powers; very differently from their parents, on the
- slightest touch they feigned death and ceased to shine; nor
- did irritation excite any fresh display. I kept several of
- them alive for some time: their tails are very singular organs,
- for they act, by a well-fitted contrivance, as suckers or organs
- of attachment, and likewise as reservoirs for saliva, or some
- such fluid. I repeatedly fed them on raw meat; and I invariably
- observed, that every now and then the extremity
- of the tail was applied to the mouth, and a drop of fluid
- exuded on the meat, which was then in the act of being consumed.
- The tail, notwithstanding so much practice, does not
- seem to be able to find its way to the mouth; at least the neck
- was always touched first, and apparently as a guide.
-
- When we were at Bahia, an elater or beetle (Pyrophorus
- luminosus, Illig.) seemed the most common luminous insect.
- The light in this case was also rendered more brilliant by
- irritation. I amused myself one day by observing the springing
- powers of this insect, which have not, as it appears to
- me, been properly described. [5] The elater, when placed on
- its back and preparing to spring, moved its head and thorax
- backwards, so that the pectoral spine was drawn out, and
- rested on the edge of its sheath. The same backward movement
- being continued, the spine, by the full action of the
- muscles, was bent like a spring; and the insect at this moment
- rested on the extremity of its head and wing-cases.
- The effort being suddenly relaxed, the head and thorax flew
- up, and in consequence, the base of the wing-cases struck
- the supporting surface with such force, that the insect by
- the reaction was jerked upwards to the height of one or
- two inches. The projecting points of the thorax, and the
- sheath of the spine, served to steady the whole body during
- the spring. In the descriptions which I have read, sufficient
- stress does not appear to have been laid on the elasticity of
- the spine: so sudden a spring could not be the result of simple
- muscular contraction, without the aid of some mechanical
- contrivance.
-
- On several occasions I enjoyed some short but most pleasant
- excursions in the neighbouring country. One day I went
- to the Botanic Garden, where many plants, well known for
- their great utility, might be seen growing. The leaves of the
- camphor, pepper, cinnamon, and clove trees were delightfully
- aromatic; and the bread-fruit, the jaca, and the mango,
- vied with each other in the magnificence of their foliage.
- The landscape in the neighbourhood of Bahia almost takes
- its character from the two latter trees. Before seeing them,
- I had no idea that any trees could cast so black a shade on
- the ground. Both of them bear to the evergreen vegetation
- of these climates the same kind of relation which laurels
- and hollies in England do to the lighter green of the deciduous
- trees. It may be observed, that the houses within the
- tropics are surrounded by the most beautiful forms of
- vegetation, because many of them are at the same time most
- useful to man. Who can doubt that these qualities are united
- in the banana, the cocoa-nut, the many kinds of palm, the
- orange, and the bread-fruit tree?
-
- During this day I was particularly struck with a remark
- of Humboldt's, who often alludes to "the thin vapour which,
- without changing the transparency of the air, renders its
- tints more harmonious, and softens its effects." This is an
- appearance which I have never observed in the temperate
- zones. The atmosphere, seen through a short space of half
- or three-quarters of a mile, was perfectly lucid, but at a
- greater distance all colours were blended into a most beautiful
- haze, of a pale French grey, mingled with a little blue.
- The condition of the atmosphere between the morning and
- about noon, when the effect was most evident, had undergone
- little change, excepting in its dryness. In the interval,
- the difference between the dew point and temperature had
- increased from 7.5 to 17 degs.
-
- On another occasion I started early and walked to the
- Gavia, or topsail mountain. The air was delightfully cool
- and fragrant; and the drops of dew still glittered on the
- leaves of the large liliaceous plants, which shaded the
- streamlets of clear water. Sitting down on a block of granite,
- it was delightful to watch the various insects and birds as
- they flew past. The humming-bird seems particularly fond of
- such shady retired spots. Whenever I saw these little creatures
- buzzing round a flower, with their wings vibrating so
- rapidly as to be scarcely visible, I was reminded of the
- sphinx moths: their movements and habits are indeed in
- many respects very similar.
-
- Following a pathway, I entered a noble forest, and from
- a height of five or six hundred feet, one of those splendid
- views was presented, which are so common on every side
- of Rio. At this elevation the landscape attains its most
- brilliant tint; and every form, every shade, so completely
- surpasses in magnificence all that the European has ever
- beheld in his own country, that he knows not how to express
- his feelings. The general effect frequently recalled
- to my mind the gayest scenery of the Opera-house or the
- great theatres. I never returned from these excursions
- empty-handed. This day I found a specimen of a curious
- fungus, called Hymenophallus. Most people know the English
- Phallus, which in autumn taints the air with its odious
- smell: this, however, as the entomologist is aware, is, to
- some of our beetles a delightful fragrance. So was it here;
- for a Strongylus, attracted by the odour, alighted on the
- fungus as I carried it in my hand. We here see in two distant
- countries a similar relation between plants and insects of the
- same families, though the species of both are different. When
- man is the agent in introducing into a country a new species,
- this relation is often broken: as one instance of this I may
- mention, that the leaves of the cabbages and lettuces, which
- in England afford food to such a multitude of slugs and
- caterpillars, in the gardens near Rio are untouched.
-
- During our stay at Brazil I made a large collection of
- insects. A few general observations on the comparative
- importance of the different orders may be interesting to the
- English entomologist. The large and brilliantly coloured
- Lepidoptera bespeak the zone they inhabit, far more plainly
- than any other race of animals. I allude only to the
- butterflies; for the moths, contrary to what might have been
- expected from the rankness of the vegetation, certainly
- appeared in much fewer numbers than in our own temperate
- regions. I was much surprised at the habits of Papilio
- feronia. This butterfly is not uncommon, and generally
- frequents the orange-groves. Although a high flier, yet
- it very frequently alights on the trunks of trees. On these
- occasions its head is invariably placed downwards; and its
- wings are expanded in a horizontal plane, instead of being
- folded vertically, as is commonly the case. This is the only
- butterfly which I have ever seen, that uses its legs for running.
- Not being aware of this fact, the insect, more than once, as I
- cautiously approached with my forceps, shuffled on one side
- just as the instrument was on the point of closing, and thus
- escaped. But a far more singular fact is the power which
- this species possesses of making a noise. [6] Several times when
- a pair, probably male and female, were chasing each other
- in an irregular course, they passed within a few yards of me;
- and I distinctly heard a clicking noise, similar to that
- produced by a toothed wheel passing under a spring catch. The
- noise was continued at short intervals, and could be
- distinguished at about twenty yards' distance: I am certain
- there is no error in the observation.
-
- I was disappointed in the general aspect of the Coleoptera.
- The number of minute and obscurely coloured beetles
- is exceedingly great. [7] The cabinets of Europe can, as yet,
- boast only of the larger species from tropical climates. It
- is sufficient to disturb the composure of an entomologist's
- mind, to look forward to the future dimensions of a complete
- catalogue. The carnivorous beetles, or Carabidae, appear
- in extremely few numbers within the tropics: this is
- the more remarkable when compared to the case of the
- carnivorous quadrupeds, which are so abundant in hot
- countries. I was struck with this observation both on entering
- Brazil, and when I saw the many elegant and active forms
- of the Harpalidae re-appearing on the temperate plains of
- La Plata. Do the very numerous spiders and rapacious
- Hymenoptera supply the place of the carnivorous beetles?
- The carrion-feeders and Brachelytra are very uncommon;
- on the other hand, the Rhyncophora and Chrysomelidae, all
- of which depend on the vegetable world for subsistence, are
- present in astonishing numbers. I do not here refer to the
- number of different species, but to that of the individual
- insects; for on this it is that the most striking character in
- the entomology of different countries depends. The orders
- Orthoptera and Hemiptera are particularly numerous; as
- likewise is the stinging division of the Hymenoptera the bees,
- perhaps, being excepted. A person, on first entering a tropical
- forest, is astonished at the labours of the ants: well-beaten
- paths branch off in every direction, on which an army
- of never-failing foragers may be seen, some going forth, and
- others returning, burdened with pieces of green leaf, often
- larger than their own bodies.
-
- A small dark-coloured ant sometimes migrates in countless
- numbers. One day, at Bahia, my attention was drawn
- by observing many spiders, cockroaches, and other insects,
- and some lizards, rushing in the greatest agitation across
- a bare piece of ground. A little way behind, every stalk and
- leaf was blackened by a small ant. The swarm having
- crossed the bare space, divided itself, and descended an old
- wall. By this means many insects were fairly enclosed; and
- the efforts which the poor little creatures made to extricate
- themselves from such a death were wonderful. When the
- ants came to the road they changed their course, and in
- narrow files reascended the wall. Having placed a small
- stone so as to intercept one of the lines, the whole body
- attacked it, and then immediately retired. Shortly afterwards
- another body came to the charge, and again having failed
- to make any impression, this line of march was entirely
- given up. By going an inch round, the file might have
- avoided the stone, and this doubtless would have happened,
- if it had been originally there: but having been attacked, the
- lion-hearted little warriors scorned the idea of yielding.
-
- Certain wasp-like insects, which construct in the corners
- of the verandahs clay cells for their larvae, are very numerous
- in the neighbourhood of Rio. These cells they stuff full
- of half-dead spiders and caterpillars, which they seem
- wonderfully to know how to sting to that degree as to leave
- them paralysed but alive, until their eggs are hatched; and
- the larvae feed on the horrid mass of powerless, half-killed
- victims -- a sight which has been described by an enthusiastic
- naturalist [8] as curious and pleasing! I was much interested
- one day by watching a deadly contest between a Pepsis and
- a large spider of the genus Lycosa. The wasp made a sudden
- dash at its prey, and then flew away: the spider was evidently
- wounded, for, trying to escape, it rolled down a little
- slope, but had still strength sufficient to crawl into a thick
- tuft of grass. The wasp soon returned, and seemed surprised
- at not immediately finding its victim. It then commenced
- as regular a hunt as ever hound did after fox;
- making short semicircular casts, and all the time rapidly vibrating
- its wings and antennae. The spider, though well
- concealed, was soon discovered, and the wasp, evidently still
- afraid of its adversary's jaws, after much manoeuvring, inflicted
- two stings on the under side of its thorax. At last,
- carefully examining with its antennae the now motionless
- spider, it proceeded to drag away the body. But I stopped
- both tyrant and prey. [9]
-
- The number of spiders, in proportion to other insects, is
- here compared with England very much larger; perhaps
- more so than with any other division of the articulate animals.
- The variety of species among the jumping spiders
- appears almost infinite. The genus, or rather family, of
- Epeira, is here characterized by many singular forms; some
- species have pointed coriaceous shells, others enlarged and
- spiny tibiae. Every path in the forest is barricaded with the
- strong yellow web of a species, belonging to the same division
- with the Epeira clavipes of Fabricius, which was formerly
- said by Sloane to make, in the West Indies, webs so
- strong as to catch birds. A small and pretty kind of spider,
- with very long fore-legs, and which appears to belong to an
- undescribed genus, lives as a parasite on almost every one
- of these webs. I suppose it is too insignificant to be noticed
- by the great Epeira, and is therefore allowed to prey on the
- minute insects, which, adhering to the lines, would otherwise
- be wasted. When frightened, this little spider either
- feigns death by extending its front legs, or suddenly drops
- from the web. A large Epeira of the same division with
- Epeira tuberculata and conica is extremely common, especially
- in dry situations. Its web, which is generally placed
- among the great leaves of the common agave, is sometimes
- strengthened near the centre by a pair or even four zigzag
- ribbons, which connect two adjoining rays. When any large
- insect, as a grasshopper or wasp, is caught, the spider, by
- a dexterous movement, makes it revolve very rapidly, and at
- the same time emitting a band of threads from its spinners,
- soon envelops its prey in a case like the cocoon of a silkworm.
- The spider now examines the powerless victim, and
- gives the fatal bite on the hinder part of its thorax; then
- retreating, patiently waits till the poison has taken effect.
- The virulence of this poison may be judged of from the fact
- that in half a minute I opened the mesh, and found a large
- wasp quite lifeless. This Epeira always stands with its head
- downwards near the centre of the web. When disturbed, it
- acts differently according to circumstances: if there is a
- thicket below, it suddenly falls down; and I have distinctly
- seen the thread from the spinners lengthened by the animal
- while yet stationary, as preparatory to its fall. If the ground
- is clear beneath, the Epeira seldom falls, but moves quickly
- through a central passage from one to the other side. When
- still further disturbed, it practises a most curious manoeuvre:
- standing in the middle, it violently jerks the web, which it
- attached to elastic twigs, till at last the whole acquires such
- a rapid vibratory movement, that even the outline of the
- spider's body becomes indistinct.
-
- It is well known that most of the British spiders, when
- a large insect is caught in their webs, endeavour to cut the
- lines and liberate their prey, to save their nets from being
- entirely spoiled. I once, however, saw in a hot-house in
- Shropshire a large female wasp caught in the irregular web
- of a quite small spider; and this spider, instead of cutting
- the web, most perseveringly continued to entangle the body,
- and especially the wings, of its prey. The wasp at first aimed
- in vain repeated thrusts with its sting at its little antagonist.
- Pitying the wasp, after allowing it to struggle for more than
- an hour, I killed it and put it back into the web. The spider
- soon returned; and an hour afterwards I was much surprised to
- find it with its jaws buried in the orifice, through which the
- sting is protruded by the living wasp. I drove the spider away
- two or three times, but for the next twenty-four hours I
- always found it again sucking at the same place. The spider
- became much distended by the juices of its prey, which was
- many times larger than itself.
-
- I may here just mention, that I found, near St. Fe Bajada,
- many large black spiders, with ruby-coloured marks on their
- backs, having gregarious habits. The webs were placed
- vertically, as is invariably the case with the genus Epeira:
- they were separated from each other by a space of about
- two feet, but were all attached to certain common lines,
- which were of great length, and extended to all parts of
- the community. In this manner the tops of some large bushes
- were encompassed by the united nets. Azara [10] has described
- a gregarious spider in Paraguay, which Walckanaer thinks
- must be a Theridion, but probably it is an Epeira, and
- perhaps even the same species with mine. I cannot, however,
- recollect seeing a central nest as large as a hat, in which,
- during autumn, when the spiders die, Azara says the eggs are
- deposited. As all the spiders which I saw were of the same
- size, they must have been nearly of the same age. This
- gregarious habit, in so typical a genus as Epeira, among
- insects, which are so bloodthirsty and solitary that even
- the two sexes attack each other, is a very singular fact.
-
- In a lofty valley of the Cordillera, near Mendoza, I found
- another spider with a singularly-formed web. Strong lines
- radiated in a vertical plane from a common centre, where the
- insect had its station; but only two of the rays were connected
- by a symmetrical mesh-work; so that the net, instead of being,
- as is generally the case, circular, consisted of a wedge-shaped
- segment. All the webs were similarly constructed.
-
- [1] Venda, the Portuguese name for an inn.
-
- [2] Annales des Sciences Naturelles for 1833.
-
- [3] I have described and named these species in the Annals of
- Nat. Hist., vol. xiv. p. 241.
-
- [4] I am greatly indebted to Mr. Waterhouse for his kindness
- in naming for me this and many other insects, and giving me
- much valuable assistance.
-
- [5] Kirby's Entomology, vol. ii. p. 317.
-
- [6] Mr. Doubleday has lately described (before the Entomological
- Society, March 3rd, 1845) a peculiar structure in the wings
- of this butterfly, which seems to be the means of its making
- its noise. He says, "It is remarkable for having a sort of
- drum at the base of the fore wings, between the costal nervure
- and the subcostal. These two nervures, moreover, have a peculiar
- screw-like diaphragm or vessel in the interior." I find in
- Langsdorff's travels (in the years 1803-7, p. 74) it is said,
- that in the island of St. Catherine's on the coast of Brazil,
- a butterfly called Februa Hoffmanseggi, makes a noise, when
- flying away, like a rattle.
-
- [7] I may mention, as a common instance of one day's (June 23rd)
- collecting, when I was not attending particularly to the
- Coleoptera, that I caught sixty-eight species of that order.
- Among these, there were only two of the Carabidae, four
- Brachelytra, fifteen Rhyncophora, and fourteen of the
- Chrysomelidae. Thirty-seven species of Arachnidae, which I
- brought home, will be sufficient to prove that I was not
- paying overmuch attention to the generally favoured order
- of Coleoptera.
-
- [8] In a MS. in the British Museum by Mr. Abbott, who made
- his observations in Georgia; see Mr. A. White's paper in the
- "Annals of Nat. Hist.," vol. vii. p. 472. Lieut. Hutton has
- described a sphex with similar habits in India, in the "Journal
- of the Asiatic Society," vol. i. p. 555.
-
- [9] Don Felix Azara (vol. i. p. 175), mentioning a hymenopterous
- insect, probably of the same genus, says he saw it dragging
- a dead spider through tall grass, in a straight line to its
- nest, which was one hundred and sixty-three paces distant. He
- adds that the wasp, in order to find the road, every now and
- then made "demi-tours d'environ trois palmes."
-
- [10] Azara's Voyage, vol. i. p. 213
-
-
-
- CHAPTER III
-
- MALDONADO
-
- Monte Video -- Excursion to R. Polanco -- Lazo and Bolas --
- Partridges -- Absence of Trees -- Deer -- Capybara, or River
- Hog -- Tucutuco -- Molothrus, cuckoo-like habits -- Tyrant-
- flycatcher -- Mocking-bird -- Carrion Hawks -- Tubes formed
- by Lightning -- House struck.
-
-
- July 5th, 1832 -- In the morning we got under way, and stood
- out of the splendid harbour of Rio de Janeiro. In our passage
- to the Plata, we saw nothing particular, excepting on one day
- a great shoal of porpoises, many hundreds in number. The whole
- sea was in places furrowed by them; and a most extraordinary
- spectacle was presented, as hundreds, proceeding together by
- jumps, in which their whole bodies were exposed, thus cut the
- water. When the ship was running nine knots an hour, these
- animals could cross and recross the bows with the greatest of
- ease, and then dash away right ahead. As soon as we entered
- the estuary of the Plata, the weather was very unsettled. One
- dark night we were surrounded by numerous seals and penguins,
- which made such strange noises, that the officer on watch
- reported he could hear the cattle bellowing on shore. On a
- second night we witnessed a splendid scene of natural fireworks;
- the mast-head and yard-arm-ends shone with St. Elmo's light;
- and the form of the vane could almost be traced, as if it had
- been rubbed with phosphorus. The sea was so highly luminous,
- that the tracks of the penguins were marked by a fiery wake,
- and the darkness of the sky was momentarily illuminated by
- the most vivid lightning.
-
- When within the mouth of the river, I was interested by
- observing how slowly the waters of the sea and river mixed.
- The latter, muddy and discoloured, from its less specific
- gravity, floated on the surface of the salt water. This was
- curiously exhibited in the wake of the vessel, where a line
- of blue water was seen mingling in little eddies, with the
- adjoining fluid.
-
- July 26th. -- We anchored at Monte Video. The Beagle
- was employed in surveying the extreme southern and eastern
- coasts of America, south of the Plata, during the two succeeding
- years. To prevent useless repetitions, I will extract
- those parts of my journal which refer to the same districts
- without always attending to the order in which we visited
- them.
-
- MALDONADO is situated on the northern bank of the Plata,
- and not very far from the mouth of the estuary. It is a
- most quiet, forlorn, little town; built, as is universally the
- case in these countries, with the streets running at right
- angles to each other, and having in the middle a large plaza
- or square, which, from its size, renders the scantiness of the
- population more evident. It possesses scarcely any trade;
- the exports being confined to a few hides and living cattle.
- The inhabitants are chiefly landowners, together with a few
- shopkeepers and the necessary tradesmen, such as blacksmiths
- and carpenters, who do nearly all the business for a
- circuit of fifty miles round. The town is separated from the
- river by a band of sand-hillocks, about a mile broad: it is
- surrounded, on all other sides, by an open slightly-undulating
- country, covered by one uniform layer of fine green turf,
- on which countless herds of cattle, sheep, and horses graze.
- There is very little land cultivated even close to the town.
- A few hedges, made of cacti and agave, mark out where
- some wheat or Indian corn has been planted. The features
- of the country are very similar along the whole northern
- bank of the Plata. The only difference is, that here the
- granitic hills are a little bolder. The scenery is very
- uninteresting; there is scarcely a house, an enclosed piece of
- ground, or even a tree, to give it an air of cheerfulness
- Yet, after being imprisoned for some time in a ship, there is
- a charm in the unconfined feeling of walking over boundless
- plains of turf. Moreover, if your view is limited to a small
- space, many objects possess beauty. Some of the smaller
- birds are brilliantly coloured; and the bright green sward,
- browsed short by the cattle, is ornamented by dwarf flowers,
- among which a plant, looking like the daisy, claimed the
- place of an old friend. What would a florist say to whole
- tracts, so thickly covered by the Verbena melindres, as, even
- at a distance, to appear of the most gaudy scarlet?
-
- I stayed ten weeks at Maldonado, in which time a nearly
- perfect collection of the animals, birds, and reptiles, was
- procured. Before making any observations respecting them,
- I will give an account of a little excursion I made as far
- as the river Polanco, which is about seventy miles distant,
- in a northerly direction. I may mention, as a proof how
- cheap everything is in this country, that I paid only two
- dollars a day, or eight shillings, for two men, together with
- a troop of about a dozen riding-horses. My companions
- were well armed with pistols and sabres; a precaution which
- I thought rather unnecessary but the first piece of news
- we heard was, that, the day before, a traveller from Monte
- Video had been found dead on the road, with his throat
- cut. This happened close to a cross, the record of a former
- murder.
-
- On the first night we slept at a retired little country-house;
- and there I soon found out that I possessed two or
- three articles, especially a pocket compass, which created
- unbounded astonishment. In every house I was asked to
- show the compass, and by its aid, together with a map, to
- point out the direction of various places. It excited the
- liveliest admiration that I, a perfect stranger, should know
- the road (for direction and road are synonymous in this open
- country) to places where I had never been. At one house
- a young woman, who was ill in bed, sent to entreat me to
- come and show her the compass. If their surprise was great,
- mine was greater, to find such ignorance among people who
- possessed their thousands of cattle, and "estancias" of great
- extent. It can only be accounted for by the circumstance
- that this retired part of the country is seldom visited by
- foreigners. I was asked whether the earth or sun moved;
- whether it was hotter or colder to the north; where Spain
- was, and many other such questions. The greater number of
- the inhabitants had an indistinct idea that England, London,
- and North America, were different names for the same
- place; but the better informed well knew that London and
- North America were separate countries close together, and
- that England was a large town in London! I carried with
- me some promethean matches, which I ignited by biting; it
- was thought so wonderful that a man should strike fire with
- his teeth, that it was usual to collect the whole family to
- see it: I was once offered a dollar for a single one. Washing
- my face in the morning caused much speculation at the village
- of Las Minas; a superior tradesman closely cross-questioned
- me about so singular a practice; and likewise why on
- board we wore our beards; for he had heard from my guide
- that we did so. He eyed me with much suspicion; perhaps
- he had heard of ablutions in the Mahomedan religion, and
- knowing me to be a heretick, probably he came to the conclusion
- that all hereticks were Turks. It is the general custom
- in this country to ask for a night's lodging at the first
- convenient house. The astonishment at the compass, and
- my other feats of jugglery, was to a certain degree
- advantageous, as with that, and the long stories my guides
- told of my breaking stones, knowing venomous from harmless
- snakes, collecting insects, etc., I repaid them for their
- hospitality. I am writing as if I had been among the inhabitants
- of central Africa: Banda Oriental would not be flattered by
- the comparison; but such were my feelings at the time.
-
- The next day we rode to the village of Las Minas. The
- country was rather more hilly, but otherwise continued the
- same; an inhabitant of the Pampas no doubt would have
- considered it as truly Alpine. The country is so thinly
- inhabited, that during the whole day we scarcely met a single
- person. Las Minas is much smaller even than Maldonado.
- It is seated on a little plain, and is surrounded by low rocky
- mountains. It is of the usual symmetrical form, and with
- its whitewashed church standing in the centre, had rather
- a pretty appearance. The outskirting houses rose out of the
- plain like isolated beings, without the accompaniment of
- gardens or courtyards. This is generally the case in the
- country, and all the houses have, in consequence an
- uncomfortable aspect. At night we stopped at a pulperia,
- or drinking-shop. During the evening a great number of Gauchos
- came in to drink spirits and smoke cigars: their appearance
- is very striking; they are generally tall and handsome, but
- with a proud and dissolute expression of countenance. They
- frequently wear their moustaches and long black hair curling
- down their backs. With their brightly coloured garments,
- great spurs clanking about their heels, and knives
- stuck as daggers (and often so used) at their waists, they
- look a very different race of men from what might be expected
- from their name of Gauchos, or simple countrymen.
- Their politeness is excessive; they never drink their spirits
- without expecting you to taste it; but whilst making their
- exceedingly graceful bow, they seem quite as ready, if occasion
- offered, to cut your throat.
-
- On the third day we pursued rather an irregular course,
- as I was employed in examining some beds of marble. On
- the fine plains of turf we saw many ostriches (Struthio
- rhea). Some of the flocks contained as many as twenty or
- thirty birds. These, when standing on any little eminence,
- and seen against the clear sky, presented a very noble
- appearance. I never met with such tame ostriches in any other
- part of the country: it was easy to gallop up within a short
- distance of them; but then, expanding their wings, they
- made all sail right before the wind, and soon left the horse
- astern.
-
- At night we came to the house of Don Juan Fuentes, a
- rich landed proprietor, but not personally known to either
- of my companions. On approaching the house of a stranger,
- it is usual to follow several little points of etiquette: riding
- up slowly to the door, the salutation of Ave Maria is given,
- and until somebody comes out and asks you to alight, it is
- not customary even to get off your horse: the formal answer
- of the owner is, "sin pecado concebida" -- that is, conceived
- without sin. Having entered the house, some general conversation
- is kept up for a few minutes, till permission is
- asked to pass the night there. This is granted as a matter
- of course. The stranger then takes his meals with the family,
- and a room is assigned him, where with the horsecloths
- belonging to his recado (or saddle of the Pampas) he makes
- his bed. It is curious how similar circumstances produce
- such similar results in manners. At the Cape of Good Hope
- the same hospitality, and very nearly the same points of
- etiquette, are universally observed. The difference, however,
- between the character of the Spaniard and that of the Dutch
- boer is shown, by the former never asking his guest a single
- question beyond the strictest rule of politeness, whilst the
- honest Dutchman demands where he has been, where he is
- going, what is his business, and even how many brothers
- sisters, or children he may happen to have.
-
- Shortly after our arrival at Don Juan's, one of the largest
- herds of cattle was driven in towards the house, and three
- beasts were picked out to be slaughtered for the supply of
- the establishment. These half-wild cattle are very active;
- and knowing full well the fatal lazo, they led the horses a
- long and laborious chase. After witnessing the rude wealth
- displayed in the number of cattle, men, and horses, Don
- Juan's miserable house was quite curious. The floor consisted
- of hardened mud, and the windows were without
- glass; the sitting-room boasted only of a few of the roughest
- chairs and stools, with a couple of tables. The supper, although
- several strangers were present, consisted of two huge
- piles, one of roast beef, the other of boiled, with some pieces
- of pumpkin: besides this latter there was no other vegetable,
- and not even a morsel of bread. For drinking, a large
- earthenware jug of water served the whole party. Yet this
- man was the owner of several square miles of land, of which
- nearly every acre would produce corn, and, with a little
- trouble, all the common vegetables. The evening was spent in
- smoking, with a little impromptu singing, accompanied by
- the guitar. The signoritas all sat together in one corner
- of the room, and did not sup with the men.
-
- So many works have been written about these countries,
- that it is almost superfluous to describe either the lazo or
- the bolas. The lazo consists of a very strong, but thin,
- well-plaited rope, made of raw hide. One end is attached to the
- broad surcingle, which fastens together the complicated gear
- of the recado, or saddle used in the Pampas; the other is
- terminated by a small ring of iron or brass, by which a noose
- can be formed. The Gaucho, when he is going to use the
- lazo, keeps a small coil in his bridle-hand, and in the other
- holds the running noose which is made very large, generally
- having a diameter of about eight feet. This he whirls
- round his head, and by the dexterous movement of his wrist
- keeps the noose open; then, throwing it, he causes it to fall
- on any particular spot he chooses. The lazo, when not used,
- is tied up in a small coil to the after part of the recado.
- The bolas, or balls, are of two kinds: the simplest, which
- is chiefly used for catching ostriches, consists of two round
- stones, covered with leather, and united by a thin plaited
- thong, about eight feet long. The other kind differs only
- in having three balls united by the thongs to a common
- centre. The Gaucho holds the smallest of the three in his
- hand, and whirls the other two round and round his head;
- then, taking aim, sends them like chain shot revolving
- through the air. The balls no sooner strike any object, than,
- winding round it, they cross each other, and become firmly
- hitched. The size and weight of the balls vary, according
- to the purpose for which they are made: when of stone,
- although not larger than an apple, they are sent with such
- force as sometimes to break the leg even of a horse. I have
- seen the balls made of wood, and as large as a turnip, for
- the sake of catching these animals without injuring them.
- The balls are sometimes made of iron, and these can be
- hurled to the greatest distance. The main difficulty in using
- either lazo or bolas is to ride so well as to be able at full
- speed, and while suddenly turning about, to whirl them so
- steadily round the head, as to take aim: on foot any person
- would soon learn the art. One day, as I was amusing myself
- by galloping and whirling the balls round my head, by accident
- the free one struck a bush, and its revolving motion
- being thus destroyed, it immediately fell to the ground, and,
- like magic, caught one hind leg of my horse; the other ball
- was then jerked out of my hand, and the horse fairly secured.
- Luckily he was an old practised animal, and knew
- what it meant; otherwise he would probably have kicked
- till he had thrown himself down. The Gauchos roared with
- laughter; they cried out that they had seen every sort of
- animal caught, but had never before seen a man caught by
- himself.
-
- During the two succeeding days, I reached the furthest
- point which I was anxious to examine. The country wore
- the same aspect, till at last the fine green turf became more
- wearisome than a dusty turnpike road. We everywhere saw
- great numbers of partridges (Nothura major). These birds
- do not go in coveys, nor do they conceal themselves like
- the English kind. It appears a very silly bird. A man on
- horseback by riding round and round in a circle, or rather
- in a spire, so as to approach closer each time, may knock
- on the head as many as he pleases. The more common
- method is to catch them with a running noose, or little lazo,
- made of the stem of an ostrich's feather, fastened to the
- end of a long stick. A boy on a quiet old horse will frequently
- thus catch thirty or forty in a day. In Arctic North
- America [1] the Indians catch the Varying Hare by walking
- spirally round and round it, when on its form: the middle
- of the day is reckoned the best time, when the sun is high,
- and the shadow of the hunter not very long.
-
- On our return to Maldonado, we followed rather a different
- line of road. Near Pan de Azucar, a landmark well
- known to all those who have sailed up the Plata, I stayed
- a day at the house of a most hospitable old Spaniard. Early
- in the morning we ascended the Sierra de las Animas. By
- the aid of the rising sun the scenery was almost picturesque.
- To the westward the view extended over an immense level
- plain as far as the Mount, at Monte Video, and to the eastward,
- over the mammillated country of Maldonado. On
- the summit of the mountain there were several small heaps
- of stones, which evidently had lain there for many years.
- My companion assured me that they were the work of the
- Indians in the old time. The heaps were similar, but on
- a much smaller scale, to those so commonly found on the
- mountains of Wales. The desire to signalize any event, on
- the highest point of the neighbouring land, seems an universal
- passion with mankind. At the present day, not a
- single Indian, either civilized or wild, exists in this part
- of the province; nor am I aware that the former inhabitants
- have left behind them any more permanent records than
- these insignificant piles on the summit of the Sierra de las
- Animas.
-
-
- The general, and almost entire absence of trees in Banda
- Oriental is remarkable. Some of the rocky hills are partly
- covered by thickets, and on the banks of the larger streams,
- especially to the north of Las Minas, willow-trees are not
- uncommon. Near the Arroyo Tapes I heard of a wood of
- palms; and one of these trees, of considerable size, I saw
- near the Pan de Azucar, in lat. 35 degs. These, and the trees
- planted by the Spaniards, offer the only exceptions to the
- general scarcity of wood. Among the introduced kinds may
- be enumerated poplars, olives, peach, and other fruit trees:
- the peaches succeed so well, that they afford the main supply
- of firewood to the city of Buenos Ayres. Extremely level
- countries, such as the Pampas, seldom appear favourable to
- the growth of trees. This may possibly be attributed either
- to the force of the winds, or the kind of drainage. In the
- nature of the land, however, around Maldonado, no such
- reason is apparent; the rocky mountains afford protected
- situations; enjoying various kinds of soil; streamlets of
- water are common at the bottoms of nearly every valley;
- and the clayey nature of the earth seems adapted to retain
- moisture. It has been inferred with much probability, that
- the presence of woodland is generally determined [2] by the
- annual amount of moisture; yet in this province abundant
- and heavy rain falls during the winter; and the summer,
- though dry, is not so in any excessive degree. [3] We see nearly
- the whole of Australia covered by lofty trees, yet that country
- possesses a far more arid climate. Hence we must look
- to some other and unknown cause.
-
- Confining our view to South America, we should certainly
- be tempted to believe that trees flourished only under a very
- humid climate; for the limit of the forest-land follows, in a
- most remarkable manner, that of the damp winds. In the
- southern part of the continent, where the western gales,
- charged with moisture from the Pacific, prevail, every island
- on the broken west coast, from lat. 38 degs. to the extreme
- point of Tierra del Fuego, is densely covered by impenetrable
- forests. On the eastern side of the Cordillera, over the same
- extent of latitude, where a blue sky and a fine climate prove
- that the atmosphere has been deprived of its moisture by
- passing over the mountains, the arid plains of Patagonia
- support a most scanty vegetation. In the more northern
- parts of the continent, within the limits of the constant
- south-eastern trade-wind, the eastern side is ornamented by
- magnificent forests; whilst the western coast, from lat.
- 4 degs. S. to lat. 32 degs. S., may be described as a
- desert; on this western coast, northward of lat. 4 degs.
- S., where the trade-wind loses its regularity, and heavy
- torrents of rain fall periodically, the shores of the
- Pacific, so utterly desert in Peru, assume near Cape
- Blanco the character of luxuriance so celebrated at
- Guyaquil and Panama. Hence in the southern and northern
- parts of the continent, the forest and desert lands occupy
- reversed positions with respect to the Cordillera, and these
- positions are apparently determined by the direction of the
- prevalent winds. In the middle of the continent there is a
- broad intermediate band, including central Chile and the
- provinces of La Plata, where the rain-bringing winds have
- not to pass over lofty mountains, and where the land is neither
- a desert nor covered by forests. But even the rule, if
- confined to South America, of trees flourishing only in a
- climate rendered humid by rain-bearing winds, has a strongly
- marked exception in the case of the Falkland Islands. These
- islands, situated in the same latitude with Tierra del Fuego
- and only between two and three hundred miles distant from
- it, having a nearly similar climate, with a geological
- formation almost identical, with favourable situations and the
- same kind of peaty soil, yet can boast of few plants deserving
- even the title of bushes; whilst in Tierra del Fuego it is
- impossible to find an acre of land not covered by the densest
- forest. In this case, both the direction of the heavy gales
- of wind and of the currents of the sea are favourable to
- the transport of seeds from Tierra del Fuego, as is shown
- by the canoes and trunks of trees drifted from that country,
- and frequently thrown on the shores of the Western Falkland.
- Hence perhaps it is, that there are many plants in
- common to the two countries but with respect to the trees
- of Tierra del Fuego, even attempts made to transplant them
- have failed.
-
- During our stay at Maldonado I collected several quadrupeds,
- eighty kinds of birds, and many reptiles, including
- nine species of snakes. Of the indigenous mammalia, the
- only one now left of any size, which is common, is the Cervus
- campestris. This deer is exceedingly abundant, often in
- small herds, throughout the countries bordering the Plata
- and in Northern Patagonia. If a person crawling close along
- the ground, slowly advances towards a herd, the deer frequently,
- out of curiosity, approach to reconnoitre him. I
- have by this means, killed from one spot, three out of the
- same herd. Although so tame and inquisitive, yet when
- approached on horseback, they are exceedingly wary. In this
- country nobody goes on foot, and the deer knows man as its
- enemy only when he is mounted and armed with the bolas.
- At Bahia Blanca, a recent establishment in Northern Patagonia,
- I was surprised to find how little the deer cared for
- the noise of a gun: one day I fired ten times from within
- eighty yards at one animal; and it was much more startled
- at the ball cutting up the ground than at the report of
- the rifle. My powder being exhausted, I was obliged to
- get up (to my shame as a sportsman be it spoken, though
- well able to kill birds on the wing) and halloo till the deer
- ran away.
-
- The most curious fact with respect to this animal, is the
- overpoweringly strong and offensive odour which proceeds
- from the buck. It is quite indescribable: several times
- whilst skinning the specimen which is now mounted at the
- Zoological Museum, I was almost overcome by nausea. I
- tied up the skin in a silk pocket-handkerchief, and so carried
- it home: this handkerchief, after being well washed, I
- continually used, and it was of course as repeatedly washed;
- yet every time, for a space of one year and seven months, when
- first unfolded, I distinctly perceived the odour. This appears
- an astonishing instance of the permanence of some
- matter, which nevertheless in its nature must be most subtile
- and volatile. Frequently, when passing at the distance of
- half a mile to leeward of a herd, I have perceived the whole
- air tainted with the effluvium. I believe the smell from the
- buck is most powerful at the period when its horns are perfect,
- or free from the hairy skin. When in this state the
- meat is, of course, quite uneatable; but the Gauchos assert,
- that if buried for some time in fresh earth, the taint is
- removed. I have somewhere read that the islanders in the
- north of Scotland treat the rank carcasses of the fish-eating
- birds in the same manner.
-
- The order Rodentia is here very numerous in species:
- of mice alone I obtained no less than eight kinds. [4] The
- largest gnawing animal in the world, the Hydrochaerus capybara
- (the water-hog), is here also common. One which I
- shot at Monte Video weighed ninety-eight pounds: its
- length from the end of the snout to the stump-like tail, was
- three feet two inches; and its girth three feet eight. These
- great Rodents occasionally frequent the islands in the mouth
- of the Plata, where the water is quite salt, but are far more
- abundant on the borders of fresh-water lakes and rivers.
- Near Maldonado three or four generally live together. In
- the daytime they either lie among the aquatic plants, or
- openly feed on the turf plain. [5] When viewed at a distance,
- from their manner of walking and colour they resemble pigs:
- but when seated on their haunches, and attentively watching
- any object with one eye, they reassume the appearance
- of their congeners, cavies and rabbits. Both the front and
- side view of their head has quite a ludicrous aspect, from
- the great depth of their jaw. These animals, at Maldonado,
- were very tame; by cautiously walking, I approached within
- three yards of four old ones. This tameness may probably
- be accounted for, by the Jaguar having been banished for
- some years, and by the Gaucho not thinking it worth his
- while to hunt them. As I approached nearer and nearer
- they frequently made their peculiar noise, which is a low
- abrupt grunt, not having much actual sound, but rather arising
- from the sudden expulsion of air: the only noise I know
- at all like it, is the first hoarse bark of a large dog. Having
- watched the four from almost within arm's length (and they
- me) for several minutes, they rushed into the water at full
- gallop with the greatest impetuosity, and emitted at the
- same time their bark. After diving a short distance they
- came again to the surface, but only just showed the upper
- part of their heads. When the female is swimming in the
- water, and has young ones, they are said to sit on her back.
- These animals are easily killed in numbers; but their skins
- are of trifling value, and the meat is very indifferent. On
- the islands in the Rio Parana they are exceedingly abundant,
- and afford the ordinary prey to the Jaguar.
-
- The Tucutuco (Ctenomys Brasiliensis) is a curious small
- animal, which may be briefly described as a Gnawer, with
- the habits of a mole. It is extremely numerous in some
- parts of the country, but it is difficult to be procured, and
- never, I believe, comes out of the ground. It throws up at
- the mouth of its burrows hillocks of earth like those of the
- mole, but smaller. Considerable tracts of country are so
- completely undermined by these animals, that horses in passing
- over, sink above their fetlocks. The tucutucos appear,
- to a certain degree, to be gregarious: the man who procured
- the specimens for me had caught six together, and he
- said this was a common occurrence. They are nocturnal in
- their habits; and their principal food is the roots of plants,
- which are the object of their extensive and superficial burrows.
- This animal is universally known by a very peculiar
- noise which it makes when beneath the ground. A person,
- the first time he hears it, is much surprised; for it is not
- easy to tell whence it comes, nor is it possible to guess what
- kind of creature utters it. The noise consists in a short, but
- not rough, nasal grunt, which is monotonously repeated
- about four times in quick succession: [6] the name Tucutuco is
- given in imitation of the sound. Where this animal is
- abundant, it may be heard at all times of the day, and sometimes
- directly beneath one's feet. When kept in a room, the
- tucutucos move both slowly and clumsily, which appears
- owing to the outward action of their hind legs; and they are
- quite incapable, from the socket of the thigh-bone not having
- a certain ligament, of jumping even the smallest vertical
- height. They are very stupid in making any attempt to
- escape; when angry or frightened they utter the tucutuco.
- Of those I kept alive several, even the first day, became
- quite tame, not attempting to bite or to run away; others
- were a little wilder.
-
- The man who caught them asserted that very many are
- invariably found blind. A specimen which I preserved in
- spirits was in this state; Mr. Reid considers it to be the
- effect of inflammation in the nictitating membrane. When the
- animal was alive I placed my finger within half an inch of
- its head, and not the slightest notice was taken: it made its
- way, however, about the room nearly as well as the others.
- Considering the strictly subterranean habits of the tucutuco,
- the blindness, though so common, cannot be a very serious
- evil; yet it appears strange that any animal should possess
- an organ frequently subject to be injured. Lamarck would
- have been delighted with this fact, had he known it, when
- speculating [7] (probably with more truth than usual with him)
- on the gradually _acquired_ blindness of the Asphalax, a
- Gnawer living under ground, and of the Proteus, a reptile
- living in dark caverns filled with water; in both of which
- animals the eye is in an almost rudimentary state, and is
- covered by a tendinous membrane and skin. In the common
- mole the eye is extraordinarily small but perfect, though
- many anatomists doubt whether it is connected with the true
- optic nerve; its vision must certainly be imperfect, though
- probably useful to the animal when it leaves its burrow. In
- the tucutuco, which I believe never comes to the surface of
- the ground, the eye is rather larger, but often rendered blind
- and useless, though without apparently causing any inconvenience
- to the animal; no doubt Lamarck would have said
- that the tucutuco is now passing into the state of the
- Asphalax and Proteus.
-
- Birds of many kinds are extremely abundant on the undulating,
- grassy plains around Maldonado. There are several
- species of a family allied in structure and manners to our
- Starling: one of these (Molothrus niger) is remarkable from
- its habits. Several may often be seen standing together on
- tbe back of a cow or horse; and while perched on a hedge,
- pluming themselves in the sun, they sometimes attempt to
- sing, or rather to hiss; the noise being very peculiar,
- resembling that of bubbles of air passing rapidly from a small
- orifice under water, so as to produce an acute sound. According
- to Azara, this bird, like the cuckoo, deposits its eggs
- in other birds' nests. I was several times told by the country
- people that there certainly is some bird having this
- habit; and my assistant in collecting, who is a very accurate
- person, found a nest of the sparrow of this country (Zonotrichia
- matutina), with one egg in it larger than the others,
- and of a different colour and shape. In North America
- there is another species of Molothrus (M. pecoris), which
- has a similar cuckoo-like habit, and which is most closely
- allied in every respect to the species from the Plata, even in
- such trifling peculiarities as standing on the backs of cattle;
- it differs only in being a little smaller, and in its plumage
- and eggs being of a slightly different shade of colour. This
- close agreement in structure and habits, in representative
- species coming from opposite quarters of a great continent,
- always strikes one as interesting, though of common
- occurrence.
-
- Mr. Swainson has well remarked, [8] that with the exception
- of the Molothrus pecoris, to which must be added the
- M. niger, the cuckoos are the only birds which can be called
- truly parasitical; namely, such as "fasten themselves, as it
- were, on another living animal, whose animal heat brings
- their young into life, whose food they live upon, and whose
- death would cause theirs during the period of infancy." It
- is remarkable that some of the species, but not all, both of
- the Cuckoo and Molothrus, should agree in this one strange
- habit of their parasitical propagation, whilst opposed to each
- other in almost every other habit: the molothrus, like our
- starling, is eminently sociable, and lives on the open plains
- without art or disguise: the cuckoo, as every one knows,
- is a singularly shy bird; it frequents the most retired thickets,
- and feeds on fruit and caterpillars. In structure also
- these two genera are widely removed from each other.
- Many theories, even phrenological theories, have been advanced
- to explain the origin of the cuckoo laying its eggs in
- other birds' nests. M. Prevost alone, I think, has thrown
- light by his observations [9] on this puzzle: he finds that the
- female cuckoo, which, according to most observers, lays at
- least from four to six eggs, must pair with the male each time
- after laying only one or two eggs. Now, if the cuckoo was
- obliged to sit on her own eggs, she would either have to sit
- on all together, and therefore leave those first laid so long,
- that they probably would become addled; or she would have
- to hatch separately each egg, or two eggs, as soon as laid:
- but as the cuckoo stays a shorter time in this country than
- any other migratory bird, she certainly would not have time
- enough for the successive hatchings. Hence we can perceive
- in the fact of the cuckoo pairing several times, and laying
- her eggs at intervals, the cause of her depositing her eggs
- in other birds' nests, and leaving them to the care of
- foster-parents. I am strongly inclined to believe that this
- view is correct, from having been independently led (as we
- shall hereafter see) to an analogous conclusion with regard
- to the South American ostrich, the females of which are
- parasitical, if I may so express it, on each other; each
- female laying several eggs in the nests of several other
- females, and the male ostrich undertaking all the cares
- of incubation, like the strange foster-parents with the
- cuckoo.
-
- I will mention only two other birds, which are very common,
- and render themselves prominent from their habits.
- The Saurophagus sulphuratus is typical of the great American
- tribe of tyrant-flycatchers. In its structure it closely
- approaches the true shrikes, but in its habits may be compared
- to many birds. I have frequently observed it, hunting
- a field, hovering over one spot like a hawk, and then proceeding
- on to another. When seen thus suspended in the air,
- it might very readily at a short distance be mistaken for one
- of the Rapacious order; its stoop, however, is very inferior
- in force and rapidity to that of a hawk. At other times
- the Saurophagus haunts the neighbourhood of water, and
- there, like a kingfisher, remaining stationary, it catches any
- small fish which may come near the margin. These birds are
- not unfrequently kept either in cages or in courtyards, with
- their wings cut. They soon become tame, and are very
- amusing from their cunning odd manners, which were
- described to me as being similar to those of the common
- magpie. Their flight is undulatory, for the weight of the
- head and bill appears too great for the body. In the
- evening the Saurophagus takes its stand on a bush, often
- by the roadside, and continually repeats without a change
- a shrill and rather agreeable cry, which somewhat resembles
- articulate words: the Spaniards say it is like the words
- "Bien te veo" (I see you well), and accordingly have given
- it this name.
-
- A mocking-bird (Mimus orpheus), called by the inhabitants
- Calandria, is remarkable, from possessing a song far
- superior to that of any other bird in the country: indeed, it
- is nearly the only bird in South America which I have
- observed to take its stand for the purpose of singing. The
- song may be compared to that of the Sedge warbler, but
- is more powerful; some harsh notes and some very high
- ones, being mingled with a pleasant warbling. It is heard
- only during the spring. At other times its cry is harsh and
- far from harmonious. Near Maldonado these birds were
- tame and bold; they constantly attended the country houses
- in numbers, to pick the meat which was hung up on the posts
- or walls: if any other small bird joined the feast, the
- Calandria soon chased it away. On the wide uninhabited plains
- of Patagonia another closely allied species, O. Patagonica
- of d'Orbigny, which frequents the valleys clothed with
- spiny bushes, is a wilder bird, and has a slightly different
- tone of voice. It appears to me a curious circumstance, as
- showing the fine shades of difference in habits, that judging
- from this latter respect alone, when I first saw this second
- species, I thought it was different from the Maldonado kind.
- Having afterwards procured a specimen, and comparing the
- two without particular care, they appeared so very similar,
- that I changed my opinion; but now Mr. Gould says that they
- are certainly distinct; a conclusion in conformity with the
- trifling difference of habit, of which, of course, he was not
- aware.
-
- The number, tameness, and disgusting habits of the
- carrion-feeding hawks of South America make them
- pre-eminently striking to any one accustomed only to the birds
- of Northern Europe. In this list may be included four species
- of the Caracara or Polyborus, the Turkey buzzard, the Gallinazo,
- and the Condor. The Caracaras are, from their
- structure, placed among the eagles: we shall soon see how
- ill they become so high a rank. In their habits they well
- supply the place of our carrion-crows, magpies, and ravens;
- a tribe of birds widely distributed over the rest of the world,
- but entirely absent in South America. To begin with the
- Polyborus Brasiliensis: this is a common bird, and has a wide
- geographical range; it is most numerous on the grassy savannahs
- of La Plata (where it goes by the name of Carrancha),
- and is far from unfrequent throughout the sterile plains of
- Patagonia. In the desert between the rivers Negro and Colorado,
- numbers constantly attend the line of road to devour
- the carcasses of the exhausted animals which chance to
- perish from fatigue and thirst. Although thus common in
- these dry and open countries, and likewise on the arid shores
- of the Pacific, it is nevertheless found inhabiting the damp
- impervious forests of West Patagonia and Tierra del Fuego.
- The Carranchas, together with the Chimango, constantly
- attend in numbers the estancias and slaughtering-houses. If
- an animal dies on the plain the Gallinazo commences the
- feast, and then the two species of Polyborus pick the bones
- clean. These birds, although thus commonly feeding together,
- are far from being friends. When the Carrancha is
- quietly seated on the branch of a tree or on the ground, the
- Chimango often continues for a long time flying backwards
- and forwards, up and down, in a semicircle, trying each time
- at the bottom of the curve to strike its larger relative. The
- Carrancha takes little notice, except by bobbing its head.
- Although the Carranchas frequently assemble in numbers,
- they are not gregarious; for in desert places they may be
- seen solitary, or more commonly by pairs.
-
- The Carranchas are said to be very crafty, and to steal
- great numbers of eggs. They attempt, also, together with
- the Chimango, to pick off the scabs from the sore backs of
- horses and mules. The poor animal, on the one hand, with
- its ears down and its back arched; and, on the other, the
- hovering bird, eyeing at the distance of a yard the disgusting
- morsel, form a picture, which has been described by Captain
- Head with his own peculiar spirit and accuracy. These
- false eagles most rarely kill any living bird or animal; and
- their vulture-like, necrophagous habits are very evident to
- any one who has fallen asleep on the desolate plains of
- Patagonia, for when he wakes, he will see, on each surrounding
- hillock, one of these birds patiently watching him with an
- evil eye: it is a feature in the landscape of these countries,
- which will be recognised by every one who has wandered
- over them. If a party of men go out hunting with dogs
- and horses, they will be accompanied, during the day, by
- several of these attendants. After feeding, the uncovered
- craw protrudes; at such times, and indeed generally, the
- Carrancha is an inactive, tame, and cowardly bird. Its
- flight is heavy and slow, like that of an English rook. It
- seldom soars; but I have twice seen one at a great height
- gliding through the air with much ease. It runs (in
- contradistinction to hopping), but not quite so quickly as some
- of its congeners. At times the Carrancha is noisy, but is
- not generally so: its cry is loud, very harsh and peculiar, and
- may be likened to the sound of the Spanish guttural g, followed
- by a rough double r r; when uttering this cry it
- elevates its head higher and higher, till at last, with its
- beak wide open, the crown almost touches the lower part of
- the back. This fact, which has been doubted, is quite true;
- I have seen them several times with their heads backwards
- in a completely inverted position. To these observations I
- may add, on the high authority of Azara, that the Carrancha
- feeds on worms, shells, slugs, grasshoppers, and frogs; that
- it destroys young lambs by tearing the umbilical cord; and
- that it pursues the Gallinazo, till that bird is compelled to
- vomit up the carrion it may have recently gorged. Lastly,
- Azara states that several Carranchas, five or six together,
- will unite in chase of large birds, even such as herons. All
- these facts show that it is a bird of very versatile habits and
- considerable ingenuity.
-
- The Polyborus Chimango is considerably smaller than the
- last species. It is truly omnivorous, and will eat even bread;
- and I was assured that it materially injures the potato crops
- in Chiloe, by stocking up the roots when first planted. Of
- all the carrion-feeders it is generally the last which leaves
- the skeleton of a dead animal, and may often be seen within
- the ribs of a cow or horse, like a bird in a cage. Another
- species is the Polyborus Novae Zelandiae, which is exceedingly
- common in the Falkland Islands. These birds in many
- respects resemble in their habits the Carranchas. They live
- on the flesh of dead animals and on marine productions; and
- on the Ramirez rocks their whole sustenance must depend
- on the sea. They are extraordinarily tame and fearless, and
- haunt the neighborhood of houses for offal. If a hunting
- party kills an animal, a number soon collect and patiently
- await, standing on the ground on all sides. After eating,
- their uncovered craws are largely protruded, giving them a
- disgusting appearance. They readily attack wounded birds:
- a cormorant in this state having taken to the shore, was
- immediately seized on by several, and its death hastened
- by their blows. The Beagle was at the Falklands only
- during the summer, but the officers of the Adventure, who
- were there in the winter, mention many extraordinary instances
- of the boldness and rapacity of these birds. They
- actually pounced on a dog that was lying fast asleep close
- by one of the party; and the sportsmen had difficulty in
- preventing the wounded geese from being seized before their
- eyes. It is said that several together (in this respect
- resembling the Carranchas) wait at the mouth of a rabbit-hole,
- and together seize on the animal when it comes out. They
- were constantly flying on board the vessel when in the harbour;
- and it was necessary to keep a good look out to prevent
- the leather being torn from the rigging, and the meat or
- game from the stern. These birds are very mischievous and
- inquisitive; they will pick up almost anything from the
- ground; a large black glazed hat was carried nearly a mile,
- as was a pair of the heavy balls used in catching cattle. Mr.
- Usborne experienced during the survey a more severe loss,
- in their stealing a small Kater's compass in a red morocco
- leather case, which was never recovered. These birds are,
- moreover, quarrelsome and very passionate; tearing up the
- grass with their bills from rage. They are not truly gregarious;
- they do not soar, and their flight is heavy and clumsy;
- on the ground they run extremely fast, very much like
- pheasants. They are noisy, uttering several harsh cries, one
- of which is like that of the English rook, hence the sealers
- always call them rooks. It is a curious circumstance that,
- when crying out, they throw their heads upwards and backwards,
- after the same manner as the Carrancha. They build
- in the rocky cliffs of the sea-coast, but only on the small
- adjoining islets, and not on the two main islands: this is a
- singular precaution in so tame and fearless a bird. The sealers
- say that the flesh of these birds, when cooked, is quite
- white, and very good eating; but bold must the man be who
- attempts such a meal.
-
- We have now only to mention the turkey-buzzard (Vultur
- aura), and the Gallinazo. The former is found wherever
- the country is moderately damp, from Cape Horn to North
- America. Differently from the Polyborus Brasiliensis and
- Chimango, it has found its way to the Falkland Islands. The
- turkey-buzzard is a solitary bird, or at most goes in pairs. It
- may at once be recognised from a long distance, by its lofty,
- soaring, and most elegant flight. lt is well known to be a
- true carrion-feeder. On the west coast of Patagonia, among
- the thickly-wooded islets and broken land, it lives exclusively
- on what the sea throws up, and on the carcasses of dead
- seals. Wherever these animals are congregated on the rocks,
- there the vultures may be seen. The Gallinazo (Cathartes
- atratus) has a different range from the last species, as it
- never occurs southward of lat. 41 degs. Azara states that
- there exists a tradition that these birds, at the time of the
- conquest, were not found near Monte Video, but that they
- subsequently followed the inhabitants from more northern
- districts.At the present day they are numerous in the valley
- of the Colorado, which is three hundred miles due south of Monte
- Video. It seems probable that this additional migration has
- happened since the time of Azara. The Gallinazo generally
- prefers a humid climate, or rather the neighbourhood of
- fresh water; hence it is extremely abundant in Brazil and
- La Plata, while it is never found on the desert and arid
- plains of Northern Patagonia, excepting near some stream.
- These birds frequent the whole Pampas to the foot of the
- Cordillera, but I never saw or heard of one in Chile; in Peru
- they are preserved as scavengers. These vultures certainly
- may be called gregarious, for they seem to have pleasure in
- society, and are not solely brought together by the attraction
- of a common prey. On a fine day a flock may often be
- observed at a great height, each bird wheeling round and
- round without closing its wings, in the most graceful
- evolutions. This is clearly performed for the mere pleasure of
- the exercise, or perhaps is connected with their matrimonial
- alliances.
-
- I have now mentioned all the carrion-feeders, excepting
- the condor, an account of which will be more appropriately
- introduced when we visit a country more congenial to its
- habits than the plains of La Plata.
-
-
- In a broad band of sand-hillocks which separate the
- Laguna del Potrero from the shores of the Plata, at the
- distance of a few miles from Maldonado, I found a group of
- those vitrified, siliceous tubes, which are formed by lightning
- entering loose sand. These tubes resemble in every particular
- those from Drigg in Cumberland, described in the
- Geological Transactions. [10] The sand-hillocks of Maldonado
- not being protected by vegetation, are constantly changing
- their position. From this cause the tubes projected above
- the surface, and numerous fragments lying near, showed
- that they had formerly been buried to a greater depth. Four
- sets entered the sand perpendicularly: by working with
- my hands I traced one of them two feet deep; and some
- fragments which evidently had belonged to the same tube,
- when added to the other part, measured five feet three
- inches. The diameter of the whole tube was nearly equal,
- and therefore we must suppose that originally it extended to
- a much greater depth. These dimensions are however small,
- compared to those of the tubes from Drigg, one of which
- was traced to a depth of not less than thirty feet.
-
- The internal surface is completely vitrified, glossy, and
- smooth. A small fragment examined under the microscope
- appeared, from the number of minute entangled air or perhaps
- steam bubbles, like an assay fused before the blowpipe.
- The sand is entirely, or in greater part, siliceous; but some
- points are of a black colour, and from their glossy surface
- possess a metallic lustre. The thickness of the wall of the
- tube varies from a thirtieth to a twentieth of an inch, and
- occasionally even equals a tenth. On the outside the grains
- of sand are rounded, and have a slightly glazed appearance:
- I could not distinguish any signs of crystallization. In a
- similar manner to that described in the Geological Transactions,
- the tubes are generally compressed, and have deep
- longitudinal furrows, so as closely to resemble a shrivelled
- vegetable stalk, or the bark of the elm or cork tree. Their
- circumference is about two inches, but in some fragments,
- which are cylindrical and without any furrows, it is as much
- as four inches. The compression from the surrounding loose
- sand, acting while the tube was still softened from the
- effects of the intense heat, has evidently caused the creases
- or furrows. Judging from the uncompressed fragments, the
- measure or bore of the lightning (if such a term may be used)
- must have been about one inch and a quarter. At Paris, M.
- Hachette and M. Beudant [11] succeeded in making tubes, in
- most respects similar to these fulgurites, by passing very
- strong shocks of galvanism through finely-powdered glass:
- when salt was added, so as to increase its fusibility, the tubes
- were larger in every dimension, They failed both with
- powdered felspar and quartz. One tube, formed with
- pounded glass, was very nearly an inch long, namely .982,
- and had an internal diameter of .019 of an inch. When we
- hear that the strongest battery in Paris was used, and that
- its power on a substance of such easy fusibility as glass was
- to form tubes so diminutive, we must feel greatly astonished
- at the force of a shock of lightning, which, striking the sand
- in several places, has formed cylinders, in one instance of at
- least thirty feet long, and having an internal bore, where not
- compressed, of full an inch and a half; and this in a material
- so extraordinarily refractory as quartz!
-
- The tubes, as I have already remarked, enter the sand
- nearly in a vertical direction. One, however, which was less
- regular than the others, deviated from a right line, at the
- most considerable bend, to the amount of thirty-three degrees.
- From this same tube, two small branches, about a
- foot apart, were sent off; one pointed downwards, and the
- other upwards. This latter case is remarkable, as the electric
- fluid must have turned back at the acute angle of 26 degs.,
- to the line of its main course. Besides the four tubes which
- I found vertical, and traced beneath the surface, there were
- several other groups of fragments, the original sites of which
- without doubt were near. All occurred in a level area of
- shifting sand, sixty yards by twenty, situated among some
- high sand-hillocks, and at the distance of about half a mile
- from a chain of hills four or five hundred feet in height. The
- most remarkable circumstance, as it appears to me, in this
- case as well as in that of Drigg, and in one described by
- M. Ribbentrop in Germany, is the number of tubes found
- within such limited spaces. At Drigg, within an area of
- fifteen yards, three were observed, and the same number
- occurred in Germany. In the case which I have described,
- certainly more than four existed within the space of the
- sixty by twenty yards. As it does not appear probable that
- the tubes are produced by successive distinct shocks, we must
- believe that the lightning, shortly before entering the ground,
- divides itself into separate branches.
-
- The neighbourhood of the Rio Plata seems peculiarly subject
- to electric phenomena. In the year 1793, [12] one of the
- most destructive thunderstorms perhaps on record happened
- at Buenos Ayres: thirty-seven places within the city were
- struck by lightning, and nineteen people killed. From facts
- stated in several books of travels, I am inclined to suspect
- that thunderstorms are very common near the mouths of
- great rivers. Is it not possible that the mixture of large
- bodies of fresh and salt water may disturb the electrical
- equilibrium? Even during our occasional visits to this part
- of South America, we heard of a ship, two churches, and a
- house having been struck. Both the church and the house
- I saw shortly afterwards: the house belonged to Mr. Hood,
- the consul-general at Monte Video. Some of the effects were
- curious: the paper, for nearly a foot on each side of the line
- where the bell-wires had run, was blackened. The metal had
- been fused, and although the room was about fifteen feet
- high, the globules, dropping on the chairs and furniture, had
- drilled in them a chain of minute holes. A part of the wall
- was shattered, as if by gunpowder, and the fragments had
- been blown off with force sufficient to dent the wall on the
- opposite side of the room. The frame of a looking-glass was
- blackened, and the gilding must have been volatilized, for a
- smelling-bottle, which stood on the chimney-piece, was coated
- with bright metallic particles, which adhered as firmly as
- if they had been enamelled.
-
- [1] Hearne's Journey, p. 383.
-
- [2] Maclaren, art. "America," Encyclop. Brittann.
-
- [3] Azara says, "Je crois que la quantite annuelle des pluies
- est, dans toutes ces contrees, plus considerable qu'en Espagne."
- -- Vol. i. p. 36.
-
- [4] In South America I collected altogether twenty-seven
- species of mice, and thirteen more are known from the works
- of Azara and other authors. Those collected by myself have
- been named and described by Mr. Waterhouse at the meetings
- of the Zoological Society. I must be allowed to take this
- opportunity of returning my cordial thanks to Mr. Waterhouse,
- and to the other gentleman attached to that Society, for their
- kind and most liberal assistance on all occasions.
-
- [5] In the stomach and duodenum of a capybara which I opened
- I found a very large quantity of a thin yellowish fluid,
- in which scarcely a fibre could be distinguished. Mr. Owen
- informs me that a part of the oesophagus is so constructed
- that nothing much larger than a crowquill can be passed down.
- Certainly the broad teeth and strong jaws of this animal are
- well fitted to grind into pulp the aquatic plants on which it
- feeds.
-
- [6] At the R. Negro, in Northern Patagonia, there is an animal
- of the same habits, and probably a closely allied species, but
- which I never saw. Its noise is different from that of the
- Maldonado kind; it is repeated only twice instead of three or
- four times, and is more distinct and sonorous; when heard from
- a distance it so closely resembles the sound made in cutting
- down a small tree with an axe, that I have sometimes remained
- in doubt concerning it.
-
- [7] Philosoph. Zoolog., tom. i. p. 242.
-
- [8] Magazine of Zoology and Botany, vol. i. p. 217.
-
- [9] Read before the Academy of Sciences in Paris. L'Institut,
- 1834, p. 418.
-
- [10] Geolog. Transact. vol. ii. p. 528. In the Philosoph.
- Transact. (1790, p. 294) Dr. Priestly has described some
- imperfect siliceous tubes and a melted pebble of quartz,
- found in digging into the ground, under a tree, where a man
- had been killed by lightning.
-
- [11] Annals de Chimie et de Physique, tom. xxxvii. p. 319.
-
- [12] Azara's Voyage, vol. i. p. 36.
-
-
-
- CHAPTER IV
-
- RIO NEGRO TO BAHIA BLANCA
-
- Rio Negro -- Estancias attacked by the Indians -- Salt-Lakes --
- Flamingoes -- R. Negro to R. Colorado -- Sacred Tree --
- Patagonian Hare -- Indian Families -- General Rosas --
- Proceed to Bahia Blanca -- Sand Dunes -- Negro Lieutenant --
- Bahia Blanca -- Saline Incrustations -- Punta Alta -- Zorillo.
-
-
- JULY 24th, 1833. -- The Beagle sailed from Maldonado,
- and on August the 3rd she arrived off the mouth of the
- Rio Negro. This is the principal river on the whole line
- of coast between the Strait of Magellan and the Plata. It
- enters the sea about three hundred miles south of the estuary
- of the Plata. About fifty years ago, under the old Spanish
- government, a small colony was established here; and it is
- still the most southern position (lat. 41 degs.) on this
- eastern coast of America inhabited by civilized man.
-
- The country near the mouth of the river is wretched in
- the extreme: on the south side a long line of perpendicular
- cliffs commences, which exposes a section of the geological
- nature of the country. The strata are of sandstone, and
- one layer was remarkable from being composed of a firmly-
- cemented conglomerate of pumice pebbles, which must have
- travelled more than four hundred miles, from the Andes.
- The surface is everywhere covered up by a thick bed of
- gravel, which extends far and wide over the open plain.
- Water is extremely scarce, and, where found, is almost
- invariably brackish. The vegetation is scanty; and although
- there are bushes of many kinds, all are armed with formidable
- thorns, which seem to warn the stranger not to enter on
- these inhospitable regions.
-
- The settlement is situated eighteen miles up the river.
- The road follows the foot of the sloping cliff, which forms
- the northern boundary of the great valley, in which the Rio
- Negro flows. On the way we passed the ruins of some fine
- "estancias," which a few years since had been destroyed by
- the Indians. They withstood several attacks. A man present
- at one gave me a very lively description of what took place.
- The inhabitants had sufficient notice to drive all the cattle
- and horses into the "corral" [1] which surrounded the house,
- and likewise to mount some small cannon. The Indians were
- Araucanians from the south of Chile; several hundreds in
- number, and highly disciplined. They first appeared in two
- bodies on a neighbouring hill; having there dismounted, and
- taken off their fur mantles, they advanced naked to the
- charge. The only weapon of an Indian is a very long bamboo
- or chuzo, ornamented with ostrich feathers, and pointed
- by a sharp spearhead. My informer seemed to remember
- with the greatest horror the quivering of these chuzos as they
- approached near. When close, the cacique Pincheira hailed
- the besieged to give up their arms, or he would cut all their
- throats. As this would probably have been the result of
- their entrance under any circumstances, the answer was
- given by a volley of musketry. The Indians, with great
- steadiness, came to the very fence of the corral: but to their
- surprise they found the posts fastened together by iron nails
- instead of leather thongs, and, of course, in vain attempted
- to cut them with their knives. This saved the lives of the
- Christians: many of the wounded Indians were carried away
- by their companions, and at last, one of the under caciques
- being wounded, the bugle sounded a retreat. They retired to
- their horses, and seemed to hold a council of war. This was
- an awful pause for the Spaniards, as all their ammunition,
- with the exception of a few cartridges, was expended. In
- an instant the Indians mounted their horses, and galloped
- out of sight. Another attack was still more quickly repulsed.
- A cool Frenchman managed the gun; he stopped till the
- Indians approached close, and then raked their line with
- grape-shot: he thus laid thirty-nine of them on the ground;
- and, of course, such a blow immediately routed the whole
- party.
-
- The town is indifferently called El Carmen or Patagones.
- It is built on the face of a cliff which fronts the river, and
- many of the houses are excavated even in the sandstone.
- The river is about two or three hundred yards wide, and is
- deep and rapid. The many islands, with their willow-trees,
- and the flat headlands, seen one behind the other on the
- northern boundary of the broad green valley, form, by the
- aid of a bright sun, a view almost picturesque. The number
- of inhabitants does not exceed a few hundreds. These Spanish
- colonies do not, like our British ones, carry within themselves
- the elements of growth. Many Indians of pure blood
- reside here: the tribe of the Cacique Lucanee constantly have
- their Toldos [2] on the outskirts of the town. The local
- government partly supplies them with provisions, by giving them
- all the old worn-out horses, and they earn a little by making
- horse-rugs and other articles of riding-gear. These Indians
- are considered civilized; but what their character may have
- gained by a lesser degree of ferocity, is almost counterbalanced
- by their entire immorality. Some of the younger men
- are, however, improving; they are willing to labour, and a
- short time since a party went on a sealing-voyage, and behaved
- very well. They were now enjoying the fruits of their
- labour, by being dressed in very gay, clean clothes, and by
- being very idle. The taste they showed in their dress was
- admirable; if you could have turned one of these young
- Indians into a statue of bronze, his drapery would have been
- perfectly graceful.
-
- One day I rode to a large salt-lake, or Salina, which is
- distant fifteen miles from the town. During the winter it
- consists of a shallow lake of brine, which in summer is
- converted into a field of snow-white salt. The layer near the
- margin is from four to five inches thick, but towards the
- centre its thickness increases. This lake was two and a half
- miles long, and one broad. Others occur in the neighbourhood
- many times larger, and with a floor of salt, two and
- three feet in thickness, even when under water during the
- winter. One of these brilliantly white and level expanses
- in the midst of the brown and desolate plain, offers an
- extraordinary spectacle. A large quantity of salt is annually
- drawn from the salina: and great piles, some hundred
- tons in weight, were lying ready for exportation. The season
- for working the salinas forms the harvest of Patagones; for
- on it the prosperity of the place depends. Nearly the whole
- population encamps on the bank of the river, and the people
- are employed in drawing out the salt in bullock-waggons,
- This salt is crystallized in great cubes, and is remarkably
- pure: Mr. Trenham Reeks has kindly analyzed some for me,
- and he finds in it only 0.26 of gypsum and 0.22 of earthy
- matter. It is a singular fact, that it does not serve so well
- for preserving meat as sea-salt from the Cape de Verd
- islands; and a merchant at Buenos Ayres told me that he
- considered it as fifty per cent. less valuable. Hence the
- Cape de Verd salt is constantly imported, and is mixed with
- that from these salinas. The purity of the Patagonian salt,
- or absence from it of those other saline bodies found in all
- sea-water, is the only assignable cause for this inferiority:
- a conclusion which no one, I think, would have suspected,
- but which is supported by the fact lately ascertained, [3]
- that those salts answer best for preserving cheese which
- contain most of the deliquescent chlorides.
-
- The border of this lake is formed of mud: and in this
- numerous large crystals of gypsum, some of which are three
- inches long, lie embedded; whilst on the surface others of
- sulphate of soda lie scattered about. The Gauchos call the
- former the "Padre del sal," and the latter the "Madre;"
- they state that these progenitive salts always occur on the
- borders of the salinas, when the water begins to evaporate.
- The mud is black, and has a fetid odour. I could not at first
- imagine the cause of this, but I afterwards perceived that the
- froth which the wind drifted on shore was coloured green,
- as if by confervae; I attempted to carry home some of this
- green matter, but from an accident failed. Parts of the lake
- seen from a short distance appeared of a reddish colour, and
- this perhaps was owing to some infusorial animalcula. The
- mud in many places was thrown up by numbers of some kind
- of worm, or annelidous animal. How surprising it is that
- any creatures should be able to exist in brine, and that they
- should be crawling among crystals of sulphate of soda and
- lime! And what becomes of these worms when, during the
- long summer, the surface is hardened into a solid layer of
- salt? Flamingoes in considerable numbers inhabit this lake,
- and breed here, throughout Patagonia, in Northern Chile,
- and at the Galapagos Islands, I met with these birds wherever
- there were lakes of brine. I saw them here wading
- about in search of food -- probably for the worms which burrow
- in the mud; and these latter probably feed on infusoria or
- confervae. Thus we have a little living world within itself
- adapted to these inland lakes of brine. A minute crustaceous
- animal (Cancer salinus) is said [4] to live in countless numbers
- in the brine-pans at Lymington: but only in those in which
- the fluid has attained, from evaporation, considerable
- strength -- namely, about a quarter of a pound of salt to a
- pint of water. Well may we affirm that every part of the
- world is habitable! Whether lakes of brine, or those
- subterranean ones hidden beneath volcanic mountains -- warm
- mineral springs -- the wide expanse and depths of the ocean
- -- the upper regions of the atmosphere, and even the surface
- of perpetual snow -- all support organic beings.
-
-
- To the northward of the Rio Negro, between it and the
- inhabited country near Buenos Ayres, the Spaniards have
- only one small settlement, recently established at Bahia
- Blanca. The distance in a straight line to Buenos Ayres is
- very nearly five hundred British miles. The wandering
- tribes of horse Indians, which have always occupied the
- greater part of this country, having of late much harassed
- the outlying estancias, the government at Buenos Ayres
- equipped some time since an army under the command of
- General Rosas for the purpose of exterminating them. The
- troops were now encamped on the banks of the Colorado;
- a river lying about eighty miles northward of the Rio Negro
- When General Rosas left Buenos Ayres he struck in a direct
- line across the unexplored plains: and as the country was
- thus pretty well cleared of Indians, he left behind him, at
- wide intervals, a small party of soldiers with a troop of
- horses (a posta), so as to be enabled to keep up a communication
- with the capital. As the Beagle intended to call at
- Bahia Blanca, I determined to proceed there by land; and
- ultimately I extended my plan to travel the whole way by
- the postas to Buenos Ayres.
-
- August 11th. -- Mr. Harris, an Englishman residing at
- Patagones, a guide, and five Gauchos who were proceeding
- to the army on business, were my companions on the journey.
- The Colorado, as I have already said, is nearly eighty
- miles distant: and as we travelled slowly, we were two days
- and a half on the road. The whole line of country deserves
- scarcely a better name than that of a desert. Water is found
- only in two small wells; it is called fresh; but even at this
- time of the year, during the rainy season, it was quite brackish.
- In the summer this must be a distressing passage; for
- now it was sufficiently desolate. The valley of the Rio
- Negro, broad as it is, has merely been excavated out of the
- sandstone plain; for immediately above the bank on which
- the town stands, a level country commences, which is interrupted
- only by a few trifling valleys and depressions. Everywhere
- the landscape wears the same sterile aspect; a dry
- gravelly soil supports tufts of brown withered grass, and
- low scattered bushes, armed with thorns.
-
- Shortly after passing the first spring we came in sight of
- a famous tree, which the Indians reverence as the altar of
- Walleechu. It is situated on a high part of the plain; and
- hence is a landmark visible at a great distance. As soon as a
- tribe of Indians come in sight of it, they offer their adorations
- by loud shouts. The tree itself is low, much branched,
- and thorny: just above the root it has a diameter of about
- three feet. It stands by itself without any neighbour, and
- was indeed the first tree we saw; afterwards we met with a
- few others of the same kind, but they were far from common.
- Being winter the tree had no leaves, but in their place
- numberless threads, by which the various offerings, such as
- cigars, bread, meat, pieces of cloth, etc., had been suspended.
- Poor Indians, not having anything better, only pull a thread
- out of their ponchos, and fasten it to the tree. Richer
- Indians are accustomed to pour spirits and mate into a certain
- hole, and likewise to smoke upwards, thinking thus to
- afford all possible gratification to Walleechu. To complete
- the scene, the tree was surrounded by the bleached bones
- of horses which had been slaughtered as sacrifices. All
- Indians of every age and sex make their offerings; they then
- think that their horses will not tire, and that they themselves
- shall be prosperous. The Gaucho who told me this, said that
- in the time of peace he had witnessed this scene, and that
- he and others used to wait till the Indians had passed by, for
- the sake of stealing from Walleechu the offerings.
-
- The Gauchos think that the Indians consider the tree as
- the god itself, but it seems for more probable that they
- regard it as the altar. The only cause which I can imagine
- for this choice, is its being a landmark in a dangerous passage.
- The Sierra de la Ventana is visible at an immense
- distance; and a Gaucho told me that he was once riding with
- an Indian a few miles to the north of the Rio Colorado
- when the Indian commenced making the same loud noise
- which is usual at the first sight of the distant tree, putting
- his hand to his head, and then pointing in the direction of the
- Sierra. Upon being asked the reason of this, the Indian said
- in broken Spanish, "First see the Sierra." About two
- leagues beyond this curious tree we halted for the night: at
- this instant an unfortunate cow was spied by the lynx-eyed
- Gauchos, who set off in full chase, and in a few minutes
- dragged her in with their lazos, and slaughtered her. We
- here had the four necessaries of life "en el campo," -- pasture
- for the horses, water (only a muddy puddle), meat and
- firewood. The Gauchos were in high spirits at finding all
- these luxuries; and we soon set to work at the poor cow. This
- was the first night which I passed under the open sky, with
- the gear of the recado for my bed. There is high enjoyment
- in the independence of the Gaucho life -- to be able at any
- moment to pull up your horse, and say, "Here we will pass
- the night." The death-like stillness of the plain, the dogs
- keeping watch, the gipsy-group of Gauchos making their
- beds round the fire, have left in my mind a strongly-marked
- picture of this first night, which will never be forgotten.
-
- The next day the country continued similar to that above
- described. It is inhabited by few birds or animals of any
- kind. Occasionally a deer, or a Guanaco (wild Llama) may
- be seen; but the Agouti (Cavia Patagonica) is the commonest
- quadruped. This animal here represents our hares. It
- differs, however, from that genus in many essential respects;
- for instance, it has only three toes behind. It is also nearly
- twice the size, weighing from twenty to twenty-five pounds.
- The Agouti is a true friend of the desert; it is a common
- feature of the landscape to see two or three hopping quickly
- one after the other in a straight line across these wild plains.
- They are found as far north as the Sierra Tapalguen (lat.
- 37 degs. 30'), where the plain rather suddenly becomes greener
- and more humid; and their southern limit is between Port
- Desire and St. Julian, where there is no change in the nature
- of the country. It is a singular fact, that although the
- Agouti is not now found as far south as Port St. Julian, yet
- that Captain Wood, in his voyage in 1670, talks of them as
- being numerous there. What cause can have altered, in a
- wide, uninhabited, and rarely-visited country, the range of
- an animal like this? It appears also, from the number shot
- by Captain Wood in one day at Port Desire, that they must
- have been considerably more abundant there formerly than
- at present. Where the Bizcacha lives and makes its burrows,
- the Agouti uses them; but where, as at Bahia Blanca, the
- Bizcacha is not found, the Agouti burrows for itself. The
- same thing occurs with the little owl of the Pampas (Athene
- cunicularia), which has so often been described as standing
- like a sentinel at the mouth of the burrows; for in Banda
- Oriental, owing to the absence of the Bizcacha, it is obliged
- to hollow out its own habitation.
-
- The next morning, as we approached the Rio Colorado,
- the appearance of the country changed; we soon came on a
- plain covered with turf, which, from its flowers, tall clover,
- and little owls, resembled the Pampas. We passed also a
- muddy swamp of considerable extent, which in summer dries,
- and becomes incrusted with various salts; and hence is called
- a salitral. It was covered by low succulent plants, of the
- same kind with those growing on the sea-shore. The Colorado,
- at the pass where we crossed it, is only about sixty
- yards wide; generally it must be nearly double that width.
- Its course is very tortuous, being marked by willow-trees
- and beds of reeds: in a direct line the distance to the mouth
- of the river is said to be nine leagues, but by water
- twenty-five. We were delayed crossing in the canoe by some
- immense troops of mares, which were swimming the river in
- order to follow a division of troops into the interior. A
- more ludicrous spectacle I never beheld than the hundreds
- and hundreds of heads, all directed one way, with pointed
- ears and distended snorting nostrils, appearing just above
- the water like a great shoal of some amphibious animal.
- Mare's flesh is the only food which the soldiers have when
- on an expedition. This gives them a great facility of movement;
- for the distance to which horses can be driven over
- these plains is quite surprising: I have been assured that an
- unloaded horse can travel a hundred miles a day for many
- days successively.
-
- The encampment of General Rosas was close to the river.
- It consisted of a square formed by waggons, artillery, straw
- huts, etc. The soldiers were nearly all cavalry; and I should
- think such a villainous, banditti-like army was never before
- collected together. The greater number of men were of a
- mixed breed, between Negro, Indian, and Spaniard. I know
- not the reason, but men of such origin seldom have a good
- expression of countenance. I called on the Secretary to show
- my passport. He began to cross-question me in the most
- dignified and mysterious manner. By good luck I had a
- letter of recommendation from the government of Buenos
- Ayres [5] to the commandant of Patagones. This was taken
- to General Rosas, who sent me a very obliging message; and
- the Secretary returned all smiles and graciousness. We took
- up our residence in the _rancho_, or hovel, of a curious old
- Spaniard, who had served with Napoleon in the expedition
- against Russia.
-
- We stayed two days at the Colorado; I had little to do,
- for the surrounding country was a swamp, which in summer
- (December), when the snow melts on the Cordillera, is over-
- flowed by the river. My chief amusement was watching the
- Indian families as they came to buy little articles at the
- rancho where we stayed. It was supposed that General
- Rosas had about six hundred Indian allies. The men were
- a tall, fine race, yet it was afterwards easy to see in the
- Fuegian savage the same countenance rendered hideous by
- cold, want of food, and less civilization. Some authors,
- in defining the primary races of mankind, have separated
- these Indians into two classes; but this is certainly
- incorrect. Among the young women or chinas, some deserve to
- be called even beautiful. Their hair was coarse, but bright
- and black; and they wore it in two plaits hanging down
- to the waist. They had a high colour, and eyes that
- glistened with brilliancy; their legs, feet, and arms were
- small and elegantly formed; their ankles, and sometimes
- their wrists, were ornamented by broad bracelets of blue
- beads. Nothing could be more interesting than some of the
- family groups. A mother with one or two daughters would
- often come to our rancho, mounted on the same horse. They
- ride like men, but with their knees tucked up much higher.
- This habit, perhaps, arises from their being accustomed,
- when travelling, to ride the loaded horses. The duty of the
- women is to load and unload the horses; to make the tents
- for the night; in short to be, like the wives of all savages,
- useful slaves. The men fight, hunt, take care of the horses,
- and make the riding gear. One of their chief indoor occupations
- is to knock two stones together till they become round,
- in order to make the bolas. With this important weapon the
- Indian catches his game, and also his horse, which roams
- free over the plain. In fighting, his first attempt is to throw
- down the horse of his adversary with the bolas, and when
- entangled by the fall to kill him with the chuzo. If the balls
- only catch the neck or body of an animal, they are often
- carried away and lost. As the making the stones round is
- the labour of two days, the manufacture of the balls is a
- very common employment. Several of the men and women
- had their faces painted red, but I never saw the horizontal
- bands which are so common among the Fuegians. Their
- chief pride consists in having everything made of silver; I
- have seen a cacique with his spurs, stirrups, handle of his
- knife, and bridle made of this metal: the head-stall and reins
- being of wire, were not thicker than whipcord; and to see a
- fiery steed wheeling about under the command of so light
- a chain, gave to the horsemanship a remarkable character of
- elegance.
-
- General Rosas intimated a wish to see me; a circumstance
- which I was afterwards very glad of. He is a man of an
- extraordinary character, and has a most predominant influence
- in the country, which it seems he will use to its prosperity
- and advancement. [6] He is said to be the owner of
- seventy-four square leagues of land, and to have about three
- hundred thousand head of cattle. His estates are admirably
- managed, and are far more productive of corn than those of
- others. He first gained his celebrity by his laws for his own
- estancias, and by disciplining several hundred men, so as to
- resist with success the attacks of the Indians. There are
- many stories current about the rigid manner in which his
- laws were enforced. One of these was, that no man, on
- penalty of being put into the stocks, should carry his knife
- on a Sunday: this being the principal day for gambling and
- drinking, many quarrels arose, which from the general manner
- of fighting with the knife often proved fatal. One
- Sunday the Governor came in great form to pay the estancia
- a visit, and General Rosas, in his hurry, walked out to receive
- him with his knife, as usual, stuck in his belt. The steward
- touched his arm, and reminded him of the law; upon which
- turning to the Governor, he said he was extremely sorry, but
- that he must go into the stocks, and that till let out, he
- possessed no power even in his own house. After a little time
- the steward was persuaded to open the stocks, and to let
- him out, but no sooner was this done, than he turned to the
- steward and said, "You now have broken the laws, so you
- must take my place in the stocks." Such actions as these
- delighted the Gauchos, who all possess high notions of their
- own equality and dignity.
-
- General Rosas is also a perfect horseman -- an accomplishment
- of no small consequence In a country where an assembled
- army elected its general by the following trial: A troop
- of unbroken horses being driven into a corral, were let out
- through a gateway, above which was a cross-bar: it was
- agreed whoever should drop from the bar on one of these
- wild animals, as it rushed out, and should be able, without
- saddle or bridle, not only to ride it, but also to bring it back
- to the door of the corral, should be their general. The person
- who succeeded was accordingly elected; and doubtless
- made a fit general for such an army. This extraordinary
- feat has also been performed by Rosas.
-
- By these means, and by conforming to the dress and habits
- of the Gauchos, he has obtained an unbounded popularity in
- the country, and in consequence a despotic power. I was
- assured by an English merchant, that a man who had murdered
- another, when arrested and questioned concerning his
- motive, answered, "He spoke disrespectfully of General
- Rosas, so I killed him." At the end of a week the murderer
- was at liberty. This doubtless was the act of the general's
- party, and not of the general himself.
-
- In conversation he is enthusiastic, sensible, and very
- grave. His gravity is carried to a high pitch: I heard one
- of his mad buffoons (for he keeps two, like the barons of
- old) relate the following anecdote. "I wanted very much to
- hear a certain piece of music, so I went to the general two
- or three times to ask him; he said to me, 'Go about your
- business, for I am engaged.' I went a second time; he said,
- 'If you come again I will punish you.' A third time I
- asked, and he laughed. I rushed out of the tent, but it was
- too late -- he ordered two soldiers to catch and stake me. I
- begged by all the saints in heaven he would let me off; but it
- would not do, -- when the general laughs he spares neither
- mad man nor sound." The poor flighty gentleman looked quite
- dolorous, at the very recollection of the staking. This is a
- very severe punishment; four posts are driven into the
- ground, and the man is extended by his arms and legs
- horizontally, and there left to stretch for several hours.
- The idea is evidently taken from the usual method of drying
- hides. My interview passed away, without a smile, and I
- obtained a passport and order for the government post-horses,
- and this he gave me in the most obliging and ready
- manner.
-
- In the morning we started for Bahia Blanca, which we
- reached in two days. Leaving the regular encampment, we
- passed by the toldos of the Indians. These are round like
- ovens, and covered with hides; by the mouth of each, a tapering
- chuzo was stuck in the ground. The toldos were divided
- into separate groups, which belong to the different caciques'
- tribes, and the groups were again divided into smaller ones,
- according to the relationship of the owners. For several
- miles we travelled along the valley of the Colorado. The
- alluvial plains on the side appeared fertile, and it is supposed
- that they are well adapted to the growth of corn. Turning
- northward from the river, we soon entered on a country, differing
- from the plains south of the river. The land still continued
- dry and sterile: but it supported many different kinds
- of plants, and the grass, though brown and withered, was
- more abundant, as the thorny bushes were less so. These
- latter in a short space entirely disappeared, and the plains
- were left without a thicket to cover their nakedness. This
- change in the vegetation marks the commencement of the
- grand calcareo argillaceous deposit, which forms the wide
- extent of the Pampas, and covers the granitic rocks of Banda
- Oriental. From the Strait of Magellan to the Colorado, a
- distance of about eight hundred miles, the face of the country
- is everywhere composed of shingle: the pebbles are
- chiefly of porphyry, and probably owe their origin to the
- rocks of the Cordillera. North of the Colorado this bed
- thins out, and the pebbles become exceedingly small, and
- here the characteristic vegetation of Patagonia ceases.
-
- Having ridden about twenty-five miles, we came to a
- broad belt of sand-dunes, which stretches, as far as the eye
- can reach, to the east and west. The sand-hillocks resting
- on the clay, allow small pools of water to collect, and thus
- afford in this dry country an invaluable supply of fresh
- water. The great advantage arising from depressions and
- elevations of the soil, is not often brought home to the mind.
- The two miserable springs in the long passage between the
- Rio Negro and Colorado were caused by trifling inequalities
- in the plain, without them not a drop of water would have
- been found. The belt of sand-dunes is about eight miles
- wide; at some former period, it probably formed the margin
- of a grand estuary, where the Colorado now flows. In this
- district, where absolute proofs of the recent elevation of
- the land occur, such speculations can hardly be neglected by
- any one, although merely considering the physical geography
- of the country. Having crossed the sandy tract, we arrived
- in the evening at one of the post-houses; and, as the fresh
- horses were grazing at a distance we determined to pass
- the night there.
-
- The house was situated at the base of a ridge between
- one and two hundred feet high -- a most remarkable feature
- in this country. This posta was commanded by a negro
- lieutenant, born in Africa: to his credit be it said, there
- was not a ranche between the Colorado and Buenos Ayres in
- nearly such neat order as his. He had a little room for
- strangers, and a small corral for the horses, all made of
- sticks and reeds; he had also dug a ditch round his house
- as a defence in case of being attacked. This would, however,
- have been of little avail, if the Indians had come; but
- his chief comfort seemed to rest in the thought of selling
- his life dearly. A short time before, a body of Indians had
- travelled past in the night; if they had been aware of the
- posta, our black friend and his four soldiers would assuredly
- have been slaughtered. I did not anywhere meet a more
- civil and obliging man than this negro; it was therefore
- the more painful to see that he would not sit down and eat
- with us.
-
- In the morning we sent for the horses very early, and
- started for another exhilarating gallop. We passed the
- Cabeza del Buey, an old name given to the head of a large
- marsh, which extends from Bahia Blanca. Here we changed
- horses, and passed through some leagues of swamps and
- saline marshes. Changing horses for the last time, we again
- began wading through the mud. My animal fell and I was
- well soused in black mire -- a very disagreeable accident
- when one does not possess a change of clothes. Some miles
- from the fort we met a man, who told us that a great gun
- had been fired, which is a signal that Indians are near. We
- immediately left the road, and followed the edge of a marsh,
- which when chased offers the best mode of escape. We
- were glad to arrive within the walls, when we found all the
- alarm was about nothing, for the Indians turned out to be
- friendly ones, who wished to join General Rosas.
-
- Bahia Blanca scarcely deserves the name of a village. A
- few houses and the barracks for the troops are enclosed by
- a deep ditch and fortified wall. The settlement is only of
- recent standing (since 1828); and its growth has been one of
- trouble. The government of Buenos Ayres unjustly occupied
- it by force, instead of following the wise example of the
- Spanish Viceroys, who purchased the land near the older
- settlement of the Rio Negro, from the Indians. Hence the
- need of the fortifications; hence the few houses and little
- cultivated land without the limits of the walls; even the
- cattle are not safe from the attacks of the Indians beyond
- the boundaries of the plain, on which the fortress stands.
-
- The part of the harbour where the Beagle intended to
- anchor being distant twenty-five miles, I obtained from the
- Commandant a guide and horses, to take me to see whether
- she had arrived. Leaving the plain of green turf, which
- extended along the course of a little brook, we soon entered
- on a wide level waste consisting either of sand, saline
- marshes, or bare mud. Some parts were clothed by low
- thickets, and others with those succulent plants, which
- luxuriate only where salt abounds. Bad as the country was,
- ostriches, deer, agoutis, and armadilloes, were abundant. My
- guide told me, that two months before he had a most narrow
- escape of his life: he was out hunting with two other men,
- at no great distance from this part of the country, when they
- were suddenly met by a party of Indians, who giving chase,
- soon overtook and killed his two friends. His own horse's
- legs were also caught by the bolas, but he jumped off, and
- with his knife cut them free: while doing this he was obliged
- to dodge round his horse, and received two severe wounds
- from their chuzos. Springing on the saddle, he managed, by
- a most wonderful exertion, just to keep ahead of the long
- spears of his pursuers, who followed him to within sight of
- the fort. From that time there was an order that no one
- should stray far from the settlement. I did not know of this
- when I started, and was surprised to observe how earnestly
- my guide watched a deer, which appeared to have been
- frightened from a distant quarter.
-
- We found the Beagle had not arrived, and consequently
- set out on our return, but the horses soon tiring, we were
- obliged to bivouac on the plain. In the morning we had
- caught an armadillo, which although a most excellent dish
- when roasted in its shell, did not make a very substantial
- breakfast and dinner for two hungry men. The ground at
- the place where we stopped for the night, was incrusted with
- a layer of sulphate of soda, and hence, of course, was without
- water. Yet many of the smaller rodents managed to
- exist even here, and the tucutuco was making its odd little
- grunt beneath my head, during half the night. Our horses
- were very poor ones, and in the morning they were soon
- exhausted from not having had anything to drink, so that
- we were obliged to walk. About noon the dogs killed a kid,
- which we roasted. I ate some of it, but it made me intolerably
- thirsty. This was the more distressing as the road,
- from some recent rain, was full of little puddles of clear
- water, yet not a drop was drinkable. I had scarcely been
- twenty hours without water, and only part of the time under
- a hot sun, yet the thirst rendered me very weak. How people
- survive two or three days under such circumstances, I cannot
- imagine: at the same time, I must confess that my guide did
- not suffer at all, and was astonished that one day's
- deprivation should be so troublesome to me.
-
- I have several times alluded to the surface of the ground
- being incrusted with salt. This phenomenon is quite
- different from that of the salinas, and more extraordinary.
- In many parts of South America, wherever the climate is
- moderately dry, these incrustations occur; but I have nowhere
- seen them so abundant as near Bahia Blanca. The salt here,
- and in other parts of Patagonia, consists chiefly of sulphate
- of soda with some common salt. As long as the ground
- remains moist in the salitrales (as the Spaniards improperly
- call them, mistaking this substance for saltpeter), nothing is
- to be seen but an extensive plain composed of a black, muddy
- soil, supporting scattered tufts of succulent plants. On returning
- through one of these tracts, after a week's hot weather,
- one is surprised to see square miles of the plain white, as if
- from a slight fall of snow, here and there heaped up by the
- wind into little drifts. This latter appearance is chiefly
- caused by the salts being drawn up, during the slow evaporation
- of the moisture, round blades of dead grass, stumps of
- wood, and pieces of broken earth, instead of being crystallized
- at the bottoms of the puddles of water. The salitrales
- occur either on level tracts elevated only a few feet above
- the level of the sea, or on alluvial land bordering rivers.
- M. Parchappe [7] found that the saline incrustation on the plain,
- at the distance of some miles from the sea, consisted chiefly
- of sulphate of soda, with only seven per cent. of common
- salt; whilst nearer to the coast, the common salt increased
- to 37 parts in a hundred. This circumstance would tempt
- one to believe that the sulphate of soda is generated in the
- soil, from the muriate, left on the surface during the slow
- and recent elevation of this dry country. The whole phenomenon
- is well worthy the attention of naturalists. Have
- the succulent, salt-loving plants, which are well known to
- contain much soda, the power of decomposing the muriate?
- Does the black fetid mud, abounding with organic matter,
- yield the sulphur and ultimately the sulphuric acid?
-
- Two days afterwards I again rode to the harbour: when
- not far from our destination, my companion, the same man
- as before, spied three people hunting on horseback. He
- immediately dismounted, and watching them intently, said,
- "They don't ride like Christians, and nobody can leave the
- fort." The three hunters joined company, and likewise
- dismounted from their horses. At last one mounted again
- and rode over the hill out of sight. My companion said,
- "We must now get on our horses: load your pistol;" and he
- looked to his own sword. I asked, "Are they Indians?" --
- "Quien sabe? (who knows?) if there are no more than three,
- it does not signify." It then struck me, that the one man
- had gone over the hill to fetch the rest of his tribe. I
- suggested this; but all the answer I could extort was, "Quien
- sabe?" His head and eye never for a minute ceased scanning
- slowly the distant horizon. I thought his uncommon
- coolness too good a joke, and asked him why he did not
- return home. I was startled when he answered, "We are
- returning, but in a line so as to pass near a swamp, into
- which we can gallop the horses as far as they can go, and
- then trust to our own legs; so that there is no danger." I did
- not feel quite so confident of this, and wanted to increase
- our pace. He said, "No, not until they do." When any
- little inequality concealed us, we galloped; but when in sight,
- continued walking. At last we reached a valley, and turning
- to the left, galloped quickly to the foot of a hill; he gave me
- his horse to hold, made the dogs lie down, and then crawled
- on his hands and knees to reconnoitre. He remained in this
- position for some time, and at last, bursting out in laughter,
- exclaimed, "Mugeres!" (women!). He knew them to be
- the wife and sister-in-law of the major's son, hunting for
- ostrich's eggs. I have described this man's conduct, because
- he acted under the full impression that they were Indians.
- As soon, however, as the absurd mistake was found out, he
- gave me a hundred reasons why they could not have been
- Indians; but all these were forgotten at the time. We then
- rode on in peace and quietness to a low point called Punta
- Alta, whence we could see nearly the whole of the great harbour
- of Bahia Blanca.
-
- The wide expanse of water is choked up by numerous
- great mud-banks, which the inhabitants call Cangrejales, or
- _crabberies_, from the number of small crabs. The mud is so
- soft that it is impossible to walk over them, even for the
- shortest distance. Many of the banks have their surfaces
- covered with long rushes, the tops of which alone are visible
- at high water. On one occasion, when in a boat, we were
- so entangled by these shallows that we could hardly find
- our way. Nothing was visible but the flat beds of mud; the
- day was not very clear, and there was much refraction, or
- as the sailors expressed it, "things loomed high." The only
- object within our view which was not level was the horizon;
- rushes looked like bushes unsupported in the air, and water
- like mud-banks, and mud-banks like water.
-
- We passed the night in Punta Alta, and I employed myself
- in searching for fossil bones; this point being a perfect
- catacomb for monsters of extinct races. The evening was
- perfectly calm and clear; the extreme monotony of the view
- gave it an interest even in the midst of mud-banks and gulls
- sand-hillocks and solitary vultures. In riding back in the
- morning we came across a very fresh track of a Puma, but
- did not succeed in finding it. We saw also a couple of
- Zorillos, or skunks, -- odious animals, which are far from
- uncommon. In general appearance, the Zorillo resembles a
- polecat, but it is rather larger, and much thicker in proportion.
- Conscious of its power, it roams by day about the open
- plain, and fears neither dog nor man. If a dog is urged to
- the attack, its courage is instantly checked by a few drops
- of the fetid oil, which brings on violent sickness and running
- at the nose. Whatever is once polluted by it, is for
- ever useless. Azara says the smell can be perceived at a
- league distant; more than once, when entering the harbour
- of Monte Video, the wind being off shore, we have perceived
- the odour on board the Beagle. Certain it is, that
- every animal most willingly makes room for the Zorillo.
-
- [1] The corral is an enclosure made of tall and strong
- stakes. Every estancia, or farming estate, has one attached
- to it.
-
- [2] The hovels of the Indians are thus called.
-
- [3] Report of the Agricult. Chem. Assoc. in the Agricult.
- Gazette, 1845, p. 93.
-
- [4] Linnaean Trans,. vol. xi. p. 205. It is remarkable how
- all the circumstances connected with the salt-lakes in Siberia
- and Patagonia are similar. Siberia, like Patagonia, appears
- to have been recently elevated above the waters of the sea.
- In both countries the salt-lakes occupy shallow depressions
- in the plains; in both the mud on the borders is black and
- fetid; beneath the crust of common salt, sulphate of soda or
- of magnesium occurs, imperfectly crystallized; and in both,
- the muddy sand is mixed with lentils of gypsum. The Siberian
- salt-lakes are inhabited by small crustaceous animals; and
- flamingoes (Edin. New Philos. Jour., Jan 1830) likewise
- frequent them. As these circumstances, apparently so trifling,
- occur in two distant continents, we may feel sure that they
- are the necessary results of a common cause -- See Pallas's
- Travels, 1793 to 1794, pp. 129 - 134.
-
- [5] I am bound to express in the strongest terms, my obligation
- to the government of Buenos Ayres for the obliging manner in
- which passports to all parts of the country were given me, as
- naturalist of the Beagle.
-
- [6] This prophecy has turned out entirely and miserably wrong.
- 1845.
-
- [7] Voyage dans l'Amerique Merid par M. A. d'Orbigny. Part.
- Hist. tom. i. p. 664
-
-
-
- CHAPTER V
-
- BAHIA BLANCA
-
- Bahia Blanca -- Geology -- Numerous gigantic Quadrupeds --
- Recent Extinction -- Longevity of species -- Large Animals
- do not require a luxuriant vegetation -- Southern Africa --
- Siberian Fossils -- Two Species of Ostrich -- Habits of
- Oven-bird -- Armadilloes -- Venomous Snake, Toad, Lizard --
- Hybernation of Animal -- Habits of Sea-Pen -- Indian Wars and
- Massacres -- Arrow-head, antiquarian Relic.
-
-
- The Beagle arrived here on the 24th of August, and a
- week afterwards sailed for the Plata. With Captain
- Fitz Roy's consent I was left behind, to travel by land
- to Buenos Ayres. I will here add some observations, which
- were made during this visit and on a previous occasion, when
- the Beagle was employed in surveying the harbour.
-
- The plain, at the distance of a few miles from the coast,
- belongs to the great Pampean formation, which consists in
- part of a reddish clay, and in part of a highly calcareous
- marly rock. Nearer the coast there are some plains formed
- from the wreck of the upper plain, and from mud, gravel,
- and sand thrown up by the sea during the slow elevation of
- the land, of which elevation we have evidence in upraised
- beds of recent shells, and in rounded pebbles of pumice
- scattered over the country. At Punta Alta we have a section of
- one of these later-formed little plains, which is highly
- interesting from the number and extraordinary character of the
- remains of gigantic land-animals embedded in it. These have
- been fully described by Professor Owen, in the Zoology of the
- voyage of the Beagle, and are deposited in the College of
- Surgeons. I will here give only a brief outline of their nature.
-
- First, parts of three heads and other bones of the Megatherium,
- the huge dimensions of which are expressed by its
- name. Secondly, the Megalonyx, a great allied animal.
- Thirdly, the Scelidotherium, also an allied animal, of which
- I obtained a nearly perfect skeleton. It must have been as
- large as a rhinoceros: in the structure of its head it comes
- according to Mr. Owen, nearest to the Cape Anteater, but
- in some other respects it approaches to the armadilloes.
- Fourthly, the Mylodon Darwinii, a closely related genus of
- little inferior size. Fifthly, another gigantic edental quadruped.
- Sixthly, a large animal, with an osseous coat in compartments,
- very like that of an armadillo. Seventhly, an
- extinct kind of horse, to which I shall have again to refer.
- Eighthly, a tooth of a Pachydermatous animal, probably the
- same with the Macrauchenia, a huge beast with a long neck
- like a camel, which I shall also refer to again. Lastly, the
- Toxodon, perhaps one of the strangest animals ever discovered:
- in size it equalled an elephant or megatherium, but
- the structure of its teeth, as Mr. Owen states, proves
- indisputably that it was intimately related to the Gnawers, the
- order which, at the present day, includes most of the smallest
- quadrupeds: in many details it is allied to the Pachydermata:
- judging from the position of its eyes, ears, and nostrils,
- it was probably aquatic, like the Dugong and Manatee,
- to which it is also allied. How wonderfully are the different
- Orders, at the present time so well separated, blended together
- in different points of the structure of the Toxodon!
-
- The remains of these nine great quadrupeds, and many
- detached bones, were found embedded on the beach, within
- the space of about 200 yards square. It is a remarkable
- circumstance that so many different species should be found
- together; and it proves how numerous in kind the ancient
- inhabitants of this country must have been. At the distance
- of about thirty miles from Punta Alta, in a cliff of red earth,
- I found several fragments of bones, some of large size.
- Among them were the teeth of a gnawer, equalling in size
- and closely resembling those of the Capybara, whose habits
- have been described; and therefore, probably, an aquatic
- animal. There was also part of the head of a Ctenomys; the
- species being different from the Tucutuco, but with a close
- general resemblance. The red earth, like that of the Pampas,
- in which these remains were embedded, contains, according
- to Professor Ehrenberg, eight fresh-water and one salt-water
- infusorial animalcule; therefore, probably, it was an estuary
- deposit.
-
- The remains at Punta Alta were embedded in stratified
- gravel and reddish mud, just such as the sea might now wash
- up on a shallow bank. They were associated with twenty-
- three species of shells, of which thirteen are recent and four
- others very closely related to recent forms. [1] From the bones
- of the Scelidotherium, including even the knee-cap, being
- intombed in their proper relative positions, and from the
- osseous armour of the great armadillo-like animal being so
- well preserved, together with the bones of one of its legs, we
- may feel assured that these remains were fresh and united by
- their ligaments, when deposited in the gravel together with
- the shells. [2] Hence we have good evidence that the above
- enumerated gigantic quadrupeds, more different from those
- of the present day than the oldest of the tertiary quadrupeds
- of Europe, lived whilst the sea was peopled with most
- of its present inhabitants; and we have confirmed that remarkable
- law so often insisted on by Mr. Lyell, namely, that
- the "longevity of the species in the mammalia is upon the
- whole inferior to that of the testacea." [3]
-
- The great size of the bones of the Megatheroid animals,
- including the Megatherium, Megalonyx, Scelidotherium, and
- Mylodon, is truly wonderful. The habits of life of these
- animals were a complete puzzle to naturalists, until Professor
- Owen [4] solved the problem with remarkable ingenuity. The
- teeth indicate, by their simple structure, that these Megatheroid
- animals lived on vegetable food, and probably on the
- leaves and small twigs of trees; their ponderous forms and
- great strong curved claws seem so little adapted for locomotion,
- that some eminent naturalists have actually believed,
- that, like the sloths, to which they are intimately related,
- they subsisted by climbing back downwards on trees, and
- feeding on the leaves. It was a bold, not to say preposterous,
- idea to conceive even antediluvian trees, with branches
- strong enough to bear animals as large as elephants. Professor
- Owen, with far more probability, believes that, instead
- of climbing on the trees, they pulled the branches down to
- them, and tore up the smaller ones by the roots, and so fed on
- the leaves. The colossal breadth and weight of their hinder
- quarters, which can hardly be imagined without having been
- seen, become on this view, of obvious service, instead of
- being an incumbrance: their apparent clumsiness disappears.
- With their great tails and their huge heels firmly fixed like
- a tripod on the ground, they could freely exert the full force
- of their most powerful arms and great claws. Strongly
- rooted, indeed, must that tree have been, which could have
- resisted such force! The Mylodon, moreover, was furnished
- with a long extensile tongue like that of the giraffe, which,
- by one of those beautiful provisions of nature, thus reaches
- with the aid of its long neck its leafy food. I may remark,
- that in Abyssinia the elephant, according to Bruce, when it
- cannot reach with its proboscis the branches, deeply scores
- with its tusks the trunk of the tree, up and down and all
- round, till it is sufficiently weakened to be broken down.
-
- The beds including the above fossil remains, stand only
- from fifteen to twenty feet above the level of high-water;
- and hence the elevation of the land has been small (without
- there has been an intercalated period of subsidence, of which
- we have no evidence) since the great quadrupeds wandered
- over the surrounding plains; and the external features of
- the country must then have been very nearly the same as
- now. What, it may naturally be asked, was the character
- of the vegetation at that period; was the country as wretchedly
- sterile as it now is? As so many of the co-embedded
- shells are the same with those now living in the bay, I was
- at first inclined to think that the former vegetation was
- probably similar to the existing one; but this would have
- been an erroneous inference for some of these same shells
- live on the luxuriant coast of Brazil; and generally, the
- character of the inhabitants of the sea are useless as guides
- to judge of those on the land. Nevertheless, from the following
- considerations, I do not believe that the simple fact
- of many gigantic quadrupeds having lived on the plains
- round Bahia Blanca, is any sure guide that they formerly
- were clothed with a luxuriant vegetation: I have no doubt
- that the sterile country a little southward, near the Rio
- Negro, with its scattered thorny trees, would support many
- and large quadrupeds.
-
-
- That large animals require a luxuriant vegetation, has
- been a general assumption which has passed from one work
- to another; but I do not hesitate to say that it is completely
- false, and that it has vitiated the reasoning of geologists
- on some points of great interest in the ancient history of
- the world. The prejudice has probably been derived from
- India, and the Indian islands, where troops of elephants,
- noble forests, and impenetrable jungles, are associated together
- in every one's mind. If, however, we refer to any
- work of travels through the southern parts of Africa, we
- shall find allusions in almost every page either to the desert
- character of the country, or to the numbers of large animals
- inhabiting it. The same thing is rendered evident
- by the many engravings which have been published of various
- parts of the interior. When the Beagle was at Cape
- Town, I made an excursion of some days' length into the
- country, which at least was sufficient to render that which
- I had read more fully intelligible.
-
- Dr. Andrew Smith, who, at the head of his adventurous
- party, has lately succeeded in passing the Tropic of Capricorn,
- informs me that, taking into consideration the whole
- of the southern part of Africa, there can be no doubt of its
- being a sterile country. On the southern and south-eastern
- coasts there are some fine forests, but with these exceptions,
- the traveller may pass for days together through open plains,
- covered by a poor and scanty vegetation. It is difficult to
- convey any accurate idea of degrees of comparative fertility;
- but it may be safely said that the amount of vegetation
- supported at any one time [5] by Great Britain, exceeds,
- perhaps even tenfold, the quantity on an equal area, in the
- interior parts of Southern Africa. The fact that bullock-
- waggons can travel in any direction, excepting near the
- coast, without more than occasionally half an hour's delay
- in cutting down bushes, gives, perhaps, a more definite notion
- of the scantiness of the vegetation. Now, if we look to the
- animals inhabiting these wide plains, we shall find their
- numbers extraordinarily great, and their bulk immense. We
- must enumerate the elephant, three species of rhinoceros,
- and probably, according to Dr. Smith, two others, the hippopotamus,
- the giraffe, the bos caffer -- as large as a full-grown
- bull, and the elan -- but little less, two zebras, and the
- quaccha, two gnus, and several antelopes even larger than these
- latter animals. It may be supposed that although the species
- are numerous, the individuals of each kind are few.
- By the kindness of Dr. Smith, I am enabled to show that
- the case is very different. He informs me, that in lat. 24 degs.,
- in one day's march with the bullock-waggons, he saw, without
- wandering to any great distance on either side, between
- one hundred and one hundred and fifty rhinoceroses, which
- belonged to three species: the same day he saw several herds
- of giraffes, amounting together to nearly a hundred; and
- that although no elephant was observed, yet they are found
- in this district. At the distance of a little more than one
- hour's march from their place of encampment on the previous
- night, his party actually killed at one spot eight
- hippopotamuses, and saw many more. In this same river there
- were likewise crocodiles. Of course it was a case quite
- extraordinary, to see so many great animals crowded together,
- but it evidently proves that they must exist in great numbers.
- Dr. Smith describes the country passed through that
- day, as "being thinly covered with grass, and bushes about
- four feet high, and still more thinly with mimosa-trees."
- The waggons were not prevented travelling in a nearly
- straight line.
-
- Besides these large animals, every one the least acquainted
- with the natural history of the Cape, has read of
- the herds of antelopes, which can be compared only with the
- flocks of migratory birds. The numbers indeed of the lion,
- panther, and hyaena, and the multitude of birds of prey,
- plainly speak of the abundance of the smaller quadrupeds:
- one evening seven lions were counted at the same time prowling
- round Dr. Smith's encampment. As this able naturalist
- remarked to me, the carnage each day in Southern Africa
- must indeed be terrific! I confess it is truly surprising how
- such a number of animals can find support in a country
- producing so little food. The larger quadrupeds no doubt
- roam over wide tracts in search of it; and their food chiefly
- consists of underwood, which probably contains much nutriment
- in a small bulk. Dr. Smith also informs me that the
- vegetation has a rapid growth; no sooner is a part consumed,
- than its place is supplied by a fresh stock. There can be
- no doubt, however, that our ideas respecting the apparent
- amount of food necessary for the support of large quadrupeds
- are much exaggerated: it should have been remembered
- that the camel, an animal of no mean bulk, has always been
- considered as the emblem of the desert.
-
- The belief that where large quadrupeds exist, the vegetation
- must necessarily be luxuriant, is the more remarkable,
- because the converse is far from true. Mr. Burchell observed
- to me that when entering Brazil, nothing struck him more
- forcibly than the splendour of the South American vegetation
- contrasted with that of South Africa, together with
- the absence of all large quadrupeds. In his Travels, [6] he has
- suggested that the comparison of the respective weights (if
- there were sufficient data) of an equal number of the largest
- herbivorous quadrupeds of each country would be extremely
- curious. If we take on the one side, the elephant, [7] hippopotamus,
- giraffe, bos caffer, elan, certainly three, and probably
- five species of rhinoceros; and on the American side,
- two tapirs, the guanaco, three deer, the vicuna, peccari,
- capybara (after which we must choose from the monkeys to
- complete the number), and then place these two groups
- alongside each other, it is not easy to conceive ranks more
- disproportionate in size. After the above facts, we are compelled
- to conclude, against anterior probability, [8] that among
- the mammalia there exists no close relation between the
- bulk of the species, and the _quantity_ of the vegetation, in
- the countries which they inhabit.
-
- With regard to the number of large quadrupeds, there
- certainly exists no quarter of the globe which will bear
- comparison with Southern Africa. After the different statements
- which have been given, the extremely desert character
- of that region will not be disputed. In the European division
- of the world, we must look back to the tertiary epochs,
- to find a condition of things among the mammalia, resembling
- that now existing at the Cape of Good Hope. Those
- tertiary epochs, which we are apt to consider as abounding
- to an astonishing degree with large animals, because we
- find the remains of many ages accumulated at certain spots,
- could hardly boast of more large quadrupeds than Southern
- Africa does at present. If we speculate on the condition
- of the vegetation during these epochs we are at least bound
- so far to consider existing analogies, as not to urge as
- absolutely necessary a luxuriant vegetation, when we see
- a state of things so totally different at the Cape of Good
- Hope.
-
- We know [9] that the extreme regions of North America,
- many degrees beyond the limit where the ground at the depth
- of a few feet remains perpetually congealed, are covered by
- forests of large and tall trees. In a like manner, in Siberia,
- we have woods of birch, fir, aspen, and larch, growing in a
- latitude [10] (64 degs.) where the mean temperature of the
- air falls below the freezing point, and where the earth is so
- completely frozen, that the carcass of an animal embedded in it
- is perfectly preserved. With these facts we must grant, as
- far as _quantity alone_ of vegetation is concerned, that the
- great quadrupeds of the later tertiary epochs might, in most
- parts of Northern Europe and Asia, have lived on the spots
- where their remains are now found. I do not here speak of
- the kind of vegetation necessary for their support; because,
- as there is evidence of physical changes, and as the animals
- have become extinct, so may we suppose that the species of
- plants have likewise been changed.
-
- These remarks, I may be permitted to add, directly bear
- on the case of the Siberian animals preserved in ice. The
- firm conviction of the necessity of a vegetation possessing
- a character of tropical luxuriance, to support such large
- animals, and the impossibility of reconciling this with the
- proximity of perpetual congelation, was one chief cause of
- the several theories of sudden revolutions of climate, and of
- overwhelming catastrophes, which were invented to account
- for their entombment. I am far from supposing that the
- climate has not changed since the period when those animals
- lived, which now lie buried in the ice. At present I
- only wish to show, that as far as _quantity_ of food _alone_ is
- concerned, the ancient rhinoceroses might have roamed over
- the _steppes_ of central Siberia (the northern parts probably
- being under water) even in their present condition, as well
- as the living rhinoceroses and elephants over the _Karros_
- of Southern Africa.
-
-
- I will now give an account of the habits of some of the
- more interesting birds which are common on the wild plains
- of Northern Patagonia: and first for the largest, or South
- American ostrich. The ordinary habits of the ostrich are
- familiar to every one. They live on vegetable matter, such
- as roots and grass; but at Bahia Blanca I have repeatedly
- seen three or four come down at low water to the extensive
- mud-banks which are then dry, for the sake, as the Gauchos
- say, of feeding on small fish. Although the ostrich in its
- habits is so shy, wary, and solitary, and although so fleet
- in its pace, it is caught without much difficulty by the Indian
- or Gaucho armed with the bolas. When several horsemen
- appear in a semicircle, it becomes confounded, and does
- not know which way to escape. They generally prefer running
- against the wind; yet at the first start they expand
- their wings, and like a vessel make all sail. On one fine
- hot day I saw several ostriches enter a bed of tall rushes,
- where they squatted concealed, till quite closely approached.
- It is not generally known that ostriches readily take to the
- water. Mr. King informs me that at the Bay of San Blas,
- and at Port Valdes in Patagonia, he saw these birds swimming
- several times from island to island. They ran into
- the water both when driven down to a point, and likewise
- of their own accord when not frightened: the distance
- crossed was about two hundred yards. When swimming,
- very little of their bodies appear above water; their necks
- are extended a little forward, and their progress is slow.
- On two occasions I saw some ostriches swimming across the
- Santa Cruz river, where its course was about four hundred
- yards wide, and the stream rapid. Captain Sturt, [11] when
- descending the Murrumbidgee, in Australia, saw two emus
- in the act of swimming.
-
- The inhabitants of the country readily distinguish, even
- at a distance, the cock bird from the hen. The former is
- larger and darker-coloured, [12] and has a bigger head. The
- ostrich, I believe the cock, emits a singular, deep-toned,
- hissing note: when first I heard it, standing in the midst of
- some sand-hillocks, I thought it was made by some wild
- beast, for it is a sound that one cannot tell whence it comes,
- or from how far distant. When we were at Bahia Blanca
- in the months of September and October, the eggs, in
- extraordinary numbers, were found all over the country. They
- lie either scattered and single, in which case they are never
- hatched, and are called by the Spaniards huachos; or they
- are collected together into a shallow excavation, which forms
- the nest. Out of the four nests which I saw, three contained
- twenty-two eggs each, and the fourth twenty-seven.
- In one day's hunting on horseback sixty-four eggs were
- found; forty-four of these were in two nests, and the remaining
- twenty, scattered huachos. The Gauchos unanimously
- affirm, and there is no reason to doubt their statement,
- that the male bird alone hatches the eggs, and for
- some time afterwards accompanies the young. The cock
- when on the nest lies very close; I have myself almost
- ridden over one. It is asserted that at such times they
- are occasionally fierce, and even dangerous, and that they
- have been known to attack a man on horseback, trying to
- kick and leap on him. My informer pointed out to me an old
- man, whom he had seen much terrified by one chasing him. I
- observe in Burchell's travels in South Africa, that he remarks,
- "Having killed a male ostrich, and the feathers being
- dirty, it was said by the Hottentots to be a nest bird." I
- understand that the male emu in the Zoological Gardens
- takes charge of the nest: this habit, therefore, is common
- to the family.
-
- The Gauchos unanimously affirm that several females
- lay in one nest. I have been positively told that four or
- five hen birds have been watched to go in the middle of the
- day, one after the other, to the same nest. I may add, also,
- that it is believed in Africa, that two or more females lay
- in one nest. [13] Although this habit at first appears very
- strange, I think the cause may be explained in a simple
- manner. The number of eggs in the nest varies from twenty
- to forty, and even to fifty; and according to Azara, some
- times to seventy or eighty. Now, although it is most probable,
- from the number of eggs found in one district being
- so extraordinarily great in proportion to the parent birds,
- and likewise from the state of the ovarium of the hen, that
- she may in the course of the season lay a large number, yet
- the time required must be very long. Azara states, [14] that a
- female in a state of domestication laid seventeen eggs, each
- at the interval of three days one from another. If the hen
- was obliged to hatch her own eggs, before the last was laid
- the first probably would be addled; but if each laid a few
- eggs at successive periods, in different nests, and several
- hens, as is stated to be the case, combined together, then
- the eggs in one collection would be nearly of the same age.
- If the number of eggs in one of these nests is, as I believe,
- not greater on an average than the number laid by one
- female in the season, then there must be as many nests as
- females, and each cock bird will have its fair share of the
- labour of incubation; and that during a period when the
- females probably could not sit, from not having finished
- laying. [15] I have before mentioned the great numbers of
- huachos, or deserted eggs; so that in one day's hunting
- twenty were found in this state. It appears odd that so
- many should be wasted. Does it not arise from the difficulty
- of several females associating together, and finding a male
- ready to undertake the office of incubation? It is evident
- that there must at first be some degree of association between
- at least two females; otherwise the eggs would remain
- scattered over the wide plain, at distances far too great to
- allow of the male collecting them into one nest: some authors
- have believed that the scattered eggs were deposited
- for the young birds to feed on. This can hardly be the case
- in America, because the huachos, although often found
- addled and putrid, are generally whole.
-
- When at the Rio Negro in Northern Patagonia, I repeatedly
- heard the Gauchos talking of a very rare bird which
- they called Avestruz Petise. They described it as being less
- than the common ostrich (which is there abundant), but
- with a very close general resemblance. They said its colour
- was dark and mottled, and that its legs were shorter, and
- feathered lower down than those of the common ostrich.
- It is more easily caught by the bolas than the other species.
- The few inhabitants who had seen both kinds, affirmed they
- could distinguish them apart from a long distance. The
- eggs of the small species appeared, however, more generally
- known; and it was remarked, with surprise, that they were
- very little less than those of the Rhea, but of a slightly
- different form, and with a tinge of pale blue. This species occurs
- most rarely on the plains bordering the Rio Negro; but about
- a degree and a half further south they are tolerably abundant.
- When at Port Desire, in Patagonia (lat. 48 degs.), Mr.
- Martens shot an ostrich; and I looked at it, forgetting at
- the moment, in the most unaccountable manner, the whole
- subject of the Petises, and thought it was a not full-grown
- bird of the common sort. It was cooked and eaten before
- my memory returned. Fortunately the head, neck, legs,
- wings, many of the larger feathers, and a large part of the
- skin, had been preserved; and from these a very nearly perfect
- specimen has been put together, and is now exhibited
- in the museum of the Zoological Society. Mr. Gould, in
- describing this new species, has done me the honour of
- calling it after my name.
-
- Among the Patagonian Indians in the Strait of Magellan,
- we found a half Indian, who had lived some years with
- the tribe, but had been born in the northern provinces. I
- asked him if he had ever heard of the Avestruz Petise? He
- answered by saying, " Why, there are none others in these
- southern countries." He informed me that the number of
- eggs in the nest of the petise is considerably less than in that
- of the other kind, namely, not more than fifteen on an average,
- but he asserted that more than one female deposited
- them. At Santa Cruz we saw several of these birds. They
- were excessively wary: I think they could see a person
- approaching when too far off to be distinguished themselves.
- In ascending the river few were seen; but in our quiet and
- rapid descent, many, in pairs and by fours or fives, were
- observed. It was remarked that this bird did not expand
- its wings, when first starting at full speed, after the manner
- of the northern kind. In conclusion I may observe, that
- the Struthio rhea inhabits the country of La Plata as far
- as a little south of the Rio Negro in lat. 41 degs., and that
- the Struthio Darwinii takes its place in Southern Patagonia;
- the part about the Rio Negro being neutral territory. M.
- A. d'Orbigny, [16] when at the Rio Negro, made great exertions
- to procure this bird, but never had the good fortune to
- succeed. Dobrizhoffer [17] long ago was aware of there being
- two kinds of ostriches, he says, "You must know, moreover,
- that Emus differ in size and habits in different tracts
- of land; for those that inhabit the plains of Buenos Ayres
- and Tucuman are larger, and have black, white and grey
- feathers; those near to the Strait of Magellan are smaller
- and more beautiful, for their white feathers are tipped with
- black at the extremity, and their black ones in like manner
- terminate in white."
-
- A very singular little bird, Tinochorus rumicivorus, is
- here common: in its habits and general appearance, it nearly
- equally partakes of the characters, different as they are, of
- the quail and snipe. The Tinochorus is found in the whole
- of southern South America, wherever there are sterile plains,
- or open dry pasture land. It frequents in pairs or small
- flocks the most desolate places, where scarcely another living
- creature can exist. Upon being approached they squat close,
- and then are very difficult to be distinguished from the
- ground. When feeding they walk rather slowly, with their
- legs wide apart. They dust themselves in roads and sandy
- places, and frequent particular spots, where they may be
- found day after day: like partridges, they take wing in a
- flock. In all these respects, in the muscular gizzard adapted
- for vegetable food, in the arched beak and fleshy nostrils,
- short legs and form of foot, the Tinochorus has a close affinity
- with quails. But as soon as the bird is seen flying, its
- whole appearance changes; the long pointed wings, so different
- from those in the gallinaceous order, the irregular
- manner of flight, and plaintive cry uttered at the moment
- of rising, recall the idea of a snipe. The sportsmen of the
- Beagle unanimously called it the short-billed snipe. To this
- genus, or rather to the family of the Waders, its skeleton
- shows that it is really related.
-
- The Tinochorus is closely related to some other South
- American birds. Two species of the genus Attagis are in
- almost every respect ptarmigans in their habits; one lives
- in Tierra del Fuego, above the limits of the forest land; and
- the other just beneath the snow-line on the Cordillera of
- Central Chile. A bird of another closely allied genus, Chionis
- alba, is an inhabitant of the antarctic regions; it feeds
- on sea-weed and shells on the tidal rocks. Although not
- web footed, from some unaccountable habit, it is frequently
- met with far out at sea. This small family of birds is one
- of those which, from its varied relations to other families,
- although at present offering only difficulties to the systematic
- naturalist, ultimately may assist in revealing the
- grand scheme, common to the present and past ages, on
- which organized beings have been created.
-
- The genus Furnarius contains several species, all small
- birds, living on the ground, and inhabiting open dry countries.
- In structure they cannot be compared to any European
- form. Ornithologists have generally included them
- among the creepers, although opposed to that family in every
- habit. The best known species is the common oven-bird of
- La Plata, the Casara or housemaker of the Spaniards. The
- nest, whence it takes its name, is placed in the most exposed
- situations, as on the top of a post, a bare rock, or on
- a cactus. It is composed of mud and bits of straw, and has
- strong thick walls: in shape it precisely resembles an oven,
- or depressed beehive. The opening is large and arched,
- and directly in front, within the nest, there is a partition,
- which reaches nearly to the roof, thus forming a passage
- or antechamber to the true nest.
-
- Another and smaller species of Furnarius (F. cunicularius),
- resembles the oven-bird in the general reddish tint
- of its plumage, in a peculiar shrill reiterated cry, and in an
- odd manner of running by starts. From its affinity, the
- Spaniards call it Casarita (or little housebuilder), although
- its nidification is quite different. The Casarita builds its
- nest at the bottom of a narrow cylindrical hole, which is
- said to extend horizontally to nearly six feet under ground.
- Several of the country people told me, that when boys, they
- had attempted to dig out the nest, but had scarcely ever
- succeeded in getting to the end of the passage. The bird
- chooses any low bank of firm sandy soil by the side of a
- road or stream. Here (at Bahia Blanca) the walls round
- the houses are built of hardened mud, and I noticed that
- one, which enclosed a courtyard where I lodged, was bored
- through by round holes in a score of places. On asking the
- owner the cause of this he bitterly complained of the little
- casarita, several of which I afterwards observed at work.
- It is rather curious to find how incapable these birds must
- be of acquiring any notion of thickness, for although they
- were constantly flitting over the low wall, they continued
- vainly to bore through it, thinking it an excellent bank for
- their nests. I do not doubt that each bird, as often as it
- came to daylight on the opposite side, was greatly surprised
- at the marvellous fact.
-
- I have already mentioned nearly all the mammalia common
- in this country. Of armadilloes three species occur
- namely, the Dasypus minutus or _pichy_, the D. villosus or
- _peludo_, and the _apar_. The first extends ten degrees further
- south than any other kind; a fourth species, the _Mulita_,
- does not come as far south as Bahia Blanca. The four species
- have nearly similar habits; the _peludo_, however, is nocturnal,
- while the others wander by day over the open plains,
- feeding on beetles, larvae, roots, and even small snakes. The
- _apar_, commonly called _mataco_, is remarkable by having only
- three moveable bands; the rest of its tesselated covering
- being nearly inflexible. It has the power of rolling itself
- into a perfect sphere, like one kind of English woodlouse.
- In this state it is safe from the attack of dogs; for the dog
- not being able to take the whole in its mouth, tries to bite
- one side, and the ball slips away. The smooth hard covering
- of the _mataco_ offers a better defence than the sharp
- spines of the hedgehog. The _pichy_ prefers a very dry soil;
- and the sand-dunes near the coast, where for many months
- it can never taste water, is its favourite resort: it often tries
- to escape notice, by squatting close to the ground. In the
- course of a day's ride, near Bahia Blanca, several were generally
- met with. The instant one was perceived, it was
- necessary, in order to catch it, almost to tumble off one's
- horse; for in soft soil the animal burrowed so quickly, that
- its hinder quarters would almost disappear before one could
- alight. It seems almost a pity to kill such nice little animals,
- for as a Gaucho said, while sharpening his knife on
- the back of one, "Son tan mansos" (they are so quiet).
-
- Of reptiles there are many kinds: one snake (a Trigonocephalus,
- or Cophias [18]), from the size of the poison channel
- in its fangs, must be very deadly. Cuvier, in opposition to
- some other naturalists, makes this a sub-genus of the rattlesnake,
- and intermediate between it and the viper. In confirmation
- of this opinion, I observed a fact, which appears
- to me very curious and instructive, as showing how every
- character, even though it may be in some degree independent
- of structure, has a tendency to vary by slow degrees.
- The extremity of the tail of this snake is terminated by a
- point, which is very slightly enlarged; and as the animal
- glides along, it constantly vibrates the last inch; and this
- part striking against the dry grass and brushwood, produces
- a rattling noise, which can be distinctly heard at the distance
- of six feet. As often as the animal was irritated or
- surprised, its tail was shaken; and the vibrations were extremely
- rapid. Even as long as the body retained its irritability,
- a tendency to this habitual movement was evident.
- This Trigonocephalus has, therefore, in some respects the
- structure of a viper, with the habits of a rattlesnake: the
- noise, however, being produced by a simpler device. The
- expression of this snake's face was hideous and fierce; the
- pupil consisted of a vertical slit in a mottled and coppery
- iris; the jaws were broad at the base, and the nose terminated
- in a triangular projection. I do not think I ever saw
- anything more ugly, excepting, perhaps, some of the vampire
- bats. I imagine this repulsive aspect originates from
- the features being placed in positions, with respect to each
- other, somewhat proportional to those of the human face;
- and thus we obtain a scale of hideousness.
-
- Amongst the Batrachian reptiles, I found only one little
- toad (Phryniscus nigricans), which was most singular from
- its colour. If we imagine, first, that it had been steeped in
- the blackest ink, and then, when dry, allowed to crawl over
- a board, freshly painted with the brightest vermilion, so
- as to colour the soles of its feet and parts of its stomach, a
- good idea of its appearance will be gained. If it had been
- an unnamed species, surely it ought to have been called
- _Diabolicus_, for it is a fit toad to preach in the ear of Eve.
- Instead of being nocturnal in its habits, as other toads are,
- and living in damp obscure recesses, it crawls during the heat
- of the day about the dry sand-hillocks and arid plains, where
- not a single drop of water can be found. It must necessarily
- depend on the dew for its moisture; and this probably is
- absorbed by the skin, for it is known, that these reptiles possess
- great powers of cutaneous absorption. At Maldonado,
- I found one in a situation nearly as dry as at Bahia Blanca,
- and thinking to give it a great treat, carried it to a pool of
- water; not only was the little animal unable to swim, but
- I think without help it would soon have been drowned.
- Of lizards there were many kinds, but only one (Proctotretus
- multimaculatus) remarkable from its habits. It
- lives on the bare sand near the sea coast, and from its mottled
- colour, the brownish scales being speckled with white,
- yellowish red, and dirty blue, can hardly be distinguished
- from the surrounding surface. When frightened, it attempts
- to avoid discovery by feigning death, with outstretched
- legs, depressed body, and closed eyes: if further
- molested, it buries itself with great quickness in the loose
- sand. This lizard, from its flattened body and short legs,
- cannot run quickly.
-
- I will here add a few remarks on the hybernation of animals
- in this part of South America. When we first arrived
- at Bahia Blanca, September 7th, 1832, we thought nature
- had granted scarcely a living creature to this sandy and dry
- country. By digging, however, in the ground, several insects,
- large spiders, and lizards were found in a half-torpid
- state. On the 15th, a few animals began to appear, and by
- the 18th (three days from the equinox), everything announced
- the commencement of spring. The plains were ornamented
- by the flowers of a pink wood-sorrel, wild peas,
- cenotherae, and geraniums; and the birds began to lay their
- eggs. Numerous Lamellicorn and Heteromerous insects, the
- latter remarkable for their deeply sculptured bodies, were
- slowly crawling about; while the lizard tribe, the constant
- inhabitants of a sandy soil, darted about in every direction.
- During the first eleven days, whilst nature was dormant, the
- mean temperature taken from observations made every two
- hours on board the Beagle, was 51 degs.; and in the middle of
- the day the thermometer seldom ranged above 55 degs. On the
- eleven succeeding days, in which all living things became so
- animated, the mean was 58 degs., and the range in the middle
- of the day 7 between 60 and 70 degs. Here, then, an
- increase of seven degrees in mean temperature, but a greater one
- of extreme heat, was sufficient to awake the functions of life.
- At Monte Video, from which we had just before sailed, in
- the twenty-three days included between the 26th of July
- and the 19th of August, the mean temperature from 276
- observations was 58.4 degs.; the mean hottest day being
- 65.5 degs., and the coldest 46 degs. The lowest point to
- which the thermometer fell was 41.5 degs., and occasionally
- in the middle of the day it rose to 69 or 70 degs.
- Yet with this high temperature, almost every beetle, several
- genera of spiders, snails, and land-shells, toads and
- lizards were all lying torpid beneath stones. But
- we have seen that at Bahia Blanca, which is four degrees
- southward and therefore with a climate only a very little
- colder, this same temperature with a rather less extreme
- heat, was sufficient to awake all orders of animated beings.
- This shows how nicely the stimulus required to arouse hybernating
- animals is governed by the usual climate of the
- district, and not by the absolute heat. It is well known that
- within the tropics, the hybernation, or more properly aestivation,
- of animals is determined not by the temperature, but
- by the times of drought. Near Rio de Janeiro, I was at first
- surprised to observe, that, a few days after some little
- depressions had been filled with water, they were peopled by
- numerous full-grown shells and beetles, which must have
- been lying dormant. Humboldt has related the strange accident
- of a hovel having been erected over a spot where a
- young crocodile lay buried in the hardened mud. He adds,
- "The Indians often find enormous boas, which they call Uji
- or water serpents, in the same lethargic state. To reanimate
- them, they must be irritated or wetted with water."
-
- I will only mention one other animal, a zoophyte (I believe
- Virgularia Patagonica), a kind of sea-pen. It consists
- of a thin, straight, fleshy stem, with alternate rows of polypi
- on each side, and surrounding an elastic stony axis, varying
- in length from eight inches to two feet. The stem at one
- extremity is truncate, but at the other is terminated by a
- vermiform fleshy appendage. The stony axis which gives
- strength to the stem may be traced at this extremity into a
- mere vessel filled with granular matter. At low water hundreds
- of these zoophytes might be seen, projecting like stubble,
- with the truncate end upwards, a few inches above the
- surface of the muddy sand. When touched or pulled they
- suddenly drew themselves in with force, so as nearly or quite
- to disappear. By this action, the highly elastic axis must
- be bent at the lower extremity, where it is naturally slightly
- curved; and I imagine it is by this elasticity alone that the
- zoophyte is enabled to rise again through the mud. Each
- polypus, though closely united to its brethren, has a distinct
- mouth, body, and tentacula. Of these polypi, in a large
- specimen, there must be many thousands; yet we see that
- they act by one movement: they have also one central axis
- connected with a system of obscure circulation, and the ova
- are produced in an organ distinct from the separate
- individuals. [19] Well may one be allowed to ask, what is an
- individual? It is always interesting to discover the foundation
- of the strange tales of the old voyagers; and I have no doubt
- but that the habits of this Virgularia explain one such case.
- Captain Lancaster, in his voyage [20] in 1601, narrates that on
- the sea-sands of the Island of Sombrero, in the East Indies,
- he "found a small twig growing up like a young tree, and
- on offering to pluck it up it shrinks down to the ground,
- and sinks, unless held very hard. On being plucked up, a
- great worm is found to be its root, and as the tree groweth
- in greatness, so doth the worm diminish, and as soon as the
- worm is entirely turned into a tree it rooteth in the earth,
- and so becomes great. This transformation is one of the
- strangest wonders that I saw in all my travels: for if this
- tree is plucked up, while young, and the leaves and bark
- stripped off, it becomes a hard stone when dry, much like
- white coral: thus is this worm twice transformed into
- different natures. Of these we gathered and brought home
- many."
-
-
- During my stay at Bahia Blanca, while waiting for the
- Beagle, the place was in a constant state of excitement, from
- rumours of wars and victories, between the troops of Rosas
- and the wild Indians. One day an account came that a small
- party forming one of the postas on the line to Buenos Ayres,
- had been found all murdered. The next day three hundred
- men arrived from the Colorado, under the command of Commandant
- Miranda. A large portion of these men were Indians
- (mansos, or tame), belonging to the tribe of the Cacique
- Bernantio. They passed the night here; and it was
- impossible to conceive anything more wild and savage than
- the scene of their bivouac. Some drank till they were
- intoxicated; others swallowed the steaming blood of the
- cattle slaughtered for their suppers, and then, being sick
- from drunkenness, they cast it up again, and were besmeared
- with filth and gore.
-
- Nam simul expletus dapibus, vinoque sepultus
- Cervicem inflexam posuit, jacuitque per antrum
- Immensus, saniem eructans, ac frusta cruenta
- Per somnum commixta mero.
-
- In the morning they started for the scene of the murder,
- with orders to follow the "rastro," or track, even if it led
- them to Chile. We subsequently heard that the wild Indians
- had escaped into the great Pampas, and from some
- cause the track had been missed. One glance at the rastro
- tells these people a whole history. Supposing they examine
- the track of a thousand horses, they will soon guess the number
- of mounted ones by seeing how many have cantered; by
- the depth of the other impressions, whether any horses were
- loaded with cargoes; by the irregularity of the footsteps,
- how far tired; by the manner in which the food has been
- cooked, whether the pursued travelled in haste; by the general
- appearance, how long it has been since they passed.
- They consider a rastro of ten days or a fortnight, quite
- recent enough to be hunted out. We also heard that Miranda
- struck from the west end of the Sierra Ventana, in a direct
- line to the island of Cholechel, situated seventy leagues up
- the Rio Negro. This is a distance of between two and three
- hundred miles, through a country completely unknown.
- What other troops in the world are so independent? With
- the sun for their guide, mare's flesh for food, their saddle-
- cloths for beds, -- as long as there is a little water, these
- men would penetrate to the end of the world.
-
- A few days afterwards I saw another troop of these banditti-like
- soldiers start on an expedition against a tribe of
- Indians at the small Salinas, who had been betrayed by a
- prisoner cacique. The Spaniard who brought the orders
- for this expedition was a very intelligent man. He gave
- me an account of the last engagement at which he was present.
- Some Indians, who had been taken prisoners, gave
- information of a tribe living north of the Colorado. Two
- hundred soldiers were sent; and they first discovered the
- Indians by a cloud of dust from their horses' feet, as they
- chanced to be travelling. The country was mountainous and
- wild, and it must have been far in the interior, for the
- Cordillera were in sight. The Indians, men, women, and children,
- were about one hundred and ten in number, and they
- were nearly all taken or killed, for the soldiers sabre every
- man. The Indians are now so terrified that they offer no
- resistance in a body, but each flies, neglecting even his wife
- and children; but when overtaken, like wild animals, they
- fight against any number to the last moment. One dying Indian
- seized with his teeth the thumb of his adversary, and
- allowed his own eye to be forced out sooner than relinquish
- his hold. Another, who was wounded, feigned death, keeping
- a knife ready to strike one more fatal blow. My informer
- said, when he was pursuing an Indian, the man cried out
- for mercy, at the same time that he was covertly loosing the
- bolas from his waist, meaning to whirl it round his head and
- so strike his pursuer. "I however struck him with my sabre
- to the ground, and then got off my horse, and cut his throat
- with my knife." This is a dark picture; but how much more
- shocking is the unquestionable fact, that all the women who
- appear above twenty years old are massacred in cold blood!
- When I exclaimed that this appeared rather inhuman, he
- answered, "Why, what can be done? they breed so!"
-
- Every one here is fully convinced that this is the most
- just war, because it is against barbarians. Who would
- believe in this age that such atrocities could be committed in
- a Christian civilized country? The children of the Indians
- are saved, to be sold or given away as servants, or rather
- slaves for as long a time as the owners can make them
- believe themselves slaves; but I believe in their treatment
- there is little to complain of.
-
- In the battle four men ran away together. They were
- pursued, one was killed, and the other three were taken alive.
- They turned out to be messengers or ambassadors from a
- large body of Indians, united in the common cause of
- defence, near the Cordillera. The tribe to which they had
- been sent was on the point of holding a grand council, the
- feast of mare's flesh was ready, and the dance prepared: in
- the morning the ambassadors were to have returned to the
- Cordillera. They were remarkably fine men, very fair, above
- six feet high, and all under thirty years of age. The three
- survivors of course possessed very valuable information and
- to extort this they were placed in a line. The two first being
- questioned, answered, "No se" (I do not know), and were
- one after the other shot. The third also said " No se;" adding,
- "Fire, I am a man, and can die!" Not one syllable
- would they breathe to injure the united cause of their country!
- The conduct of the above-mentioned cacique was very
- different; he saved his life by betraying the intended plan
- of warfare, and the point of union in the Andes. It was
- believed that there were already six or seven hundred Indians
- together, and that in summer their numbers would be
- doubled. Ambassadors were to have been sent to the Indians
- at the small Salinas, near Bahia Blanca, whom I have mentioned
- that this same cacique had betrayed. The communication,
- therefore, between the Indians, extends from the
- Cordillera to the coast of the Atlantic.
-
- General Rosas's plan is to kill all stragglers, and having
- driven the remainder to a common point, to attack them in
- a body, in the summer, with the assistance of the Chilenos.
- This operation is to be repeated for three successive years.
- I imagine the summer is chosen as the time for the main
- attack, because the plains are then without water, and the
- Indians can only travel in particular directions. The escape
- of the Indians to the south of the Rio Negro, where in such
- a vast unknown country they would be safe, is prevented by
- a treaty with the Tehuelches to this effect; -- that Rosas pays
- them so much to slaughter every Indian who passes to the
- south of the river, but if they fail in so doing, they
- themselves are to be exterminated. The war is waged chiefly
- against the Indians near the Cordillera; for many of the
- tribes on this eastern side are fighting with Rosas. The
- general, however, like Lord Chesterfield, thinking that his
- friends may in a future day become his enemies, always
- places them in the front ranks, so that their numbers may
- be thinned. Since leaving South America we have heard
- that this war of extermination completely failed.
-
- Among the captive girls taken in the same engagement,
- there were two very pretty Spanish ones, who had been carried
- away by the Indians when young, and could now only
- speak the Indian tongue. From their account they must
- have come from Salta, a distance in a straight line of nearly
- one thousand miles. This gives one a grand idea of the
- immense territory over which the Indians roam: yet, great
- as it is, I think there will not, in another half-century, be
- a wild Indian northward of the Rio Negro. The warfare
- is too bloody to last; the Christians killing every Indian,
- and the Indians doing the same by the Christians. It is
- melancholy to trace how the Indians have given way before
- the Spanish invaders. Schirdel [21] says that in 1535, when
- Buenos Ayres was founded, there were villages containing
- two and three thousand inhabitants. Even in Falconer's
- time (1750) the Indians made inroads as far as Luxan,
- Areco, and Arrecife, but now they are driven beyond the
- Salado. Not only have whole tribes been exterminated, but
- the remaining Indians have become more barbarous: instead
- of living in large villages, and being employed in the arts of
- fishing, as well as of the chase, they now wander about the
- open plains, without home or fixed occupation.
-
- I heard also some account of an engagement which took
- place, a few weeks previously to the one mentioned, at
- Cholechel. This is a very important station on account of
- being a pass for horses; and it was, in consequence, for
- some time the head-quarters of a division of the army.
- When the troops first arrived there they found a tribe of
- Indians, of whom they killed twenty or thirty. The cacique
- escaped in a manner which astonished every one. The chief
- Indians always have one or two picked horses, which they
- keep ready for any urgent occasion. On one of these, an old
- white horse, the cacique sprung, taking with him his little
- son. The horse had neither saddle nor bridle. To avoid the
- shots, the Indian rode in the peculiar method of his nation
- namely, with an arm round the horse's neck, and one leg
- only on its back. Thus hanging on one side, he was seen
- patting the horse's head, and talking to him. The pursuers
- urged every effort in the chase; the Commandant three
- times changed his horse, but all in vain. The old Indian
- father and his son escaped, and were free. What a fine picture
- one can form in one's mind, -- the naked, bronze-like
- figure of the old man with his little boy, riding like a
- Mazeppa on the white horse, thus leaving far behind him the
- host of his pursuers!
-
- I saw one day a soldier striking fire with a piece of flint,
- which I immediately recognised as having been a part of the
- head of an arrow. He told me it was found near the island
- of Cholechel, and that they are frequently picked up there.
- It was between two and three inches long, and therefore
- twice as large as those now used in Tierra del Fuego: it was
- made of opaque cream-coloured flint, but the point and barbs
- had been intentionally broken off. It is well known that no
- Pampas Indians now use bows and arrows. I believe a small
- tribe in Banda Oriental must be excepted; but they are
- widely separated from the Pampas Indians, and border close
- on those tribes that inhabit the forest, and live on foot. It
- appears, therefore, that these arrow-heads are antiquarian [22]
- relics of the Indians, before the great change in habits
- consequent on the introduction of the horse into South
- America.
-
- [1] Since this was written, M. Alcide d'Orbingy has examined
- these shells, and pronounces them all to be recent.
-
- [2] M. Aug. Bravard has described, in a Spanish work
- ('Observaciones Geologicas,' 1857), this district, and he
- believes that the bones of the extinct mammals were washed
- out of the underlying Pampean deposit, and subsequently became
- embedded with the still existing shells; but I am not convinced
- by his remarks. M. Bravard believes that the whole enormous
- Pampean deposit is a sub-aerial formation, like sand-dunes: this
- seems to me to be an untenable doctrine.
-
- [3] Principles of Geology, vol. iv. p. 40.
-
- [4] This theory was first developed in the Zoology of the
- Voyage of the Beagle, and subsequently in Professor Owen's
- Memoir on Mylodon robustus.
-
- [5] I mean this to exclude the total amount which may have been
- successively produced and consumed during a given period.
-
- [6] Travels in the Interior of South Africa, vol. ii. p. 207
-
- [7] The elephant which was killed at Exeter Change was
- estimated (being partly weighed) at five tons and a half.
- The elephant actress, as I was informed, weighed one ton less;
- so that we may take five as the average of a full-grown
- elephant. I was told at the Surry Gardens, that a hippopotamus
- which was sent to England cut up into pieces was estimated at
- three tons and a half; we will call it three. From these
- premises we may give three tons and a half to each of the five
- rhinoceroses; perhaps a ton to the giraffe, and half to the
- bos caffer as well as to the elan (a large ox weighs from
- 1200 to 1500 pounds). This will give an average (from the above
- estimates) of 2.7 of a ton for the ten largest herbivorous
- animals of Southern Africa. In South America, allowing 1200
- pounds for the two tapirs together, 550 for the guanaco and
- vicuna, 500 for three deer, 300 for the capybara, peccari, and
- a monkey, we shall have an average of 250 pounds, which I
- believe is overstating the result. The ratio will therefore
- be as 6048 to 250, or 24 to 1, for the ten largest animals
- from the two continents.
-
- [8] If we suppose the case of the discovery of a skeleton of
- a Greenland whale in a fossil state, not a single cetaceous
- animal being known to exist, what naturalist would have ventured
- conjecture on the possibility of a carcass so gigantic being
- supported on the minute crustacea and mollusca living in the
- frozen seas of the extreme North?
-
- [9] See Zoological Remarks to Capt. Back's Expedition, by Dr.
- Richardson. He says, "The subsoil north of latitude 56 degs.
- is perpetually frozen, the thaw on the coast not penetrating
- above three feet, and at Bear Lake, in latitude 64 degs., not
- more than twenty inches. The frozen substratum does not of
- itself destroy vegetation, for forests flourish on the surface,
- at a distance from the coast."
-
- [10] See Humboldt, Fragments Asiatiques, p. 386: Barton's
- Geography of Plants: and Malte Brun. In the latter work it is
- said that the limit of the growth of trees in Siberia may be
- drawn under the parallel of 70 degs.
-
- [11] Sturt's Travels, vol. ii. p. 74.
-
- [12] A Gucho assured me that he had once seen a snow-white or
- Albino variety, and that it was a most beautiful bird.
-
- [13] Burchell's Travels, vol. i. p. 280.
-
- [14] Azara, vol. iv. p. 173.
-
- [15] Lichtenstein, however, asserts (Travels, vol. ii. p. 25)
- that the hens begin sitting when they have laid ten or twelve
- eggs; and that they continue laying, I presume, in another
- nest. This appears to me very improbable. He asserts that four
- or five hens associate for incubation with one cock, who sits
- only at night.
-
- [16] When at the Rio Negro, we heard much of the indefatigable
- labours of this naturalist. M. Aleide d'Orbigny, during the
- years 1825 to 1833, traversed several large portions of South
- America, and has made a collection, and is now publishing the
- results on a scale of magnificence, which at once places himself
- in the list of American travellers second only to Humboldt.
-
- [17] Account of the Abipones, A.D. 1749, vol. i. (English
- Translation) p. 314
-
- [18] M. Bibron calls it T. crepitans.
-
-
- [19] The cavities leading from the fleshy compartments of
- the extremity, were filled with a yellow pulpy matter, which,
- examined under a microscope, presented an extraordinary
- appearance. The mass consisted of rounded, semi-transparent,
- irregular grains, aggregated together into particles of
- various sizes. All such particles, and the separate grains,
- possessed the power of rapid movement; generally revolving
- around different axes, but sometimes progressive. The movement
- was visible with a very weak power, but even with the highest
- its cause could not be perceived. It was very different from
- the circulation of the fluid in the elastic bag, containing
- the thin extremity of the axis. On other occasions, when
- dissecting small marine animals beneath the microscope, I have
- seen particles of pulpy matter, some of large size, as soon as
- they were disengaged, commence revolving. I have imagined, I know
- not with how much truth, that this granulo-pulpy matter was in
- process of being converted into ova. Certainly in this zoophyte
- such appeared to be the case.
-
- [20] Kerr's Collection of Voyages, vol. viii. p. 119.
-
- [21] Purchas's Collection of Voyages. I believe the date was
- really 1537.
-
- [22] Azara has even doubted whether the Pampas Indians ever
- used bows.
-
-
-
- CHAPTER VI
-
- BAHIA BLANCA TO BUENOS AYRES
-
- Set out for Buenos Ayres -- Rio Sauce -- Sierra Ventana --
- Third Posta -- Driving Horses -- Bolas -- Partridges and
- Foxes -- Features of the Country -- Long-legged Plover --
- Teru-tero -- Hail-storm -- Natural Enclosures in the Sierra
- Tapalguen -- Flesh of Puma -- Meat Diet -- Guardia del
- Monte -- Effects of Cattle on the Vegetation -- Cardoon --
- Buenos Ayres -- Corral where Cattle are Slaughtered.
-
-
- SEPTEMBER 18th. -- I hired a Gaucho to accompany me
- on my ride to Buenos Ayres, though with some difficulty,
- as the father of one man was afraid to let him
- go, and another, who seemed willing, was described to me
- as so fearful, that I was afraid to take him, for I was told
- that even if he saw an ostrich at a distance, he would mistake
- it for an Indian, and would fly like the wind away.
- The distance to Buenos Ayres is about four hundred miles,
- and nearly the whole way through an uninhabited country.
- We started early in the morning; ascending a few hundred
- feet from the basin of green turf on which Bahia Blanca
- stands, we entered on a wide desolate plain. It consists of
- a crumbling argillaceo-calcareous rock, which, from the dry
- nature of the climate, supports only scattered tufts of withered
- grass, without a single bush or tree to break the monotonous
- uniformity. The weather was fine, but the atmosphere
- remarkably hazy; I thought the appearance foreboded
- a gale, but the Gauchos said it was owing to the plain, at
- some great distance in the interior, being on fire. After a
- long gallop, having changed horses twice, we reached the Rio
- Sauce: it is a deep, rapid, little stream, not above twenty-five
- feet wide. The second posta on the road to Buenos Ayres
- stands on its banks, a little above there is a ford for horses,
- where the water does not reach to the horses' belly; but from
- that point, in its course to the sea, it is quite impassable,
- and hence makes a most useful barrier against the Indians.
-
- Insignificant as this stream is, the Jesuit Falconer, whose
- information is generally so very correct, figures it as a
- considerable river, rising at the foot of the Cordillera. With
- respect to its source, I do not doubt that this is the case
- for the Gauchos assured me, that in the middle of the dry
- summer, this stream, at the same time with the Colorado
- has periodical floods; which can only originate in the snow
- melting on the Andes. It is extremely improbable that a
- stream so small as the Sauce then was, should traverse the
- entire width of the continent; and indeed, if it were the
- residue of a large river, its waters, as in other ascertained
- cases, would be saline. During the winter we must look to
- the springs round the Sierra Ventana as the source of its
- pure and limpid stream. I suspect the plains of Patagonia
- like those of Australia, are traversed by many water-courses
- which only perform their proper parts at certain periods.
- Probably this is the case with the water which flows into the
- head of Port Desire, and likewise with the Rio Chupat, on
- the banks of which masses of highly cellular scoriae were
- found by the officers employed in the survey.
-
- As it was early in the afternoon when we arrived, we
- took fresh horses, and a soldier for a guide, and started for
- the Sierra de la Ventana. This mountain is visible from
- the anchorage at Bahia Blanca; and Capt. Fitz Roy calculates
- its height to be 3340 feet -- an altitude very remarkable
- on this eastern side of the continent. I am not aware
- that any foreigner, previous to my visit, had ascended this
- mountain; and indeed very few of the soldiers at Bahia
- Blanca knew anything about it. Hence we heard of beds
- of coal, of gold and silver, of caves, and of forests, all of
- which inflamed my curiosity, only to disappoint it. The
- distance from the posta was about six leagues over a level
- plain of the same character as before. The ride was, however,
- interesting, as the mountain began to show its true
- form. When we reached the foot of the main ridge, we had
- much difficulty in finding any water, and we thought we
- should have been obliged to have passed the night without
- any. At last we discovered some by looking close to the
- mountain, for at the distance even of a few hundred yards
- the streamlets were buried and entirely lost in the friable
- calcareous stone and loose detritus. I do not think Nature
- ever made a more solitary, desolate pile of rock; -- it well
- deserves its name of _Hurtado_, or separated. The mountain
- is steep, extremely rugged, and broken, and so entirely destitute
- of trees, and even bushes, that we actually could not
- make a skewer to stretch out our meat over the fire of thistle-
- stalks. [1] The strange aspect of this mountain is contrasted
- by the sea-like plain, which not only abuts against its steep
- sides, but likewise separates the parallel ranges. The uniformity
- of the colouring gives an extreme quietness to the
- view, -- the whitish grey of the quartz rock, and the light
- brown of the withered grass of the plain, being unrelieved
- by any brighter tint. From custom, one expects to see in
- the neighbourhood of a lofty and bold mountain, a broken
- country strewed over with huge fragments. Here nature
- shows that the last movement before the bed of the sea is
- changed into dry land may sometimes be one of tranquillity.
- Under these circumstances I was curious to observe how
- far from the parent rock any pebbles could be found. On
- the shores of Bahia Blanca, and near the settlement, there
- were some of quartz, which certainly must have come from
- this source: the distance is forty-five miles.
-
- The dew, which in the early part of the night wetted the
- saddle-cloths under which we slept, was in the morning
- frozen. The plain, though appearing horizontal, had insensibly
- sloped up to a height of between 800 and 900 feet
- above the sea. In the morning (9th of September) the guide
- told me to ascend the nearest ridge, which he thought would
- lead me to the four peaks that crown the summit. The climbing
- up such rough rocks was very fatiguing; the sides
- were so indented, that what was gained in one five minutes
- was often lost in the next. At last, when I reached the ridge,
- my disappointment was extreme in finding a precipitous
- valley as deep as the plain, which cut the chain transversely
- in two, and separated me from the four points. This valley
- is very narrow, but flat-bottomed, and it forms a fine horse-
- pass for the Indians, as it connects the plains on the northern
- and southern sides of the range. Having descended, and
- while crossing it, I saw two horses grazing: I immediately
- hid myself in the long grass, and began to reconnoitre; but
- as I could see no signs of Indians I proceeded cautiously on
- my second ascent. It was late in the day, and this part of
- the mountain, like the other, was steep and rugged. I was
- on the top of the second peak by two o'clock, but got there
- with extreme difficulty; every twenty yards I had the cramp
- in the upper part of both thighs, so that I was afraid I
- should not have been able to have got down again. It was
- also necessary to return by another road, as it was out of
- the question to pass over the saddle-back. I was therefore
- obliged to give up the two higher peaks. Their altitude was
- but little greater, and every purpose of geology had been
- answered; so that the attempt was not worth the hazard
- of any further exertion. I presume the cause of the cramp
- was the great change in the kind of muscular action, from
- that of hard riding to that of still harder climbing. It is
- a lesson worth. remembering, as in some cases it might cause
- much difficulty.
-
- I have already said the mountain is composed of white
- quartz rock, and with it a little glossy clay-slate is
- associated. At the height of a few hundred feet above the plain
- patches of conglomerate adhered in several places to the
- solid rock. They resembled in hardness, and in the nature
- of the cement, the masses which may be seen daily forming
- on some coasts. I do not doubt these pebbles were in a similar
- manner aggregated, at a period when the great calcareous
- formation was depositing beneath the surrounding sea.
- We may believe that the jagged and battered forms of the
- hard quartz yet show the effects of the waves of an open
- ocean.
-
- I was, on the whole, disappointed with this ascent. Even
- the view was insignificant; -- a plain like the sea, but without
- its beautiful colour and defined outline. The scene, however,
- was novel, and a little danger, like salt to meat, gave
- it a relish. That the danger was very little was certain, for
- my two companions made a good fire -- a thing which is never
- done when it is suspected that Indians are near. I reached
- the place of our bivouac by sunset, and drinking much mate,
- and smoking several cigaritos, soon made up my bed for the
- night. The wind was very strong and cold, but I never slept
- more comfortably.
-
- September 10th. -- In the morning, having fairly scudded
- before the gale, we arrived by the middle of the day at the
- Sauce posta. In the road we saw great numbers of deer,
- and near the mountain a guanaco. The plain, which abuts
- against the Sierra, is traversed by some curious gullies, of
- which one was about twenty feet wide, and at least thirty
- deep; we were obliged in consequence to make a considerable
- circuit before we could find a pass. We stayed the night
- at the posta, the conversation, as was generally the case,
- being about the Indians. The Sierra Ventana was formerly
- a great place of resort; and three or four years ago there
- was much fighting there. My guide had been present when
- many Indians were killed: the women escaped to the top of
- the ridge, and fought most desperately with great stones;
- many thus saving themselves.
-
- September 11th. -- Proceeded to the third posta in company
- with the lieutenant who commanded it. The distance
- is called fifteen leagues; but it is only guess-work, and is
- generally overstated. The road was uninteresting, over a
- dry grassy plain; and on our left hand at a greater or less
- distance there were some low hills; a continuation of which
- we crossed close to the posta. Before our arrival we met
- a large herd of cattle and horses, guarded by fifteen soldiers;
- but we were told many had been lost. It is very difficult to
- drive animals across the plains; for if in the night a puma,
- or even a fox, approaches, nothing can prevent the horses
- dispersing in every direction; and a storm will have the
- same effect. A short time since, an officer left Buenos Ayres
- with five hundred horses, and when he arrived at the army
- he had under twenty.
-
- Soon afterwards we perceived by the cloud of dust, that
- a party of horsemen were coming towards us; when far distant
- my companions knew them to be Indians, by their long
- hair streaming behind their backs. The Indians generally
- have a fillet round their heads, but never any covering; and
- their black hair blowing across their swarthy faces, heightens
- to an uncommon degree the wildness of their appearance.
- They turned out to be a party of Bernantio's friendly tribe,
- going to a salina for salt. The Indians eat much salt, their
- children sucking it like sugar. This habit is very different
- from that of the Spanish Gauchos, who, leading the same
- kind of life, eat scarcely any; according to Mungo Park, [2]
- it is people who live on vegetable food who have an unconquerable
- desire for salt. The Indians gave us good-humoured
- nods as they passed at full gallop, driving before them a
- troop of horses, and followed by a train of lanky dogs.
-
- September 12th and 13th. -- I stayed at this posta two days,
- waiting for a troop of soldiers, which General Rosas had
- the kindness to send to inform me, would shortly travel to
- Buenos Ayres; and he advised me to take the opportunity
- of the escort. In the morning we rode to some neighbouring
- hills to view the country, and to examine the geology. After
- dinner the soldiers divided themselves into two parties for
- a trial of skill with the bolas. Two spears were stuck in
- the ground twenty-five yards apart, but they were struck
- and entangled only once in four or five times. The balls can
- be thrown fifty or sixty yards, but with little certainty.
- This, however, does not apply to a man on horseback; for when
- the speed of the horse is added to the force of the arm, it
- is said, that they can be whirled with effect to the distance
- of eighty yards. As a proof of their force, I may mention,
- that at the Falkland Islands, when the Spaniards murdered
- some of their own countrymen and all the Englishmen, a
- young friendly Spaniard was running away, when a great
- tall man, by name Luciano, came at full gallop after him,
- shouting to him to stop, and saying that he only wanted to
- speak to him. Just as the Spaniard was on the point of
- reaching the boat, Luciano threw the balls: they struck him
- on the legs with such a jerk, as to throw him down and
- to render him for some time insensible. The man, after
- Luciano had had his talk, was allowed to escape. He told
- us that his legs were marked by great weals, where the thong
- had wound round, as if he had been flogged with a whip.
- In the middle of the day two men arrived, who brought a
- parcel from the next posta to be forwarded to the general:
- so that besides these two, our party consisted this evening
- of my guide and self, the lieutenant, and his four soldiers.
- The latter were strange beings; the first a fine young negro;
- the second half Indian and negro; and the two others non-
- descripts; namely, an old Chilian miner, the colour of mahogany,
- and another partly a mulatto; but two such mongrels
- with such detestable expressions, I never saw before.
- At night, when they were sitting round the fire, and playing
- at cards, I retired to view such a Salvator Rosa scene. They
- were seated under a low cliff, so that I could look down
- upon them; around the party were lying dogs, arms, remnants
- of deer and ostriches; and their long spears were stuck
- in the turf. Further in the dark background, their horses
- were tied up, ready for any sudden danger. If the stillness
- of the desolate plain was broken by one of the dogs barking,
- a soldier, leaving the fire, would place his head close to the
- ground, and thus slowly scan the horizon. Even if the noisy
- teru-tero uttered its scream, there would be a pause in the
- conversation, and every head, for a moment, a little inclined.
-
- What a life of misery these men appear to us to lead!
- They were at least ten leagues from the Sauce posta, and
- since the murder committed by the Indians, twenty from
- another. The Indians are supposed to have made their attack
- in the middle of the night; for very early in the morning
- after the murder, they were luckily seen approaching
- this posta. The whole party here, however, escaped, together
- with the troop of horses; each one taking a line for himself,
- and driving with him as many animals as he was able to
- manage.
-
- The little hovel, built of thistle-stalks, in which they slept,
- neither kept out the wind nor rain; indeed in the latter case
- the only effect the roof had, was to condense it into larger
- drops. They had nothing to eat excepting what they could
- catch, such as ostriches, deer, armadilloes, etc., and their
- only fuel was the dry stalks of a small plant, somewhat
- resembling an aloe. The sole luxury which these men enjoyed
- was smoking the little paper cigars, and sucking mate. I
- used to think that the carrion vultures, man's constant
- attendants on these dreary plains, while seated on the little
- neighbouring cliffs seemed by their very patience to say,
- "Ah! when the Indians come we shall have a feast."
-
- In the morning we all sallied forth to hunt, and although
- we had not much success, there were some animated chases.
- Soon after starting the party separated, and so arranged
- their plans, that at a certain time of the day (in guessing
- which they show much skill) they should all meet from different
- points of the compass on a plain piece of ground,
- and thus drive together the wild animals. One day I went
- out hunting at Bahia Blanca, but the men there merely rode
- in a crescent, each being about a quarter of a mile apart
- from the other. A fine male ostrich being turned by the
- headmost riders, tried to escape on one side. The Gauchos
- pursued at a reckless pace, twisting their horses about with
- the most admirable command, and each man whirling the
- balls round his head. At length the foremost threw them,
- revolving through the air: in an instant the ostrich rolled
- over and over, its legs fairly lashed together by the thong.
- The plains abound with three kinds of partridge, [3] two
- of which are as large as hen pheasants. Their destroyer,
- a small and pretty fox, was also singularly numerous; in
- the course of the day we could not have seen less than forty
- or fifty. They were generally near their earths, but the dogs
- killed one. When we returned to the posta, we found two
- of the party returned who had been hunting by themselves.
- They had killed a puma, and had found an ostrich's nest with
- twenty-seven eggs in it. Each of these is said to equal in
- weight eleven hen's eggs; so that we obtained from this one
- nest as much food as 297 hen's eggs would have given.
-
- September 14th. -- As the soldiers belonging to the next
- posta meant to return, and we should together make a party
- of five, and all armed, I determined not to wait for the expected
- troops. My host, the lieutenant, pressed me much
- to stop. As he had been very obliging -- not only providing
- me with food, but lending me his private horses -- I wanted
- to make him some remuneration. I asked my guide whether
- I might do so, but he told me certainly not; that the only
- answer I should receive, probably would be, "We have meat
- for the dogs in our country, and therefore do not grudge it
- to a Christian." It must not be supposed that the rank of
- lieutenant in such an army would at all prevent the acceptance
- of payment: it was only the high sense of hospitality,
- which every traveller is bound to acknowledge as nearly universal
- throughout these provinces. After galloping some
- leagues, we came to a low swampy country, which extends
- for nearly eighty miles northward, as far as the Sierra
- Tapalguen. In some parts there were fine damp plains, covered
- with grass, while others had a soft, black, and peaty soil.
- There were also many extensive but shallow lakes, and large
- beds of reeds. The country on the whole resembled the better
- parts of the Cambridgeshire fens. At night we had some
- difficulty in finding amidst the swamps, a dry place for our
- bivouac.
-
- September 15th. -- Rose very early in the morning and
- shortly after passed the posta where the Indians had murdered
- the five soldiers. The officer had eighteen chuzo
- wounds in his body. By the middle of the day, after a hard
- gallop, we reached the fifth posta: on account of some difficulty
- in procuring horses we stayed there the night. As this
- point was the most exposed on the whole line, twenty-one
- soldiers were stationed here; at sunset they returned from
- hunting, bringing with them seven deer, three ostriches, and
- many armadilloes and partridges. When riding through the
- country, it is a common practice to set fire to the plain;
- and hence at night, as on this occasion, the horizon was
- illuminated in several places by brilliant conflagrations.
- This is done partly for the sake of puzzling any stray Indians,
- but chiefly for improving the pasture. In grassy
- plains unoccupied by the larger ruminating quadrupeds, it
- seems necessary to remove the superfluous vegetation by fire,
- so as to render the new year's growth serviceable.
-
- The rancho at this place did not boast even of a roof,
- but merely consisted of a ring of thistle-stalks, to break
- the force of the wind. It was situated on the borders of an
- extensive but shallow lake, swarming with wild fowl, among
- which the black-necked swan was conspicuous.
-
- The kind of plover, which appears as if mounted on
- stilts (Himantopus nigricollis), is here common in flocks of
- considerable size. It has been wrongfully accused of inelegance;
- when wading about in shallow water, which is its
- favourite resort, its gait is far from awkward. These birds
- in a flock utter a noise, that singularly resembles the cry of
- a pack of small dogs in full chase: waking in the night, I
- have more than once been for a moment startled at the distant
- sound. The teru-tero (Vanellus cayanus) is another
- bird, which often disturbs the stillness of the night. In
- appearance and habits it resembles in many respects our peewits;
- its wings, however, are armed with sharp spurs, like
- those on the legs of the common cock. As our peewit takes
- its name from the sound of its voice, so does the teru-tero.
- While riding over the grassy plains, one is constantly pursued
- by these birds, which appear to hate mankind, and I
- am sure deserve to be hated for their never-ceasing, unvaried,
- harsh screams. To the sportsman they are most annoying,
- by telling every other bird and animal of his approach: to
- the traveller in the country, they may possibly, as Molina
- says, do good, by warning him of the midnight robber. During
- the breeding season, they attempt, like our peewits, by
- feigning to be wounded, to draw away from their nests dogs
- and other enemies. The eggs of this bird are esteemed a
- great delicacy.
-
- September 16th. -- To the seventh posta at the foot of the
- Sierra Tapalguen. The country was quite level, with a
- coarse herbage and a soft peaty soil. The hovel was here
- remarkably neat, the posts and rafters being made of about
- a dozen dry thistle-stalks bound together with thongs of
- hide; and by the support of these Ionic-like columns, the
- roof and sides were thatched with reeds. We were here told
- a fact, which I would not have credited, if I had not had
- partly ocular proof of it; namely, that, during the previous
- night hail as large as small apples, and extremely hard, had
- fallen with such violence, as to kill the greater number of the
- wild animals. One of the men had already found thirteen
- deer (Cervus campestris) lying dead, and I saw their _fresh_
- hides; another of the party, a few minutes after my arrival
- brought in seven more. Now I well know, that one man
- without dogs could hardly have killed seven deer in a week.
- The men believed they had seen about fifteen ostriches (part
- of one of which we had for dinner); and they said that
- several were running about evidently blind in one eye.
- Numbers of smaller birds, as ducks, hawks, and partridges,
- were killed. I saw one of the latter with a black mark on
- its back, as if it had been struck with a paving-stone. A
- fence of thistle-stalks round the hovel was nearly broken
- down, and my informer, putting his head out to see what was
- the matter, received a severe cut, and now wore a bandage.
- The storm was said to have been of limited extent: we
- certainly saw from our last night's bivouac a dense cloud
- and lightning in this direction. It is marvellous how such
- strong animals as deer could thus have been killed; but I
- have no doubt, from the evidence I have given, that the
- story is not in the least exaggerated. I am glad, however,
- to have its credibility supported by the Jesuit Dobrizhoffen, [4]
- who, speaking of a country much to the northward, says,
- hail fell of an enormous size and killed vast numbers of cattle:
- the Indians hence called the place _Lalegraicavalca_, meaning
- "the little white things." Dr. Malcolmson, also, informs me
- that he witnessed in 1831 in India, a hail-storm, which
- killed numbers of large birds and much injured the cattle.
- These hailstones were flat, and one was ten inches in
- circumference, and another weighed two ounces. They
- ploughed up a gravel-walk like musket-balls, and passed
- through glass-windows, making round holes, but not cracking
- them.
-
- Having finished our dinner, of hail-stricken meat, we
- crossed the Sierra Tapalguen; a low range of hills, a few
- hundred feet in height, which commences at Cape Corrientes.
- The rock in this part is pure quartz; further eastward I
- understand it is granitic. The hills are of a remarkable
- form; they consist of flat patches of table-land, surrounded
- by low perpendicular cliffs, like the outliers of a sedimentary
- deposit. The hill which I ascended was very small, not
- above a couple of hundred yards in diameter; but I saw
- others larger. One which goes by the name of the "Corral,"
- is said to be two or three miles in diameter, and encompassed
- by perpendicular cliffs, between thirty and forty feet high,
- excepting at one spot, where the entrance lies. Falconer [5]
- gives a curious account of the Indians driving troops of
- wild horses into it, and then by guarding the entrance, keeping
- them secure. I have never heard of any other instance
- of table-land in a formation of quartz, and which, in the
- hill I examined, had neither cleavage nor stratification. I
- was told that the rock of the "Corral" was white, and would
- strike fire.
-
- We did not reach the posta on the Rio Tapalguen till
- after it was dark. At supper, from something which was
- said, I was suddenly struck with horror at thinking that I
- was eating one of the favourite dishes of the country
- namely, a half-formed calf, long before its proper time of
- birth. It turned out to be Puma; the meat is very white
- and remarkably like veal in taste. Dr. Shaw was laughed
- at for stating that "the flesh of the lion is in great esteem
- having no small affinity with veal, both in colour, taste,
- and flavour." Such certainly is the case with the Puma.
- The Gauchos differ in their opinion, whether the Jaguar is
- good eating, but are unanimous in saying that cat is excellent.
-
- September 17th. -- We followed the course of the Rio
- Tapalguen, through a very fertile country, to the ninth
- posta. Tapalguen, itself, or the town of Tapalguen, if it
- may be so called, consists of a perfectly level plain, studded
- over, as far as the eye can reach, with the toldos or
- oven-shaped huts of the Indians. The families of the friendly
- Indians, who were fighting on the side of Rosas, resided
- here. We met and passed many young Indian women, riding
- by two or three together on the same horse: they, as
- well as many of the young men, were strikingly handsome, --
- their fine ruddy complexions being the picture of health.
- Besides the toldos, there were three ranchos; one inhabited
- by the Commandant, and the two others by Spaniards with
- small shops.
-
- We were here able to buy some biscuit. I had now been
- several days without tasting anything besides meat: I did
- not at all dislike this new regimen; but I felt as if it would
- only have agreed with me with hard exercise. I have heard
- that patients in England, when desired to confine themselves
- exclusively to an animal diet, even with the hope of life
- before their eyes, have hardly been able to endure it. Yet
- the Gaucho in the Pampas, for months together, touches
- nothing but beef. But they eat, I observe, a very large
- proportion of fat, which is of a less animalized nature; and
- they particularly dislike dry meat, such as that of the Agouti.
- Dr. Richardson [6] also, has remarked, "that when people
- have fed for a long time solely upon lean animal food, the
- desire for fat becomes so insatiable, that they can consume
- a large quantity of unmixed and even oily fat without
- nausea:" this appears to me a curious physiological fact.
- It is, perhaps, from their meat regimen that the Gauchos,
- like other carnivorous animals, can abstain long from food.
- I was told that at Tandeel, some troops voluntarily pursued
- a party of Indians for three days, without eating or drinking.
-
- We saw in the shops many articles, such as horsecloths,
- belts, and garters, woven by the Indian women. The patterns
- were very pretty, and the colours brilliant; the workmanship
- of the garters was so good that an English merchant
- at Buenos Ayres maintained they must have been
- manufactured in England, till he found the tassels had been
- fastened by split sinew.
-
- September 18th. -- We had a very long ride this day. At
- the twelfth posta, which is seven leagues south of the Rio
- Salado, we came to the first estancia with cattle and white
- women. Afterwards we had to ride for many miles through
- a country flooded with water above our horses' knees. By
- crossing the stirrups, and riding Arab-like with our legs
- bent up, we contrived to keep tolerably dry. It was nearly
- dark when we arrived at the Salado; the stream was deep,
- and about forty yards wide; in summer, however, its bed
- becomes almost dry, and the little remaining water nearly
- as salt as that of the sea. We slept at one of the great
- estancias of General Rosas. It was fortified, and of such an
- extent, that arriving in the dark I thought it was a town
- and fortress. In the morning we saw immense herds of
- cattle, the general here having seventy-four square leagues
- of land. Formerly nearly three hundred men were employed
- about this estate, and they defied all the attacks of
- the Indians.
-
- September 19th. -- Passed the Guardia del Monte. This
- is a nice scattered little town, with many gardens, full of
- peach and quince trees. The plain here looked like that
- around Buenos Ayres; the turf being short and bright green,
- with beds of clover and thistles, and with bizcacha holes.
- I was very much struck with the marked change in the
- aspect of the country after having crossed the Salado. From
- a coarse herbage we passed on to a carpet of fine green verdure.
- I at first attributed this to some change in the nature
- of the soil, but the inhabitants assured me that here, as
- well as in Banda Oriental, where there is as great a difference
- between the country round Monte Video and the
- thinly-inhabited savannahs of Colonia, the whole was to be
- attributed to the manuring and grazing of the cattle. Exactly
- the same fact has been observed in the prairies [7] of
- North America, where coarse grass, between five and six
- feet high, when grazed by cattle, changes into common pasture
- land. I am not botanist enough to say whether the
- change here is owing to the introduction of new species,
- to the altered growth of the same, or to a difference in their
- proportional numbers. Azara has also observed with astonishment
- this change: he is likewise much perplexed by the
- immediate appearance of plants not occurring in the neighbourhood,
- on the borders of any track that leads to a newly-
- constructed hovel. In another part he says, [8] "ces chevaux
- (sauvages) ont la manie de preferer les chemins, et le bord
- des routes pour deposer leurs excremens, dont on trouve des
- monceaux dans ces endroits." Does this not partly explain
- the circumstance? We thus have lines of richly manured
- land serving as channels of communication across wide districts.
-
- Near the Guardia we find the southern limit of two European
- plants, now become extraordinarily common. The
- fennel in great profusion covers the ditch-banks in the
- neighbourhood of Buenos Ayres, Monte Video, and other towns.
- But the cardoon (Cynara cardunculus) has a far wider
- range: [9] it occurs in these latitudes on both sides of the,
- Cordillera, across the continent. I saw it in unfrequented
- spots in Chile, Entre Rios, and Banda Oriental. In the
- latter country alone, very many (probably several hundred)
- square miles are covered by one mass of these prickly plants,
- and are impenetrable by man or beast. Over the undulating
- plains, where these great beds occur, nothing else can now
- live. Before their introduction, however, the surface must
- have supported, as in other parts, a rank herbage. I doubt
- whether any case is on record of an invasion on so grand
- a scale of one plant over the aborigines. As I have already
- said, I nowhere saw the cardoon south of the Salado; but
- it is probable that in proportion as that country becomes
- inhabited, the cardoon will extend its limits. The case is
- different with the giant thistle (with variegated leaves) of
- the Pampas, for I met with it in the valley of the Sauce.
- According to the principles so well laid down by Mr. Lyell,
- few countries have undergone more remarkable changes,
- since the year 1535, when the first colonist of La Plata landed
- with seventy-two horses. The countless herds of horses,
- cattle, and sheep, not only have altered the whole aspect of
- the vegetation, but they have almost banished the guanaco,
- deer and ostrich. Numberless other changes must likewise
- have taken place; the wild pig in some parts probably replaces
- the peccari; packs of wild dogs may be heard howling
- on the wooded banks of the less-frequented streams; and
- the common cat, altered into a large and fierce animal, inhabits
- rocky hills. As M. d'Orbigny has remarked, the increase
- in numbers of the carrion-vulture, since the introduction
- of the domestic animals, must have been infinitely great;
- and we have given reasons for believing that they have extended
- their southern range. No doubt many plants, besides
- the cardoon and fennel, are naturalized; thus the islands
- near the mouth of the Parana, are thickly clothed with
- peach and orange trees, springing from seeds carried there
- by the waters of the river.
-
- While changing horses at the Guardia several people questioned
- us much about the army, -- I never saw anything like
- the enthusiasm for Rosas, and for the success of the "most
- just of all wars, because against barbarians." This expression,
- it must be confessed, is very natural, for till lately,
- neither man, woman nor horse, was safe from the attacks
- of the Indians. We had a long day's ride over the same
- rich green plain, abounding with various flocks, and with
- here and there a solitary estancia, and its one _ombu_ tree.
- In the evening it rained heavily: on arriving at a posthouse
- we were told by the owner, that if we had not a
- regular passport we must pass on, for there were so
- many robbers he would trust no one. When he read, however,
- my passport, which began with "El Naturalista Don
- Carlos," his respect and civility were as unbounded as his
- suspicions had been before. What a naturalist might be,
- neither he nor his countrymen, I suspect, had any idea;
- but probably my title lost nothing of its value from that
- cause.
-
- September 20th. -- We arrived by the middle of the day at
- Buenos Ayres. The outskirts of the city looked quite pretty,
- with the agave hedges, and groves of olive, peach and willow
- trees, all just throwing out their fresh green leaves. I rode
- to the house of Mr. Lumb, an English merchant, to whose
- kindness and hospitality, during my stay in the country, I
- was greatly indebted.
-
- The city of Buenos Ayres is large; [10] and I should think
- one of the most regular in the world. Every street is at right
- angles to the one it crosses, and the parallel ones being
- equidistant, the houses are collected into solid squares of
- equal dimensions, which are called quadras. On the other hand,
- the houses themselves are hollow squares; all the rooms opening
- into a neat little courtyard. They are generally only
- one story high, with flat roofs, which are fitted with seats
- and are much frequented by the inhabitants in summer. In
- the centre of the town is the Plaza, where the public offices,
- fortress, cathedral, etc., stand. Here also, the old viceroys,
- before the revolution, had their palaces. The general assemblage
- of buildings possesses considerable architectural beauty,
- although none individually can boast of any.
-
- The great _corral_, where the animals are kept for slaughter
- to supply food to this beef-eating population, is one of
- the spectacles best worth seeing. The strength of the horse
- as compared to that of the bullock is quite astonishing: a
- man on horseback having thrown his lazo round the horns
- of a beast, can drag it anywhere he chooses. The animal
- ploughing up the ground with outstretched legs, in vain
- efforts to resist the force, generally dashes at full speed to
- one side; but the horse immediately turning to receive the
- shock, stands so firmly that the bullock is almost thrown
- down, and it is surprising that their necks are not broken.
- The struggle is not, however, one of fair strength; the
- horse's girth being matched against the bullock's extended
- neck. In a similar manner a man can hold the wildest horse,
- if caught with the lazo, just behind the ears. When the
- bullock has been dragged to the spot where it is to be
- slaughtered, the matador with great caution cuts the hamstrings.
- Then is given the death bellow; a noise more expressive
- of fierce agony than any I know. I have often distinguished
- it from a long distance, and have always known
- that the struggle was then drawing to a close. The whole
- sight is horrible and revolting: the ground is almost made of
- bones; and the horses and riders are drenched with gore.
-
- [1] I call these thistle-stalks for the want of a more correct
- name. I believe it is a species of Eryngium.
-
- [2] Travels in Africa, p. 233.
-
- [3] Two species of Tinamus and Eudromia elegans of A. d'Orbigny,
- which can only be called a partridge with regard to its habits.
-
- [4] History of the Abipones, vol. ii. p. 6.
-
- [5] Falconer's Patagonia, p. 70.
-
- [6] Fauna Boreali-Americana, vol. i. p. 35.
-
- [7] See Mr. Atwater's account of the Prairies, in Silliman's
- N. A. Journal, vol. i. p. 117.
-
- [8] Azara's Voyages, vol. i. p. 373.
-
- [9] M. A. d'Orbigny (vol. i. p. 474) says that the cardoon
- and artichoke are both found wild. Dr. Hooker (Botanical
- Magazine, vol. lv. p. 2862), has described a variety of the
- Cynara from this part of South America under the name of
- inermis. He states that botanists are now generally agreed
- that the cardoon and the artichoke are varieties of one plant.
- I may add, that an intelligent farmer assured me that he had
- observed in a deserted garden some artichokes changing into
- the common cardoon. Dr. Hooker believes that Head's vivid
- description of the thistle of the Pampas applies to the
- cardoon, but this is a mistake. Captain Head referred to the
- plant, which I have mentioned a few lines lower down, under
- the title of giant thistle. Whether it is a true thistle I do
- not know; but it is quite different from the cardoon; and more
- like a thistle properly so called.
-
- [10] It is said to contain 60,000 inhabitants. Monte Video, the
- second town of importance on the banks of the Plata, has
- 15,000.
-
-
-
- CHAPTER VII
-
- BUENOS AYRES AND ST. FE
-
- Excursion to St. Fe -- Thistle Beds -- Habits of the Bizcacha --
- Little Owl -- Saline Streams -- Level Plain -- Mastodon -- St.
- Fe -- Change in Landscape -- Geology -- Tooth of extinct
- Horse -- Relation of the Fossil and recent Quadrupeds of North
- and South America -- Effects of a great Drought -- Parana --
- Habits of the Jaguar -- Scissor-beak -- Kingfisher, Parrot,
- and Scissor-tail -- Revolution -- Buenos Ayres State of
- Government.
-
-
- SEPTEMBER 27th. -- In the evening I set out on an
- excursion to St. Fe, which is situated nearly three hundred
- English miles from Buenos Ayres, on the banks of
- the Parana. The roads in the neighbourhood of the city after
- the rainy weather, were extraordinarily bad. I should never
- have thought it possible for a bullock waggon to have
- crawled along: as it was, they scarcely went at the rate of a
- mile an hour, and a man was kept ahead, to survey the best
- line for making the attempt. The bullocks were terribly
- jaded: it is a great mistake to suppose that with improved
- roads, and an accelerated rate of travelling, the sufferings of
- the animals increase in the same proportion. We passed a
- train of waggons and a troop of beasts on their road to
- Mendoza. The distance is about 580 geographical miles, and
- the journey is generally performed in fifty days. These
- waggons are very long, narrow, and thatched with reeds;
- they have only two wheels, the diameter of which in some
- cases is as much as ten feet. Each is drawn by six bullocks,
- which are urged on by a goad at least twenty feet long: this
- is suspended from within the roof; for the wheel bullocks a
- smaller one is kept; and for the intermediate pair, a point
- projects at right angles from the middle of the long one.
-
- The whole apparatus looked like some implement of war.
-
- September 28th. -- We passed the small town of Luxan
- where there is a wooden bridge over the river -- a most
- unusual convenience in this country. We passed also Areco.
- The plains appeared level, but were not so in fact; for in
- various places the horizon was distant. The estancias are
- here wide apart; for there is little good pasture, owing to
- the land being covered by beds either of an acrid clover,
- or of the great thistle. The latter, well known from the
- animated description given by Sir F. Head, were at this
- time of the year two-thirds grown; in some parts they were
- as high as the horse's back, but in others they had not yet
- sprung up, and the ground was bare and dusty as on a turnpike-
- road. The clumps were of the most brilliant green, and
- they made a pleasing miniature-likeness of broken forest
- land. When the thistles are full grown, the great beds are
- impenetrable, except by a few tracts, as intricate as those
- in a labyrinth. These are only known to the robbers, who
- at this season inhabit them, and sally forth at night to rob
- and cut throats with impunity. Upon asking at a house
- whether robbers were numerous, I was answered, "The thistles
- are not up yet;" -- the meaning of which reply was not at
- first very obvious. There is little interest in passing over
- these tracts, for they are inhabited by few animals or birds,
- excepting the bizcacha and its friend the little owl.
-
- The bizcacha [1] is well known to form a prominent feature
- in the zoology of the Pampas. It is found as far south as
- the Rio Negro, in lat. 41 degs., but not beyond. It cannot,
- like the agouti, subsist on the gravelly and desert plains of
- Patagonia, but prefers a clayey or sandy soil, which produces a
- different and more abundant vegetation. Near Mendoza, at
- the foot of the Cordillera, it occurs in close neighbourhood
- with the allied alpine species. It is a very curious
- circumstance in its geographical distribution, that it has never
- been seen, fortunately for the inhabitants of Banda Oriental, to
- the eastward of the river Uruguay: yet in this province there
- are plains which appear admirably adapted to its habits.
- The Uruguay has formed an insuperable obstacle to its
- migration: although the broader barrier of the Parana has
- been passed, and the bizcacha is common in Entre Rios, the
- province between these two great rivers. Near Buenos Ayres
- these animals are exceedingly common. Their most favourite
- resort appears to be those parts of the plain which during
- one-half of the year are covered with giant thistles, to the
- exclusion of other plants. The Gauchos affirm that it lives
- on roots; which, from the great strength of its gnawing
- teeth, and the kind of places frequented by it, seems probable.
- In the evening the bizcachas come out in numbers, and quietly
- sit at the mouths of their burrows on their haunches. At
- such times they are very tame, and a man on horseback passing
- by seems only to present an object for their grave
- contemplation. They run very awkwardly, and when running
- out of danger, from their elevated tails and short front legs
- much resemble great rats. Their flesh, when cooked, is very
- white and good, but it is seldom used.
-
- The bizcacha has one very singular habit; namely, dragging
- every hard object to the mouth of its burrow: around
- each group of holes many bones of cattle, stones, thistle-
- stalks, hard lumps of earth, dry dung, etc., are collected into
- an irregular heap, which frequently amounts to as much as
- a wheelbarrow would contain. I was credibly informed that
- a gentleman, when riding on a dark night, dropped his
- watch; he returned in the morning, and by searching the
- neighbourhood of every bizcacha hole on the line of road,
- as he expected, he soon found it. This habit of picking
- up whatever may be lying on the ground anywhere near its
- habitation, must cost much trouble. For what purpose it
- is done, I am quite unable to form even the most remote
- conjecture: it cannot be for defence, because the rubbish
- is chiefly placed above the mouth of the burrow, which
- enters the ground at a very small inclination. No doubt
- there must exist some good reason; but the inhabitants of
- the country are quite ignorant of it. The only fact which
- I know analogous to it, is the habit of that extraordinary
- Australian bird, the Calodera maculata, which makes an
- elegant vaulted passage of twigs for playing in, and
- which collects near the spot, land and sea-shells, bones
- and the feathers of birds, especially brightly coloured
- ones. Mr. Gould, who has described these facts, informs
- me, that the natives, when they lose any hard object,
- search the playing passages, and he has known a tobacco-
- pipe thus recovered.
-
- The little owl (Athene cunicularia), which has been so
- often mentioned, on the plains of Buenos Ayres exclusively
- inhabits the holes of the bizcacha; but in Banda Oriental it
- is its own workman. During the open day, but more especially
- in the evening, these birds may be seen in every direction
- standing frequently by pairs on the hillock near their
- burrows. If disturbed they either enter the hole, or, uttering
- a shrill harsh cry, move with a remarkably undulatory
- flight to a short distance, and then turning round, steadily
- gaze at their pursuer. Occasionally in the evening they may
- be heard hooting. I found in the stomachs of two which
- I opened the remains of mice, and I one day saw a small
- snake killed and carried away. It is said that snakes are
- their common prey during the daytime. I may here mention,
- as showing on what various kinds of food owls subsist,
- that a species killed among the islets of the Chonos
- Archipelago, had its stomach full of good-sized crabs. In
- India [2] there is a fishing genus of owls, which likewise
- catches crabs.
-
- In the evening we crossed the Rio Arrecife on a simple
- raft made of barrels lashed together, and slept at the post-
- house on the other side. I this day paid horse-hire for
- thirty-one leagues; and although the sun was glaring hot I
- was but little fatigued. When Captain Head talks of riding
- fifty leagues a day, I do not imagine the distance is equal
- to 150 English miles. At all events, the thirty-one leagues
- was only 76 miles in a straight line, and in an open country
- I should think four additional miles for turnings would be
- a sufficient allowance.
-
- 29th and 30th. -- We continued to ride over plains of the
- same character. At San Nicolas I first saw the noble river
- of the Parana. At the foot of the cliff on which the town
- stands, some large vessels were at anchor. Before arriving
- at Rozario, we crossed the Saladillo, a stream of fine clear
- running water, but too saline to drink. Rozario is a large
- town built on a dead level plain, which forms a cliff about
- sixty feet high over the Parana. The river here is very
- broad, with many islands, which are low and wooded, as is
- also the opposite shore. The view would resemble that of a
- great lake, if it were not for the linear-shaped islets, which
- alone give the idea of running water. The cliffs are the most
- picturesque part; sometimes they are absolutely perpendicular,
- and of a red colour; at other times in large broken
- masses, covered with cacti and mimosa-trees. The real
- grandeur, however, of an immense river like this, is derived
- from reflecting how important a means of communication
- and commerce it forms between one nation and another; to
- what a distance it travels, and from how vast a territory
- it drains the great body of fresh water which flows past
- your feet.
-
- For many leagues north and south of San Nicolas and
- Rozario, the country is really level. Scarcely anything which
- travellers have written about its extreme flatness, can be
- considered as exaggeration. Yet I could never find a spot
- where, by slowly turning round, objects were not seen at
- greater distances in some directions than in others; and
- this manifestly proves inequality in the plain. At sea, a
- person's eye being six feet above the surface of the water,
- his horizon is two miles and four-fifths distant. In like
- manner, the more level the plain, the more nearly does the
- horizon approach within these narrow limits; and this, in
- my opinion, entirely destroys that grandeur which one would
- have imagined that a vast level plain would have possessed.
-
- October 1st. - We started by moonlight and arrived at the
- Rio Tercero by sunrise. The river is also called the Saladillo,
- and it deserves the name, for the water is brackish.
- I stayed here the greater part of the day, searching for fossil
- bones. Besides a perfect tooth of the Toxodon, and many
- scattered bones, I found two immense skeletons near each
- other, projecting in bold relief from the perpendicular cliff
- of the Parana. They were, however, so completely decayed,
- that I could only bring away small fragments of one of the
- great molar teeth; but these are sufficient to show that the
- remains belonged to a Mastodon, probably to the same species
- with that, which formerly must have inhabited the Cordillera
- in Upper Peru in such great numbers. The men
- who took me in the canoe, said they had long known of these
- skeletons, and had often wondered how they had got there:
- the necessity of a theory being felt, they came to the
- conclusion that, like the bizcacha, the mastodon was formerly
- a burrowing animal! In the evening we rode another stage,
- and crossed the Monge, another brackish stream, bearing the
- dregs of the washings of the Pampas.
-
- October 2nd. -- We passed through Corunda, which, from
- the luxuriance of its gardens, was one of the prettiest
- villages I saw. From this point to St. Fe the road is not very
- safe. The western side of the Parana northward, ceases to
- be inhabited; and hence the Indians sometimes come down
- thus far, and waylay travellers. The nature of the country
- also favours this, for instead of a grassy plain, there is an
- open woodland, composed of low prickly mimosas. We
- passed some houses that had been ransacked and since deserted;
- we saw also a spectacle, which my guides viewed
- with high satisfaction; it was the skeleton of an Indian
- with the dried skin hanging on the bones, suspended to the
- branch of a tree.
-
- In the morning we arrived at St. Fe. I was surprised
- to observe how great a change of climate a difference of only
- three degrees of latitude between this place and Buenos
- Ayres had caused. This was evident from the dress and
- complexion of the men -- from the increased size of the
- ombu-trees -- the number of new cacti and other plants --
- and especially from the birds. In the course of an hour I
- remarked half-a-dozen birds, which I had never seen at
- Buenos Ayres. Considering that there is no natural boundary
- between the two places, and that the character of the
- country is nearly similar, the difference was much greater
- than I should have expected.
-
- October 3rd and 4th. -- I was confined for these two days
- to my bed by a headache. A good-natured old woman,
- who attended me, wished me to try many odd remedies. A
- common practice is, to bind an orange-leaf or a bit of black
- plaster to each temple: and a still more general plan is, to
- split a bean into halves, moisten them, and place one on
- each temple, where they will easily adhere. It is not thought
- proper ever to remove the beans or plaster, but to allow
- them to drop off, and sometimes, if a man, with patches on
- his head, is asked, what is the matter? he will answer, "I
- had a headache the day before yesterday." Many of the
- remedies used by the people of the country are ludicrously
- strange, but too disgusting to be mentioned. One of the
- least nasty is to kill and cut open two puppies and bind
- them on each side of a broken limb. Little hairless dogs are
- in great request to sleep at the feet of invalids.
-
- St. Fe is a quiet little town, and is kept clean and in good
- order. The governor, Lopez, was a common soldier at the
- time of the revolution; but has now been seventeen years
- in power. This stability of government is owing to his
- tyrannical habits; for tyranny seems as yet better adapted
- to these countries than republicanism. The governor's favourite
- occupation is hunting Indians: a short time since
- he slaughtered forty-eight, and sold the children at the rate
- of three or four pounds apiece.
-
- October 5th. -- We crossed the Parana to St. Fe Bajada,
- a town on the opposite shore. The passage took some hours,
- as the river here consisted of a labyrinth of small streams,
- separated by low wooded islands. I had a letter of introduction
- to an old Catalonian Spaniard, who treated me with
- the most uncommon hospitality. The Bajada is the capital
- of Entre Rios. In 1825 the town contained 6000 inhabitants,
- and the province 30,000; yet, few as the inhabitants are, no
- province has suffered more from bloody and desperate
- revolutions. They boast here of representatives, ministers, a
- standing army, and governors: so it is no wonder that they
- have their revolutions. At some future day this must be
- one of the richest countries of La Plata. The soil is varied
- and productive; and its almost insular form gives it two
- grand lines of communication by the rivers Parana and
- Uruguay.
-
-
- I was delayed here five days, and employed myself in examining
- the geology of the surrounding country, which was
- very interesting. We here see at the bottom of the cliffs,
- beds containing sharks' teeth and sea-shells of extinct species,
- passing above into an indurated marl, and from that
- into the red clayey earth of the Pampas, with its calcareous
- concretions and the bones of terrestrial quadrupeds. This
- vertical section clearly tells us of a large bay of pure salt-
- water, gradually encroached on, and at last converted into
- the bed of a muddy estuary, into which floating carcasses
- were swept. At Punta Gorda, in Banda Oriental, I found
- an alternation of the Pampaean estuary deposit, with a
- limestone containing some of the same extinct sea-shells; and
- this shows either a change in the former currents, or more
- probably an oscillation of level in the bottom of the ancient
- estuary. Until lately, my reasons for considering the Pampaean
- formation to be an estuary deposit were, its general
- appearance, its position at the mouth of the existing great
- river the Plata, and the presence of so many bones of
- terrestrial quadrupeds: but now Professor Ehrenberg has had
- the kindness to examine for me a little of the red earth,
- taken from low down in the deposit, close to the skeletons
- of the mastodon, and he finds in it many infusoria, partly
- salt-water and partly fresh-water forms, with the latter
- rather preponderating; and therefore, as he remarks, the
- water must have been brackish. M. A. d'Orbigny found on
- the banks of the Parana, at the height of a hundred feet,
- great beds of an estuary shell, now living a hundred miles
- lower down nearer the sea; and I found similar shells at a
- less height on the banks of the Uruguay; this shows that
- just before the Pampas was slowly elevated into dry land,
- the water covering it was brackish. Below Buenos Ayres
- there are upraised beds of sea-shells of existing species,
- which also proves that the period of elevation of the Pampas
- was within the recent period.
-
- In the Pampaean deposit at the Bajada I found the osseous
- armour of a gigantic armadillo-like animal, the inside
- of which, when the earth was removed, was like a great
- cauldron; I found also teeth of the Toxodon and Mastodon,
- and one tooth of a Horse, in the same stained and decayed
- state. This latter tooth greatly interested me, [3] and I took
- scrupulous care in ascertaining that it had been embedded
- contemporaneously with the other remains; for I was not
- then aware that amongst the fossils from Bahia Blanca
- there was a horse's tooth hidden in the matrix: nor was it
- then known with certainty that the remains of horses are
- common in North America. Mr. Lyell has lately brought
- from the United States a tooth of a horse; and it is an
- interesting fact, that Professor Owen could find in no species,
- either fossil or recent, a slight but peculiar curvature
- characterizing it, until he thought of comparing it with my
- specimen found here: he has named this American horse Equus
- curvidens. Certainly it is a marvellous fact in the history
- of the Mammalia, that in South America a native horse
- should have lived and disappeared, to be succeeded in after-
- ages by the countless herds descended from the few introduced
- with the Spanish colonists!
-
- The existence in South America of a fossil horse, of the
- mastodon, possibly of an elephant, [4] and of a hollow-horned
- ruminant, discovered by MM. Lund and Clausen in the
- caves of Brazil, are highly interesting facts with respect to
- the geographical distribution of animals. At the present
- time, if we divide America, not by the Isthmus of Panama,
- but by the southern part of Mexico [5] in lat. 20 degs., where
- the great table-land presents an obstacle to the migration of
- species, by affecting the climate, and by forming, with the
- exception of some valleys and of a fringe of low land on
- the coast, a broad barrier; we shall then have the two
- zoological provinces of North and South America strongly
- contrasted with each other. Some few species alone have
- passed the barrier, and may be considered as wanderers from
- the south, such as the puma, opossum, kinkajou, and peccari.
- South America is characterized by possessing many peculiar
- gnawers, a family of monkeys, the llama, peccari, tapir,
- opossums, and, especially, several genera of Edentata, the
- order which includes the sloths, ant-eaters, and armadilloes.
- North America, on the other hand, is characterized (putting
- on one side a few wandering species) by numerous peculiar
- gnawers, and by four genera (the ox, sheep, goat, and antelope)
- of hollow-horned ruminants, of which great division
- South America is not known to possess a single species.
- Formerly, but within the period when most of the now existing
- shells were living, North America possessed, besides
- hollow-horned ruminants, the elephant, mastodon, horse, and
- three genera of Edentata, namely, the Megatherium, Megalonyx,
- and Mylodon. Within nearly this same period (as
- proved by the shells at Bahia Blanca) South America possessed,
- as we have just seen, a mastodon, horse, hollow-
- horned ruminant, and the same three genera (as well as
- several others) of the Edentata. Hence it is evident that
- North and South America, in having within a late geological
- period these several genera in common, were much
- more closely related in the character of their terrestrial
- inhabitants than they now are. The more I reflect on this
- case, the more interesting it appears: I know of no other
- instance where we can almost mark the period and manner
- of the splitting up of one great region into two well-
- characterized zoological provinces. The geologist, who is fully
- impressed with the vast oscillations of level which have
- affected the earth's crust within late periods, will not fear
- to speculate on the recent elevation of the Mexican platform,
- or, more probably, on the recent submergence of land
- in the West Indian Archipelago, as the cause of the present
- zoological separation of North and South America. The
- South American character of the West Indian mammals [6]
- seems to indicate that this archipelago was formerly united
- to the southern continent, and that it has subsequently been
- an area of subsidence.
-
- When America, and especially North America, possessed
- its elephants, mastodons, horse, and hollow-horned ruminants,
- it was much more closely related in its zoological
- characters to the temperate parts of Europe and Asia than
- it now is. As the remains of these genera are found on
- both sides of Behring's Straits [7] and on the plains of
- Siberia, we are led to look to the north-western side of North
- America as the former point of communication between the Old
- and so-called New World. And as so many species, both
- living and extinct, of these same genera inhabit and have
- inhabited the Old World, it seems most probable that the
- North American elephants, mastodons, horse, and hollow-
- horned ruminants migrated, on land since submerged near
- Behring's Straits, from Siberia into North America, and
- thence, on land since submerged in the West Indies, into
- South America, where for a time they mingled with the
- forms characteristic of that southern continent, and have
- since become extinct.
-
-
- While travelling through the country, I received several
- vivid descriptions of the effects of a late great drought; and
- the account of this may throw some light on the cases where
- vast numbers of animals of all kinds have been embedded
- together. The period included between the years 1827 and
- 1830 is called the "gran seco," or the great drought. During
- this time so little rain fell, that the vegetation, even to the
- thistles, failed; the brooks were dried up, and the whole
- country assumed the appearance of a dusty high road. This
- was especially the case in the northern part of the province
- of Buenos Ayres and the southern part of St. Fe. Very
- great numbers of birds, wild animals, cattle, and horses
- perished from the want of food and water. A man told me
- that the deer [8] used to come into his courtyard to the well,
- which he had been obliged to dig to supply his own family
- with water; and that the partridges had hardly strength to
- fly away when pursued. The lowest estimation of the loss
- of cattle in the province of Buenos Ayres alone, was taken
- at one million head. A proprietor at San Pedro had previously
- to these years 20,000 cattle; at the end not one remained.
- San Pedro is situated in the middle of the finest
- country; and even now abounds again with animals; yet
- during the latter part of the "gran seco," live cattle were
- brought in vessels for the consumption of the inhabitants.
- The animals roamed from their estancias, and, wandering
- far southward, were mingled together in such multitudes,
- that a government commission was sent from Buenos Ayres
- to settle the disputes of the owners. Sir Woodbine Parish
- informed me of another and very curious source of dispute;
- the ground being so long dry, such quantities of dust were
- blown about, that in this open country the landmarks became
- obliterated, and people could not tell the limits of their
- estates.
-
- I was informed by an eye-witness that the cattle in herds
- of thousands rushed into the Parana, and being exhausted
- by hunger they were unable to crawl up the muddy banks,
- and thus were drowned. The arm of the river which runs
- by San Pedro was so full of putrid carcasses, that the master
- of a vessel told me that the smell rendered it quite impassable.
- Without doubt several hundred thousand animals
- thus perished in the river: their bodies when putrid were
- seen floating down the stream; and many in all probability
- were deposited in the estuary of the Plata. All the small
- rivers became highly saline, and this caused the death of
- vast numbers in particular spots; for when an animal drinks
- of such water it does not recover. Azara describes [9] the
- fury of the wild horses on a similar occasion, rushing into
- the marshes, those which arrived first being overwhelmed
- and crushed by those which followed. He adds that more
- than once he has seen the carcasses of upwards of a thousand
- wild horses thus destroyed. I noticed that the smaller
- streams in the Pampas were paved with a breccia of bones
- but this probably is the effect of a gradual increase, rather
- than of the destruction at any one period. Subsequently
- to the drought of 1827 to 1832, a very rainy season followed
- which caused great floods. Hence it is almost certain that
- some thousands of the skeletons were buried by the deposits
- of the very next year. What would be the opinion of a
- geologist, viewing such an enormous collection of bones, of
- all kinds of animals and of all ages, thus embedded in one
- thick earthy mass? Would he not attribute it to a flood
- having swept over the surface of the land, rather than to
- the common order of things? [10]
-
- October 12th. -- I had intended to push my excursion further,
- but not being quite well, I was compelled to return by
- a balandra, or one-masted vessel of about a hundred tons'
- burden, which was bound to Buenos Ayres. As the weather
- was not fair, we moored early in the day to a branch of a
- tree on one of the islands. The Parana is full of islands,
- which undergo a constant round of decay and renovation.
- In the memory of the master several large ones had disappeared,
- and others again had been formed and protected
- by vegetation. They are composed of muddy sand, without
- even the smallest pebble, and were then about four feet
- above the level of the river; but during the periodical floods
- they are inundated. They all present one character; numerous
- willows and a few other trees are bound together by a
- great variety of creeping plants, thus forming a thick jungle.
- These thickets afford a retreat for capybaras and jaguars.
- The fear of the latter animal quite destroyed all pleasure
- in scrambling through the woods. This evening I had not
- proceeded a hundred yards, before finding indubitable signs
- of the recent presence of the tiger, I was obliged to come
- back. On every island there were tracks; and as on the
- former excursion "el rastro de los Indios" had been the
- subject of conversation, so in this was "el rastro del tigre."
- The wooded banks of the great rivers appear to be the
- favourite haunts of the jaguar; but south of the Plata, I
- was told that they frequented the reeds bordering lakes:
- wherever they are, they seem to require water. Their common
- prey is the capybara, so that it is generally said, where
- capybaras are numerous there is little danger from the
- jaguar. Falconer states that near the southern side of the
- mouth of the Plata there are many jaguars, and that they
- chiefly live on fish; this account I have heard repeated. On
- the Parana they have killed many wood-cutters, and have
- even entered vessels at night. There is a man now living
- in the Bajada, who, coming up from below when it was
- dark, was seized on the deck; he escaped, however, with
- the loss of the use of one arm. When the floods drive these
- animals from the islands, they are most dangerous. I was
- told that a few years since a very large one found its way
- into a church at St. Fe: two padres entering one after the
- other were killed, and a third, who came to see what was the
- matter, escaped with difficulty. The beast was destroyed by
- being shot from a corner of the building which was unroofed.
- They commit also at these times great ravages
- among cattle and horses. It is said that they kill their prey
- by breaking their necks. If driven from the carcass, they
- seldom return to it. The Gauchos say that the jaguar, when
- wandering about at night, is much tormented by the foxes
- yelping as they follow him. This is a curious coincidence
- with the fact which is generally affirmed of the jackals
- accompanying, in a similarly officious manner, the East Indian
- tiger. The jaguar is a noisy animal, roaring much by night,
- and especially before bad weather.
-
- One day, when hunting on the banks of the Uruguay, I
- was shown certain trees, to which these animals constantly
- recur for the purpose, as it is said, of sharpening their
- claws. I saw three well-known trees; in front, the bark
- was worn smooth, as if by the breast of the animal, and on
- each side there were deep scratches, or rather grooves,
- extending in an oblique line, nearly a yard in length. The
- scars were of different ages. A common method of ascertaining
- whether a jaguar is in the neighbourhood is to
- examine these trees. I imagine this habit of the jaguar is
- exactly similar to one which may any day be seen in the
- common cat, as with outstretched legs and exserted claws it
- scrapes the leg of a chair; and I have heard of young fruit-
- trees in an orchard in England having been thus much injured.
- Some such habit must also be common to the puma,
- for on the bare hard soil of Patagonia I have frequently
- seen scores so deep that no other animal could have made
- them. The object of this practice is, I believe, to tear off
- the ragged points of their claws, and not, as the Gauchos
- think, to sharpen them. The jaguar is killed, without much
- difficulty, by the aid of dogs baying and driving him up a
- tree, where he is despatched with bullets.
-
- Owing to bad weather we remained two days at our moorings.
- Our only amusement was catching fish for our dinner:
- there were several kinds, and all good eating. A fish called
- the "armado" (a Silurus) is remarkable from a harsh grating
- noise which it makes when caught by hook and line,
- and which can be distinctly heard when the fish is beneath
- the water. This same fish has the power of firmly catching
- hold of any object, such as the blade of an oar or the fishing-
- line, with the strong spine both of its pectoral and dorsal
- fin. In the evening the weather was quite tropical, the
- thermometer standing at 79 degs. Numbers of fireflies were
- hovering about, and the musquitoes were very troublesome.
- I exposed my hand for five minutes, and it was soon black
- with them; I do not suppose there could have been less than
- fifty, all busy sucking.
-
- October 15th. -- We got under way and passed Punta
- Gorda, where there is a colony of tame Indians from the
- province of Missiones. We sailed rapidly down the current,
- but before sunset, from a silly fear of bad weather, we
- brought-to in a narrow arm of the river. I took the boat
- and rowed some distance up this creek. It was very narrow,
- winding, and deep; on each side a wall thirty or forty feet
- high, formed by trees intwined with creepers, gave to the
- canal a singularly gloomy appearance. I here saw a very
- extraordinary bird, called the Scissor-beak (Rhynchops
- nigra). It has short legs, web feet, extremely long-pointed
- wings, and is of about the size of a tern. The beak is flattened
- laterally, that is, in a plane at right angles to that
- of a spoonbill or duck. It is as flat and elastic as an ivory
- paper-cutter, and the lower mandible, differing from every
- other bird, is an inch and a half longer than the upper. In
- a lake near Maldonado, from which the water had been
- nearly drained, and which, in consequence, swarmed with
- small fry, I saw several of these birds, generally in small
- flocks, flying rapidly backwards and forwards close to the
- surface of the lake. They kept their bills wide open, and
- the lower mandible half buried in the water. Thus skimming
- the surface, they ploughed it in their course: the water was
- quite smooth, and it formed a most curious spectacle to behold
- a flock, each bird leaving its narrow wake on the mirror-like
- surface. In their flight they frequently twist about
- with extreme quickness, and dexterously manage with their
- projecting lower mandible to plough up small fish, which are
- secured by the upper and shorter half of their scissor-like
-
-
- [picture]
-
-
- bills. This fact I repeatedly saw, as, like swallows, they
- continued to fly backwards and forwards close before me.
- Occasionally when leaving the surface of the water their
- flight was wild, irregular, and rapid; they then uttered loud
- harsh cries. When these birds are fishing, the advantage
- of the long primary feathers of their wings, in keeping them
- dry, is very evident. When thus employed, their forms resemble
- the symbol by which many artists represent marine
- birds. Their tails are much used in steering their irregular
- course.
-
- These birds are common far inland along the course of
- the Rio Parana; it is said that they remain here during the
- whole year, and breed in the marshes. During the day they
- rest in flocks on the grassy plains at some distance from
- the water. Being at anchor, as I have said, in one of the
- deep creeks between the islands of the Parana, as the evening
- drew to a close, one of these scissor-beaks suddenly appeared.
- The water was quite still, and many little fish were
- rising. The bird continued for a long time to skim the
- surface, flying in its wild and irregular manner up and down
- the narrow canal, now dark with the growing night and the
- shadows of the overhanging trees. At Monte Video, I observed
- that some large flocks during the day remained on the
- mud-banks at the head of the harbour, in the same manner
- as on the grassy plains near the Parana; and every evening
- they took flight seaward. From these facts I suspect
- that the Rhynchops generally fishes by night, at which time
- many of the lower animals come most abundantly to the
- surface. M. Lesson states that he has seen these birds
- opening the shells of the mactrae buried in the sand-banks on
- the coast of Chile: from their weak bills, with the lower
- mandible so much projecting, their short legs and long
- wings, it is very improbable that this can be a general habit.
-
- In our course down the Parana, I observed only three
- other birds, whose habits are worth mentioning. One is a
- small kingfisher (Ceryle Americana); it has a longer tail
- than the European species, and hence does not sit in so stiff
- and upright a position. Its flight also, instead of being direct
- and rapid, like the course of an arrow, is weak and
- undulatory, as among the soft-billed birds. It utters a low
- note, like the clicking together of two small stones. A small
- green parrot (Conurus murinus), with a grey breast, appears
- to prefer the tall trees on the islands to any other
- situation for its building-place. A number of nests are
- placed so close together as to form one great mass of sticks.
- These parrots always live in flocks, and commit great ravages
- on the corn-fields. I was told, that near Colonia 2500 were
- killed in the course of one year. A bird with a forked tail,
- terminated by two long feathers (Tyrannus savana), and
- named by the Spaniards scissor-tail, is very common near
- Buenos Ayres: it commonly sits on a branch of the _ombu_
- tree, near a house, and thence takes a short flight in pursuit
- of insects, and returns to the same spot. When on the wing
- it presents in its manner of flight and general appearance
- a caricature-likeness of the common swallow. It has the
- power of turning very shortly in the air, and in so doing
- opens and shuts its tail, sometimes in a horizontal or lateral
- and sometimes in a vertical direction, just like a pair of
- scissors.
-
- October 16th. -- Some leagues below Rozario, the western
- shore of the Parana is bounded by perpendicular cliffs,
- which extend in a long line to below San Nicolas; hence it
- more resembles a sea-coast than that of a fresh-water river.
- It is a great drawback to the scenery of the Parana, that,
- from the soft nature of its banks, the water is very muddy.
- The Uruguay, flowing through a granitic country, is much
- clearer; and where the two channels unite at the head of
- the Plata, the waters may for a long distance be distinguished
- by their black and red colours. In the evening, the
- wind being not quite fair, as usual we immediately moored,
- and the next day, as it blew rather freshly, though with a
- favouring current, the master was much too indolent to think
- of starting. At Bajada, he was described to me as "hombre
- muy aflicto" -- a man always miserable to get on; but certainly
- he bore all delays with admirable resignation. He
- was an old Spaniard, and had been many years in this
- country. He professed a great liking to the English, but
- stoutly maintained that the battle of Trafalgar was merely
- won by the Spanish captains having been all bought over;
- and that the only really gallant action on either side was
- performed by the Spanish admiral. It struck me as rather
- characteristic, that this man should prefer his countrymen
- being thought the worst of traitors, rather than unskilful or
- cowardly.
-
- 18th and 19th. -- We continued slowly to sail down the
- noble stream: the current helped us but little. We met,
- during our descent, very few vessels. One of the best gifts
- of nature, in so grand a channel of communication, seems
- here wilfully thrown away -- a river in which ships might
- navigate from a temperate country, as surprisingly abundant
- in certain productions as destitute of others, to another
- possessing a tropical climate, and a soil which, according to
- the best of judges, M. Bonpland, is perhaps unequalled in
- fertility in any part of the world. How different would
- have been the aspect of this river if English colonists had
- by good fortune first sailed up the Plata! What noble towns
- would now have occupied its shores! Till the death of
- Francia, the Dictator of Paraguay, these two countries must
- remain distinct, as if placed on opposite sides of the globe.
- And when the old bloody-minded tyrant is gone to his long
- account, Paraguay will be torn by revolutions, violent in
- proportion to the previous unnatural calm. That country
- will have to learn, like every other South American state,
- that a republic cannot succeed till it contains a certain body
- of men imbued with the principles of justice and honour.
-
- October 20th. -- Being arrived at the mouth of the Parana,
- and as I was very anxious to reach Buenos Ayres, I went
- on shore at Las Conchas, with the intention of riding there.
- Upon landing, I found to my great surprise that I was to
- a certain degree a prisoner. A violent revolution having
- broken out, all the ports were laid under an embargo. I
- could not return to my vessel, and as for going by land to
- the city, it was out of the question. After a long conversation
- with the commandant, I obtained permission to go the
- next day to General Rolor, who commanded a division of
- the rebels on this side the capital. In the morning I rode
- to the encampment. The general, officers, and soldiers, all
- appeared, and I believe really were, great villains. The
- general, the very evening before he left the city, voluntarily
- went to the Governor, and with his hand to his heart, pledged
- his word of honour that he at least would remain faithful
- to the last. The general told me that the city was in a state
- of close blockade, and that all he could do was to give me
- a passport to the commander-in-chief of the rebels at Quilmes.
- We had therefore to take a great sweep round the
- city, and it was with much difficulty that we procured horses.
- My reception at the encampment was quite civil, but I was
- told it was impossible that I could be allowed to enter the
- city. I was very anxious about this, as I anticipated the
- Beagle's departure from the Rio Plata earlier than it took
- place. Having mentioned, however, General Rosas's obliging
- kindness to me when at the Colorado, magic itself could
- not have altered circumstances quicker than did this
- conversation. I was instantly told that though they could not
- give me a passport, if I chose to leave my guide and horses,
- I might pass their sentinels. I was too glad to accept of
- this, and an officer was sent with me to give directions that
- I should not be stopped at the bridge. The road for the
- space of a league was quite deserted. I met one party of
- soldiers, who were satisfied by gravely looking at an old
- passport: and at length I was not a little pleased to find
- myself within the city.
-
- This revolution was supported by scarcely any pretext of
- grievances: but in a state which, in the course of nine months
- (from February to October, 1820), underwent fifteen
- changes in its government -- each governor, according to the
- constitution, being elected for three years -- it would be very
- unreasonable to ask for pretexts. In this case, a party of
- men -- who, being attached to Rosas, were disgusted with
- the governor Balcarce -- to the number of seventy left the
- city, and with the cry of Rosas the whole country took arms.
- The city was then blockaded, no provisions, cattle or horses,
- were allowed to enter; besides this, there was only a little
- skirmishing, and a few men daily killed. The outside party
- well knew that by stopping the supply of meat they would
- certainly be victorious. General Rosas could not have known
- of this rising; but it appears to be quite consonant with the
- plans of his party. A year ago he was elected governor, but
- he refused it, unless the Sala would also confer on him
- extraordinary powers. This was refused, and since then
- his party have shown that no other governor can keep his
- place. The warfare on both sides was avowedly protracted
- till it was possible to hear from Rosas. A note arrived a
- few days after I left Buenos Ayres, which stated that the
- General disapproved of peace having been broken, but that
- he thought the outside party had justice on their side. On
- the bare reception of this, the Governor, ministers, and part
- of the military, to the number of some hundreds, fled from
- the city. The rebels entered, elected a new governor, and
- were paid for their services to the number of 5500 men.
- From these proceedings, it was clear that Rosas ultimately
- would become the dictator: to the term king, the people in
- this, as in other republics, have a particular dislike. Since
- leaving South America, we have heard that Rosas has
- been elected, with powers and for a time altogether opposed
- to the constitutional principles of the republic.
-
- [1] The bizcacha (Lagostomus trichodactylus) somewhat resembles
- a large rabbit, but with bigger gnawing teeth and a long tail;
- it has, however, only three toes behind, like the agouti. During
- the last three or four years the skins of these animals have
- been sent to England for the sake of the fur.
-
- [2] Journal of Asiatic Soc., vol. v. p. 363.
-
- [3] I need hardly state here that there is good evidence
- against any horse living in America at the time of Columbus.
-
- [4] Cuvier. Ossemens Fossils, tom. i. p. 158.
-
- [5] This is the geographical division followed by Lichtenstein,
- Swainson, Erichson, and Richardson. The section from Vera Cruz
- to Acapulco, given by Humboldt in the Polit. Essay on Kingdom
- of N. Spain will show how immense a barrier the Mexican
- table-land forms. Dr. Richardson, in his admirable Report on
- the Zoology of N. America read before the Brit. Assoc. 1836
- (p. 157), talking of the identification of a Mexican animal
- with the Synetheres prehensilis, says, "We do not know with
- what propriety, but if correct, it is, if not a solitary
- instance, at least very nearly so, of a rodent animal being
- common to North and South America."
-
- [6] See Dr. Richardson's Report, p. 157; also L'Institut,
- 1837, p. 253. Cuvier says the kinkajou is found in the larger
- Antilles, but this is doubtful. M. Gervais states that the
- Didelphis crancrivora is found there. It is certain that the
- West Indies possess some mammifers peculiar to themselves. A
- tooth of a mastadon has been brought from Bahama; Edin. New
- Phil. Journ., 1826, p. 395.
-
- [7] See the admirable Appendix by Dr. Buckland to Beechey's
- Voyage; also the writings of Chamisso in Kotzebue's Voyage.
-
- [8] In Captain Owen's Surveying Voyage (vol. ii. p. 274)
- there is a curious account of the effects of a drought on the
- elephants, at Benguela (west coast of Africa). "A number of
- these animals had some time since entered the town, in a body,
- to possess themselves of the wells, not being able to procure
- any water in the country. The inhabitants mustered, when a
- desperate conflict ensued, which terminated in the ultimate
- discomfiture of the invaders, but not until they had killed
- one man, and wounded several others." The town is said to
- have a population of nearly three thousand! Dr. Malcolmson
- informs me that, during a great drought in India, the wild
- animals entered the tents of some troops at Ellore, and that
- a hare drank out of a vessel held by the adjutant of the
- regiment.
-
- [9] Travels, vol. i. p. 374.
-
- [10] These droughts to a certain degree seem to be almost
- periodical; I was told the dates of several others, and the
- intervals were about fifteen years.
-
-
-
- CHAPTER VIII
-
- BANDA ORIENTAL AND PATAGONIA
-
- Excursion to Colonia del Sacramiento -- Value of an Estancia --
- Cattle, how counted -- Singular Breed of Oxen -- Perforated
- Pebbles -- Shepherd Dogs -- Horses broken-in, Gauchos
- riding -- Character of Inhabitants -- Rio Plata -- Flocks of
- Butterflies -- Aeronaut Spiders -- Phosphorescence of the
- Sea -- Port Desire -- Guanaco -- Port St. Julian -- Geology
- of Patagonia -- Fossil gigantic Animal -- Types of Organization
- constant -- Change in the Zoology of America -- Causes of
- Extinction.
-
-
- HAVING been delayed for nearly a fortnight in the
- city, I was glad to escape on board a packet bound
- for Monte Video. A town in a state of blockade
- must always be a disagreeable place of residence; in this case
- moreover there were constant apprehensions from robbers
- within. The sentinels were the worst of all; for, from
- their office and from having arms in their hands, they robbed
- with a degree of authority which other men could not
- imitate.
-
- Our passage was a very long and tedious one. The Plata
- looks like a noble estuary on the map; but is in truth a poor
- affair. A wide expanse of muddy water has neither grandeur
- nor beauty. At one time of the day, the two shores,
- both of which are extremely low, could just be distinguished
- from the deck. On arriving at Monte Video I found that
- the Beagle would not sail for some time, so I prepared for a
- short excursion in this part of Banda Oriental. Everything
- which I have said about the country near Maldonado is applicable
- to Monte Video; but the land, with the one exception
- of the Green Mount 450 feet high, from which it takes
- its name, is far more level. Very little of the undulating
- grassy plain is enclosed; but near the town there are a few
- hedge-banks, covered with agaves, cacti, and fennel.
-
- November 14th. -- We left Monte Video in the afternoon.
- I intended to proceed to Colonia del Sacramiento, situated
- on the northern bank of the Plata and opposite to Buenos
- Ayres, and thence, following up the Uruguay, to the village
- of Mercedes on the Rio Negro (one of the many rivers of
- this name in South America), and from this point to return
- direct to Monte Video. We slept at the house of my guide
- at Canelones. In the morning we rose early, in the hopes
- of being able to ride a good distance; but it was a vain
- attempt, for all the rivers were flooded. We passed in boats
- the streams of Canelones, St. Lucia, and San Jose, and thus
- lost much time. On a former excursion I crossed the Lucia
- near its mouth, and I was surprised to observe how easily
- our horses, although not used to swim, passed over a width
- of at least six hundred yards. On mentioning this at Monte
- Video, I was told that a vessel containing some mountebanks
- and their horses, being wrecked in the Plata, one horse
- swam seven miles to the shore. In the course of the day I
- was amused by the dexterity with which a Gaucho forced
- a restive horse to swim a river. He stripped off his clothes,
- and jumping on its back, rode into the water till it was out
- of its depth; then slipping off over the crupper, he caught
- hold of the tail, and as often as the horse turned round
- the man frightened it back by splashing water in its face.
- As soon as the horse touched the bottom on the other side,
- the man pulled himself on, and was firmly seated, bridle
- in hand, before the horse gained the bank. A naked man
- on a naked horse is a fine spectacle; I had no idea how well
- the two animals suited each other. The tail of a horse is a
- very useful appendage; I have passed a river in a boat with
- four people in it, which was ferried across in the same way
- as the Gaucho. If a man and horse have to cross a broad
- river, the best plan is for the man to catch hold of the pommel
- or mane, and help himself with the other arm.
-
- We slept and stayed the following day at the post of
- Cufre. In the evening the postman or letter-carrier arrived.
- He was a day after his time, owing to the Rio Rozario being
- flooded. It would not, however, be of much consequence;
- for, although he had passed through some of the principal
- towns in Banda Oriental, his luggage consisted of two letters!
- The view from the house was pleasing; an undulating
- green surface, with distant glimpses of the Plata. I find
- that I look at this province with very different eyes from
- what I did upon my first arrival. I recollect I then thought
- it singularly level; but now, after galloping over the Pampas,
- my only surprise is, what could have induced me ever
- to call it level. The country is a series of undulations, in
- themselves perhaps not absolutely great, but, as compared
- to the plains of St. Fe, real mountains. From these
- inequalities there is an abundance of small rivulets, and
- the turf is green and luxuriant.
-
- November 17th. -- We crossed the Rozario, which was
- deep and rapid, and passing the village of Colla, arrived
- at midday at Colonia del Sacramiento. The distance is
- twenty leagues, through a country covered with fine grass,
- but poorly stocked with cattle or inhabitants. I was invited
- to sleep at Colonia, and to accompany on the following
- day a gentleman to his estancia, where there were some
- limestone rocks. The town is built on a stony promontory
- something in the same manner as at Monte Video. It is
- strongly fortified, but both fortifications and town suffered
- much in the Brazilian war. It is very ancient; and the
- irregularity of the streets, and the surrounding groves of
- old orange and peach trees, gave it a pretty appearance.
- The church is a curious ruin; it was used as a powder-
- magazine, and was struck by lightning in one of the ten
- thousand thunder-storms of the Rio Plata. Two-thirds of
- the building were blown away to the very foundation; and
- the rest stands a shattered and curious monument of the
- united powers of lightning and gunpowder. In the evening
- I wandered about the half-demolished walls of the town. It
- was the chief seat of the Brazilian war; -- a war most injurious
- to this country, not so much in its immediate effects,
- as in being the origin of a multitude of generals and all
- other grades of officers. More generals are numbered (but
- not paid) in the United Provinces of La Plata than in the
- United Kingdom of Great Britain. These gentlemen have
- learned to like power, and do not object to a little
- skirmishing. Hence there are many always on the watch to
- create disturbance and to overturn a government which as yet
- has never rested on any staple foundation. I noticed, however,
- both here and in other places, a very general interest
- in the ensuing election for the President; and this appears
- a good sign for the prosperity of this little country. The
- inhabitants do not require much education in their
- representatives; I heard some men discussing the merits of those
- for Colonia; and it was said that, "although they were not
- men of business, they could all sign their names:" with this
- they seemed to think every reasonable man ought to be
- satisfied.
-
- 18th. -- Rode with my host to his estancia, at the Arroyo
- de San Juan. In the evening we took a ride round the
- estate: it contained two square leagues and a half, and was
- situated in what is called a rincon; that is, one side was
- fronted by the Plata, and the two others guarded by impassable
- brooks. There was an excellent port for little vessels,
- and an abundance of small wood, which is valuable
- as supplying fuel to Buenos Ayres. I was curious to know
- the value of so complete an estancia. Of cattle there were
- 3000, and it would well support three or four times that
- number; of mares 800, together with 150 broken-in horses,
- and 600 sheep. There was plenty of water and limestone,
- a rough house, excellent corrals, and a peach orchard. For
- all this he had been offered 2000 Pounds, and he only wanted
- 500 Pounds additional, and probably would sell it for less. The
- chief trouble with an estancia is driving the cattle twice a
- week to a central spot, in order to make them tame, and to count
- them. This latter operation would be thought difficult,
- where there are ten or fifteen thousand head together. It
- is managed on the principle that the cattle invariably divide
- themselves into little troops of from forty to one hundred.
- Each troop is recognized by a few peculiarly marked
- animals, and its number is known: so that, one being lost
- out of ten thousand, it is perceived by its absence from one
- of the tropillas. During a stormy night the cattle all mingle
- together; but the next morning the tropillas separate as
- before; so that each animal must know its fellow out of ten
- thousand others.
-
- On two occasions I met with in this province some oxen
- of a very curious breed, called nata or niata. They appear
- externally to hold nearly the same relation to other cattle,
- which bull or pug dogs do to other dogs. Their forehead
- is very short and broad, with the nasal end turned up, and
- the upper lip much drawn back; their lower jaws project
- beyond the upper, and have a corresponding upward curve;
- hence their teeth are always exposed. Their nostrils are
- seated high up and are very open; their eyes project outwards.
- When walking they carry their heads low, on a short
- neck; and their hinder legs are rather longer compared
- with the front legs than is usual. Their bare teeth, their
- short heads, and upturned nostrils give them the most ludicrous
- self-confident air of defiance imaginable.
-
- Since my return, I have procured a skeleton head,
- through the kindness of my friend Captain Sulivan, R. N.,
- which is now deposited in the College of Surgeons. [1] Don
- F. Muniz, of Luxan, has kindly collected for me all the
- information which he could respecting this breed. From his
- account it seems that about eighty or ninety years ago, they
- were rare and kept as curiosities at Buenos Ayres. The
- breed is universally believed to have originated amongst
- the Indians southward of the Plata; and that it was with
- them the commonest kind. Even to this day, those reared
- in the provinces near the Plata show their less civilized
- origin, in being fiercer than common cattle, and in the cow
- easily deserting her first calf, if visited too often or
- molested. It is a singular fact that an almost similar structure
- to the abnormal [2] one of the niata breed, characterizes, as I
- am informed by Dr. Falconer, that great extinct ruminant
- of India, the Sivatherium. The breed is very _true_; and a
- niata bull and cow invariably produce niata calves. A niata
- bull with a common cow, or the reverse cross, produces offspring
- having an intermediate character, but with the niata
- characters strongly displayed: according to Senor Muniz,
- there is the clearest evidence, contrary to the common belief
- of agriculturists in analogous cases, that the niata cow when
- crossed with a common bull transmits her peculiarities more
- strongly than the niata bull when crossed with a common
- cow. When the pasture is tolerably long, the niata cattle
- feed with the tongue and palate as well as common cattle;
- but during the great droughts, when so many animals perish,
- the niata breed is under a great disadvantage, and would
- be exterminated if not attended to; for the common cattle,
- like horses, are able just to keep alive, by browsing with
- their lips on twigs of trees and reeds; this the niatas cannot
- so well do, as their lips do not join, and hence they are found
- to perish before the common cattle. This strikes me as a
- good illustration of how little we are able to judge from the
- ordinary habits of life, on what circumstances, occurring
- only at long intervals, the rarity or extinction of a species
- may be determined.
-
- November 19th. -- Passing the valley of Las Vacas, we
- slept at a house of a North American, who worked a lime-
- kiln on the Arroyo de las Vivoras. In the morning we rode
- to a protecting headland on the banks of the river, called
- Punta Gorda. On the way we tried to find a jaguar. There
- were plenty of fresh tracks, and we visited the trees, on
- which they are said to sharpen their claws; but we did not
- succeed in disturbing one. From this point the Rio Uruguay
- presented to our view a noble volume of water. From
- the clearness and rapidity of the stream, its appearance was
- far superior to that of its neighbour the Parana. On the
- opposite coast, several branches from the latter river entered
- the Uruguay. As the sun was shining, the two colours of
- the waters could be seen quite distinct.
-
- In the evening we proceeded on our road towards Mercedes
- on the Rio Negro. At night we asked permission to
- sleep at an estancia at which we happened to arrive. It was
- a very large estate, being ten leagues square, and the owner
- is one of the greatest landowners in the country. His nephew
- had charge of it, and with him there was a captain in
- the army, who the other day ran away from Buenos Ayres.
- Considering their station, their conversation was rather
- amusing. They expressed, as was usual, unbounded astonishment
- at the globe being round, and could scarcely credit
- that a hole would, if deep enough, come out on the other
- side. They had, however, heard of a country where there
- were six months of light and six of darkness, and where
- the inhabitants were very tall and thin! They were curious
- about the price and condition of horses and cattle in England.
- Upon finding out we did not catch our animals with
- the lazo, they cried out, "Ah, then, you use nothing but
- the bolas:" the idea of an enclosed country was quite new
- to them. The captain at last said, he had one question to
- ask me, which he should be very much obliged if I would
- answer with all truth. I trembled to think how deeply scientific
- it would be: it was, "Whether the ladies of Buenos
- Ayres were not the handsomest in the world." I replied, like
- a renegade, "Charmingly so." He added, "I have one other
- question: Do ladies in any other part of the world wear
- such large combs?" I solemnly assured him that they did
- not. They were absolutely delighted. The captain exclaimed,
- "Look there! a man who has seen half the world
- says it is the case; we always thought so, but now we know
- it." My excellent judgment in combs and beauty procured
- me a most hospitable reception; the captain forced me to
- take his bed, and he would sleep on his recado.
-
- 21st. -- Started at sunrise, and rode slowly during the
- whole day. The geological nature of this part of the province
- was different from the rest, and closely resembled that
- of the Pampas. In consequence, there were immense beds
- of the thistle, as well as of the cardoon: the whole country,
- indeed, may be called one great bed of these plants. The
- two sorts grow separate, each plant in company with its
- own kind. The cardoon is as high as a horse's back, but the
- Pampas thistle is often higher than the crown of the rider's
- head. To leave the road for a yard is out of the question;
- and the road itself is partly, and in some cases entirely
- closed. Pasture, of course there is none; if cattle or horses
- once enter the bed, they are for the time completely lost.
- Hence it is very hazardous to attempt to drive cattle at
- this season of the year; for when jaded enough to face the
- thistles, they rush among them, and are seen no more. In
- these districts there are very few estancias, and these few
- are situated in the neighbourhood of damp valleys, where
- fortunately neither of these overwhelming plants can exist.
- As night came on before we arrived at our journey's end,
- we slept at a miserable little hovel inhabited by the poorest
- people. The extreme though rather formal courtesy of our
- host and hostess, considering their grade of life, was quite
- delightful.
-
- November 22nd. -- Arrived at an estancia on the Berquelo
- belonging to a very hospitable Englishman, to whom I had
- a letter of introduction from my friend Mr. Lumb. I stayed
- here three days. One morning I rode with my host to the
- Sierra del Pedro Flaco, about twenty miles up the Rio
- Negro. Nearly the whole country was covered with good
- though coarse grass, which was as high as a horse's belly;
- yet there were square leagues without a single head of cattle.
- The province of Banda Oriental, if well stocked, would support
- an astonishing number of animals, at present the annual
- export of hides from Monte Video amounts to three
- hundred thousand; and the home consumption, from waste,
- is very considerable. An "estanciero" told me that he often
- had to send large herds of cattle a long journey to a salting
- establishment, and that the tired beasts were frequently
- obliged to be killed and skinned; but that he could never
- persuade the Gauchos to eat of them, and every evening
- a fresh beast was slaughtered for their suppers! The view
- of the Rio Negro from the Sierra was more picturesque than
- any other which I saw in this province. The river, broad,
- deep, and rapid, wound at the foot of a rocky precipitous
- cliff: a belt of wood followed its course, and the horizon
- terminated in the distant undulations of the turf-plain.
-
- When in this neighbourhood, I several times heard of
- the Sierra de las Cuentas: a hill distant many miles to the
- northward. The name signifies hill of beads. I was assured
- that vast numbers of little round stones, of various colours,
- each with a small cylindrical hole, are found there. Formerly
- the Indians used to collect them, for the purpose of
- making necklaces and bracelets -- a taste, I may observe,
- which is common to all savage nations, as well as to the most
- polished. I did not know what to understand from this
- story, but upon mentioning it at the Cape of Good Hope
- to Dr. Andrew Smith, he told me that he recollected finding
- on the south-eastern coast of Africa, about one hundred
- miles to the eastward of St. John's river, some quartz crystals
- with their edges blunted from attrition, and mixed with
- gravel on the sea-beach. Each crystal was about five lines
- in diameter, and from an inch to an inch and a half in
- length. Many of them had a small canal extending from
- one extremity to the other, perfectly cylindrical, and of a
- size that readily admitted a coarse thread or a piece of fine
- catgut. Their colour was red or dull white. The natives
- were acquainted with this structure in crystals. I have
- mentioned these circumstances because, although no crystallized
- body is at present known to assume this form, it may
- lead some future traveller to investigate the real nature of
- such stones.
-
-
- While staying at this estancia, I was amused with what
- I saw and heard of the shepherd-dogs of the country. [3] When
- riding, it is a common thing to meet a large flock of sheep
- guarded by one or two dogs, at the distance of some miles
- from any house or man. I often wondered how so firm a
- friendship had been established. The method of education
- consists in separating the puppy, while very young, from
- the bitch, and in accustoming it to its future companions.
- An ewe is held three or four times a day for the little thing
- to suck, and a nest of wool is made for it in the sheep-pen;
- at no time is it allowed to associate with other dogs, or with
- the children of the family. The puppy is, moreover, generally
- castrated; so that, when grown up, it can scarcely
- have any feelings in common with the rest of its kind. From
- this education it has no wish to leave the flock, and just
- as another dog will defend its master, man, so will these
- the sheep. It is amusing to observe, when approaching a
- flock, how the dog immediately advances barking, and the
- sheep all close in his rear, as if round the oldest ram. These
- dogs are also easily taught to bring home the flock, at a
- certain hour in the evening. Their most troublesome fault,
- when young, is their desire of playing with the sheep; for
- in their sport they sometimes gallop their poor subjects most
- unmercifully.
-
- The shepherd-dog comes to the house every day for some
- meat, and as soon as it is given him, he skulks away as if
- ashamed of himself. On these occasions the house-dogs are
- very tyrannical, and the least of them will attack and pursue
- the stranger. The minute, however, the latter has reached
- the flock, he turns round and begins to bark, and then all
- the house-dogs take very quickly to their heels. In a similar
- manner a whole pack of the hungry wild dogs will scarcely
- ever (and I was told by some never) venture to attack a
- flock guarded by even one of these faithful shepherds. The
- whole account appears to me a curious instance of the pliability
- of the affections in the dog; and yet, whether wild or
- however educated, he has a feeling of respect or fear for
- those that are fulfilling their instinct of association. For
- we can understand on no principle the wild dogs being
- driven away by the single one with its flock, except that they
- consider, from some confused notion, that the one thus
- associated gains power, as if in company with its own kind.
- F. Cuvier has observed that all animals that readily enter
- into domestication, consider man as a member of their own
- society, and thus fulfil their instinct of association. In
- the above case the shepherd-dog ranks the sheep as its fellow-
- brethren, and thus gains confidence; and the wild dogs,
- though knowing that the individual sheep are not dogs, but
- are good to eat, yet partly consent to this view when seeing
- them in a flock with a shepherd-dog at their head.
-
- One evening a "domidor" (a subduer of horses) came
- for the purpose of breaking-in some colts. I will describe
- the preparatory steps, for I believe they have not been
- mentioned by other travellers. A troop of wild young horses
- is driven into the corral, or large enclosure of stakes, and
- the door is shut. We will suppose that one man alone has
- to catch and mount a horse, which as yet had never felt
- bridle or saddle. I conceive, except by a Gaucho, such a feat
- would be utterly impracticable. The Gaucho picks out a
- full-grown colt; and as the beast rushes round the circus
- he throws his lazo so as to catch both the front legs. Instantly
- the horse rolls over with a heavy shock, and whilst
- struggling on the ground, the Gaucho, holding the lazo
- tight, makes a circle, so as to catch one of the hind legs
- just beneath the fetlock, and draws it close to the two front
- legs: he then hitches the lazo, so that the three are bound
- together. Then sitting on the horse's neck, he fixes a strong
- bridle, without a bit, to the lower jaw: this he does by passing
- a narrow thong through the eye-holes at the end of the
- reins, and several times round both jaw and tongue. The
- two front legs are now tied closely together with a strong
- leathern thong, fastened by a slip-knot. The lazo, which
- bound the three together, being then loosed, the horse rises
- with difficulty. The Gaucho now holding fast the bridle
- fixed to the lower jaw, leads the horse outside the corral. If
- a second man is present (otherwise the trouble is much
- greater) he holds the animal's head, whilst the first puts on
- the horsecloths and saddle, and girths the whole together.
- During this operation, the horse, from dread and astonishment
- at thus being bound round the waist, throws himself
- over and over again on the ground, and, till beaten, is
- unwilling to rise. At last, when the saddling is finished, the
- poor animal can hardly breathe from fear, and is white with
- foam and sweat. The man now prepares to mount by pressing
- heavily on the stirrup, so that the horse may not lose
- its balance; and at the moment that he throws his leg over
- the animal's back, he pulls the slip-knot binding the front
- legs, and the beast is free. Some "domidors" pull the knot
- while the animal is lying on the ground, and, standing over
- the saddle, allow him to rise beneath them. The horse, wild
- with dread, gives a few most violent bounds, and then starts
- off at full gallop: when quite exhausted, the man, by patience,
- brings him back to the corral, where, reeking hot and
- scarcely alive, the poor beast is let free. Those animals
- which will not gallop away, but obstinately throw themselves
- on the ground, are by far the most troublesome. This process
- is tremendously severe, but in two or three trials the horse
- is tamed. It is not, however, for some weeks that the animal
- is ridden with the iron bit and solid ring, for it must learn
- to associate the will of its rider with the feel of the rein,
- before the most powerful bridle can be of any service.
-
- Animals are so abundant in these countries, that humanity
- and self-interest are not closely united; therefore I
- fear it is that the former is here scarcely known. One day,
- riding in the Pampas with a very respectable "estanciero,"
- my horse, being tired, lagged behind. The man often shouted
- to me to spur him. When I remonstrated that it was a pity,
- for the horse was quite exhausted, he cried out, "Why not?
- -- never mind -- spur him -- it is my horse." I had then some
- difficulty in making him comprehend that it was for the
- horse's sake, and not on his account, that I did not choose
- to use my spurs. He exclaimed, with a look of great surprise,
- "Ah, Don Carlos, que cosa!" It was clear that such
- an idea had never before entered his head.
-
- The Gauchos are well known to be perfect riders The
- idea of being thrown, let the horse do what it likes; never
- enters their head. Their criterion of a good rider is, a man
- who can manage an untamed colt, or who, if his horse falls,
- alights on his own feet, or can perform other such exploits.
- I have heard of a man betting that he would throw his horse
- down twenty times, and that nineteen times he would not
- fall himself. I recollect seeing a Gaucho riding a very
- stubborn horse, which three times successively reared so
- high as to fall backwards with great violence. The man
- judged with uncommon coolness the proper moment for
- slipping off, not an instant before or after the right time;
- and as soon as the horse got up, the man jumped on his back,
- and at last they started at a gallop. The Gaucho never appears
- to exert any muscular force. I was one day watching
- a good rider, as we were galloping along at a rapid pace,
- and thought to myself, "Surely if the horse starts, you
- appear so careless on your seat, you must fall." At this moment,
- a male ostrich sprang from its nest right beneath the
- horse's nose: the young colt bounded on one side like a stag;
- but as for the man, all that could be said was, that he started
- and took fright with his horse.
-
- In Chile and Peru more pains are taken with the mouth
- of the horse than in La Plata, and this is evidently a
- consequence of the more intricate nature of the country. In
- Chile a horse is not considered perfectly broken, till he can
- be brought up standing, in the midst of his full speed, on
- any particular spot, -- for instance, on a cloak thrown on
- the ground: or, again, he will charge a wall, and rearing,
- scrape the surface with his hoofs. I have seen an animal
- bounding with spirit, yet merely reined by a fore-finger and
- thumb, taken at full gallop across a courtyard, and then
- made to wheel round the post of a veranda with great speed,
- but at so equal a distance, that the rider, with outstretched
- arm, all the while kept one finger rubbing the post. Then
- making a demi-volte in the air, with the other arm outstretched
- in a like manner, he wheeled round, with astonishing
- force, in an opposite direction.
-
- Such a horse is well broken; and although this at first
- may appear useless, it is far otherwise. It is only carrying
- that which is daily necessary into perfection. When a bullock
- is checked and caught by the lazo, it will sometimes
- gallop round and round in a circle, and the horse being
- alarmed at the great strain, if not well broken, will not
- readily turn like the pivot of a wheel. In consequence many
- men have been killed; for if the lazo once takes a twist
- round a man's body, it will instantly, from the power of the
- two opposed animals, almost cut him in twain. On the
- same principle the races are managed; the course is only
- two or three hundred yards long, the wish being to have
- horses that can make a rapid dash. The racehorses are
- trained not only to stand with their hoofs touching a line,
- but to draw all four feet together, so as at the first spring
- to bring into play the full action of the hind-quarters. In
- Chile I was told an anecdote, which I believe was true; and
- it offers a good illustration of the use of a well-broken
- animal. A respectable man riding one day met two others, one
- of whom was mounted on a horse, which he knew to have
- been stolen from himself. He challenged them; they answered
- him by drawing their sabres and giving chase. The
- man, on his good and fleet beast, kept just ahead: as he
- passed a thick bush he wheeled round it, and brought up
- his horse to a dead check. The pursuers were obliged to
- shoot on one side and ahead. Then instantly dashing on,
- right behind them, he buried his knife in the back of one,
- wounded the other, recovered his horse from the dying
- robber, and rode home. For these feats of horsemanship
- two things are necessary: a most severe bit, like the Mameluke,
- the power of which, though seldom used, the horse
- knows full well; and large blunt spurs, that can be applied
- either as a mere touch, or as an instrument of extreme pain.
- I conceive that with English spurs, the slightest touch of
- which pricks the skin, it would be impossible to break in a
- horse after the South American fashion
-
- At an estancia near Las Vacas large numbers of mares
- are weekly slaughtered for the sake of their hides, although
- worth only five paper dollars, or about half a crown apiece.
- It seems at first strange that it can answer to kill mares
- for such a trifle; but as it is thought ridiculous in this
- country ever to break in or ride a mare, they are of no value
- except for breeding. The only thing for which I ever saw
- mares used, was to tread out wheat from the ear, for which
- purpose they were driven round a circular enclosure, where
- the wheat-sheaves were strewed. The man employed for
- slaughtering the mares happened to be celebrated for his
- dexterity with the lazo. Standing at the distance of twelve
- yards from the mouth of the corral, he has laid a wager
- that he would catch by the legs every animal, without missing
- one, as it rushed past him. There was another man
- who said he would enter the corral on foot, catch a mare,
- fasten her front legs together, drive her out, throw her down,
- kill, skin, and stake the hide for drying (which latter is a
- tedious job); and he engaged that he would perform this
- whole operation on twenty-two animals in one day. Or he
- would kill and take the skin off fifty in the same time. This
- would have been a prodigious task, for it is considered a
- good day's work to skin and stake the hides of fifteen or
- sixteen animals.
-
- November 26th. -- I set out on my return in a direct line
- for Monte Video. Having heard of some giant's bones at
- a neighbouring farm-house on the Sarandis, a small stream
- entering the Rio Negro, I rode there accompanied by my
- host, and purchased for the value of eighteen pence the head
- of the Toxodon. [4] When found it was quite perfect; but
- the boys knocked out some of the teeth with stones, and then
- set up the head as a mark to throw at. By a most fortunate
- chance I found a perfect tooth, which exactly fitted one of
- the sockets in this skull, embedded by itself on the banks
- of the Rio Tercero, at the distance of about 180 miles from
- this place. I found remains of this extraordinary animal
- at two other places, so that it must formerly have been common.
- I found here, also, some large portions of the armour
- of a gigantic armadillo-like animal, and part of the great
- head of a Mylodon. The bones of this head are so fresh,
- that they contain, according to the analysis by Mr. T. Reeks,
- seven per cent of animal matter; and when placed in a
- spirit-lamp, they burn with a small flame. The number
- of the remains embedded in the grand estuary deposit which
- forms the Pampas and covers the granitic rocks of Banda
- Oriental, must be extraordinarily great. I believe a straight
- line drawn in any direction through the Pampas would cut
- through some skeleton or bones. Besides those which I
- found during my short excursions, I heard of many others,
- and the origin of such names as "the stream of the animal,"
- "the hill of the giant," is obvious. At other times I heard
- of the marvellous property of certain rivers, which had the
- power of changing small bones into large; or, as some
- maintained, the bones themselves grew. As far as I am aware,
- not one of these animals perished, as was formerly supposed,
- in the marshes or muddy river-beds of the present land, but
- their bones have been exposed by the streams intersecting the
- subaqueous deposit in which they were originally embedded.
- We may conclude that the whole area of the Pampas is one
- wide sepulchre of these extinct gigantic quadrupeds.
-
- By the middle of the day, on the 28th, we arrived at
- Monte Video, having been two days and a half on the road.
- The country for the whole way was of a very uniform character,
- some parts being rather more rocky and hilly than
- near the Plata. Not far from Monte Video we passed
- through the village of Las Pietras, so named from some
- large rounded masses of syenite. Its appearance was rather
- pretty. In this country a few fig-trees round a group of
- houses, and a site elevated a hundred feet above the general
- level, ought always to be called picturesque.
-
-
- During the last six months I have had an opportunity of
- seeing a little of the character of the inhabitants of these
- provinces. The Gauchos, or countryrmen, are very superior
- to those who reside in the towns. The Gaucho is invariably
- most obliging, polite, and hospitable: I did not meet with
- even one instance of rudeness or inhospitality. He is modest,
- both respecting himself and country, but at the same
- time a spirited, bold fellow. On the other hand, many robberies
- are committed, and there is much bloodshed: the
- habit of constantly wearing the knife is the chief cause
- of the latter. It is lamentable to hear how many lives are
- lost in trifling quarrels. In fighting, each party tries to
- mark the face of his adversary by slashing his nose or eyes;
- as is often attested by deep and horrid-looking scars. Robberies
- are a natural consequence of universal gambling,
- much drinking, and extreme indolence. At Mercedes I asked
- two men why they did not work. One gravely said the days
- were too long; the other that he was too poor. The number
- of horses and the profusion of food are the destruction of
- all industry. Moreover, there are so many feast-days; and
- again, nothing can succeed without it be begun when the
- moon is on the increase; so that half the month is lost from
- these two causes.
-
- Police and justice are quite inefficient. If a man who is
- poor commits murder and is taken, he will be imprisoned,
- and perhaps even shot; but if he is rich and has friends,
- he may rely on it no very severe consequence will ensue.
- It is curious that the most respectable inhabitants of the
- country invariably assist a murderer to escape: they seem
- to think that the individual sins against the government,
- and not against the people. A traveller has no protection
- besides his fire-arms; and the constant habit of carrying
- them is the main check to more frequent robberies.
- The character of the higher and more educated classes
- who reside in the towns, partakes, but perhaps in a lesser
- degree, of the good parts of the Gaucho, but is, I fear, stained
- by many vices of which he is free. Sensuality, mockery of
- all religion, and the grossest corruption, are far from
- uncommon. Nearly every public officer can be bribed. The
- head man in the post-office sold forged government franks.
- The governor and prime minister openly combined to plunder
- the state. Justice, where gold came into play, was
- hardly expected by any one. I knew an Englishman, who
- went to the Chief Justice (he told me, that not then
- understanding the ways of the place, he trembled as he entered
- the room), and said, "Sir, I have come to offer you two hundred
- (paper) dollars (value about five pounds sterling) if
- you will arrest before a certain time a man who has cheated
- me. I know it is against the law, but my lawyer (naming
- him) recommended me to take this step." The Chief Justice
- smiled acquiescence, thanked him, and the man before
- night was safe in prison. With this entire want of principle
- in many of the leading men, with the country full of
- ill-paid turbulent officers, the people yet hope that a
- democratic form of government can succeed!
-
- On first entering society in these countries, two or three
- features strike one as particularly remarkable. The polite
- and dignified manners pervading every rank of life, the
- excellent taste displayed by the women in their dresses, and
- the equality amongst all ranks. At the Rio Colorado some
- men who kept the humblest shops used to dine with General
- Rosas. A son of a major at Bahia Blanca gained his
- livelihood by making paper cigars, and he wished to accompany
- me, as guide or servant, to Buenos Ayres, but his
- father objected on the score of the danger alone. Many
- officers in the army can neither read nor write, yet all meet
- in society as equals. In Entre Rios, the Sala consisted of
- only six representatives. One of them kept a common shop,
- and evidently was not degraded by the office. All this is
- what would be expected in a new country; nevertheless the
- absence of gentlemen by profession appears to an Englishman
- something strange.
-
- When speaking of these countries, the manner in which
- they have been brought up by their unnatural parent, Spain,
- should always be borne in mind. On the whole, perhaps,
- more credit is due for what has been done, than blame for
- that which may be deficient. It is impossible to doubt but
- that the extreme liberalism of these countries must ultimately
- lead to good results. The very general toleration of
- foreign religions, the regard paid to the means of education,
- the freedom of the press, the facilities offered to all
- foreigners, and especially, as I am bound to add, to every one
- professing the humblest pretensions to science, should be
- recollected with gratitude by those who have visited Spanish
- South America.
-
- December 6th. -- The Beagle sailed from the Rio Plata,
- never again to enter its muddy stream. Our course was
- directed to Port Desire, on the coast of Patagonia. Before
- proceeding any further, I will here put together a few
- observations made at sea.
-
- Several times when the ship has been some miles off the
- mouth of the Plata, and at other times when off the shores
- of Northern Patagonia, we have been surrounded by insects.
- One evening, when we were about ten miles from the Bay
- of San Blas, vast numbers of butterflies, in bands or flocks
- of countless myriads, extended as far as the eye could range.
- Even by the aid of a telescope it was not possible to see a
- space free from butterflies. The seamen cried out "it was
- snowing butterflies," and such in fact was the appearance.
- More species than one were present, but the main part belonged
- to a kind very similar to, but not identical with, the
- common English Colias edusa. Some moths and hymenoptera
- accompanied the butterflies; and a fine beetle (Calosoma)
- flew on board. Other instances are known of this
- beetle having been caught far out at sea; and this is the
- more remarkable, as the greater number of the Carabidae
- seldom or never take wing. The day had been fine and calm,
- and the one previous to it equally so, with light and variable
- airs. Hence we cannot suppose that the insects were blown
- off the land, but we must conclude that they voluntarily took
- flight. The great bands of the Colias seem at first to afford
- an instance like those on record of the migrations of another
- butterfly, Vanessa cardui; [5] but the presence of other insects
- makes the case distinct, and even less intelligible. Before
- sunset a strong breeze sprung up from the north, and this
- must have caused tens of thousands of the butterflies and
- other insects to have perished.
-
- On another occasion, when seventeen miles off Cape Corrientes,
- I had a net overboard to catch pelagic animals.
- Upon drawing it up, to my surprise, I found a considerable
- number of beetles in it, and although in the open sea, they
- did not appear much injured by the salt water. I lost some
- of the specimens, but those which I preserved belonged
- to the genera Colymbetes, Hydroporus, Hydrobius (two species),
- Notaphus, Cynucus, Adimonia, and Scarabaeus. At
- first I thought that these insects had been blown from the
- shore; but upon reflecting that out of the eight species four
- were aquatic, and two others partly so in their habits, it
- appeared to me most probable that they were floated into the
- sea by a small stream which drains a lake near Cape Corrientes.
- On any supposition it is an interesting circumstance
- to find live insects swimming in the open ocean seventeen
- miles from the nearest point of land. There are several
- accounts of insects having been blown off the Patagonian
- shore. Captain Cook observed it, as did more lately Captain
- King of the Adventure. The cause probably is due to the
- want of shelter, both of trees and hills, so that an insect on
- the wing with an off-shore breeze, would be very apt to
- be blown out to sea. The most remarkable instance I have
- known of an insect being caught far from the land, was that
- of a large grasshopper (Acrydium), which flew on board,
- when the Beagle was to windward of the Cape de Verd
- Islands, and when the nearest point of land, not directly
- opposed to the trade-wind, was Cape Blanco on the coast of
- Africa, 370 miles distant. [6]
-
- On several occasions, when the Beagle has been within
- the mouth of the Plata, the rigging has been coated with
- the web of the Gossamer Spider. One day (November 1st,
- 1832) I paid particular attention to this subject. The weather
- had been fine and clear, and in the morning the air was full
- of patches of the flocculent web, as on an autumnal day in
- England. The ship was sixty miles distant from the land, in
- the direction of a steady though light breeze. Vast numbers
- of a small spider, about one-tenth of an inch in length, and of
- a dusky red colour, were attached to the webs. There must
- have been, I should suppose, some thousands on the ship. The
- little spider, when first coming in contact with the rigging,
- was always seated on a single thread, and not on the flocculent
- mass. This latter seems merely to be produced by the
- entanglement of the single threads. The spiders were all of
- one species, but of both sexes, together with young ones.
- These latter were distinguished by their smaller size and
- more dusky colour. I will not give the description of this
- spider, but merely state that it does not appear to me to be
- included in any of Latreille's genera. The little aeronaut as
- soon as it arrived on board was very active, running about,
- sometimes letting itself fall, and then reascending the same
- thread; sometimes employing itself in making a small and
- very irregular mesh in the corners between the ropes. It
- could run with facility on the surface of the water. When
- disturbed it lifted up its front legs, in the attitude of
- attention. On its first arrival it appeared very thirsty, and
- with exserted maxillae drank eagerly of drops of water, this
- same circumstance has been observed by Strack: may it not be in
- consequence of the little insect having passed through a dry
- and rarefied atmosphere? Its stock of web seemed inexhaustible.
- While watching some that were suspended by a
- single thread, I several times observed that the slightest
- breath of air bore them away out of sight, in a horizontal
- line.
-
- On another occasion (25th) under similar circumstances,
- I repeatedly observed the same kind of small spider,
- either when placed or having crawled on some little eminence,
- elevate its abdomen, send forth a thread, and then
- sail away horizontally, but with a rapidity which was quite
- unaccountable. I thought I could perceive that the spider,
- before performing the above preparatory steps, connected
- its legs together with the most delicate threads, but I am not
- sure whether this observation was correct.
-
- One day, at St. Fe, I had a better opportunity of observing
- some similar facts. A spider which was about three-tenths
- of an inch in length, and which in its general appearance
- resembled a Citigrade (therefore quite different from the
- gossamer), while standing on the summit of a post, darted
- forth four or five threads from its spinners. These, glittering
- in the sunshine, might be compared to diverging rays of
- light; they were not, however, straight, but in undulations
- like films of silk blown by the wind. They were more than a
- yard in length, and diverged in an ascending direction from
- the orifices. The spider then suddenly let go its hold of the
- post, and was quickly borne out of sight. The day was hot
- and apparently calm; yet under such circumstances, the
- atmosphere can never be so tranquil as not to affect a vane so
- delicate as the thread of a spider's web. If during a warm
- day we look either at the shadow of any object cast on a
- bank, or over a level plain at a distant landmark, the effect
- of an ascending current of heated air is almost always evident:
- such upward currents, it has been remarked, are also
- shown by the ascent of soap-bubbles, which will not rise in
- an in-doors room. Hence I think there is not much difficulty
- in understanding the ascent of the fine lines projected from
- a spider's spinners, and afterwards of the spider itself; the
- divergence of the lines has been attempted to be explained, I
- believe by Mr. Murray, by their similar electrical condition.
- The circumstance of spiders of the same species, but of
- different sexes and ages, being found on several occasions at
- the distance of many leagues from the land, attached in vast
- numbers to the lines, renders it probable that the habit of
- sailing through the air is as characteristic of this tribe, as
- that of diving is of the Argyroneta. We may then reject
- Latreille's supposition, that the gossamer owes its origin
- indifferently to the young of several genera of spiders:
- although, as we have seen, the young of other spiders do
- possess the power of performing aerial voyages. [7]
-
- During our different passages south of the Plata, I often
- towed astern a net made of bunting, and thus caught many
- curious animals. Of Crustacea there were many strange
- and undescribed genera. One, which in some respects is
- allied to the Notopods (or those crabs which have their
- posterior legs placed almost on their backs, for the purpose
- of adhering to the under side of rocks), is very remarkable
- from the structure of its hind pair of legs. The penultimate
- joint, instead of terminating in a simple claw, ends in three
- bristle-like appendages of dissimilar lengths -- the longest
- equalling that of the entire leg. These claws are very thin,
- and are serrated with the finest teeth, directed backwards:
- their curved extremities are flattened, and on this part five
- most minute cups are placed which seem to act in the same
- manner as the suckers on the arms of the cuttle-fish. As
- the animal lives in the open sea, and probably wants a place
- of rest, I suppose this beautiful and most anomalous structure
- is adapted to take hold of floating marine animals.
-
- In deep water, far from the land, the number of living
- creatures is extremely small: south of the latitude 35 degs.,
- I never succeeded in catching anything besides some beroe,
- and a few species of minute entomostracous crustacea.
- In shoaler water, at the distance of a few miles from the
- coast, very many kinds of crustacea and some other animals
- are numerous, but only during the night. Between latitudes
- 56 and 57 degs. south of Cape Horn, the net was put
- astern several times; it never, however, brought up anything
- besides a few of two extremely minute species of Entomostraca.
- Yet whales and seals, petrels and albatross, are exceedingly
- abundant throughout this part of the ocean. It has always
- been a mystery to me on what the albatross, which lives far
- from the shore, can subsist; I presume that, like the condor,
- it is able to fast long; and that one good feast on the carcass
- of a putrid whale lasts for a long time. The central and
- intertropical parts of the Atlantic swarm with Pteropoda,
- Crustacea, and Radiata, and with their devourers the flying-
- fish, and again with their devourers the bonitos and albicores;
- I presume that the numerous lower pelagic animals
- feed on the Infusoria, which are now known, from the
- researches of Ehrenberg, to abound in the open ocean: but
- on what, in the clear blue water, do these Infusoria subsist?
-
- While sailing a little south of the Plata on one very dark
- night, the sea presented a wonderful and most beautiful
- spectacle. There was a fresh breeze, and every part of the
- surface, which during the day is seen as foam, now glowed
- with a pale light. The vessel drove before her bows two
- billows of liquid phosphorus, and in her wake she was followed
- by a milky train. As far as the eye reached, the crest
- of every wave was bright, and the sky above the horizon,
- from the reflected glare of these livid flames, was not so
- utterly obscure as over the vault of the heavens.
-
- As we proceed further southward the sea is seldom
- phosphorescent; and off Cape Horn I do not recollect more than
- once having seen it so, and then it was far from being
- brilliant. This circumstance probably has a close connection
- with the scarcity of organic beings in that part of the ocean.
- After the elaborate paper, [8] by Ehrenberg, on the
- phosphorescence of the sea, it is almost superfluous on my part
- to make any observations on the subject. I may however
- add, that the same torn and irregular particles of gelatinous
- matter, described by Ehrenberg, seem in the southern as
- well as in the northern hemisphere, to be the common cause
- of this phenomenon. The particles were so minute as easily
- to pass through fine gauze; yet many were distinctly visible
- by the naked eye. The water when placed in a tumbler and
- agitated, gave out sparks, but a small portion in a watch-
- glass scarcely ever was luminous. Ehrenberg states that
- these particles all retain a certain degree of irritability. My
- observations, some of which were made directly after taking
- up the water, gave a different result. I may also mention,
- that having used the net during one night, I allowed it to
- become partially dry, and having occasion twelve hours
- afterwards to employ it again, I found the whole surface
- sparkled as brightly as when first taken out of the water.
- It does not appear probable in this case, that the particles
- could have remained so long alive. On one occasion having
- kept a jelly-fish of the genus Dianaea till it was dead, the
- water in which it was placed became luminous. When the
- waves scintillate with bright green sparks, I believe it is
- generally owing to minute crustacea. But there can be no
- doubt that very many other pelagic animals, when alive, are
- phosphorescent.
-
- On two occasions I have observed the sea luminous at
- considerable depths beneath the surface. Near the mouth
- of the Plata some circular and oval patches, from two to
- four yards in diameter, and with defined outlines, shone with
- a steady but pale light; while the surrounding water only
- gave out a few sparks. The appearance resembled the reflection
- of the moon, or some luminous body; for the edges were
- sinuous from the undulations of the surface. The ship,
- which drew thirteen feet of water, passed over, without
- disturbing these patches. Therefore we must suppose that some
- animals were congregated together at a greater depth than
- the bottom of the vessel.
-
- Near Fernando Noronha the sea gave out light in flashes.
- The appearance was very similar to that which might be
- expected from a large fish moving rapidly through a luminous
- fluid. To this cause the sailors attributed it; at the
- time, however, I entertained some doubts, on account of the
- frequency and rapidity of the flashes. I have already
- remarked that the phenomenon is very much more common
- in warm than in cold countries; and I have sometimes imagined
- that a disturbed electrical condition of the atmosphere
- was most favourable to its production. Certainly I
- think the sea is most luminous after a few days of more
- calm weather than ordinary, during which time it has
- swarmed with various animals. Observing that the water
- charged with gelatinous particles is in an impure state, and
- that the luminous appearance in all common cases is produced
- by the agitation of the fluid in contact with the atmosphere,
- I am inclined to consider that the phosphorescence is
- the result of the decomposition of the organic particles, by
- which process (one is tempted almost to call it a kind of
- respiration) the ocean becomes purified.
-
- December 23rd. -- We arrived at Port Desire, situated in
- lat. 47 degs., on the coast of Patagonia. The creek runs for
- about twenty miles inland, with an irregular width. The
- Beagle anchored a few miles within the entrance, in front of
- the ruins of an old Spanish settlement.
-
- The same evening I went on shore. The first landing in
- any new country is very interesting, and especially when, as in
- this case, the whole aspect bears the stamp of a marked and
- individual character. At the height of between two and
- three hundred feet above some masses of porphyry a wide
- plain extends, which is truly characteristic of Patagonia.
- The surface is quite level, and is composed of well-rounded
- shingle mixed with a whitish earth. Here and there scattered
- tufts of brown wiry grass are supported, and still more
- rarely, some low thorny bushes. The weather is dry and
- pleasant, and the fine blue sky is but seldom obscured. When
- standing in the middle of one of these desert plains and
- looking towards the interior, the view is generally bounded
- by the escarpment of another plain, rather higher, but equally
- level and desolate; and in every other direction the horizon
- is indistinct from the trembling mirage which seems to rise
- from the heated surface.
-
- In such a country the fate of the Spanish settlement was
- soon decided; the dryness of the climate during the greater
- part of the year, and the occasional hostile attacks of the
- wandering Indians, compelled the colonists to desert their
- half-finished buildings. The style, however, in which they
- were commenced shows the strong and liberal hand of Spain
- in the old time. The result of all the attempts to colonize this
- side of America south of 41 degs., has been miserable. Port
- Famine expresses by its name the lingering and extreme
- sufferings of several hundred wretched people, of whom one
- alone survived to relate their misfortunes. At St. Joseph's
- Bay, on the coast of Patagonia, a small settlement was made;
- but during one Sunday the Indians made an attack and massacred
- the whole party, excepting two men, who remained
- captives during many years. At the Rio Negro I conversed
- with one of these men, now in extreme old age.
-
- The zoology of Patagonia is as limited as its flora. [9] On
- the arid plains a few black beetles (Heteromera) might be
- seen slowly crawling about, and occasionally a lizard darted
- from side to side. Of birds we have three carrion hawks
- and in the valleys a few finches and insect-feeders. An ibis
- (Theristicus melanops -- a species said to be found in central
- Africa) is not uncommon on the most desert parts: in
- their stomachs I found grasshoppers, cicadae, small lizards,
- and even scorpions. [10] At one time of the year these birds
- go in flocks, at another in pairs, their cry is very loud and
- singular, like the neighing of the guanaco.
-
- The guanaco, or wild llama, is the characteristic quadruped
- of the plains of Patagonia; it is the South American
- representative of the camel of the East. It is an elegant
- animal in a state of nature, with a long slender neck and
- fine legs. It is very common over the whole of the temperate
- parts of the continent, as far south as the islands near Cape
- Horn. It generally lives in small herds of from half a dozen
- to thirty in each; but on the banks of the St. Cruz we saw
- one herd which must have contained at least five hundred.
-
- They are generally wild and extremely wary. Mr. Stokes
- told me, that he one day saw through a glass a herd of these
- animals which evidently had been frightened, and were running
- away at full speed, although their distance was so great
- that he could not distinguish them with his naked eye. The
- sportsman frequently receives the first notice of their
- presence, by hearing from a long distance their peculiar shrill
- neighing note of alarm. If he then looks attentively, he will
- probably see the herd standing in a line on the side of some
- distant hill. On approaching nearer, a few more squeals are
- given, and off they set at an apparently slow, but really quick
- canter, along some narrow beaten track to a neighbouring
- hill. If, however, by chance he abruptly meets a single animal,
- or several together, they will generally stand motionless
- and intently gaze at him; then perhaps move on a few yards,
- turn round, and look again. What is the cause of this difference
- in their shyness? Do they mistake a man in the distance
- for their chief enemy the puma? Or does curiosity
- overcome their timidity? That they are curious is certain;
- for if a person lies on the ground, and plays strange antics,
- such as throwing up his feet in the air, they will almost
- always approach by degrees to reconnoitre him. It was an
- artifice that was repeatedly practised by our sportsmen with
- success, and it had moreover the advantage of allowing several
- shots to be fired, which were all taken as parts of the
- performance. On the mountains of Tierra del Fuego, I have
- more than once seen a guanaco, on being approached, not
- only neigh and squeal, but prance and leap about in the most
- ridiculous manner, apparently in defiance as a challenge.
- These animals are very easily domesticated, and I have seen
- some thus kept in northern Patagonia near a house, though
- not under any restraint. They are in this state very bold, and
- readily attack a man by striking him from behind with both
- knees. It is asserted that the motive for these attacks is
- jealousy on account of their females. The wild guanacos,
- however, have no idea of defence; even a single dog will
- secure one of these large animals, till the huntsman can come
- up. In many of their habits they are like sheep in a flock.
- Thus when they see men approaching in several directions
- on horseback, they soon become bewildered, and know not
- which way to run. This greatly facilitates the Indian method
- of hunting, for they are thus easily driven to a central point,
- and are encompassed.
-
- The guanacos readily take to the water: several times at
- Port Valdes they were seen swimming from island to island.
- Byron, in his voyage says he saw them drinking salt water.
- Some of our officers likewise saw a herd apparently drinking
- the briny fluid from a salina near Cape Blanco. I imagine
- in several parts of the country, if they do not drink salt
- water, they drink none at all. In the middle of the day they
- frequently roll in the dust, in saucer-shaped hollows. The
- males fight together; two one day passed quite close to me,
- squealing and trying to bite each other; and several were
- shot with their hides deeply scored. Herds sometimes appear
- to set out on exploring parties: at Bahia Blanca, where,
- within thirty miles of the coast, these animals are extremely
- unfrequent, I one day saw the tracks of thirty or forty, which
- had come in a direct line to a muddy salt-water creek. They
- then must have perceived that they were approaching the
- sea, for they had wheeled with the regularity of cavalry, and
- had returned back in as straight a line as they had advanced.
- The guanacos have one singular habit, which is to me quite
- inexplicable; namely, that on successive days they drop their
- dung in the same defined heap. I saw one of these heaps
- which was eight feet in diameter, and was composed of a
- large quantity. This habit, according to M. A. d'Orbigny, is
- common to all the species of the genus; it is very useful to
- the Peruvian Indians, who use the dung for fuel, and are
- thus saved the trouble of collecting it.
-
- The guanacos appear to have favourite spots for lying
- down to die. On the banks of the St. Cruz, in certain
- circumscribed spaces, which were generally bushy and all near
- the river, the ground was actually white with bones. On one
- such spot I counted between ten and twenty heads. I particularly
- examined the bones; they did not appear, as some
- scattered ones which I had seen, gnawed or broken, as if
- dragged together by beasts of prey. The animals in most
- cases must have crawled, before dying, beneath and amongst
- the bushes. Mr. Bynoe informs me that during a former
- voyage he observed the same circumstance on the banks of
- the Rio Gallegos. I do not at all understand the reason of
- this, but I may observe, that the wounded guanacos at the
- St. Cruz invariably walked towards the river. At St. Jago
- in the Cape de Verd Islands, I remember having seen in a
- ravine a retired corner covered with bones of the goat; we
- at the time exclaimed that it was the burial ground of all the
- goats in the island. I mention these trifling circumstances,
- because in certain cases they might explain the occurrence
- of a number of uninjured bones in a cave, or buried under
- alluvial accumulations; and likewise the cause why certain
- animals are more commonly embedded than others in sedimentary
- deposits.
-
- One day the yawl was sent under the command of Mr.
- Chaffers with three days' provisions to survey the upper part
- of the harbour. In the morning we searched for some
- watering-places mentioned in an old Spanish chart. We found one
- creek, at the head of which there was a trickling rill (the
- first we had seen) of brackish water. Here the tide compelled
- us to wait several hours; and in the interval I walked
- some miles into the interior. The plain as usual consisted
- of gravel, mingled with soil resembling chalk in appearance,
- but very different from it in nature. From the softness of
- these materials it was worn into many gulleys. There was
- not a tree, and, excepting the guanaco, which stood on the
- hill-top a watchful sentinel over its herd, scarcely an animal
- or a bird. All was stillness and desolation. Yet in passing
- over these scenes, without one bright object near, an
- ill-defined but strong sense of pleasure is vividly excited.
- One asked how many ages the plain had thus lasted, and how
- many more it was doomed thus to continue.
-
- "None can reply -- all seems eternal now.
- The wilderness has a mysterious tongue,
- Which teaches awful doubt." [11]
-
- In the evening we sailed a few miles further up, and then
- pitched the tents for the night. By the middle of the next
- day the yawl was aground, and from the shoalness of the
- water could not proceed any higher. The water being found
- partly fresh, Mr. Chaffers took the dingey and went up two
- or three miles further, where she also grounded, but in a
- fresh-water river. The water was muddy, and though the
- stream was most insignificant in size, it would be difficult to
- account for its origin, except from the melting snow on the
- Cordillera. At the spot where we bivouacked, we were surrounded
- by bold cliffs and steep pinnacles of porphyry. I do
- not think I ever saw a spot which appeared more secluded
- from the rest of the world, than this rocky crevice in the
- wide plain.
-
- The second day after our return to the anchorage, a party
- of officers and myself went to ransack an old Indian grave,
- which I had found on the summit of a neighbouring hill.
- Two immense stones, each probably weighing at least a
- couple of tons, had been placed in front of a ledge of rock
- about six feet high. At the bottom of the grave on the hard
- rock there was a layer of earth about a foot deep, which
- must have been brought up from the plain below. Above it a
- pavement of flat stones was placed, on which others were
- piled, so as to fill up the space between the ledge and the two
- great blocks. To complete the grave, the Indians had contrived
- to detach from the ledge a huge fragment, and to
- throw it over the pile so as to rest on the two blocks. We
- undermined the grave on both sides, but could not find any
- relics, or even bones. The latter probably had decayed long
- since (in which case the grave must have been of extreme
- antiquity), for I found in another place some smaller heaps
- beneath which a very few crumbling fragments could yet be
- distinguished as having belonged to a man. Falconer states,
- that where an Indian dies he is buried, but that subsequently
- his bones are carefully taken up and carried, let the distance
- be ever so great, to be deposited near the sea-coast. This
- custom, I think, may be accounted for by recollecting, that
- before the introduction of horses, these Indians must have
- led nearly the same life as the Fuegians now do, and therefore
- generally have resided in the neighbourhood of the sea.
- The common prejudice of lying where one's ancestors have
- lain, would make the now roaming Indians bring the less
- perishable part of their dead to their ancient burial-ground
- on the coast.
-
- January 9th, 1834. -- Before it was dark the Beagle anchored
- in the fine spacious harbour of Port St. Julian, situated
- about one hundred and ten miles to the south of Port Desire.
- We remained here eight days. The country is nearly similar
- to that of Port Desire, but perhaps rather more sterile. One
- day a party accompanied Captain Fitz Roy on a long walk
- round the head of the harbour. We were eleven hours without
- tasting any water, and some of the party were quite
- exhausted. From the summit of a hill (since well named
- Thirsty Hill) a fine lake was spied, and two of the party
- proceeded with concerted signals to show whether it was fresh
- water. What was our disappointment to find a snow-white
- expanse of salt, crystallized in great cubes! We attributed
- our extreme thirst to the dryness of the atmosphere; but
- whatever the cause might be, we were exceedingly glad late
- in the evening to get back to the boats. Although we could
- nowhere find, during our whole visit, a single drop of fresh
- water, yet some must exist; for by an odd chance I found on
- the surface of the salt water, near the head of the bay, a
- Colymbetes not quite dead, which must have lived in some
- not far distant pool. Three other insects (a Cincindela, like
- hybrida, a Cymindis, and a Harpalus, which all live on muddy
- flats occasionally overflowed by the sea), and one other
- found dead on the plain, complete the list of the beetles. A
- good-sized fly (Tabanus) was extremely numerous, and tormented
- us by its painful bite. The common horsefly, which
- is so troublesome in the shady lanes of England, belongs to
- this same genus. We here have the puzzle that so frequently
- occurs in the case of musquitoes -- on the blood of what
- animals do these insects commonly feed? The guanaco is
- nearly the only warm-blooded quadruped, and it is found in
- quite inconsiderable numbers compared with the multitude
- of flies.
-
- The geology of Patagonia is interesting. Differently from
- Europe, where the tertiary formations appear to have accumulated
- in bays, here along hundreds of miles of coast we
- have one great deposit, including many tertiary shells, all
- apparently extinct. The most common shell is a massive
- gigantic oyster, sometimes even a foot in diameter. These
- beds are covered by others of a peculiar soft white stone,
- including much gypsum, and resembling chalk, but really of
- a pumiceous nature. It is highly remarkable, from being
- composed, to at least one-tenth of its bulk, of Infusoria.
- Professor Ehrenberg has already ascertained in it thirty
- oceanic forms. This bed extends for 500 miles along the coast,
- and probably for a considerably greater distance. At Port
- St. Julian its thickness is more than 800 feet! These white
- beds are everywhere capped by a mass of gravel, forming
- probably one of the largest beds of shingle in the world: it
- certainly extends from near the Rio Colorado to between 600
- and 700 nautical miles southward, at Santa Cruz (a river a
- little south of St. Julian), it reaches to the foot of the
- Cordillera; half way up the river, its thickness is more than
- 200 feet; it probably everywhere extends to this great chain,
- whence the well-rounded pebbles of porphyry have been
- derived: we may consider its average breadth as 200 miles,
- and its average thickness as about 50 feet. If this great bed
- of pebbles, without including the mud necessarily derived
- from their attrition, was piled into a mound, it would form a
- great mountain chain! When we consider that all these
- pebbles, countless as the grains of sand in the desert, have
- been derived from the slow falling of masses of rock on the
- old coast-lines and banks of rivers, and that these fragments
- have been dashed into smaller pieces, and that each of them
- has since been slowly rolled, rounded, and far transported
- the mind is stupefied in thinking over the long, absolutely
- necessary, lapse of years. Yet all this gravel has been
- transported, and probably rounded, subsequently to the
- deposition of the white beds, and long subsequently to the
- underlying beds with the tertiary shells.
-
- Everything in this southern continent has been effected
- on a grand scale: the land, from the Rio Plata to Tierra del
- Fuego, a distance of 1200 miles, has been raised in mass (and
- in Patagonia to a height of between 300 and 400 feet), within
- the period of the now existing sea-shells. The old and
- weathered shells left on the surface of the upraised plain still
- partially retain their colours. The uprising movement has
- been interrupted by at least eight long periods of rest, during
- which the sea ate, deeply back into the land, forming at
- successive levels the long lines of cliffs, or escarpments,
- which separate the different plains as they rise like steps one
- behind the other. The elevatory movement, and the eating-back
- power of the sea during the periods of rest, have been
- equable over long lines of coast; for I was astonished to
- find that the step-like plains stand at nearly corresponding
- heights at far distant points. The lowest plain is 90 feet
- high; and the highest, which I ascended near the coast, is
- 950 feet; and of this, only relics are left in the form of flat
- gravel-capped hills. The upper plain of Santa Cruz slopes
- up to a height of 3000 feet at the foot of the Cordillera. I
- have said that within the period of existing sea-shells,
- Patagonia has been upraised 300 to 400 feet: I may add, that
- within the period when icebergs transported boulders over
- the upper plain of Santa Cruz, the elevation has been at least
- 1500 feet. Nor has Patagonia been affected only by upward
- movements: the extinct tertiary shells from Port St. Julian
- and Santa Cruz cannot have lived, according to Professor E.
- Forbes, in a greater depth of water than from 40 to 250 feet;
- but they are now covered with sea-deposited strata from 800
- to 1000 feet in thickness: hence the bed of the sea, on which
- these shells once lived, must have sunk downwards several
- hundred feet, to allow of the accumulation of the superincumbent
- strata. What a history of geological changes does the
- simply-constructed coast of Patagonia reveal!
-
- At Port St. Julian, [12] in some red mud capping the gravel
- on the 90-feet plain, I found half the skeleton of the
- Macrauchenia Patachonica, a remarkable quadruped, full as large
- as a camel. It belongs to the same division of the Pachydermata
- with the rhinoceros, tapir, and palaeotherium; but
- in the structure of the bones of its long neck it shows a clear
- relation to the camel, or rather to the guanaco and llama.
- From recent sea-shells being found on two of the higher
- step-formed plains, which must have been modelled and
- upraised before the mud was deposited in which the Macrauchenia
- was entombed, it is certain that this curious quadruped
- lived long after the sea was inhabited by its present
- shells. I was at first much surprised how a large quadruped
- could so lately have subsisted, in lat. 49 degs. 15', on these
- wretched gravel plains, with their stunted vegetation; but
- the relationship of the Macrauchenia to the Guanaco, now
- an inhabitant of the most sterile parts, partly explains this
- difficulty.
-
- The relationship, though distant, between the Macrauchenia
- and the Guanaco, between the Toxodon and the
- Capybara, -- the closer relationship between the many extinct
- Edentata and the living sloths, ant-eaters, and armadillos,
- now so eminently characteristic of South American zoology,
- -- and the still closer relationship between the fossil and
- living species of Ctenomys and Hydrochaerus, are most
- interesting facts. This relationship is shown wonderfully -- as
- wonderfully as between the fossil and extinct Marsupial
- animals of Australia -- by the great collection lately brought
- to Europe from the caves of Brazil by MM. Lund and Clausen.
- In this collection there are extinct species of all the
- thirty-two genera, excepting four, of the terrestrial quadrupeds
- now inhabiting the provinces in which the caves occur;
- and the extinct species are much more numerous than those
- now living: there are fossil ant-eaters, armadillos, tapirs,
- peccaries, guanacos, opossums, and numerous South American
- gnawers and monkeys, and other animals. This wonderful
- relationship in the same continent between the dead and
- the living, will, I do not doubt, hereafter throw more light
- on the appearance of organic beings on our earth, and their
- disappearance from it, than any other class of facts.
-
- It is impossible to reflect on the changed state of the
- American continent without the deepest astonishment. Formerly
- it must have swarmed with great monsters: now we
- find mere pigmies, compared with the antecedent, allied
- races. If Buffon had known of the gigantic sloth and
- armadillo-like animals, and of the lost Pachydermata, he might
- have said with a greater semblance of truth that the creative
- force in America had lost its power, rather than that it had
- never possessed great vigour. The greater number, if not all,
- of these extinct quadrupeds lived at a late period, and were
- the contemporaries of most of the existing sea-shells. Since
- they lived, no very great change in the form of the land can
- have taken place. What, then, has exterminated so many
- species and whole genera? The mind at first is irresistibly
- hurried into the belief of some great catastrophe; but thus
- to destroy animals, both large and small, in Southern Patagonia,
- in Brazil, on the Cordillera of Peru, in North America
- up to Behring's Straits, we must shake the entire framework
- of the globe. An examination, moreover, of the geology of
- La Plata and Patagonia, leads to the belief that all the
- features of the land result from slow and gradual changes. It
- appears from the character of the fossils in Europe, Asia,
- Australia, and in North and South America, that those conditions
- which favour the life of the _larger_ quadrupeds were
- lately co-extensive with the world: what those conditions
- were, no one has yet even conjectured. It could hardly have
- been a change of temperature, which at about the same time
- destroyed the inhabitants of tropical, temperate, and arctic
- latitudes on both sides of the globe. In North America we
- positively know from Mr. Lyell, that the large quadrupeds
- lived subsequently to that period, when boulders were
- brought into latitudes at which icebergs now never arrive:
- from conclusive but indirect reasons we may feel sure, that
- in the southern hemisphere the Macrauchenia, also, lived
- long subsequently to the ice-transporting boulder-period. Did
- man, after his first inroad into South America, destroy, as
- has been suggested, the unwieldy Megatherium and the
- other Edentata? We must at least look to some other cause
- for the destruction of the little tucutuco at Bahia Blanca, and
- of the many fossil mice and other small quadrupeds in
- Brazil. No one will imagine that a drought, even far severer
- than those which cause such losses in the provinces of La
- Plata, could destroy every individual of every species from
- Southern Patagonia to Behring's Straits. What shall we say
- of the extinction of the horse? Did those plains fail of
- pasture, which have since been overrun by thousands and hundreds
- of thousands of the descendants of the stock introduced
- by the Spaniards? Have the subsequently introduced
- species consumed the food of the great antecedent races?
- Can we believe that the Capybara has taken the food of the
- Toxodon, the Guanaco of the Macrauchenia, the existing
- small Edentata of their numerous gigantic prototypes? Certainly,
- no fact in the long history of the world is so startling
- as the wide and repeated exterminations of its inhabitants.
-
- Nevertheless, if we consider the subject under another
- point of view, it will appear less perplexing. We do not
- steadily bear in mind, how profoundly ignorant we are of the
- conditions of existence of every animal; nor do we always
- remember, that some check is constantly preventing the too
- rapid increase of every organized being left in a state of
- nature. The supply of food, on an average, remains constant, yet
- the tendency in every animal to increase by propagation is
- geometrical; and its surprising effects have nowhere been
- more astonishingly shown, than in the case of the European
- animals run wild during the last few centuries in America.
- Every animal in a state of nature regularly breeds; yet in a
- species long established, any _great_ increase in numbers is
- obviously impossible, and must be checked by some means.
- We are, nevertheless, seldom able with certainty to tell in
- any given species, at what period of life, or at what period
- of the year, or whether only at long intervals, the check
- falls; or, again, what is the precise nature of the check.
- Hence probably it is, that we feel so little surprise at one, of
- two species closely allied in habits, being rare and the other
- abundant in the same district; or, again, that one should be
- abundant in one district, and another, filling the same place
- in the economy of nature, should be abundant in a neighbouring
- district, differing very little in its conditions. If asked
- how this is, one immediately replies that it is determined by
- some slight difference, in climate, food, or the number of
- enemies: yet how rarely, if ever, we can point out the precise
- cause and manner of action of the check! We are
- therefore, driven to the conclusion, that causes generally
- quite inappreciable by us, determine whether a given species
- shall be abundant or scanty in numbers.
-
- In the cases where we can trace the extinction of a
- species through man, either wholly or in one limited district,
- we know that it becomes rarer and rarer, and is then lost:
- it would be difficult to point out any just distinction [13]
- between a species destroyed by man or by the increase of its
- natural enemies. The evidence of rarity preceding extinction,
- is more striking in the successive tertiary strata, as remarked
- by several able observers; it has often been found that a shell
- very common in a tertiary stratum is now most rare, and has
- even long been thought extinct. If then, as appears probable,
- species first become rare and then extinct -- if the too rapid
- increase of every species, even the most favoured, is steadily
- checked, as we must admit, though how and when it is hard to
- say -- and if we see, without the smallest surprise, though
- unable to assign the precise reason, one species abundant
- and another closely allied species rare in the same district --
- why should we feel such great astonishment at the rarity being
- carried one step further to extinction? An action going on,
- on every side of us, and yet barely appreciable, might surely
- be carried a little further, without exciting our observation.
- Who would feel any great surprise at hearing that the Magalonyx
- was formerly rare compared with the Megatherium, or that one of
- the fossil monkeys was few in number compared with one of the
- now living monkeys? and yet in this comparative rarity, we
- should have the plainest evidence of less favourable conditions
- for their existence. To admit that species generally become
- rare before they become extinct -- to feel no surprise at the
- comparative rarity of one species with another, and yet to
- call in some extraordinary agent and to marvel greatly when
- a species ceases to exist, appears to me much the same as
- to admit that sickness in the individual is the prelude to
- death -- to feel no surprise at sickness -- but when the
- sick man dies to wonder, and to believe that he died through
- violence.
-
- [1] Mr. Waterhouse has drawn up a detailed description of this
- head, which I hope he will publish in some Journal.
-
- [2] A nearly similar abnormal, but I do not know whether
- hereditary, structure has been observed in the carp, and
- likewise in the crocodile of the Ganges: Histoire des Anomalies,
- par M. Isid. Geoffroy St. Hilaire, tom. i. p. 244.
-
- [3] M. A. d'Orbigny has given nearly a similar account of these
- dogs, tom. i. p. 175.
-
- [4] I must express my obligations to Mr. Keane, at whose house
- I was staying on the Berquelo, and to Mr. Lumb at Buenos Ayres,
- for without their assistance these valuable remains would never
- have reached England.
-
- [5] Lyell's Principles of Geology, vol. iii. p. 63.
-
- [6] The flies which frequently accompany a ship for some days
- on its passage from harbour to harbour, wandering from the
- vessel, are soon lost, and all disappear.
-
- [7] Mr. Blackwall, in his Researches in Zoology, has many
- excellent observations on the habits of spiders.
-
- [8] An abstract is given in No. IV. of the Magazine of Zoology
- and Botany.
-
- [9] I found here a species of cactus, described by Professor
- Henslow, under the name of Opuntia Darwinii (Magazine of
- Zoology and Botany, vol. i. p. 466), which was remarkable
- for the irritability of the stamens, when I inserted either a
- piece of stick or the end of my finger in the flower. The
- segments of the perianth also closed on the pistil, but more
- slowly than the stamens. Plants of this family, generally
- considered as tropical, occur in North America (Lewis and
- Clarke's Travels, p. 221), in the same high latitude as here,
- namely, in both cases, in 47 degs.
-
- [10] These insects were not uncommon beneath stones. I found
- one cannibal scorpion quietly devouring another.
-
- [11] Shelley, Lines on Mt. Blanc.
-
- [12] I have lately heard that Capt. Sulivan, R.N., has found
- numerous fossil bones, embedded in regular strata, on the banks
- of the R. Gallegos, in lat. 51 degs. 4'. Some of the bones
- are large; others are small, and appear to have belonged to
- an armadillo. This is a most interesting and important
- discovery.
-
- [13] See the excellent remarks on this subject by Mr. Lyell,
- in his Principles of Geology.
-
-
-
- CHAPTER IX
-
- SANTA CRUZ, PATAGONIA, AND THE FALKLAND ISLANDS
-
- Santa Cruz -- Expedition up the River -- Indians -- Immense
- Streams of Basaltic Lava -- Fragments not transported by the
- River -- Excavations of the Valley -- Condor, Habits of --
- Cordillera -- Erratic Boulders of great size -- Indian Relics --
- Return to the Ship -- Falkland Islands -- Wild Horses, Cattle,
- Rabbits -- Wolf-like Fox -- Fire made of Bones -- Manner of
- Hunting Wild Cattle -- Geology -- Streams of Stones -- Scenes
- of Violence -- Penguins -- Geese -- Eggs of Doris -- Compound
- Animals.
-
-
- APRIL 13, 1834. -- The Beagle anchored within the mouth of the
- Santa Cruz. This river is situated about sixty miles south of
- Port St. Julian. During the last voyage Captain Stokes proceeded
- thirty miles up it, but then, from the want of provisions, was
- obliged to return. Excepting what was discovered at that time,
- scarcely anything was known about this large river. Captain Fitz
- Roy now determined to follow its course as far as time would
- allow. On the 18th three whale-boats started, carrying three
- weeks' provisions; and the party consisted of twenty-five
- souls -- a force which would have been sufficient to have
- defied a host of Indians. With a strong flood-tide and a fine
- day we made a good run, soon drank some of the fresh water,
- and were at night nearly above the tidal influence.
-
- The river here assumed a size and appearance which, even at
- the highest point we ultimately reached, was scarcely
- diminished. It was generally from three to four hundred yards
- broad, and in the middle about seventeen feet deep. The
- rapidity of the current, which in its whole course runs at
- the rate of from four to six knots an hour, is perhaps its
- most remarkable feature. The water is of a fine blue colour,
- but with a slight milky tinge, and not so transparent as at
- first sight would have been expected. It flows over a bed of
- pebbles, like those which compose the beach and the surrounding
- plains. It runs in a winding course through
- valley, which extends in a direct line westward. This valle
- varies from five to ten miles in breadth; it is bounded b
- step-formed terraces, which rise in most parts, one above th
- other, to the height of five hundred feet, and have on th
- opposite sides a remarkable correspondence.
-
- April 19th. -- Against so strong a current it was, o
- course, quite impossible to row or sail: consequently th
- three boats were fastened together head and stern, two hand
- left in each, and the rest came on shore to track. As th
- general arrangements made by Captain Fitz Roy were ver
- good for facilitating the work of all, and as all had a shar
- in it, I will describe the system. The party including ever
- one, was divided into two spells, each of which hauled at th
- tracking line alternately for an hour and a half. The officers
- of each boat lived with, ate the same food, and slep
- in the same tent with their crew, so that each boat wa
- quite independent of the others. After sunset the first leve
- spot where any bushes were growing, was chosen for ou
- night's lodging. Each of the crew took it in turns to b
- cook. Immediately the boat was hauled up, the cook mad
- his fire; two others pitched the tent; the coxswain hande
- the things out of the boat; the rest carried them up to th
- tents and collected firewood. By this order, in half an hou
- everything was ready for the night. A watch of two me
- and an officer was always kept, whose duty it was to loo
- after the boats, keep up the fire, and guard against Indians
- Each in the party had his one hour every night.
-
- During this day we tracked but a short distance, for ther
- were many islets, covered by thorny bushes, and the channels
- between them were shallow.
-
- April 20th. -- We passed the islands and set to work. Ou
- regular day's march, although it was hard enough, carrie
- us on an average only ten miles in a straight line, and perhaps
- fifteen or twenty altogether. Beyond the place wher
- we slept last night, the country is completely _terra incognita_
- for it was there that Captain Stokes turned back. We sa
- in the distance a great smoke, and found the skeleton of
- horse, so we knew that Indians were in the neighbourhood
- On the next morning (21st) tracks of a party of horse
- and marks left by the trailing of the chuzos, or long spears
- were observed on the ground. It was generally though
- that the Indians had reconnoitred us during the night
- Shortly afterwards we came to a spot where, from the fres
- footsteps of men, children, and horses, it was evident tha
- the party had crossed the river.
-
- April 22nd. -- The country remained the same, and wa
- extremely uninteresting. The complete similarity of th
- productions throughout Patagonia is one of its most striking
- characters. The level plains of arid shingle suppor
- the same stunted and dwarf plants; and in the valleys th
- same thorn-bearing bushes grow. Everywhere we see th
- same birds and insects. Even the very banks of the rive
- and of the clear streamlets which entered it, were scarcel
- enlivened by a brighter tint of green. The curse of sterilit
- is on the land, and the water flowing over a bed of pebble
- partakes of the same curse. Hence the number of waterfowl
- is very scanty; for there is nothing to support life i
- the stream of this barren river.
-
- Patagonia, poor as she is in some respects, can howeve
- boast of a greater stock of small rodents [1] than perhaps an
- other country in the world. Several species of mice ar
- externally characterized by large thin ears and a very fin
- fur. These little animals swarm amongst the thickets in th
- valleys, where they cannot for months together taste a dro
- of water excepting the dew. They all seem to be cannibals
- for no sooner was a mouse caught in one of my traps tha
- it was devoured by others. A small and delicately shape
- fox, which is likewise very abundant, probably derives it
- entire support from these small animals. The guanaco i
- also in his proper district, herds of fifty or a hundred wer
- common; and, as I have stated, we saw one which mus
- have contained at least five hundred. The puma, with th
- condor and other carrion-hawks in its train, follows an
- preys upon these animals. The footsteps of the puma wer
- to be seen almost everywhere on the banks of the river
- and the remains of several guanacos, with their neck
- dislocated and bones broken, showed how they had met thei
- death.
-
- April 24th. -- Like the navigators of old when approachin
- an unknown land, we examined and watched for the mos
- trivial sign of a change. The drifted trunk of a tree, or
- boulder of primitive rock, was hailed with joy, as if we ha
- seen a forest growing on the flanks of the Cordillera. Th
- top, however, of a heavy bank of clouds, which remaine
- almost constantly in one position, was the most promisin
- sign, and eventually turned out a true harbinger. At first th
- clouds were mistaken for the mountains themselves, instea
- of the masses of vapour condensed by their icy summits.
-
- April 26th. -- We this day met with a marked change i
- the geological structure of the plains. From the first starting
- I had carefully examined the gravel in the river, an
- for the two last days had noticed the presence of a few smal
- pebbles of a very cellular basalt. These gradually increase
- in number and in size, but none were as large as a man'
- head. This morning, however, pebbles of the same rock
- but more compact, suddenly became abundant, and in th
- course of half an hour we saw, at the distance of five o
- six miles, the angular edge of a great basaltic platform
- When we arrived at its base we found the stream bubblin
- among the fallen blocks. For the next twenty-eight mile
- the river-course was encumbered with these basaltic masses
- Above that limit immense fragments of primitive rocks
- derived from its surrounding boulder-formation, wer
- equally numerous. None of the fragments of any considerable
- size had been washed more than three or four mile
- down the river below their parent-source: considering th
- singular rapidity of the great body of water in the Sant
- Cruz, and that no still reaches occur in any part, this example
- is a most striking one, of the inefficiency of rivers i
- transporting even moderately-sized fragments.
-
- The basalt is only lava, which has flowed beneath the sea
- but the eruptions must have been on the grandest scale. A
- the point where we first met this formation it was 120 fee
- in thickness; following up the river course, the surfac
- imperceptibly rose and the mass became thicker, so that a
- forty miles above the first station it was 320 feet thick
- What the thickness may be close to the Cordillera, I hav
- no means of knowing, but the platform there attains a heigh
- of about three thousand feet above the level of the sea
- we must therefore look to the mountains of that great chai
- for its source; and worthy of such a source are streams tha
- have flowed over the gently inclined bed of the sea to
- distance of one hundred miles. At the first glance of th
- basaltic cliffs on the opposite sides of the valley, it wa
- evident that the strata once were united. What power, then
- has removed along a whole line of country, a solid mass o
- very hard rock, which had an average thickness of nearl
- three hundred feet, and a breadth varying from rather les
- than two miles to four miles? The river, though it has s
- little power in transporting even inconsiderable fragments
- yet in the lapse of ages might produce by its gradual erosio
- an effect of which it is difficult to judge the amount. Bu
- in this case, independently of the insignificance of such a
- agency, good reasons can be assigned for believing that thi
- valley was formerly occupied by an arm of the sea. It i
- needless in this work to detail the arguments leading to thi
- conclusion, derived from the form and the nature of th
- step-formed terraces on both sides of the valley, from th
- manner in which the bottom of the valley near the Ande
- expands into a great estuary-like plain with sand-hillock
- on it, and from the occurrence of a few sea-shells lying i
- the bed of the river. If I had space I could prove tha
- South America was formerly here cut off by a strait, joinin
- the Atlantic and Pacific oceans, like that of Magellan
- But it may yet be asked, how has the solid basalt bee
- moved? Geologists formerly would have brought into play
- the violent action of some overwhelming debacle; but in thi
- case such a supposition would have been quite inadmissible
- because, the same step-like plains with existing sea-shell
- lying on their surface, which front the long line of the
- Patagonian coast, sweep up on each side of the valley of Sant
- Cruz. No possible action of any flood could thus hav
- modelled the land, either within the valley or along the ope
- coast; and by the formation of such step-like plains or terraces
- the valley itself had been hollowed out. Although w
- know that there are tides, which run within the Narrow
- of the Strait of Magellan at the rate of eight knots an hour
- yet we must confess that it makes the head almost giddy t
- reflect on the number of years, century after century, whic
- the tides, unaided by a heavy surf, must have required t
- have corroded so vast an area and thickness of solid basalti
- lava. Nevertheless, we must believe that the strata undermined
- by the waters of this ancient strait, were broken u
- into huge fragments, and these lying scattered on the beach
- were reduced first to smaller blocks, then to pebbles an
- lastly to the most impalpable mud, which the tides drifte
- far into the Eastern or Western Ocean.
-
- With the change in the geological structure of the plain
- the character of the landscape likewise altered. While rambling
- up some of the narrow and rocky defiles, I could almos
- have fancied myself transported back again to the barre
- valleys of the island of St. Jago. Among the basaltic cliffs
- I found some plants which I had seen nowhere else, bu
- others I recognised as being wanderers from Tierra de
- Fuego. These porous rocks serve as a reservoir for th
- scanty rain-water; and consequently on the line where th
- igneous and sedimentary formations unite, some smal
- springs (most rare occurrences in Patagonia) burst forth
- and they could be distinguished at a distance by the
- circumscribed patches of bright green herbage.
-
- April 27th. -- The bed of the river became rather narrower
- and hence the stream more rapid. It here ran at the rat
- of six knots an hour. From this cause, and from the man
- great angular fragments, tracking the boats became bot
- dangerous and laborious
-
-
- This day I shot a condor. It measured from tip to ti
- of the wings, eight and a half feet, and from beak to tail
- four feet. This bird is known to have a wide geographica
- range, being found on the west coast of South America
- from the Strait of Magellan along the Cordillera as far a
- eight degrees north of the equator. The steep cliff near th
- mouth of the Rio Negro is its northern limit on the Patagonian
- coast; and they have there wandered about fou
- hundred miles from the great central line of their habitation
- in the Andes. Further south, among the bold precipices
- at the head of Port Desire, the condor is not uncommon;
- yet only a few stragglers occasionally visit the seacoast.
- A line of cliff near the mouth of the Santa Cruz i
- frequented by these birds, and about eighty miles up th
- river, where the sides of the valley are formed by stee
- basaltic precipices, the condor reappears. From these facts
- it seems that the condors require perpendicular cliffs. I
- Chile, they haunt, during the greater part of the year, th
- lower country near the shores of the Pacific, and at nigh
- several roost together in one tree; but in the early part o
- summer, they retire to the most inaccessible parts of th
- inner Cordillera, there to breed in peace.
-
- With respect to their propagation, I was told by th
- country people in Chile, that the condor makes no sort o
- nest, but in the months of November and December lay
- two large white eggs on a shelf of bare rock. It is said tha
- the young condors cannot fly for an entire year; and lon
- after they are able, they continue to roost by night, an
- hunt by day with their parents. The old birds generally liv
- in pairs; but among the inland basaltic cliffs of the Sant
- Cruz, I found a spot, where scores must usually haunt. O
- coming suddenly to the brow of the precipice, it was a gran
- spectacle to see between twenty and thirty of these grea
- birds start heavily from their resting-place, and wheel awa
- in majestic circles. From the quantity of dung on the rocks
- they must long have frequented this cliff for roosting an
- breeding. Having gorged themselves with carrion on th
- plains below, they retire to these favourite ledges to diges
- their food. From these facts, the condor, like the gallinazo
- must to a certain degree be considered as a gregarious bird
- In this part of the country they live altogether on the guanacos
- which have died a natural death, or as more commonl
- happens, have been killed by the pumas. I believe, fro
- what I saw in Patagonia, that they do not on ordinary occasions
- extend their daily excursions to any great distanc
- from their regular sleeping-places.
-
- The condors may oftentimes be seen at a great height
- soaring over a certain spot in the most graceful circles
- On some occasions I am sure that they do this only fo
- pleasure, but on others, the Chileno countryman tells yo
- that they are watching a dying animal, or the puma devouring
- its prey. If the condors glide down, and then suddenl
- all rise together, the Chileno knows that it is the pum
- which, watching the carcass, has sprung out to drive awa
- the robbers. Besides feeding on carrion, the condors frequently
- attack young goats and lambs; and the shepherd-dogs
- are trained, whenever they pass over, to run out, an
- looking upwards to bark violently. The Chilenos destro
- and catch numbers. Two methods are used; one is to plac
- a carcass on a level piece of ground within an enclosure o
- sticks with an opening, and when the condors are gorged
- to gallop up on horseback to the entrance, and thus enclos
- them: for when this bird has not space to run, it canno
- give its body sufficient momentum to rise from the ground
- The second method is to mark the trees in which, frequentl
- to the number of five or six together, they roost, and the
- at night to climb up and noose them. They are such heav
- sleepers, as I have myself witnessed, that this is not a
- difficult task. At Valparaiso, I have seen a living condor sol
- for sixpence, but the common price is eight or ten shillings
- One which I saw brought in, had been tied with rope, an
- was much injured; yet, the moment the line was cut b
- which its bill was secured, although surrounded by people
- it began ravenously to tear a piece of carrion. In a garde
- at the same place, between twenty and thirty were kept alive
- They were fed only once a week, but they appeared in prett
- good health. [2] The Chileno countrymen assert that the condor
- will live, and retain its vigour, between five and six week
- without eating: I cannot answer for the truth of this, bu
- it is a cruel experiment, which very likely has been tried.
-
- When an animal is killed in the country, it is well know
- that the condors, like other carrion-vultures, soon gain
- intelligence of it, and congregate in an inexplicable manner
- In most cases it must not be overlooked, that the bird
- have discovered their prey, and have picked the skeleto
- clean, before the flesh is in the least degree tainted.
- Remembering the experiments of M. Audubon, on the littl
- smelling powers of carrion-hawks, I tried in the above
- mentioned garden the following experiment: the condor
- were tied, each by a rope, in a long row at the bottom of
- wall; and having folded up a piece of meat in white paper,
- walked backwards and forwards, carrying it in my hand a
- the distance of about three yards from them, but no notic
- whatever was taken. I then threw it on the ground, withi
- one yard of an old male bird; he looked at it for a momen
- with attention, but then regarded it no more. With a stic
- I pushed it closer and closer, until at last he touched it wit
- his beak; the paper was then instantly torn off with fury
- and at the same moment, every bird in the long row bega
- struggling and flapping its wings. Under the same circumstances,
- it would have been quite impossible to have deceive
- a dog. The evidence in favour of and against the acut
- smelling powers of carrion-vultures is singularly balanced
- Professor Owen has demonstrated that the olfactory nerve
- of the turkey-buzzard (Cathartes aura) are highly developed,
- and on the evening when Mr. Owen's paper was rea
- at the Zoological Society, it was mentioned by a gentlema
- that he had seen the carrion-hawks in the West Indies o
- two occasions collect on the roof of a house, when a corps
- had become offensive from not having been buried, in thi
- case, the intelligence could hardly have been acquired b
- sight. On the other hand, besides the experiments of Audubon
- and that one by myself, Mr. Bachman has tried in th
- United States many varied plans, showing that neither th
- turkey-buzzard (the species dissected by Professor Owen
- nor the gallinazo find their food by smell. He covered portions
- of highly-offensive offal with a thin canvas cloth, an
- strewed pieces of meat on it: these the carrion-vultures at
- up, and then remained quietly standing, with their beak
- within the eighth of an inch of the putrid mass, withou
- discovering it. A small rent was made in the canvas, an
- the offal was immediately discovered; the canvas was replaced
- by a fresh piece, and meat again put on it, and wa
- again devoured by the vultures without their discoverin
- the hidden mass on which they were trampling. These fact
- are attested by the signatures of six gentlemen, besides tha
- of Mr. Bachman. [3
-
- Often when lying down to rest on the open plains, o
- looking upwards, I have seen carrion-hawks sailing throug
- the air at a great height. Where the country is level I d
- not believe a space of the heavens, of more than fifteen degrees
- above the horizon, is commonly viewed with any attention
- by a person either walking or on horseback. If suc
- be the case, and the vulture is on the wing at a height o
- between three and four thousand feet, before it could com
- within the range of vision, its distance in a straight lin
- from the beholder's eye, would be rather more than tw
- British miles. Might it not thus readily be overlooked
- When an animal is killed by the sportsman in a lonely valley
- may he not all the while be watched from above by th
- sharp-sighted bird? And will not the manner of its descen
- proclaim throughout the district to the whole family o
- carrion-feeders, that their prey is at hand?
-
- When the condors are wheeling in a flock round an
- round any spot, their flight is beautiful. Except when risin
- from the ground, I do not recollect ever having seen on
- of these birds flap its wings. Near Lima, I watched severa
- for nearly half an hour, without once taking off my eyes
- they moved in large curves, sweeping in circles, descendin
- and ascending without giving a single flap. As they glide
- close over my head, I intently watched from an oblique position,
- the outlines of the separate and great terminal feather
- of each wing; and these separate feathers, if there had bee
- the least vibratory movement, would have appeared as i
- blended together; but they were seen distinct against th
- blue sky. The head and neck were moved frequently, an
- apparently with force; and the extended wings seemed t
- form the fulcrum on which the movements of the neck, body
- and tail acted. If the bird wished to descend, the wing
- were for a moment collapsed; and when again expande
- with an altered inclination, the momentum gained by th
- rapid descent seemed to urge the bird upwards with th
- even and steady movement of a paper kite. In the case o
- any bird soaring, its motion must be sufficiently rapid s
- that the action of the inclined surface of its body on th
- atmosphere may counterbalance its gravity. The force t
- keep up the momentum of a body moving in a horizonta
- plane in the air (in which there is so little friction) canno
- be great, and this force is all that is wanted. The movement
- of the neck and body of the condor, we must suppose
- is sufficient for this. However this may be, it is truly
- wonderful and beautiful to see so great a bird, hour after hour
- without any apparent exertion, wheeling and gliding ove
- mountain and river
-
- April 29th. -- From some high land we hailed with jo
- the white summits of the Cordillera, as they were seen
- occasionally peeping through their dusky envelope of clouds
- During the few succeeding days we continued to get o
- slowly, for we found the river-course very tortuous, an
- strewed with immense fragments of various ancient slat
- rocks, and of granite. The plain bordering the valley ha
- here attained an elevation of about 1100 feet above the river
- and its character was much altered. The well-rounded pebbles
- of porphyry were mingled with many immense angula
- fragments of basalt and of primary rocks. The first of thes
- erratic boulders which I noticed, was sixty-seven miles distant
- from the nearest mountain; another which I measure
- was five yards square, and projected five feet above th
- gravel. Its edges were so angular, and its size so great, tha
- I at first mistook it for a rock _in situ_, and took out my
- compass to observe the direction of its cleavage. The plain her
- was not quite so level as that nearer the coast, but yet i
- betrayed no signs of any great violence. Under these
- circumstances it is, I believe, quite impossible to explain th
- transportal of these gigantic masses of rock so many mile
- from their parent-source, on any theory except by that o
- floating icebergs.
-
- During the two last days we met with signs of horses, an
- with several small articles which had belonged to the Indian
- -- such as parts of a mantle and a bunch of ostrich feathers --
- but they appeared to have been lying long on the ground
- Between the place where the Indians had so lately crosse
- the river and this neighbourhood, though so many mile
- apart, the country appears to be quite unfrequented. At first
- considering the abundance of the guanacos, I was surprise
- at this; but it is explained by the stony nature of the plains
- which would soon disable an unshod horse from taking par
- in the chase. Nevertheless, in two places in this very centra
- region, I found small heaps of stones, which I do not thin
- could have been accidentally thrown together. They wer
- placed on points, projecting over the edge of the highest lav
- cliff, and they resembled, but on a small scale, those nea
- Port Desire.
-
- May 4th. -- Captain Fitz Roy determined to take the boat
- no higher. The river had a winding course, and was ver
- rapid; and the appearance of the country offered no temptation
- to proceed any further. Everywhere we met with th
- same productions, and the same dreary landscape. We wer
- now one hundred and forty miles distant from the Atlantic
- and about sixty from the nearest arm of the Pacific. Th
- valley in this upper part expanded into a wide basin, bounde
- on the north and south by the basaltic platforms, and fronte
- by the long range of the snow-clad Cordillera. But w
- viewed these grand mountains with regret, for we wer
- obliged to imagine their nature and productions, instead o
- standing, as we had hoped, on their summits. Besides th
- useless loss of time which an attempt to ascend the river an
- higher would have cost us, we had already been for som
- days on half allowance of bread. This, although reall
- enough for reasonable men, was, after a hard day's march
- rather scanty food: a light stomach and an easy digestio
- are good things to talk about, but very unpleasant in practice
-
- 5th. -- Before sunrise we commenced our descent. W
- shot down the stream with great rapidity, generally at th
- rate of ten knots an hour. In this one day we effected wha
- had cost us five-and-a-half hard days' labour in ascending
- On the 8th, we reached the Beagle after our twenty-one days
- expedition. Every one, excepting myself, had cause to b
- dissatisfied; but to me the ascent afforded a most interestin
- section of the great tertiary formation of Patagonia
-
- On March 1st, 1833, and again on March 16th, 1834, th
- Beagle anchored in Berkeley Sound, in East Falkland Island
- This archipelago is situated in nearly the same latitude wit
- the mouth of the Strait of Magellan; it covers a space o
- one hundred and twenty by sixty geographical miles, and is
- little more than half the size of Ireland. After the possession
- of these miserable islands had been contested by France
- Spain, and England, they were left uninhabited. The government
- of Buenos Ayres then sold them to a private individual,
- but likewise used them, as old Spain had done before
- for a penal settlement. England claimed her right an
- seized them. The Englishman who was left in charge o
- the flag was consequently murdered. A British officer wa
- next sent, unsupported by any power: and when we arrived
- we found him in charge of a population, of which rathe
- more than half were runaway rebels and murderers.
-
- The theatre is worthy of the scenes acted on it. An undulating
- land, with a desolate and wretched aspect, is everywhere
- covered by a peaty soil and wiry grass, of one monotonous
- brown colour. Here and there a peak or ridg
- of grey quartz rock breaks through the smooth surface
- Every one has heard of the climate of these regions; i
- may be compared to that which is experienced at the heigh
- of between one and two thousand feet, on the mountains o
- North Wales; having however less sunshine and less frost
- but more wind and rain. [4]
-
- 16th. -- I will now describe a short excursion which
- made round a part of this island. In the morning I starte
- with six horses and two Gauchos: the latter were capita
- men for the purpose, and well accustomed to living on thei
- own resources. The weather was very boisterous and cold
- with heavy hail-storms. We got on, however, pretty well
- but, except the geology, nothing could be less interestin
- than our day's ride. The country is uniformly the sam
- undulating moorland; the surface being covered by ligh
- brown withered grass and a few very small shrubs, al
- springing out of an elastic peaty soil. In the valleys her
- and there might be seen a small flock of wild geese, an
- everywhere the ground was so soft that the snipe were abl
- to feed. Besides these two birds there were few others
- There is one main range of hills, nearly two thousand fee
- in height, and composed of quartz rock, the rugged and barren
- crests of which gave us some trouble to cross. On th
- south side we came to the best country for wild cattle; w
- met, however, no great number, for they had been latel
- much harassed.
-
- In the evening we came across a small herd. One of m
- companions, St. Jago by name, soon separated a fat cow
- he threw the bolas, and it struck her legs, but failed in
- becoming entangled. Then dropping his hat to mark the spo
- where the balls were left, while at full gallop, he uncoile
- his lazo, and after a most severe chase, again came up t
- the cow, and caught her round the horns. The other Gauch
- had gone on ahead with the spare horses, so that St. Jag
- had some difficulty in killing the furious beast. He managed
- to get her on a level piece of ground, by taking advantage
- of her as often as she rushed at him; and when sh
- would not move, my horse, from having been trained, woul
- canter up, and with his chest give her a violent push. Bu
- when on level ground it does not appear an easy job fo
- one man to kill a beast mad with terror. Nor would it b
- so, if the horse, when left to itself without its rider, di
- not soon learn, for its own safety, to keep the lazo tight
- so that, if the cow or ox moves forward, the horse move
- just as quickly forward; otherwise, it stands motionles
- leaning on one side. This horse, however, was a youn
- one, and would not stand still, but gave in to the cow as sh
- struggled. It was admirable to see with what dexterity St
- Jago dodged behind the beast, till at last he contrived t
- give the fatal touch to the main tendon of the hind le
- after which, without much difficulty, he drove his knif
- into the head of the spinal marrow, and the cow droppe
- as if struck by lightning. He cut off pieces of flesh wit
- the skin to it, but without any bones, sufficient for ou
- expedition. We then rode on to our sleeping-place, an
- had for supper "carne con cuero," or meat roasted with th
- skin on it. This is as superior to common beef as veniso
- is to mutton. A large circular piece taken from the bac
- is roasted on the embers with the hide downwards and i
- the form of a saucer, so that none of the gravy is lost
- If any worthy alderman had supped with us that evening
- "carne con cuero," without doubt, would soon have bee
- celebrated in London
-
- During the night it rained, and the next day (17th) wa
- very stormy, with much hail and snow. We rode across th
- island to the neck of land which joins the Rincon del Tor
- (the great peninsula at the S. W. extremity) to the rest o
- the island. From the great number of cows which hav
- been killed, there is a large proportion of bulls. These wander
- about single, or two and three together, and are ver
- savage. I never saw such magnificent beasts; they equalle
- in the size of their huge heads and necks the Grecian marbl
- sculptures. Capt. Sulivan informs me that the hide of a
- average-sized bull weighs forty-seven pounds, whereas
- hide of this weight, less thoroughly dried, is considered a
- a very heavy one at Monte Video. The young bulls generally
- run away, for a short distance; but the old ones do no
- stir a step, except to rush at man and horse; and man
- horses have been thus killed. An old bull crossed a bogg
- stream, and took his stand on the opposite side to us; w
- in vain tried to drive him away, and failing, were oblige
- to make a large circuit. The Gauchos in revenge determined
- to emasculate him and render him for the futur
- harmless. It was very interesting to see how art completel
- mastered force. One lazo was thrown over his horns as h
- rushed at the horse, and another round his hind legs: in
- minute the monster was stretched powerless on the ground
- After the lazo has once been drawn tightly round the horn
- of a furious animal, it does not at first appear an easy thin
- to disengage it again without killing the beast: nor, I
- apprehend, would it be so if the man was by himself. By th
- aid, however, of a second person throwing his lazo so as t
- catch both hind legs, it is quickly managed: for the animal
- as long as its hind legs are kept outstretched, is quite
- helpless, and the first man can with his hands loosen his laz
- from the horns, and then quietly mount his horse; but th
- moment the second man, by backing ever so little, relaxe
- the strain, the lazo slips off the legs of the struggling beast
- which then rises free, shakes himself, and vainly rushes a
- his antagonist
-
- During our whole ride we saw only one troop of wil
- horses. These animals, as well as the cattle, were introduce
- by the French in 1764, since which time both have greatl
- increased. It is a curious fact, that the horses have neve
- left the eastern end of the island, although there is no natural
- boundary to prevent them from roaming, and that par
- of the island is not more tempting than the rest. The Gauchos
- whom I asked, though asserting this to be the case
- were unable to account for it, except from the strong attachment
- which horses have to any locality to which they ar
- accustomed. Considering that the island does not appea
- fully stocked, and that there are no beasts of prey, I wa
- particularly curious to know what has checked their originally
- rapid increase. That in a limited island some chec
- would sooner or later supervene, is inevitable; but why ha
- the increase of the horse been checked sooner than that o
- the cattle? Capt. Sulivan has taken much pains for m
- in this inquiry. The Gauchos employed here attribute i
- chiefly to the stallions constantly roaming from place t
- place, and compelling the mares to accompany them, whethe
- or not the young foals are able to follow. One Gaucho tol
- Capt. Sulivan that he had watched a stallion for a whol
- hour, violently kicking and biting a mare till he force
- her to leave her foal to its fate. Capt. Sulivan can so fa
- corroborate this curious account, that he has several time
- found young foals dead, whereas he has never found a dea
- calf. Moreover, the dead bodies of full-grown horses ar
- more frequently found, as if more subject to disease o
- accidents, than those of the cattle. From the softness o
- the ground their hoofs often grow irregularly to a grea
- length, and this causes lameness. The predominant colour
- are roan and iron-grey. All the horses bred here, both tam
- and wild, are rather small-sized, though generally in goo
- condition; and they have lost so much strength, that the
- are unfit to be used in taking wild cattle with the lazo: i
- consequence, it is necessary to go to the great expense o
- importing fresh horses from the Plata. At some futur
- period the southern hemisphere probably will have its bree
- of Falkland ponies, as the northern has its Shetland breed.
-
- The cattle, instead of having degenerated like the horse
- seem, as before remarked, to have increased in size; an
- they are much more numerous than the horses Capt. Sulivan
- informs me that they vary much less in the genera
- form of their bodies and in the shape of their horns tha
- English cattle. In colour they differ much; and it is a
- remarkable circumstance, that in different parts of this on
- small island, different colours predominate. Round Moun
- Usborne, at a height of from 1000 to 1500 feet above the sea
- about half of some of the herds are mouse or lead-coloured
- a tint which is not common in other parts of the island
- Near Port Pleasant dark brown prevails, whereas south o
- Choiseul Sound (which almost divides the island into tw
- parts), white beasts with black heads and feet are the mos
- common: in all parts black, and some spotted animals ma
- be observed. Capt. Sulivan remarks, that the difference i
- the prevailing colours was so obvious, that in looking fo
- the herds near Port Pleasant, they appeared from a lon
- distance like black spots, whilst south of Choiseul Soun
- they appeared like white spots on the hill-sides. Capt. Sulivan
- thinks that the herds do not mingle; and it is a singula
- fact, that the mouse-coloured cattle, though living on th
- high land, calve about a month earlier in the season tha
- the other coloured beasts on the lower land. It is interesting
- thus to find the once domesticated cattle breakin
- into three colours, of which some one colour would in al
- probability ultimately prevail over the others, if the herd
- were left undisturbed for the next several centuries.
-
- The rabbit is another animal which has been introduced
- and has succeeded very well; so that they abound over larg
- parts of the island. Yet, like the horses, they are confine
- within certain limits; for they have not crossed the centra
- chain of hills, nor would they have extended even so far a
- its base, if, as the Gauchos informed me, small colonies ha
- not been carried there. I should not have supposed tha
- these animals, natives of northern Africa, could have existe
- in a climate so humid as this, and which enjoys so littl
- sunshine that even wheat ripens only occasionally. It i
- asserted that in Sweden, which any one would have though
- a more favourable climate, the rabbit cannot live out o
- doors. The first few pairs, moreover, had here to conten
- against pre-existing enemies, in the fox and some larg
- hawks. The French naturalists have considered the black variety
- a distinct species, and called it Lepus Magellanicus. [5
- They imagined that Magellan, when talking of an anima
- under the name of "conejos" in the Strait of Magellan
- referred to this species; but he was alluding to a small cavy
- which to this day is thus called by the Spaniards. Th
- Gauchos laughed at the idea of the black kind being different
- from the grey, and they said that at all events it ha
- not extended its range any further than the grey kind; tha
- the two were never found separate; and that they readil
- bred together, and produced piebald offspring. Of the latte
- I now possess a specimen, and it is marked about the hea
- differently from the French specific description. This
- circumstance shows how cautious naturalists should be i
- making species; for even Cuvier, on looking at the skul
- of one of these rabbits, thought it was probably distinct!
-
- The only quadruped native to the island [6]; is a large wolf
- like fox (Canis antarcticus), which is common to both Eas
- and West Falkland. I have no doubt it is a peculiar species
- and confined to this archipelago; because many sealers
- Gauchos, and Indians, who have visited these islands, al
- maintain that no such animal is found in any part of Sout
- America.
-
- Molina, from a similarity in habits, thought that thi
- was the same with his "culpeu;" [7] but I have seen both
- and they are quite distinct. These wolves are well know
- from Byron's account of their tameness and curiosity, whic
- the sailors, who ran into the water to avoid them, mistoo
- for fierceness. To this day their manners remain the same
- They have been observed to enter a tent, and actually pul
- some meat from beneath the head of a sleeping seaman. Th
- Gauchos also have frequently in the evening killed them
- by holding out a piece of meat in one hand, and in the othe
- a knife ready to stick them. As far as I am aware, ther
- is no other instance in any part of the world, of so smal
- a mass of broken land, distant from a continent, possessin
- so large an aboriginal quadruped peculiar to itself. Thei
- numbers have rapidly decreased; they are already banishe
- from that half of the island which lies to the eastward o
- the neck of land between St. Salvador Bay and Berkele
- Sound. Within a very few years after these islands shal
- have become regularly settled, in all probability this fo
- will be classed with the dodo, as an animal which has perished
- from the face of the earth.
-
- At night (17th) we slept on the neck of land at the hea
- of Choiseul Sound, which forms the south-west peninsula
- The valley was pretty well sheltered from the cold wind
- but there was very little brushwood for fuel. The Gauchos
- however, soon found what, to my great surprise, made nearl
- as hot a fire as coals; this was the skeleton of a bullock
- lately killed, from which the flesh had been picked by the
- carrion-hawks. They told me that in winter they often killed a
- beast, cleaned the flesh from the bones with their knives
- and then with these same bones roasted the meat for thei
- suppers.
-
- 18th. -- It rained during nearly the whole day. At nigh
- we managed, however, with our saddle-cloths to keep ourselves
- pretty well dry and warm; but the ground on whic
- we slept was on each occasion nearly in the state of a bog
- and there was not a dry spot to sit down on after our day'
- ride. I have in another part stated how singular it is tha
- there should be absolutely no trees on these islands, althoug
- Tierra del Fuego is covered by one large forest. Th
- largest bush in the island (belonging to the family of
- Compositae) is scarcely so tall as our gorse. The best fuel i
- afforded by a green little bush about the size of commo
- heath, which has the useful property of burning while fres
- and green. It was very surprising to see the Gauchos, i
- the midst of rain and everything soaking wet, with nothin
- more than a tinder-box and a piece of rag, immediately mak
- a fire. They sought beneath the tufts of grass and bushe
- for a few dry twigs, and these they rubbed into fibres; the
- surrounding them with coarser twigs, something like a bird'
- nest, they put the rag with its spark of fire in the middl
- and covered it up. The nest being then held up to th
- wind, by degrees it smoked more and more, and at las
- burst out in flames. I do not think any other method woul
- have had a chance of succeeding with such damp materials.
-
- 19th. -- Each morning, from not having ridden for som
- time previously, I was very stiff. I was surprised to hea
- the Gauchos, who have from infancy almost lived on horseback,
- say that, under similar circumstances, they alway
- suffer. St. Jago told me, that having been confined for thre
- months by illness, he went out hunting wild cattle, and i
- consequence, for the next two days, his thighs were so stif
- that he was obliged to lie in bed. This shows that the Gauchos,
- although they do not appear to do so, yet really mus
- exert much muscular effort in riding. The hunting wil
- cattle, in a country so difficult to pass as this is on accoun
- of the swampy ground, must be very hard work. Th
- Gauchos say they often pass at full speed over ground whic
- would be impassable at a slower pace; in the same manne
- as a man is able to skate over thin ice. When hunting, th
- party endeavours to get as close as possible to the herd with
- out being discovered. Each man carries four or five pair o
- the bolas; these he throws one after the other at as man
- cattle, which, when once entangled, are left for some day
- till they become a little exhausted by hunger and struggling
- They are then let free and driven towards a small herd o
- tame animals, which have been brought to the spot on purpose.
- From their previous treatment, being too much terrified
- to leave the herd, they are easily driven, if thei
- strength last out, to the settlement.
-
- The weather continued so very bad that we determine
- to make a push, and try to reach the vessel before night
- From the quantity of rain which had fallen, the surfac
- of the whole country was swampy. I suppose my horse fel
- at least a dozen times, and sometimes the whole six horse
- were floundering in the mud together. All the little stream
- are bordered by soft peat, which makes it very difficult fo
- the horses to leap them without falling. To complete ou
- discomforts we were obliged to cross the head of a cree
- of the sea, in which the water was as high as our horses
- backs; and the little waves, owing to the violence of th
- wind, broke over us, and made us very wet and cold. Eve
- the iron-framed Gauchos professed themselves glad whe
- they reached the settlement, after our little excursion
-
- The geological structure of these islands is in mos
- respects simple. The lower country consists of clay-slat
- and sandstone, containing fossils, very closely related to, bu
- not identical with, those found in the Silurian formation
- of Europe; the hills are formed of white granular quart
- rock. The strata of the latter are frequently arched wit
- perfect symmetry, and the appearance of some of the masse
- is in consequence most singular. Pernety [8] has devote
- several pages to the description of a Hill of Ruins, th
- successive strata of which he has justly compared to th
- seats of an amphitheatre. The quartz rock must have bee
- quite pasty when it underwent such remarkable flexure
- without being shattered into fragments. As the quart
- insensibly passes into the sandstone, it seems probable tha
- the former owes its origin to the sandstone having bee
- heated to such a degree that it became viscid, and upon cooling
- crystallized. While in the soft state it must have bee
- pushed up through the overlying beds.
-
- In many parts of the island the bottoms of the valleys ar
- covered in an extraordinary manner by myriads of grea
- loose angular fragments of the quartz rock, forming "stream
- of stones." These have been mentioned with surprise b
- every voyager since the time of Pernety. The blocks ar
- not waterworn, their angles being only a little blunted; the
- vary in size from one or two feet in diameter to ten, or eve
- more than twenty times as much. They are not throw
- together into irregular piles, but are spread out into leve
- sheets or great streams. It is not possible to ascertain thei
- thickness, but the water of small streamlets can be hear
- trickling through the stones many feet below the surface
- The actual depth is probably great, because the crevice
- between the lower fragments must long ago have been fille
- up with sand. The width of these sheets of stones varie
- from a few hundred feet to a mile; but the peaty soil dail
- encroaches on the borders, and even forms islets whereve
- a few fragments happen to lie close together. In a valle
- south of Berkeley Sound, which some of our party calle
- the "great valley of fragments," it was necessary to cros
- an uninterrupted band half a mile wide, by jumping fro
- one pointed stone to another. So large were the fragments
- that being overtaken by a shower of rain, I readily foun
- shelter beneath one of them.
-
- Their little inclination is the most remarkable circumstance
- in these "streams of stones." On the hill-sides I hav
- seen them sloping at an angle of ten degrees with the horizon
- but in some of the level, broad-bottomed valleys, the
- inclination is only just sufficient to be clearly perceived.
- On so rugged a surface there was no means of measuring th
- angle, but to give a common illustration, I may say that th
- slope would not have checked the speed of an English mail-coach.
- In some places, a continuous stream of these fragments
- followed up the course of a valley, and eve
- extended to the very crest of the hill. On these crests hug
- masses, exceeding in dimensions any small building, seeme
- to stand arrested in their headlong course: there, also, th
- curved strata of the archways lay piled on each other, lik
- the ruins of some vast and ancient cathedral. In endeavouring
- to describe these scenes of violence one is tempted to pas
- from one simile to another. We may imagine that stream
- of white lava had flowed from many parts of the mountain
- into the lower country, and that when solidified they had bee
- rent by some enormous convulsion into myriads of fragments.
- The expression "streams of stones," which immediately
- occurred to every one, conveys the same idea. Thes
- scenes are on the spot rendered more striking by the contrast
- of the low rounded forms of the neighbouring hills.
-
- I was interested by finding on the highest peak of on
- range (about 700 feet above the sea) a great arched fragment,
- lying on its convex side, or back downwards. Mus
- we believe that it was fairly pitched up in the air, and thu
- turned? Or, with more probability, that there existed formerly
- a part of the same range more elevated than the poin
- on which this monument of a great convulsion of nature no
- lies. As the fragments in the valleys are neither rounde
- nor the crevices filled up with sand, we must infer that th
- period of violence was subsequent to the land having bee
- raised above the waters of the sea. In a transverse sectio
- within these valleys, the bottom is nearly level, or rises bu
- very little towards either side. Hence the fragments appea
- to have travelled from the head of the valley; but in realit
- it seems more probable that they have been hurled down fro
- the nearest slopes; and that since, by a vibratory movemen
- of overwhelming force, [9] the fragments have been levelle
- into one continuous sheet. If during the earthquake [10] whic
- in 1835 overthrew Concepcion, in Chile, it was thought wonderful
- that small bodies should have been pitched a fe
- inches from the ground, what must we say to a movemen
- which has caused fragments many tons in weight, to mov
- onwards like so much sand on a vibrating board, and fin
- their level? I have seen, in the Cordillera of the Andes, th
- evident marks where stupendous mountains have been broke
- into pieces like so much thin crust, and the strata thrown o
- their vertical edges; but never did any scene, like thes
- "streams of stones," so forcibly convey to my mind the ide
- of a convulsion, of which in historical records we might i
- vain seek for any counterpart: yet the progress of knowledg
- will probably some day give a simple explanation of thi
- phenomenon, as it already has of the so long-thought
- inexplicable transportal of the erratic boulders, which are
- strewed over the plains of Europe.
-
- I have little to remark on the zoology of these islands.
- have before described the carrion-vulture of Polyborus
- There are some other hawks, owls, and a few small land-birds.
- The water-fowl are particularly numerous, and the
- must formerly, from the accounts of the old navigators
- have been much more so. One day I observed a cormoran
- playing with a fish which it had caught. Eight times
- successively the bird let its prey go, then dived after it, an
- although in deep water, brought it each time to the surface
- In the Zoological Gardens I have seen the otter treat a fis
- in the same manner, much as a cat does a mouse: I do no
- know of any other instance where dame Nature appears s
- wilfully cruel. Another day, having placed myself betwee
- a penguin (Aptenodytes demersa) and the water, I was muc
- amused by watching its habits. It was a brave bird; and til
- reaching the sea, it regularly fought and drove me backwards
- Nothing less than heavy blows would have stopped him; ever
- inch he gained he firmly kept, standing close before me erec
- and determined. When thus opposed he continually rolle
- his head from side to side, in a very odd manner, as if th
- power of distinct vision lay only in the anterior and basa
- part of each eye. This bird is commonly called the jackas
- penguin, from its habit, while on shore, of throwing its hea
- backwards, and making a loud strange noise, very like th
- braying of an ass; but while at sea, and undisturbed, its not
- is very deep and solemn, and is often heard in the night-time
- In diving, its little wings are used as fins; but on the land,
- as front legs. When crawling, it may be said on four legs
- through the tussocks or on the side of a grassy cliff, it move
- so very quickly that it might easily be mistaken for a
- quadruped. When at sea and fishing, it comes to the surface fo
- the purpose of breathing with such a spring, and dives agai
- so instantaneously, that I defy any one at first sight to b
- sure that it was not a fish leaping for sport.
-
- Two kinds of geese frequent the Falklands. The uplan
- species (Anas Magellanica) is common, in pairs and in smal
- flocks, throughout the island. They do not migrate, but buil
- on the small outlying islets. This is supposed to be fro
- fear of the foxes: and it is perhaps from the same caus
- that these birds, though very tame by day, are shy and wil
- in the dusk of the evening. They live entirely on vegetabl
- matter.
-
- The rock-goose, so called from living exclusively on th
- sea-beach (Anas antarctica), is common both here and o
- the west coast of America, as far north as Chile. In the dee
- and retired channels of Tierra del Fuego, the snow-whit
- gander, invariably accompanied by his darker consort, an
- standing close by each other on some distant rocky point, i
- a common feature in the landscape.
-
- In these islands a great loggerheaded duck or goose (Ana
- brachyptera), which sometimes weighs twenty-two pounds
- is very abundant. These birds were in former days called
- from their extraordinary manner of paddling and splashin
- upon the water, race-horses; but now they are named, muc
- more appropriately, steamers. Their wings are too small an
- weak to allow of flight, but by their aid, partly swimming an
- partly flapping the surface of the water, they move ver
- quickly. The manner is something like that by which th
- common house-duck escapes when pursued by a dog; but
- am nearly sure that the steamer moves its wings alternately
- instead of both together, as in other birds. These clumsy
- loggerheaded ducks make such a noise and splashing, that th
- effect is exceedingly curious.
-
- Thus we find in South America three birds which use thei
- wings for other purposes besides flight; the penguins as fins
- the steamer as paddles, and the ostrich as sails: and th
- Apteryz of New Zealand, as well as its gigantic extinct
- prototype the Deinornis, possess only rudimentary
- representatives of wings. The steamer is able to dive only
- to a very short distance. It feeds entirely on shell-fish
- from the kelp and tidal rocks: hence the beak and head, for
- the purpose of breaking them, are surprisingly heavy and
- strong: the head is so strong that I have scarcely been able
- to fracture it with my geological hammer; and all our sportsmen
- soon discovered how tenacious these birds were of life. When in
- the evening pluming themselves in a flock, they make the sam
- odd mixture of sounds which bull-frogs do within the tropics
-
- In Tierra del Fuego, as well as in the Falkland Islands,
- made many observations on the lower marine animals, [11] bu
- they are of little general interest. I will mention only on
- class of facts, relating to certain zoophytes in the more highl
- organized division of that class. Several genera (Flustra
- Eschara, Cellaria, Crisia, and others) agree in having singular
- moveable organs (like those of Flustra avicularia, foun
- in the European seas) attached to their cells. The organ, i
- the greater number of cases, very closely resembles the hea
- of a vulture; but the lower mandible can be opened muc
- wider than in a real bird's beak. The head itself possesse
- considerable powers of movement, by means of a short neck
- In one zoophyte the head itself was fixed, but the lower ja
- free: in another it was replaced by a triangular hood, with
- beautifully-fitted trap-door, which evidently answered to th
- lower mandible. In the greater number of species, each cel
- was provided with one head, but in others each cell had two.
-
- The young cells at the end of the branches of these corallines
- contain quite immature polypi, yet the vulture-head
- attached to them, though small, are in every respect perfect
- When the polypus was removed by a needle from any of th
- cells, these organs did not appear in the least affected. Whe
- one of the vulture-like heads was cut off from the cell, th
- lower mandible retained its power of opening and closing
- Perhaps the most singular part of their structure is, tha
- when there were more than two rows of cells on a branch
- the central cells were furnished with these appendages, o
- only one-fourth the size of the outside ones. Their movements
- varied according to the species; but in some I neve
- saw the least motion; while others, with the lower mandibl
- generally wide open, oscillated backwards and forwards a
- the rate of about five seconds each turn, others moved rapidly
- and by starts. When touched with a needle, the bea
- generally seized the point so firmly, that the whole branc
- might be shaken.
-
- These bodies have no relation whatever with the production
- of the eggs or gemmules, as they are formed before th
- young polypi appear in the cells at the end of the growin
- branches; as they move independently of the polypi, and d
- not appear to be in any way connected with them; and a
- they differ in size on the outer and inner rows of cells, I hav
- little doubt, that in their functions, they are related rathe
- to the horny axis of the branches than to the polypi in th
- cells. The fleshy appendage at the lower extremity of th
- sea-pen (described at Bahia Blanca) also forms part of th
- zoophyte, as a whole, in the same manner as the roots of
- tree form part of the whole tree, and not of the individua
- leaf or flower-buds.
-
- In another elegant little coralline (Crisia?), each cell wa
- furnished with a long-toothed bristle, which had the powe
- of moving quickly. Each of these bristles and each of th
- vulture-like heads generally moved quite independently o
- the others, but sometimes all on both sides of a branch,
- sometimes only those on one side, moved together
- coinstantaneously, sometimes each moved in regular order one
- after another. In these actions we apparently behold as perfect
- a transmission of will in the zoophyte, though composed o
- thousands of distinct polypi, as in any single animal. Th
- case, indeed, is not different from that of the sea-pens, which
- when touched, drew themselves into the sand on the coast o
- Bahia Blanca. I will state one other instance of unifor
- action, though of a very different nature, in a zoophyt
- closely allied to Clytia, and therefore very simply organized
- Having kept a large tuft of it in a basin of salt-water, whe
- it was dark I found that as often as I rubbed any part of
- branch, the whole became strongly phosphorescent with
- green light: I do not think I ever saw any object more
- beautifully so. But the remarkable circumstance was, that th
- flashes of light always proceeded up the branches, from th
- base towards the extremities.
-
- The examination of these compound animals was alway
- very interesting to me. What can be more remarkable tha
- to see a plant-like body producing an egg, capable of swimming
- about and of choosing a proper place to adhere to
- which then sprouts into branches, each crowded with innumerable
- distinct animals, often of complicated organizations
- The branches, moreover, as we have just seen, sometime
- possess organs capable of movement and independent of th
- polypi. Surprising as this union of separate individuals in
- common stock must always appear, every tree displays th
- same fact, for buds must be considered as individual plants
- It is, however, natural to consider a polypus, furnished wit
- a mouth, intestines, and other organs, as a distinct individual
- whereas the individuality of a leaf-bud is not easily realised
- so that the union of separate individuals in a common bod
- is more striking in a coralline than in a tree. Our conception
- of a compound animal, where in some respects the individuality
- of each is not completed, may be aided, by reflectin
- on the production of two distinct creatures by bisecting
- single one with a knife, or where Nature herself perform
- the task of bisection. We may consider the polypi in
- zoophyte, or the buds in a tree, as cases where the divisio
- of the individual has not been completely effected. Certainl
- in the case of trees, and judging from analogy in that o
- corallines, the individuals propagated by buds seem mor
- intimately related to each other, than eggs or seeds are t
- their parents. It seems now pretty well established tha
- plants propagated by buds all partake of a common duratio
- of life; and it is familiar to every one, what singular an
- numerous peculiarities are transmitted with certainty, b
- buds, layers, and grafts, which by seminal propagation neve
- or only casually reappear
-
- [1] The desserts of Syria are characterized, according to
- Volney (tom. i. p. 351), by woody bushes, numerous rats,
- gazelles and hares. In the landscape of Patagonia, the guanaco
- replaces the gazelle, and the agouti the hare.
-
- [2] I noticed that several hours before any one of the condors
- died, all the lice, with which it was infested, crawled to the
- outside feathers. I was assured that this always happens.
-
- [3] London's Magazine of Nat. Hist., vol. vii.
-
- [4] From accounts published since our voyage, and more
- especially from several interesting letters from Capt. Sulivan,
- R. N., employed on the survey, it appears that we took an
- exaggerated view of the badness of the climate on these
- islands. But when I reflect on the almost universal covering
- of peat, and on the fact of wheat seldom ripening here, I can
- hardly believe that the climate in summer is so fine and dry
- as it has lately been represented.
-
- [5] Lesson's Zoology of the Voyage of the Coquille, tom. i.
- p. 168. All the early voyagers, and especially Bougainville,
- distinctly state that the wolf-like fox was the only native
- animal on the island. The distinction of the rabbit as a
- species, is taken from peculiarities in the fur, from the
- shape of the head, and from the shortness of the ears. I may
- here observe that the difference between the Irish and English
- hare rests upon nearly similar characters, only more strongly
- marked
-
- [6] I have reason, however, to suspect that there is a field-
- mouse. The common European rat and mouse have roamed far from
- the habitations of the settlers. The common hog has also run
- wild on one islet; all are of a black colour: the boars are
- very fierce, and have great trunks.
-
- [7] The "culpeu" is the Canis Magellanicus brought home by
- Captain King from the Strait of Magellan. It is common in
- Chile
-
- [8] Pernety, Voyage aux Isles Malouines, p. 526.
-
- [9] "Nous n'avons pas ete moins saisis d'etonnement a la vue
- de l'innombrable quantite de pierres de touts grandeurs,
- bouleversees les unes sur les autres, et cependent rangees,
- comme si elles avoient ete amoncelees negligemment pour remplir
- des ravins. On ne se lassoit pas d'admirer les effets
- prodigieux de la nature." -- Pernety, p. 526.
-
- [10] An inhabitant of Mendoza, and hence well capable of
- judging, assured me that, during the several years he had
- resided on these islands, he had never felt the slightest
- shock of an earthquake.
-
- [11] I was surprised to find, on counting the eggs of a large
- white Doris (this sea-slug was three and a half inches long),
- how extraordinarily numerous they were. From two to five eggs
- (each three-thousandths of an inch in diameter) were contained
- in spherical little case. These were arranged two deep in
- transverse rows forming a ribbon. The ribbon adhered by its
- edge to the rock in an oval spire. One which I found, measured
- nearly twenty inches in length and half in breadth. By counting
- how many balls were contained in a tenth of an inch in the
- row, and how many rows in an equal length of the ribbon, on
- the most moderate computation there were six hundred thousand
- eggs. Yet this Doris was certainly not very common; although
- I was often searching under the stones, I saw only seven
- individuals. No fallacy is more common with naturalists,
- than that the numbers of an individual species depend on
- its powers of propagation.
-
-
-
- CHAPTER X
-
- TIERRA DEL FUEGO
-
- Tierra del Fuego, first arrival -- Good Success Bay -- An
- Account of the Fuegians on board -- Interview With the
- Savages -- Scenery of the Forests -- Cape Horn -- Wigwam
- Cove -- Miserable Condition of the Savages -- Famines --
- Cannibals -- Matricide -- Religious Feelings -- Great
- Gale -- Beagle Channel -- Ponsonby Sound -- Build Wigwams
- and settle the Fuegians -- Bifurcation of the Beagle
- Channel -- Glaciers -- Return to the Ship -- Second Visit
- in the Ship to the Settlement -- Equality of Condition
- amongst the Natives.
-
-
- DECEMBER 17th, 1832. -- Having now finished with
- Patagonia and the Falkland Islands, I will describe
- our first arrival in Tierra del Fuego. A little after
- noon we doubled Cape St. Diego, and entered the famous
- strait of Le Maire. We kept close to the Fuegian shore, but
- the outline of the rugged, inhospitable Statenland was visible
- amidst the clouds. In the afternoon we anchored in the Bay
- of Good Success. While entering we were saluted in a manner
- becoming the inhabitants of this savage land. A group
- of Fuegians partly concealed by the entangled forest, were
- perched on a wild point overhanging the sea; and as we
- passed by, they sprang up and waving their tattered cloaks
- sent forth a loud and sonorous shout. The savages followed
- the ship, and just before dark we saw their fire, and again
- heard their wild cry. The harbour consists of a fine piece
- of water half surrounded by low rounded mountains of clay-
- slate, which are covered to the water's edge by one dense
- gloomy forest. A single glance at the landscape was sufficient
- to show me how widely different it was from anything
- I had ever beheld. At night it blew a gale of wind, and
- heavy squalls from the mountains swept past us. It would
- have been a bad time out at sea, and we, as well as others,
- may call this Good Success Bay.
-
- In the morning the Captain sent a party to communicate
- with the Fuegians. When we came within hail, one of the
- four natives who were present advanced to receive us, and
- began to shout most vehemently, wishing to direct us where
- to land. When we were on shore the party looked rather
- alarmed, but continued talking and making gestures with
- great rapidity. It was without exception the most curious
- and interesting spectacle I ever beheld: I could not have
- believed how wide was the difference between savage and
- civilized man: it is greater than between a wild and
- domesticated animal, inasmuch as in man there is a greater
- power of improvement. The chief spokesman was old, and
- appeared to be the head of the family; the three others were
- powerful young men, about six feet high. The women and
- children had been sent away. These Fuegians are a very
- different race from the stunted, miserable wretches farther
- westward; and they seem closely allied to the famous Patagonians
- of the Strait of Magellan. Their only garment consists
- of a mantle made of guanaco skin, with the wool outside:
- this they wear just thrown over their shoulders, leaving
- their persons as often exposed as covered. Their skin is of
- a dirty coppery-red colour.
-
- The old man had a fillet of white feathers tied round his
- head, which partly confined his black, coarse, and entangled
- hair. His face was crossed by two broad transverse bars;
- one, painted bright red, reached from ear to ear and included
- the upper lip; the other, white like chalk, extended above
- and parallel to the first, so that even his eyelids were thus
- coloured. The other two men were ornamented by streaks
- of black powder, made of charcoal. The party altogether
- closely resembled the devils which come on the stage in plays
- like Der Freischutz.
-
- Their very attitudes were abject, and the expression of
- their countenances distrustful, surprised, and startled. After
- we had presented them with some scarlet cloth, which they
- immediately tied round their necks, they became good friends.
- This was shown by the old man patting our breasts,
- and making a chuckling kind of noise, as people do when
- feeding chickens. I walked with the old man, and this
- demonstration of friendship was repeated several times; it was
- concluded by three hard slaps, which were given me on the
- breast and back at the same time. He then bared his bosom
- for me to return the compliment, which being done, he
- seemed highly pleased. The language of these people,
- according to our notions, scarcely deserves to be called
- articulate. Captain Cook has compared it to a man clearing his
- throat, but certainly no European ever cleared his throat
- with so many hoarse, guttural, and clicking sounds.
-
- They are excellent mimics: as often as we coughed or
- yawned, or made any odd motion, they immediately imitated
- us. Some of our party began to squint and look awry; but
- one of the young Fuegians (whose whole face was painted
- black, excepting a white band across his eyes) succeeded in
- making far more hideous grimaces. They could repeat with
- perfect correctness each word in any sentence we addressed
- them, and they remembered such words for some time. Yet
- we Europeans all know how difficult it is to distinguish
- apart the sounds in a foreign language. Which of us, for
- instance, could follow an American Indian through a sentence
- of more than three words? All savages appear to possess, to
- an uncommon degree, this power of mimicry. I was told,
- almost in the same words, of the same ludicrous habit among
- the Caffres; the Australians, likewise, have long been notorious
- for being able to imitate and describe the gait of any
- man, so that he may be recognized. How can this faculty be
- explained? is it a consequence of the more practised habits
- of perception and keener senses, common to all men in a
- savage state, as compared with those long civilized?
-
- When a song was struck up by our party, I thought the
- Fuegians would have fallen down with astonishment. With
- equal surprise they viewed our dancing; but one of the
- young men, when asked, had no objection to a little waltzing.
- Little accustomed to Europeans as they appeared to be, yet
- they knew and dreaded our fire-arms; nothing would tempt
- them to take a gun in their hands. They begged for knives,
- calling them by the Spanish word "cuchilla." They explained
- also what they wanted, by acting as if they had a
- piece of blubber in their mouth, and then pretending to cut
- instead of tear it.
-
- I have not as yet noticed the Fuegians whom we had on
- board. During the former voyage of the Adventure and
- Beagle in 1826 to 1830, Captain Fitz Roy seized on a party
- of natives, as hostages for the loss of a boat, which had
- been stolen, to the great jeopardy of a party employed on
- the survey; and some of these natives, as well as a child
- whom he bought for a pearl-button, he took with him to
- England, determining to educate them and instruct them in
- religion at his own expense. To settle these natives in their
- own country, was one chief inducement to Captain Fitz Roy
- to undertake our present voyage; and before the Admiralty
- had resolved to send out this expedition, Captain Fitz Roy
- had generously chartered a vessel, and would himself have
- taken them back. The natives were accompanied by a missionary,
- R. Matthews; of whom and of the natives, Captain
- Fitz Roy has published a full and excellent account. Two
- men, one of whom died in England of the small-pox, a boy
- and a little girl, were originally taken; and we had now on
- board, York Minster, Jemmy Button (whose name expresses
- his purchase-money), and Fuegia Basket. York Minster
- was a full-grown, short, thick, powerful man: his disposition
- was reserved, taciturn, morose, and when excited violently
- passionate; his affections were very strong towards a few
- friends on board; his intellect good. Jemmy Button was a
- universal favourite, but likewise passionate; the expression
- of his face at once showed his nice disposition. He was
- merry and often laughed, and was remarkably sympathetic
- with any one in pain: when the water was rough, I was often
- a little sea-sick, and he used to come to me and say in a
- plaintive voice, "Poor, poor fellow!" but the notion, after
- his aquatic life, of a man being sea-sick, was too ludicrous,
- and he was generally obliged to turn on one side to hide a
- smile or laugh, and then he would repeat his "Poor, poor
- fellow!" He was of a patriotic disposition; and he liked to
- praise his own tribe and country, in which he truly said there
- were "plenty of trees," and he abused all the other tribes:
- he stoutly declared that there was no Devil in his land.
- Jemmy was short, thick, and fat, but vain of his personal
- appearance; he used always to wear gloves, his hair was
- neatly cut, and he was distressed if his well-polished shoes
- were dirtied. He was fond of admiring himself in a looking
- glass; and a merry-faced little Indian boy from the Rio
- Negro, whom we had for some months on board, soon perceived
- this, and used to mock him: Jemmy, who was always
- rather jealous of the attention paid to this little boy, did not
- at all like this, and used to say, with rather a contemptuous
- twist of his head, "Too much skylark." It seems yet wonderful
- to me, when I think over all his many good qualities
- that he should have been of the same race, and doubtless
- partaken of the same character, with the miserable, degraded
- savages whom we first met here. Lastly, Fuegia Basket was
- a nice, modest, reserved young girl, with a rather pleasing but
- sometimes sullen expression, and very quick in learning anything,
- especially languages. This she showed in picking up
- some Portuguese and Spanish, when left on shore for only
- a short time at Rio de Janeiro and Monte Video, and in her
- knowledge of English. York Minster was very jealous of
- any attention paid to her; for it was clear he determined to
- marry her as soon as they were settled on shore.
-
- Although all three could both speak and understand a
- good deal of English, it was singularly difficult to obtain
- much information from them, concerning the habits of their
- countrymen; this was partly owing to their apparent difficulty
- in understanding the simplest alternative. Every one
- accustomed to very young children, knows how seldom one
- can get an answer even to so simple a question as whether a
- thing is black or white; the idea of black or white seems
- alternately to fill their minds. So it was with these Fuegians,
- and hence it was generally impossible to find out, by cross
- questioning, whether one had rightly understood anything
- which they had asserted. Their sight was remarkably acute;
- it is well known that sailors, from long practice, can make
- out a distant object much better than a landsman; but both
- York and Jemmy were much superior to any sailor on board:
- several times they have declared what some distant object
- has been, and though doubted by every one, they have proved
- right, when it has been examined through a telescope. They
- were quite conscious of this power; and Jemmy, when he
- had any little quarrel with the officer on watch, would say,
- "Me see ship, me no tell."
-
- It was interesting to watch the conduct of the savages,
- when we landed, towards Jemmy Button: they immediately
- perceived the difference between him and ourselves, and held
- much conversation one with another on the subject. The
- old man addressed a long harangue to Jemmy, which it
- seems was to invite him to stay with them But Jemmy
- understood very little of their language, and was, moreover,
- thoroughly ashamed of his countrymen. When York Minster
- afterwards came on shore, they noticed him in the
- same way, and told him he ought to shave; yet he had not
- twenty dwarf hairs on his face, whilst we all wore our
- untrimmed beards. They examined the colour of his skin, and
- compared it with ours. One of our arms being bared, they
- expressed the liveliest surprise and admiration at its
- whiteness, just in the same way in which I have seen the
- ourangoutang do at the Zoological Gardens. We thought that they
- mistook two or three of the officers, who were rather shorter
- and fairer, though adorned with large beards, for the ladies
- of our party. The tallest amongst the Fuegians was evidently
- much pleased at his height being noticed. When placed
- back to back with the tallest of the boat's crew, he
- tried his best to edge on higher ground, and to stand on
- tiptoe. He opened his mouth to show his teeth, and turned
- his face for a side view; and all this was done with such
- alacrity, that I dare say he thought himself the handsomest
- man in Tierra del Fuego. After our first feeling of grave
- astonishment was over, nothing could be more ludicrous
- than the odd mixture of surprise and imitation which these
- savages every moment exhibited.
-
-
- The next day I attempted to penetrate some way into the
- country. Tierra del Fuego may be described as a mountainous
- land, partly submerged in the sea, so that deep inlets
- and bays occupy the place where valleys should exist. The
- mountain sides, except on the exposed western coast, are
- covered from the water's edge upwards by one great forest.
- The trees reach to an elevation of between 1000 and 1500
- feet, and are succeeded by a band of peat, with minute alpine
- plants; and this again is succeeded by the line of perpetual
- snow, which, according to Captain King, in the Strait of
- Magellan descends to between 3000 and 4000 feet. To find
- an acre of level land in any part of the country is most rare.
- I recollect only one little flat piece near Port Famine, and
- another of rather larger extent near Goeree Road. In both
- places, and everywhere else, the surface is covered by a
- thick bed of swampy peat. Even within the forest, the
- ground is concealed by a mass of slowly putrefying vegetable
- matter, which, from being soaked with water, yields to the
- foot.
-
- Finding it nearly hopeless to push my way through the
- wood, I followed the course of a mountain torrent. At first,
- from the waterfalls and number of dead trees, I could hardly
- crawl along; but the bed of the stream soon became a little
- more open, from the floods having swept the sides. I continued
- slowly to advance for an hour along the broken and
- rocky banks, and was amply repaid by the grandeur of the
- scene. The gloomy depth of the ravine well accorded with
- the universal signs of violence. On every side were lying
- irregular masses of rock and torn-up trees; other trees,
- though still erect, were decayed to the heart and ready to
- fall. The entangled mass of the thriving and the fallen
- reminded me of the forests within the tropics -- yet there was
- a difference: for in these still solitudes, Death, instead of
- Life, seemed the predominant spirit. I followed the watercourse
- till I came to a spot where a great slip had cleared a
- straight space down the mountain side. By this road I
- ascended to a considerable elevation, and obtained a good
- view of the surrounding woods. The trees all belong to
- one kind, the Fagus betuloides; for the number of the other
- species of Fagus and of the Winter's Bark, is quite
- inconsiderable. This beech keeps its leaves throughout the year;
- but its foliage is of a peculiar brownish-green colour, with
- a tinge of yellow. As the whole landscape is thus coloured,
- it has a sombre, dull appearance; nor is it often enlivened
- by the rays of the sun.
-
- December 20th. -- One side of the harbour is formed by a
- hill about 1500 feet high, which Captain Fitz Roy has called
- after Sir J. Banks, in commemoration of his disastrous
- excursion, which proved fatal to two men of his party, and
- nearly so to Dr. Solander. The snowstorm, which was the
- cause of their misfortune, happened in the middle of January,
- corresponding to our July, and in the latitude of Durham!
- I was anxious to reach the summit of this mountain
- to collect alpine plants; for flowers of any kind in the lower
- parts are few in number. We followed the same watercourse
- as on the previous day, till it dwindled away, and we
- were then compelled to crawl blindly among the trees.
- These, from the effects of the elevation and of the impetuous
- winds, were low, thick and crooked. At length we reached
- that which from a distance appeared like a carpet of fine
- green turf, but which, to our vexation, turned out to be a
- compact mass of little beech-trees about four or five feet
- high. They were as thick together as box in the border of
- a garden, and we were obliged to struggle over the flat but
- treacherous surface. After a little more trouble we gained
- the peat, and then the bare slate rock.
-
- A ridge connected this hill with another, distant some
- miles, and more lofty, so that patches of snow were lying
- on it. As the day was not far advanced, I determined to
- walk there and collect plants along the road. It would have
- been very hard work, had it not been for a well-beaten and
- straight path made by the guanacos; for these animals, like
- sheep, always follow the same line. When we reached the
- hill we found it the highest in the immediate neighbourhood,
- and the waters flowed to the sea in opposite directions. We
- obtained a wide view over the surrounding country: to the
- north a swampy moorland extended, but to the south we
- had a scene of savage magnificence, well becoming Tierra
- del Fuego. There was a degree of mysterious grandeur
- in mountain behind mountain, with the deep intervening
- valleys, all covered by one thick, dusky mass of forest. The
- atmosphere, likewise, in this climate, where gale succeeds
- gale, with rain, hail, and sleet, seems blacker than anywhere
- else. In the Strait of Magellan looking due southward from
- Port Famine, the distant channels between the mountains
- appeared from their gloominess to lead beyond the confines
- of this world.
-
- December 21st. -- The Beagle got under way: and on the
- succeeding day, favoured to an uncommon degree by a fine
- easterly breeze, we closed in with the Barnevelts, and running
- past Cape Deceit with its stony peaks, about three
- o'clock doubled the weather-beaten Cape Horn. The evening
- was calm and bright, and we enjoyed a fine view of the
- surrounding isles. Cape Horn, however, demanded his tribute,
- and before night sent us a gale of wind directly in our teeth.
- We stood out to sea, and on the second day again made the
- land, when we saw on our weather-bow this notorious promontory
- in its proper form -- veiled in a mist, and its dim
- outline surrounded by a storm of wind and water. Great
- black clouds were rolling across the heavens, and squalls
- of rain, with hail, swept by us with such extreme violence,
- that the Captain determined to run into Wigwam Cove.
- This is a snug little harbour, not far from Cape Horn; and
- here, at Christmas-eve, we anchored in smooth water. The
- only thing which reminded us of the gale outside, was every
- now and then a puff from the mountains, which made the
- ship surge at her anchors.
-
- December 25th. -- Close by the Cove, a pointed hill, called
- Kater's Peak, rises to the height of 1700 feet. The surrounding
- islands all consist of conical masses of greenstone,
- associated sometimes with less regular hills of baked and
- altered clay-slate. This part of Tierra del Fuego may be
- considered as the extremity of the submerged chain of
- mountains already alluded to. The cove takes its name of
- "Wigwam" from some of the Fuegian habitations; but every
- bay in the neighbourhood might be so called with equal
- propriety. The inhabitants, living chiefly upon shell-fish, are
- obliged constantly to change their place of residence; but
- they return at intervals to the same spots, as is evident from
- the piles of old shells, which must often amount to many
- tons in freight. These heaps can be distinguished at a long
- distance by the bright green colour of certain plants, which
- invariably grow on them. Among these may be enumerated
- the wild celery and scurvy grass, two very serviceable plants,
- the use of which has not been discovered by the natives.
-
- The Fuegian wigwam resembles, in size and dimensions,
- a haycock. It merely consists of a few broken branches
- stuck in the ground, and very imperfectly thatched on one
- side with a few tufts of grass and rushes. The whole cannot
- be the work of an hour, and it is only used for a few days.
- At Goeree Roads I saw a place where one of these naked
- men had slept, which absolutely offered no more cover than
- the form of a hare. The man was evidently living by himself,
- and York Minster said he was "very bad man," and
- that probably he had stolen something. On the west coast,
- however, the wigwams are rather better, for they are covered
- with seal-skins. We were detained here several days by the
- bad weather. The climate is certainly wretched: the summer
- solstice was now passed, yet every day snow fell on the
- hills, and in the valleys there was rain, accompanied by
- sleet. The thermometer generally stood about 45 degs., but in
- the night fell to 38 or 40 degs. From the damp and boisterous
- state of the atmosphere, not cheered by a gleam of sunshine,
- one fancied the climate even worse than it really was.
-
- While going one day on shore near Wollaston Island, we
- pulled alongside a canoe with six Fuegians. These were the
- most abject and miserable creatures I anywhere beheld. On
- the east coast the natives, as we have seen, have guanaco
- cloaks, and on the west they possess seal-skins. Amongst
- these central tribes the men generally have an otter-skin, or
- some small scrap about as large as a pocket-handkerchief,
- which is barely sufficient to cover their backs as low down
- as their loins. It is laced across the breast by strings, and
- according as the wind blows, it is shifted from side to side.
- But these Fuegians in the canoe were quite naked, and even
- one full-grown woman was absolutely so. It was raining
- heavily, and the fresh water, together with the spray, trickled
- down her body. In another harbour not far distant, a
- woman, who was suckling a recently-born child, came one
- day alongside the vessel, and remained there out of mere
- curiosity, whilst the sleet fell and thawed on her naked
- bosom, and on the skin of her naked baby! These poor
- wretches were stunted in their growth, their hideous faces
- bedaubed with white paint, their skins filthy and greasy,
- their hair entangled, their voices discordant, and their
- gestures violent. Viewing such men, one can hardly make one's
- self believe that they are fellow-creatures, and inhabitants
- of the same world. It is a common subject of conjecture
- what pleasure in life some of the lower animals can enjoy:
- how much more reasonably the same question may be asked
- with respect to these barbarians! At night, five or six
- human beings, naked and scarcely protected from the wind
- and rain of this tempestuous climate, sleep on the wet
- ground coiled up like animals. Whenever it is low water,
- winter or summer, night or day, they must rise to pick shellfish
- from the rocks; and the women either dive to collect
- sea-eggs, or sit patiently in their canoes, and with a baited
- hair-line without any hook, jerk out little fish. If a seal is
- killed, or the floating carcass of a putrid whale is discovered,
- it is a feast; and such miserable food is assisted by a few
- tasteless berries and fungi.
-
- They often suffer from famine: I heard Mr. Low, a sealing-master
- intimately acquainted with the natives of this
- country, give a curious account of the state of a party of
- one hundred and fifty natives on the west coast, who were
- very thin and in great distress. A succession of gales prevented
- the women from getting shell-fish on the rocks, and
- they could not go out in their canoes to catch seal. A small
- party of these men one morning set out, and the other
- Indians explained to him, that they were going a four days'
- journey for food: on their return, Low went to meet them,
- and he found them excessively tired, each man carrying
- a great square piece of putrid whale's-blubber with a hole
- in the middle, through which they put their heads, like the
- Gauchos do through their ponchos or cloaks. As soon as
- the blubber was brought into a wigwam, an old man cut off
- thin slices, and muttering over them, broiled them for a
- minute, and distributed them to the famished party, who
- during this time preserved a profound silence. Mr. Low
- believes that whenever a whale is cast on shore, the natives
- bury large pieces of it in the sand, as a resource in time of
- famine; and a native boy, whom he had on board, once
- found a stock thus buried. The different tribes when at
- war are cannibals. From the concurrent, but quite independent
- evidence of the boy taken by Mr. Low, and of
- Jemmy Button, it is certainly true, that when pressed in
- winter by hunger, they kill and devour their old women
- before they kill their dogs: the boy, being asked by Mr.
- Low why they did this, answered, "Doggies catch otters,
- old women no." This boy described the manner in which
- they are killed by being held over smoke and thus choked;
- he imitated their screams as a joke, and described the parts
- of their bodies which are considered best to eat. Horrid
- as such a death by the hands of their friends and relatives
- must be, the fears of the old women, when hunger begins
- to press, are more painful to think of; we are told that they
- then often run away into the mountains, but that they are
- pursued by the men and brought back to the slaughter-house
- at their own firesides!
-
- Captain Fitz Roy could never ascertain that the Fuegians
- have any distinct belief in a future life. They sometimes
- bury their dead in caves, and sometimes in the mountain
- forests; we do not know what ceremonies they perform.
- Jemmy Button would not eat land-birds, because "eat dead
- men": they are unwilling even to mention their dead friends.
- We have no reason to believe that they perform any sort of
- religious worship; though perhaps the muttering of the old
- man before he distributed the putrid blubber to his famished
- party, may be of this nature. Each family or tribe has a
- wizard or conjuring doctor, whose office we could never
- clearly ascertain. Jemmy believed in dreams, though not, as
- I have said, in the devil: I do not think that our Fuegians
- were much more superstitious than some of the sailors; for
- an old quartermaster firmly believed that the successive
- heavy gales, which we encountered off Cape Horn, were
- caused by our having the Fuegians on board. The nearest
- approach to a religious feeling which I heard of, was shown
- by York Minster, who, when Mr. Bynoe shot some very
- young ducklings as specimens, declared in the most solemn
- manner, "Oh, Mr. Bynoe, much rain, snow, blow much."
- This was evidently a retributive punishment for wasting
- human food. In a wild and excited manner he also related,
- that his brother, one day whilst returning to pick up some
- dead birds which he had left on the coast, observed some
- feathers blown by the wind. His brother said (York imitating
- his manner), "What that?" and crawling onwards,
- he peeped over the cliff, and saw "wild man" picking his
- birds; he crawled a little nearer, and then hurled down a
- great stone and killed him. York declared for a long time
- afterwards storms raged, and much rain and snow fell.
- As far as we could make out, he seemed to consider the
- elements themselves as the avenging agents: it is evident in
- this case, how naturally, in a race a little more advanced
- in culture, the elements would become personified. What
- the "bad wild men" were, has always appeared to me most
- mysterious: from what York said, when we found the place
- like the form of a hare, where a single man had slept the
- night before, I should have thought that they were thieves
- who had been driven from their tribes; but other obscure
- speeches made me doubt this; I have sometimes imagined
- that the most probable explanation was that they were
- insane.
-
- The different tribes have no government or chief; yet
- each is surrounded by other hostile tribes, speaking different
- dialects, and separated from each other only by a deserted
- border or neutral territory: the cause of their warfare appears
- to be the means of subsistence. Their country is a
- broken mass of wild rocks, lofty hills, and useless forests:
- and these are viewed through mists and endless storms. The
- habitable land is reduced to the stones on the beach; in
- search of food they are compelled unceasingly to wander
- from spot to spot, and so steep is the coast, that they can
- only move about in their wretched canoes. They cannot
- know the feeling of having a home, and still less that of
- domestic affection; for the husband is to the wife a brutal
- master to a laborious slave. Was a more horrid deed ever
- perpetrated, than that witnessed on the west coast by Byron,
- who saw a wretched mother pick up her bleeding dying
- infant-boy, whom her husband had mercilessly dashed on the
- stones for dropping a basket of sea-eggs! How little can
- the higher powers of the mind be brought into play: what is
- there for imagination to picture, for reason to compare, or
- judgment to decide upon? to knock a limpet from the rock
- does not require even cunning, that lowest power of the
- mind. Their skill in some respects may be compared to the
- instinct of animals; for it is not improved by experience:
- the canoe, their most ingenious work, poor as it is, has
- remained the same, as we know from Drake, for the last two
- hundred and fifty years.
-
- Whilst beholding these savages, one asks, whence have
- they come? What could have tempted, or what change compelled
- a tribe of men, to leave the fine regions of the north,
- to travel down the Cordillera or backbone of America, to
- invent and build canoes, which are not used by the tribes
- of Chile, Peru, and Brazil, and then to enter on one of the
- most inhospitable countries within the limits of the globe?
- Although such reflections must at first seize on the mind, yet
- we may feel sure that they are partly erroneous. There is
- no reason to believe that the Fuegians decrease in number;
- therefore we must suppose that they enjoy a sufficient share
- of happiness, of whatever kind it may be, to render life
- worth having. Nature by making habit omnipotent, and its
- effects hereditary, has fitted the Fuegian to the climate and
- the productions of his miserable country.
-
-
- After having been detained six days in Wigwam Cove by
- very bad weather, we put to sea on the 30th of December.
- Captain Fitz Roy wished to get westward to land York and
- Fuegia in their own country. When at sea we had a constant
- succession of gales, and the current was against us: we
- drifted to 57 degs. 23' south. On the 11th of January, 1833,
- by carrying a press of sail, we fetched within a few miles of
- the great rugged mountain of York Minster (so called by
- Captain Cook, and the origin of the name of the elder Fuegian),
- when a violent squall compelled us to shorten sail
- and stand out to sea. The surf was breaking fearfully on
- the coast, and the spray was carried over a cliff estimated
- to 200 feet in height. On the 12th the gale was very heavy,
- and we did not know exactly where we were: it was a most
- unpleasant sound to hear constantly repeated, "keep a good
- look-out to leeward." On the 13th the storm raged with its
- full fury: our horizon was narrowly limited by the sheets
- of spray borne by the wind. The sea looked ominous, like
- a dreary waving plain with patches of drifted snow: whilst
- the ship laboured heavily, the albatross glided with its
- expanded wings right up the wind. At noon a great sea broke
- over us, and filled one of the whale boats, which was
- obliged to be instantly cut away. The poor Beagle trembled
- at the shock, and for a few minutes would not obey her helm;
- but soon, like a good ship that she was, she righted and came
- up to the wind again. Had another sea followed the first,
- our fate would have been decided soon, and for ever. We
- had now been twenty-four days trying in vain to get westward;
- the men were worn out with fatigue, and they had not
- had for many nights or days a dry thing to put on. Captain
- Fitz Roy gave up the attempt to get westward by the outside
- coast. In the evening we ran in behind False Cape Horn,
- and dropped our anchor in forty-seven fathoms, fire flashing
- from the windlass as the chain rushed round it. How delightful
- was that still night, after having been so long involved
- in the din of the warring elements!
-
- January 15th, 1833. -- The Beagle anchored in Goeree
- Roads. Captain Fitz Roy having resolved to settle the Fuegians,
- according to their wishes, in Ponsonby Sound, four
- boats were equipped to carry them there through the Beagle
- Channel. This channel, which was discovered by Captain
- Fitz Roy during the last voyage, is a most remarkable feature
- in the geography of this, or indeed of any other country: it
- may be compared to the valley of Lochness in Scotland, with
- its chain of lakes and friths. It is about one hundred and
- twenty miles long, with an average breadth, not subject to
- any very great variation, of about two miles; and is throughout
- the greater part so perfectly straight, that the view,
- bounded on each side by a line of mountains, gradually becomes
- indistinct in the long distance. It crosses the southern
- part of Tierra del Fuego in an east and west line, and
- in the middle is joined at right angles on the south side by
- an irregular channel, which has been called Ponsonby Sound.
- This is the residence of Jemmy Button's tribe and family.
-
- 19th. -- Three whale-boats and the yawl, with a party of
- twenty-eight, started under the command of Captain Fitz
- Roy. In the afternoon we entered the eastern mouth of the
- channel, and shortly afterwards found a snug little cove
- concealed by some surrounding islets. Here we pitched our
- tents and lighted our fires. Nothing could look more comfortable
- than this scene. The glassy water of the little harbour,
- with the branches of the trees hanging over the rocky
- beach, the boats at anchor, the tents supported by the crossed
- oars, and the smoke curling up the wooded valley, formed a
- picture of quiet retirement. The next day (20th) we smoothly
- glided onwards in our little fleet, and came to a more inhabited
- district. Few if any of these natives could ever
- have seen a white man; certainly nothing could exceed their
- astonishment at the apparition of the four boats. Fires were
- lighted on every point (hence the name of Tierra del Fuego,
- or the land of fire), both to attract our attention and to
- spread far and wide the news. Some of the men ran for
- miles along the shore. I shall never forget how wild and
- savage one group appeared: suddenly four or five men came
- to the edge of an overhanging cliff; they were absolutely
- naked, and their long hair streamed about their faces; they
- held rugged staffs in their hands, and, springing from the
- ground, they waved their arms round their heads, and sent
- forth the most hideous yells.
-
- At dinner-time we landed among a party of Fuegians.
- At first they were not inclined to be friendly; for until the
- Captain pulled in ahead of the other boats, they kept their
- slings in their hands. We soon, however, delighted them by
- trifling presents, such as tying red tape round their heads.
- They liked our biscuit: but one of the savages touched with
- his finger some of the meat preserved in tin cases which I
- was eating, and feeling it soft and cold, showed as much disgust
- at it, as I should have done at putrid blubber. Jemmy
- was thoroughly ashamed of his countrymen, and declared his
- own tribe were quite different, in which he was wofully
- mistaken. It was as easy to please as it was difficult to
- satisfy these savages. Young and old, men and children, never
- ceased repeating the word "yammerschooner," which means
- "give me." After pointing to almost every object, one after
- the other, even to the buttons on our coats, and saying their
- favourite word in as many intonations as possible, they would
- then use it in a neuter sense, and vacantly repeat
- "yammerschooner." After yammerschoonering for any article very
- eagerly, they would by a simple artifice point to their young
- women or little children, as much as to say, "If you will
- not give it me, surely you will to such as these."
-
- At night we endeavoured in vain to find an uninhabited
- cove; and at last were obliged to bivouac not far from a
- party of natives. They were very inoffensive as long as they
- were few in numbers, but in the morning (21st) being joined
- by others they showed symptoms of hostility, and we thought
- that we should have come to a skirmish. An European
- labours under great disadvantages when treating with savages
- like these, who have not the least idea of the power of
- fire-arms. In the very act of levelling his musket he appears
- to the savage far inferior to a man armed with a bow and
- arrow, a spear, or even a sling. Nor is it easy to teach them
- our superiority except by striking a fatal blow. Like wild
- beasts, they do not appear to compare numbers; for each
- individual, if attacked, instead of retiring, will endeavour to
- dash your brains out with a stone, as certainly as a tiger
- under similar circumstances would tear you. Captain Fitz
- Roy on one occasion being very anxious, from good reasons,
- to frighten away a small party, first flourished a cutlass near
- them, at which they only laughed; he then twice fired his
- pistol close to a native. The man both times looked astounded,
- and carefully but quickly rubbed his head; he then
- stared awhile, and gabbled to his companions, but he never
- seemed to think of running away. We can hardly put ourselves
- in the position of these savages, and understand their
- actions. In the case of this Fuegian, the possibility of such
- a sound as the report of a gun close to his ear could never
- have entered his mind. He perhaps literally did not for a
- second know whether it was a sound or a blow, and therefore
- very naturally rubbed his head. In a similar manner,
- when a savage sees a mark struck by a bullet, it may be some
- time before he is able at all to understand how it is effected;
- for the fact of a body being invisible from its velocity would
- perhaps be to him an idea totally inconceivable. Moreover,
- the extreme force of a bullet, that penetrates a hard substance
- without tearing it, may convince the savage that it
- has no force at all. Certainly I believe that many savages
- of the lowest grade, such as these of Tierra del Fuego, have
- seen objects struck, and even small animals killed by the
- musket, without being in the least aware how deadly an
- instrument it is.
-
- 22nd. -- After having passed an unmolested night, in what
- would appear to be neutral territory between Jemmy's tribe
- and the people whom we saw yesterday, we sailed pleasantly
- along. I do not know anything which shows more clearly
- the hostile state of the different tribes, than these wide
- border or neutral tracts. Although Jemmy Button well knew the
- force of our party, he was, at first, unwilling to land amidst
- the hostile tribe nearest to his own. He often told us how
- the savage Oens men "when the leaf red," crossed the mountains
- from the eastern coast of Tierra del Fuego, and made
- inroads on the natives of this part of the country. It was
- most curious to watch him when thus talking, and see his
- eyes gleaming and his whole face assume a new and wild
- expression. As we proceeded along the Beagle Channel, the
- scenery assumed a peculiar and very magnificent character;
- but the effect was much lessened from the lowness of the
- point of view in a boat, and from looking along the valley,
- and thus losing all the beauty of a succession of ridges. The
- mountains were here about three thousand feet high, and
- terminated in sharp and jagged points. They rose in one
- unbroken sweep from the water's edge, and were covered to
- the height of fourteen or fifteen hundred feet by the dusky-
- coloured forest. It was most curious to observe, as far as
- the eye could range, how level and truly horizontal the line
- on the mountain side was, at which trees ceased to grow: it
- precisely resembled the high-water mark of drift-weed on a
- sea-beach.
-
- At night we slept close to the junction of Ponsonby Sound
- with the Beagle Channel. A small family of Fuegians, who
- were living in the cove, were quiet and inoffensive, and soon
- joined our party round a blazing fire. We were well clothed,
- and though sitting close to the fire were far from too warm;
- yet these naked savages, though further off, were observed,
- to our great surprise, to be streaming with perspiration at
- undergoing such a roasting. They seemed, however, very
- well pleased, and all joined in the chorus of the seamen's
- songs: but the manner in which they were invariably a little
- behindhand was quite ludicrous.
-
- During the night the news had spread, and early in the
- morning (23rd) a fresh party arrived, belonging to the Tekenika,
- or Jemmy's tribe. Several of them had run so fast that
- their noses were bleeding, and their mouths frothed from
- the rapidity with which they talked; and with their naked
- bodies all bedaubed with black, white, [1] and red, they looked
- like so many demoniacs who had been fighting. We then
- proceeded (accompanied by twelve canoes, each holding four
- or five people) down Ponsonby Sound to the spot where poor
- Jemmy expected to find his mother and relatives. He had
- already heard that his father was dead; but as he had had
- a "dream in his head" to that effect, he did not seem to
- care much about it, and repeatedly comforted himself with
- the very natural reflection -- "Me no help it." He was not
- able to learn any particulars regarding his father's death, as
- his relations would not speak about it.
-
- Jemmy was now in a district well known to him, and
- guided the boats to a quiet pretty cove named Woollya,
- surrounded by islets, every one of which and every point had
- its proper native name. We found here a family of Jemmy's
- tribe, but not his relations: we made friends with them;
- and in the evening they sent a canoe to inform Jemmy's
- mother and brothers. The cove was bordered by some acres
- of good sloping land, not covered (as elsewhere) either by
- peat or by forest-trees. Captain Fitz Roy originally intended,
- as before stated, to have taken York Minster and
- Fuegia to their own tribe on the west coast; but as they
- expressed a wish to remain here, and as the spot was singularly
- favourable, Captain Fitz Roy determined to settle here the
- whole party, including Matthews, the missionary. Five days
- were spent in building for them three large wigwams, in
- landing their goods, in digging two gardens, and sowing
- seeds.
-
- The next morning after our arrival (the 24th) the Fuegians
- began to pour in, and Jemmy's mother and brothers
- arrived. Jemmy recognised the stentorian voice of one of
- his brothers at a prodigious distance. The meeting was less
- interesting than that between a horse, turned out into a field,
- when he joins an old companion. There was no demonstration
- of affection; they simply stared for a short time at
- each other; and the mother immediately went to look after
- her canoe. We heard, however, through York that the
- mother has been inconsolable for the loss of Jemmy and had
- searched everywhere for him, thinking that he might have
- been left after having been taken in the boat. The women
- took much notice of and were very kind to Fuegia. We had
- already perceived that Jemmy had almost forgotten his own
- language. I should think there was scarcely another human
- being with so small a stock of language, for his English was
- very imperfect. It was laughable, but almost pitiable, to
- hear him speak to his wild brother in English, and then ask
- him in Spanish ("no sabe?") whether he did not understand
- him.
-
- Everything went on peaceably during the three next days
- whilst the gardens were digging and wigwams building. We
- estimated the number of natives at about one hundred and
- twenty. The women worked hard, whilst the men lounged
- about all day long, watching us. They asked for everything
- they saw, and stole what they could. They were delighted
- at our dancing and singing, and were particularly interested
- at seeing us wash in a neighbouring brook; they did not pay
- much attention to anything else, not even to our boats. Of
- all the things which York saw, during his absence from his
- country, nothing seems more to have astonished him than
- an ostrich, near Maldonado: breathless with astonishment
- he came running to Mr. Bynoe, with whom he was out walking
- -- "Oh, Mr. Bynoe, oh, bird all same horse!" Much as
- our white skins surprised the natives, by Mr. Low's account
- a negro-cook to a sealing vessel, did so more effectually, and
- the poor fellow was so mobbed and shouted at that he would
- never go on shore again. Everything went on so quietly
- that some of the officers and myself took long walks in the
- surrounding hills and woods. Suddenly, however, on the
- 27th, every woman and child disappeared. We were all uneasy
- at this, as neither York nor Jemmy could make out
- the cause. It was thought by some that they had been frightened
- by our cleaning and firing off our muskets on the previous
- evening; by others, that it was owing to offence taken
- by an old savage, who, when told to keep further off, had
- coolly spit in the sentry's face, and had then, by gestures
- acted over a sleeping Fuegian, plainly showed, as it was said,
- that he should like to cut up and eat our man. Captain
- Fitz Roy, to avoid the chance of an encounter, which would
- have been fatal to so many of the Fuegians, thought it advisable
- for us to sleep at a cove a few miles distant. Matthews,
- with his usual quiet fortitude (remarkable in a man
- apparently possessing little energy of character), determined
- to stay with the Fuegians, who evinced no alarm for themselves;
- and so we left them to pass their first awful night.
-
- On our return in the morning (28th) we were delighted
- to find all quiet, and the men employed in their canoes
- spearing fish. Captain Fitz Roy determined to send the
- yawl and one whale-boat back to the ship; and to proceed
- with the two other boats, one under his own command (in
- which he most kindly allowed me to accompany him), and
- one under Mr. Hammond, to survey the western parts of
- the Beagle Channel, and afterwards to return and visit the
- settlement. The day to our astonishment was overpoweringly
- hot, so that our skins were scorched: with this beautiful
- weather, the view in the middle of the Beagle Channel
- was very remarkable. Looking towards either hand, no object
- intercepted the vanishing points of this long canal between
- the mountains. The circumstance of its being an arm
- of the sea was rendered very evident by several huge whales [2]
- spouting in different directions. On one occasion I saw two
- of these monsters, probably male and female, slowly swimming
- one after the other, within less than a stone's throw
- of the shore, over which the beech-tree extended its branches.
- We sailed on till it was dark, and then pitched our tents
- in a quiet creek. The greatest luxury was to find for our
- beds a beach of pebbles, for they were dry and yielded to
- the body. Peaty soil is damp; rock is uneven and hard;
- sand gets into one's meat, when cooked and eaten boat-fashion;
- but when lying in our blanket-bags, on a good bed of
- smooth pebbles, we passed most comfortable nights.
-
- It was my watch till one o'clock. There is something
- very solemn in these scenes. At no time does the consciousness
- in what a remote corner of the world you are then
- standing, come so strongly before the mind. Everything
- tends to this effect; the stillness of the night is interrupted
- only by the heavy breathing of the seamen beneath the tents,
- and sometimes by the cry of a night-bird. The occasional
- barking of a dog, heard in the distance, reminds one that it
- is the land of the savage.
-
- January 20th. -- Early in the morning we arrived at the
- point where the Beagle Channel divides into two arms; and
- we entered the northern one. The scenery here becomes
- even grander than before. The lofty mountains on the north
- side compose the granitic axis, or backbone of the country
- and boldly rise to a height of between three and four thousand
- feet, with one peak above six thousand feet. They are
- covered by a wide mantle of perpetual snow, and numerous
- cascades pour their waters, through the woods, into the narrow
- channel below. In many parts, magnificent glaciers extend
- from the mountain side to the water's edge. It is
- scarcely possible to imagine anything more beautiful than
- the beryl-like blue of these glaciers, and especially as
- contrasted with the dead white of the upper expanse of snow.
- The fragments which had fallen from the glacier into the
- water were floating away, and the channel with its icebergs
- presented, for the space of a mile, a miniature likeness of
- the Polar Sea. The boats being hauled on shore at our
- dinner-hour, we were admiring from the distance of half a
- mile a perpendicular cliff of ice, and were wishing that some
- more fragments would fall. At last, down came a mass with
- a roaring noise, and immediately we saw the smooth outline
- of a wave travelling towards us. The men ran down as
- quickly as they could to the boats; for the chance of their
- being dashed to pieces was evident. One of the seamen just
- caught hold of the bows, as the curling breaker reached it:
- he was knocked over and over, but not hurt, and the boats
- though thrice lifted on high and let fall again, received no
- damage. This was most fortunate for us, for we were a
- hundred miles distant from the ship, and we should have
- been left without provisions or fire-arms. I had previously
- observed that some large fragments of rock on the beach had
- been lately displaced; but until seeing this wave, I did not
- understand the cause. One side of the creek was formed
- by a spur of mica-slate; the head by a cliff of ice about
- forty feet high; and the other side by a promontory fifty
- feet high, built up of huge rounded fragments of granite
- and mica-slate, out of which old trees were growing. This
- promontory was evidently a moraine, heaped up at a period
- when the glacier had greater dimensions.
-
- When we reached the western mouth of this northern
- branch of the Beagle Channel, we sailed amongst many unknown
- desolate islands, and the weather was wretchedly bad.
- We met with no natives. The coast was almost everywhere
- so steep, that we had several times to pull many miles before
- we could find space enough to pitch our two tents: one night
- we slept on large round boulders, with putrefying sea-weed
- between them; and when the tide rose, we had to get up and
- move our blanket-bags. The farthest point westward which
- we reached was Stewart Island, a distance of about one hundred
- and fifty miles from our ship. We returned into the
- Beagle Channel by the southern arm, and thence proceeded,
- with no adventure, back to Ponsonby Sound.
-
- February 6th. -- We arrived at Woollya. Matthews gave
- so bad an account of the conduct of the Fuegians, that Captain
- Fitz Roy determined to take him back to the Beagle;
- and ultimately he was left at New Zealand, where his brother
- was a missionary. From the time of our leaving, a regular
- system of plunder commenced; fresh parties of the natives
- kept arriving: York and Jemmy lost many things, and Matthews
- almost everything which had not been concealed underground.
- Every article seemed to have been torn up and
- divided by the natives. Matthews described the watch he
- was obliged always to keep as most harassing; night and
- day he was surrounded by the natives, who tried to tire him
- out by making an incessant noise close to his head. One day
- an old man, whom Matthews asked to leave his wigwam,
- immediately returned with a large stone in his hand: another
- day a whole party came armed with stones and stakes, and
- some of the younger men and Jemmy's brother were crying:
- Matthews met them with presents. Another party showed
- by signs that they wished to strip him naked and pluck all
- the hairs out of his face and body. I think we arrived just
- in time to save his life. Jemmy's relatives had been so vain
- and foolish, that they had showed to strangers their plunder,
- and their manner of obtaining it. It was quite melancholy
- leaving the three Fuegians with their savage countrymen;
- but it was a great comfort that they had no personal
- fears. York, being a powerful resolute man, was pretty sure
- to get on well, together with his wife Fuegia. Poor Jemmy
- looked rather disconsolate, and would then, I have little
- doubt, have been glad to have returned with us. His own
- brother had stolen many things from him; and as he remarked,
- "What fashion call that:" he abused his countrymen,
- "all bad men, no sabe (know) nothing" and, though
- I never heard him swear before, "damned fools." Our three
- Fuegians, though they had been only three years with civilized
- men, would, I am sure, have been glad to have retained
- their new habits; but this was obviously impossible. I fear
- it is more than doubtful, whether their visit will have been
- of any use to them.
-
- In the evening, with Matthews on board, we made sail
- back to the ship, not by the Beagle Channel, but by the
- southern coast. The boats were heavily laden and the sea
- rough, and we had a dangerous passage. By the evening
- of the 7th we were on board the Beagle after an absence of
- twenty days, during which time we had gone three hundred
- miles in the open boats. On the 11th, Captain Fitz Roy
- paid a visit by himself to the Fuegians and found them going
- on well; and that they had lost very few more things.
-
-
- On the last day of February in the succeeding year (1834)
- the Beagle anchored in a beautiful little cove at the eastern
- entrance of the Beagle Channel. Captain Fitz Roy determined
- on the bold, and as it proved successful, attempt to
- beat against the westerly winds by the same route, which
- we had followed in the boats to the settlement at Woollya.
- We did not see many natives until we were near Ponsonby
- Sound, where we were followed by ten or twelve canoes. The
- natives did not at all understand the reason of our tacking,
- and, instead of meeting us at each tack, vainly strove to
- follow us in our zigzag course. I was amused at finding
- what a difference the circumstance of being quite superior
- in force made, in the interest of beholding these savages.
- While in the boats I got to hate the very sound of their
- voices, so much trouble did they give us. The first and last
- word was "yammerschooner." When, entering some quiet
- little cove, we have looked round and thought to pass a quiet
- night, the odious word "yammerschooner" has shrilly sounded
- from some gloomy nook, and then the little signal-smoke
- has curled up to spread the news far and wide. On leaving
- some place we have said to each other, "Thank heaven, we
- have at last fairly left these wretches!" when one more faint
- hallo from an all-powerful voice, heard at a prodigious
- distance, would reach our ears, and clearly could we distinguish
- -- "yammerschooner." But now, the more Fuegians the merrier;
- and very merry work it was. Both parties laughing,
- wondering, gaping at each other; we pitying them, for giving
- us good fish and crabs for rags, etc.; they grasping at the
- chance of finding people so foolish as to exchange such splendid
- ornaments for a good supper. It was most amusing to
- see the undisguised smile of satisfaction with which one
- young woman with her face painted black, tied several bits
- of scarlet cloth round her head with rushes. Her husband,
- who enjoyed the very universal privilege in this country of
- possessing two wives, evidently became jealous of all the
- attention paid to his young wife; and, after a consultation
- with his naked beauties, was paddled away by them.
-
- Some of the Fuegians plainly showed that they had a fair
- notion of barter. I gave one man a large nail (a most valuable
- present) without making any signs for a return; but he
- immediately picked out two fish, and handed them up on the
- point of his spear. If any present was designed for one
- canoe, and it fell near another, it was invariably given to the
- right owner. The Fuegian boy, whom Mr. Low had on
- board showed, by going into the most violent passion, that
- he quite understood the reproach of being called a liar, which
- in truth he was. We were this time, as on all former occasions,
- much surprised at the little notice, or rather none
- whatever, which was taken of many things, the use of which
- must have been evident to the natives. Simple circumstances
- -- such as the beauty of scarlet cloth or blue beads,
- the absence of women, our care in washing ourselves, -- excited
- their admiration far more than any grand or complicated
- object, such as our ship. Bougainville has well remarked
- concerning these people, that they treat the "chefs
- d'oeuvre de l'industrie humaine, comme ils traitent les loix
- de la nature et ses phenomenes."
-
- On the 5th of March, we anchored in a cove at Woollya,
- but we saw not a soul there. We were alarmed at this, for
- the natives in Ponsonby Sound showed by gestures, that there
- had been fighting; and we afterwards heard that the dreaded
- Oens men had made a descent. Soon a canoe, with a little
- flag flying, was seen approaching, with one of the men in it
- washing the paint off his face. This man was poor Jemmy,
- -- now a thin, haggard savage, with long disordered hair, and
- naked, except a bit of blanket round his waist. We did not
- recognize him till he was close to us, for he was ashamed
- of himself, and turned his back to the ship. We had left him
- plump, fat, clean, and well-dressed; -- I never saw so complete
- and grievous a change. As soon, however, as he was clothed,
- and the first flurry was over, things wore a good appearance.
- He dined with Captain Fitz Roy, and ate his dinner
- as tidily as formerly. He told us that he had "too much"
- (meaning enough) to eat, that he was not cold, that his
- relations were very good people, and that he did not wish to go
- back to England: in the evening we found out the cause of
- this great change in Jemmy's feelings, in the arrival of his
- young and nice-looking wife. With his usual good feeling
- he brought two beautiful otter-skins for two of his best
- friends, and some spear-heads and arrows made with his own
- hands for the Captain. He said he had built a canoe for himself,
- and he boasted that he could talk a little of his own
- language! But it is a most singular fact, that he appears to
- have taught all his tribe some English: an old man spontaneously
- announced "Jemmy Button's wife." Jemmy had lost
- all his property. He told us that York Minster had built
- a large canoe, and with his wife Fuegia, [3] had several months
- since gone to his own country, and had taken farewell by an
- act of consummate villainy; he persuaded Jemmy and his
- mother to come with him, and then on the way deserted them
- by night, stealing every article of their property.
-
- Jemmy went to sleep on shore, and in the morning returned,
- and remained on board till the ship got under way,
- which frightened his wife, who continued crying violently
- till he got into his canoe. He returned loaded with valuable
- property. Every soul on board was heartily sorry to shake
- hands with him for the last time. I do not now doubt that
- he will be as happy as, perhaps happier than, if he had never
- left his own country. Every one must sincerely hope that
- Captain Fitz Roy's noble hope may be fulfilled, of being
- rewarded for the many generous sacrifices which he made for
- these Fuegians, by some shipwrecked sailor being protected
- by the descendants of Jemmy Button and his tribe! When
- Jemmy reached the shore, he lighted a signal fire, and the
- smoke curled up, bidding us a last and long farewell, as the
- ship stood on her course into the open sea.
-
- The perfect equality among the individuals composing the
- Fuegian tribes must for a long time retard their civilization.
- As we see those animals, whose instinct compels them to live
- in society and obey a chief, are most capable of improvement,
- so is it with the races of mankind. Whether we look
- at it as a cause or a consequence, the more civilized always
- have the most artificial governments. For instance, the
- inhabitants of Otaheite, who, when first discovered, were
- governed by hereditary kings, had arrived at a far higher grade
- than another branch of the same people, the New Zealanders,
- -- who, although benefited by being compelled to turn their
- attention to agriculture, were republicans in the most absolute
- sense. In Tierra del Fuego, until some chief shall arise
- with power sufficient to secure any acquired advantage, such
- as the domesticated animals, it seems scarcely possible that
- the political state of the country can be improved. At present,
- even a piece of cloth given to one is torn into shreds
- and distributed; and no one individual becomes richer than
- another. On the other hand, it is difficult to understand how
- a chief can arise till there is property of some sort by which
- he might manifest his superiority and increase his power.
-
- I believe, in this extreme part of South America, man
- exists in a lower state of improvement than in any other part
- of the world. The South Sea Islanders, of the two races
- inhabiting the Pacific, are comparatively civilized. The
- Esquimau in his subterranean hut, enjoys some of the comforts
- of life, and in his canoe, when fully equipped, manifests
- much skill. Some of the tribes of Southern Africa
- prowling about in search of roots, and living concealed on
- the wild and arid plains, are sufficiently wretched. The
- Australian, in the simplicity of the arts of life, comes
- nearest the Fuegian: he can, however, boast of his boomerang,
- his spear and throwing-stick, his method of climbing trees, of
- tracking animals, and of hunting. Although the Australian may be
- superior in acquirements, it by no means follows that he is
- likewise superior in mental capacity: indeed, from what I
- saw of the Fuegians when on board and from what I have
- read of the Australians, I should think the case was exactly
- the reverse.
-
- [1] This substance, when dry, is tolerably compact, and of
- little specific gravity: Professor Ehrenberg has examined
- it: he states (Konig Akad. der Wissen: Berlin, Feb. 1845)
- that it is composed of infusoria, including fourteen
- polygastrica, and four phytolitharia. He says that they are
- all inhabitants of fresh-water; this is a beautiful example
- of the results obtainable through Professor Ehrenberg's
- microscopic researches; for Jemmy Button told me that it is
- always collected at the bottoms of mountain-brooks. It is,
- moreover, a striking fact that in the geographical distribution
- of the infusoria, which are well known to have very wide
- ranges, that all the species in this substance, although
- brought from the extreme southern point of Tierra del Fuego,
- are old, known forms.
-
- [2] One day, off the East coast of Tierra del Fuego, we saw
- a grand sight in several spermaceti whales jumping upright
- quite out of the water, with the exception of their tail-fins.
- As they fell down sideways, they splashed the water high up,
- and the sound reverberated like a distant broadside.
-
- [3] Captain Sulivan, who, since his voyage in the Beagle, has
- been employed on the survey of the Falkland Islands, heard
- from a sealer in (1842?), that when in the western part of
- the Strait of Magellan, he was astonished by a native woman
- coming on board, who could talk some English. Without doubt
- this was Fuega Basket. She lived (I fear the term probably
- bears a double interpretation) some days on board.
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XI
-
- STRAIT OF MAGELLAN. -- CLIMATE OF THE SOUTHERN COASTS
-
- Strait of Magellan -- Port Famine -- Ascent of Mount Tarn --
- Forests -- Edible Fungus -- Zoology -- Great Sea-weed -- Leave
- Tierra del Fuego -- Climate -- Fruit-trees and Productions
- of the Southern Coasts -- Height of Snow-line on the
- Cordillera -- Descent of Glaciers to the Sea -- Icebergs
- formed -- Transportal of Boulders -- Climate and Productions
- of the Antarctic Islands -- Preservation of Frozen Carcasses --
- Recapitulation.
-
-
- IN THE end of May, 1834, we entered for a second time
- the eastern mouth of the Strait of Magellan. The country
- on both sides of this part of the Strait consists of
- nearly level plains, like those of Patagonia. Cape Negro, a
- little within the second Narrows, may be considered as the
- point where the land begins to assume the marked features
- of Tierra del Fuego. On the east coast, south of the Strait,
- broken park-like scenery in a like manner connects these two
- countries, which are opposed to each other in almost every
- feature. It is truly surprising to find in a space of twenty
- miles such a change in the landscape. If we take a rather
- greater distance, as between Port Famine and Gregory Bay,
- that is about sixty miles, the difference is still more
- wonderful. At the former place, we have rounded mountains
- concealed by impervious forests, which are drenched with the
- rain, brought by an endless succession of gales; while at
- Cape Gregory, there is a clear and bright blue sky over the
- dry and sterile plains. The atmospheric currents, [1] although
- rapid, turbulent, and unconfined by any apparent limits, yet
- seem to follow, like a river in its bed, a regularly determined
- course.
-
- During our previous visit (in January), we had an interview
- at Cape Gregory with the famous so-called gigantic
- Patagonians, who gave us a cordial reception. Their height
- appears greater than it really is, from their large guanaco
- mantles, their long flowing hair, and general figure: on an
- average, their height is about six feet, with some men taller
- and only a few shorter; and the women are also tall; altogether
- they are certainly the tallest race which we anywhere
- saw. In features they strikingly resemble the more northern
- Indians whom I saw with Rosas, but they have a wilder and
- more formidable appearance: their faces were much painted
- with red and black, and one man was ringed and dotted with
- white like a Fuegian. Captain Fitz Roy offered to take any
- three of them on board, and all seemed determined to be of
- the three. It was long before we could clear the boat; at
- last we got on board with our three giants, who dined with
- the Captain, and behaved quite like gentlemen, helping
- themselves with knives, forks, and spoons: nothing was so much
- relished as sugar. This tribe has had so much communication
- with sealers and whalers that most of the men can speak a
- little English and Spanish; and they are half civilized, and
- proportionally demoralized.
-
- The next morning a large party went on shore, to barter
- for skins and ostrich-feathers; fire-arms being refused,
- tobacco was in greatest request, far more so than axes or
- tools. The whole population of the toldos, men, women, and
- children, were arranged on a bank. It was an amusing
- scene, and it was impossible not to like the so-called giants,
- they were so thoroughly good-humoured and unsuspecting:
- they asked us to come again. They seem to like to have
- Europeans to live with them; and old Maria, an important
- woman in the tribe, once begged Mr. Low to leave any one
- of his sailors with them. They spend the greater part of the
- year here; but in summer they hunt along the foot of the
- Cordillera: sometimes they travel as far as the Rio Negro
- 750 miles to the north. They are well stocked with horses,
- each man having, according to Mr. Low, six or seven, and
- all the women, and even children, their one own horse. In
- the time of Sarmiento (1580), these Indians had bows and
- arrows, now long since disused; they then also possessed
- some horses. This is a very curious fact, showing the
- extraordinarily rapid multiplication of horses in South America.
- The horse was first landed at Buenos Ayres in 1537, and the
- colony being then for a time deserted, the horse ran wild; [2]
- in 1580, only forty-three years afterwards, we hear of them at
- the Strait of Magellan! Mr. Low informs me, that a neighbouring
- tribe of foot-Indians is now changing into horse-Indians:
- the tribe at Gregory Bay giving them their worn-out horses,
- and sending in winter a few of their best skilled men to hunt
- for them.
-
- June 1st. -- We anchored in the fine bay of Port Famine.
- It was now the beginning of winter, and I never saw a more
- cheerless prospect; the dusky woods, piebald with snow,
- could be only seen indistinctly, through a drizzling hazy
- atmosphere. We were, however, lucky in getting two fine
- days. On one of these, Mount Sarmiento, a distant mountain
- 6800 feet high, presented a very noble spectacle. I was
- frequently surprised in the scenery of Tierra del Fuego, at the
- little apparent elevation of mountains really lofty. I suspect
- it is owing to a cause which would not at first be imagined,
- namely, that the whole mass, from the summit to the water's
- edge, is generally in full view. I remember having seen a
- mountain, first from the Beagle Channel, where the whole
- sweep from the summit to the base was full in view, and then
- from Ponsonby Sound across several successive ridges; and
- it was curious to observe in the latter case, as each fresh
- ridge afforded fresh means of judging of the distance, how
- the mountain rose in height.
-
- Before reaching Port Famine, two men were seen running
- along the shore and hailing the ship. A boat was sent for
- them. They turned out to be two sailors who had run away
- from a sealing-vessel, and had joined the Patagonians. These
- Indians had treated them with their usual disinterested
- hospitality. They had parted company through accident, and
- were then proceeding to Port Famine in hopes of finding
- some ship. I dare say they were worthless vagabonds, but I
- never saw more miserable-looking ones. They had been living
- for some days on mussel-shells and berries, and their
- tattered clothes had been burnt by sleeping so near their fires.
- They had been exposed night and day, without any shelter,
- to the late incessant gales, with rain, sleet, and snow, and yet
- they were in good health.
-
- During our stay at Port Famine, the Fuegians twice came
- and plagued us. As there were many instruments, clothes,
- and men on shore, it was thought necessary to frighten them
- away. The first time a few great guns were fired, when they
- were far distant. It was most ludicrous to watch through a
- glass the Indians, as often as the shot struck the water, take
- up stones, and, as a bold defiance, throw them towards the
- ship, though about a mile and a half distant! A boat was
- sent with orders to fire a few musket-shots wide of them.
- The Fuegians hid themselves behind the trees, and for every
- discharge of the muskets they fired their arrows; all, however,
- fell short of the boat, and the officer as he pointed at
- them laughed. This made the Fuegians frantic with passion,
- and they shook their mantles in vain rage. At last, seeing
- the balls cut and strike the trees, they ran away, and we were
- left in peace and quietness. During the former voyage the
- Fuegians were here very troublesome, and to frighten them a
- rocket was fired at night over their wigwams; it answered
- effectually, and one of the officers told me that the clamour
- first raised, and the barking of the dogs, was quite ludicrous
- in contrast with the profound silence which in a minute or
- two afterwards prevailed. The next morning not a single
- Fuegian was in the neighbourhood.
-
- When the Beagle was here in the month of February, I
- started one morning at four o'clock to ascend Mount Tarn,
- which is 2600 feet high, and is the most elevated point in this
- immediate district. We went in a boat to the foot of the
- mountain (but unluckily not to the best part), and then
- began our ascent. The forest commences at the line of high-
- water mark, and during the first two hours I gave over all
- hopes of reaching the summit. So thick was the wood, that
- it was necessary to have constant recourse to the compass;
- for every landmark, though in a mountainous country, was
- completely shut out. In the deep ravines, the death-like
- scene of desolation exceeded all description; outside it was
- blowing a gale, but in these hollows, not even a breath of
- wind stirred the leaves of the tallest trees. So gloomy, cold,
- and wet was every part, that not even the fungi, mosses, or
- ferns could flourish. In the valleys it was scarcely possible
- to crawl along, they were so completely barricaded by great
- mouldering trunks, which had fallen down in every direction.
- When passing over these natural bridges, one's course was
- often arrested by sinking knee deep into the rotten wood; at
- other times, when attempting to lean against a firm tree, one
- was startled by finding a mass of decayed matter ready to
- fall at the slightest touch. We at last found ourselves among
- the stunted trees, and then soon reached the bare ridge, which
- conducted us to the summit. Here was a view characteristic
- of Tierra del Fuego; irregular chains of hills, mottled with
- patches of snow, deep yellowish-green valleys, and arms of
- the sea intersecting the land in many directions. The strong
- wind was piercingly cold, and the atmosphere rather hazy, so
- that we did not stay long on the top of the mountain. Our
- descent was not quite so laborious as our ascent, for the
- weight of the body forced a passage, and all the slips and
- falls were in the right direction.
-
- I have already mentioned the sombre and dull character of
- the evergreen forests, [3] in which two or three species of
- trees grow, to the exclusion of all others. Above the forest
- land, there are many dwarf alpine plants, which all spring
- from the mass of peat, and help to compose it: these plants
- are very remarkable from their close alliance with the species
- growing on the mountains of Europe, though so many thousand
- miles distant. The central part of Tierra del Fuego, where the
- clay-slate formation occurs, is most favourable to the growth
- of trees; on the outer coast the poorer granitic soil, and a
- situation more exposed to the violent winds, do not allow of
- their attaining any great size. Near Port Famine I have seen
- more large trees than anywhere else: I measured a Winter's
- Bark which was four feet six inches in girth, and several of
- the beech were as much as thirteen feet. Captain King also
- mentions a beech which was seven feet in diameter, seventeen
- feet above the roots.
-
- There is one vegetable production deserving notice from
- its importance as an article of food to the Fuegians. It is a
- globular, bright-yellow fungus, which grows in vast numbers
- on the beech-trees. When young it is elastic and turgid, with
-
- [picture]
-
- a smooth surface; but when mature it shrinks, becomes tougher,
- and has its entire surface deeply pitted or honey-combed,
- as represented in the accompanying wood-cut. This fungus
- belongs to a new and curious genus, [4] I found a second
- species on another species of beech in Chile: and Dr. Hooker
- informs me, that just lately a third species has been discovered
- on a third species of beech in Van Diernan's Land. How singular
- is this relationship between parasitical fungi and the trees
- on which they grow, in distant parts of the world! In Tierra
- del Fuego the fungus in its tough and mature state is collected
- in large quantities by the women and children, and is eaten
- un-cooked. It has a mucilaginous, slightly sweet taste, with
- a faint smell like that of a mushroom. With the exception of
- a few berries, chiefly of a dwarf arbutus, the natives eat
- no vegetable food besides this fungus. In New Zealand,
- before the introduction of the potato, the roots of the fern
- were largely consumed; at the present time, I believe, Tierra
- del Fuego is the only country in the world where a cryptogamic
- plant affords a staple article of food.
-
- The zoology of Tierra del Fuego, as might have been
- expected from the nature of its climate and vegetation, is
- very poor. Of mammalia, besides whales and seals, there is
- one bat, a kind of mouse (Reithrodon chinchilloides), two
- true mice, a ctenomys allied to or identical with the tucutuco,
- two foxes (Canis Magellanicus and C. Azarae), a sea-otter,
- the guanaco, and a deer. Most of these animals inhabit only
- the drier eastern parts of the country; and the deer has never
- been seen south of the Strait of Magellan. Observing the
- general correspondence of the cliffs of soft sandstone, mud,
- and shingle, on the opposite sides of the Strait, and on some
- intervening islands, one is strongly tempted to believe that the
- land was once joined, and thus allowed animals so delicate
- and helpless as the tucutuco and Reithrodon to pass over.
- The correspondence of the cliffs is far from proving any
- junction; because such cliffs generally are formed by the
- intersection of sloping deposits, which, before the elevation
- of the land, had been accumulated near the then existing
- shores. It is, however, a remarkable coincidence, that in the
- two large islands cut off by the Beagle Channel from the
- rest of Tierra del Fuego, one has cliffs composed of matter
- that may be called stratified alluvium, which front similar
- ones on the opposite side of the channel, -- while the other is
- exclusively bordered by old crystalline rocks: in the former,
- called Navarin Island, both foxes and guanacos occur; but in
- the latter, Hoste Island, although similar in every respect,
- and only separated by a channel a little more than half a mile
- wide, I have the word of Jemmy Button for saying that
- neither of these animals are found.
-
- The gloomy woods are inhabited by few birds: occasionally
- the plaintive note of a white-tufted tyrant-flycatcher
- (Myiobius albiceps) may be heard, concealed near the summit
- of the most lofty trees; and more rarely the loud strange
- cry of a black wood-pecker, with a fine scarlet crest on its
- head. A little, dusky-coloured wren (Scytalopus Magellanicus)
- hops in a skulking manner among the entangled mass
- of the fallen and decaying trunks. But the creeper (Oxyurus
- tupinieri) is the commonest bird in the country. Throughout
- the beech forests, high up and low down, in the most
- gloomy, wet, and impenetrable ravines, it may be met with.
- This little bird no doubt appears more numerous than it
- really is, from its habit of following with seeming curiosity
- any person who enters these silent woods: continually uttering
- a harsh twitter, it flutters from tree to tree, within a few
- feet of the intruder's face. It is far from wishing for the
- modest concealment of the true creeper (Certhia familiaris);
- nor does it, like that bird, run up the trunks of trees, but
- industriously, after the manner of a willow-wren, hops about,
- and searches for insects on every twig and branch. In the
- more open parts, three or four species of finches, a thrush,
- a starling (or Icterus), two Opetiorhynchi, and several hawks
- and owls occur.
-
- The absence of any species whatever in the whole class of
- Reptiles, is a marked feature in the zoology of this country,
- as well as in that of the Falkland Islands. I do not ground
- this statement merely on my own observation, but I heard it
- from the Spanish inhabitants of the latter place, and from
- Jemmy Button with regard to Tierra del Fuego. On the
- banks of the Santa Cruz, in 50 degs. south, I saw a frog; and
- it is not improbable that these animals, as well as lizards, may
- be found as far south as the Strait of Magellan, where the
- country retains the character of Patagonia; but within the
- damp and cold limit of Tierra del Fuego not one occurs.
- That the climate would not have suited some of the orders,
- such as lizards, might have been foreseen; but with respect
- to frogs, this was not so obvious.
-
- Beetles occur in very small numbers: it was long before I
- could believe that a country as large as Scotland, covered
- with vegetable productions and with a variety of stations,
- could be so unproductive. The few which I found were
- alpine species (Harpalidae and Heteromidae) living under
- stones. The vegetable-feeding Chrysomelidae, so eminently
- characteristic of the Tropics, are here almost entirely
- absent; [5] I saw very few flies, butterflies, or bees, and no
- crickets or Orthoptera. In the pools of water I found but a few
- aquatic beetles, and not any fresh-water shells: Succinea at
- first appears an exception; but here it must be called a
- terrestrial shell, for it lives on the damp herbage far from the
- water. Land-shells could be procured only in the same alpine
- situations with the beetles. I have already contrasted the
- climate as well as the general appearance of Tierra del
- Fuego with that of Patagonia; and the difference is strongly
- exemplified in the entomology. I do not believe they have
- one species in common; certainly the general character of the
- insects is widely different.
-
- If we turn from the land to the sea, we shall find the latter
- as abundantly stocked with living creatures as the former is
- poorly so. In all parts of the world a rocky and partially
- protected shore perhaps supports, in a given space, a greater
- number of individual animals than any other station. There
- is one marine production which, from its importance, is
- worthy of a particular history. It is the kelp, or Macrocystis
- pyrifera. This plant grows on every rock from low-water
- mark to a great depth, both on the outer coast and within the
- channels. [6] I believe, during the voyages of the Adventure
- and Beagle, not one rock near the surface was discovered
- which was not buoyed by this floating weed. The good service
- it thus affords to vessels navigating near this stormy
- land is evident; and it certainly has saved many a one from
- being wrecked. I know few things more surprising than to
- see this plant growing and flourishing amidst those great
- breakers of the western ocean, which no mass of rock, let it
- be ever so hard, can long resist. The stem is round, slimy,
- and smooth, and seldom has a diameter of so much as an
- inch. A few taken together are sufficiently strong to support
- the weight of the large loose stones, to which in the inland
- channels they grow attached; and yet some of these stones
- were so heavy that when drawn to the surface, they could
- scarcely be lifted into a boat by one person. Captain Cook,
- in his second voyage, says, that this plant at Kerguelen Land
- rises from a greater depth than twenty-four fathoms; "and
- as it does not grow in a perpendicular direction, but makes a
- very acute angle with the bottom, and much of it afterwards
- spreads many fathoms on the surface of the sea, I am well
- warranted to say that some of it grows to the length of sixty
- fathoms and upwards." I do not suppose the stem of any
- other plant attains so great a length as three hundred and
- sixty feet, as stated by Captain Cook. Captain Fitz Roy,
- moreover, found it growing [7] up from the greater depth of
- forty-five fathoms. The beds of this sea-weed, even when
- of not great breadth, make excellent natural floating
- breakwaters. It is quite curious to see, in an exposed harbour,
- how soon the waves from the open sea, as they travel through
- the straggling stems, sink in height, and pass into smooth
- water.
-
- The number of living creatures of all Orders, whose existence
- intimately depends on the kelp, is wonderful. A great
- volume might be written, describing the inhabitants of one
- of these beds of sea-weed. Almost all the leaves, excepting
- those that float on the surface, are so thickly incrusted with
- corallines as to be of a white colour. We find exquisitely
- delicate structures, some inhabited by simple hydra-like
- polypi, others by more organized kinds, and beautiful compound
- Ascidiae. On the leaves, also, various patelliform shells,
- Trochi, uncovered molluscs, and some bivalves are attached.
- Innumerable crustacea frequent every part of the plant. On
- shaking the great entangled roots, a pile of small fish, shells,
- cuttle-fish, crabs of all orders, sea-eggs, star-fish, beautiful
- Holuthuriae, Planariae, and crawling nereidous animals of a
- multitude of forms, all fall out together. Often as I recurred
- to a branch of the kelp, I never failed to discover animals
- of new and curious structures. In Chiloe, where the kelp
- does not thrive very well, the numerous shells, corallines, and
- crustacea are absent; but there yet remain a few of the
- Flustraceae, and some compound Ascidiae; the latter, however,
- are of different species from those in Tierra del Fuego:
- we see here the fucus possessing a wider range than the animals
- which use it as an abode. I can only compare these
- great aquatic forests of the southern hemisphere with the
- terrestrial ones in the intertropical regions. Yet if in any
- country a forest was destroyed, I do not believe nearly so
- many species of animals would perish as would here, from
- the destruction of the kelp. Amidst the leaves of this plant
- numerous species of fish live, which nowhere else could find
- food or shelter; with their destruction the many cormorants
- and other fishing birds, the otters, seals, and porpoises, would
- soon perish also; and lastly, the Fuegian savage, the miserable
- lord of this miserable land, would redouble his cannibal
- feast, decrease in numbers, and perhaps cease to exist.
-
- June 8th. -- We weighed anchor early in the morning and
- left Port Famine. Captain Fitz Roy determined to leave the
- Strait of Magellan by the Magdalen Channel, which had not
- long been discovered. Our course lay due south, down that
- gloomy passage which I have before alluded to as appearing
- to lead to another and worse world. The wind was fair, but
- the atmosphere was very thick; so that we missed much
- curious scenery. The dark ragged clouds were rapidly driven
- over the mountains, from their summits nearly down to their
- bases. The glimpses which we caught through the dusky
- mass were highly interesting; jagged points, cones of snow,
- blue glaciers, strong outlines, marked on a lurid sky, were
- seen at different distances and heights. In the midst of such
- scenery we anchored at Cape Turn, close to Mount Sarmiento,
- which was then hidden in the clouds. At the base of
- the lofty and almost perpendicular sides of our little cove
- there was one deserted wigwam, and it alone reminded us
- that man sometimes wandered into these desolate regions.
- But it would be difficult to imagine a scene where he seemed
- to have fewer claims or less authority. The inanimate works
- of nature -- rock, ice, snow, wind, and water -- all warring
- with each other, yet combined against man -- here reigned in
- absolute sovereignty.
-
- June 9th. -- In the morning we were delighted by seeing
- the veil of mist gradually rise from Sarmiento, and display it
- to our view. This mountain, which is one of the highest in
- Tierra del Fuego, has an altitude of 6800 feet. Its base, for
- about an eighth of its total height, is clothed by dusky woods,
- and above this a field of snow extends to the summit. These
- vast piles of snow, which never melt, and seem destined to
- last as long as the world holds together, present a noble and
- even sublime spectacle. The outline of the mountain was
- admirably clear and defined. Owing to the abundance of
- light reflected from the white and glittering surface, no
- shadows were cast on any part; and those lines which intersected
- the sky could alone be distinguished: hence the mass
- stood out in the boldest relief. Several glaciers descended in
- a winding course from the upper great expanse of snow to
- the sea-coast: they may be likened to great frozen Niagaras;
- and perhaps these cataracts of blue ice are full as beautiful
- as the moving ones of water. By night we reached the western
- part of the channel; but the water was so deep that no
- anchorage could be found. We were in consequence obliged
- to stand off and on in this narrow arm of the sea, during a
- pitch-dark night of fourteen hours long.
-
- June 10th. -- In the morning we made the best of our way
- into the open Pacific. The western coast generally consists
- of low, rounded, quite barren hills of granite and greenstone.
- Sir J. Narborough called one part South Desolation, because
- it is "so desolate a land to behold:" and well indeed might
- he say so. Outside the main islands, there are numberless
- scattered rocks on which the long swell of the open ocean
- incessantly rages. We passed out between the East and West
- Furies; and a little farther northward there are so many
- breakers that the sea is called the Milky Way. One sight of
- such a coast is enough to make a landsman dream for a week
- about shipwrecks, peril, and death; and with this sight we
- bade farewell for ever to Tierra del Fuego.
-
- The following discussion on the climate of the southern
- parts of the continent with relation to its productions, on
- the snow-line, on the extraordinarily low descent of the
- glaciers, and on the zone of perpetual congelation in
- the antarctic islands, may be passed over by any one
- not interested in these curious subjects, or the final
- recapitulation alone may be read. I shall, however, here
- give only an abstract, and must refer for details to the
- Thirteenth Chapter and the Appendix of the former edition
- of this work.
-
- On the Climate and Productions of Tierra del Fuego and
- of the South-west Coast. -- The following table gives the
- mean temperature of Tierra del Fuego, the Falkland Islands,
- and, for comparison, that of Dublin: --
-
- Summer Winter Mean of Summer
- Latitude Temp. Temp. and Winter
- ---------------------------------------------------------------
- Tierra del Fuego 53 38' S. 50 33.08 41.54
- Falkland Islands 51 38' S. 51 -- --
- Dublin 53 21' N. 59.54 39.2 49.37
-
-
- Hence we see that the central part of Tierra del Fuego is
- colder in winter, and no less than 9.5 degs. less hot in
- summer, than Dublin. According to von Buch, the mean
- temperature of July (not the hottest month in the year)
- at Saltenfiord in Norway, is as high as 57.8 degs.,
- and this place is actually 13 degs. nearer the pole
- than Port Famine! [8] Inhospitable as this climate appears
- to our feelings evergreen trees flourish luxuriantly under
- it. Humming-birds may be seen sucking the flowers, and
- parrots feeding on the seeds of the Winter's Bark, in lat.
- 55 degs. S. I have already remarked to what a degree the
- sea swarms with living creatures; and the shells (such as
- the Patellae, Fissurellae, Chitons, and Barnacles),
- according to Mr. G. B. Sowerby, are of a much larger size
- and of a more vigorous growth, than the analogous species in
- the northern hemisphere. A large Voluta is abundant in
- southern Tierra del Fuego and the Falkland Islands. At
- Bahia Blanca, in lat. 39 degs. S., the most abundant shells were
- three species of Oliva (one of large size), one or two Volutas,
- and a Terebra. Now, these are amongst the best characterized
- tropical forms. It is doubtful whether even one
- small species of Oliva exists on the southern shores of
- Europe, and there are no species of the two other genera.
- If a geologist were to find in lat 39 degs. on the coast of
- Portugal a bed containing numerous shells belonging to three
- species of Oliva, to a Voluta and Terebra, he would probably
- assert that the climate at the period of their existence must
- have been tropical; but judging from South America, such an
- inference might be erroneous.
-
- The equable, humid, and windy climate of Tierra del
- Fuego extends, with only a small increase of heat, for many
- degrees along the west coast of the continent. The forests
- for 600 miles northward of Cape Horn, have a very similar
- aspect. As a proof of the equable climate, even for 300 or
- 400 miles still further northward, I may mention that in
- Chiloe (corresponding in latitude with the northern parts
- of Spain) the peach seldom produces fruit, whilst strawberries
- and apples thrive to perfection. Even the crops of
- barley and wheat [9] are often brought into the houses to be
- dried and ripened. At Valdivia (in the same latitude of
- 40 degs., with Madrid) grapes and figs ripen, but are not
- common; olives seldom ripen even partially, and oranges not at
- all. These fruits, in corresponding latitudes in Europe, are
- well known to succeed to perfection; and even in this continent,
- at the Rio Negro, under nearly the same parallel
- with Valdivia, sweet potatoes (convolvulus) are cultivated;
- and grapes, figs, olives, oranges, water and musk melons,
- produce abundant fruit. Although the humid and equable
- climate of Chiloe, and of the coast northward and southward
- of it, is so unfavourable to our fruits, yet the native
- forests, from lat. 45 to 38 degs., almost rival in luxuriance
- those of the glowing intertropical regions. Stately trees of
- many kinds, with smooth and highly coloured barks, are loaded
- by parasitical monocotyledonous plants; large and elegant
- ferns are numerous, and arborescent grasses entwine the
- trees into one entangled mass to the height of thirty or forty
- feet above the ground. Palm-trees grow in lat 37 degs.; an
- arborescent grass, very like a bamboo, in 40 degs.; and
- another closely allied kind, of great length, but not erect,
- flourishes even as far south as 45 degs. S.
-
- An equable climate, evidently due to the large area of sea
- compared with the land, seems to extend over the greater
- part of the southern hemisphere; and, as a consequence, the
- vegetation partakes of a semi-tropical character. Tree-ferns
- thrive luxuriantly in Van Diemen's Land (lat. 45 degs.), and I
- measured one trunk no less than six feet in circumference.
- An arborescent fern was found by Forster in New Zealand
- in 46 degs., where orchideous plants are parasitical on the
- trees. In the Auckland Islands, ferns, according to Dr.
- Dieffenbach [10] have trunks so thick and high that they may
- be almost called tree-ferns; and in these islands, and even
- as far south as lat. 55 degs. in the Macquarrie Islands,
- parrots abound.
-
- On the Height of the Snow-line, and on the Descent of
- the Glaciers in South America. -- For the detailed authorities
- for the following table, I must refer to the former edition: --
-
- Height in feet
- Latitude of Snow-line Observer
- ----------------------------------------------------------------
- Equatorial region; mean result 15,748 Humboldt.
- Bolivia, lat. 16 to 18 degs. S. 17,000 Pentland.
- Central Chile, lat. 33 degs. S. 14,500 - 15,000 Gillies, and
- the Author.
- Chiloe, lat. 41 to 43 degs. S. 6,000 Officers of the
- Beagle and the
- Author.
- Tierra del Fuego, 54 degs. S. 3,500 - 4,000 King.
-
-
- As the height of the plane of perpetual snow seems chiefly to
- be determined by the extreme heat of the summer, rather than
- by the mean temperature of the year, we ought not to be
- surprised at its descent in the Strait of Magellan, where the
- summer is so cool, to only 3500 or 4000 feet above the level of
- the sea; although in Norway, we must travel to between lat. 67
- and 70 degs. N., that is, about 14 degs. nearer the pole, to meet
- with perpetual snow at this low level. The difference in height,
- namely, about 9000 feet, between the snow-line on the Cordillera
- behind Chiloe (with its highest points ranging from
- only 5600 to 7500 feet) and in central Chile [11] (a distance of
- only 9 degs. of latitude), is truly wonderful. The land from the
- southward of Chiloe to near Concepcion (lat. 37 degs.) is hidden
- by one dense forest dripping with moisture. The sky is
- cloudy, and we have seen how badly the fruits of southern
- Europe succeed. In central Chile, on the other hand, a little
- northward of Concepcion, the sky is generally clear, rain does
- not fall for the seven summer months, and southern European
- fruits succeed admirably; and even the sugar-cane has
- been cultivated. [12] No doubt the plane of perpetual snow
- undergoes the above remarkable flexure of 9000 feet,
- unparalleled in other parts of the world, not far from the
- latitude of Concepcion, where the land ceases to be covered
- with forest-trees; for trees in South America indicate a rainy
- climate, and rain a clouded sky and little heat in summer.
-
- The descent of glaciers to the sea must, I conceive, mainly
- depend (subject, of course, to a proper supply of snow in the
- upper region) on the lowness of the line of perpetual snow
- on steep mountains near the coast. As the snow-line is so
- low in Tierra del Fuego, we might have expected that many
- of the glaciers would have reached the sea. Nevertheless,
- I was astonished when I first saw a range, only from 3000 to
- 4000 feet in height, in the latitude of Cumberland, with every
- valley filled with streams of ice descending to the sea-coast.
- Almost every arm of the sea, which penetrates to the interior
- higher chain, not only in Tierra del Fuego, but on the coast
- for 650 miles northwards, is terminated by "tremendous and
- astonishing glaciers," as described by one of the officers on
- the survey. Great masses of ice frequently fall from these
- icy cliffs, and the crash reverberates like the broadside of a
- man-of-war through the lonely channels. These falls, as
- noticed in the last chapter, produce great waves which break
- on the adjoining coasts. It is known that earthquakes frequently
- cause masses of earth to fall from sea-cliffs: how
- terrific, then, would be the effect of a severe shock (and such
- occur here [13]) on a body like a glacier, already in motion, and
- traversed by fissures! I can readily believe that the water
- would be fairly beaten back out of the deepest channel, and
- then, returning with an overwhelming force, would whirl
- about huge masses of rock like so much chaff. In Eyre's
- Sound, in the latitude of Paris, there are immense glaciers,
- and yet the loftiest neighbouring mountain is only 6200 feet
- high. In this Sound, about fifty icebergs were seen at one
- time floating outwards, and one of them must have been at
- least 168 feet in total height. Some of the icebergs were
- loaded with blocks of no inconsiderable size, of granite and
- other rocks, different from the clay-slate of the surrounding
- mountains. The glacier furthest from the pole, surveyed
- during the voyages of the Adventure and Beagle, is in lat.
- 46 degs. 50', in the Gulf of Penas. It is 15 miles long, and in
- one part 7 broad and descends to the sea-coast. But even a
- few miles northward of this glacier, in Laguna de San
-
- [picture]
-
- Rafael, some Spanish missionaries [14] encountered "many
- icebergs, some great, some small, and others middle-sized," in
- a narrow arm of the sea, on the 22nd of the month corresponding
- with our June, and in a latitude corresponding with
- that of the Lake of Geneva !
-
- In Europe, the most southern glacier which comes down
- to the sea is met with, according to Von Buch, on the coast
- of Norway, in lat. 67 degs. Now, this is more than 20 degs. of
- latitude, or 1230 miles, nearer the pole than the Laguna de San
- Rafael. The position of the glaciers at this place and in the
- Gulf of Penas may be put even in a more striking point of
- view, for they descend to the sea-coast within 7.5 degs. of
- latitude, or 450 miles, of a harbour, where three species of
- Oliva, a Voluta, and a Terebra, are the commonest shells,
- within less than 9 degs. from where palms grow, within 4.5 degs.
- of a region where the jaguar and puma range over the
- plains, less than 2.5 degs. from arborescent grasses, and
- (looking to the westward in the same hemisphere) less than
- 2 degs. from orchideous parasites, and within a single degree
- of tree-ferns!
-
- These facts are of high geological interest with respect to
- the climate of the northern hemisphere at the period when
- boulders were transported. I will not here detail how simply
- the theory of icebergs being charged with fragments of rock,
- explain the origin and position of the gigantic boulders of
- eastern Tierra del Fuego, on the high plain of Santa Cruz,
- and on the island of Chiloe. In Tierra del Fuego, the greater
- number of boulders lie on the lines of old sea-channels, now
- converted into dry valleys by the elevation of the land. They
- are associated with a great unstratified formation of mud
- and sand, containing rounded and angular fragments of all
- sizes, which has originated [15] in the repeated ploughing up of
- the sea-bottom by the stranding of icebergs, and by the matter
- transported on them. Few geologists now doubt that
- those erratic boulders which lie near lofty mountains have
- been pushed forward by the glaciers themselves, and that
- those distant from mountains, and embedded in subaqueous
- deposits, have been conveyed thither either on icebergs or
- frozen in coast-ice. The connection between the transportal
- of boulders and the presence of ice in some form, is strikingly
- shown by their geographical distribution over the earth.
- In South America they are not found further than 48 degs. of
- latitude, measured from the southern pole; in North America
- it appears that the limit of their transportal extends to
- 53.5 degs. from the northern pole; but in Europe to not more
- than 40 degs. of latitude, measured from the same point. On the
- other hand, in the intertropical parts of America, Asia, and
- Africa, they have never been observed; nor at the Cape of Good
- Hope, nor in Australia. [16]
-
- On the Climate and Productions of the Antarctic Islands.
- -- Considering the rankness of the vegetation in Tierra del
- Fuego, and on the coast northward of it, the condition of the
- islands south and south-west of America is truly surprising.
- Sandwich Land, in the latitude of the north part of Scotland,
- was found by Cook, during the hottest month of the
- year, "covered many fathoms thick with everlasting snow;"
- and there seems to be scarcely any vegetation. Georgia, an
- island 96 miles long and 10 broad, in the latitude of Yorkshire,
- "in the very height of summer, is in a manner wholly
- covered with frozen snow." It can boast only of moss, some
- tufts of grass, and wild burnet; it has only one land-bird
- (Anthus correndera), yet Iceland, which is 10 degs. nearer the
- pole, has, according to Mackenzie, fifteen land-birds. The
- South Shetland Islands, in the same latitude as the southern
- half of Norway, possess only some lichens, moss, and a little
- grass; and Lieut. Kendall [17] found the bay, in which he was
- at anchor, beginning to freeze at a period corresponding with
- our 8th of September. The soil here consists of ice and
- volcanic ashes interstratified; and at a little depth beneath
- the surface it must remain perpetually congealed, for Lieut.
- Kendall found the body of a foreign sailor which had long
- been buried, with the flesh and all the features perfectly
- preserved. It is a singular fact, that on the two great
- continents in the northern hemisphere (but not in the broken
- land of Europe between them ), we have the zone of perpetually
- frozen undersoil in a low latitude -- namely, in 56 degs. in
- North America at the depth of three feet, [18] and in 62 degs.
- in Siberia at the depth of twelve to fifteen feet -- as the
- result of a directly opposite condition of things to those
- of the southern hemisphere. On the northern continents, the
- winter is rendered excessively cold by the radiation from a
- large area of land into a clear sky, nor is it moderated by
- the warmth-bringing currents of the sea; the short summer,
- on the other hand, is hot. In the Southern Ocean the winter
- is not so excessively cold, but the summer is far less hot,
- for the clouded sky seldom allows the sun to warm the ocean,
- itself a bad absorbent of heat: and hence the mean temperature
- of the year, which regulates the zone of perpetually congealed
- under-soil, is low. It is evident that a rank vegetation,
- which does not so much require heat as it does protection
- from intense cold, would approach much nearer to this zone
- of perpetual congelation under the equable climate of the
- southern hemisphere, than under the extreme climate of the
- northern continents.
-
- The case of the sailor's body perfectly preserved in the icy
- soil of the South Shetland Islands (lat. 62 to 63 degs. S.), in a
- rather lower latitude than that (lat. 64 degs. N.) under which
- Pallas found the frozen rhinoceros in Siberia, is very
- interesting. Although it is a fallacy, as I have endeavoured to
- show in a former chapter, to suppose that the larger quadrupeds
- require a luxuriant vegetation for their support, nevertheless
- it is important to find in the South Shetland Islands
- a frozen under-soil within 360 miles of the forest-clad islands
- near Cape Horn, where, as far as the _bulk_ of vegetation is
- concerned, any number of great quadrupeds might be supported.
- The perfect preservation of the carcasses of the
- Siberian elephants and rhinoceroses is certainly one of the
- most wonderful facts in geology; but independently of the
- imagined difficulty of supplying them with food from the
- adjoining countries, the whole case is not, I think, so
- perplexing as it has generally been considered. The plains of
- Siberia, like those of the Pampas, appear to have been formed
- under the sea, into which rivers brought down the bodies
- of many animals; of the greater number of these, only the
- skeletons have been preserved, but of others the perfect
- carcass. Now, it is known that in the shallow sea on the Arctic
- coast of America the bottom freezes, [19] and does not thaw in
- spring so soon as the surface of the land, moreover at
- greater depths, where the bottom of the sea does not freeze
- the mud a few feet beneath the top layer might remain even
- in summer below 32 degs., as in the case on the land with the
- soil at the depth of a few feet. At still greater depths, the
- temperature of the mud and water would probably not be low
- enough to preserve the flesh; and hence, carcasses drifted
- beyond the shallow parts near an Arctic coast, would have
- only their skeletons preserved: now in the extreme northern
- parts of Siberia bones are infinitely numerous, so that even
- islets are said to be almost composed of them; [20] and those
- islets lie no less than ten degrees of latitude north of the
- place where Pallas found the frozen rhinoceros. On the other
- hand, a carcass washed by a flood into a shallow part of the
- Arctic Sea, would be preserved for an indefinite period, if it
- were soon afterwards covered with mud sufficiently thick to
- prevent the heat of the summer-water penetrating to it; and
- if, when the sea-bottom was upraised into land, the covering
- was sufficiently thick to prevent the heat of the summer air
- and sun thawing and corrupting it.
-
- Recapitulation. -- I will recapitulate the principal facts with
- regard to the climate, ice-action, and organic productions of
- the southern hemisphere, transposing the places in imagination
- to Europe, with which we are so much better acquainted.
- Then, near Lisbon, the commonest sea-shells, namely, three
- species of Oliva, a Voluta, and a Terebra, would have a
- tropical character. In the southern provinces of France,
- magnificent forests, intwined by arborescent grasses and with
- the trees loaded with parasitical plants, would hide the face
- of the land. The puma and the jaguar would haunt the
- Pyrenees. In the latitude of Mont Blanc, but on an island as
- far westward as Central North America, tree-ferns and
- parasitical Orchideae would thrive amidst the thick woods.
- Even as far north as central Denmark, humming-birds would be
- seen fluttering about delicate flowers, and parrots feeding
- amidst the evergreen woods; and in the sea there, we should
- have a Voluta, and all the shells of large size and vigorous
- growth. Nevertheless, on some islands only 360 miles northward
- of our new Cape Horn in Denmark, a carcass buried
- in the soil (or if washed into a shallow sea, and covered up
- with mud) would be preserved perpetually frozen. If some
- bold navigator attempted to penetrate northward of these
- islands, he would run a thousand dangers amidst gigantic
- icebergs, on some of which he would see great blocks of rock
- borne far away from their original site. Another island of
- large size in the latitude of southern Scotland, but twice as
- far to the west, would be "almost wholly covered with
- everlasting snow," and would have each bay terminated by
- ice-cliffs, whence great masses would be yearly detached: this
- island would boast only of a little moss, grass, and burnet,
- and a titlark would be its only land inhabitant. From our
- new Cape Horn in Denmark, a chain of mountains, scarcely
- half the height of the Alps, would run in a straight line due
- southward; and on its western flank every deep creek of the
- sea, or fiord, would end in "bold and astonishing glaciers."
- These lonely channels would frequently reverberate with the
- falls of ice, and so often would great waves rush along their
- coasts; numerous icebergs, some as tall as cathedrals, and
- occasionally loaded with "no inconsiderable blocks of rock,"
- would be stranded on the outlying islets; at intervals violent
- earthquakes would shoot prodigious masses of ice into the
- waters below. Lastly, some missionaries attempting to penetrate
- a long arm of the sea, would behold the not lofty surrounding
- mountains, sending down their many grand icy streams
- to the sea-coast, and their progress in the boats would
- be checked by the innumerable floating icebergs, some small
- and some great; and this would have occurred on our twenty-
- second of June, and where the Lake of Geneva is now spread
- out! [21]
-
- [1] The south-westerly breezes are generally very dry.
- January 29th, being at anchor under Cape Gregory: a very
- hard gale from W. by S., clear sky with few cumuli;
- temperature 57 degs., dew-point 36 degs., -- difference
- 21 degs. On January 15th, at Port St. Julian: in the
- morning, light winds with much rain, followed by a very
- heavy squall with rain, -- settled into heavy gale with
- large cumuli, -- cleared up, blowing very strong from S.S.W.
- Temperature 60 degs., dew-point 42 degs., -- difference
- 18 degs.
-
- [2] Rengger, Natur. der Saeugethiere von Paraguay. S. 334.
-
- [3] Captain Fitz Roy informs me that in April (our October),
- the leaves of those trees which grow near the base of the
- mountains change colour, but not those on the more elevated
- parts. I remember having read some observations, showing
- that in England the leaves fall earlier in a warm and fine
- autumn than in a late and cold one, The change in the colour
- being here retarded in the more elevated, and therefore colder
- situations, must he owing to the same general law of vegetation.
- The trees of Tierra del Fuego during no part of the year
- entirely shed their leaves.
-
- [4] Described from my specimens and notes by the Rev. J. M.
- Berkeley, in the Linnean Transactions (vol. xix. p. 37), under
- the name of Cyttaria Darwinii; the Chilean species is the
- C. Berteroii. This genus is allied to Bulgaria.
-
- [5] I believe I must except one alpine Haltica, and a single
- specimen of a Melasoma. Mr. Waterhouse informs me, that of
- the Harpalidae there are eight or nine species -- the forms
- of the greater number being very peculiar; of Heteromera,
- four or five species; of Rhyncophora, six or seven; and of
- the following families one species in each: Staphylinidae,
- Elateridae, Cebrionidae, Melolonthidae. The species in the
- other orders are even fewer. In all the orders, the scarcity
- of the individuals is even more remarkable than that of the
- species. Most of the Coleoptera have been carefully described
- by Mr. Waterhouse in the Annals of Nat. Hist.
-
- [6] Its geographical range is remarkably wide; it is found
- from the extreme southern islets near Cape Horn, as far
- north on the eastern coast (according to information given
- me by Mr. Stokes) as lat. 43 degs., -- but on the western
- coast, as Dr. Hooker tells me, it extends to the R. San
- Francisco in California, and perhaps even to Kamtschatka.
- We thus have an immense range in latitude; and as Cook,
- who must have been well acquainted with the species, found
- it at Kerguelen Land, no less than 140 degs. in longitude.
-
- [7] Voyages of the Adventure and Beagle, vol. i. p. 363. -- It
- appears that sea-weed grows extremely quick. -- Mr. Stephenson
- found (Wilson's Voyage round Scotland, vol. ii. p. 228) that
- a rock uncovered only at spring-tides, which had been chiselled
- smooth in November, on the following May, that is, within
- six months afterwards, was thickly covered with Fucus digitatus
- two feet, and F. esculentus six feet, in length.
-
- [8] With regard to Tierra del Fuego, the results are deduced
- from the observations of Capt. King (Geographical Journal,
- 1830), and those taken on board the Beagle. For the Falkland
- Islands, I am indebted to Capt. Sulivan for the mean of the
- mean temperature (reduced from careful observations at
- midnight, 8 A.M., noon, and 8 P.M.) of the three hottest
- months, viz., December, January, and February. The temperature
- of Dublin is taken from Barton.
-
- [9] Agueros, Descrip. Hist. de la Prov. de Chiloe, 1791, p. 94.
-
- [10] See the German Translation of this Journal; and for the
- other facts, Mr. Brown's Appendix to Flinders's Voyage.
-
-
- [11] On the Cordillera of central Chile, I believe the
- snow-line varies exceedingly in height in different summers.
- I was assured that during one very dry and long summer, all
- the snow disappeared from Aconcagua, although it attains the
- prodigious height of 23,000 feet. It is probable that much
- of the snow at these great heights is evaporated rather than
- thawed.
-
- [12] Miers's Chile, vol. i. p. 415. It is said that the
- sugar-cane grew at Ingenio, lat. 32 to 33 degs., but not in
- sufficient quantity to make the manufacture profitable. In
- the valley of Quillota, south of Ingenio, I saw some large
- date palm trees.
-
- [13] Bulkeley's and Cummin's Faithful Narrative of the Loss
- of the Wager. The earthquake happened August 25, 1741.
-
- [14] Agueros, Desc. Hist. de Chiloe, p. 227.
-
- [15] Geological Transactions, vol. vi. p. 415.
-
- [16] I have given details (the first, I believe, published) on
- this subject in the first edition, and in the Appendix to it.
- I have there shown that the apparent exceptions to the absence
- of erratic boulders in certain countries, are due to erroneous
- observations; several statements there given I have since
- found confirmed by various authors.
-
- [17] Geographical Journal, 1830, pp. 65, 66.
-
- [18] Richardson's Append. to Back's Exped., and Humboldt's
- Fragm. Asiat., tom. ii. p. 386.
-
- [19] Messrs. Dease and Simpson, in Geograph. Journ., vol.
- viii. pp. 218 and 220.
-
- [20] Cuvier (Ossemens Fossiles, tom. i. p. 151), from Billing's
- Voyage.
-
- [21] In the former edition and Appendix, I have given some
- facts on the transportal of erratic boulders and icebergs
- in the Atlantic Ocean. This subject has lately been treated
- excellently by Mr. Hayes, in the Boston Journal (vol. iv.
- p. 426). The author does not appear aware of a case published
- by me (Geographical Journal, vol. ix. p. 528) of a gigantic
- boulder embedded in an iceberg in the Antarctic Ocean, almost
- certainly one hundred miles distant from any land, and
- perhaps much more distant. In the Appendix I have discussed
- at length the probability (at that time hardly thought of)
- of icebergs, when stranded, grooving and polishing rocks,
- like glaciers. This is now a very commonly received opinion;
- and I cannot still avoid the suspicion that it is applicable
- even to such cases as that of the Jura. Dr. Richardson has
- assured me that the icebergs off North America push before
- them pebbles and sand, and leave the sub-marine rocky flats
- quite bare; it is hardly possible to doubt that such ledges
- must be polished and scored in the direction of the set of
- the prevailing currents. Since writing that Appendix, I have
- seen in North Wales (London Phil. Mag., vol. xxi. p. 180)
- the adjoining action of glaciers and floating icebergs.
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XII
-
- CENTRAL CHILE
-
- Valparaiso -- Excursion to the Foot of the Andes -- Structure
- of the Land -- Ascend the Bell of Quillota -- Shattered
- Masses of Greenstone -- Immense Valleys -- Mines -- State of
- Miners -- Santiago -- Hot-baths of Cauquenes -- Gold-mines --
- Grinding-mills -- Perforated Stones -- Habits of the Puma -- El
- Turco and Tapacolo -- Hummingbirds.
-
-
- JULY 23rd. -- The Beagle anchored late at night in the
- bay of Valparaiso, the chief seaport of Chile. When
- morning came, everything appeared delightful. After
- Tierra del Fuego, the climate felt quite delicious -- the
- atmosphere so dry, and the heavens so clear and blue with the
- sun shining brightly, that all nature seemed sparkling with
- life. The view from the anchorage is very pretty. The town is
- built at the very foot of a range of hills, about 1600 feet
- high, and rather steep. From its position, it consists of one
- long, straggling street, which runs parallel to the beach,
- and wherever a ravine comes down, the houses are piled up on
- each side of it. The rounded hills, being only partially
- protected by a very scanty vegetation, are worn into numberless
- little gullies, which expose a singularly bright red soil. From
- this cause, and from the low whitewashed houses with tile roofs,
- the view reminded me of St. Cruz in Teneriffe. In a north-
- westerly direction there are some fine glimpses of the Andes:
- but these mountains appear much grander when viewed from
- the neighbouring hills: the great distance at which they are
- situated can then more readily be perceived. The volcano of
- Aconcagua is particularly magnificent. This huge and irregularly
- conical mass has an elevation greater than that of
- Chimborazo; for, from measurements made by the officers in
- the Beagle, its height is no less than 23,000 feet. The
- Cordillera, however, viewed from this point, owe the greater
- part of their beauty to the atmosphere through which they are
- seen. When the sun was setting in the Pacific, it was
- admirable to watch how clearly their rugged outlines could
- be distinguished, yet how varied and how delicate were the
- shades of their colour.
-
- I had the good fortune to find living here Mr. Richard
- Corfield, an old schoolfellow and friend, to whose hospitality
- and kindness I was greatly indebted, in having afforded me
- a most pleasant residence during the Beagle's stay in Chile.
- The immediate neighbourhood of Valparaiso is not very productive
- to the naturalist. During the long summer the wind
- blows steadily from the southward, and a little off shore, so
- that rain never falls; during the three winter months, however,
- it is sufficiently abundant. The vegetation in consequence
- is very scanty: except in some deep valleys, there are
- no trees, and only a little grass and a few low bushes are
- scattered over the less steep parts of the hills. When we
- reflect, that at the distance of 350 miles to the south, this
- side of the Andes is completely hidden by one impenetrable
- forest, the contrast is very remarkable. I took several long
- walks while collecting objects of natural history. The country
- is pleasant for exercise. There are many very beautiful flowers;
- and, as in most other dry climates, the plants and shrubs
- possess strong and peculiar odours -- even one's clothes by
- brushing through them became scented. I did not cease from
- wonder at finding each succeeding day as fine as the foregoing.
- What a difference does climate make in the enjoyment
- of life! How opposite are the sensations when viewing
- black mountains half enveloped in clouds, and seeing
- another range through the light blue haze of a fine day! The
- one for a time may be very sublime; the other is all gaiety
- and happy life.
-
- August 14th. -- I set out on a riding excursion, for the
- purpose of geologizing the basal parts of the Andes, which
- alone at this time of the year are not shut up by the winter
- snow. Our first day's ride was northward along the seacoast.
- After dark we reached the Hacienda of Quintero,
- the estate which formerly belonged to Lord Cochrane. My
- object in coming here was to see the great beds of shells,
- which stand some yards above the level of the sea, and are
- burnt for lime. The proofs of the elevation of this whole
- line of coast are unequivocal: at the height of a few hundred
- feet old-looking shells are numerous, and I found some
- at 1300 feet. These shells either lie loose on the surface, or
- are embedded in a reddish-black vegetable mould. I was
- much surprised to find under the microscope that this vegetable
- mould is really marine mud, full of minute particles of
- organic bodies.
-
- 15th. -- We returned towards the valley of Quillota. The
- country was exceedingly pleasant; just such as poets would
- call pastoral: green open lawns, separated by small valleys
- with rivulets, and the cottages, we may suppose of the shepherds
- scattered on the hill-sides. We were obliged to cross
- the ridge of the Chilicauquen. At its base there were many
- fine evergreen forest-trees, but these flourished only in the
- ravines, where there was running water. Any person who
- had seen only the country near Valparaiso, would never have
- imagined that there had been such picturesque spots in Chile.
- As soon as we reached the brow of the Sierra, the valley of
- Quillota was immediately under our feet. The prospect was
- one of remarkable artificial luxuriance. The valley is very
- broad and quite flat, and is thus easily irrigated in all parts.
- The little square gardens are crowded with orange and olive
- trees, and every sort of vegetable. On each side huge bare
- mountains rise, and this from the contrast renders the patchwork
- valley the more pleasing. Whoever called "Valparaiso"
- the "Valley of Paradise," must have been thinking
- of Quillota. We crossed over to the Hacienda de San Isidro,
- situated at the very foot of the Bell Mountain.
-
- Chile, as may be seen in the maps, is a narrow strip of
- land between the Cordillera and the Pacific; and this strip
- is itself traversed by several mountain-lines, which in this
- part run parallel to the great range. Between these outer
- lines and the main Cordillera, a succession of level basins,
- generally opening into each other by narrow passages, extend
- far to the southward: in these, the principal towns are
- situated, as San Felipe, Santiago, San Fernando. These basins
- or plains, together with the transverse flat valleys (like that
- of Quillota) which connect them with the coast, I have no
- doubt are the bottoms of ancient inlets and deep bays, such
- as at the present day intersect every part of Tierra del Fuego
- and the western coast. Chile must formerly have resembled
- the latter country in the configuration of its land and water.
- The resemblance was occasionally shown strikingly when a
- level fog-bank covered, as with a mantle, all the lower parts
- of the country: the white vapour curling into the ravines,
- beautifully represented little coves and bays; and here and
- there a solitary hillock peeping up, showed that it had formerly
- stood there as an islet. The contrast of these flat
- valleys and basins with the irregular mountains, gave the
- scenery a character which to me was new and very interesting.
-
- From the natural slope to seaward of these plains, they
- are very easily irrigated, and in consequence singularly
- fertile. Without this process the land would produce scarcely
- anything, for during the whole summer the sky is cloudless.
- The mountains and hills are dotted over with bushes and
- low trees, and excepting these the vegetation is very scanty.
- Each landowner in the valley possesses a certain portion of
- hill-country, where his half-wild cattle, in considerable
- numbers, manage to find sufficient pasture. Once every year
- there is a grand "rodeo," when all the cattle are driven down,
- counted, and marked, and a certain number separated to be
- fattened in the irrigated fields. Wheat is extensively
- cultivated, and a good deal of Indian corn: a kind of bean is,
- however, the staple article of food for the common labourers.
- The orchards produce an overflowing abundance of peaches
- figs, and grapes. With all these advantages, the inhabitants
- of the country ought to be much more prosperous than they
- are.
-
- 16th. -- The mayor-domo of the Hacienda was good enough
- to give me a guide and fresh horses; and in the morning we
- set out to ascend the Campana, or Bell Mountain, which is
- 6400 feet high. The paths were very bad, but both the
- geology and scenery amply repaid the trouble. We reached
- by the evening, a spring called the Agua del Guanaco, which
- is situated at a great height. This must be an old name,
- for it is very many years since a guanaco drank its waters.
- During the ascent I noticed that nothing but bushes grew
- on the northern slope, whilst on the southern slope there was
- a bamboo about fifteen feet high. In a few places there were
- palms, and I was surprised to see one at an elevation of at
- least 4500 feet. These palms are, for their family, ugly trees.
- Their stem is very large, and of a curious form, being thicker
- in the middle than at the base or top. They are excessively
- numerous in some parts of Chile, and valuable on account of
- a sort of treacle made from the sap. On one estate near
- Petorca they tried to count them, but failed, after having
- numbered several hundred thousand. Every year in the early
- spring, in August, very many are cut down, and when the
- trunk is lying on the ground, the crown of leaves is lopped
- off. The sap then immediately begins to flow from the upper
- end, and continues so doing for some months: it is, however,
- necessary that a thin slice should be shaved off from
- that end every morning, so as to expose a fresh surface. A
- good tree will give ninety gallons, and all this must have
- been contained in the vessels of the apparently dry trunk.
- It is said that the sap flows much more quickly on those
- days when the sun is powerful; and likewise, that it is
- absolutely necessary to take care, in cutting down the tree,
- that it should fall with its head upwards on the side of the
- hill; for if it falls down the slope, scarcely any sap will
- flow; although in that case one would have thought that the
- action would have been aided, instead of checked, by the force
- of gravity. The sap is concentrated by boiling, and is then
- called treacle, which it very much resembles in taste.
-
- We unsaddled our horses near the spring, and prepared to
- pass the night. The evening was fine, and the atmosphere so
- clear, that the masts of the vessels at anchor in the bay of
- Valparaiso, although no less than twenty-six geographical
- miles distant, could be distinguished clearly as little black
- streaks. A ship doubling the point under sail, appeared as
- a bright white speck. Anson expresses much surprise, in his
- voyage, at the distance at which his vessels were discovered
- from the coast; but he did not sufficiently allow for the height
- of the land, and the great transparency of the air.
-
- The setting of the sun was glorious; the valleys being
- black whilst the snowy peaks of the Andes yet retained a
- ruby tint. When it was dark, we made a fire beneath a little
- arbour of bamboos, fried our charqui (or dried slips of beef),
- took our mate, and were quite comfortable. There is an
- inexpressible charm in thus living in the open air. The evening
- was calm and still; -- the shrill noise of the mountain
- bizcacha, and the faint cry of a goatsucker, were occasionally
- to be heard. Besides these, few birds, or even
- insects, frequent these dry, parched mountains.
-
- August 17th. -- In the morning we climbed up the rough
- mass of greenstone which crowns the summit. This rock, as
- frequently happens, was much shattered and broken into
- huge angular fragments. I observed, however, one remarkable
- circumstance, namely, that many of the surfaces presented
- every degree of freshness some appearing as if
- broken the day before, whilst on others lichens had either
- just become, or had long grown, attached. I so fully believed
- that this was owing to the frequent earthquakes, that I felt
- inclined to hurry from below each loose pile. As one might
- very easily be deceived in a fact of this kind, I doubted its
- accuracy, until ascending Mount Wellington, in Van Diemen's
- Land, where earthquakes do not occur; and there I saw
- the summit of the mountain similarly composed and similarly
- shattered, but all the blocks appeared as if they had been
- hurled into their present position thousands of years ago.
-
- We spent the day on the summit, and I never enjoyed one
- more thoroughly. Chile, bounded by the Andes and the
- Pacific, was seen as in a map. The pleasure from the scenery,
- in itself beautiful, was heightened by the many reflections
- which arose from the mere view of the Campana range with
- its lesser parallel ones, and of the broad valley of Quillota
- directly intersecting them. Who can avoid wondering at the
- force which has upheaved these mountains, and even more
- so at the countless ages which it must have required to have
- broken through, removed, and levelled whole masses of them?
- It is well in this case to call to mind the vast shingle and
- sedimentary beds of Patagonia, which, if heaped on the
- Cordillera, would increase its height by so many thousand feet.
- When in that country, I wondered how any mountain-chain
- could have supplied such masses, and not have been utterly
- obliterated. We must not now reverse the wonder, and doubt
- whether all-powerful time can grind down mountains -- even
- the gigantic Cordillera -- into-gravel and mud.
-
- The appearance of the Andes was different from that
- which I had expected. The lower line of the snow was of
- course horizontal, and to this line the even summits of the
- range seemed quite parallel. Only at long intervals, a group
- of points or a single cone showed where a volcano had
- existed, or does now exist. Hence the range resembled a
- great solid wall, surmounted here and there by a tower, and
- making a most perfect barrier to the country.
-
- Almost every part of the hill had been drilled by attempts
- to open gold-mines: the rage for mining has left scarcely
- a spot in Chile unexamined. I spent the evening as before,
- talking round the fire with my two companions. The Guasos
- of Chile, who correspond to the Gauchos of the Pampas, are,
- however, a very different set of beings. Chile is the more
- civilized of the two countries, and the inhabitants, in
- consequence, have lost much individual character. Gradations
- in rank are much more strongly marked: the Guaso does not
- by any means consider every man his equal; and I was quite
- surprised to find that my companions did not like to eat at
- the same time with myself. This feeling of inequality is a
- necessary consequence of the existence of an aristocracy of
- wealth. It is said that some few of the greater landowners
- possess from five to ten thousand pounds sterling per annum:
- an inequality of riches which I believe is not met with in
- any of the cattle-breeding countries eastward of the Andes.
- A traveller does not here meet that unbounded hospitality
- which refuses all payment, but yet is so kindly offered that
- no scruples can be raised in accepting it. Almost every house
- in Chile will receive you for the night, but a trifle is
- expected to be given in the morning; even a rich man will
- accept two or three shillings. The Gaucho, although he may be
- a cutthroat, is a gentleman; the Guaso is in few respects
- better, but at the same time a vulgar, ordinary fellow. The
- two men, although employed much in the same manner, are
- different in their habits and attire; and the peculiarities
- of each are universal in their respective countries. The Gaucho
- seems part of his horse, and scorns to exert himself except when
- on his back: the Guaso may be hired to work as a labourer in
- the fields. The former lives entirely on animal food; the latter
- almost wholly on vegetable. We do not here see the white
- boots, the broad drawers and scarlet chilipa; the picturesque
- costume of the Pampas. Here, common trousers are protected
- by black and green worsted leggings. The poncho,
- however, is common to both. The chief pride of the Guaso
- lies in his spurs, which are absurdly large. I measured one
- which was six inches in the _diameter_ of the rowel, and the
- rowel itself contained upwards of thirty points. The stirrups
- are on the same scale, each consisting of a square, carved
- block of wood, hollowed out, yet weighing three or four
- pounds. The Guaso is perhaps more expert with the lazo
- than the Gaucho; but, from the nature of the country, he
- does not know the use of the bolas.
-
- August 18th. -- We descended the mountain, and passed
- some beautiful little spots, with rivulets and fine trees.
- Having slept at the same hacienda as before, we rode during the
- two succeeding days up the valley, and passed through Quillota,
- which is more like a collection of nursery-gardens than
- a town. The orchards were beautiful, presenting one mass
- of peach-blossoms. I saw, also, in one or two places the
- date-palm; it is a most stately tree; and I should think a
- group of them in their native Asiatic or African deserts must
- be superb. We passed likewise San Felipe, a pretty straggling
- town like Quillota. The valley in this part expands into
- one of those great bays or plains, reaching to the foot of the
- Cordillera, which have been mentioned as forming so curious
- a part of the scenery of Chile. In the evening we reached
- the mines of Jajuel, situated in a ravine at the flank of the
- great chain. I stayed here five days. My host the superintendent
- of the mine, was a shrewd but rather ignorant Cornish
- miner. He had married a Spanish woman, and did not
- mean to return home; but his admiration for the mines of
- Cornwall remained unbounded. Amongst many other questions,
- he asked me, "Now that George Rex is dead, how
- many more of the family of Rexes are yet alive?" This Rex
- certainly must be a relation of the great author Finis, who
- wrote all books!
-
- These mines are of copper, and the ore is all shipped to
- Swansea, to be smelted. Hence the mines have an aspect
- singularly quiet, as compared to those in England: here no
- smoke, furnaces, or great steam-engines, disturb the solitude
- of the surrounding mountains.
-
- The Chilian government, or rather the old Spanish law,
- encourages by every method the searching for mines. The
- discoverer may work a mine on any ground, by paying five
- shillings; and before paying this he may try, even in the
- garden of another man, for twenty days.
-
- It is now well known that the Chilian method of mining
- is the cheapest. My host says that the two principal
- improvements introduced by foreigners have been, first,
- reducing by previous roasting the copper pyrites -- which,
- being the common ore in Cornwall, the English miners were
- astounded on their arrival to find thrown away as useless:
- secondly, stamping and washing the scoriae from the old
- furnaces -- by which process particles of metal are recovered
- in abundance. I have actually seen mules carrying to the
- coast, for transportation to England, a cargo of such cinders.
- But the first case is much the most curious. The Chilian
- miners were so convinced that copper pyrites contained not
- a particle of copper, that they laughed at the Englishmen
- for their ignorance, who laughed in turn, and bought their
- richest veins for a few dollars. It is very odd that, in a
- country where mining had been extensively carried on for many
- years, so simple a process as gently roasting the ore to expel
- the sulphur previous to smelting it, had never been discovered.
- A few improvements have likewise been introduced in some of the
- simple machinery; but even to the present day, water is
- removed from some mines by men carrying it up the shaft in
- leathern bags!
-
- The labouring men work very hard. They have little time
- allowed for their meals, and during summer and winter they
- begin when it is light, and leave off at dark. They are paid
- one pound sterling a month, and their food is given them:
- this for breakfast consists of sixteen figs and two small loaves
- of bread; for dinner, boiled beans; for supper, broken roasted
- wheat grain. They scarcely ever taste meat; as, with the
- twelve pounds per annum, they have to clothe themselves, and
- support their families. The miners who work in the mine
- itself have twenty-five shillings per month, and are allowed
- a little charqui. But these men come down from their bleak
- habitations only once in every fortnight or three weeks.
-
- During my stay here I thoroughly enjoyed scrambling
- about these huge mountains. The geology, as might have
- been expected, was very interesting. The shattered and
- baked rocks, traversed by innumerable dykes of greenstone,
- showed what commotions had formerly taken place. The
- scenery was much the same as that near the Bell of Quillota
- -- dry barren mountains, dotted at intervals by bushes
- with a scanty foliage. The cactuses, or rather opuntias
- were here very numerous. I measured one of a spherical
- figure, which, including the spines, was six feet and four
- inches in circumference. The height of the common cylindrical,
- branching kind, is from twelve to fifteen feet, and
- the girth (with spines) of the branches between three and
- four feet.
-
- A heavy fall of snow on the mountains prevented me
- during the last two days, from making some interesting
- excursions. I attempted to reach a lake which the inhabitants,
- from some unaccountable reason, believe to be an arm
- of the sea. During a very dry season, it was proposed to
- attempt cutting a channel from it for the sake of the water,
- but the padre, after a consultation, declared it was too
- dangerous, as all Chile would be inundated, if, as generally
- supposed, the lake was connected with the Pacific. We
- ascended to a great height, but becoming involved in the
- snow-drifts failed in reaching this wonderful lake, and had
- some difficulty in returning. I thought we should have lost
- our horses; for there was no means of guessing how deep
- the drifts were, and the animals, when led, could only move
- by jumping. The black sky showed that a fresh snowstorm
- was gathering, and we therefore were not a little glad
- when we escaped. By the time we reached the base the
- storm commenced, and it was lucky for us that this did not
- happen three hours earlier in the day.
-
- August 26th. -- We left Jajuel and again crossed the basin
- of San Felipe. The day was truly Chilian: glaringly bright,
- and the atmosphere quite clear. The thick and uniform
- covering of newly fallen snow rendered the view of the volcano
- of Aconcagua and the main chain quite glorious. We
- were now on the road to Santiago, the capital of Chile. We
- crossed the Cerro del Talguen, and slept at a little rancho.
- The host, talking about the state of Chile as compared to
- other countries, was very humble: "Some see with two eyes,
- and some with one, but for my part I do not think that Chile
- sees with any."
-
- August 27th. -- After crossing many low hills we descended
- into the small land-locked plain of Guitron. In the basins,
- such as this one, which are elevated from one thousand to
- two thousand feet above the sea, two species of acacia, which
- are stunted in their forms, and stand wide apart from each
- other, grow in large numbers. These trees are never found
- near the sea-coast; and this gives another characteristic
- feature to the scenery of these basins. We crossed a low
- ridge which separates Guitron from the great plain on which
- Santiago stands. The view was here pre-eminently striking:
- the dead level surface, covered in parts by woods of acacia,
- and with the city in the distance, abutting horizontally
- against the base of the Andes, whose snowy peaks were
- bright with the evening sun. At the first glance of this
- view, it was quite evident that the plain represented the
- extent of a former inland sea. As soon as we gained the
- level road we pushed our horses into a gallop, and reached
- the city before it was dark.
-
- I stayed a week in Santiago, and enjoyed myself very
- much. In the morning I rode to various places on the plain,
- and in the evening dined with several of the English merchants,
- whose hospitality at this place is well known. A
- never-failing source of pleasure was to ascend the little
- hillock of rock (St. Lucia) which projects in the middle of
- the city. The scenery certainly is most striking, and, as I
- have said, very peculiar. I am informed that this same
- character is common to the cities on the great Mexican
- platform. Of the town I have nothing to say in detail: it is
- not so fine or so large as Buenos Ayres, but is built after the
- same model. I arrived here by a circuit to the north; so I
- resolved to return to Valparaiso by a rather longer excursion
- to the south of the direct road.
-
- September 5th. -- By the middle of the day we arrived at
- one of the suspension bridges, made of hide, which cross the
- Maypu, a large turbulent river a few leagues southward of
- Santiago. These bridges are very poor affairs. The road,
- following the curvature of the suspending ropes, is made of
- bundles of sticks placed close together. It was full of holes,
- and oscillated rather fearfully, even with the weight of a
- man leading his horse. In the evening we reached a comfortable
- farm-house, where there were several very pretty
- senoritas. They were much horrified at my having entered
- one of their churches out of mere curiosity. They asked
- me, "Why do you not become a Christian -- for our religion
- is certain?" I assured them I was a sort of Christian; but
- they would not hear of it -- appealing to my own words, "Do
- not your padres, your very bishops, marry?" The absurdity
- of a bishop having a wife particularly struck them: they
- scarcely knew whether to be most amused or horror-struck
- at such an enormity.
-
- 6th. -- We proceeded due south, and slept at Rancagua.
- The road passed over the level but narrow plain, bounded on
- one side by lofty hills, and on the other by the Cordillera.
- The next day we turned up the valley of the Rio Cachapual,
- in which the hot-baths of Cauquenes, long celebrated for
- their medicinal properties, are situated. The suspension
- bridges, in the less frequented parts, are generally taken down
- during the winter when the rivers are low. Such was the
- case in this valley, and we were therefore obliged to cross
- the stream on horseback. This is rather disagreeable, for
- the foaming water, though not deep, rushes so quickly over
- the bed of large rounded stones, that one's head becomes
- quite confused, and it is difficult even to perceive whether
- the horse is moving onward or standing still. In summer,
- when the snow melts, the torrents are quite impassable; their
- strength and fury are then extremely great, as might be
- plainly seen by the marks which they had left. We reached
- the baths in the evening, and stayed there five days, being
- confined the two last by heavy rain. The buildings consist
- of a square of miserable little hovels, each with a single table
- and bench. They are situated in a narrow deep valley just
- without the central Cordillera. It is a quiet, solitary spot,
- with a good deal of wild beauty.
-
- The mineral springs of Cauquenes burst forth on a line of
- dislocation, crossing a mass of stratified rock, the whole
- of which betrays the action of heat. A considerable quantity
- of gas is continually escaping from the same orifices with
- the water. Though the springs are only a few yards apart,
- they have very different temperature; and this appears to be
- the result of an unequal mixture of cold water: for those
- with the lowest temperature have scarcely any mineral taste.
- After the great earthquake of 1822 the springs ceased, and
- the water did not return for nearly a year. They were also
- much affected by the earthquake of 1835; the temperature
- being suddenly changed from 118 to 92 degs. [1] It seems probable
- that mineral waters rising deep from the bowels of the earth,
- would always be more deranged by subterranean disturbances
- than those nearer the surface. The man who had charge of
- the baths assured me that in summer the water is hotter and
- more plentiful than in winter. The former circumstance I
- should have expected, from the less mixture, during the dry
- season, of cold water; but the latter statement appears very
- strange and contradictory. The periodical increase during
- the summer, when rain never falls, can, I think, only be
- accounted for by the melting of the snow: yet the mountains
- which are covered by snow during that season, are three or
- four leagues distant from the springs. I have no reason to
- doubt the accuracy of my informer, who, having lived on
- the spot for several years, ought to be well acquainted with
- the circumstance, -- which, if true, certainly is very curious:
- for we must suppose that the snow-water, being conducted
- through porous strata to the regions of heat, is again thrown
- up to the surface by the line of dislocated and injected rocks
- at Cauquenes; and the regularity of the phenomenon would
- seem to indicate that in this district heated rock occurred at
- a depth not very great.
-
- One day I rode up the valley to the farthest inhabited
- spot. Shortly above that point, the Cachapual divides into
- two deep tremendous ravines, which penetrate directly into
- the great range. I scrambled up a peaked mountain, probably
- more than six thousand feet high. Here, as indeed
- everywhere else, scenes of the highest interest presented
- themselves. It was by one of these ravines, that Pincheira
- entered Chile and ravaged the neighbouring country. This
- is the same man whose attack on an estancia at the Rio Negro
- I have described. He was a renegade half-caste Spaniard,
- who collected a great body of Indians together and established
- himself by a stream in the Pampas, which place none
- of the forces sent after him could ever discover. From this
- point he used to sally forth, and crossing the Cordillera by
- passes hitherto unattempted, he ravaged the farm-houses
- and drove the cattle to his secret rendezvous. Pincheira was
- a capital horseman, and he made all around him equally
- good, for he invariably shot any one who hesitated to follow
- him. It was against this man, and other wandering Indian
- tribes, that Rosas waged the war of extermination.
-
- September 13th. -- We left the baths of Cauquenes, and,
- rejoining the main road, slept at the Rio Clara. From this
- place we rode to the town of San Fernando. Before arriving
- there, the last land-locked basin had expanded into a great
- plain, which extended so far to the south, that the snowy
- summits of the more distant Andes were seen as if above the
- horizon of the sea. San Fernando is forty leagues from Santiago;
- and it was my farthest point southward; for we here
- turned at right angles towards the coast. We slept at the
- gold-mines of Yaquil, which are worked by Mr. Nixon, an
- American gentleman, to whose kindness I was much indebted
- during the four days I stayed at his house. The next
- morning we rode to the mines, which are situated at the
- distance of some leagues, near the summit of a lofty hill. On
- the way we had a glimpse of the lake Tagua-tagua, celebrated
- for its floating islands, which have been described by
- M. Gay. [2] They are composed of the stalks of various dead
- plants intertwined together, and on the surface of which
- other living ones take root. Their form is generally circular,
- and their thickness from four to six feet, of which the
- greater part is immersed in the water. As the wind blows,
- they pass from one side of the lake to the other, and often
- carry cattle and horses as passengers.
-
- When we arrived at the mine, I was struck by the pale
- appearance of many of the men, and inquired from Mr.
- Nixon respecting their condition. The mine is 450 feet deep,
- and each man brings up about 200 pounds weight of stone.
- With this load they have to climb up the alternate notches cut
- in the trunks of trees, placed in a zigzag line up the shaft.
- Even beardless young men, eighteen and twenty years old,
- with little muscular development of their bodies (they are
- quite naked excepting drawers) ascend with this great load
- from nearly the same depth. A strong man, who is not
- accustomed to this labour, perspires most profusely, with
- merely carrying up his own body. With this very severe
- labour, they live entirely on boiled beans and bread. They
- would prefer having bread alone; but their masters, finding
- that they cannot work so hard upon this, treat them like
- horses, and make them eat the beans. Their pay is here
- rather more than at the mines of Jajuel, being from 24 to 28
- shillings per month. They leave the mine only once in three
- weeks; when they stay with their families for two days. One
- of the rules of this mine sounds very harsh, but answers
- pretty well for the master. The only method of stealing gold
- is to secrete pieces of the ore, and take them out as occasion
- may offer. Whenever the major-domo finds a lump thus
- hidden, its full value is stopped out of the wages of all the
- men; who thus, without they all combine, are obliged to keep
- watch over each other.
-
- When the ore is brought to the mill, it is ground into an
- impalpable powder; the process of washing removes all the
- lighter particles, and amalgamation finally secures the
- gold-dust. The washing, when described, sounds a very simple
- process; but it is beautiful to see how the exact adaptation of
- the current of water to the specific gravity of the gold, so
- easily separates the powdered matrix from the metal. The
- mud which passes from the mills is collected into pools, where
- it subsides, and every now and then is cleared out, and thrown
- into a common heap. A great deal of chemical action then
- commences, salts of various kinds effloresce on the surface,
- and the mass becomes hard. After having been left for a year
- or two, and then rewashed, it yields gold; and this process
- may be repeated even six or seven times; but the gold each
- time becomes less in quantity, and the intervals required (as
- the inhabitants say, to generate the metal) are longer. There
- can be no doubt that the chemical action, already mentioned,
- each time liberates fresh gold from some combination. The
- discovery of a method to effect this before the first grinding
- would without doubt raise the value of gold-ores many fold.
-
- It is curious to find how the minute particles of gold, being
- scattered about and not corroding, at last accumulate in
- some quantity. A short time since a few miners, being out of
- work, obtained permission to scrape the ground round the
- house and mills; they washed the earth thus got together, and
- so procured thirty dollars' worth of gold. This is an exact
- counterpart of what takes place in nature. Mountains suffer
- degradation and wear away, and with them the metallic veins
- which they contain. The hardest rock is worn into impalpable
- mud, the ordinary metals oxidate, and both are removed;
- but gold, platina, and a few others are nearly indestructible,
- and from their weight, sinking to the bottom, are left behind.
- After whole mountains have passed through this grinding
- mill, and have been washed by the hand of nature, the residue
- becomes metalliferous, and man finds it worth his while to
- complete the task of separation.
-
- Bad as the above treatment of the miners appears, it is
- gladly accepted of by them; for the condition of the labouring
- agriculturists is much worse. Their wages are lower, and
- they live almost exclusively on beans. This poverty must be
- chiefly owing to the feudal-like system on which the land is
- tilled: the landowner gives a small plot of ground to the
- labourer for building on and cultivating, and in return has
- his services (or those of a proxy) for every day of his life,
- without any wages. Until a father has a grown-up son, who
- can by his labour pay the rent, there is no one, except on
- occasional days, to take care of his own patch of ground.
- Hence extreme poverty is very common among the labouring
- classes in this country.
-
- There are some old Indian ruins in this neighbourhood,
- and I was shown one of the perforated stones, which Molina
- mentions as being found in many places in considerable
- numbers. They are of a circular flattened form, from five to
- six inches in diameter, with a hole passing quite through the
- centre. It has generally been supposed that they were used
- as heads to clubs, although their form does not appear at all
- well adapted for that purpose. Burchell [3] states that some
- of the tribes in Southern Africa dig up roots by the aid of a
- stick pointed at one end, the force and weight of which are
- increased by a round stone with a hole in it, into which the
- other end is firmly wedged. It appears probable that the
- Indians of Chile formerly used some such rude agricultural
- instrument.
-
- One day, a German collector in natural history, of the
- name of Renous, called, and nearly at the same time an old
- Spanish lawyer. I was amused at being told the conversation
- which took place between them. Renous speaks Spanish so
- well, that the old lawyer mistook him for a Chilian. Renous
- alluding to me, asked him what he thought of the King of
- England sending out a collector to their country, to pick up
- lizards and beetles, and to break stones? The old gentleman
- thought seriously for some time, and then said, "It is not
- well, -- _hay un gato encerrado aqui_ (there is a cat shut up
- here). No man is so rich as to send out people to pick up
- such rubbish. I do not like it: if one of us were to go and
- do such things in England, do not you think the King of
- England would very soon send us out of his country?" And
- this old gentleman, from his profession, belongs to the better
- informed and more intelligent classes! Renous himself, two
- or three years before, left in a house at San Fernando some
- caterpillars, under charge of a girl to feed, that they might
- turn into butterflies. This was rumoured through the town,
- and at last the padres and governor consulted together, and
- agreed it must be some heresy. Accordingly, when Renous
- returned, he was arrested.
-
- September 19th. -- We left Yaquil, and followed the flat
- valley, formed like that of Quillota, in which the Rio
- Tinderidica flows. Even at these few miles south of Santiago
- the climate is much damper; in consequence there are fine
- tracts of pasturage, which are not irrigated. (20th.) We l
- followed this valley till it expanded into a great plain, which
- reaches from the sea to the mountains west of Rancagua.
- We shortly lost all trees and even bushes; so that the
- inhabitants are nearly as badly off for firewood as those in
- the Pampas. Never having heard of these plains, I was much
- surprised at meeting with such scenery in Chile. The plains
- belong to more than one series of different elevations, and
- they are traversed by broad flat-bottomed valleys; both of
- which circumstances, as in Patagonia, bespeak the action of
- the sea on gently rising land. In the steep cliffs bordering
- these valleys, there are some large caves, which no doubt
- were originally formed by the waves: one of these is celebrated
- under the name of Cueva del Obispo; having formerly
- been consecrated. During the day I felt very unwell, and
- from that time till the end of October did not recover.
-
- September 22nd. -- We continued to pass over green plains
- without a tree. The next day we arrived at a house near
- Navedad, on the sea-coast, where a rich Haciendero gave us
- lodgings. I stayed here the two ensuing days, and although
- very unwell, managed to collect from the tertiary formation
- some marine shells.
-
- 24th. -- Our course was now directed towards Valparaiso,
- which with great difficulty I reached on the 27th, and was there
- confined to my bed till the end of October. During this time
- I was an inmate in Mr. Corfield's house, whose kindness to
- me I do not know how to express.
-
-
- I will here add a few observations on some of the animals
- and birds of Chile. The Puma, or South American Lion, is
- not uncommon. This animal has a wide geographical range;
- being found from the equatorial forests, throughout the
- deserts of Patagonia as far south as the damp and cold
- latitudes (53 to 54 degs.) of Tierra del Fuego. I have seen its
- footsteps in the Cordillera of central Chile, at an elevation of
- at least 10,000 feet. In La Plata the puma preys chiefly on
- deer, ostriches, bizcacha, and other small quadrupeds; it there
- seldom attacks cattle or horses, and most rarely man. In
- Chile, however, it destroys many young horses and cattle,
- owing probably to the scarcity of other quadrupeds: I heard,
- likewise, of two men and a woman who had been thus killed.
- It is asserted that the puma always kills its prey by springing
- on the shoulders, and then drawing back the head with one
- of its paws, until the vertebrae break: I have seen in Patagonia
- the skeletons of guanacos, with their necks thus
- dislocated.
-
- The puma, after eating its fill, covers the carcass with
- many large bushes, and lies down to watch it. This habit is
- often the cause of its being discovered; for the condors
- wheeling in the air every now and then descend to partake
- of the feast, and being angrily driven away, rise all together
- on the wing. The Chileno Guaso then knows there is a lion
- watching his prey -- the word is given -- and men and dogs
- hurry to the chase. Sir F. Head says that a Gaucho in the
- pampas, upon merely seeing some condors wheeling in the
- air, cried "A lion!" I could never myself meet with any one
- who pretended to such powers of discrimination. It is asserted
- that, if a puma has once been betrayed by thus watching
- the carcass, and has then been hunted, it never resumes
- this habit; but that, having gorged itself, it wanders far away.
- The puma is easily killed. In an open country, it is first
- entangled with the bolas, then lazoed, and dragged along the
- ground till rendered insensible. At Tandeel (south of the
- plata), I was told that within three months one hundred
- were thus destroyed. In Chile they are generally driven up
- bushes or trees, and are then either shot, or baited to death
- by dogs. The dogs employed in this chase belong to a particular
- breed, called Leoneros: they are weak, slight animals,
- like long-legged terriers, but are born with a particular
- instinct for this sport. The puma is described as being very
- crafty: when pursued, it often returns on its former track,
- and then suddenly making a spring on one side, waits there
- till the dogs have passed by. It is a very silent animal,
- uttering no cry even when wounded, and only rarely during
- the breeding season.
-
- Of birds, two species of the genus Pteroptochos (megapodius
- and albicollis of Kittlitz) are perhaps the most conspicuous.
- The former, called by the Chilenos "el Turco,"
- is as large as a fieldfare, to which bird it has some alliance;
- but its legs are much longer, tail shorter, and beak stronger:
- its colour is a reddish brown. The Turco is not uncommon.
- It lives on the ground, sheltered among the thickets which are
- scattered over the dry and sterile hills. With its tail erect,
- and stilt-like legs, it may be seen every now and then popping
- from one bush to another with uncommon quickness.
- It really requires little imagination to believe that the bird
- is ashamed of itself, and is aware of its most ridiculous
- figure. On first seeing it, one is tempted to exclaim, "A
- vilely stuffed specimen has escaped from some museum, and has
- come to life again!" It cannot be made to take flight without
- the greatest trouble, nor does it run, but only hops. The
- various loud cries which it utters when concealed amongst the
- bushes, are as strange as its appearance. It is said to build
- its nest in a deep hole beneath the ground. I dissected several
- specimens: the gizzard, which was very muscular, contained
- beetles, vegetable fibres, and pebbles. From this character,
- from the length of its legs, scratching feet, membranous
- covering to the nostrils, short and arched wings, this bird
- seems in a certain degree to connect the thrushes with the
- gallinaceous order.
-
- The second species (or P. albicollis) is allied to the first
- in its general form. It is called Tapacolo, or "cover your
- posterior;" and well does the shameless little bird deserve its
- name; for it carries its tail more than erect, that is, inclined
- backwards towards its head. It is very common, and frequents
- the bottoms of hedge-rows, and the bushes scattered
- over the barren hills, where scarcely another bird can exist.
- In its general manner of feeding, of quickly hopping out of
- the thickets and back again, in its desire of concealment,
- unwillingness to take flight, and nidification, it bears a close
- resemblance to the Turco; but its appearance is not quite so
- ridiculous. The Tapacolo is very crafty: when frightened by
- any person, it will remain motionless at the bottom of a bush,
- and will then, after a little while, try with much address to
- crawl away on the opposite side. It is also an active bird, and
- continually making a noise: these noises are various and
- strangely odd; some are like the cooing of doves, others like
- the bubbling of water, and many defy all similes. The country
- people say it changes its cry five times in the year --
- according to some change of season, I suppose. [4]
-
- Two species of humming-birds are common; Trochilus
- forficatus is found over a space of 2500 miles on the west
- coast, from the hot dry country of Lima, to the forests of
- Tierra del Fuego -- where it may be seen flitting about in
- snow-storms. In the wooded island of Chiloe, which has an
- extremely humid climate, this little bird, skipping from side
- to side amidst the dripping foliage, is perhaps more abundant
- than almost any other kind. I opened the stomachs of several
- specimens, shot in different parts of the continent, and in all,
- remains of insects were as numerous as in the stomach of a
- creeper. When this species migrates in the summer southward,
- it is replaced by the arrival of another species coming
- from the north. This second kind (Trochilus gigas) is a
- very large bird for the delicate family to which it belongs:
- when on the wing its appearance is singular. Like others
- of the genus, it moves from place to place with a rapidity
- which may be compared to that of Syrphus amongst flies,
- and Sphinx among moths; but whilst hovering over a flower,
- it flaps its wings with a very slow and powerful movement,
- totally different from that vibratory one common to most of
- the species, which produces the humming noise. I never saw
- any other bird where the force of its wings appeared (as in a
- butterfly) so powerful in proportion to the weight of its body.
- When hovering by a flower, its tail is constantly expanded
- and shut like a fan, the body being kept in a nearly vertical
- position. This action appears to steady and support the bird,
- between the slow movements of its wings. Although flying
- from flower to flower in search of food, its stomach generally
- contained abundant remains of insects, which I suspect are
- much more the object of its search than honey. The note of
- this species, like that of nearly the whole family, is
- extremely shrill.
-
- [1] Caldeleugh, in Philosoph. Transact. for 1836.
-
- [2] Annales des Sciences Naturelles, March, 1833. M. Gay, a
- zealous and able naturalist, was then occupied in studying
- every branch of natural history throughout the kingdom of
- Chile.
-
- [3] Burchess's Travels, vol. ii. p. 45.
-
- [4] It is a remarkable fact, that Molina, though describing
- in detail all the birds and animals of Chile, never once
- mentions this genus, the species of which are so common, and
- so remarkable in their habits. Was he at a loss how to
- classify them, and did he consequently think that silence
- was the more prudent course? It is one more instance of the
- frequency of omissions by authors, on those very subjects
- where it might have been least expected.
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XIII
-
- CHILOE AND CHONOS ISLANDS
-
- Chiloe -- General Aspect -- Boat Excursion -- Native
- Indians -- Castro -- Tame Fox -- Ascend San Pedro -- Chonos
- Archipelago -- Peninsula of Tres Montes -- Granitic
- Range -- Boat-wrecked Sailors -- Low's Harbour -- Wild
- Potato -- Formation of Peat -- Myopotamus, Otter and Mice --
- Cheucau and Barking-bird -- Opetiorhynchus -- Singular
- Character of Ornithology -- Petrels.
-
-
- NOVEMBER 10th. -- The Beagle sailed from Valparaiso
- to the south, for the purpose of surveying the southern
- part of Chile, the island of Chiloe, and the broken
- land called the Chonos Archipelago, as far south as the
- Peninsula of Tres Montes. On the 21st we anchored in the
- bay of S. Carlos, the capital of Chiloe.
-
- This island is about ninety miles long, with a breadth of
- rather less than thirty. The land is hilly, but not mountainous,
- and is covered by one great forest, except where a few
- green patches have been cleared round the thatched cottages.
- From a distance the view somewhat resembles that of Tierra
- del Fuego; but the woods, when seen nearer, are incomparably
- more beautiful. Many kinds of fine evergreen trees, and
- plants with a tropical character, here take the place of the
- gloomy beech of the southern shores. In winter the climate
- is detestable, and in summer it is only a little better. I
- should think there are few parts of the world, within the
- temperate regions, where so much rain falls. The winds are
- very boisterous, and the sky almost always clouded: to have a
- week of fine weather is something wonderful. It is even
- difficult to get a single glimpse of the Cordillera: during
- our first visit, once only the volcano of Osorno stood out in
- bold relief, and that was before sunrise; it was curious to
- watch, as the sun rose, the outline gradually fading away in
- the glare of the eastern sky.
-
- The inhabitants, from their complexion and low stature;
- appear to have three-fourths of Indian blood in their veins.
- They are an humble, quiet, industrious set of men. Although
- the fertile soil, resulting from the decomposition of the
- volcanic rocks, supports a rank vegetation, yet the climate is
- not favourable to any production which requires much sunshine
- to ripen it. There is very little pasture for the larger
- quadrupeds; and in consequence, the staple articles of food are
- pigs, potatoes, and fish. The people all dress in strong
- woollen garments, which each family makes for itself, and
- dyes with indigo of a dark blue colour. The arts, however,
- are in the rudest state; -- as may be seen in their strange
- fashion of ploughing, their method of spinning, grinding
- corn, and in the construction of their boats. The forests are
- so impenetrable, that the land is nowhere cultivated except
- near the coast and on the adjoining islets. Even where paths
- exist, they are scarcely passable from the soft and swampy
- state of the soil. The inhabitants, like those of Tierra del
- Fuego, move about chiefly on the beach or in boats. Although
- with plenty to eat, the people are very poor: there is no
- demand for labour, and consequently the lower orders cannot
- scrape together money sufficient to purchase even the smallest
- luxuries. There is also a great deficiency of a circulating
- medium. I have seen a man bringing on his back a bag of
- charcoal, with which to buy some trifle, and another carrying
- a plank to exchange for a bottle of wine. Hence every tradesman
- must also be a merchant, and again sell the goods which
- he takes in exchange.
-
- November 24th. -- The yawl and whale-boat were sent under
- the command of Mr. (now Captain) Sulivan, to survey the
- eastern or inland coast of Chiloe; and with orders to meet
- the Beagle at the southern extremity of the island; to which
- point she would proceed by the outside, so as thus to
- circumnavigate the whole. I accompanied this expedition, but
- instead of going in the boats the first day, I hired horses to
- take me to Chacao, at the northern extremity of the island.
- The road followed the coast; every now and then crossing
- promontories covered by fine forests. In these shaded paths
- it is absolutely necessary that the whole road should be made
- of logs of wood, which are squared and placed by the side of
- each other. From the rays of the sun never penetrating the
- evergreen foliage, the ground is so damp and soft, that except
- by this means neither man nor horse would be able to pass
- along. I arrived at the village of Chacao shortly after the
- tents belonging to the boats were pitched for the night.
-
- The land in this neighbourhood has been extensively
- cleared, and there were many quiet and most picturesque
- nooks in the forest. Chacao was formerly the principal port
- in the island; but many vessels having been lost, owing to the
- dangerous currents and rocks in the straits, the Spanish
- government burnt the church, and thus arbitrarily compelled the
- greater number of inhabitants to migrate to S. Carlos. We
- had not long bivouacked, before the barefooted son of the
- governor came down to reconnoitre us. Seeing the English
- flag hoisted at the yawl's mast-head, he asked with the utmost
- indifference, whether it was always to fly at Chacao. In several
- places the inhabitants were much astonished at the
- appearance of men-of-war's boats, and hoped and believed
- it was the forerunner of a Spanish fleet, coming to recover
- the island from the patriot government of Chile. All the
- men in power, however, had been informed of our intended
- visit, and were exceedingly civil. While we were eating our
- supper, the governor paid us a visit. He had been a lieutenant-
- colonel in the Spanish service, but now was miserably
- poor. He gave us two sheep, and accepted in return two cotton
- handkerchiefs, some brass trinkets, and a little tobacco.
-
- 25th. -- Torrents of rain: we managed, however, to run
- down the coast as far as Huapi-lenou. The whole of this
- eastern side of Chiloe has one aspect; it is a plain, broken by
- valleys and divided into little islands, and the whole thickly
- covered with one impervious blackish-green forest. On the
- margins there are some cleared spaces, surrounding the high-
- roofed cottages.
-
- 26th -- The day rose splendidly clear. The volcano of
- Orsono was spouting out volumes of smoke. This most
- beautiful mountain, formed like a perfect cone, and white
- with snow, stands out in front of the Cordillera. Another
- great volcano, with a saddle-shaped summit, also emitted
- from its immense crater little jets of steam. Subsequently
- we saw the lofty-peaked Corcovado -- well deserving the name
- of "el famoso Corcovado." Thus we beheld, from one point
- of view, three great active volcanoes, each about seven thousand
- feet high. In addition to this, far to the south, there
- were other lofty cones covered with snow, which, although
- not known to be active, must be in their origin volcanic.
- The line of the Andes is not, in this neighbourhood, nearly
- so elevated as in Chile; neither does it appear to form so
- perfect a barrier between the regions of the earth. This
- great range, although running in a straight north and south
- line, owing to an optical deception, always appeared more or
- less curved; for the lines drawn from each peak to the
- beholder's eye, necessarily converged like the radii of a
- semicircle, and as it was not possible (owing to the clearness
- of the atmosphere and the absence of all intermediate objects)
- to judge how far distant the farthest peaks were off,
- they appeared to stand in a flattish semicircle.
-
- Landing at midday, we saw a family of pure Indian extraction.
- The father was singularly like York Minster; and some
- of the younger boys, with their ruddy complexions, might
- have been mistaken for Pampas Indians. Everything I have
- seen, convinces me of the close connexion of the different
- American tribes, who nevertheless speak distinct languages.
- This party could muster but little Spanish, and talked to each
- other in their own tongue. It is a pleasant thing to see the
- aborigines advanced to the same degree of civilization, however
- low that may be, which their white conquerors have
- attained. More to the south we saw many pure Indians:
- indeed, all the inhabitants of some of the islets retain their
- Indian surnames. In the census of 1832, there were in Chiloe
- and its dependencies forty-two thousand souls; the greater
- number of these appear to be of mixed blood. Eleven thousand
- retain their Indian surnames, but it is probable that not
- nearly all of these are of a pure breed. Their manner of life
- is the same with that of the other poor inhabitants, and they
- are all Christians; but it is said that they yet retain some
- strange superstitious ceremonies, and that they pretend to
- hold communication with the devil in certain caves. Formerly,
- every one convicted of this offence was sent to the
- Inquisition at Lima. Many of the inhabitants who are not
- included in the eleven thousand with Indian surnames, cannot
- be distinguished by their appearance from Indians.
- Gomez, the governor of Lemuy, is descended from noblemen
- of Spain on both sides; but by constant intermarriages with
- the natives the present man is an Indian. On the other hand
- the governor of Quinchao boasts much of his purely kept
- Spanish blood.
-
- We reached at night a beautiful little cove, north of the
- island of Caucahue. The people here complained of want of
- land. This is partly owing to their own negligence in not
- clearing the woods, and partly to restrictions by the government,
- which makes it necessary, before buying ever so small
- a piece, to pay two shillings to the surveyor for measuring
- each quadra (150 yards square), together with whatever
- price he fixes for the value of the land. After his valuation
- the land must be put up three times to auction, and if no one
- bids more, the purchaser can have it at that rate. All these
- exactions must be a serious check to clearing the ground,
- where the inhabitants are so extremely poor. In most countries,
- forests are removed without much difficulty by the aid
- of fire; but in Chiloe, from the damp nature of the climate,
- and the sort of trees, it is necessary first to cut them down.
- This is a heavy drawback to the prosperity of Chiloe. In the
- time of the Spaniards the Indians could not hold land; and a
- family, after having cleared a piece of ground, might be
- driven away, and the property seized by the government.
- The Chilian authorities are now performing an act of justice
- by making retribution to these poor Indians, giving to each
- man, according to his grade of life, a certain portion of land.
- The value of uncleared ground is very little. The government
- gave Mr. Douglas (the present surveyor, who informed
- me of these circumstances) eight and a half square miles of
- forest near S. Carlos, in lieu of a debt; and this he sold for
- 350 dollars, or about 70 pounds sterling.
-
- The two succeeding days were fine, and at night we reached
- the island of Quinchao. This neighbourhood is the most cultivated
- part of the Archipelago; for a broad strip of land on
- the coast of the main island, as well as on many of the smaller
- adjoining ones, is almost completely cleared. Some of the
- farmhouses seemed very comfortable. I was curious to
- ascertain how rich any of these people might be, but Mr.
- Douglas says that no one can be considered as possessing a
- regular income. One of the richest land-owners might possibly
- accumulate, in a long industrious life, as much as 1000 pounds
- sterling; but should this happen, it would all be stowed away
- in some secret corner, for it is the custom of almost every
- family to have a jar or treasure-chest buried in the ground.
-
- November 30th. -- Early on Sunday morning we reached
- Castro, the ancient capital of Chiloe, but now a most forlorn
- and deserted place. The usual quadrangular arrangement
- of Spanish towns could be traced, but the streets and plaza
- were coated with fine green turf, on which sheep were
- browsing. The church, which stands in the middle, is entirely
- built of plank, and has a picturesque and venerable appearance.
- The poverty of the place may be conceived from the
- fact, that although containing some hundreds of inhabitants,
- one of our party was unable anywhere to purchase either a
- pound of sugar or an ordinary knife. No individual possessed
- either a watch or a clock; and an old man, who was supposed
- to have a good idea of time, was employed to strike the
- church bell by guess. The arrival of our boats was a rare
- event in this quiet retired corner of the world; and nearly all
- the inhabitants came down to the beach to see us pitch our
- tents. They were very civil, and offered us a house; and one
- man even sent us a cask of cider as a present. In the afternoon
- we paid our respects to the governor -- a quiet old man,
- who, in his appearance and manner of life, was scarcely
- superior to an English cottager. At night heavy rain set in,
- which was hardly sufficient to drive away from our tents the
- large circle of lookers-on. An Indian family, who had come
- to trade in a canoe from Caylen, bivouacked near us. They
- had no shelter during the rain. In the morning I asked a
- young Indian, who was wet to the skin, how he had passed
- the night. He seemed perfectly content, and answered, "Muy
- bien, senor."
-
- December 1st. - We steered for the island of Lemuy. I
- was anxious to examine a reported coal-mine which turned
- out to be lignite of little value, in the sandstone (probably
- of an ancient tertiary epoch) of which these islands are
- composed. When we reached Lemuy we had much difficulty in
- finding any place to pitch our tents, for it was spring-tide,
- and the land was wooded down to the water's edge. In a
- short time we were surrounded by a large group of the nearly
- pure Indian inhabitants. They were much surprised at our
- arrival, and said one to the other, "This is the reason we
- have seen so many parrots lately; the cheucau (an odd red-
- breasted little bird, which inhabits the thick forest, and utters
- very peculiar noises) has not cried 'beware' for nothing."
- They were soon anxious for barter. Money was scarcely
- worth anything, but their eagerness for tobacco was something
- quite extraordinary. After tobacco, indigo came next
- in value; then capsicum, old clothes, and gunpowder. The
- latter article was required for a very innocent purpose: each
- parish has a public musket, and the gunpowder was wanted
- for making a noise on their saint or feast days
-
- The people here live chiefly on shell-fish and potatoes. At
- certain seasons they catch also, in "corrales," or hedges
- under water, many fish which are left on the mud-banks as
- the tide falls. They occasionally possess fowls, sheep, goats,
- pigs, horses, and cattle; the order in which they are here
- mentioned, expressing their respective numbers. I never
- saw anything more obliging and humble than the manners
- of these people. They generally began with stating that
- they were poor natives of the place, and not Spaniards
- and that they were in sad want of tobacco and other comforts.
- At Caylen, the most southern island, the sailors
- bought with a stick of tobacco, of the value of three-halfpence,
- two fowls, one of which, the Indian stated, had skin
- between its toes, and turned out to be a fine duck; and with
- some cotton handkerchiefs, worth three shillings, three sheep
- and a large bunch of onions were procured. The yawl at
- this place was anchored some way from the shore, and we
- had fears for her safety from robbers during the night. Our
- pilot, Mr. Douglas, accordingly told the constable of the
- district that we always placed sentinels with loaded arms
- and not understanding Spanish, if we saw any person in the
- dark, we should assuredly shoot him. The constable, with
- much humility, agreed to the perfect propriety of this
- arrangement, and promised us that no one should stir out
- of his house during that night.
-
- During the four succeeding days we continued sailing
- southward. The general features of the country remained
- the same, but it was much less thickly inhabited. On the
- large island of Tanqui there was scarcely one cleared spot,
- the trees on every side extending their branches over the
- sea-beach. I one day noticed, growing on the sandstone
- cliffs, some very fine plants of the panke (Gunnera scabra),
- which somewhat resembles the rhubarb on a gigantic scale.
- The inhabitants eat the stalks, which are subacid, and tan
- leather with the roots, and prepare a black dye from them.
- The leaf is nearly circular, but deeply indented on its margin.
- I measured one which was nearly eight feet in diameter,
- and therefore no less than twenty-four in circumference!
- The stalk is rather more than a yard high, and each
- plant sends out four or five of these enormous leaves,
- presenting together a very noble appearance.
-
- December 6th. -- We reached Caylen, called "el fin del
- Cristiandad." In the morning we stopped for a few minutes
- at a house on the northern end of Laylec, which was the
- extreme point of South American Christendom, and a miserable
- hovel it was. The latitude is 43 degs. 10', which is two
- degrees farther south than the Rio Negro on the Atlantic
- coast. These extreme Christians were very poor, and, under
- the plea of their situation, begged for some tobacco. As a
- proof of the poverty of these Indians, I may mention that
- shortly before this, we had met a man, who had travelled
- three days and a half on foot, and had as many to return,
- for the sake of recovering the value of a small axe and a few
- fish. How very difficult it must be to buy the smallest article,
- when such trouble is taken to recover so small a debt.
-
- In the evening we reached the island of San Pedro, where
- we found the Beagle at anchor. In doubling the point, two
- of the officers landed to take a round of angles with the
- theodolite. A fox (Canis fulvipes), of a kind said to be
- peculiar to the island, and very rare in it, and which is a new
- species, was sitting on the rocks. He was so intently absorbed
- in watching the work of the officers, that I was able,
- by quietly walking up behind, to knock him on the head
- with my geological hammer. This fox, more curious or
- more scientific, but less wise, than the generality of his
- brethren, is now mounted in the museum of the Zoological
- Society.
-
- We stayed three days in this harbour, on one of which
- Captain Fitz Roy, with a party, attempted to ascend to the
- summit of San Pedro. The woods here had rather a different
- appearance from those on the northern part of the island.
- The rock, also, being micaceous slate, there was no beach,
- but the steep sides dipped directly beneath the water. The
- general aspect in consequence was more like that of Tierra
- del Fuego than of Chiloe. In vain we tried to gain the
- summit: the forest was so impenetrable, that no one who
- has not beheld it can imagine so entangled a mass of dying
- and dead trunks. I am sure that often, for more than ten
- minutes together, our feet never touched the ground, and
- we were frequently ten or fifteen feet above it, so that the
- seamen as a joke called out the soundings. At other times
- we crept one after another on our hands and knees, under
- the rotten trunks. In the lower part of the mountain, noble
- trees of the Winter's Bark, and a laurel like the sassafras
- with fragrant leaves, and others, the names of which I do
- not know, were matted together by a trailing bamboo or cane.
- Here we were more like fishes struggling in a net than any
- other animal. On the higher parts, brushwood takes the
- place of larger trees, with here and there a red cedar or an
- alerce pine. I was also pleased to see, at an elevation of a
- little less than 1000 feet, our old friend the southern beech.
- They were, however, poor stunted trees, and I should think
- that this must be nearly their northern limit. We ultimately
- gave up the attempt in despair.
-
- December 10th. -- The yawl and whale-boat, with Mr.
- Sulivan, proceeded on their survey, but I remained on board
- the Beagle, which the next day left San Pedro for the southward.
- On the 13th we ran into an opening in the southern
- part of Guayatecas, or the Chonos Archipelago; and it was
- fortunate we did so, for on the following day a storm, worthy
- of Tierra del Fuego, raged with great fury. White massive
- clouds were piled up against a dark blue sky, and across them
- black ragged sheets of vapour were rapidly driven. The
- successive mountain ranges appeared like dim shadows, and
- the setting sun cast on the woodland a yellow gleam, much
- like that produced by the flame of spirits of wine. The water
- was white with the flying spray, and the wind lulled and
- roared again through the rigging: it was an ominous, sublime
- scene. During a few minutes there was a bright rainbow,
- and it was curious to observe the effect of the spray,
- which being carried along the surface of the water, changed
- the ordinary semicircle into a circle -- a band of prismatic
- colours being continued, from both feet of the common arch
- across the bay, close to the vessel's side: thus forming a
- distorted, but very nearly entire ring.
-
- We stayed here three days. The weather continued bad:
- but this did not much signify, for the surface of the land
- in all these islands is all but impassable. The coast is so
- very rugged that to attempt to walk in that direction requires
- continued scrambling up and down over the sharp
- rocks of mica-slate; and as for the woods, our faces, hands,
- and shin-bones all bore witness to the maltreatment we
- received, in merely attempting to penetrate their forbidden
- recesses.
-
- December 18th. -- We stood out to sea. On the 20th we
- bade farewell to the south, and with a fair wind turned the
- ship's head northward. From Cape Tres Montes we sailed
- pleasantly along the lofty weather-beaten coast, which is
- remarkable for the bold outline of its hills, and the thick
- covering of forest even on the almost precipitous flanks. The
- next day a harbour was discovered, which on this dangerous
- coast might be of great service to a distressed vessel. It
- can easily be recognized by a hill 1600 feet high, which is
- even more perfectly conical than the famous sugar-loaf at
- Rio de Janeiro. The next day, after anchoring, I succeeded
- in reaching the summit of this hill. It was a laborious
- undertaking, for the sides were so steep that in some parts it
- was necessary to use the trees as ladders. There were also
- several extensive brakes of the Fuchsia, covered with its
- beautiful drooping flowers, but very difficult to crawl through.
- In these wild countries it gives much delight to gain the summit
- of any mountain. There is an indefinite expectation of seeing
- something very strange, which, however often it may be
- balked, never failed with me to recur on each successive
- attempt. Every one must know the feeling of triumph and
- pride which a grand view from a height communicates to the
- mind. In these little frequented countries there is also joined
- to it some vanity, that you perhaps are the first man who ever
- stood on this pinnacle or admired this view.
-
- A strong desire is always felt to ascertain whether any
- human being has previously visited an unfrequented spot.
- A bit of wood with a nail in it, is picked up and studied as
- if it were covered with hieroglyphics. Possessed with this
- feeling, I was much interested by finding, on a wild part of
- the coast, a bed made of grass beneath a ledge of rock. Close
- by it there had been a fire, and the man had used an axe.
- The fire, bed, and situation showed the dexterity of an Indian;
- but he could scarcely have been an Indian, for the race is
- in this part extinct, owing to the Catholic desire of making
- at one blow Christians and Slaves. I had at the time some
- misgivings that the solitary man who had made his bed on
- this wild spot, must have been some poor shipwrecked sailor,
- who, in trying to travel up the coast, had here laid himself
- down for his dreary night
-
- December 28th. -- The weather continued very bad, but it
- at last permitted us to proceed with the survey. The time
- hung heavy on our hands, as it always did when we were
- delayed from day to day by successive gales of wind. In
- the evening another harbour was discovered, where we
- anchored. Directly afterwards a man was seen waving a
- shirt, and a boat was sent which brought back two seamen.
- A party of six had run away from an American whaling
- vessel, and had landed a little to the southward in a boat,
- which was shortly afterwards knocked to pieces by the surf.
- They had now been wandering up and down the coast for
- fifteen months, without knowing which way to go, or where
- they were. What a singular piece of good fortune it was
- that this harbour was now discovered! Had it not been for
- this one chance, they might have wandered till they had
- grown old men, and at last have perished on this wild coast.
- Their sufferings had been very great, and one of their party
- had lost his life by falling from the cliffs. They were
- sometimes obliged to separate in search of food, and this
- explained the bed of the solitary man. Considering what they
- had undergone, I think they had kept a very good reckoning of
- time, for they had lost only four days.
-
- December 30th. -- We anchored in a snug little cove at the
- foot of some high hills, near the northern extremity of Tres
- Montes. After breakfast the next morning, a party ascended
- one of these mountains, which was 2400 feet high. The
- scenery was remarkable The chief part of the range was
- composed of grand, solid, abrupt masses of granite, which
- appeared as if they had been coeval with the beginning of
- the world. The granite was capped with mica-slate, and this
- in the lapse of ages had been worn into strange finger-
- shaped points. These two formations, thus differing in their
- outlines, agree in being almost destitute of vegetation. This
- barrenness had to our eyes a strange appearance, from having
- been so long accustomed to the sight of an almost universal
- forest of dark-green trees. I took much delight in examining
- the structure of these mountains. The complicated and lofty
- ranges bore a noble aspect of durability -- equally profitless,
- however, to man and to all other animals. Granite to the
- geologist is classic ground: from its widespread limits, and its
- beautiful and compact texture, few rocks have been more
- anciently recognised. Granite has given rise, perhaps, to
- more discussion concerning its origin than any other formation.
- We generally see it constituting the fundamental rock,
- and, however formed, we know it is the deepest layer in the
- crust of this globe to which man has penetrated. The limit
- of man's knowledge in any subject possesses a high interest,
- which is perhaps increased by its close neighbourhood to the
- realms of imagination.
-
- January 1st 1835. -- The new year is ushered in with the
- ceremonies proper to it in these regions. She lays out no
- false hopes: a heavy north-western gale, with steady rain,
- bespeaks the rising year. Thank God, we are not destined
- here to see the end of it, but hope then to be in the Pacific
- Ocean, where a blue sky tells one there is a heaven, -- a
- something beyond the clouds above our heads.
-
- The north-west winds prevailing for the next four days,
- we only managed to cross a great bay, and then anchored in
- another secure harbour. I accompanied the Captain in a
- boat to the head of a deep creek. On the way the number of
- seals which we saw was quite astonishing: every bit of flat
- rock, and parts of the beach, were covered with them. There
- appeared to be of a loving disposition, and lay huddled
- together, fast asleep, like so many pigs; but even pigs would
- have been ashamed of their dirt, and of the foul smell which
- came from them. Each herd was watched by the patient but
- inauspicious eyes of the turkey-buzzard. This disgusting bird,
- with its bald scarlet head, formed to wallow in putridity, is
- very common on the west coast, and their attendance on the
- seals shows on what they rely for their food. We found the
- water (probably only that of the surface) nearly fresh: this
- was caused by the number of torrents which, in the form
- of cascades, came tumbling over the bold granite mountains
- into the sea. The fresh water attracts the fish, and these
- bring many terns, gulls, and two kinds of cormorant. We
- saw also a pair of the beautiful black-necked swans, and
- several small sea-otters, the fur of which is held in such
- high estimation. In returning, we were again amused by the
- impetuous manner in which the heap of seals, old and young,
- tumbled into the water as the boat passed. They did not
- remain long under water, but rising, followed us with
- outstretched necks, expressing great wonder and curiosity.
-
- 7th. -- Having run up the coast, we anchored near the
- northern end of the Chonos Archipelago, in Low's Harbour,
- where we remained a week. The islands were here, as in
- Chiloe, composed of a stratified, soft, littoral deposit; and
- the vegetation in consequence was beautifully luxuriant. The
- woods came down to the sea-beach, just in the manner of
- an evergreen shrubbery over a gravel walk. We also enjoyed
- from the anchorage a splendid view of four great snowy
- cones of the Cordillera, including "el famoso Corcovado;"
- the range itself had in this latitude so little height, that few
- parts of it appeared above the tops of the neighbouring
- islets. We found here a party of five men from Caylen, "el
- fin del Cristiandad," who had most adventurously crossed in
- their miserable boat-canoe, for the purpose of fishing, the
- open space of sea which separates Chonos from Chiloe. These
- islands will, in all probability, in a short time become peopled
- like those adjoining the coast of Chiloe.
-
-
- The wild potato grows on these islands in great abundance,
- on the sandy, shelly soil near the sea-beach. The tallest
- plant was four feet in height. The tubers were generally
- small, but I found one, of an oval shape, two inches in
- diameter: they resembled in every respect, and had the same
- smell as English potatoes; but when boiled they shrunk much,
- and were watery and insipid, without any bitter taste. They
- are undoubtedly here indigenous: they grow as far south,
- according to Mr. Low, as lat. 50 degs., and are called Aquinas by
- the wild Indians of that part: the Chilotan Indians have a
- different name for them. Professor Henslow, who has examined
- the dried specimens which I brought home, says that
- they are the same with those described by Mr. Sabine [1] from
- Valparaiso, but that they form a variety which by some
- botanists has been considered as specifically distinct. It is
- remarkable that the same plant should be found on the sterile
- mountains of central Chile, where a drop of rain does not
- fall for more than six months, and within the damp forests
- of these southern islands.
-
- In the central parts of the Chonos Archipelago (lat. 45 degs.),
- the forest has very much the same character with that along
- the whole west coast, for 600 miles southward to Cape Horn.
- The arborescent grass of Chiloe is not found here; while the
- beech of Tierra del Fuego grows to a good size, and forms a
- considerable proportion of the wood; not, however, in the
- same exclusive manner as it does farther southward. Cryptogamic
- plants here find a most congenial climate. In the Strait
- of Magellan, as I have before remarked, the country appears
- too cold and wet to allow of their arriving at perfection; but
- in these islands, within the forest, the number of species and
- great abundance of mosses, lichens, and small ferns, is quite
- extraordinary. [2] In Tierra del Fuego trees grow only on the
- hillsides; every level piece of land being invariably covered
- by a thick bed of peat; but in Chiloe flat land supports the
- most luxuriant forests. Here, within the Chonos Archipelago,
- the nature of the climate more closely approaches that
- of Tierra del Fuego than that of northern Chiloe; for every
- patch of level ground is covered by two species of plants
- (Astelia pumila and Donatia magellanica), which by their
- joint decay compose a thick bed of elastic peat
-
- In Tierra del Fuego, above the region of woodland, the
- former of these eminently sociable plants is the chief agent
- in the production of peat. Fresh leaves are always succeeding
- one to the other round the central tap-root, the lower
- ones soon decay, and in tracing a root downwards in the peat,
- the leaves, yet holding their place, can be observed passing
- through every stage of decomposition, till the whole becomes
- blended in one confused mass. The Astelia is assisted by a
- few other plants, -- here and there a small creeping Myrtus
- (M. nummularia), with a woody stem like our cranberry and
- with a sweet berry, -- an Empetrum (E. rubrum), like our
- heath, -- a rush (Juncus grandiflorus), are nearly the only
- ones that grow on the swampy surface. These plants, though
- possessing a very close general resemblance to the English
- species of the same genera, are different. In the more level
- parts of the country, the surface of the peat is broken up into
- little pools of water, which stand at different heights, and
- appear as if artificially excavated. Small streams of water,
- flowing underground, complete the disorganization of the
- vegetable matter, and consolidate the whole.
-
- The climate of the southern part of America appears particularly
- favourable to the production of peat. In the Falkland
- Islands almost every kind of plant, even the coarse grass
- which covers the whole surface of the land, becomes converted
- into this substance: scarcely any situation checks its
- growth; some of the beds are as much as twelve feet thick,
- and the lower part becomes so solid when dry, that it will
- hardly burn. Although every plant lends its aid, yet in most
- parts the Astelia is the most efficient. It is rather a singular
- circumstance, as being so very different from what occurs
- in Europe, that I nowhere saw moss forming by its decay
- any portion of the peat in South America. With respect to
- the northern limit, at which the climate allows of that peculiar
- kind of slow decomposition which is necessary for its
- production, I believe that in Chiloe (lat. 41 to 42 degs.),
- although there is much swampy ground, no well-characterized peat
- occurs: but in the Chonos Islands, three degrees farther
- southward, we have seen that it is abundant. On the eastern
- coast in La Plata (lat. 35 degs.) I was told by a Spanish
- resident who had visited Ireland, that he had often sought for
- this substance, but had never been able to find any. He showed
- me, as the nearest approach to it which he had discovered, a
- black peaty soil, so penetrated with roots as to allow of an
- extremely slow and imperfect combustion.
-
-
- The zoology of these broken islets of the Chonos Archipelago
- is, as might have been expected, very poor. Of quadrupeds
- two aquatic kinds are common. The Myopotamus
- Coypus (like a beaver, but with a round tail) is well known
- from its fine fur, which is an object of trade throughout the
- tributaries of La Plata. It here, however, exclusively frequents
- salt water; which same circumstance has been mentioned
- as sometimes occurring with the great rodent, the
- Capybara. A small sea-otter is very numerous; this animal
- does not feed exclusively on fish, but, like the seals, draws a
- large supply from a small red crab, which swims in shoals
- near the surface of the water. Mr. Bynoe saw one in Tierra
- del Fuego eating a cuttle-fish; and at Low's Harbour, another
- was killed in the act of carrying to its hole a large volute
- shell. At one place I caught in a trap a singular little mouse
- (M. brachiotis); it appeared common on several of the islets,
- but the Chilotans at Low's Harbour said that it was not found
- in all. What a succession of chances, [3] or what changes of
- level must have been brought into play, thus to spread these
- small animals throughout this broken archipelago!
-
- In all parts of Chiloe and Chonos, two very strange birds
- occur, which are allied to, and replace, the Turco and Tapacolo
- of central Chile. One is called by the inhabitants
- "Cheucau" (Pteroptochos rubecula): it frequents the most
- gloomy and retired spots within the damp forests. Sometimes,
- although its cry may be heard close at hand, let a person
- watch ever so attentively he will not see the cheucau; at
- other times, let him stand motionless and the red-breasted
- little bird will approach within a few feet in the most familiar
- manner. It then busily hops about the entangled mass of
- rotting cones and branches, with its little tail cocked upwards.
- The cheucau is held in superstitious fear by the Chilotans, on
- account of its strange and varied cries. There are three
- very distinct cries: One is called "chiduco," and is an omen
- of good; another, "huitreu," which is extremely unfavourable;
- and a third, which I have forgotten. These words are
- given in imitation of the noises; and the natives are in some
- things absolutely governed by them. The Chilotans assuredly
- have chosen a most comical little creature for their prophet.
- An allied species, but rather larger, is called by the natives
- "Guid-guid" (Pteroptochos Tarnii), and by the English the
- barking-bird. This latter name is well given; for I defy any
- one at first to feel certain that a small dog is not yelping
- somewhere in the forest. Just as with the cheucau, a person
- will sometimes hear the bark close by, but in vain many
- endeavour by watching, and with still less chance by beating
- the bushes, to see the bird; yet at other times the guid-guid
- fearlessly comes near. Its manner of feeding and its general
- habits are very similar to those of the cheucau.
-
- On the coast, [4] a small dusky-coloured bird (Opetiorhynchus
- Patagonicus) is very common. It is remarkable from
- its quiet habits; it lives entirely on the sea-beach, like a
- sandpiper. Besides these birds only few others inhabit this
- broken land. In my rough notes I describe the strange
- noises, which, although frequently heard within these gloomy
- forests, yet scarcely disturb the general silence. The yelping
- of the guid-guid, and the sudden whew-whew of the
- cheucau, sometimes come from afar off, and sometimes from
- close at hand; the little black wren of Tierra del Fuego
- occasionally adds its cry; the creeper (Oxyurus) follows the
- intruder screaming and twittering; the humming-bird may
- be seen every now and then darting from side to side, and
- emitting, like an insect, its shrill chirp; lastly, from the top
- of some lofty tree the indistinct but plaintive note of the
- white-tufted tyrant-flycatcher (Myiobius) may be noticed.
- From the great preponderance in most countries of certain
- common genera of birds, such as the finches, one feels at
- first surprised at meeting with the peculiar forms above
- enumerated, as the commonest birds in any district. In central
- Chile two of them, namely, the Oxyurus and Scytalopus, occur,
- although most rarely. When finding, as in this case,
- animals which seem to play so insignificant a part in the great
- scheme of nature, one is apt to wonder why they were
- created.
-
- But it should always be recollected, that in some other
- country perhaps they are essential members of society, or
- at some former period may have been so. If America
- south of 37 degs. were sunk beneath the waters of the ocean,
- these two birds might continue to exist in central Chile for
- a long period, but it is very improbable that their numbers
- would increase. We should then see a case which must inevitably
- have happened with very many animals.
-
- These southern seas are frequented by several species of
- Petrels: the largest kind, Procellaria gigantea, or nelly
- (quebrantahuesos, or break-bones, of the Spaniards), is a common
- bird, both in the inland channels and on the open sea.
- In its habits and manner of flight, there is a very close
- resemblance with the albatross; and as with the albatross, a
- person may watch it for hours together without seeing on
- what it feeds. The "break-bones" is, however, a rapacious
- bird, for it was observed by some of the officers at Port St.
- Antonio chasing a diver, which tried to escape by diving
- and flying, but was continually struck down, and at last
- killed by a blow on its head. At Port St. Julian these great
- petrels were seen killing and devouring young gulls. A second
- species (Puffinus cinereus), which is common to Europe,
- Cape Horn, and the coast of Peru, is of much smaller size
- than the P. gigantea, but, like it, of a dirty black colour. It
- generally frequents the inland sounds in very large flocks:
- I do not think I ever saw so many birds of any other sort
- together, as I once saw of these behind the island of Chiloe.
- Hundreds of thousands flew in an irregular line for several
- hours in one direction. When part of the flock settled on the
- water the surface was blackened, and a noise proceeded from
- them as of human beings talking in the distance.
-
- There are several other species of petrels, but I will only
- mention one other kind, the Pelacanoides Berardi which
- offers an example of those extraordinary cases, of a bird
- evidently belonging to one well-marked family, yet both in
- its habits and structure allied to a very distinct tribe. This
- bird never leaves the quiet inland sounds. When disturbed
- it dives to a distance, and on coming to the surface, with the
- same movement takes flight. After flying by a rapid movement
- of its short wings for a space in a straight line, it drops,
- as if struck dead, and dives again. The form of its beak and
- nostrils, length of foot, and even the colouring of its plumage,
- show that this bird is a petrel: on the other hand, its
- short wings and consequent little power of flight, its form
- of body and shape of tail, the absence of a hind toe to its
- foot, its habit of diving, and its choice of situation, make it
- at first doubtful whether its relationship is not equally close
- with the auks. It would undoubtedly be mistaken for an auk,
- when seen from a distance, either on the wing, or when diving
- and quietly swimming about the retired channels of
- Tierra del Fuego.
-
- [1] Horticultural Transact., vol. v. p. 249. Mr. Caldeleugh
- sent home two tubers, which, being well manured, even the
- first season produced numerous potatoes and an abundance of
- leaves. See Humboldt's interesting discussion on this plant,
- which it appears was unknown in Mexico, -- in Polit. Essay
- on New Spain, book iv. chap. ix.
-
- [2] By sweeping with my insect-net, I procured from these
- situations a considerable number of minute insects, of the
- family of Staphylinidae, and others allied to Pselaphus,
- and minute Hymenoptera. But the most characteristic family
- in number, both of individuals and species, throughout the
- more open parts of Chiloe and Chonos is that of Telephoridae.
-
- [3] It is said that some rapacious birds bring their prey
- alive to their nests. If so, in the course of centuries,
- every now and then, one might escape from the young birds.
- Some such agency is necessary, to account for the distribution
- of the smaller gnawing animals on islands not very near each other.
-
- [4] I may mention, as a proof of how great a difference there
- is between the seasons of the wooded and the open parts of
- this coast, that on September 20th, in lat. 34 degs., these
- birds had young ones in the nest, while among the Chonos
- Islands, three months later in the summer, they were only
- laying, the difference in latitude between these two places
- being about 700 miles.
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XIV
-
- CHILOE AND CONCEPCION: GREAT EARTHQUAKE
-
- San Carlos, Chiloe -- Osorno in eruption, contemporaneously
- with Aconcagua and Coseguina -- Ride to Cucao -- Impenetrable
- Forests -- Valdivia Indians -- Earthquake -- Concepcion --
- Great Earthquake -- Rocks fissured -- Appearance of the
- former Towns -- The Sea Black and Boiling -- Direction of
- the Vibrations -- Stones twisted round -- Great Wave --
- Permanent Elevation of the Land -- Area of Volcanic
- Phenomena -- The connection between the Elevatory and
- Eruptive Forces -- Cause of Earthquakes -- Slow Elevation of
- Mountain-chains
-
-
- ON JANUARY the 15th we sailed from Low's Harbour,
- and three days afterwards anchored a second time in
- the bay of S. Carlos in Chiloe. On the night of the
- 19th the volcano of Osorno was in action. At midnight the
- sentry observed something like a large star, which gradually
- increased in size till about three o'clock, when it presented
- a very magnificent spectacle. By the aid of a glass, dark
- objects, in constant succession, were seen, in the midst of a
- great glare of red light, to be thrown up and to fall down.
- The light was sufficient to cast on the water a long bright
- reflection. Large masses of molten matter seem very commonly
- to be cast out of the craters in this part of the Cordillera.
- I was assured that when the Corcovado is in eruption,
- great masses are projected upwards and are seen to burst in
- the air, assuming many fantastical forms, such as trees:
- their size must be immense, for they can be distinguished
- from the high land behind S. Carlos, which is no less than
- ninety-three miles from the Corcovado. In the morning the
- volcano became tranquil.
-
- I was surprised at hearing afterwards that Aconcagua in
- Chile, 480 miles northwards, was in action on the same night;
- and still more surprised to hear that the great eruption of
- Coseguina (2700 miles north of Aconcagua), accompanied by
- an earthquake felt over a 1000 miles, also occurred within
- six hours of this same time. This coincidence is the more
- remarkable, as Coseguina had been dormant for twenty-six
- years; and Aconcagua most rarely shows any signs of action.
- It is difficult even to conjecture whether this coincidence was
- accidental, or shows some subterranean connection. If Vesuvius,
- Etna, and Hecla in Iceland (all three relatively nearer
- each other than the corresponding points in South America),
- suddenly burst forth in eruption on the same night, the
- coincidence would be thought remarkable; but it is far more
- remarkable in this case, where the three vents fall on the same
- great mountain-chain, and where the vast plains along the
- entire eastern coast, and the upraised recent shells along
- more than 2000 miles on the western coast, show in how
- equable and connected a manner the elevatory forces have acted.
-
- Captain Fitz Roy being anxious that some bearings should
- be taken on the outer coast of Chiloe, it was planned that
- Mr. King and myself should ride to Castro, and thence across
- the island to the Capella de Cucao, situated on the west
- coast. Having hired horses and a guide, we set out on
- the morning of the 22nd. We had not proceeded far, before
- we were joined by a woman and two boys, who were bent on
- the same journey. Every one on this road acts on a "hail
- fellow well met" fashion; and one may here enjoy the privilege,
- so rare in South America, of travelling without firearms.
- At first, the country consisted of a succession of hills
- and valleys: nearer to Castro it became very level. The road
- itself is a curious affair; it consists in its whole length,
- with the exception of very few parts, of great logs of wood,
- which are either broad and laid longitudinally, or narrow and
- placed transversely. In summer the road is not very bad; but in
- winter, when the wood is rendered slippery from rain, travelling
- is exceedingly difficult. At that time of the year, the
- ground on each side becomes a morass, and is often overflowed:
- hence it is necessary that the longitudinal logs
- should be fastened down by transverse poles, which are
- pegged on each side into the earth. These pegs render a fall
- from a horse dangerous, as the chance of alighting on one of
- them is not small. It is remarkable, however, how active
- custom has made the Chilotan horses. In crossing bad parts,
- where the logs had been displaced, they skipped from one
- to the other, almost with the quickness and certainty of a
- dog. On both hands the road is bordered by the lofty forest-
- trees, with their bases matted together by canes. When
- occasionally a long reach of this avenue could be beheld, it
- presented a curious scene of uniformity: the white line of logs,
- narrowing in perspective, became hidden by the gloomy forest,
- or terminated in a zigzag which ascended some steep hill.
-
- Although the distance from S. Carlos to Castro is only
- twelve leagues in a straight line, the formation of the road
- must have been a great labour. I was told that several people
- had formerly lost their lives in attempting to cross the
- forest. The first who succeeded was an Indian, who cut his
- way through the canes in eight days, and reached S. Carlos:
- he was rewarded by the Spanish government with a grant of
- land. During the summer, many of the Indians wander
- about the forests (but chiefly in the higher parts, where the
- woods are not quite so thick) in search of the half-wild cattle
- which live on the leaves of the cane and certain trees. It
- was one of these huntsmen who by chance discovered, a few
- years since, an English vessel, which had been wrecked on the
- outer coast. The crew were beginning to fail in provisions,
- and it is not probable that, without the aid of this man, they
- would ever have extricated themselves from these scarcely
- penetrable woods. As it was, one seaman died on the march,
- from fatigue. The Indians in these excursions steer by the
- sun; so that if there is a continuance of cloudy weather, they
- can not travel.
-
- The day was beautiful, and the number of trees which
- were in full flower perfumed the air; yet even this could
- hardly dissipate the effects of the gloomy dampness of the
- forest. Moreover, the many dead trunks that stand like
- skeletons, never fail to give to these primeval woods a
- character of solemnity, absent in those of countries long
- civilized. Shortly after sunset we bivouacked for the night. Our
- female companion, who was rather good-looking, belonged to
- one of the most respectable families in Castro: she rode,
- however, astride, and without shoes or stockings. I was
- surprised at the total want of pride shown by her and her
- brother. They brought food with them, but at all our meals sat
- watching Mr. King and myself whilst eating, till we were
- fairly shamed into feeding the whole party. The night was
- cloudless; and while lying in our beds, we enjoyed the sight
- (and it is a high enjoyment) of the multitude of stars which
- illumined the darkness of the forest.
-
- January 23rd. -- We rose early in the morning, and reached
- the pretty quiet town of Castro by two o'clock. The old governor
- had died since our last visit, and a Chileno was acting
- in his place. We had a letter of introduction to Don Pedro,
- whom we found exceedingly hospitable and kind, and more
- disinterested than is usual on this side of the continent. The
- next day Don Pedro procured us fresh horses, and offered
- to accompany us himself. We proceeded to the south -- generally
- following the coast, and passing through several hamlets,
- each with its large barn-like chapel built of wood. At
- Vilipilli, Don Pedro asked the commandant to give us a guide
- to Cucao. The old gentleman offered to come himself; but
- for a long time nothing would persuade him that two Englishmen
- really wished to go to such an out-of-the-way place
- as Cucao. We were thus accompanied by the two greatest
- aristocrats in the country, as was plainly to be seen in the
- manner of all the poorer Indians towards them. At Chonchi
- we struck across the island, following intricate winding
- paths, sometimes passing through magnificent forests, and
- sometimes through pretty cleared spots, abounding with corn
- and potato crops. This undulating woody country, partially
- cultivated, reminded me of the wilder parts of England, and
- therefore had to my eye a most fascinating aspect. At Vilinco,
- which is situated on the borders of the lake of Cucao,
- only a few fields were cleared; and all the inhabitants appeared
- to be Indians. This lake is twelve miles long, and
- runs in an east and west direction. From local circumstances,
- the sea-breeze blows very regularly during the day,
- and during the night it falls calm: this has given rise to
- strange exaggerations, for the phenomenon, as described to
- us at S. Carlos, was quite a prodigy.
-
- The road to Cucao was so very bad that we determined to
- embark in a _periagua_. The commandant, in the most authoritative
- manner, ordered six Indians to get ready to pull
- us over, without deigning to tell them whether they would
- be paid. The periagua is a strange rough boat, but the crew
- were still stranger: I doubt if six uglier little men ever got
- into a boat together. They pulled, however, very well and
- cheerfully. The stroke-oarsman gabbled Indian, and uttered
- strange cries, much after the fashion of a pig-driver driving
- his pigs. We started with a light breeze against us, but yet
- reached the Capella de Cucao before it was late. The country
- on each side of the lake was one unbroken forest. In the
- same periagua with us, a cow was embarked. To get so
- large an animal into a small boat appears at first a difficulty,
- but the Indians managed it in a minute. They brought the
- cow alongside the boat, which was heeled towards her; then
- placing two oars under her belly, with their ends resting on
- the gunwale, by the aid of these levers they fairly tumbled
- the poor beast heels over head into the bottom of the boat,
- and then lashed her down with ropes. At Cucao we found
- an uninhabited hovel (which is the residence of the padre
- when he pays this Capella a visit), where, lighting a fire, we
- cooked our supper, and were very comfortable.
-
- The district of Cucao is the only inhabited part on the
- whole west coast of Chiloe. It contains about thirty or forty
- Indian families, who are scattered along four or five miles
- of the shore. They are very much secluded from the rest of
- Chiloe, and have scarcely any sort of commerce, except
- sometimes in a little oil, which they get from seal-blubber.
- They are tolerably dressed in clothes of their own manufacture,
- and they have plenty to eat. They seemed, however,
- discontented, yet humble to a degree which it was quite painful
- to witness. These feelings are, I think, chiefly to be
- attributed to the harsh and authoritative manner in which
- they are treated by their rulers. Our companions, although
- so very civil to us, behaved to the poor Indians as if they
- had been slaves, rather than free men. They ordered provisions
- and the use of their horses, without ever condescending
- to say how much, or indeed whether the owners should
- be paid at all. In the morning, being left alone with these
- poor people, we soon ingratiated ourselves by presents of
- cigars and mate. A lump of white sugar was divided between
- all present, and tasted with the greatest curiosity. The
- Indians ended all their complaints by saying, "And it is only
- because we are poor Indians, and know nothing; but it was
- not so when we had a King."
-
- The next day after breakfast, we rode a few miles northward
- to Punta Huantamo. The road lay along a very broad
- beach, on which, even after so many fine days, a terrible surf
- was breaking. I was assured that after a heavy gale, the
- roar can be heard at night even at Castro, a distance of no
- less than twenty-one sea-miles across a hilly and wooded
- country. We had some difficulty in reaching the point, owing
- to the intolerably bad paths; for everywhere in the shade
- the ground soon becomes a perfect quagmire. The point
- itself is a bold rocky hill. It is covered by a plant allied, I
- believe, to Bromelia, and called by the inhabitants Chepones.
- In scrambling through the beds, our hands were very much
- scratched. I was amused by observing the precaution our
- Indian guide took, in turning up his trousers, thinking that
- they were more delicate than his own hard skin. This plant
- bears a fruit, in shape like an artichoke, in which a number
- of seed-vessels are packed: these contain a pleasant sweet
- pulp, here much esteemed. I saw at Low's Harbour the
- Chilotans making chichi, or cider, with this fruit: so true is
- it, as Humboldt remarks, that almost everywhere man finds
- means of preparing some kind of beverage from the vegetable
- kingdom. The savages, however, of Tierra del Fuego,
- and I believe of Australia, have not advanced thus far in
- the arts.
-
- The coast to the north of Punta Huantamo is exceedingly
- rugged and broken, and is fronted by many breakers, on
- which the sea is eternally roaring. Mr. King and myself
- were anxious to return, if it had been possible, on foot along
- this coast; but even the Indians said it was quite
- impracticable. We were told that men have crossed by striking
- directly through the woods from Cucao to S. Carlos, but
- never by the coast. On these expeditions, the Indians carry
- with them only roasted corn, and of this they eat sparingly
- twice a day.
-
- 26th. -- Re-embarking in the periagua, we returned across
- the lake, and then mounted our horses. The whole of Chiloe
- took advantage of this week of unusually fine weather, to
- clear the ground by burning. In every direction volumes of
- smoke were curling upwards. Although the inhabitants were
- so assiduous in setting fire to every part of the wood, yet
- I did not see a single fire which they had succeeded in making
- extensive. We dined with our friend the commandant,
- and did not reach Castro till after dark. The next morning
- we started very early. After having ridden for some time,
- we obtained from the brow of a steep hill an extensive view
- (and it is a rare thing on this road) of the great forest.
- Over the horizon of trees, the volcano of Corcovado, and
- the great flat-topped one to the north, stood out in proud
- pre-eminence: scarcely another peak in the long range
- showed its snowy summit. I hope it will be long before I
- forget this farewell view of the magnificent Cordillera fronting
- Chiloe. At night we bivouacked under a cloudless sky,
- and the next morning reached S. Carlos. We arrived on the
- right day, for before evening heavy rain commenced.
-
- February 4th. -- Sailed from Chiloe. During the last week
- I made several short excursions. One was to examine a
- great bed of now-existing shells, elevated 350 feet above
- the level of the sea: from among these shells, large forest-
- trees were growing. Another ride was to P. Huechucucuy.
- I had with me a guide who knew the country far too well;
- for he would pertinaciously tell me endless Indian names for
- every little point, rivulet, and creek. In the same manner as
- in Tierra del Fuego, the Indian language appears singularly
- well adapted for attaching names to the most trivial features
- of the land. I believe every one was glad to say farewell
- to Chiloe; yet if we could forget the gloom and ceaseless
- rain of winter, Chiloe might pass for a charming island.
- There is also something very attractive in the simplicity and
- humble politeness of the poor inhabitants.
-
- We steered northward along shore, but owing to thick
- weather did not reach Valdivia till the night of the 8th. The
- next morning the boat proceeded to the town, which is distant
- about ten miles. We followed the course of the river,
- occasionally passing a few hovels, and patches of ground
- cleared out of the otherwise unbroken forest; and sometimes
- meeting a canoe with an Indian family. The town is situated
- on the low banks of the stream, and is so completely
- buried in a wood of apple-trees that the streets are merely
- paths in an orchard I have never seen any country, where
- apple-trees appeared to thrive so well as in this damp part of
- South America: on the borders of the roads there were
- many young trees evidently self-grown. In Chiloe the inhabitants
- possess a marvellously short method of making an
- orchard. At the lower part of almost every branch, small,
- conical, brown, wrinkled points project: these are always
- ready to change into roots, as may sometimes be seen, where
- any mud has been accidentally splashed against the tree. A
- branch as thick as a man's thigh is chosen in the early spring,
- and is cut off just beneath a group of these points, all the
- smaller branches are lopped off, and it is then placed about
- two feet deep in the ground. During the ensuing summer
- the stump throws out long shoots, and sometimes even bears
- fruit: I was shown one which had produced as many as
- twenty-three apples, but this was thought very unusual. In
- the third season the stump is changed (as I have myself
- seen) into a well-wooded tree, loaded with fruit. An old
- man near Valdivia illustrated his motto, "Necesidad es la
- madre del invencion," by giving an account of the several
- useful things he manufactured from his apples. After making
- cider, and likewise wine, he extracted from the refuse a
- white and finely flavoured spirit; by another process he
- procured a sweet treacle, or, as he called it, honey. His
- children and pigs seemed almost to live, during this season of
- the year, in his orchard.
-
- February 11th. -- I set out with a guide on a short ride, in
- which, however, I managed to see singularly little, either
- of the geology of the country or of its inhabitants. There
- is not much cleared land near Valdivia: after crossing a
- river at the distance of a few miles, we entered the forest, and
- then passed only one miserable hovel, before reaching our
- sleeping-place for the night. The short difference in latitude,
- of 150 miles, has given a new aspect to the forest compared
- with that of Chiloe. This is owing to a slightly
- different proportion in the kinds of trees. The evergreens
- do not appear to be quite so numerous, and the forest in
- consequence has a brighter tint. As in Chiloe, the lower
- parts are matted together by canes: here also another kind
- (resembling the bamboo of Brazil and about twenty feet in
- height) grows in clusters, and ornaments the banks of some
- of the streams in a very pretty manner. It is with this plant
- that the Indians make their chuzos, or long tapering spears.
- Our resting-house was so dirty that I preferred sleeping
- outside: on these journeys the first night is generally very
- uncomfortable, because one is not accustomed to the tickling
- and biting of the fleas. I am sure, in the morning, there
- was not a space on my legs the size of a shilling which had
- not its little red mark where the flea had feasted.
-
- 12th. -- We continued to ride through the uncleared forest;
- only occasionally meeting an Indian on horseback, or a troop
- of fine mules bringing alerce-planks and corn from the southern
- plains. In the afternoon one of the horses knocked up:
- we were then on a brow of a hill, which commanded a fine
- view of the Llanos. The view of these open plains was very
- refreshing, after being hemmed in and buried in the wilderness
- of trees. The uniformity of a forest soon becomes very
- wearisome. This west coast makes me remember with pleasure
- the free, unbounded plains of Patagonia; yet, with the
- true spirit of contradiction, I cannot forget how sublime is
- the silence of the forest. The Llanos are the most fertile
- and thickly peopled parts of the country, as they possess the
- immense advantage of being nearly free from trees. Before
- leaving the forest we crossed some flat little lawns, around
- which single trees stood, as in an English park: I have often
- noticed with surprise, in wooded undulatory districts, that
- the quite level parts have been destitute of trees. On account
- of the tired horse, I determined to stop at the Mission
- of Cudico, to the friar of which I had a letter of introduction.
- Cudico is an intermediate district between the forest
- and the Llanos. There are a good many cottages, with
- patches of corn and potatoes, nearly all belonging to Indians.
- The tribes dependent on Valdivia are "reducidos y cristianos."
- The Indians farther northward, about Arauco and
- Imperial, are still very wild, and not converted; but they
- have all much intercourse with the Spaniards. The padre
- said that the Christian Indians did not much like coming
- to mass, but that otherwise they showed respect for religion.
- The greatest difficulty is in making them observe the ceremonies
- of marriage. The wild Indians take as many wives
- as they can support, and a cacique will sometimes have more
- than ten: on entering his house, the number may be told by
- that of the separate fires. Each wife lives a week in turn
- with the cacique; but all are employed in weaving ponchos,
- etc., for his profit. To be the wife of a cacique, is an honour
- much sought after by the Indian women.
-
- The men of all these tribes wear a coarse woolen poncho:
- those south of Valdivia wear short trousers, and those north
- of it a petticoat, like the chilipa of the Gauchos. All have
- their long hair bound by a scarlet fillet, but with no other
- covering on their heads. These Indians are good-sized men;
- their cheek-bones are prominent, and in general appearance
- they resemble the great American family to which they belong;
- but their physiognomy seemed to me to be slightly
- different from that of any other tribe which I had before
- seen. Their expression is generally grave, and even austere,
- and possesses much character: this may pass either for honest
- bluntness or fierce determination. The long black hair,
- the grave and much-lined features, and the dark complexion,
- called to my mind old portraits of James I. On the road we
- met with none of that humble politeness so universal in
- Chiloe. Some gave their "mari-mari" (good morning) with
- promptness, but the greater number did not seem inclined to
- offer any salute. This independence of manners is probably
- a consequence of their long wars, and the repeated victories
- which they alone, of all the tribes in America, have gained
- over the Spaniards.
-
- I spent the evening very pleasantly, talking with the
- padre. He was exceedingly kind and hospitable; and coming
- from Santiago, had contrived to surround himself with some
- few comforts. Being a man of some little education, he bitterly
- complained of the total want of society. With no particular
- zeal for religion, no business or pursuit, how completely
- must this man's life be wasted! The next day, on
- our return, we met seven very wild-looking Indians, of whom
- some were caciques that had just received from the Chilian
- government their yearly small stipend for having long remained
- faithful. They were fine-looking men, and they rode
- one after the other, with most gloomy faces. An old cacique,
- who headed them, had been, I suppose, more excessively
- drunk than the rest, for he seemed extremely grave and
- very crabbed. Shortly before this, two Indians joined us,
- who were travelling from a distant mission to Valdivia
- concerning some lawsuit. One was a good-humoured old man,
- but from his wrinkled beardless face looked more like an
- old woman than a man. I frequently presented both of them
- with cigars; and though ready to receive them, and I dare
- say grateful, they would hardly condescend to thank me. A
- Chilotan Indian would have taken off his hat, and given his
- "Dios le page!" The travelling was very tedious, both
- from the badness of the roads, and from the number of great
- fallen trees, which it was necessary either to leap over or to
- avoid by making long circuits. We slept on the road, and
- next morning reached Valdivia, whence I proceeded on
- board.
-
- A few days afterwards I crossed the bay with a party of
- officers, and landed near the fort called Niebla. The buildings
- were in a most ruinous state, and the gun-carriages
- quite rotten. Mr. Wickham remarked to the commanding
- officer, that with one discharge they would certainly all fall
- to pieces. The poor man, trying to put a good face upon it,
- gravely replied, "No, I am sure, sir, they would stand
- two!" The Spaniards must have intended to have made this
- place impregnable. There is now lying in the middle of the
- court-yard a little mountain of mortar, which rivals in hardness
- the rock on which it is placed. It was brought from
- Chile, and cost 7000 dollars. The revolution having broken
- out, prevented its being applied to any purpose, and now it
- remains a monument of the fallen greatness of Spain.
-
- I wanted to go to a house about a mile and a half distant,
- but my guide said it was quite impossible to penetrate the
- wood in a straight line. He offered, however, to lead me, by
- following obscure cattle-tracks, the shortest way: the walk,
- nevertheless, took no less than three hours! This man is
- employed in hunting strayed cattle; yet, well as he must
- know the woods, he was not long since lost for two whole
- days, and had nothing to eat. These facts convey a good
- idea of the impracticability of the forests of these countries.
- A question often occurred to me -- how long does any vestige
- of a fallen tree remain? This man showed me one which
- a party of fugitive royalists had cut down fourteen years
- ago; and taking this as a criterion, I should think a bole a
- foot and a half in diameter would in thirty years be changed
- into a heap of mould.
-
- February 20th. -- This day has been memorable in the
- annals of Valdivia, for the most severe earthquake experienced
- by the oldest inhabitant. I happened to be on shore,
- and was lying down in the wood to rest myself. It came on
- suddenly, and lasted two minutes, but the time appeared
- much longer. The rocking of the ground was very sensible.
- The undulations appeared to my companion and myself to
- come from due east, whilst others thought they proceeded
- from south-west: this shows how difficult it sometimes is to
- perceive the directions of the vibrations. There was no
- difficulty in standing upright, but the motion made me almost
- giddy: it was something like the movement of a vessel in a
- little cross-ripple, or still more like that felt by a person
- skating over thin ice, which bends under the weight of his body.
- A bad earthquake at once destroys our oldest associations:
- the earth, the very emblem of solidity, has moved beneath
- our feet like a thin crust over a fluid; -- one second of time
- has created in the mind a strange idea of insecurity, which
- hours of reflection would not have produced. In the forest,
- as a breeze moved the trees, I felt only the earth tremble, but
- saw no other effect. Captain Fitz Roy and some officers
- were at the town during the shock, and there the scene was
- more striking; for although the houses, from being built of
- wood, did not fall, they were violently shaken, and the boards
- creaked and rattled together. The people rushed out of
- doors in the greatest alarm. It is these accompaniments that
- create that perfect horror of earthquakes, experienced by all
- who have thus seen, as well as felt, their effects. Within the
- forest it was a deeply interesting, but by no means an awe-
- exciting phenomenon. The tides were very curiously affected.
- The great shock took place at the time of low water;
- and an old woman who was on the beach told me that the
- water flowed very quickly, but not in great waves, to high-
- water mark, and then as quickly returned to its proper level;
- this was also evident by the line of wet sand. The same kind
- of quick but quiet movement in the tide happened a few
- years since at Chiloe, during a slight earthquake, and created
- much causeless alarm. In the course of the evening there
- were many weaker shocks, which seemed to produce in the
- harbour the most complicated currents, and some of great
- strength.
-
-
- March 4th. -- We entered the harbour of Concepcion. While
- the ship was beating up to the anchorage, I landed on the
- island of Quiriquina. The mayor-domo of the estate quickly
- rode down to tell me the terrible news of the great earthquake
- of the 20th: -- "That not a house in Concepcion or
- Talcahuano (the port) was standing; that seventy villages
- were destroyed; and that a great wave had almost washed
- away the ruins of Talcahuano." Of this latter statement I
- soon saw abundant proofs -- the whole coast being strewed
- over with timber and furniture as if a thousand ships had
- been wrecked. Besides chairs, tables, book-shelves, etc., in
- great numbers, there were several roofs of cottages, which
- had been transported almost whole. The storehouses at Talcahuano
- had been burst open, and great bags of cotton, yerba,
- and other valuable merchandise were scattered on the shore.
- During my walk round the island, I observed that numerous
- fragments of rock, which, from the marine productions adhering
- to them, must recently have been lying in deep water,
- had been cast up high on the beach; one of these was six feet
- long, three broad, and two thick.
-
- The island itself as plainly showed the overwhelming
- power of the earthquake, as the beach did that of the consequent
- great wave. The ground in many parts was fissured
- in north and south lines, perhaps caused by the yielding of
- the parallel and steep sides of this narrow island. Some of
- the fissures near the cliffs were a yard wide. Many enormous
- masses had already fallen on the beach; and the inhabitants
- thought that when the rains commenced far greater slips would
- happen. The effect of the vibration on the hard primary slate,
- which composes the foundation of the island, was still more
- curious: the superficial parts of some narrow ridges were as
- completely shivered as if they had been blasted by gunpowder.
- This effect, which was rendered conspicuous by the
- fresh fractures and displaced soil, must be confined to near
- the surface, for otherwise there would not exist a block of
- solid rock throughout Chile; nor is this improbable, as it is
- known that the surface of a vibrating body is affected
- differently from the central part. It is, perhaps, owing to this
- same reason, that earthquakes do not cause quite such terrific
- havoc within deep mines as would be expected. I believe this
- convulsion has been more effectual in lessening the size of
- the island of Quiriquina, than the ordinary wear-and-tear
- of the sea and weather during the course of a whole century.
-
- The next day I landed at Talcahuano, and afterwards rode
- to Concepcion. Both towns presented the most awful yet
- interesting spectacle I ever beheld. To a person who had
- formerly know them, it possibly might have been still more
- impressive; for the ruins were so mingled together, and the
- whole scene possessed so little the air of a habitable place,
- that it was scarcely possible to imagine its former condition.
- The earthquake commenced at half-past eleven o'clock in the
- forenoon. If it had happened in the middle of the night, the
- greater number of the inhabitants (which in this one province
- must amount to many thousands) must have perished,
- instead of less than a hundred: as it was, the invariable
- practice of running out of doors at the first trembling of the
- ground, alone saved them. In Concepcion each house, or
- row of houses, stood by itself, a heap or line of ruins; but in
- Talcahuano, owing to the great wave, little more than one
- layer of bricks, tiles, and timber with here and there part of
- a wall left standing, could be distinguished. From this
- circumstance Concepcion, although not so completely desolated,
- was a more terrible, and if I may so call it, picturesque sight.
- The first shock was very sudden. The mayor-domo at Quiriquina
- told me, that the first notice he received of it, was
- finding both the horse he rode and himself, rolling together
- on the ground. Rising up, he was again thrown down. He
- also told me that some cows which were standing on the steep
- side of the island were rolled into the sea. The great wave
- caused the destruction of many cattle; on one low island
- near the head of the bay, seventy animals were washed off
- and drowned. It is generally thought that this has been the
- worst earthquake ever recorded in Chile; but as the very
- severe ones occur only after long intervals, this cannot easily
- be known; nor indeed would a much worse shock have made
- any difference, for the ruin was now complete. Innumerable
- small tremblings followed the great earthquake, and within
- the first twelve days no less than three hundred were counted.
-
- After viewing Concepcion, I cannot understand how the
- greater number of inhabitants escaped unhurt. The houses
- in many parts fell outwards; thus forming in the middle of
- the streets little hillocks of brickwork and rubbish. Mr.
- Rouse, the English consul, told us that he was at breakfast
- when the first movement warned him to run out. He had
- scarcely reached the middle of the court-yard, when one side
- of his house came thundering down. He retained presence
- of mind to remember, that if he once got on the top of that
- part which had already fallen, he would be safe. Not being
- able from the motion of the ground to stand, he crawled up
- on his hands and knees; and no sooner had he ascended this
- little eminence, than the other side of the house fell in, the
- great beams sweeping close in front of his head. With his
- eyes blinded, and his mouth choked with the cloud of dust
- which darkened the sky, at last he gained the street. As
- shock succeeded shock, at the interval of a few minutes, no
- one dared approach the shattered ruins, and no one knew
- whether his dearest friends and relations were not perishing
- from the want of help. Those who had saved any property
- were obliged to keep a constant watch, for thieves
- prowled about, and at each little trembling of the ground,
- with one hand they beat their breasts and cried "Misericordia!"
- and then with the other filched what they could
- from the ruins. The thatched roofs fell over the fires, and
- flames burst forth in all parts. Hundreds knew themselves
- ruined, and few had the means of providing food for the day.
-
- Earthquakes alone are sufficient to destroy the prosperity
- of any country. If beneath England the now inert subterranean
- forces should exert those powers, which most assuredly
- in former geological ages they have exerted, how completely
- would the entire condition of the country be changed!
- What would become of the lofty houses, thickly packed cities,
- great manufactories, the beautiful public and private edifices?
- If the new period of disturbance were first to commence
- by some great earthquake in the dead of the night,
- how terrific would be the carnage! England would at once
- be bankrupt; all papers, records, and accounts would from
- that moment be lost. Government being unable to collect
- the taxes, and failing to maintain its authority, the hand of
- violence and rapine would remain uncontrolled. In every
- large town famine would go forth, pestilence and death following
- in its train.
-
- Shortly after the shock, a great wave was seen from the
- distance of three or four miles, approaching in the middle
- of the bay with a smooth outline; but along the shore it tore
- up cottages and trees, as it swept onwards with irresistible
- force. At the head of the bay it broke in a fearful line of
- white breakers, which rushed up to a height of 23 vertical
- feet above the highest spring-tides. Their force must have
- been prodigious; for at the Fort a cannon with its carriage,
- estimated at four tons in weight, was moved 15 feet inwards.
- A schooner was left in the midst of the ruins, 200 yards
- from the beach. The first wave was followed by two others,
- which in their retreat carried away a vast wreck of floating
- objects. In one part of the bay, a ship was pitched high
- and dry on shore, was carried off, again driven on shore, and
- again carried off. In another part, two large vessels anchored
- near together were whirled about, and their cables were thrice
- wound round each other; though anchored at a depth of 36
- feet, they were for some minutes aground. The great wave
- must have travelled slowly, for the inhabitants of Talcahuano
- had time to run up the hills behind the town; and
- some sailors pulled out seaward, trusting successfully to their
- boat riding securely over the swell, if they could reach it
- before it broke. One old woman with a little boy, four or
- five years old, ran into a boat, but there was nobody to row
- it out: the boat was consequently dashed against an anchor
- and cut in twain; the old woman was drowned, but the child
- was picked up some hours afterwards clinging to the wreck.
- Pools of salt-water were still standing amidst the ruins of
- the houses, and children, making boats with old tables and
- chairs, appeared as happy as their parents were miserable.
- It was, however, exceedingly interesting to observe, how
- much more active and cheerful all appeared than could have
- been expected. It was remarked with much truth, that from
- the destruction being universal, no one individual was humbled
- more than another, or could suspect his friends of coldness
- -- that most grievous result of the loss of wealth. Mr. Rouse,
- and a large party whom he kindly took under his protection,
- lived for the first week in a garden beneath some apple-trees.
- At first they were as merry as if it had been a picnic; but
- soon afterwards heavy rain caused much discomfort, for they
- were absolutely without shelter.
-
- In Captain Fitz Roy's excellent account of the earthquake,
- it is said that two explosions, one like a column of smoke and
- another like the blowing of a great whale, were seen in the
- bay. The water also appeared everywhere to be boiling; and
- it "became black, and exhaled a most disagreeable sulphureous
- smell." These latter circumstances were observed in the
- Bay of Valparaiso during the earthquake of 1822; they may,
- I think, be accounted for, by the disturbance of the mud at
- the bottom of the sea containing organic matter in decay. In
- the Bay of Callao, during a calm day, I noticed, that as the
- ship dragged her cable over the bottom, its course was marked
- by a line of bubbles. The lower orders in Talcahuano thought
- that the earthquake was caused by some old Indian women,
- who two years ago, being offended, stopped the volcano of
- Antuco. This silly belief is curious, because it shows that
- experience has taught them to observe, that there exists a
- relation between the suppressed action of the volcanos, and
- the trembling of the ground. It was necessary to apply the
- witchcraft to the point where their perception of cause and
- effect failed; and this was the closing of the volcanic vent.
- This belief is the more singular in this particular instance,
- because, according to Captain Fitz Roy, there is reason to
- believe that Antuco was noways affected.
-
- The town of Concepcion was built in the usual Spanish
- fashion, with all the streets running at right angles to each
- other; one set ranging S.W. by W., and the other set N.W.
- by N. The walls in the former direction certainly stood
- better than those in the latter; the greater number of the
- masses of brickwork were thrown down towards the N.E.
- Both these circumstances perfectly agree with the general
- idea, of the undulations having come from the S.W., in which
- quarter subterranean noises were also heard; for it is evident
- that the walls running S.W. and N.E. which presented their
- ends to the point whence the undulations came, would be
- much less likely to fall than those walls which, running N.W.
- and S.E., must in their whole lengths have been at the same
- instant thrown out of the perpendicular; for the undulations,
- coming from the S.W., must have extended in N.W. and
- S.E. waves, as they passed under the foundations. This may
- be illustrated by placing books edgeways on a carpet, and
- then, after the manner suggested by Michell, imitating the
- undulations of an earthquake: it will be found that they fall
- with more or less readiness, according as their direction more
- or less nearly coincides with the line of the waves. The
- fissures in the ground generally, though not uniformly, extended
- in a S.E. and N.W. direction, and therefore corresponded
- to the lines of undulation or of principal flexure. Bearing in
- mind all these circumstances, which so clearly point to the
- S.W. as the chief focus of disturbance, it is a very interesting
- fact that the island of S. Maria, situated in that quarter, was,
- during the general uplifting of the land, raised to nearly
- three times the height of any other part of the coast.
-
- The different resistance offered by the walls, according to
- their direction, was well exemplified in the case of the
- Cathedral. The side which fronted the N.E. presented a grand
- pile of ruins, in the midst of which door-cases and masses
- of timber stood up, as if floating in a stream. Some of the
- angular blocks of brickwork were of great dimensions; and
- they were rolled to a distance on the level plaza, like
- fragments of rock at the base of some high mountain. The side
- walls (running S.W. and N.E.), though exceedingly fractured,
- yet remained standing; but the vast buttresses (at
- right angles to them, and therefore parallel to the walls that
- fell) were in many cases cut clean off, as if by a chisel, and
- hurled to the ground. Some square ornaments on the coping
- of these same walls, were moved by the earthquake into
- a diagonal position. A similar circumstance was observed
- after an earthquake at Valparaiso, Calabria, and other places,
- including some of the ancient Greek temples. [1] This twisting
- displacement, at first appears to indicate a vorticose
- movement beneath each point thus affected; but this is highly
- improbable. May it not be caused by a tendency in each stone
- to arrange itself in some particular position, with respect
- to the lines of vibration, -- in a manner somewhat similar to
- pins on a sheet of paper when shaken? Generally speaking,
- arched doorways or windows stood much better than any
- other part of the buildings. Nevertheless, a poor lame old
- man, who had been in the habit, during trifling shocks, of
- crawling to a certain doorway, was this time crushed to
- pieces.
-
- I have not attempted to give any detailed description of
- the appearance of Concepcion, for I feel that it is quite
- impossible to convey the mingled feelings which I experienced.
- Several of the officers visited it before me, but their
- strongest language failed to give a just idea of the scene of
- desolation. It is a bitter and humiliating thing to see works,
- which have cost man so much time and labour, overthrown in one
- minute; yet compassion for the inhabitants was almost instantly
- banished, by the surprise in seeing a state of things produced
- in a moment of time, which one was accustomed to attribute
- to a succession of ages. In my opinion, we have scarcely beheld,
- since leaving England, any sight so deeply interesting.
-
- In almost every severe earthquake, the neighbouring waters
- of the sea are said to have been greatly agitated. The
- disturbance seems generally, as in the case of Concepcion, to
- have been of two kinds: first, at the instant of the shock,
- the water swells high up on the beach with a gentle motion,
- and then as quietly retreats; secondly, some time afterwards,
- the whole body of the sea retires from the coast, and then
- returns in waves of overwhelming force. The first movement
- seems to be an immediate consequence of the earthquake
- affecting differently a fluid and a solid, so that their
- respective levels are slightly deranged: but the second case
- is a far more important phenomenon. During most earthquakes,
- and especially during those on the west coast of
- America, it is certain that the first great movement of the
- waters has been a retirement. Some authors have attempted
- to explain this, by supposing that the water retains its level,
- whilst the land oscillates upwards; but surely the water close
- to the land, even on a rather steep coast, would partake of the
- motion of the bottom: moreover, as urged by Mr. Lyell,
- similar movements of the sea have occurred at islands far
- distant from the chief line of disturbance, as was the case
- with Juan Fernandez during this earthquake, and with
- Madeira during the famous Lisbon shock. I suspect (but the
- subject is a very obscure one) that a wave, however produced,
- first draws the water from the shore, on which it is advancing
- to break: I have observed that this happens with the little
- waves from the paddles of a steam-boat. It is remarkable
- that whilst Talcahuano and Callao (near Lima), both situated
- at the head of large shallow bays, have suffered during
- every severe earthquake from great waves, Valparaiso,
- seated close to the edge of profoundly deep water, has never
- been overwhelmed, though so often shaken by the severest
- shocks. From the great wave not immediately following the
- earthquake, but sometimes after the interval of even half an
- hour, and from distant islands being affected similarly with
- the coasts near the focus of the disturbance, it appears that
- the wave first rises in the offing; and as this is of general
- occurrence, the cause must be general: I suspect we must
- look to the line, where the less disturbed waters of the deep
- ocean join the water nearer the coast, which has partaken
- of the movements of the land, as the place where the great
- wave is first generated; it would also appear that the wave
- is larger or smaller, according to the extent of shoal water
- which has been agitated together with the bottom on which it
- rested.
-
-
- The most remarkable effect of this earthquake was the permanent
- elevation of the land, it would probably be far more
- correct to speak of it as the cause. There can be no doubt
- that the land round the Bay of Concepcion was upraised
- two or three feet; but it deserves notice, that owing to the
- wave having obliterated the old lines of tidal action on the
- sloping sandy shores, I could discover no evidence of this
- fact, except in the united testimony of the inhabitants, that
- one little rocky shoal, now exposed, was formerly covered
- with water. At the island of S. Maria (about thirty miles
- distant) the elevation was greater; on one part, Captain Fitz
- Roy founds beds of putrid mussel-shells _still adhering to the
- rocks_, ten feet above high-water mark: the inhabitants had
- formerly dived at lower-water spring-tides for these shells.
- The elevation of this province is particularly interesting,
- from its having been the theatre of several other violent
- earthquakes, and from the vast numbers of sea-shells scattered
- over the land, up to a height of certainly 600, and I
- believe, of 1000 feet. At Valparaiso, as I have remarked,
- similar shells are found at the height of 1300 feet: it is
- hardly possible to doubt that this great elevation has been
- effected by successive small uprisings, such as that which
- accompanied or caused the earthquake of this year, and likewise
- by an insensibly slow rise, which is certainly in progress on
- some parts of this coast.
-
- The island of Juan Fernandez, 360 miles to the N.E., was,
- at the time of the great shock of the 20th, violently shaken,
- so that the trees beat against each other, and a volcano burst
- forth under water close to the shore: these facts are remarkable
- because this island, during the earthquake of 1751, was
- then also affected more violently than other places at an equal
- distance from Concepcion, and this seems to show some
- subterranean connection between these two points. Chiloe, about
- 340 miles southward of Concepcion, appears to have been
- shaken more strongly than the intermediate district of Valdivia,
- where the volcano of Villarica was noways affected,
- whilst in the Cordillera in front of Chiloe, two of the volcanos
- burst-forth at the same instant in violent action. These
- two volcanos, and some neighbouring ones, continued for a
- long time in eruption, and ten months afterwards were
- again influenced by an earthquake at Concepcion. Some
- men, cutting wood near the base of one of these volcanos,
- did not perceive the shock of the 20th, although the whole
- surrounding Province was then trembling; here we have an
- eruption relieving and taking the place of an earthquake,
- as would have happened at Concepcion, according to the
- belief of the lower orders, if the volcano at Antuco had not
- been closed by witchcraft. Two years and three-quarters
- afterwards, Valdivia and Chiloe were again shaken, more
- violently than on the 20th, and an island in the Chonos
- Archipelago was permanently elevated more than eight feet.
- It will give a better idea of the scale of these phenomena, if
- (as in the case of the glaciers) we suppose them to have
- taken place at corresponding distances in Europe: -- then
- would the land from the North Sea to the Mediterranean
- have been violently shaken, and at the same instant of time a
- large tract of the eastern coast of England would have been
- permanently elevated, together with some outlying islands, -- a
- train of volcanos on the coast of Holland would have burst
- forth in action, and an eruption taken place at the bottom of
- the sea, near the northern extremity of Ireland -- and lastly,
- the ancient vents of Auvergne, Cantal, and Mont d'Or would
- each have sent up to the sky a dark column of smoke, and
- have long remained in fierce action. Two years and three-
- quarters afterwards, France, from its centre to the English
- Channel, would have been again desolated by an earthquake
- and an island permanently upraised in the Mediterranean.
-
- The space, from under which volcanic matter on the 20th
- was actually erupted, is 720 miles in one line, and 400 miles
- in another line at right angles to the first: hence, in all
- probability, a subterranean lake of lava is here stretched out,
- of nearly double the area of the Black Sea. From the intimate
- and complicated manner in which the elevatory and eruptive
- forces were shown to be connected during this train of
- phenomena, we may confidently come to the conclusion, that the
- forces which slowly and by little starts uplift continents, and
- those which at successive periods pour forth volcanic matter
- from open orifices, are identical. From many reasons, I
- believe that the frequent quakings of the earth on this line
- of coast are caused by the rending of the strata, necessarily
- consequent on the tension of the land when upraised, and
- their injection by fluidified rock. This rending and injection
- would, if repeated often enough (and we know that earthquakes
- repeatedly affect the same areas in the same manner),
- form a chain of hills; -- and the linear island of S. Mary,
- which was upraised thrice the height of the neighbouring
- country, seems to be undergoing this process. I believe that
- the solid axis of a mountain, differs in its manner of formation
- from a volcanic hill, only in the molten stone having
- been repeatedly injected, instead of having been repeatedly
- ejected. Moreover, I believe that it is impossible to explain
- the structure of great mountain-chains, such as that of the
- Cordillera, were the strata, capping the injected axis of
- plutonic rock, have been thrown on their edges along several
- parallel and neighbouring lines of elevation, except on this
- view of the rock of the axis having been repeatedly injected,
- after intervals sufficiently long to allow the upper parts or
- wedges to cool and become solid; -- for if the strata had been
- thrown into their present highly inclined, vertical, and even
- inverted positions, by a single blow, the very bowels of the
- earth would have gushed out; and instead of beholding abrupt
- mountain-axes of rock solidified under great pressure, deluges
- of lava would have flowed out at innumerable points on every
- line of elevation. [2]
-
- [1] M. Arago in L'Institut, 1839, p. 337. See also Miers's
- Chile, vol. i. p. 392; also Lyell's Principles of Geology,
- chap. xv., book ii.
-
- [2] For a full account of the volcanic phenomena which
- accompanied the earthquake of the 20th, and for the conclusions
- deducible from them, I must refer to Volume V. of the Geological
- Transactions.
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XV
-
- PASSAGE OF THE CORDILLERA
-
- Valparaiso -- Portillo Pass -- Sagacity of Mules -- Mountain-
- torrents -- Mines, how discovered -- Proofs of the gradual
- Elevation of the Cordillera -- Effect of Snow on Rocks --
- Geological Structure of the two main Ranges, their distinct
- Origin and Upheaval -- Great Subsidence -- Red Snow --
- Winds -- Pinnacles of Snow -- Dry and clear Atmosphere --
- Electricity -- Pampas -- Zoology of the opposite Side of
- the Andes -- Locusts -- Great Bugs -- Mendoza -- Uspallata
- Pass -- Silicified Trees buried as they grew -- Incas Bridge --
- Badness of the Passes exaggerated -- Cumbre -- Casuchas --
- Valparaiso.
-
-
- MARCH 7th, 1835. -- We stayed three days at Concepcion,
- and then sailed for Valparaiso. The wind
- being northerly, we only reached the mouth of the
- harbour of Concepcion before it was dark. Being very near
- the land, and a fog coming on, the anchor was dropped.
- Presently a large American whaler appeared alongside of us;
- and we heard the Yankee swearing at his men to keep quiet,
- whilst he listened for the breakers. Captain Fitz Roy hailed
- him, in a loud clear voice, to anchor where he then was. The
- poor man must have thought the voice came from the shore:
- such a Babel of cries issued at once from the ship -- every
- one hallooing out, "Let go the anchor! veer cable! shorten
- sail!" It was the most laughable thing I ever heard. If
- the ship's crew had been all captains, and no men, there could
- not have been a greater uproar of orders. We afterwards
- found that the mate stuttered: I suppose all hands were
- assisting him in giving his orders.
-
- On the 11th we anchored at Valparaiso, and two days
- afterwards I set out to cross the Cordillera. I proceeded to
- Santiago, where Mr. Caldcleugh most kindly assisted me in
- every possible way in making the little preparations which
- were necessary. In this part of Chile there are two passes
- across the Andes to Mendoza: the one most commonly used,
- namely, that of Aconcagua or Uspallata -- is situated some
- way to the north; the other, called the Portillo, is to the
- south, and nearer, but more lofty and dangerous.
-
- March 18th. -- We set out for the Portillo pass. Leaving
- Santiago we crossed the wide burnt-up plain on which that
- city stands, and in the afternoon arrived at the Maypu, one
- of the principal rivers in Chile. The valley, at the point
- where it enters the first Cordillera, is bounded on each side
- by lofty barren mountains; and although not broad, it is very
- fertile. Numerous cottages were surrounded by vines, and by
- orchards of apple, nectarine, and peach-trees -- their boughs
- breaking with the weight of the beautiful ripe fruit. In the
- evening we passed the custom-house, where our luggage was
- examined. The frontier of Chile is better guarded by the
- Cordillera, than by the waters of the sea. There are very
- few valleys which lead to the central ranges, and the
- mountains are quite impassable in other parts by beasts of
- burden. The custom-house officers were very civil, which
- was perhaps partly owing to the passport which the President
- of the Republic had given me; but I must express my admiration
- at the natural politeness of almost every Chileno. In
- this instance, the contrast with the same class of men in
- most other countries was strongly marked. I may mention
- an anecdote with which I was at the time much pleased: we
- met near Mendoza a little and very fat negress, riding astride
- on a mule. She had a _goitre_ so enormous that it was scarcely
- possible to avoid gazing at her for a moment; but my two
- companions almost instantly, by way of apology, made the
- common salute of the country by taking off their hats. Where
- would one of the lower or higher classes in Europe, have
- shown such feeling politeness to a poor and miserable object
- of a degraded race?
-
- At night we slept at a cottage. Our manner of travelling
- was delightfully independent. In the inhabited parts we
- bought a little firewood, hired pasture for the animals, and
- bivouacked in the corner of the same field with them. Carrying
- an iron pot, we cooked and ate our supper under a
- cloudless sky, and knew no trouble. My companions were
- Mariano Gonzales, who had formerly accompanied me in
- Chile, and an "arriero," with his ten mules and a "madrina."
- The madrina (or godmother) is a most important personage:
-
- she is an old steady mare, with a little bell round her neck;
- and wherever she goes, the mules, like good children, follow
- her. The affection of these animals for their madrinas saves
- infinite trouble. If several large troops are turned into one
- field to graze, in the morning the muleteers have only to lead
- the madrinas a little apart, and tinkle their bells; although
- there may be two or three hundred together, each mule
- immediately knows the bell of its own madrina, and comes to
- her. It is nearly impossible to lose an old mule; for if
- detained for several hours by force, she will, by the power
- of smell, like a dog, track out her companions, or rather the
- madrina, for, according to the muleteer, she is the chief
- object of affection. The feeling, however, is not of an
- individual nature; for I believe I am right in saying that any
- animal with a bell will serve as a madrina. In a troop each
- animal carries on a level road, a cargo weighing 416 pounds
- (more than 29 stone), but in a mountainous country 100
- pounds less; yet with what delicate slim limbs, without any
- proportional bulk of muscle, these animals support so great
- a burden! The mule always appears to me a most surprising
- animal. That a hybrid should possess more reason, memory,
- obstinacy, social affection, powers of muscular endurance,
- and length of life, than either of its parents, seems to
- indicate that art has here outdone nature. Of our ten animals,
- six were intended for riding, and four for carrying cargoes,
- each taking turn about. We carried a good deal of food in
- case we should be snowed up, as the season was rather late
- for passing the Portillo.
-
- March 19th. -- We rode during this day to the last, and
- therefore most elevated, house in the valley. The number of
- inhabitants became scanty; but wherever water could be
- brought on the land, it was very fertile. All the main valleys
- in the Cordillera are characterized by having, on both sides, a
- fringe or terrace of shingle and sand, rudely stratified, and
- generally of considerable thickness. These fringes evidently
- once extended across the valleys and were united; and the
- bottoms of the valleys in northern Chile, where there are no
- streams, are thus smoothly filled up. On these fringes the
- roads are generally carried, for their surfaces are even, and
- they rise, with a very gentle slope up the valleys: hence, also,
- they are easily cultivated by irrigation. They may be traced
- up to a height of between 7000 and 9000 feet, where they
- become hidden by the irregular piles of debris. At the lower
- end or mouths of the valleys, they are continuously united to
- those land-locked plains (also formed of shingle) at the foot
- of the main Cordillera, which I have described in a former
- chapter as characteristic of the scenery of Chile, and which
- were undoubtedly deposited when the sea penetrated Chile, as
- it now does the more southern coasts. No one fact in the
- geology of South America, interested me more than these
- terraces of rudely-stratified shingle. They precisely resemble
- in composition the matter which the torrents in each valley
- would deposit, if they were checked in their course by any
- cause, such as entering a lake or arm of the sea; but the
- torrents, instead of depositing matter, are now steadily at
- work wearing away both the solid rock and these alluvial
- deposits, along the whole line of every main valley and side
- valley. It is impossible here to give the reasons, but I am
- convinced that the shingle terraces were accumulated, during
- the gradual elevation of the Cordillera, by the torrents
- delivering, at successive levels, their detritus on the
- beachheads of long narrow arms of the sea, first high up the
- valleys, then lower and lower down as the land slowly rose. If
- this be so, and I cannot doubt it, the grand and broken chain
- of the Cordillera, instead of having been suddenly thrown up,
- as was till lately the universal, and still is the common
- opinion of geologists, has been slowly upheaved in mass, in the
- same gradual manner as the coasts of the Atlantic and Pacific
- have risen within the recent period. A multitude of facts in the
- structure of the Cordillera, on this view receive a simple
- explanation.
-
- The rivers which flow in these valleys ought rather to be
- called mountain-torrents. Their inclination is very great,
- and their water the colour of mud. The roar which the
- Maypu made, as it rushed over the great rounded fragments,
- was like that of the sea. Amidst the din of rushing waters,
- the noise from the stones, as they rattled one over another,
- was most distinctly audible even from a distance. This rattling
- noise, night and day, may be heard along the whole
- course of the torrent. The sound spoke eloquently to the
- geologist; the thousands and thousands of stones, which,
- striking against each other, made the one dull uniform sound,
- were all hurrying in one direction. It was like thinking on
- time, where the minute that now glides past is irrevocable.
- So was it with these stones; the ocean is their eternity, and
- each note of that wild music told of one more step towards
- their destiny.
-
- It is not possible for the mind to comprehend, except by
- a slow process, any effect which is produced by a cause repeated
- so often, that the multiplier itself conveys an idea,
- not more definite than the savage implies when he points to
- the hairs of his head. As often as I have seen beds of mud,
- sand, and shingle, accumulated to the thickness of many
- thousand feet, I have felt inclined to exclaim that causes,
- such as the present rivers and the present beaches, could
- never have ground down and produced such masses. But, on
- the other hand, when listening to the rattling noise of these
- torrents, and calling to mind that whole races of animals have
- passed away from the face of the earth, and that during this
- whole period, night and day, these stones have gone rattling
- onwards in their course, I have thought to myself, can any
- mountains, any continent, withstand such waste?
-
- In this part of the valley, the mountains on each side were
- from 3000 to 6000 or 8000 feet high, with rounded outlines
- and steep bare flanks. The general colour of the rock was
- dullish purple, and the stratification very distinct. If the
- scenery was not beautiful, it was remarkable and grand. We
- met during the day several herds of cattle, which men were
- driving down from the higher valleys in the Cordillera. This
- sign of the approaching winter hurried our steps, more than
- was convenient for geologizing. The house where we slept
- was situated at the foot of a mountain, on the summit of
- which are the mines of S. Pedro de Nolasko. Sir F. Head
- marvels how mines have been discovered in such extraordinary
- situations, as the bleak summit of the mountain of S.
- Pedro de Nolasko. In the first place, metallic veins in this
- country are generally harder than the surrounding strata:
- hence, during the gradual wear of the hills, they project
- above the surface of the ground. Secondly, almost every
- labourer, especially in the northern parts of Chile, understands
- something about the appearance of ores. In the great
- mining provinces of Coquimbo and Copiapo, firewood is very
- scarce, and men search for it over every hill and dale; and
- by this means nearly all the richest mines have there been
- discovered. Chanuncillo, from which silver to the value of
- many hundred thousand pounds has been raised in the course
- of a few years, was discovered by a man who threw a stone
- at his loaded donkey, and thinking that it was very heavy, he
- picked it up, and found it full of pure silver: the vein
- occurred at no great distance, standing up like a wedge of
- metal. The miners, also, taking a crowbar with them, often
- wander on Sundays over the mountains. In this south part
- of Chile, the men who drive cattle into the Cordillera, and
- who frequent every ravine where there is a little pasture, are
- the usual discoverers.
-
- 20th. -- As we ascended the valley, the vegetation, with
- the exception of a few pretty alpine flowers, became exceedingly
- scanty, and of quadrupeds, birds, or insects, scarcely
- one could be seen. The lofty mountains, their summits
- marked with a few patches of snow, stood well separated
- from each other, the valleys being filled up with an immense
- thickness of stratified alluvium. The features in the scenery
- of the Andes which struck me most, as contrasted with the
- other mountain chains with which I am acquainted, were, --
- the flat fringes sometimes expanding into narrow plains on
- each side of the valleys, -- the bright colours, chiefly red and
- purple, of the utterly bare and precipitous hills of porphyry,
- the grand and continuous wall-like dykes, -- the plainly-
- divided strata which, where nearly vertical, formed the
- picturesque and wild central pinnacles, but where less inclined,
- composed the great massive mountains on the outskirts of the
- range, -- and lastly, the smooth conical piles of fine and
- brightly coloured detritus, which sloped up at a high angle
- from the base of the mountains, sometimes to a height of
- more than 2000 feet.
-
- I frequently observed, both in Tierra del Fuego and within
- the Andes, that where the rock was covered during the greater
- part of the year with snow, it was shivered in a very
- extraordinary manner into small angular fragments. Scoresby [1]
- has observed the same fact in Spitzbergen. The case
- appears to me rather obscure: for that part of the mountain
- which is protected by a mantle of snow, must be less subject
- to repeated and great changes of temperature than any other
- part. I have sometimes thought, that the earth and fragments
- of stone on the surface, were perhaps less effectually
- removed by slowly percolating snow-water [2] than by rain, and
- therefore that the appearance of a quicker disintegration of
- the solid rock under the snow, was deceptive. Whatever the
- cause may be, the quantity of crumbling stone on the Cordillera
- is very great. Occasionally in the spring, great masses
- of this detritus slide down the mountains, and cover the
- snow-drifts in the valleys, thus forming natural ice-houses.
- We rode over one, the height of which was far below the
- limit of perpetual snow.
-
- As the evening drew to a close, we reached a singular
- basin-like plain, called the Valle del Yeso. It was covered
- by a little dry pasture, and we had the pleasant sight of a
- herd of cattle amidst the surrounding rocky deserts. The
- valley takes its name of Yeso from a great bed, I should think
- at least 2000 feet thick, of white, and in some parts quite
- pure, gypsum. We slept with a party of men, who were
- employed in loading mules with this substance, which is used
- in the manufacture of wine. We set out early in the morning
- (21st), and continued to follow the course of the river, which
- had become very small, till we arrived at the foot of the ridge,
- that separates the waters flowing into the Pacific and Atlantic
- Oceans. The road, which as yet had been good with a steady
- but very gradual ascent, now changed into a steep zigzag
- track up the great range, dividing the republics of Chile
- and Mendoza.
-
- I will here give a very brief sketch of the geology of the
- several parallel lines forming the Cordillera. Of these lines,
- there are two considerably higher than the others; namely,
- on the Chilian side, the Peuquenes ridge, which, where the
- road crosses it, is 13,210 feet above the sea; and the Portillo
- ridge, on the Mendoza side, which is 14,305 feet. The lower
- beds of the Peuquenes ridge, and of the several great lines
- to the westward of it, are composed of a vast pile, many
- thousand feet in thickness, of porphyries which have flowed as
- submarine lavas, alternating with angular and rounded fragments
- of the same rocks, thrown out of the submarine craters.
- These alternating masses are covered in the central parts,
- by a great thickness of red sandstone, conglomerate, and
- calcareous clay-slate, associated with, and passing into,
- prodigious beds of gypsum. In these upper beds shells are
- tolerably frequent; and they belong to about the period of the
- lower chalk of Europe. It is an old story, but not the less
- wonderful, to hear of shells which were once crawling on the
- bottom of the sea, now standing nearly 14,000 feet above its
- level. The lower beds in this great pile of strata, have been
- dislocated, baked, crystallized and almost blended together,
- through the agency of mountain masses of a peculiar white
- soda-granitic rock.
-
- The other main line, namely, that of the Portillo, is of a
- totally different formation: it consists chiefly of grand bare
- pinnacles of a red potash-granite, which low down on the
- western flank are covered by a sandstone, converted by the
- former heat into a quartz-rock. On the quartz, there rest
- beds of a conglomerate several thousand feet in thickness,
- which have been upheaved by the red granite, and dip at an
- angle of 45 degs. towards the Peuquenes line. I was astonished
- to find that this conglomerate was partly composed of pebbles,
- derived from the rocks, with their fossil shells, of the
- Peuquenes range; and partly of red potash-granite, like that
- of the Portillo. Hence we must conclude, that both the Peuquenes
- and Portillo ranges were partially upheaved and exposed
- to wear and tear, when the conglomerate was forming;
- but as the beds of the conglomerate have been thrown off at
- an angle of 45 degs. by the red Portillo granite (with the
- underlying sandstone baked by it), we may feel sure, that the
- greater part of the injection and upheaval of the already
- partially formed Portillo line, took place after the
- accumulation of the conglomerate, and long after the elevation
- of the Peuquenes ridge. So that the Portillo, the loftiest line
- in this part of the Cordillera, is not so old as the less lofty
- line of the Peuquenes. Evidence derived from an inclined stream
- of lava at the eastern base of the Portillo, might be adduced
- to show, that it owes part of its great height to elevations of
- a still later date. Looking to its earliest origin, the red
- granite seems to have been injected on an ancient pre-existing
- line of white granite and mica-slate. In most parts, perhaps in
- all parts, of the Cordillera, it may be concluded that each line
- has been formed by repeated upheavals and injections; and
- that the several parallel lines are of different ages. Only
- thus can we gain time, at all sufficient to explain the truly
- astonishing amount of denudation, which these great, though
- comparatively with most other ranges recent, mountains have
- suffered.
-
- Finally, the shells in the Peuquenes or oldest ridge, prove,
- as before remarked, that it has been upraised 14,000 feet
- since a Secondary period, which in Europe we are accustomed
- to consider as far from ancient; but since these shells
- lived in a moderately deep sea, it can be shown that the area
- now occupied by the Cordillera, must have subsided several
- thousand feet -- in northern Chile as much as 6000 feet -- so
- as to have allowed that amount of submarine strata to have
- been heaped on the bed on which the shells lived. The proof
- is the same with that by which it was shown, that at a much
- later period, since the tertiary shells of Patagonia lived,
- there must have been there a subsidence of several hundred
- feet, as well as an ensuing elevation. Daily it is forced home
- on the mind of the geologist, that nothing, not even the wind
- that blows, is so unstable as the level of the crust of this
- earth.
-
- I will make only one other geological remark: although
- the Portillo chain is here higher than the Peuquenes, the
- waters draining the intermediate valleys, have burst through
- it. The same fact, on a grander scale, has been remarked in
- the eastern and loftiest line of the Bolivian Cordillera,
- through which the rivers pass: analogous facts have also
- been observed in other quarters of the world. On the supposition
- of the subsequent and gradual elevation of the Portillo
- line, this can be understood; for a chain of islets would
- at first appear, and, as these were lifted up, the tides would
- be always wearing deeper and broader channels between them.
- At the present day, even in the most retired Sounds on the
- coast of Tierra del Fuego, the currents in the transverse
- breaks which connect the longitudinal channels, are very
- strong, so that in one transverse channel even a small vessel
- under sail was whirled round and round.
-
-
- About noon we began the tedious ascent of the Peuquenes
- ridge, and then for the first time experienced some little
- difficulty in our respiration. The mules would halt every fifty
- yards, and after resting for a few seconds the poor willing
- animals started of their own accord again. The short breathing
- from the rarefied atmosphere is called by the Chilenos
- "puna;" and they have most ridiculous notions concerning
- its origin. Some say "all the waters here have puna;" others
- that "where there is snow there is puna;" -- and this no
- doubt is true. The only sensation I experienced was a slight
- tightness across the head and chest, like that felt on leaving
- a warm room and running quickly in frosty weather. There
- was some imagination even in this; for upon finding fossil
- shells on the highest ridge, I entirely forgot the puna in my
- delight. Certainly the exertion of walking was extremely
- great, and the respiration became deep and laborious: I am
- told that in Potosi (about 13,000 feet above the sea) strangers
- do not become thoroughly accustomed to the atmosphere for
- an entire year. The inhabitants all recommend onions for
- the puna; as this vegetable has sometimes been given in
- Europe for pectoral complaints, it may possibly be of real
- service: -- for my part I found nothing so good as the fossil
- shells!
-
- When about half-way up we met a large party with seventy
- loaded mules. It was interesting to hear the wild cries
- of the muleteers, and to watch the long descending string
- of the animals; they appeared so diminutive, there being
- nothing but the black mountains with which they could be
- compared. When near the summit, the wind, as generally
- happens, was impetuous and extremely cold. On each side of
- the ridge, we had to pass over broad bands of perpetual
- snow, which were now soon to be covered by a fresh layer.
- When we reached the crest and looked backwards, a glorious
- view was presented. The atmosphere resplendently clear;
- the sky an intense blue; the profound valleys; the wild
- broken forms: the heaps of ruins, piled up during the lapse
- of ages; the bright-coloured rocks, contrasted with the quiet
- mountains of snow, all these together produced a scene no
- one could have imagined. Neither plant nor bird, excepting
- a few condors wheeling around the higher pinnacles, distracted
- my attention from the inanimate mass. I felt glad
- that I was alone: it was like watching a thunderstorm, or
- hearing in full orchestra a chorus of the Messiah.
-
- On several patches of the snow I found the Protococcus
- nivalis, or red snow, so well known from the accounts of
- Arctic navigators. My attention was called to it, by observing
- the footsteps of the mules stained a pale red, as if their
- hoofs had been slightly bloody. I at first thought that it was
- owing to dust blown from the surrounding mountains of red
- porphyry; for from the magnifying power of the crystals
- of snow, the groups of these microscopical plants appeared
- like coarse particles. The snow was coloured only where it
- had thawed very rapidly, or had been accidentally crushed.
- A little rubbed on paper gave it a faint rose tinge mingled
- with a little brick-red. I afterwards scraped some off the
- paper, and found that it consisted of groups of little spheres
- in colourless cases, each of the thousandth part of an inch in
- diameter.
-
- The wind on the crest of the Peuquenes, as just remarked,
- is generally impetuous and very cold: it is said [3] to blow
- steadily from the westward or Pacific side. As the observations
- have been chiefly made in summer, this wind must be
- an upper and return current. The Peak of Teneriffe, with
- a less elevation, and situated in lat. 28 degs., in like manner
- falls within an upper return stream. At first it appears rather
- surprising, that the trade-wind along the northern parts of
- Chile and on the coast of Peru, should blow in so very southerly
- a direction as it does; but when we reflect that the Cordillera,
- running in a north and south line, intercepts, like a
- great wall, the entire depth of the lower atmospheric current,
- we can easily see that the trade-wind must be drawn northward,
- following the line of mountains, towards the equatorial
- regions, and thus lose part of that easterly movement which
- it otherwise would have gained from the earth's rotation. At
- Mendoza, on the eastern foot of the Andes, the climate is
- said to be subject to long calms, and to frequent though false
- appearances of gathering rain-storms: we may imagine that
- the wind, which coming from the eastward is thus banked up
- by the line of mountains, would become stagnant and irregular
- in its movements.
-
- Having crossed the Peuquenes, we descended into a mountainous
- country, intermediate between the two main ranges,
- and then took up our quarters for the night. We were now
- in the republic of Mendoza. The elevation was probably not
- under 11,000 feet, and the vegetation in consequence exceedingly
- scanty. The root of a small scrubby plant served as
- fuel, but it made a miserable fire, and the wind was
- piercingly cold. Being quite tired with my days work, I
- made up my bed as quickly as I could, and went to sleep.
- About midnight I observed the sky became suddenly clouded:
- I awakened the arriero to know if there was any danger of
- bad weather; but he said that without thunder and lightning
- there was no risk of a heavy snow-storm. The peril is
- imminent, and the difficulty of subsequent escape great, to
- any one overtaken by bad weather between the two ranges.
- A certain cave offers the only place of refuge: Mr. Caldcleugh,
- who crossed on this same day of the month, was
- detained there for some time by a heavy fall of snow. Casuchas,
- or houses of refuge, have not been built in this pass
- as in that of Uspallata, and, therefore, during the autumn,
- the Portillo is little frequented. I may here remark that
- within the main Cordillera rain never falls, for during the
- summer the sky is cloudless, and in winter snow-storms alone
- occur.
-
- At the place where we slept water necessarily boiled, from
- the diminished pressure of the atmosphere, at a lower
- temperature than it does in a less lofty country; the case being
- the converse of that of a Papin's digester. Hence the potatoes,
- after remaining for some hours in the boiling water,
- were nearly as hard as ever. The pot was left on the fire
- all night, and next morning it was boiled again, but yet the
- potatoes were not cooked. I found out this, by overhearing
- my two companions discussing the cause, they had come
- to the simple conclusion, "that the cursed pot [which was a
- new one] did not choose to boil potatoes."
-
- March 22nd. -- After eating our potatoless breakfast, we
- travelled across the intermediate tract to the foot of the
- Portillo range. In the middle of summer cattle are brought
- up here to graze; but they had now all been removed: even
- the greater number of the Guanacos had decamped, knowing
- well that if overtaken here by a snow-storm, they would be
- caught in a trap. We had a fine view of a mass of mountains
- called Tupungato, the whole clothed with unbroken
- snow, in the midst of which there was a blue patch, no
- doubt a glacier; -- a circumstance of rare occurrence in these
- mountains. Now commenced a heavy and long climb, similar
- to that of the Peuquenes. Bold conical hills of red
- granite rose on each hand; in the valleys there were several
- broad fields of perpetual snow. These frozen masses, during
- the process of thawing, had in some parts been converted
- into pinnacles or columns, [4] which, as they were high and
- close together, made it difficult for the cargo mules to pass.
- On one of these columns of ice, a frozen horse was sticking
- as on a pedestal, but with its hind legs straight up in
- the air. The animal, I suppose, must have fallen with its
- head downward into a hole, when the snow was continuous,
- and afterwards the surrounding parts must have been
- removed by the thaw.
-
- When nearly on the crest of the Portillo, we were enveloped
- in a falling cloud of minute frozen spicula. This was
- very unfortunate, as it continued the whole day, and quite
- intercepted our view. The pass takes its name of Portillo,
- from a narrow cleft or doorway on the highest ridge,
- through which the road passes. From this point, on a clear
- day, those vast plains which uninterruptedly extend to the
- Atlantic Ocean can be seen. We descended to the upper
- limit of vegetation, and found good quarters for the night
- under the shelter of some large fragments of rock. We met
- here some passengers, who made anxious inquiries about the
- state of the road. Shortly after it was dark the clouds suddenly
- cleared away, and the effect was quite magical. The
- great mountains, bright with the full moon, seemed impending
- over us on all sides, as over a deep crevice: one morning,
- very early, I witnessed the same striking effect. As
- soon as the clouds were dispersed it froze severely; but as
- there was no wind, we slept very comfortably.
-
- The increased brilliancy of the moon and stars at this
- elevation, owing to the perfect transparency of the atmosphere,
- was very remarkable. Travelers having observed
- the difficulty of judging heights and distances amidst lofty
- mountains, have generally attributed it to the absence of
- objects of comparison. It appears to me, that it is fully as
- much owing to the transparency of the air confounding
- objects at different distances, and likewise partly to the
- novelty of an unusual degree of fatigue arising from a little
- exertion, -- habit being thus opposed to the evidence of the
- senses. I am sure that this extreme clearness of the air
- gives a peculiar character to the landscape, all objects
- appearing to be brought nearly into one plane, as in a drawing
- or panorama. The transparency is, I presume, owing to
- the equable and high state of atmospheric dryness. This
- dryness was shown by the manner in which woodwork
- shrank (as I soon found by the trouble my geological hammer
- gave me); by articles of food, such as bread and sugar,
- becoming extremely hard; and by the preservation of the
- skin and parts of the flesh of the beasts, which had perished
- on the road. To the same cause we must attribute the singular
- facility with which electricity is excited. My flannel
- waistcoat, when rubbed in the dark, appeared as if it had
- been washed with phosphorus, -- every hair on a dog's back
- crackled; -- even the linen sheets, and leathern straps of the
- saddle, when handled, emitted sparks.
-
- March 23rd. -- The descent on the eastern side of the Cordillera
- is much shorter or steeper than on the Pacific side;
- in other words, the mountains rise more abruptly from the
- plains than from the alpine country of Chile. A level and
- brilliantly white sea of clouds was stretched out beneath our
- feet, shutting out the view of the equally level Pampas. We
- soon entered the band of clouds, and did not again emerge
- from it that day. About noon, finding pasture for the animals
- and bushes for firewood at Los Arenales, we stopped
- for the night. This was near the uppermost limit of bushes,
- and the elevation, I suppose, was between seven and eight
- thousand feet.
-
- I was much struck with the marked difference between
- the vegetation of these eastern valleys and those on the
- Chilian side: yet the climate, as well as the kind of soil, is
- nearly the same, and the difference of longitude very trifling.
- The same remark holds good with the quadrupeds, and in
- a lesser degree with the birds and insects. I may instance the
- mice, of which I obtained thirteen species on the shores of
- the Atlantic, and five on the Pacific, and not one of them
- is identical. We must except all those species, which habitually
- or occasionally frequent elevated mountains; and certain
- birds, which range as far south as the Strait of Magellan.
- This fact is in perfect accordance with the geological
- history of the Andes; for these mountains have existed as
- a great barrier since the present races of animals have
- appeared; and therefore, unless we suppose the same species
- to have been created in two different places, we ought not to
- expect any closer similarity between the organic beings on
- the opposite sides of the Andes than on the opposite shores
- of the ocean. In both cases, we must leave out of the question
- those kinds which have been able to cross the barrier,
- whether of solid rock or salt-water. [5]
-
- A great number of the plants and animals were absolutely
- the same as, or most closely allied to, those of Patagonia.
- We here have the agouti, bizcacha, three species of armadillo,
- the ostrich, certain kinds of partridges and other birds,
- none of which are ever seen in Chile, but are the characteristic
- animals of the desert plains of Patagonia. We have
- likewise many of the same (to the eyes of a person who is
- not a botanist) thorny stunted bushes, withered grass, and
- dwarf plants. Even the black slowly crawling beetles are
- closely similar, and some, I believe, on rigorous examination,
- absolutely identical. It had always been to me a subject of
- regret, that we were unavoidably compelled to give up the
- ascent of the S. Cruz river before reaching the mountains:
- I always had a latent hope of meeting with some great
- change in the features of the country; but I now feel sure,
- that it would only have been following the plains of Patagonia
- up a mountainous ascent.
-
- March 24th. -- Early in the morning I climbed up a mountain
- on one side of the valley, and enjoyed a far extended
- view over the Pampas. This was a spectacle to which I had
- always looked forward with interest, but I was disappointed:
- at the first glance it much resembled a distant view of the
- ocean, but in the northern parts many irregularities were
- soon distinguishable. The most striking feature consisted
- in the rivers, which, facing the rising sun, glittered like
- silver threads, till lost in the immensity of the distance. At
- midday we descended the valley, and reached a hovel, where
- an officer and three soldiers were posted to examine passports.
- One of these men was a thoroughbred Pampas
- Indian: he was kept much for the same purpose as a bloodhound,
- to track out any person who might pass by secretly,
- either on foot or horseback. Some years ago, a passenger
- endeavoured to escape detection, by making a long circuit
- over a neighbouring mountain; but this Indian, having by
- chance crossed his track, followed it for the whole day over
- dry and very stony hills, till at last he came on his prey
- hidden in a gully. We here heard that the silvery clouds,
- which we had admired from the bright region above, had
- poured down torrents of rain. The valley from this point
- gradually opened, and the hills became mere water-worn
- hillocks compared to the giants behind: it then expanded
- into a gently sloping plain of shingle, covered with low trees
- and bushes. This talus, although appearing narrow, must be
- nearly ten miles wide before it blends into the apparently
- dead level Pampas. We passed the only house in this
- neighbourhood, the Estancia of Chaquaio: and at sunset we pulled
- up in the first snug corner, and there bivouacked.
-
- March 25th. -- I was reminded of the Pampas of Buenos
- Ayres, by seeing the disk of the rising sun, intersected by an
- horizon level as that of the ocean. During the night a heavy
- dew fell, a circumstance which we did not experience within
- the Cordillera. The road proceeded for some distance due
- east across a low swamp; then meeting the dry plain, it
- turned to the north towards Mendoza. The distance is two
- very long days' journey. Our first day's journey was called
- fourteen leagues to Estacado, and the second seventeen to
- Luxan, near Mendoza. The whole distance is over a level
- desert plain, with not more than two or three houses. The
- sun was exceedingly powerful, and the ride devoid of all
- interest. There is very little water in this "traversia," and
- in our second day's journey we found only one little pool.
- Little water flows from the mountains, and it soon becomes
- absorbed by the dry and porous soil; so that, although we
- travelled at the distance of only ten or fifteen miles from
- the outer range of the Cordillera, we did not cross a single
- stream. In many parts the ground was incrusted with a
- saline efflorescence; hence we had the same salt-loving
- plants which are common near Bahia Blanca. The landscape
- has a uniform character from the Strait of Magellan,
- along the whole eastern coast of Patagonia, to the Rio Colorado;
- and it appears that the same kind of country extends
- inland from this river, in a sweeping line as far as San Luis
- and perhaps even further north. To the eastward of this
- curved line lies the basin of the comparatively damp and
- green plains of Buenos Ayres. The sterile plains of Mendoza
- and Patagonia consist of a bed of shingle, worn smooth
- and accumulated by the waves of the sea while the Pampas,
- covered by thistles, clover, and grass, have been formed by
- the ancient estuary mud of the Plata.
-
- After our two days' tedious journey, it was refreshing to
- see in the distance the rows of poplars and willows growing
- round the village and river of Luxan. Shortly before we
- arrived at this place, we observed to the south a ragged cloud
- of dark reddish-brown colour. At first we thought that it
- was smoke from some great fire on the plains; but we soon
- found that it was a swarm of locusts. They were flying
- northward; and with the aid of a light breeze, they overtook
- us at a rate of ten or fifteen miles an hour. The main body
- filled the air from a height of twenty feet, to that, as it
- appeared, of two or three thousand above the ground; "and the
- sound of their wings was as the sound of chariots of many
- horses running to battle:" or rather, I should say, like a
- strong breeze passing through the rigging of a ship. The
- sky, seen through the advanced guard, appeared like a mezzotinto
- engraving, but the main body was impervious to sight;
- they were not, however, so thick together, but that they
- could escape a stick waved backwards and forwards. When
- they alighted, they were more numerous than the leaves in
- the field, and the surface became reddish instead of being
- green: the swarm having once alighted, the individuals flew
- from side to side in all directions. Locusts are not an uncommon
- pest in this country: already during the season, several
- smaller swarms had come up from the south, where, as
- apparently in all other parts of the world, they are bred in
- the deserts. The poor cottagers in vain attempted by lighting
- fires, by shouts, and by waving branches to avert the
- attack. This species of locust closely resembles, and perhaps
- is identical with, the famous Gryllus migratorius of the East.
-
- We crossed the Luxan, which is a river of considerable
- size, though its course towards the sea-coast is very
- imperfectly known: it is even doubtful whether, in passing over
- the plains, it is not evaporated and lost. We slept in the
- village of Luxan, which is a small place surrounded by gardens,
- and forms the most southern cultivated district in the
- Province of Mendoza; it is five leagues south of the capital.
- At night I experienced an attack (for it deserves no less a
- name) of the _Benchuca_, a species of Reduvius, the great
- black bug of the Pampas. It is most disgusting to feel soft
- wingless insects, about an inch long, crawling over one's
- body. Before sucking they are quite thin, but afterwards
- they become round and bloated with blood, and in this state
- are easily crushed. One which I caught at Iquique, (for they
- are found in Chile and Peru,) was very empty. When placed
- on a table, and though surrounded by people, if a finger was
- presented, the bold insect would immediately protrude its
- sucker, make a charge, and if allowed, draw blood. No pain
- was caused by the wound. It was curious to watch its body
- during the act of sucking, as in less than ten minutes it
- changed from being as flat as a wafer to a globular form.
- This one feast, for which the benchuca was indebted to one
- of the officers, kept it fat during four whole months; but,
- after the first fortnight, it was quite ready to have another
- suck.
-
- March 27th. -- We rode on to Mendoza. The country was
- beautifully cultivated, and resembled Chile. This neighbourhood
- is celebrated for its fruit; and certainly nothing could
- appear more flourishing than the vineyards and the orchards
- of figs, peaches, and olives. We bought water-melons nearly
- twice as large as a man's head, most deliciously cool and
- well-flavoured, for a halfpenny apiece; and for the value of
- threepence, half a wheelbarrowful of peaches. The cultivated
- and enclosed part of this province is very small; there
- is little more than that which we passed through between
- Luxan and the capital. The land, as in Chile, owes its fertility
- entirely to artificial irrigation; and it is really wonderful
- to observe how extraordinarily productive a barren
- traversia is thus rendered.
-
- We stayed the ensuing day in Mendoza. The prosperity
- of the place has much declined of late years. The inhabitants
- say "it is good to live in, but very bad to grow rich in."
- The lower orders have the lounging, reckless manners of the
- Gauchos of the Pampas; and their dress, riding-gear, and
- habits of life, are nearly the same. To my mind the town
- had a stupid, forlorn aspect. Neither the boasted alameda,
- nor the scenery, is at all comparable with that of Santiago;
- but to those who, coming from Buenos Ayres, have just
- crossed the unvaried Pampas, the gardens and orchards must
- appear delightful. Sir F. Head, speaking of the inhabitants,
- says, "They eat their dinners, and it is so very hot, they go
- to sleep -- and could they do better?" I quite agree with
- Sir F. Head: the happy doom of the Mendozinos is to eat,
- sleep and be idle.
-
-
- March 29th. -- We set out on our return to Chile, by the
- Uspallata pass situated north of Mendoza. We had to cross
- a long and most sterile traversia of fifteen leagues. The
- soil in parts was absolutely bare, in others covered by
- numberless dwarf cacti, armed with formidable spines, and called
- by the inhabitants "little lions." There were, also, a few
- low bushes. Although the plain is nearly three thousand feet
- above the sea, the sun was very powerful; and the heat as
- well as the clouds of impalpable dust, rendered the travelling
- extremely irksome. Our course during the day lay nearly
- parallel to the Cordillera, but gradually approaching them.
- Before sunset we entered one of the wide valleys, or rather
- bays, which open on the plain: this soon narrowed into a
- ravine, where a little higher up the house of Villa Vicencio
- is situated. As we had ridden all day without a drop of
- water, both our mules and selves were very thirsty, and we
- looked out anxiously for the stream which flows down this
- valley. It was curious to observe how gradually the water
- made its appearance: on the plain the course was quite dry;
- by degrees it became a little damper; then puddles of water
- appeared; these soon became connected; and at Villa Vicencio
- there was a nice little rivulet.
-
- 30th. -- The solitary hovel which bears the imposing name
- of Villa Vicencio, has been mentioned by every traveller who
- has crossed the Andes. I stayed here and at some neighbouring
- mines during the two succeeding days. The geology
- of the surrounding country is very curious. The Uspallata
- range is separated from the main Cordillera by a long narrow
- plain or basin, like those so often mentioned in Chile,
- but higher, being six thousand feet above the sea. This
- range has nearly the same geographical position with respect
- to the Cordillera, which the gigantic Portillo line has, but it
- is of a totally different origin: it consists of various kinds
- of submarine lava, alternating with volcanic sandstones and
- other remarkable sedimentary deposits; the whole having a
- very close resemblance to some of the tertiary beds on the
- shores of the Pacific. From this resemblance I expected to
- find silicified wood, which is generally characteristic of those
- formations. I was gratified in a very extraordinary manner.
- In the central part of the range, at an elevation of about
- seven thousand feet, I observed on a bare slope some snow-white
- projecting columns. These were petrified trees, eleven
- being silicified, and from thirty to forty converted into
- coarsely-crystallized white calcareous spar. They were abruptly
- broken off, the upright stumps projecting a few feet
- above the ground. The trunks measured from three to five
- feet each in circumference. They stood a little way apart
- from each other, but the whole formed one group. Mr. Robert
- Brown has been kind enough to examine the wood: he
- says it belongs to the fir tribe, partaking of the character
- of the Araucarian family, but with some curious points of
- affinity with the yew. The volcanic sandstone in which the
- trees were embedded, and from the lower part of which they
- must have sprung, had accumulated in successive thin layers
- around their trunks; and the stone yet retained the impression
- of the bark.
-
- It required little geological practice to interpret the
- marvellous story which this scene at once unfolded; though I
- confess I was at first so much astonished that I could
- scarcely believe the plainest evidence. I saw the spot where
- a cluster of fine trees once waved their branches on the
- shores of the Atlantic, when that ocean (now driven back
- 700 miles) came to the foot of the Andes. I saw that they
- had sprung from a volcanic soil which had been raised above
- the level of the sea, and that subsequently this dry land,
- with its upright trees, had been let down into the depths of
- the ocean. In these depths, the formerly dry land was
- covered by sedimentary beds, and these again by enormous
- streams of submarine lava -- one such mass attaining the
- thickness of a thousand feet; and these deluges of molten
- stone and aqueous deposits five times alternately had been
- spread out. The ocean which received such thick masses,
- must have been profoundly deep; but again the subterranean
- forces exerted themselves, and I now beheld the bed of
- that ocean, forming a chain of mountains more than seven
- thousand feet in height. Nor had those antagonistic forces
- been dormant, which are always at work wearing down the
- surface of the land; the great piles of strata had been
- intersected by many wide valleys, and the trees now changed
- into silex, were exposed projecting from the volcanic soil,
- now changed into rock, whence formerly, in a green and
- budding state, they had raised their lofty heads. Now,
- all is utterly irreclaimable and desert; even the lichen cannot
- adhere to the stony casts of former trees. Vast, and
- scarcely comprehensible as such changes must ever appear,
- yet they have all occurred within a period, recent when
- compared with the history of the Cordillera; and the Cordillera
- itself is absolutely modern as compared with many
- of the fossiliferous strata of Europe and America.
-
- April 1st. -- We crossed the Upsallata range, and at night
- slept at the custom-house -- the only inhabited spot on the
- plain. Shortly before leaving the mountains, there was a
- very extraordinary view; red, purple, green, and quite white
- sedimentary rocks, alternating with black lavas, were broken
- up and thrown into all kinds of disorder by masses of porphyry
- of every shade of colour, from dark brown to the
- brightest lilac. It was the first view I ever saw, which
- really resembled those pretty sections which geologists make
- of the inside of the earth.
-
- The next day we crossed the plain, and followed the course
- of the same great mountain stream which flows by Luxan.
- Here it was a furious torrent, quite impassable, and appeared
- larger than in the low country, as was the case with the rivulet
- of Villa Vicencio. On the evening of the succeeding day,
- we reached the Rio de las Vacas, which is considered the
- worst stream in the Cordillera to cross. As all these rivers
- have a rapid and short course, and are formed by the melting
- of the snow, the hour of the day makes a considerable difference
- in their volume. In the evening the stream is muddy
- and full, but about daybreak it becomes clearer, and much
- less impetuous. This we found to be the case with the Rio
- Vacas, and in the morning we crossed it with little difficulty.
-
- The scenery thus far was very uninteresting, compared
- with that of the Portillo pass. Little can be seen beyond the
- bare walls of the one grand flat-bottomed valley, which the
- road follows up to the highest crest. The valley and
- the huge rocky mountains are extremely barren: during the
- two previous nights the poor mules had absolutely nothing
- to eat, for excepting a few low resinous bushes, scarcely a
- plant can be seen. In the course of this day we crossed some
- of the worst passes in the Cordillera, but their danger has
- been much exaggerated. I was told that if I attempted to
- pass on foot, my head would turn giddy, and that there was
- no room to dismount; but I did not see a place where any
- one might not have walked over backwards, or got off his
- mule on either side. One of the bad passes, called _las
- Animas_ (the souls), I had crossed, and did not find out
- till a day afterwards, that it was one of the awful dangers.
- No doubt there are many parts in which, if the mule should
- stumble, the rider would be hurled down a great precipice;
- but of this there is little chance. I dare say, in the spring,
- the "laderas," or roads, which each year are formed anew
- across the piles of fallen detritus, are very bad; but from
- what I saw, I suspect the real danger is nothing. With
- cargo-mules the case is rather different, for the loads project
- so far, that the animals, occasionally running against
- each other, or against a point of rock, lose their balance, and
- are thrown down the precipices. In crossing the rivers
- I can well believe that the difficulty may be very great: at
- this season there was little trouble, but in the summer they
- must be very hazardous. I can quite imagine, as Sir F.
- Head describes, the different expressions of those who _have_
- passed the gulf, and those who _are_ passing. I never heard
- of any man being drowned, but with loaded mules it frequently
- happens. The arriero tells you to show your mule
- the best line, and then allow her to cross as she likes: the
- cargo-mule takes a bad line, and is often lost.
-
- April 4th. -- From the Rio de las Vacas to the Puente del
- Incas, half a day's journey. As there was pasture for the
- mules, and geology for me, we bivouacked here for the
- night. When one hears of a natural Bridge, one pictures
- to one's self some deep and narrow ravine, across which a
- bold mass of rock has fallen; or a great arch hollowed out
- like the vault of a cavern. Instead of this, the Incas
- Bridge consists of a crust of stratified shingle cemented
- together by the deposits of the neighbouring hot springs. It
- appears, as if the stream had scooped out a channel on one
- side, leaving an overhanging ledge, which was met by earth
- and stones falling down from the opposite cliff. Certainly
- an oblique junction, as would happen in such a case, was
- very distinct on one side. The Bridge of the Incas is by
- no means worthy of the great monarchs whose name it
- bears.
-
- 5th. -- We had a long day's ride across the central ridge,
- from the Incas Bridge to the Ojos del Agua, which are situated
- near the lowest _casucha_ on the Chilian side. These
- casuchas are round little towers, with steps outside to reach
- the floor, which is raised some feet above the ground on account
- of the snow-drifts. They are eight in number, and
- under the Spanish government were kept during the winter
- well stored with food and charcoal, and each courier had a
- master-key. Now they only answer the purpose of caves, or
- rather dungeons. Seated on some little eminence, they are
- not, however, ill suited to the surrounding scene of desolation.
- The zigzag ascent of the Cumbre, or the partition of
- the waters, was very steep and tedious; its height, according
- to Mr. Pentland, is 12,454 feet. The road did not pass over
- any perpetual snow, although there were patches of it on
- both hands. The wind on the summit was exceedingly cold,
- but it was impossible not to stop for a few minutes to admire,
- again and again, the colour of the heavens, and the
- brilliant transparency of the atmosphere. The scenery was
- grand: to the westward there was a fine chaos of mountains,
- divided by profound ravines. Some snow generally falls before
- this period of the season, and it has even happened that
- the Cordillera have been finally closed by this time. But
- we were most fortunate. The sky, by night and by day, was
- cloudless, excepting a few round little masses of vapour, that
- floated over the highest pinnacles. I have often seen these
- islets in the sky, marking the position of the Cordillera,
- when the far-distant mountains have been hidden beneath
- the horizon.
-
- April 6th. -- In the morning we found some thief had
- stolen one of our mules, and the bell of the madrina. We
- therefore rode only two or three miles down the valley, and
- stayed there the ensuing day in hopes of recovering the mule,
- which the arriero thought had been hidden in some ravine.
- The scenery in this part had assumed a Chilian character:
- the lower sides of the mountains, dotted over with the pale
- evergreen Quillay tree, and with the great chandelier-like
- cactus, are certainly more to be admired than the bare eastern
- valleys; but I cannot quite agree with the admiration
- expressed by some travellers. The extreme pleasure, I suspect,
- is chiefly owing to the prospect of a good fire and of a
- good supper, after escaping from the cold regions above: and
- I am sure I most heartily participated in these feelings.
-
- 8th. -- We left the valley of the Aconcagua, by which we
- had descended, and reached in the evening a cottage near the
- Villa del St. Rosa. The fertility of the plain was delightful:
- the autumn being advanced, the leaves of many of the
- fruit-trees were falling; and of the labourers, -- some were
- busy in drying figs and peaches on the roofs of their cottages,
- while others were gathering the grapes from the vineyards.
- It was a pretty scene; but I missed that pensive stillness
- which makes the autumn in England indeed the evening
- of the year. On the 10th we reached Santiago, where I received
- a very kind and hospitable reception from Mr. Caldcleugh.
- My excursion only cost me twenty-four days, and
- never did I more deeply enjoy an equal space of time. A
- few days afterwards I returned to Mr. Corfield's house at
- Valparaiso.
-
- [1] Scoresby's Arctic Regions, vol. i. p. 122.
-
- [2] I have heard it remarked in Shropshire that the water, when
- the Severn is flooded from long-continued rain, is much more
- turbid than when it proceeds from the snow melting in the Welsh
- mountains. D'Orbigny (tom. i. p. 184), in explaining the cause
- of the various colours of the rivers in South America, remarks
- that those with blue or clear water have there source in the
- Cordillera, where the snow melts.
-
- [3] Dr. Gillies in Journ. of Nat. and Geograph. Science, Aug.,
- 1830. This author gives the heights of the Passes.
-
- [4] This structure in frozen snow was long since observed by
- Scoresby in the icebergs near Spitzbergen, and, lately, with
- more care, by Colonel Jackson (Journ. of Geograph. Soc., vol. v.
- p. 12) on the Neva. Mr. Lyell (Principles, vol. iv. p. 360) has
- compared the fissures by which the columnar structure seems to
- be determined, to the joints that traverse nearly all rocks, but
- which are best seen in the non-stratified masses. I may observe,
- that in the case of the frozen snow, the columnar structure must
- be owing to a "metamorphic" action, and not to a process during
- deposition.
-
- [5] This is merely an illustration of the admirable laws, first
- laid down by Mr. Lyell, on the geographical distribution of
- animals, as influenced by geological changes. The whole
- reasoning, of course, is founded on the assumption of the
- immutability of species; otherwise the difference in the species
- in the two regions might be considered as superinduced during a
- length of time.
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XVI
-
- NORTHERN CHILE AND PERU
-
- Coast-road to Coquimbo -- Great Loads carried by the Miners --
- Coquimbo -- Earthquake -- Step-formed Terrace -- Absence of
- recent Deposits -- Contemporaneousness of the Tertiary
- Formations -- Excursion up the Valley -- Road to Guasco --
- Deserts -- Valley of Copiapo -- Rain and Earthquakes --
- Hydrophobia -- The Despoblado -- Indian Ruins -- Probable
- Change of Climate -- River-bed arched by an Earthquake --
- Cold Gales of Wind -- Noises from a Hill -- Iquique -- Salt
- Alluvium -- Nitrate of Soda -- Lima -- Unhealthy Country --
- Ruins of Callao, overthrown by an Earthquake -- Recent
- Subsidence -- Elevated Shells on San Lorenzo, their
- decomposition -- Plain with embedded Shells and fragments
- of Pottery -- Antiquity of the Indian Race.
-
-
- APRIL 27th. -- I set out on a journey to Coquimbo, and
- thence through Guasco to Copiapo, where Captain
- Fitz Roy kindly offered to pick me up in the Beagle.
- The distance in a straight line along the shore northward is
- only 420 miles; but my mode of travelling made it a very
- long journey. I bought four horses and two mules, the
- latter carrying the luggage on alternate days. The six
- animals together only cost the value of twenty-five pounds
- sterling, and at Copiapo I sold them again for twenty-three.
- We travelled in the same independent manner as before,
- cooking our own meals, and sleeping in the open air. As
- we rode towards the Vino del Mar, I took a farewell view
- of Valparaiso, and admired its picturesque appearance. For
- geological purposes I made a detour from the high road
- to the foot of the Bell of Quillota. We passed through an
- alluvial district rich in gold, to the neighbourhood of Limache,
- where we slept. Washing for gold supports the inhabitants
- of numerous hovels, scattered along the sides of
- each little rivulet; but, like all those whose gains are
- uncertain, they are unthrifty in all their habits, and
- consequently poor.
-
- 28th. -- In the afternoon we arrived at a cottage at the
- foot of the Bell mountain. The inhabitants were freeholders,
- which is not very usual in Chile. They supported themselves
- on the produce of a garden and a little field, but were
- very poor. Capital is here so deficient, that the people are
- obliged to sell their green corn while standing in the field,
- in order to buy necessaries for the ensuing year. Wheat in
- consequence was dearer in the very district of its production
- than at Valparaiso, where the contractors live. The next
- day we joined the main road to Coquimbo. At night there
- was a very light shower of rain: this was the first drop that
- had fallen since the heavy rain of September 11th and 12th,
- which detained me a prisoner at the Baths of Cauquenes.
- The interval was seven and a half months; but the rain this
- year in Chile was rather later than usual. The distant Andes
- were now covered by a thick mass of snow, and were a glorious
- sight.
-
- May 2nd. -- The road continued to follow the coast, at no
- great distance from the sea. The few trees and bushes which
- are common in central Chile decreased rapidly in numbers,
- and were replaced by a tall plant, something like a yucca in
- appearance. The surface of the country, on a small scale,
- was singularly broken and irregular; abrupt little peaks of
- rock rising out of small plains or basins. The indented coast
- and the bottom of the neighbouring sea, studded with breakers,
- would, if converted into dry land, present similar forms;
- and such a conversion without doubt has taken place in the
- part over which we rode.
-
- 3rd. -- Quilimari to Conchalee. The country became more
- and more barren. In the valleys there was scarcely sufficient
- water for any irrigation; and the intermediate land was
- quite bare, not supporting even goats. In the spring, after
- the winter showers, a thin pasture rapidly springs up, and
- cattle are then driven down from the Cordillera to graze
- for a short time. It is curious to observe how the seeds of
- the grass and other plants seem to accommodate themselves,
- as if by an acquired habit, to the quantity of rain which
- falls upon different parts of this coast. One shower far
- northward at Copiapo produces as great an effect on the
- vegetation, as two at Guasco, and three or four in this
- district. At Valparaiso a winter so dry as greatly to injure
- the pasture, would at Guasco produce the most unusual
- abundance. Proceeding northward, the quantity of rain does
- not appear to decrease in strict proportion to the latitude.
- At Conchalee, which is only 67 miles north of Valparaiso,
- rain is not expected till the end of May; whereas at Valparaiso
- some generally falls early in April: the annual quantity
- is likewise small in proportion to the lateness of the
- season at which it commences.
-
- 4th. -- Finding the coast-road devoid of interest of any
- kind, we turned inland towards the mining district and
- valley of Illapel. This valley, like every other in Chile, is
- level, broad, and very fertile: it is bordered on each side,
- either by cliffs of stratified shingle, or by bare rocky
- mountains. Above the straight line of the uppermost irrigating
- ditch, all is brown as on a high road; while all below is of as
- bright a green as verdigris, from the beds of alfalfa, a kind
- of clover. We proceeded to Los Hornos, another mining
- district, where the principal hill was drilled with holes, like
- a great ants'-nest. The Chilian miners are a peculiar race
- of men in their habits. Living for weeks together in the
- most desolate spots, when they descend to the villages on
- feast-days, there is no excess of extravagance into which
- they do not run. They sometimes gain a considerable sum,
- and then, like sailors with prize-money, they try how soon
- they can contrive to squander it. They drink excessively,
- buy quantities of clothes, and in a few days return penniless
- to their miserable abodes, there to work harder than beasts
- of burden. This thoughtlessness, as with sailors, is evidently
- the result of a similar manner of life. Their daily food is
- found them, and they acquire no habits of carefulness: moreover,
- temptation and the means of yielding to it are placed
- in their power at the same time. On the other hand, in
- Cornwall, and some other parts of England, where the system
- of selling part of the vein is followed, the miners, from
- being obliged to act and think for themselves, are a singularly
- intelligent and well-conducted set of men.
-
- The dress of the Chilian miner is peculiar and rather
- picturesque He wears a very long shirt of some dark-coloured
- baize, with a leathern apron; the whole being fastened
- round his waist by a bright-coloured sash. His trousers are
- very broad, and his small cap of scarlet cloth is made to fit
- the head closely. We met a party of these miners in full
- costume, carrying the body of one of their companions to be
- buried. They marched at a very quick trot, four men supporting
- the corpse. One set having run as hard as they
- could for about two hundred yards, were relieved by four
- others, who had previously dashed on ahead on horseback.
- Thus they proceeded, encouraging each other by wild cries:
- altogether the scene formed a most strange funeral.
-
- We continued travelling northward, in a zigzag line;
- sometimes stopping a day to geologize. The country was so
- thinly inhabited, and the track so obscure, that we often had
- difficulty in finding our way. On the 12th I stayed at some
- mines. The ore in this case was not considered particularly
- good, but from being abundant it was supposed the mine
- would sell for about thirty or forty thousand dollars (that is,
- 6000 or 8000 pounds sterling); yet it had been bought by
- one of the English Associations for an ounce of gold (3l.
- 8s.). The ore is yellow pyrites, which, as I have already
- remarked, before the arrival of the English, was not supposed
- to contain a particle of copper. On a scale of profits nearly
- as great as in the above instance, piles of cinders, abounding
- with minute globules of metallic copper, were purchased;
- yet with these advantages, the mining associations, as is well
- known, contrived to lose immense sums of money. The folly
- of the greater number of the commissioners and shareholders
- amounted to infatuation; -- a thousand pounds per annum
- given in some cases to entertain the Chilian authorities;
- libraries of well-bound geological books; miners brought out
- for particular metals, as tin, which are not found in Chile;
- contracts to supply the miners with milk, in parts where
- there are no cows; machinery, where it could not possibly
- be used; and a hundred similar arrangements, bore witness
- to our absurdity, and to this day afford amusement to the
- natives. Yet there can be no doubt, that the same capital
- well employed in these mines would have yielded an immense
- return, a confidential man of business, a practical
- miner and assayer, would have been all that was required.
-
- Captain Head has described the wonderful load which
- the "Apires," truly beasts of burden, carry up from the
- deepest mines. I confess I thought the account exaggerated:
- so that I was glad to take an opportunity of weighing one
- of the loads, which I picked out by hazard. It required
- considerable exertion on my part, when standing directly over
- it, to lift it from the ground. The load was considered under
- weight when found to be 197 pounds. The apire had carried
- this up eighty perpendicular yards, -- part of the way by
- a steep passage, but the greater part up notched poles, placed
- in a zigzag line up the shaft. According to the general
- regulation, the apire is not allowed to halt for breath, except
- the mine is six hundred feet deep. The average load is
- considered as rather more than 200 pounds, and I have been
- assured that one of 300 pounds (twenty-two stone and a half)
- by way of a trial has been brought up from the deepest mine!
- At this time the apires were bringing up the usual load
- twelve times in the day; that is 2400 pounds from eighty
- yards deep; and they were employed in the intervals in breaking
- and picking ore.
-
- These men, excepting from accidents, are healthy, and appear
- cheerful. Their bodies are not very muscular. They
- rarely eat meat once a week, and never oftener, and then only
- the hard dry charqui. Although with a knowledge that the
- labour was voluntary, it was nevertheless quite revolting to
- see the state in which they reached the mouth of the mine;
- their bodies bent forward, leaning with their arms on the
- steps, their legs bowed, their muscles quivering, the
- perspiration streaming from their faces over their breasts,
- their nostrils distended, the corners of their mouth forcibly
- drawn back, and the expulsion of their breath most laborious.
- Each time they draw their breath, they utter an articulate
- cry of "ay-ay," which ends in a sound rising from deep in
- the chest, but shrill like the note of a fife. After staggering
- to the pile of ore, they emptied the "carpacho;" in two or
- three seconds recovering their breath, they wiped the sweat
- from their brows, and apparently quite fresh descended the
- mine again at a quick pace. This appears to me a wonderful
- instance of the amount of labour which habit, for it can be
- nothing else, will enable a man to endure.
-
- In the evening, talking with the _mayor-domo_ of these
- mines about the number of foreigners now scattered over
- the whole country, he told me that, though quite a young
- man, he remembers when he was a boy at school at
- Coquimbo, a holiday being given to see the captain of an
- English ship, who was brought to the city to speak to the
- governor. He believes that nothing would have induced
- any boy in the school, himself included, to have gone close
- to the Englishman; so deeply had they been impressed with
- an idea of the heresy, contamination, and evil to be derived
- from contact with such a person. To this day they relate
- the atrocious actions of the bucaniers; and especially of
- one man, who took away the figure of the Virgin Mary, and
- returned the year after for that of St. Joseph, saying it
- was a pity the lady should not have a husband. I heard
- also of an old lady who, at a dinner at Coquimbo, remarked
- how wonderfully strange it was that she should have lived
- to dine in the same room with an Englishman; for she
- remembered as a girl, that twice, at the mere cry of "Los
- Ingleses," every soul, carrying what valuables they could,
- had taken to the mountains.
-
- 14th. -- We reached Coquimbo, where we stayed a few
- days. The town is remarkable for nothing but its extreme
- quietness. It is said to contain from 6000 to 8000 inhabitants.
- On the morning of the 17th it rained lightly, the first time
- this year, for about five hours. The farmers, who plant
- corn near the sea-coast where the atmosphere is most humid,
- taking advantage of this shower, would break up the ground;
- after a second they would put the seed in; and if a third
- shower should fall, they would reap a good harvest in the
- spring. It was interesting to watch the effect of this trifling
- amount of moisture. Twelve hours afterwards the ground
- appeared as dry as ever; yet after an interval of ten days,
- all the hills were faintly tinged with green patches; the
- grass being sparingly scattered in hair-like fibres a full
- inch in length. Before this shower every part of the surface
- was bare as on a high road.
-
- In the evening, Captain Fitz Roy and myself were dining
- with Mr. Edwards, an English resident well known for his
- hospitality by all who have visited Coquimbo, when a sharp
- earthquake happened. I heard the forecoming rumble, but
- from the screams of the ladies, the running of the servants,
- and the rush of several of the gentlemen to the doorway, I
- could not distinguish the motion. Some of the women afterwards
- were crying with terror, and one gentleman said he
- should not be able to sleep all night, or if he did, it would
- only be to dream of falling houses. The father of this person
- had lately lost all his property at Talcahuano, and he
- himself had only just escaped a falling roof at Valparaiso,
- in 1822. He mentioned a curious coincidence which then
- happened: he was playing at cards, when a German, one of
- the party, got up, and said he would never sit in a room in
- these countries with the door shut, as owing to his having
- done so, he had nearly lost his life at Copiapo. Accordingly
- he opened the door; and no sooner had he done this, than he
- cried out, "Here it comes again!" and the famous shock
- commenced. The whole party escaped. The danger in an
- earthquake is not from the time lost in opening the door, but
- from the chance of its becoming jammed by the movement
- of the walls.
-
- It is impossible to be much surprised at the fear which
- natives and old residents, though some of them known to
- be men of great command of mind, so generally experience
- during earthquakes. I think, however, this excess of panic
- may be partly attributed to a want of habit in governing
- their fear, as it is not a feeling they are ashamed of. Indeed,
- the natives do not like to see a person indifferent. I
- heard of two Englishmen who, sleeping in the open air during
- a smart shock, knowing that there was no danger, did not
- rise. The natives cried out indignantly, "Look at those
- heretics, they do not even get out of their beds!"
-
-
- I spent some days in examining the step-formed terraces
- of shingle, first noticed by Captain B. Hall, and believed
- by Mr. Lyell to have been formed by the sea, during the
- gradual rising of the land. This certainly is the true
- explanation, for I found numerous shells of existing species
- on these terraces. Five narrow, gently sloping, fringe-like
- terraces rise one behind the other, and where best developed
- are formed of shingle: they front the bay, and sweep up both
- sides of the valley. At Guasco, north of Coquimbo, the
- phenomenon is displayed on a much grander scale, so as to
- strike with surprise even some of the inhabitants. The terraces
- are there much broader, and may be called plains, in
- some parts there are six of them, but generally only five;
- they run up the valley for thirty-seven miles from the coast.
- These step-formed terraces or fringes closely resemble those
- in the valley of S. Cruz, and, except in being on a smaller
- scale, those great ones along the whole coast-line of Patagonia.
- They have undoubtedly been formed by the denuding
- power of the sea, during long periods of rest in the
- gradual elevation of the continent.
-
- Shells of many existing species not only lie on the surface
- of the terraces at Coquimbo (to a height of 250 feet),
- but are embedded in a friable calcareous rock, which in some
- places is as much as between twenty and thirty feet in
- thickness, but is of little extent. These modern beds rest on an
- ancient tertiary formation containing shells, apparently all
- extinct. Although I examined so many hundred miles of
- coast on the Pacific, as well as Atlantic side of the continent,
- I found no regular strata containing sea-shells of
- recent species, excepting at this place, and at a few points
- northward on the road to Guasco. This fact appears to me
- highly remarkable; for the explanation generally given by
- geologists, of the absence in any district of stratified
- fossiliferous deposits of a given period, namely, that the
- surface then existed as dry land, is not here applicable; for we
- know from the shells strewed on the surface and embedded
- in loose sand or mould that the land for thousands of miles
- along both coasts has lately been submerged. The explanation,
- no doubt, must be sought in the fact, that the whole
- southern part of the continent has been for a long time
- slowly rising; and therefore that all matter deposited along
- shore in shallow water, must have been soon brought up
- and slowly exposed to the wearing action of the sea-beach;
- and it is only in comparatively shallow water that the greater
- number of marine organic beings can flourish, and in such
- water it is obviously impossible that strata of any great
- thickness can accumulate. To show the vast power of the
- wearing action of sea-beaches, we need only appeal to the
- great cliffs along the present coast of Patagonia, and to the
- escarpments or ancient sea-cliffs at different levels, one
- above another, on that same line of coast.
-
- The old underlying tertiary formation at Coquimbo,
- appears to be of about the same age with several deposits
- on the coast of Chile (of which that of Navedad is the
- principal one), and with the great formation of Patagonia.
- Both at Navedad and in Patagonia there is evidence, that
- since the shells (a list of which has been seen by Professor
- E. Forbes) there entombed were living, there has been a
- subsidence of several hundred feet, as well as an ensuing
- elevation. It may naturally be asked, how it comes that,
- although no extensive fossiliferous deposits of the recent
- period, nor of any period intermediate between it and the
- ancient tertiary epoch, have been preserved on either side of
- the continent, yet that at this ancient tertiary epoch,
- sedimentary matter containing fossil remains, should have been
- deposited and preserved at different points in north and
- south lines, over a space of 1100 miles on the shores of the
- Pacific, and of at least 1350 miles on the shores of the
- Atlantic, and in an east and west line of 700 miles across the
- widest part of the continent? I believe the explanation is
- not difficult, and that it is perhaps applicable to nearly
- analogous facts observed in other quarters of the world.
- Considering the enormous power of denudation which the sea
- possesses, as shown by numberless facts, it is not probable
- that a sedimentary deposit, when being upraised, could pass
- through the ordeal of the beach, so as to be preserved in
- sufficient masses to last to a distant period, without it were
- originally of wide extent and of considerable thickness: now
- it is impossible on a moderately shallow bottom, which
- alone is favourable to most living creatures, that a thick
- and widely extended covering of sediment could be spread
- out, without the bottom sank down to receive the successive
- layers. This seems to have actually taken place at about
- the same period in southern Patagonia and Chile, though
- these places are a thousand miles apart. Hence, if prolonged
- movements of approximately contemporaneous subsidence
- are generally widely extensive, as I am strongly
- inclined to believe from my examination of the Coral Reefs
- of the great oceans -- or if, confining our view to South
- America, the subsiding movements have been coextensive
- with those of elevation, by which, within the same period
- of existing shells, the shores of Peru, Chile, Tierra del
- Fuego, Patagonia, and La Plata have been upraised -- then
- we can see that at the same time, at far distant points,
- circumstances would have been favourable to the formation of
- fossiliferous deposits of wide extent and of considerable
- thickness; and such deposits, consequently, would have a
- good chance of resisting the wear and tear of successive
- beach-lines, and of lasting to a future epoch.
-
-
- May 21st. -- I set out in company with Don Jose Edwards
- to the silver-mine of Arqueros, and thence up the valley of
- Coquimbo. Passing through a mountainous country, we
- reached by nightfall the mines belonging to Mr. Edwards.
- I enjoyed my night's rest here from a reason which will not
- be fully appreciated in England, namely, the absence of
- fleas! The rooms in Coquimbo swarm with them; but they
- will not live here at the height of only three or four
- thousand feet: it can scarcely be the trifling diminution
- of temperature, but some other cause which destroys these
- troublesome insects at this place. The mines are now in a
- bad state, though they formerly yielded about 2000 pounds
- in weight of silver a year. It has been said that "a person
- with a copper-mine will gain; with silver he may gain; but
- with gold he is sure to lose." This is not true: all the large
- Chilian fortunes have been made by mines of the more
- precious metals. A short time since an English physician
- returned to England from Copiapo, taking with him the
- profits of one share of a silver-mine, which amounted to
- about 24,000 pounds sterling. No doubt a copper-mine with
- care is a sure game, whereas the other is gambling, or rather
- taking a ticket in a lottery. The owners lose great quantities
- of rich ores; for no precautions can prevent robberies.
- I heard of a gentleman laying a bet with another, that one
- of his men should rob him before his face. The ore when
- brought out of the mine is broken into pieces, and the useless
- stone thrown on one side. A couple of the miners who
- were thus employed, pitched, as if by accident, two fragments
- away at the same moment, and then cried out for a joke
- "Let us see which rolls furthest." The owner, who was
- standing by, bet a cigar with his friend on the race. The
- miner by this means watched the very point amongst the
- rubbish where the stone lay. In the evening he picked it
- up and carried it to his master, showing him a rich mass of
- silver-ore, and saying, "This was the stone on which you
- won a cigar by its rolling so far."
-
- May 23rd. -- We descended into the fertile valley of Coquimbo,
- and followed it till we reached an Hacienda belonging
- to a relation of Don Jose, where we stayed the next day.
- I then rode one day's journey further, to see what were
- declared to be some petrified shells and beans, which latter
- turned out to be small quartz pebbles. We passed through
- several small villages; and the valley was beautifully
- cultivated, and the whole scenery very grand. We were here
- near the main Cordillera, and the surrounding hills were
- lofty. In all parts of northern Chile, fruit trees produce
- much more abundantly at a considerable height near the
- Andes than in the lower country. The figs and grapes of
- this district are famous for their excellence, and are
- cultivated to a great extent. This valley is, perhaps, the most
- productive one north of Quillota. I believe it contains,
- including Coquimbo, 25,000 inhabitants. The next day I
- returned to the Hacienda, and thence, together with Don
- Jose, to Coquimbo.
-
- June 2nd. -- We set out for the valley of Guasco, following
- the coast-road, which was considered rather less desert than
- the other. Our first day's ride was to a solitary house, called
- Yerba Buena, where there was pasture for our horses. The
- shower mentioned as having fallen, a fortnight ago, only
- reached about half-way to Guasco; we had, therefore, in the
- first part of our journey a most faint tinge of green, which
- soon faded quite away. Even where brightest, it was scarcely
- sufficient to remind one of the fresh turf and budding
- flowers of the spring of other countries. While travelling
- through these deserts one feels like a prisoner shut up in
- a gloomy court, who longs to see something green and to
- smell a moist atmosphere.
-
- June 3rd. -- Yerba Buena to Carizal. During the first part
- of the day we crossed a mountainous rocky desert, and afterwards
- a long deep sandy plain, strewed with broken seashells.
- There was very little water, and that little saline:
- the whole country, from the coast to the Cordillera, is an
- uninhabited desert. I saw traces only of one living animal in
- abundance, namely, the shells of a Bulimus, which were
- collected together in extraordinary numbers on the driest
- spots. In the spring one humble little plant sends out a few
- leaves, and on these the snails feed. As they are seen only
- very early in the morning, when the ground is slightly damp
- with dew, the Guascos believe that they are bred from it. I
- have observed in other places that extremely dry and sterile
- districts, where the soil is calcareous, are extraordinarily
- favourable to land-shells. At Carizal there were a few cottages,
- some brackish water, and a trace of cultivation: but it
- was with difficulty that we purchased a little corn and straw
- for our horses.
-
- 4th. -- Carizal to Sauce. We continued to ride over desert
- plains, tenanted by large herds of guanaco. We crossed also
- the valley of Chaneral; which, although the most fertile one
- between Guasco and Coquimbo, is very narrow, and produces
- so little pasture, that we could not purchase any for our
- horses. At Sauce we found a very civil old gentleman,
- superintendent of a copper-smelting furnace. As an especial
- favour, he allowed me to purchase at a high price an armful
- of dirty straw, which was all the poor horses had for supper
- after their long day's journey. Few smelting-furnaces are
- now at work in any part of Chile; it is found more profitable,
- on account of the extreme scarcity of firewood, and from
- the Chilian method of reduction being so unskilful, to ship the
- ore for Swansea. The next day we crossed some mountains
- to Freyrina, in the valley of Guasco. During each day's ride
- further northward, the vegetation became more and more
- scanty; even the great chandelier-like cactus was here
- replaced by a different and much smaller species. During the
- winter months, both in northern Chile and in Peru, a uniform
- bank of clouds hangs, at no great height, over the Pacific.
- From the mountains we had a very striking view of this
- white and brilliant aerial-field, which sent arms up the
- valleys, leaving islands and promontories in the same manner, as
- the sea does in the Chonos archipelago and in Tierra del Fuego.
-
- We stayed two days at Freyrina. In the valley of Guasco
- there are four small towns. At the mouth there is the port, a
- spot entirely desert, and without any water in the immediate
- neighbourhood. Five leagues higher up stands Freyrina, a
- long straggling village, with decent whitewashed houses.
- Again, ten leagues further up Ballenar is situated, and above
- this Guasco Alto, a horticultural village, famous for its dried
- fruit. On a clear day the view up the valley is very fine; the
- straight opening terminates in the far-distant snowy Cordillera;
- on each side an infinity of crossing-lines are blended
- together in a beautiful haze. The foreground is singular
- from the number of parallel and step-formed terraces; and
- the included strip of green valley, with its willow-bushes, is
- contrasted on both hands with the naked hills. That the
- surrounding country was most barren will be readily believed,
- when it is known that a shower of rain had not fallen during
- the last thirteen months. The inhabitants heard with the
- greatest envy of the rain at Coquimbo; from the appearance
- of the sky they had hopes of equally good fortune, which, a
- fortnight afterwards, were realized. I was at Copiapo at the
- time; and there the people, with equal envy, talked of the
- abundant rain at Guasco. After two or three very dry years,
- perhaps with not more than one shower during the whole
- time, a rainy year generally follows; and this does more harm
- than even the drought. The rivers swell, and cover with
- gravel and sand the narrow strips of ground, which alone are
- fit for cultivation. The floods also injure the irrigating
- ditches. Great devastation had thus been caused three years
- ago.
-
- June 8th. -- We rode on to Ballenar, which takes its name
- from Ballenagh in Ireland, the birthplace of the family of
- O'Higgins, who, under the Spanish government, were presidents
- and generals in Chile. As the rocky mountains on each
- hand were concealed by clouds, the terrace-like plains gave
- to the valley an appearance like that of Santa Cruz in
- Patagonia. After spending one day at Ballenar I set out, on the
- 10th, for the upper part of the valley of Copiapo. We rode
- all day over an uninteresting country. I am tired of repeating
- the epithets barren and sterile. These words, however,
- as commonly used, are comparative; I have always applied
- them to the plains of Patagonia, which can boast of spiny
- bushes and some tufts of grass; and this is absolute fertility,
- as compared with northern Chile. Here again, there are not
- many spaces of two hundred yards square, where some little
- bush, cactus or lichen, may not be discovered by careful
- examination; and in the soil seeds lie dormant ready to
- spring up during the first rainy winter. In Peru real deserts
- occur over wide tracts of country. In the evening we
- arrived at a valley, in which the bed of the streamlet was
- damp: following it up, we came to tolerably good water.
- During the night, the stream, from not being evaporated
- and absorbed so quickly, flows a league lower down than
- during the day. Sticks were plentiful for firewood, so that
- it was a good place to bivouac for us; but for the poor animals
- there was not a mouthful to eat.
-
- June 11th. -- We rode without stopping for twelve hours
- till we reached an old smelting-furnace, where there was
- water and firewood; but our horses again had nothing to eat,
- being shut up in an old courtyard. The line of road was
- hilly, and the distant views interesting, from the varied
- colours of the bare mountains. It was almost a pity to see
- the sun shining constantly over so useless a country; such
- splendid weather ought to have brightened fields and pretty
- gardens. The next day we reached the valley of Copiapo.
- I was heartily glad of it; for the whole journey was a continued
- source of anxiety; it was most disagreeable to hear,
- whilst eating our own suppers, our horses gnawing the posts
- to which they were tied, and to have no means of relieving
- their hunger. To all appearance, however, the animals
- were quite fresh; and no one could have told that they had
- eaten nothing for the last fifty-five hours.
-
- I had a letter of introduction to Mr. Bingley, who received
- me very kindly at the Hacienda of Potrero Seco. This
- estate is between twenty and thirty miles long, but very narrow,
- being generally only two fields wide, one on each side
- the river. In some parts the estate is of no width, that is
- to say, the land cannot be irrigated, and therefore is
- valueless, like the surrounding rocky desert. The small quantity
- of cultivated land in the whole line of valley, does not so
- much depend on inequalities of level, and consequent unfitness
- for irrigation, as on the small supply of water. The
- river this year was remarkably full: here, high up the valley,
- it reached to the horse's belly, and was about fifteen yards
- wide, and rapid; lower down it becomes smaller and smaller,
- and is generally quite lost, as happened during one period
- of thirty years, so that not a drop entered the sea. The
- inhabitants watch a storm over the Cordillera with great
- interest; as one good fall of snow provides them with water
- for the ensuing year. This is of infinitely more consequence
- than rain in the lower country. Rain, as often as it falls,
- which is about once in every two or three years, is a great
- advantage, because the cattle and mules can for some time
- afterwards find a little pasture in the mountains. But without
- snow on the Andes, desolation extends throughout the
- valley. It is on record that three times nearly all the
- inhabitants have been obliged to emigrate to the south. This
- year there was plenty of water, and every man irrigated his
- ground as much as he chose; but it has frequently been
- necessary to post soldiers at the sluices, to see that each
- estate took only its proper allowance during so many hours
- in the week. The valley is said to contain 12,000 souls, but
- its produce is sufficient only for three months in the year;
- the rest of the supply being drawn from Valparaiso and the
- south. Before the discovery of the famous silver-mines of
- Chanuncillo, Copiapo was in a rapid state of decay; but now
- it is in a very thriving condition; and the town, which was
- completely overthrown by an earthquake, has been rebuilt.
-
- The valley of Copiapo, forming a mere ribbon of green
- in a desert, runs in a very southerly direction; so that it is
- of considerable length to its source in the Cordillera. The
- valleys of Guasco and Copiapo may both be considered as
- long narrow islands, separated from the rest of Chile by
- deserts of rock instead of by salt water. Northward of
- these, there is one other very miserable valley, called Paposo,
- which contains about two hundred souls; and then there
- extends the real desert of Atacama -- a barrier far worse
- than the most turbulent ocean. After staying a few days at
- Potrero Seco, I proceeded up the valley to the house of Don
- Benito Cruz, to whom I had a letter of introduction. I found
- him most hospitable; indeed it is impossible to bear too
- strong testimony to the kindness with which travellers are
- received in almost every part of South America. The next
- day I hired some mules to take me by the ravine of Jolquera
- into the central Cordillera. On the second night the
- weather seemed to foretell a storm of snow or rain, and whilst
- lying in our beds we felt a trifling shock of an earthquake.
-
- The connection between earthquakes and the weather has
- been often disputed: it appears to me to be a point of great
- interest, which is little understood. Humboldt has remarked
- in one part of the Personal Narrative, [1] that it would be
- difficult for any person who had long resided in New Andalusia,
- or in Lower Peru, to deny that there exists some connection
- between these phenomena: in another part, however
- he seems to think the connection fanciful. At Guayaquil
- it is said that a heavy shower in the dry season is invariably
- followed by an earthquake. In Northern Chile, from the
- extreme infrequency of rain, or even of weather foreboding
- rain, the probability of accidental coincidences becomes very
- small; yet the inhabitants are here most firmly convinced of
- some connection between the state of the atmosphere and of
- the trembling of the ground: I was much struck by this
- when mentioning to some people at Copiapo that there had
- been a sharp shock at Coquimbo: they immediately cried out,
- "How fortunate! there will be plenty of pasture there this
- year." To their minds an earthquake foretold rain as surely
- as rain foretold abundant pasture. Certainly it did so happen
- that on the very day of the earthquake, that shower of
- rain fell, which I have described as in ten days' time producing
- a thin sprinkling of grass. At other times rain has
- followed earthquakes at a period of the year when it is a
- far greater prodigy than the earthquake itself: this happened
- after the shock of November, 1822, and again in 1829, at
- Valparaiso; also after that of September, 1833, at Tacna.
- A person must be somewhat habituated to the climate of
- these countries to perceive the extreme improbability of rain
- falling at such seasons, except as a consequence of some law
- quite unconnected with the ordinary course of the weather.
- In the cases of great volcanic eruptions, as that of Coseguina,
- where torrents of rain fell at a time of the year most
- unusual for it, and "almost unprecedented in Central
- America," it is not difficult to understand that the volumes
- of vapour and clouds of ashes might have disturbed the
- atmospheric equilibrium. Humboldt extends this view to
- the case of earthquakes unaccompanied by eruptions; but I
- can hardly conceive it possible, that the small quantity of
- aeriform fluids which then escape from the fissured ground,
- can produce such remarkable effects. There appears much
- probability in the view first proposed by Mr. P. Scrope, that
- when the barometer is low, and when rain might naturally
- be expected to fall, the diminished pressure of the atmosphere
- over a wide extent of country, might well determine
- the precise day on which the earth, already stretched to the
- utmost by the subterranean forces, should yield, crack, and
- consequently tremble. It is, however, doubtful how far this
- idea will explain the circumstances of torrents of rain falling
- in the dry season during several days, after an earthquake
- unaccompanied by an eruption; such cases seem to
- bespeak some more intimate connection between the atmospheric
- and subterranean regions.
-
- Finding little of interest in this part of the ravine, we
- retraced our steps to the house of Don Benito, where I stayed
- two days collecting fossil shells and wood. Great prostrate
- silicified trunks of trees, embedded in a conglomerate, were
- extraordinarily numerous. I measured one, which was fifteen
- feet in circumference: how surprising it is that every
- atom of the woody matter in this great cylinder should have
- been removed and replaced by silex so perfectly, that each
- vessel and pore is preserved! These trees flourished at about
- the period of our lower chalk; they all belonged to the fir-
- tribe. It was amusing to hear the inhabitants discussing the
- nature of the fossil shells which I collected, almost in the
- same terms as were used a century ago in Europe, -- namely,
- whether or not they had been thus "born by nature." My
- geological examination of the country generally created a
- good deal of surprise amongst the Chilenos: it was long
- before they could be convinced that I was not hunting for
- mines. This was sometimes troublesome: I found the most
- ready way of explaining my employment, was to ask them
- how it was that they themselves were not curious concerning
- earthquakes and volcanos? -- why some springs were hot and
- others cold? -- why there were mountains in Chile, and not
- a hill in La Plata? These bare questions at once satisfied
- and silenced the greater number; some, however (like a few
- in England who are a century behindhand), thought that all
- such inquiries were useless and impious; and that it was
- quite sufficient that God had thus made the mountains.
-
- An order had recently been issued that all stray dogs
- should be killed, and we saw many lying dead on the road. A
- great number had lately gone mad, and several men had been
- bitten and had died in consequence. On several occasions
- hydrophobia has prevailed in this valley. It is remarkable
- thus to find so strange and dreadful a disease, appearing
- time after time in the same isolated spot. It has been
- remarked that certain villages in England are in like manner
- much more subject to this visitation than others. Dr. Unanue
- states that hydrophobia was first known in South
- America in 1803: this statement is corroborated by Azara
- and Ulloa having never heard of it in their time. Dr. Unanue
- says that it broke out in Central America, and slowly
- travelled southward. It reached Arequipa in 1807; and it is
- said that some men there, who had not been bitten, were
- affected, as were some negroes, who had eaten a bullock
- which had died of hydrophobia. At Ica forty-two people thus
- miserably perished. The disease came on between twelve
- and ninety days after the bite; and in those cases where it
- did come on, death ensued invariably within five days. After
- 1808, a long interval ensued without any cases. On inquiry,
- I did not hear of hydrophobia in Van Diemen's Land, or in
- Australia; and Burchell says, that during the five years he
- was at the Cape of Good Hope, he never heard of an instance
- of it. Webster asserts that at the Azores hydrophobia has
- never occurred; and the same assertion has been made with
- respect to Mauritius and St. Helena. [2] In so strange a disease
- some information might possibly be gained by considering
- the circumstances under which it originates in distant climates;
- for it is improbable that a dog already bitten, should
- have been brought to these distant countries.
-
- At night, a stranger arrived at the house of Don Benito,
- and asked permission to sleep there. He said he had been
- wandering about the mountains for seventeen days, having
- lost his way. He started from Guasco, and being accustomed
- to travelling in the Cordillera, did not expect any difficulty
- in following the track to Copiapo; but he soon became
- involved in a labyrinth of mountains, whence he could not
- escape. Some of his mules had fallen over precipices, and he
- had been in great distress. His chief difficulty arose from
- not knowing where to find water in the lower country, so that
- he was obliged to keep bordering the central ranges.
-
- We returned down the valley, and on the 22nd reached
- the town of Copiapo. The lower part of the valley is broad,
- forming a fine plain like that of Quillota. The town covers
- a considerable space of ground, each house possessing a garden:
- but it is an uncomfortable place, and the dwellings are
- poorly furnished. Every one seems bent on the one object
- of making money, and then migrating as quickly as possible.
- All the inhabitants are more or less directly concerned with
- mines; and mines and ores are the sole subjects of conversation.
- Necessaries of all sorts are extremely dear; as the
- distance from the town to the port is eighteen leagues, and
- the land carriage very expensive. A fowl costs five or six
- shillings; meat is nearly as dear as in England; firewood,
- or rather sticks, are brought on donkeys from a distance of
- two and three days' journey within the Cordillera; and pasturage
- for animals is a shilling a day: all this for South
- America is wonderfully exorbitant.
-
-
- June 26th. -- I hired a guide and eight mules to take me
- into the Cordillera by a different line from my last excursion.
- As the country was utterly desert, we took a cargo
- and a half of barley mixed with chopped straw. About two
- leagues above the town a broad valley called the "Despoblado,"
- or uninhabited, branches off from that one by which
- we had arrived. Although a valley of the grandest dimensions,
- and leading to a pass across the Cordillera, yet it is
- completely dry, excepting perhaps for a few days during
- some very rainy winter. The sides of the crumbling mountains
- were furrowed by scarcely any ravines; and the bottom
- of the main valley, filled with shingle, was smooth and nearly
- level. No considerable torrent could ever have flowed down
- this bed of shingle; for if it had, a great cliff-bounded
- channel, as in all the southern valleys, would assuredly have
- been formed. I feel little doubt that this valley, as well as
- those mentioned by travellers in Peru, were left in the state we
- now see them by the waves of the sea, as the land slowly rose. I
- observed in one place, where the Despoblado was joined by a
- ravine (which in almost any other chain would have been
- called a grand valley), that its bed, though composed merely
- of sand and gravel, was higher than that of its tributary.
- A mere rivulet of water, in the course of an hour, would have
- cut a channel for itself; but it was evident that ages had
- passed away, and no such rivulet had drained this great
- tributary. It was curious to behold the machinery, if such a
- term may be used, for the drainage, all, with the last trifling
- exception, perfect, yet without any signs of action. Every one
- must have remarked how mud-banks, left by the retiring tide,
- imitate in miniature a country with hill and dale; and here
- we have the original model in rock, formed as the continent
- rose during the secular retirement of the ocean, instead of
- during the ebbing and flowing of the tides. If a shower of
- rain falls on the mud-bank, when left dry, it deepens the
- already-formed shallow lines of excavation; and so it is with
- the rain of successive centuries on the bank of rock and soil,
- which we call a continent.
-
- We rode on after it was dark, till we reached a side ravine
- with a small well, called "Agua amarga." The water
- deserved its name, for besides being saline it was most
- offensively putrid and bitter; so that we could not force
- ourselves to drink either tea or mate. I suppose the distance
- from the river of Copiapo to this spot was at least twenty-five
- or thirty English miles; in the whole space there was not a
- single drop of water, the country deserving the name of desert
- in the strictest sense. Yet about half way we passed some old
- Indian ruins near Punta Gorda: I noticed also in front of
- some of the valleys, which branch off from the Despoblado,
- two piles of stones placed a little way apart, and directed so
- as to point up the mouths of these small valleys. My companions
- knew nothing about them, and only answered my
- queries by their imperturbable "quien sabe?"
-
- I observed Indian ruins in several parts of the Cordillera:
- the most perfect which I saw, were the Ruinas de Tambillos,
- in the Uspallata Pass. Small square rooms were there huddled
- together in separate groups: some of the doorways were
- yet standing; they were formed by a cross slab of stone only
- about three feet high. Ulloa has remarked on the lowness of
- the doors in the ancient Peruvian dwellings. These houses,
- when perfect, must have been capable of containing a
- considerable number of persons. Tradition says, that they were
- used as halting-places for the Incas, when they crossed the
- mountains. Traces of Indian habitations have been discovered
- in many other parts, where it does not appear probable
- that they were used as mere resting-places, but yet where
- the land is as utterly unfit for any kind of cultivation, as it
- is near the Tambillos or at the Incas Bridge, or in the Portillo
- Pass, at all which places I saw ruins. In the ravine of
- Jajuel, near Aconcagua, where there is no pass, I heard of
- remains of houses situated at a great height, where it is
- extremely cold and sterile. At first I imagined that these
- buildings had been places of refuge, built by the Indians on
- the first arrival of the Spaniards; but I have since been
- inclined to speculate on the probability of a small change of
- climate.
-
- In this northern part of Chile, within the Cordillera, old
- Indian houses are said to be especially numerous: by digging
- amongst the ruins, bits of woollen articles, instruments of
- precious metals, and heads of Indian corn, are not unfrequently
- discovered: an arrow-head made of agate, and of
- precisely the same form with those now used in Tierra del
- Fuego, was given me. I am aware that the Peruvian Indians
- now frequently inhabit most lofty and bleak situations; but
- at Copiapo I was assured by men who had spent their lives in
- travelling through the Andes, that there were very many
- (muchisimas) buildings at heights so great as almost to border
- upon the perpetual snow, and in parts where there exist
- no passes, and where the land produces absolutely nothing,
- and what is still more extraordinary, where there is no water.
- Nevertheless it is the opinion of the people of the country
- (although they are much puzzled by the circumstance), that,
- from the appearance of the houses, the Indians must have
- used them as places of residence. In this valley, at Punta
- Gorda, the remains consisted of seven or eight square little
- rooms, which were of a similar form with those at Tambillos,
- but built chiefly of mud, which the present inhabitants cannot,
- either here or, according to Ulloa, in Peru, imitate in
- durability. They were situated in the most conspicuous and
- defenceless position, at the bottom of the flat broad valley.
- There was no water nearer than three or four leagues, and
- that only in very small quantity, and bad: the soil was
- absolutely sterile; I looked in vain even for a lichen adhering
- to the rocks. At the present day, with the advantage of beasts
- of burden, a mine, unless it were very rich, could scarcely
- be worked here with profit. Yet the Indians formerly chose
- it as a place of residence! If at the present time two or
- three showers of rain were to fall annually, instead of one,
- as now is the case during as many years, a small rill of water
- would probably be formed in this great valley; and then, by
- irrigation (which was formerly so well understood by the
- Indians), the soil would easily be rendered sufficiently
- productive to support a few families.
-
- I have convincing proofs that this part of the continent of
- South America has been elevated near the coast at least from
- 400 to 500, and in some parts from 1000 to 1300 feet, since
- the epoch of existing shells; and further inland the rise
- possibly may have been greater. As the peculiarly arid character
- of the climate is evidently a consequence of the height of the
- Cordillera, we may feel almost sure that before the later
- elevations, the atmosphere could not have been so completely
- drained of its moisture as it now is; and as the rise has been
- gradual, so would have been the change in climate. On this
- notion of a change of climate since the buildings were
- inhabited, the ruins must be of extreme antiquity, but I do
- not think their preservation under the Chilian climate any
- great difficulty. We must also admit on this notion (and
- this perhaps is a greater difficulty) that man has inhabited
- South America for an immensely long period, inasmuch as
- any change of climate effected by the elevation of the land
- must have been extremely gradual. At Valparaiso, within
- the last 220 years, the rise has been somewhat less than 19
- feet: at Lima a sea-beach has certainly been upheaved from
- 80 to 90 feet, within the Indo-human period: but such small
- elevations could have had little power in deflecting the
- moisture-bringing atmospheric currents. Dr. Lund, however,
- found human skeletons in the caves of Brazil, the appearance
- of which induced him to believe that the Indian race has
- existed during a vast lapse of time in South America.
-
- When at Lima, I conversed on these subjects [3] with Mr.
- Gill, a civil engineer, who had seen much of the interior
- country. He told me that a conjecture of a change of climate
- had sometimes crossed his mind; but that he thought
- that the greater portion of land, now incapable of cultivation,
- but covered with Indian ruins, had been reduced to this state
- by the water-conduits, which the Indians formerly constructed
- on so wonderful a scale, having been injured by
- neglect and by subterranean movements. I may here mention,
- that the Peruvians actually carried their irrigating
- streams in tunnels through hills of solid rock. Mr. Gill told
- me, he had been employed professionally to examine one:
- he found the passage low, narrow, crooked, and not of uniform
- breadth, but of very considerable length. Is it not
- most wonderful that men should have attempted such operations,
- without the use of iron or gunpowder? Mr. Gill also
- mentioned to me a most interesting, and, as far as I am
- aware, quite unparalleled case, of a subterranean disturbance
- having changed the drainage of a country. Travelling from
- Casma to Huaraz (not very far distant from Lima), he
- found a plain covered with ruins and marks of ancient
- cultivation but now quite barren. Near it was the dry course of
- a considerable river, whence the water for irrigation had
- formerly been conducted. There was nothing in the appearance
- of the water-course to indicate that the river had not flowed
- there a few years previously; in some parts, beds of sand and
- gravel were spread out; in others, the solid rock had been
- worn into a broad channel, which in one spot was about 40
- yards in breadth and 8 feet deep. It is self-evident that a
- person following up the course of a stream, will always
- ascend at a greater or less inclination: Mr. Gill, therefore,
- was much astonished, when walking up the bed of this
- ancient river, to find himself suddenly going down hill. He
- imagined that the downward slope had a fall of about 40 or
- 50 feet perpendicular. We here have unequivocal evidence
- that a ridge had been uplifted right across the old bed of a
- stream. From the moment the river-course was thus arched,
- the water must necessarily have been thrown back, and a new
- channel formed. From that moment, also, the neighbouring
- plain must have lost its fertilizing stream, and become a
- desert.
-
- June 27th. -- We set out early in the morning, and by midday
- reached the ravine of Paypote, where there is a tiny rill
- of water, with a little vegetation, and even a few algarroba
- trees, a kind of mimosa. From having fire-wood, a smelting-
- furnace had formerly been built here: we found a solitary
- man in charge of it, whose sole employment was hunting
- guanacos. At night it froze sharply; but having plenty of
- wood for our fire, we kept ourselves warm.
-
- 28th. -- We continued gradually ascending, and the valley
- now changed into a ravine. During the day we saw several
- guanacos, and the track of the closely-allied species, the
- Vicuna: this latter animal is pre-eminently alpine in its
- habits; it seldom descends much below the limit of perpetual
- snow, and therefore haunts even a more lofty and sterile
- situation than the guanaco. The only other animal which we
- saw in any number was a small fox: I suppose this animal
- preys on the mice and other small rodents, which, as long as
- there is the least vegetation, subsist in considerable numbers
- in very desert places. In Patagonia, even on the borders of
- the salinas, where a drop of fresh water can never be found,
- excepting dew, these little animals swarm. Next to lizards,
- mice appear to be able to support existence on the smallest
- and driest portions of the earth -- even on islets in the midst
- of great oceans.
-
- The scene on all sides showed desolation, brightened and
- made palpable by a clear, unclouded sky. For a time such
- scenery is sublime, but this feeling cannot last, and then it
- becomes uninteresting. We bivouacked at the foot of the
- "primera linea," or the first line of the partition of waters.
- The streams, however, on the east side do not flow to the
- Atlantic, but into an elevated district, in the middle of which
- there is a large saline, or salt lake; thus forming a little
- Caspian Sea at the height, perhaps, of ten thousand feet. Where
- we slept, there were some considerable patches of snow, but
- they do not remain throughout the year. The winds in these
- lofty regions obey very regular laws every day a fresh
- breeze blows up the valley, and at night, an hour or two after
- sunset, the air from the cold regions above descends as
- through a funnel. This night it blew a gale of wind, and the
- temperature must have been considerably below the freezing-
- point, for water in a vessel soon became a block of ice. No
- clothes seemed to oppose any obstacle to the air; I suffered
- very much from the cold, so that I could not sleep, and in
- the morning rose with my body quite dull and benumbed.
-
- In the Cordillera further southward, people lose their lives
- from snowstorms; here, it sometimes happens from another
- cause. My guide, when a boy of fourteen years old, was
- passing the Cordillera with a party in the month of May;
- and while in the central parts, a furious gale of wind arose,
- so that the men could hardly cling on their mules, and stones
- were flying along the ground. The day was cloudless, and
- not a speck of snow fell, but the temperature was low. It is
- probable that the thermometer could not have stood very
- many degrees below the freezing-point, but the effect on
- their bodies, ill protected by clothing, must have been in
- proportion to the rapidity of the current of cold air. The gale
- lasted for more than a day; the men began to lose their
- strength, and the mules would not move onwards. My guide's
- brother tried to return, but he perished, and his body was
- found two years afterwards, Lying by the side of his mule
- near the road, with the bridle still in his hand. Two other
- men in the party lost their fingers and toes; and out of two
- hundred mules and thirty cows, only fourteen mules escaped
- alive. Many years ago the whole of a large party are supposed
- to have perished from a similar cause, but their bodies
- to this day have never been discovered. The union of a
- cloudless sky, low temperature, and a furious gale of wind,
- must be, I should think, in all parts of the world an unusual
- occurrence.
-
- June 29th -- We gladly travelled down the valley to our
- former night's lodging, and thence to near the Agua amarga.
- On July 1st we reached the valley of Copiapo. The smell of
- the fresh clover was quite delightful, after the scentless air
- of the dry, sterile Despoblado. Whilst staying in the town I
- heard an account from several of the inhabitants, of a hill
- in the neighbourhood which they called "El Bramador," -- the
- roarer or bellower. I did not at the time pay sufficient
- attention to the account; but, as far as I understood, the hill
- was covered by sand, and the noise was produced only when
- people, by ascending it, put the sand in motion. The same
- circumstances are described in detail on the authority of
- Seetzen and Ehrenberg, [4] as the cause of the sounds which
- have been heard by many travellers on Mount Sinai near the
- Red Sea. One person with whom I conversed had himself
- heard the noise: he described it as very surprising; and he
- distinctly stated that, although he could not understand how
- it was caused, yet it was necessary to set the sand rolling
- down the acclivity. A horse walking over dry coarse sand,
- causes a peculiar chirping noise from the friction of the
- particles; a circumstance which I several times noticed on the
- coast of Brazil.
-
- Three days afterwards I heard of the Beagle's arrival at
- the Port, distant eighteen leagues from the town. There is
- very little land cultivated down the valley; its wide expanse
- supports a wretched wiry grass, which even the donkeys can
- hardly eat. This poorness of the vegetation is owing to the
- quantity of saline matter with which the soil is impregnated.
- The Port consists of an assemblage of miserable little hovels,
- situated at the foot of a sterile plain. At present, as the
- river contains water enough to reach the sea, the inhabitants
- enjoy the advantage of having fresh water within a mile and
- a half. On the beach there were large piles of merchandise,
- and the little place had an air of activity. In the evening
- I gave my adios, with a hearty good-will, to my companion
- Mariano Gonzales, with whom I had ridden so many leagues
- in Chile. The next morning the Beagle sailed for Iquique.
-
- July 12th. -- We anchored in the port of Iquique, in lat.
- 20 degs. 12', on the coast of Peru. The town contains about a
- thousand inhabitants, and stands on a little plain of sand at
- the foot of a great wall of rock, 2000 feet in height, here
- forming the coast. The whole is utterly desert. A light
- shower of rain falls only once in very many years; and the
- ravines consequently are filled with detritus, and the
- mountain-sides covered by piles of fine white sand, even to a
- height of a thousand feet. During this season of the year a
- heavy bank of clouds, stretched over the ocean, seldom rises
- above the wall of rocks on the coast. The aspect of the place
- was most gloomy; the little port, with its few vessels, and
- small group of wretched houses, seemed overwhelmed and out of
- all proportion with the rest of the scene.
-
- The inhabitants live like persons on board a ship: every
- necessary comes from a distance: water is brought in boats
- from Pisagua, about forty miles northward, and is sold at
- the rate of nine reals (4s. 6d.) an eighteen-gallon cask: I
- bought a wine-bottle full for threepence. In like manner
- firewood, and of course every article of food, is imported.
- Very few animals can be maintained in such a place: on the
- ensuing morning I hired with difficulty, at the price of four
- pounds sterling, two mules and a guide to take me to the
- nitrate of soda works. These are at present the support of
- Iquique. This salt was first exported in 1830: in one year an
- amount in value of one hundred thousand pounds sterling,
- was sent to France and England. It is principally used as a
- manure and in the manufacture of nitric acid: owing to its
- deliquescent property it will not serve for gunpowder. Formerly
- there were two exceedingly rich silver-mines in this
- neighbourhood, but their produce is now very small.
-
- Our arrival in the offing caused some little apprehension.
- Peru was in a state of anarchy; and each party having
- demanded a contribution, the poor town of Iquique was in
- tribulation, thinking the evil hour was come. The people
- had also their domestic troubles; a short time before, three
-
- French carpenters had broken open, during the same night,
- the two churches, and stolen all the plate: one of the robbers,
- however, subsequently confessed, and the plate was recovered.
- The convicts were sent to Arequipa, which though the capital
- of this province, is two hundred leagues distant, the government
- there thought it a pity to punish such useful workmen,
- who could make all sorts of furniture; and accordingly
- liberated them. Things being in this state, the churches were
- again broken open, but this time the plate was not recovered.
- The inhabitants became dreadfully enraged, and declaring
- that none but heretics would thus "eat God Almighty," proceeded
- to torture some Englishmen, with the intention of
- afterwards shooting them. At last the authorities interfered,
- and peace was established.
-
-
- 13th. -- In the morning I started for the saltpetre-works,
- a distance of fourteen leagues. Having ascended the steep
- coast-mountains by a zigzag sandy track, we soon came in
- view of the mines of Guantajaya and St. Rosa. These two
- small villages are placed at the very mouths of the mines;
- and being perched up on hills, they had a still more unnatural
- and desolate appearance than the town of Iquique. We did
- not reach the saltpetre-works till after sunset, having ridden
- all day across an undulating country, a complete and utter
- desert. The road was strewed with the bones and dried skins
- of many beasts of burden which had perished on it from
- fatigue. Excepting the Vultur aura, which preys on the
- carcasses, I saw neither bird, quadruped, reptile, nor insect.
- On the coast-mountains, at the height of about 2000 feet
- where during this season the clouds generally hang, a very
- few cacti were growing in the clefts of rock; and the loose
- sand was strewed over with a lichen, which lies on the surface
- quite unattached. This plant belongs to the genus
- Cladonia, and somewhat resembles the reindeer lichen. In
- some parts it was in sufficient quantity to tinge the sand,
- as seen from a distance, of a pale yellowish colour. Further
- inland, during the whole ride of fourteen leagues, I saw only
- one other vegetable production, and that was a most minute
- yellow lichen, growing on the bones of the dead mules. This
- was the first true desert which I had seen: the effect on me
- was not impressive; but I believe this was owing to my
- having become gradually accustomed to such scenes, as I
- rode northward from Valparaiso, through Coquimbo, to Copiapo.
- The appearance of the country was remarkable, from
- being covered by a thick crust of common salt, and of a
- stratified saliferous alluvium, which seems to have been
- deposited as the land slowly rose above the level of the sea.
- The salt is white, very hard, and compact: it occurs in water
- worn nodules projecting from the agglutinated sand, and is
- associated with much gypsum. The appearance of this superficial
- mass very closely resembled that of a country after
- snow, before the last dirty patches are thawed. The existence
- of this crust of a soluble substance over the whole face of
- the country, shows how extraordinarily dry the climate must
- have been for a long period.
-
- At night I slept at the house of the owner of one of the
- saltpetre mines. The country is here as unproductive as
- near the coast; but water, having rather a bitter and brackish
- taste, can be procured by digging wells. The well at this
- house was thirty-six yards deep: as scarcely any rain falls,
- it is evident the water is not thus derived; indeed if it were,
- it could not fail to be as salt as brine, for the whole
- surrounding country is incrusted with various saline substances.
- We must therefore conclude that it percolates under ground
- from the Cordillera, though distant many leagues. In that
- direction there are a few small villages, where the inhabitants,
- having more water, are enabled to irrigate a little land,
- and raise hay, on which the mules and asses, employed in
- carrying the saltpetre, are fed. The nitrate of soda was now
- selling at the ship's side at fourteen shillings per hundred
- pounds: the chief expense is its transport to the sea-coast.
- The mine consists of a hard stratum, between two and three
- feet thick, of the nitrate mingled with a little of the sulphate
- of soda and a good deal of common salt. It lies close beneath
- the surface, and follows for a length of one hundred and
- fifty miles the margin of a grand basin or plain; this, from
- its outline, manifestly must once have been a lake, or more
- probably an inland arm of the sea, as may be inferred from
- the presence of iodic salts in the saline stratum. The surface
- of the plain is 3300 feet above the Pacific.
-
-
- 19th. -- We anchored in the Bay of Callao, the seaport of
- Lima, the capital of Peru. We stayed here six weeks but
- from the troubled state of public affairs, I saw very little of
- the country. During our whole visit the climate was far
- from being so delightful, as it is generally represented. A
- dull heavy bank of clouds constantly hung over the land, so
- that during the first sixteen days I had only one view of the
- Cordillera behind Lima. These mountains, seen in stages,
- one above the other, through openings in the clouds, had a
- very grand appearance. It is almost become a proverb, that
- rain never falls in the lower part of Peru. Yet this can
- hardly be considered correct; for during almost every day of
- our visit there was a thick drizzling mist, which was sufficient
- to make the streets muddy and one's clothes damp: this the
- people are pleased to call Peruvian dew. That much rain
- does not fall is very certain, for the houses are covered only
- with flat roofs made of hardened mud; and on the mole shiploads
- of wheat were piled up, being thus left for weeks together
- without any shelter.
-
- I cannot say I liked the very little I saw of Peru: in
- summer, however, it is said that the climate is much pleasanter.
- In all seasons, both inhabitants and foreigners suffer
- from severe attacks of ague. This disease is common on the
- whole coast of Peru, but is unknown in the interior. The
- attacks of illness which arise from miasma never fail to appear
- most mysterious. So difficult is it to judge from the
- aspect of a country, whether or not it is healthy, that if a
- person had been told to choose within the tropics a situation
- appearing favourable for health, very probably he would
- have named this coast. The plain round the outskirts of
- Callao is sparingly covered with a coarse grass, and in some
- parts there are a few stagnant, though very small, pools of
- water. The miasma, in all probability, arises from these:
- for the town of Arica was similarly circumstanced, and its
- healthiness was much improved by the drainage of some
- little pools. Miasma is not always produced by a luxuriant
- vegetation with an ardent climate; for many parts of Brazil,
- even where there are marshes and a rank vegetation, are
- much more healthy than this sterile coast of Peru. The
- densest forests in a temperate climate, as in Chiloe, do not
- seem in the slightest degree to affect the healthy condition
- of the atmosphere.
-
- The island of St. Jago, at the Cape de Verds, offers another
- strongly marked instance of a country, which any one
- would have expected to find most healthy, being very much
- the contrary. I have described the bare and open plains as
- supporting, during a few weeks after the rainy season, a thin
- vegetation, which directly withers away and dries up: at this
- period the air appears to become quite poisonous; both natives
- and foreigners often being affected with violent fevers.
- On the other hand, the Galapagos Archipelago, in the Pacific,
- with a similar soil, and periodically subject to the same
- process of vegetation, is perfectly healthy. Humboldt has
- observed, that, "under the torrid zone, the smallest marshes
- are the most dangerous, being surrounded, as at Vera Cruz
- and Carthagena, with an arid and sandy soil, which raises
- the temperature of the ambient air." [5] On the coast of Peru,
- however, the temperature is not hot to any excessive degree;
- and perhaps in consequence, the intermittent fevers are not
- of the most malignant order. In all unhealthy countries the
- greatest risk is run by sleeping on shore. Is this owing to
- the state of the body during sleep, or to a greater abundance
- of miasma at such times? It appears certain that those
- who stay on board a vessel, though anchored at only a short
- distance from the coast, generally suffer less than those
- actually on shore. On the other hand, I have heard of one
- remarkable case where a fever broke out among the crew of
- a man-of-war some hundred miles off the coast of Africa,
- and at the same time one of those fearful periods [6] of death
- commenced at Sierra Leone.
-
- No state in South America, since the declaration of
- independence, has suffered more from anarchy than Peru. At
- the time of our visit, there were four chiefs in arms contending
- for supremacy in the government: if one succeeded
- in becoming for a time very powerful, the others coalesced
- against him; but no sooner were they victorious, than they
- were again hostile to each other. The other day, at the
- Anniversary of the Independence, high mass was performed, the
- President partaking of the sacrament: during the _Te Deum
- laudamus_, instead of each regiment displaying the Peruvian
- flag, a black one with death's head was unfurled. Imagine
- a government under which such a scene could be ordered, on
- such an occasion, to be typical of their determination of
- fighting to death! This state of affairs happened at a time
- very unfortunately for me, as I was precluded from taking
- any excursions much beyond the limits of the town. The
- barren island of St. Lorenzo, which forms the harbour, was
- nearly the only place where one could walk securely. The
- upper part, which is upwards of 1000 feet in height, during
- this season of the year (winter), comes within the lower
- limit of the clouds; and in consequence, an abundant cryptogamic
- vegetation, and a few flowers cover the summit. On
- the hills near Lima, at a height but little greater, the ground
- is carpeted with moss, and beds of beautiful yellow lilies,
- called Amancaes. This indicates a very much greater degree
- of humidity, than at a corresponding height at Iquique.
- Proceeding northward of Lima, the climate becomes damper,
- till on the banks of the Guayaquil, nearly under the equator,
- we find the most luxuriant forests. The change, however,
- from the sterile coast of Peru to that fertile land is described
- as taking place rather abruptly in the latitude of Cape Blanco,
- two degrees south of Guayaquil.
-
- Callao is a filthy, ill-built, small seaport. The inhabitants,
- both here and at Lima, present every imaginable shade of
- mixture, between European, Negro, and Indian blood. They
- appear a depraved, drunken set of people. The atmosphere
- is loaded with foul smells, and that peculiar one, which may
- be perceived in almost every town within the tropics, was
- here very strong. The fortress, which withstood Lord Cochrane's
- long siege, has an imposing appearance. But the
- President, during our stay, sold the brass guns, and proceeded
- to dismantle parts of it. The reason assigned was,
- that he had not an officer to whom he could trust so important
- a charge. He himself had good reason for thinking
- so, as he had obtained the presidentship by rebelling while
- in charge of this same fortress. After we left South America,
- he paid the penalty in the usual manner, by being conquered,
- taken prisoner, and shot.
-
- Lima stands on a plain in a valley, formed during the
- gradual retreat of the sea. It is seven miles from Callao,
- and is elevated 500 feet above it; but from the slope being
- very gradual, the road appears absolutely level; so that when
- at Lima it is difficult to believe one has ascended even one
- hundred feet: Humboldt has remarked on this singularly deceptive
- case. Steep barren hills rise like islands from the
- plain, which is divided, by straight mud-walls, into large
- green fields. In these scarcely a tree grows excepting a few
- willows, and an occasional clump of bananas and of oranges.
- The city of Lima is now in a wretched state of decay: the
- streets are nearly unpaved; and heaps of filth are piled up
- in all directions, where the black gallinazos, tame as poultry,
- pick up bits of carrion. The houses have generally an upper
- story, built on account of the earthquakes, of plastered
- woodwork but some of the old ones, which are now used by several
- families, are immensely large, and would rival in suites
- of apartments the most magnificent in any place. Lima, the
- City of the Kings, must formerly have been a splendid town.
- The extraordinary number of churches gives it, even at the
- present day, a peculiar and striking character, especially
- when viewed from a short distance.
-
- One day I went out with some merchants to hunt in the
- immediate vicinity of the city. Our sport was very poor;
- but I had an opportunity of seeing the ruins of one of the
- ancient Indian villages, with its mound like a natural hill in
- the centre. The remains of houses, enclosures, irrigating
- streams, and burial mounds, scattered over this plain, cannot
- fail to give one a high idea of the condition and number of
- the ancient population. When their earthenware, woollen
- clothes, utensils of elegant forms cut out of the hardest rocks,
- tools of copper, ornaments of precious stones, palaces, and
- hydraulic works, are considered, it is impossible not to respect
- the considerable advance made by them in the arts of
- civilization. The burial mounds, called Huacas, are really
- stupendous; although in some places they appear to be natural
- hills incased and modelled.
-
- There is also another and very different class of ruins,
- which possesses some interest, namely, those of old Callao,
- overwhelmed by the great earthquake of 1746, and its
- accompanying wave. The destruction must have been more
- complete even than at Talcahuano. Quantities of shingle
- almost conceal the foundations of the walls, and vast masses
- of brickwork appear to have been whirled about like pebbles
- by the retiring waves. It has been stated that the land subsided
- during this memorable shock: I could not discover any
- proof of this; yet it seems far from improbable, for the
- form of the coast must certainly have undergone some change
- since the foundation of the old town; as no people in their
- senses would willingly have chosen for their building place,
- the narrow spit of shingle on which the ruins now stand.
- Since our voyage, M. Tschudi has come to the conclusion,
- by the comparison of old and modern maps, that the coast
- both north and south of Lima has certainly subsided.
-
- On the island of San Lorenzo, there are very satisfactory
- proofs of elevation within the recent period; this of course
- is not opposed to the belief, of a small sinking of the ground
- having subsequently taken place. The side of this island
- fronting the Bay of Callao, is worn into three obscure terraces,
- the lower one of which is covered by a bed a mile in
- length, almost wholly composed of shells of eighteen species,
- now living in the adjoining sea. The height of this bed is
- eighty-five feet. Many of the shells are deeply corroded, and
- have a much older and more decayed appearance than those
- at the height of 500 or 600 feet on the coast of Chile. These
- shells are associated with much common salt, a little sulphate
- of lime (both probably left by the evaporation of the
- spray, as the land slowly rose), together with sulphate of
- soda and muriate of lime. They rest on fragments of the
- underlying sandstone, and are covered by a few inches thick
- of detritus. The shells, higher up on this terrace could be
- traced scaling off in flakes, and falling into an impalpable
- powder; and on an upper terrace, at the height of 170 feet,
- and likewise at some considerably higher points, I found a
- layer of saline powder of exactly similar appearance, and
- lying in the same relative position. I have no doubt that this
- upper layer originally existed as a bed of shells, like that on
- the eighty-five-feet ledge; but it does not now contain even a
- trace of organic structure. The powder has been analyzed
- for me by Mr. T. Reeks; it consists of sulphates and muriates
- both of lime and soda, with very little carbonate of
- lime. It is known that common salt and carbonate of lime
- left in a mass for some time together, partly decompose each
- other; though this does not happen with small quantities in
- solution. As the half-decomposed shells in the lower parts
- are associated with much common salt, together with some
- of the saline substances composing the upper saline layer,
- and as these shells are corroded and decayed in a remarkable
- manner, I strongly suspect that this double decomposition
- has here taken place. The resultant salts, however, ought
- to be carbonate of soda and muriate of lime, the latter is
- present, but not the carbonate of soda. Hence I am led to
- imagine that by some unexplained means, the carbonate of
- soda becomes changed into the sulphate. It is obvious that
- the saline layer could not have been preserved in any country
- in which abundant rain occasionally fell: on the other
- hand, this very circumstance, which at first sight appears so
- highly favourable to the long preservation of exposed shells,
- has probably been the indirect means, through the common
- salt not having been washed away, of their decomposition
- and early decay.
-
- I was much interested by finding on the terrace, at the
- height of eighty-five feet, _embedded_ amidst the shells and
- much sea-drifted rubbish, some bits of cotton thread, plaited
- rush, and the head of a stalk of Indian corn: I compared
- these relics with similar ones taken out of the Huacas, or old
- Peruvian tombs, and found them identical in appearance.
- On the mainland in front of San Lorenzo, near Bellavista,
- there is an extensive and level plain about a hundred feet
- high, of which the lower part is formed of alternating layers
- of sand and impure clay, together with some gravel, and the
- surface, to the depth of from three to six feet, of a reddish
- loam, containing a few scattered sea-shells and numerous
- small fragments of coarse red earthenware, more abundant
- at certain spots than at others. At first I was inclined to
- believe that this superficial bed, from its wide extent and
- smoothness, must have been deposited beneath the sea; but
- I afterwards found in one spot, that it lay on an artificial
- floor of round stones. It seems, therefore, most probable
- that at a period when the land stood at a lower level there
- was a plain very similar to that now surrounding Callao,
- which being protected by a shingle beach, is raised but very
- little above the level of the sea. On this plain, with its
- underlying red-clay beds, I imagine that the Indians
- manufactured their earthen vessels; and that, during some
- violent earthquake, the sea broke over the beach, and converted
- the plain into a temporary lake, as happened round Callao in
- 1713 and 1746. The water would then have deposited mud,
- containing fragments of pottery from the kilns, more abundant
- at some spots than at others, and shells from the sea.
- This bed, with fossil earthenware, stands at about the
- same height with the shells on the lower terrace of San
- Lorenzo, in which the cotton-thread and other relics were
- embedded.
-
- Hence we may safely conclude, that within the Indo-human
- period there has been an elevation, as before alluded to, of
- more than eighty-five feet; for some little elevation must
- have been lost by the coast having subsided since the old
- maps were engraved. At Valparaiso, although in the 220
- years before our visit, the elevation cannot have exceeded
- nineteen feet, yet subsequently to 1817, there has been a rise,
- partly insensible and partly by a start during the shock of
- 1822, of ten or eleven feet. The antiquity of the Indo-human
- race here, judging by the eighty-five feet rise of the land
- since the relics were embedded, is the more remarkable, as on
- the coast of Patagonia, when the land stood about the same
- number of feet lower, the Macrauchenia was a living beast;
- but as the Patagonian coast is some way distant from the
- Cordillera, the rising there may have been slower than here.
- At Bahia Blanca, the elevation has been only a few feet
- since the numerous gigantic quadrupeds were there entombed;
- and, according to the generally received opinion,
- when these extinct animals were living, man did not exist.
- But the rising of that part of the coast of Patagonia, is
- perhaps no way connected with the Cordillera, but rather with
- a line of old volcanic rocks in Banda Oriental, so that it
- may have been infinitely slower than on the shores of Peru.
- All these speculations, however, must be vague; for who will
- pretend to say that there may not have been several periods
- of subsidence, intercalated between the movements of elevation;
- for we know that along the whole coast of Patagonia,
- there have certainly been many and long pauses in
- the upward action of the elevatory forces.
-
- [1] Vol. iv. p. 11, and vol. ii. p. 217. For the remarks on
- Guayaquil, see Silliman's Journ., vol. xxiv. p. 384. For those
- on Tacna by Mr. Hamilton, see Trans. of British Association,
- 1840. For those on Coseguina see Mr. Caldcleugh in Phil. Trans.,
- 1835. In the former edition I collected several references on
- the coincidences between sudden falls in the barometer and
- earthquakes; and between earthquakes and meteors.
-
- [2] Observa. sobre el Clima de Lima, p. 67. -- Azara's Travels,
- vol. i. p. 381. -- Ulloa's Voyage, vol. ii. p. 28. -- Burchell's
- Travels, vol. ii. p. 524. -- Webster's Description of the
- Azores, p. 124. -- Voyage a l'Isle de France par un Officer du
- Roi, tom. i. p. 248. -- Description of St. Helena, p. 123.
-
- [3] Temple, in his travels through Upper Peru, or Bolivia, in
- going from Potosi to Oruro, says, "I saw many Indian villages or
- dwellings in ruins, up even to the very tops of the mountains,
- attesting a former population where now all is desolate." He
- makes similar remarks in another place; but I cannot tell
- whether this desolation has been caused by a want of population,
- or by an altered condition of the land.
-
- [4] Edinburgh, Phil. Journ., Jan., 1830, p. 74; and April, 1830,
- p. 258 -- also Daubeny on Volcanoes, p. 438; and Bengal
- Journ., vol. vii. p. 324.
-
- [5] Political Essay on the Kingdom of New Spain, vol. iv.
- p. 199.
-
- [6] A similar interesting case is recorded in the Madras
- Medical Quart. Journ., 1839, p. 340. Dr. Ferguson, in his
- admirable Paper (see 9th vol. of Edinburgh Royal Trans.),
- shows clearly that the poison is generated in the drying
- process; and hence that dry hot countries are often the most
- unhealthy.
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XVII
-
- GALAPAGOS ARCHIPELAGO
-
- The whole Group Volcanic -- Numbers of Craters -- Leafless
- Bushes Colony at Charles Island -- James Island -- Salt-lake in
- Crater -- Natural History of the Group -- Ornithology, curious
- Finches -- Reptiles -- Great Tortoises, habits of -- Marine
- Lizard, feeds on Sea-weed -- Terrestrial Lizard, burrowing
- habits, herbivorous -- Importance of Reptiles in the
- Archipelago -- Fish, Shells, Insects -- Botany -- American Type
- of Organization -- Differences in the Species or Races on
- different Islands -- Tameness of the Birds -- Fear of Man, an
- acquired Instinct.
-
-
- SEPTEMBER 15th. -- This archipelago consists of ten
- principal islands, of which five exceed the others in
- size. They are situated under the Equator, and between
- five and six hundred miles westward of the coast of
- America. They are all formed of volcanic rocks; a few
- fragments of granite curiously glazed and altered by the
- heat, can hardly be considered as an exception. Some of
- the craters, surmounting the larger islands, are of immense
- size, and they rise to a height of between three and four
- thousand feet. Their flanks are studded by innumerable
- smaller orifices. I scarcely hesitate to affirm, that there
- must be in the whole archipelago at least two thousand
- craters. These consist either of lava or scoriae, or of finely-
- stratified, sandstone-like tuff. Most of the latter are
- beautifully symmetrical; they owe their origin to eruptions of
- volcanic mud without any lava: it is a remarkable circumstance
- that every one of the twenty-eight tuff-craters which
- were examined, had their southern sides either much lower
- than the other sides, or quite broken down and removed. As
- all these craters apparently have been formed when standing
- in the sea, and as the waves from the trade wind and the
- swell from the open Pacific here unite their forces on the
- southern coasts of all the islands, this singular uniformity
- in the broken state of the craters, composed of the soft and
- yielding tuff, is easily explained.
-
- Considering that these islands are placed directly under
- the equator, the climate is far from being excessively hot;
- this seems chiefly caused by the singularly low temperature
- of the surrounding water, brought here by the great southern
-
-
- [map]
-
-
- Polar current. Excepting during one short season, very
- little rain falls, and even then it is irregular; but the clouds
- generally hang low. Hence, whilst the lower parts of the
- islands are very sterile, the upper parts, at a height of a
- thousand feet and upwards, possess a damp climate and a
- tolerably luxuriant vegetation. This is especially the case
- on the windward sides of the islands, which first receive and
- condense the moisture from the atmosphere.
-
- In the morning (17th) we landed on Chatham Island,
- which, like the others, rises with a tame and rounded outline,
- broken here and there by scattered hillocks, the remains
- of former craters. Nothing could be less inviting than the
- first appearance. A broken field of black basaltic lava,
- thrown into the most rugged waves, and crossed by great
- fissures, is everywhere covered by stunted, sun-burnt brushwood,
- which shows little signs of life. The dry and parched
- surface, being heated by the noon-day sun, gave to the air
- a close and sultry feeling, like that from a stove: we fancied
- even that the bushes smelt unpleasantly. Although I diligently
- tried to collect as many plants as possible, I succeeded
- in getting very few; and such wretched-looking little
- weeds would have better become an arctic than an equatorial
- Flora. The brushwood appears, from a short distance, as
- leafless as our trees during winter; and it was some time
- before I discovered that not only almost every plant was
- now in full leaf, but that the greater number were in flower.
- The commonest bush is one of the Euphorbiaceae: an acacia
- and a great odd-looking cactus are the only trees which
- afford any shade. After the season of heavy rains, the islands
- are said to appear for a short time partially green. The
- volcanic island of Fernando Noronha, placed in many respects
- under nearly similar conditions, is the only other
- country where I have seen a vegetation at all like this of
- the Galapagos Islands.
-
- The Beagle sailed round Chatham Island, and anchored
- in several bays. One night I slept on shore on a part of the
- island, where black truncated cones were extraordinarily
- numerous: from one small eminence I counted sixty of
- them, all surmounted by craters more or less perfect. The
- greater number consisted merely of a ring of red scoriae
- or slags, cemented together: and their height above the plain
- of lava was not more than from fifty to a hundred feet; none
- had been very lately active. The entire surface of this part
- of the island seems to have been permeated, like a sieve, by
- the subterranean vapours: here and there the lava, whilst
- soft, has been blown into great bubbles; and in other parts,
- the tops of caverns similarly formed have fallen in, leaving
- circular pits with steep sides. From the regular form of the
- many craters, they gave to the country an artificial appearance,
- which vividly reminded me of those parts of Staffordshire,
- where the great iron-foundries are most numerous.
- The day was glowing hot, and the scrambling over the rough
- surface and through the intricate thickets, was very fatiguing;
- but I was well repaid by the strange Cyclopean scene.
- As I was walking along I met two large tortoises, each of
- which must have weighed at least two hundred pounds: one
- was eating a piece of cactus, and as I approached, it stared
- at me and slowly walked away; the other gave a deep hiss,
- and drew in its head. These huge reptiles, surrounded by
- the black lava, the leafless shrubs, and large cacti, seemed to
- my fancy like some antediluvian animals. The few dull-
- coloured birds cared no more for me than they did for the
- great tortoises.
-
- 23rd. -- The Beagle proceeded to Charles Island. This
- archipelago has long been frequented, first by the bucaniers,
- and latterly by whalers, but it is only within the last six
- years, that a small colony has been established here. The
- inhabitants are between two and three hundred in number;
- they are nearly all people of colour, who have been banished
- for political crimes from the Republic of the Equator, of
- which Quito is the capital. The settlement is placed about
- four and a half miles inland, and at a height probably of a
- thousand feet. In the first part of the road we passed
- through leafless thickets, as in Chatham Island. Higher up,
- the woods gradually became greener; and as soon as we
- crossed the ridge of the island, we were cooled by a fine
- southerly breeze, and our sight refreshed by a green and
- thriving vegetation. In this upper region coarse grasses and
- ferns abound; but there are no tree-ferns: I saw nowhere
- any member of the palm family, which is the more singular,
- as 360 miles northward, Cocos Island takes its name from
- the number of cocoa-nuts. The houses are irregularly scattered
- over a flat space of ground, which is cultivated with
- sweet potatoes and bananas. It will not easily be imagined
- how pleasant the sight of black mud was to us, after having
- been so long, accustomed to the parched soil of Peru and
- northern Chile. The inhabitants, although complaining of
- poverty, obtain, without much trouble, the means of subsistence.
- In the woods there are many wild pigs and goats;
- but the staple article of animal food is supplied by the
- tortoises. Their numbers have of course been greatly reduced
- in this island, but the people yet count on two days'
- hunting giving them food for the rest of the week. It is
- said that formerly single vessels have taken away as many
- as seven hundred, and that the ship's company of a frigate
- some years since brought down in one day two hundred
- tortoises to the beach.
-
- September 29th. -- We doubled the south-west extremity of
- Albemarle Island, and the next day were nearly becalmed
- between it and Narborough Island. Both are covered with
- immense deluges of black naked lava, which have flowed either
- over the rims of the great caldrons, like pitch over the
- rim of a pot in which it has been boiled, or have burst forth
- from smaller orifices on the flanks; in their descent they
- have spread over miles of the sea-coast. On both of these
- islands, eruptions are known to have taken place; and in
- Albemarle, we saw a small jet of smoke curling from the
- summit of one of the great craters. In the evening we
- anchored in Bank's Cove, in Albemarle Island. The next
- morning I went out walking. To the south of the broken
- tuff-crater, in which the Beagle was anchored, there was
- another beautifully symmetrical one of an elliptic form; its
- longer axis was a little less than a mile, and its depth about
- 500 feet. At its bottom there was a shallow lake, in the
- middle of which a tiny crater formed an islet. The day was
- overpoweringly hot, and the lake looked clear and blue: I
- hurried down the cindery slope, and, choked with dust,
- eagerly tasted the water -- but, to my sorrow, I found it salt
- as brine.
-
- The rocks on the coast abounded with great black lizards,
- between three and four feet long; and on the hills, an ugly
- yellowish-brown species was equally common. We saw many of this
- latter kind, some clumsily running out of the way, and others
- shuffling into their burrows. I shall presently describe in
- more detail the habits of both these reptiles. The whole of
- this northern part of Albemarle Island is miserably sterile.
-
- October 8th. -- We arrived at James Island: this island, as
- well as Charles Island, were long since thus named after our
- kings of the Stuart line. Mr. Bynoe, myself, and our servants
- were left here for a week, with provisions and a tent,
- whilst the Beagle went for water. We found here a party
- of Spaniards, who had been sent from Charles Island to dry
- fish, and to salt tortoise-meat. About six miles inland, and
- at the height of nearly 2000 feet, a hovel had been built in
- which two men lived, who were employed in catching tortoises,
- whilst the others were fishing on the coast. I paid
- this party two visits, and slept there one night. As in the
- other islands, the lower region was covered by nearly leafless
- bushes, but the trees were here of a larger growth than
- elsewhere, several being two feet and some even two feet nine
- inches in diameter. The upper region being kept damp by
- the clouds, supports a green and flourishing vegetation. So
- damp was the ground, that there were large beds of a coarse
- cyperus, in which great numbers of a very small water-rail
- lived and bred. While staying in this upper region, we lived
- entirely upon tortoise-meat: the breast-plate roasted (as the
- Gauchos do _carne con cuero_), with the flesh on it, is very
- good; and the young tortoises make excellent soup; but
- otherwise the meat to my taste is indifferent.
-
- One day we accompanied a party of the Spaniards in
- their whale-boat to a salina, or lake from which salt is
- procured. After landing, we had a very rough walk over a
- rugged field of recent lava, which has almost surrounded a
- tuff-crater, at the bottom of which the salt-lake lies. The
- water is only three or four inches deep, and rests on a layer
- of beautifully crystallized, white salt. The lake is quite
- circular, and is fringed with a border of bright green succulent
- plants; the almost precipitous walls of the crater are clothed
- with wood, so that the scene was altogether both picturesque
- and curious. A few years since, the sailors belonging to a
- sealing-vessel murdered their captain in this quiet spot; and
- we saw his skull lying among the bushes.
-
- During the greater part of our stay of a week, the sky
- was cloudless, and if the trade-wind failed for an hour, the
- heat became very oppressive. On two days, the thermometer
- within the tent stood for some hours at 93 degs.; but in the open
- air, in the wind and sun, at only 85 degs. The sand was extremely
- hot; the thermometer placed in some of a brown colour
- immediately rose to 137 degs., and how much above that
- it would have risen, I do not know, for it was not graduated
- any higher. The black sand felt much hotter, so that
- even in thick boots it was quite disagreeable to walk over it.
-
-
- The natural history of these islands is eminently curious,
- and well deserves attention. Most of the organic productions
- are aboriginal creations, found nowhere else; there is even
- a difference between the inhabitants of the different islands;
- yet all show a marked relationship with those of America,
- though separated from that continent by an open space of
- ocean, between 500 and 600 miles in width. The archipelago
- is a little world within itself, or rather a satellite attached
- to America, whence it has derived a few stray colonists, and
- has received the general character of its indigenous
- productions. Considering the small size of the islands, we feel
- the more astonished at the number of their aboriginal beings,
- and at their confined range. Seeing every height crowned
- with its crater, and the boundaries of most of the lava-
- streams still distinct, we are led to believe that within a
- period geologically recent the unbroken ocean was here
- spread out. Hence, both in space and time, we seem to be
- brought somewhat near to that great fact -- that mystery of
- mysteries -- the first appearance of new beings on this earth.
-
- Of terrestrial mammals, there is only one which must be
- considered as indigenous, namely, a mouse (Mus Galapagoensis),
- and this is confined, as far as I could ascertain, to
- Chatham Island, the most easterly island of the group. It
- belongs, as I am informed by Mr. Waterhouse, to a division
- of the family of mice characteristic of America. At James
- Island, there is a rat sufficiently distinct from the common
- kind to have been named and described by Mr. Waterhouse;
- but as it belongs to the old-world division of the family, and
- as this island has been frequented by ships for the last hundred
- and fifty years, I can hardly doubt that this rat is
- merely a variety produced by the new and peculiar climate,
- food, and soil, to which it has been subjected. Although no
- one has a right to speculate without distinct facts, yet even
- with respect to the Chatham Island mouse, it should be borne
- in mind, that it may possibly be an American species imported
- here; for I have seen, in a most unfrequented part of
- the Pampas, a native mouse living in the roof of a newly
- built hovel, and therefore its transportation in a vessel is
- not improbable: analogous facts have been observed by Dr.
- Richardson in North America.
-
- Of land-birds I obtained twenty-six kinds, all peculiar to
- the group and found nowhere else, with the exception of one
- lark-like finch from North America (Dolichonyx oryzivorus),
- which ranges on that continent as far north as 54 degs., and
- generally frequents marshes. The other twenty-five birds
- consist, firstly, of a hawk, curiously intermediate in structure
- between a buzzard and the American group of carrion-feeding
- Polybori; and with these latter birds it agrees most
- closely in every habit and even tone of voice. Secondly,
- there are two owls, representing the short-eared and white
- barn-owls of Europe. Thirdly, a wren, three tyrant-flycatchers
- (two of them species of Pyrocephalus, one or both of
- which would be ranked by some ornithologists as only varieties),
- and a dove -- all analogous to, but distinct from, American
- species. Fourthly, a swallow, which though differing
- from the Progne purpurea of both Americas, only in being
- rather duller colored, smaller, and slenderer, is considered
- by Mr. Gould as specifically distinct. Fifthly, there are three
- species of mocking thrush -- a form highly characteristic of
- America. The remaining land-birds form a most singular
- group of finches, related to each other in the structure of
- their beaks, short tails, form of body and plumage: there are
- thirteen species, which Mr. Gould has divided into four
- subgroups. All these species are peculiar to this archipelago;
- and so is the whole group, with the exception of one species
- of the sub-group Cactornis, lately brought from Bow Island,
- in the Low Archipelago. Of Cactornis, the two species may
- be often seen climbing about the flowers of the great cactus-
- trees; but all the other species of this group of finches,
- mingled together in flocks, feed on the dry and sterile ground
- of the lower districts. The males of all, or certainly of the
- greater number, are jet black; and the females (with perhaps
- one or two exceptions) are brown. The most curious fact is
- the perfect gradation in the size of the beaks in the different
- species of Geospiza, from one as large as that of a hawfinch
- to that of a chaffinch, and (if Mr. Gould is right in including
- his sub-group, Certhidea, in the main group) even to
- that of a warbler. The largest beak in the genus Geospiza
- is shown in Fig. 1, and the smallest in Fig. 3; but instead of
- there being only one intermediate species, with a beak of
- the size shown in Fig. 2, there are no less than six species
- with insensibly graduated beaks. The beak of the sub-group
- Certhidea, is shown in Fig. 4. The beak of Cactornis is
-
-
- [picture]
-
- 1. Geospiza magnirostris. 2. Geospiza fortis.
- 3. Geospiza parvula. 4. Certhidea olivasea.
-
-
- somewhat like that of a starling, and that of the fourth
- subgroup, Camarhynchus, is slightly parrot-shaped. Seeing this
- gradation and diversity of structure in one small, intimately
- related group of birds, one might really fancy that from an
- original paucity of birds in this archipelago, one species had
- been taken and modified for different ends. In a like manner
- it might be fancied that a bird originally a buzzard, had been
- induced here to undertake the office of the carrion-feeding
- Polybori of the American continent.
-
- Of waders and water-birds I was able to get only eleven
- kinds, and of these only three (including a rail confined to
- the damp summits of the islands) are new species. Considering
- the wandering habits of the gulls, I was surprised to
- find that the species inhabiting these islands is peculiar, but
- allied to one from the southern parts of South America.
- The far greater peculiarity of the land-birds, namely,
- twenty-five out of twenty-six, being new species, or at least
- new races, compared with the waders and web-footed birds, is
- in accordance with the greater range which these latter
- orders have in all parts of the world. We shall hereafter
- see this law of aquatic forms, whether marine or freshwater,
- being less peculiar at any given point of the earth's
- surface than the terrestrial forms of the same classes,
- strikingly illustrated in the shells, and in a lesser degree in
- the insects of this archipelago.
-
- Two of the waders are rather smaller than the same species
- brought from other places: the swallow is also smaller,
- though it is doubtful whether or not it is distinct from its
- analogue. The two owls, the two tyrant-catchers (Pyrocephalus)
- and the dove, are also smaller than the analogous
- but distinct species, to which they are most nearly related;
- on the other hand, the gull is rather larger. The two owls,
- the swallow, all three species of mocking-thrush, the dove
- in its separate colours though not in its whole plumage, the
- Totanus, and the gull, are likewise duskier coloured than
- their analogous species; and in the case of the mocking-
- thrush and Totanus, than any other species of the two genera.
- With the exception of a wren with a fine yellow breast,
- and of a tyrant-flycatcher with a scarlet tuft and breast, none
- of the birds are brilliantly coloured, as might have been
- expected in an equatorial district. Hence it would appear
- probable, that the same causes which here make the immigrants
- of some peculiar species smaller, make most of the
- peculiar Galapageian species also smaller, as well as very
- generally more dusky coloured. All the plants have a
- wretched, weedy appearance, and I did not see one beautiful
- flower. The insects, again, are small-sized and dull-coloured,
- and, as Mr. Waterhouse informs me, there is nothing in their
- general appearance which would have led him to imagine
- that they had come from under the equator. [1] The birds,
- plants, and insects have a desert character, and are not more
- brilliantly coloured than those from southern Patagonia; we
- may, therefore, conclude that the usual gaudy colouring of
- the inter-tropical productions, is not related either to the
- heat or light of those zones, but to some other cause, perhaps
- to the conditions of existence being generally favourable
- to life.
-
-
- We will now turn to the order of reptiles, which gives
- the most striking character to the zoology of these islands.
- The species are not numerous, but the numbers of individuals
- of each species are extraordinarily great. There is one
- small lizard belonging to a South American genus, and two
- species (and probably more) of the Amblyrhynchus -- a genus
- confined to the Galapagos Islands. There is one snake which
- is numerous; it is identical, as I am informed by M. Bibron,
- with the Psammophis Temminckii from Chile. [2] Of sea-
- turtle I believe there are more than one species, and of
- tortoises there are, as we shall presently show, two or three
- species or races. Of toads and frogs there are none: I was
- surprised at this, considering how well suited for them the
- temperate and damp upper woods appeared to be. It recalled
- to my mind the remark made by Bory St. Vincent, [3]
- namely, that none of this family are found on any of the
- volcanic islands in the great oceans. As far as I can ascertain
- from various works, this seems to hold good throughout the
- Pacific, and even in the large islands of the Sandwich
- archipelago. Mauritius offers an apparent exception, where I
- saw the Rana Mascariensis in abundance: this frog is said
- now to inhabit the Seychelles, Madagascar, and Bourbon;
- but on the other hand, Du Bois, in his voyage in 1669, states
- that there were no reptiles in Bourbon except tortoises; and
- the Officier du Roi asserts that before 1768 it had been
- attempted, without success, to introduce frogs into Mauritius
- -- I presume for the purpose of eating: hence it may be well
- doubted whether this frog is an aboriginal of these islands.
- The absence of the frog family in the oceanic islands is the
- more remarkable, when contrasted with the case of lizards,
- which swarm on most of the smallest islands. May this difference
- not be caused, by the greater facility with which the
- eggs of lizards, protected by calcareous shells might be
- transported through salt-water, than could the slimy spawn
- of frogs?
-
- I will first describe the habits of the tortoise (Testudo
- nigra, formerly called Indica), which has been so frequently
- alluded to. These animals are found, I believe, on all the
- islands of the archipelago; certainly on the greater number.
- They frequent in preference the high damp parts, but they
- likewise live in the lower and arid districts. I have already
- shown, from the numbers which have been caught in a single
- day, how very numerous they must be. Some grow to an
- immense size: Mr. Lawson, an Englishman, and vice-governor
- of the colony, told us that he had seen several so large,
- that it required six or eight men to lift them from the
- ground; and that some had afforded as much as two hundred
- pounds of meat. The old males are the largest, the females
- rarely growing to so great a size: the male can readily be
- distinguished from the female by the greater length of its
- tail. The tortoises which live on those islands where there
- is no water, or in the lower and arid parts of the others, feed
- chiefly on the succulent cactus. Those which frequent the
- higher and damp regions, eat the leaves of various trees, a
- kind of berry (called guayavita) which is acid and austere,
- and likewise a pale green filamentous lichen (Usnera plicata),
- that hangs from the boughs of the trees.
-
- The tortoise is very fond of water, drinking large quantities,
- and wallowing in the mud. The larger islands alone
- possess springs, and these are always situated towards the
- central parts, and at a considerable height. The tortoises,
- therefore, which frequent the lower districts, when thirsty,
- are obliged to travel from a long distance. Hence broad and
- well-beaten paths branch off in every direction from the
- wells down to the sea-coast; and the Spaniards by following
- them up, first discovered the watering-places. When I landed
- at Chatham Island, I could not imagine what animal travelled
- so methodically along well-chosen tracks. Near the springs
- it was a curious spectacle to behold many of these huge
- creatures, one set eagerly travelling onwards with outstretched
- necks, and another set returning, after having
- drunk their fill. When the tortoise arrives at the spring,
- quite regardless of any spectator, he buries his head in the
- water above his eyes, and greedily swallows great mouthfuls,
- at the rate of about ten in a minute. The inhabitants say
- each animal stays three or four days in the neighbourhood
- of the water, and then returns to the lower country; but
- they differed respecting the frequency of these visits. The
- animal probably regulates them according to the nature of
- the food on which it has lived. It is, however, certain, that
- tortoises can subsist even on these islands where there is no
- other water than what falls during a few rainy days in the
- year.
-
- I believe it is well ascertained, that the bladder of the frog
- acts as a reservoir for the moisture necessary to its existence:
- such seems to be the case with the tortoise. For some
- time after a visit to the springs, their urinary bladders are
- distended with fluid, which is said gradually to decrease in
- volume, and to become less pure. The inhabitants, when
- walking in the lower district, and overcome with thirst, often
- take advantage of this circumstance, and drink the contents
- of the bladder if full: in one I saw killed, the fluid was quite
- limpid, and had only a very slightly bitter taste. The
- inhabitants, however, always first drink the water in the
- pericardium, which is described as being best.
-
- The tortoises, when purposely moving towards any point,
- travel by night and day, and arrive at their journey's end
- much sooner than would be expected. The inhabitants, from
- observing marked individuals, consider that they travel a
- distance of about eight miles in two or three days. One large
- tortoise, which I watched, walked at the rate of sixty yards
- in ten minutes, that is 360 yards in the hour, or four miles a
- day, -- allowing a little time for it to eat on the road. During
- the breeding season, when the male and female are together,
- the male utters a hoarse roar or bellowing, which, it is said,
- can be heard at the distance of more than a hundred yards.
- The female never uses her voice, and the male only at these
- times; so that when the people hear this noise, they know
- that the two are together. They were at this time (October)
- laying their eggs. The female, where the soil is sandy, deposits
- them together, and covers them up with sand; but
- where the ground is rocky she drops them indiscriminately
- in any hole: Mr. Bynoe found seven placed in a fissure. The
- egg is white and spherical; one which I measured was seven
- inches and three-eighths in circumference, and therefore
- larger than a hen's egg. The young tortoises, as soon as they
- are hatched, fall a prey in great numbers to the carrion-
- feeding buzzard. The old ones seem generally to die from
- accidents, as from falling down precipices: at least, several
- of the inhabitants told me, that they never found one dead
- without some evident cause.
-
- The inhabitants believe that these animals are absolutely
- deaf; certainly they do not overhear a person walking close
- behind them. I was always amused when overtaking one of
- these great monsters, as it was quietly pacing along, to see
- how suddenly, the instant I passed, it would draw in its head
- and legs, and uttering a deep hiss fall to the ground with a
- heavy sound, as if struck dead. I frequently got on their
- backs, and then giving a few raps on the hinder part of their
- shells, they would rise up and walk away; -- but I found it
- very difficult to keep my balance. The flesh of this animal is
- largely employed, both fresh and salted; and a beautifully
- clear oil is prepared from the fat. When a tortoise is caught,
- the man makes a slit in the skin near its tail, so as to see
- inside its body, whether the fat under the dorsal plate is
- thick. If it is not, the animal is liberated and it is said to
- recover soon from this strange operation. In order to secure
- the tortoise, it is not sufficient to turn them like turtle, for
- they are often able to get on their legs again.
-
- There can be little doubt that this tortoise is an aboriginal
- inhabitant of the Galapagos; for it is found on all, or nearly
- all, the islands, even on some of the smaller ones where there
- is no water; had it been an imported species, this would
- hardly have been the case in a group which has been so little
- frequented. Moreover, the old Bucaniers found this tortoise
- in greater numbers even than at present: Wood and Rogers
- also, in 1708, say that it is the opinion of the Spaniards, that
- it is found nowhere else in this quarter of the world. It is
- now widely distributed; but it may be questioned whether
- it is in any other place an aboriginal. The bones of a tortoise
- at Mauritius, associated with those of the extinct Dodo,
- have generally been considered as belonging to this tortoise;
- if this had been so, undoubtedly it must have been there
- indigenous; but M. Bibron informs me that he believes that
- it was distinct, as the species now living there certainly is.
-
- The Amblyrhynchus, a remarkable genus of lizards, is confined
- to this archipelago; there are two species, resembling
-
- [picture]
-
- each other in general form, one being terrestrial and the
- other aquatic. This latter species (A. cristatus) was first
- characterized by Mr. Bell, who well foresaw, from its short,
- broad head, and strong claws of equal length, that its habits
- of life would turn out very peculiar, and different from those
- of its nearest ally, the Iguana. It is extremely common on all
- the islands throughout the group, and lives exclusively on the
- rocky sea-beaches, being never found, at least I never saw
- one, even ten yards in-shore. It is a hideous-looking creature,
- of a dirty black colour, stupid, and sluggish in its movements.
- The usual length of a full-grown one is about a yard,
- but there are some even four feet long; a large one weighed
- twenty pounds: on the island of Albemarle they seem to
- grow to a greater size than elsewhere. Their tails are flattened
- sideways, and all four feet partially webbed. They are
- occasionally seen some hundred yards from the shore,
- swimming about; and Captain Collnett, in his Voyage says,
- "They go to sea in herds a-fishing, and sun themselves on
- the rocks; and may be called alligators in miniature." It
- must not, however, be supposed that they live on fish. When
- in the water this lizard swims with perfect ease and quickness,
- by a serpentine movement of its body and flattened tail
- -- the legs being motionless and closely collapsed on its sides.
- A seaman on board sank one, with a heavy weight attached
- to it, thinking thus to kill it directly; but when, an hour
- afterwards, he drew up the line, it was quite active. Their
- limbs and strong claws are admirably adapted for crawling over
- the rugged and fissured masses of lava, which everywhere form
- the coast. In such situations, a group of six or seven of
- these hideous reptiles may oftentimes be seen on the black
- rocks, a few feet above the surf, basking in the sun with
- outstretched legs.
-
- I opened the stomachs of several, and found them largely
- distended with minced sea-weed (Ulvae), which grows in
- thin foliaceous expansions of a bright green or a dull red
- colour. I do not recollect having observed this sea-weed in
- any quantity on the tidal rocks; and I have reason to believe
- it grows at the bottom of the sea, at some little distance from
- the coast. If such be the case, the object of these animals
- occasionally going out to sea is explained. The stomach
- contained nothing but the sea-weed. Mr. Baynoe, however, found
- a piece of crab in one; but this might have got in accidentally,
- in the same manner as I have seen a caterpillar, in
- the midst of some lichen, in the paunch of a tortoise. The
- intestines were large, as in other herbivorous animals. The
- nature of this lizard's food, as well as the structure of its
- tail and feet, and the fact of its having been seen voluntarily
- swimming out at sea, absolutely prove its aquatic habits;
- yet there is in this respect one strange anomaly, namely, that
- when frightened it will not enter the water. Hence it is
- easy to drive these lizards down to any little point overhanging
- the sea, where they will sooner allow a person to catch
- hold of their tails than jump into the water. They do not
- seem to have any notion of biting; but when much frightened
- they squirt a drop of fluid from each nostril. I threw one
- several times as far as I could, into a deep pool left by the
- retiring tide; but it invariably returned in a direct line to
- the spot where I stood. It swam near the bottom, with a
- very graceful and rapid movement, and occasionally aided
- itself over the uneven ground with its feet. As soon as it
- arrived near the edge, but still being under water, it tried to
- conceal itself in the tufts of sea-weed, or it entered some
- crevice. As soon as it thought the danger was past, it
- crawled out on the dry rocks, and shuffled away as quickly
- as it could. I several times caught this same lizard, by driving
- it down to a point, and though possessed of such perfect
- powers of diving and swimming, nothing would induce it to
- enter the water; and as often as I threw it in, it returned in
- the manner above described. Perhaps this singular piece of
- apparent stupidity may be accounted for by the circumstance,
- that this reptile has no enemy whatever on shore,
- whereas at sea it must often fall a prey to the numerous
- sharks. Hence, probably, urged by a fixed and hereditary
- instinct that the shore is its place of safety, whatever the
- emergency may be, it there takes refuge.
-
- During our visit (in October), I saw extremely few small
- individuals of this species, and none I should think under
- a year old. From this circumstance it seems probable that
- the breeding season had not then commenced. I asked several
- of the inhabitants if they knew where it laid its eggs:
- they said that they knew nothing of its propagation, although
- well acquainted with the eggs of the land kind -- a fact,
- considering how very common this lizard is, not a little
- extraordinary.
-
- We will now turn to the terrestrial species (A. Demarlii),
- with a round tail, and toes without webs. This lizard,
- instead of being found like the other on all the islands, is
- confined to the central part of the archipelago, namely to
- Albemarle, James, Barrington, and Indefatigable islands. To
- the southward, in Charles, Hood, and Chatham islands, and
- to the northward, in Towers, Bindloes, and Abingdon, I
- neither saw nor heard of any. It would appear as if it had
- been created in the centre of the archipelago, and thence had
- been dispersed only to a certain distance. Some of these
- lizards inhabit the high and damp parts of the islands, but
- they are much more numerous in the lower and sterile
- districts near the coast. I cannot give a more forcible proof
- of their numbers, than by stating that when we were left at
- James Island, we could not for some time find a spot free
- from their burrows on which to pitch our single tent. Like
- their brothers the sea-kind, they are ugly animals, of a
- yellowish orange beneath, and of a brownish red colour above:
- from their low facial angle they have a singularly stupid
- appearance. They are, perhaps, of a rather less size than the
- marine species; but several of them weighed between ten and
- fifteen pounds. In their movements they are lazy and half
- torpid. When not frightened, they slowly crawl along with
- their tails and bellies dragging on the ground. They often
- stop, and doze for a minute or two, with closed eyes and hind
- legs spread out on the parched soil.
-
- They inhabit burrows, which they sometimes make between
- fragments of lava, but more generally on level patches of the
- soft sandstone-like tuff. The holes do not appear to be very
- deep, and they enter the ground at a small angle; so that
- when walking over these lizard-warrens, the soil is constantly
- giving way, much to the annoyance of the tired walker. This
- animal, when making its burrow, works alternately the opposite
- sides of its body. One front leg for a short time
- scratches up the soil, and throws it towards the hind foot,
- which is well placed so as to heave it beyond the mouth of
- the hole. That side of the body being tired, the other takes
- up the task, and so on alternately. I watched one for a long
- time, till half its body was buried; I then walked up and pulled
- it by the tail, at this it was greatly astonished, and soon
- shuffled up to see what was the matter; and then stared me
- in the face, as much as to say, "What made you pull my
- tail?"
-
- They feed by day, and do not wander far from their burrows;
- if frightened, they rush to them with a most awkward
- gait. Except when running down hill, they cannot move
- very fast, apparently from the lateral position of their legs.
- They are not at all timorous: when attentively watching any
- one, they curl their tails, and, raising themselves on their
- front legs, nod their heads vertically, with a quick movement,
- and try to look very fierce; but in reality they are not at all
- so: if one just stamps on the ground, down go their tails,
- and off they shuffle as quickly as they can. I have frequently
- observed small fly-eating lizards, when watching anything,
- nod their heads in precisely the same manner; but I do not
- at all know for what purpose. If this Amblyrhynchus is held
- and plagued with a stick, it will bite it very severely; but
- I caught many by the tail, and they never tried to bite me.
- If two are placed on the ground and held together, they will
- fight, and bite each other till blood is drawn.
-
- The individuals, and they are the greater number, which
- inhabit the lower country, can scarcely taste a drop of water
- throughout the year; but they consume much of the succulent
- cactus, the branches of which are occasionally broken off
- by the wind. I several times threw a piece to two or three
- of them when together; and it was amusing enough to see
- them trying to seize and carry it away in their mouths, like
- so many hungry dogs with a bone. They eat very deliberately,
- but do not chew their food. The little birds are aware
- how harmless these creatures are: I have seen one of the
- thick-billed finches picking at one end of a piece of cactus
- (which is much relished by all the animals of the lower
- region), whilst a lizard was eating at the other end; and
- afterwards the little bird with the utmost indifference hopped
- on the back of the reptile.
-
- I opened the stomachs of several, and found them full of
- vegetable fibres and leaves of different trees, especially of
- an acacia. In the upper region they live chiefly on the acid
- and astringent berries of the guayavita, under which trees
- I have seen these lizards and the huge tortoises feeding
- together. To obtain the acacia-leaves they crawl up the low
- stunted trees; and it is not uncommon to see a pair quietly
- browsing, whilst seated on a branch several feet above the
- ground. These lizards, when cooked, yield a white meat,
- which is liked by those whose stomachs soar above all
- prejudices.
-
- Humboldt has remarked that in intertropical South
- America, all lizards which inhabit dry regions are esteemed
- delicacies for the table. The inhabitants state that those
- which inhabit the upper damp parts drink water, but that
- the others do not, like the tortoises, travel up for it from
- the lower sterile country. At the time of our visit, the
- females had within their bodies numerous, large, elongated
- eggs, which they lay in their burrows: the inhabitants seek
- them for food.
-
- These two species of Amblyrhynchus agree, as I have
- already stated, in their general structure, and in many of
- their habits. Neither have that rapid movement, so
- characteristic of the genera Lacerta and Iguana. They are both
- herbivorous, although the kind of vegetation on which they
- feed is so very different. Mr. Bell has given the name to the
- genus from the shortness of the snout: indeed, the form of
- the mouth may almost be compared to that of the tortoise:
- one is led to suppose that this is an adaptation to their
- herbivorous appetites. It is very interesting thus to find a
- well-characterized genus, having its marine and terrestrial
- species, belonging to so confined a portion of the world. The
- aquatic species is by far the most remarkable, because it is
- the only existing lizard which lives on marine vegetable
- productions. As I at first observed, these islands are not so
- remarkable for the number of the species of reptiles, as for
- that of the individuals, when we remember the well-beaten
- paths made by the thousands of huge tortoises -- the many
- turtles -- the great warrens of the terrestrial Amblyrhynchus
- -- and the groups of the marine species basking on the coast-
- rocks of every island -- we must admit that there is no other
- quarter of the world where this Order replaces the herbivorous
- mammalia in so extraordinary a manner. The geologist
- on hearing this will probably refer back in his mind to the
- Secondary epochs, when lizards, some herbivorous, some
- carnivorous, and of dimensions comparable only with our
- existing whales, swarmed on the land and in the sea. It is,
- therefore, worthy of his observation, that this archipelago,
- instead of possessing a humid climate and rank vegetation,
- cannot be considered otherwise than extremely arid, and, for
- an equatorial region, remarkably temperate.
-
- To finish with the zoology: the fifteen kinds of sea-fish
- which I procured here are all new species; they belong to
- twelve genera, all widely distributed, with the exception of
- Prionotus, of which the four previously known species live
- on the eastern side of America. Of land-shells I collected
- sixteen kinds (and two marked varieties, of which, with the
- exception of one Helix found at Tahiti, all are peculiar to
- this archipelago: a single fresh-water shell (Paludina) is
- common to Tahiti and Van Diemen's Land. Mr. Cuming,
- before our voyage procured here ninety species of sea-shells,
- and this does not include several species not yet specifically
- examined, of Trochus, Turbo, Monodonta, and Nassa. He
- has been kind enough to give me the following interesting
- results: Of the ninety shells, no less than forty-seven are
- unknown elsewhere -- a wonderful fact, considering how
- widely distributed sea-shells generally are. Of the forty-
- three shells found in other parts of the world, twenty-five
- inhabit the western coast of America, and of these eight are
- distinguishable as varieties; the remaining eighteen (including
- one variety) were found by Mr. Cuming in the Low
- Archipelago, and some of them also at the Philippines. This
- fact of shells from islands in the central parts of the Pacific
- occurring here, deserves notice, for not one single sea-shell is
- known to be common to the islands of that ocean and to the
- west coast of America. The space of open sea running north
- and south off the west coast, separates two quite distinct
- conchological provinces; but at the Galapagos Archipelago
- we have a halting-place, where many new forms have been
- created, and whither these two great conchological provinces
- have each sent up several colonists. The American province
- has also sent here representative species; for there is a
- Galapageian species of Monoceros, a genus only found on the
- west coast of America; and there are Galapageian species
- of Fissurella and Cancellaria, genera common on the west
- coast, but not found (as I am informed by Mr. Cuming) in
- the central islands of the Pacific. On the other hand, there
- are Galapageian species of Oniscia and Stylifer, genera common
- to the West Indies and to the Chinese and Indian seas,
- but not found either on the west coast of America or in the
- central Pacific. I may here add, that after the comparison
- by Messrs. Cuming and Hinds of about 2000 shells from
- the eastern and western coasts of America, only one single
- shell was found in common, namely, the Purpura patula,
- which inhabits the West Indies, the coast of Panama,
- and the Galapagos. We have, therefore, in this quarter
- of the world, three great conchological sea-provinces, quite
- distinct, though surprisingly near each other, being separated
- by long north and south spaces either of land or of
- open sea.
-
- I took great pains in collecting the insects, but excepting
- Tierra del Fuego, I never saw in this respect so poor a country.
- Even in the upper and damp region I procured very few,
- excepting some minute Diptera and Hymenoptera, mostly of
- common mundane forms. As before remarked, the insects,
- for a tropical region, are of very small size and dull colours.
- Of beetles I collected twenty-five species (excluding a
- Dermestes and Corynetes imported, wherever a ship touches);
- of these, two belong to the Harpalidae, two to the
- Hydrophilidae, nine to three families of the Heteromera, and the
- remaining twelve to as many different families. This
- circumstance of insects (and I may add plants), where few in
- number, belonging to many different families, is, I believe,
- very general. Mr. Waterhouse, who has published [4] an
- account of the insects of this archipelago, and to whom I am
- indebted for the above details, informs me that there are
- several new genera: and that of the genera not new, one
- or two are American, and the rest of mundane distribution.
- With the exception of a wood-feeding Apate, and of one or
- probably two water-beetles from the American continent,
- all the species appear to be new.
-
- The botany of this group is fully as interesting as the
- zoology. Dr. J. Hooker will soon publish in the "Linnean
- Transactions" a full account of the Flora, and I am much
- indebted to him for the following details. Of flowering
- plants there are, as far as at present is known, 185 species,
- and 40 cryptogamic species, making altogether 225; of this
- number I was fortunate enough to bring home 193. Of the
- flowering plants, 100 are new species, and are probably confined
- to this archipelago. Dr. Hooker conceives that, of the
- plants not so confined, at least 10 species found near the
- cultivated ground at Charles Island, have been imported.
- It is, I think, surprising that more American species have
- not been introduced naturally, considering that the distance
- is only between 500 and 600 miles from the continent, and
- that (according to Collnet, p. 58) drift-wood, bamboos, canes,
- and the nuts of a palm, are often washed on the south-eastern
- shores. The proportion of 100 flowering plants out of 183
- (or 175 excluding the imported weeds) being new, is sufficient,
- I conceive, to make the Galapagos Archipelago a distinct
- botanical province; but this Flora is not nearly so
- peculiar as that of St. Helena, nor, as I am informed by
- Dr. Hooker, of Juan Fernandez. The peculiarity of the
- Galapageian Flora is best shown in certain families; -- thus
- there are 21 species of Compositae, of which 20 are peculiar
- to this archipelago; these belong to twelve genera, and of
- these genera no less than ten are confined to the archipelago!
- Dr. Hooker informs me that the Flora has an undoubtedly
- Western American character; nor can he detect in it any
- affinity with that of the Pacific. If, therefore, we except the
- eighteen marine, the one fresh-water, and one land-shell,
- which have apparently come here as colonists from the
- central islands of the Pacific, and likewise the one distinct
- Pacific species of the Galapageian group of finches, we see
- that this archipelago, though standing in the Pacific Ocean,
- is zoologically part of America.
-
- If this character were owing merely to immigrants from
- America, there would be little remarkable in it; but we see
- that a vast majority of all the land animals, and that more
- than half of the flowering plants, are aboriginal productions
- It was most striking to be surrounded by new birds, new
- reptiles, new shells, new insects, new plants, and yet by
- innumerable trifling details of structure, and even by the tones
- of voice and plumage of the birds, to have the temperate plains
- of Patagonia, or rather the hot dry deserts of Northern Chile,
- vividly brought before my eyes. Why, on these small points
- of land, which within a late geological period must have
- been covered by the ocean, which are formed by basaltic lava,
- and therefore differ in geological character from the American
- continent, and which are placed under a peculiar climate,
- -- why were their aboriginal inhabitants, associated, I may
- add, in different proportions both in kind and number from
- those on the continent, and therefore acting on each other
- in a different manner -- why were they created on American
- types of organization? It is probable that the islands of the
- Cape de Verd group resemble, in all their physical conditions,
- far more closely the Galapagos Islands, than these latter
- physically resemble the coast of America, yet the aboriginal
- inhabitants of the two groups are totally unlike; those of the
- Cape de Verd Islands bearing the impress of Africa, as
- the inhabitants of the Galapagos Archipelago are stamped
- with that of America
-
-
- I have not as yet noticed by far the most remarkable feature
- in the natural history of this archipelago; it is, that
- the different islands to a considerable extent are inhabited by
- a different set of beings. My attention was first called to
- this fact by the Vice-Governor, Mr. Lawson, declaring that
- the tortoises differed from the different islands, and that he
- could with certainty tell from which island any one was
- brought. I did not for some time pay sufficient attention
- to this statement, and I had already partially mingled together
- the collections from two of the islands. I never
- dreamed that islands, about 50 or 60 miles apart, and most of
- them in sight of each other, formed of precisely the same
- rocks, placed under a quite similar climate, rising to a nearly
- equal height, would have been differently tenanted; but we
- shall soon see that this is the case. It is the fate of most
- voyagers, no sooner to discover what is most interesting in
- any locality, than they are hurried from it; but I ought,
- perhaps, to be thankful that I obtained sufficient materials to
- establish this most remarkable fact in the distribution of
- organic beings.
-
- The inhabitants, as I have said, state that they can distinguish
- the tortoises from the different islands; and that
- they differ not only in size, but in other characters. Captain
- Porter has described [5] those from Charles and from the nearest
- island to it, namely, Hood Island, as having their shells
- in front thick and turned up like a Spanish saddle, whilst
- the tortoises from James Island are rounder, blacker, and
- have a better taste when cooked. M. Bibron, moreover,
- informs me that he has seen what he considers two distinct
- species of tortoise from the Galapagos, but he does not know
- from which islands. The specimens that I brought from
- three islands were young ones: and probably owing to this
- cause neither Mr. Gray nor myself could find in them any
- specific differences. I have remarked that the marine
- Amblyrhynchus was larger at Albemarle Island than elsewhere;
- and M. Bibron informs me that he has seen two distinct
- aquatic species of this genus; so that the different
- islands probably have their representative species or races
- of the Amblyrhynchus, as well as of the tortoise. My attention
- was first thoroughly aroused, by comparing together
- the numerous specimens, shot by myself and several other
- parties on board, of the mocking-thrushes, when, to my
- astonishment, I discovered that all those from Charles Island
- belonged to one species (Mimus trifasciatus) all from
- Albemarle Island to M. parvulus; and all from James and
- Chatham Islands (between which two other islands are situated,
- as connecting links) belonged to M. melanotis. These
- two latter species are closely allied, and would by some
- ornithologists be considered as only well-marked races or
- varieties; but the Mimus trifasciatus is very distinct.
- Unfortunately most of the specimens of the finch tribe were
- mingled together; but I have strong reasons to suspect that
- some of the species of the sub-group Geospiza are confined
- to separate islands. If the different islands have their
- representatives of Geospiza, it may help to explain the
- singularly large number of the species of this sub-group in this
- one small archipelago, and as a probable consequence of their
- numbers, the perfectly graduated series in the size of their
- beaks. Two species of the sub-group Cactornis, and two of
- the Camarhynchus, were procured in the archipelago; and
- of the numerous specimens of these two sub-groups shot by
- four collectors at James Island, all were found to belong to
- one species of each; whereas the numerous specimens shot
- either on Chatham or Charles Island (for the two sets were
- mingled together) all belonged to the two other species:
- hence we may feel almost sure that these islands possess
- their respective species of these two sub-groups. In land-
- shells this law of distribution does not appear to hold good.
- In my very small collection of insects, Mr. Waterhouse
- remarks, that of those which were ticketed with their locality,
- not one was common to any two of the islands.
-
- If we now turn to the Flora, we shall find the aboriginal
- plants of the different islands wonderfully different. I give
- all the following results on the high authority of my friend
- Dr. J. Hooker. I may premise that I indiscriminately collected
- everything in flower on the different islands, and fortunately
- kept my collections separate. Too much confidence,
- however, must not be placed in the proportional results, as
- the small collections brought home by some other naturalists
- though in some respects confirming the results, plainly show
- that much remains to be done in the botany of this group:
- the Leguminosae, moreover, has as yet been only approximately
- worked out: --
-
- ----------------------------------------------------------------
- Number of
- Species
- confined
- to the
- Number of Number of Galapagos
- species species Number Archipelago
- Total found in confined confined but found
- Name Number other to the to the on more
- of of parts of Galapagos one than the
- Island Species the world Archipelago island one island
- ----------------------------------------------------------------
- James 71 33 38 30 8
- Albemarle 4 18 26 22 4
- Chatham 32 16 16 12 4
- Charles 68 39 29 21 8
- (or 29, if
- the probably
- imported
- plants be
- subtracted.)
- ----------------------------------------------------------------
-
- Hence we have the truly wonderful fact, that in James
- Island, of the thirty-eight Galapageian plants, or those found
- in no other part of the world, thirty are exclusively confined
- to this one island; and in Albemarle Island, of the twenty-
- six aboriginal Galapageian plants, twenty-two are confined
- to this one island, that is, only four are at present known to
- grow in the other islands of the archipelago; and so on, as
- shown in the above table, with the plants from Chatham and
- Charles Islands. This fact will, perhaps, be rendered even
- more striking, by giving a few illustrations: -- thus, Scalesia,
- a remarkable arborescent genus of the Compositae, is confined
- to the archipelago: it has six species: one from Chatham,
- one from Albemarle, one from Charles Island, two from
- James Island, and the sixth from one of the three latter
- islands, but it is not known from which: not one of these six
- species grows on any two islands. Again, Euphorbia, a mundane
- or widely distributed genus, has here eight species, of
- which seven are confined to the archipelago, and not one
- found on any two islands: Acalypha and Borreria, both mundane
- genera, have respectively six and seven species, none
- of which have the same species on two islands, with the
- exception of one Borreria, which does occur on two islands.
- The species of the Compositae are particularly local; and Dr.
- Hooker has furnished me with several other most striking
- illustrations of the difference of the species on the different
- islands. He remarks that this law of distribution holds good
- both with those genera confined to the archipelago, and those
- distributed in other quarters of the world: in like manner
- we have seen that the different islands have their proper
- species of the mundane genus of tortoise, and of the widely
- distributed American genus of the mocking-thrush, as well
- as of two of the Galapageian sub-groups of finches, and
- almost certainly of the Galapageian genus Amblyrhynchus.
-
- The distribution of the tenants of this archipelago would
- not be nearly so wonderful, if, for instance, one island had
- a mocking-thrush, and a second island some other quite distinct
- genus, -- if one island had its genus of lizard, and a
- second island another distinct genus, or none whatever; -- or
- if the different islands were inhabited, not by representative
- species of the same genera of plants, but by totally different
- genera, as does to a certain extent hold good: for, to give
- one instance, a large berry-bearing tree at James Island has
- no representative species in Charles Island. But it is the
- circumstance, that several of the islands possess their own
- species of the tortoise, mocking-thrush, finches, and numerous
- plants, these species having the same general habits,
- occupying analogous situations, and obviously filling the
- same place in the natural economy of this archipelago, that
- strikes me with wonder. It may be suspected that some of
- these representative species, at least in the case of the
- tortoise and of some of the birds, may hereafter prove to be
- only well-marked races; but this would be of equally great
- interest to the philosophical naturalist. I have said that most
- of the islands are in sight of each other: I may specify that
- Charles Island is fifty miles from the nearest part of Chatham
- Island, and thirty-three miles from the nearest part of
- Albemarle Island. Chatham Island is sixty miles from the
- nearest part of James Island, but there are two intermediate
- islands between them which were not visited by me. James
- Island is only ten miles from the nearest part of Albemarle
- Island, but the two points where the collections were made
- are thirty-two miles apart. I must repeat, that neither the
- nature of the soil, nor height of the land, nor the climate,
- nor the general character of the associated beings, and
- therefore their action one on another, can differ much in the
- different islands. If there be any sensible difference in their
- climates, it must be between the Windward group (namely,
- Charles and Chatham Islands), and that to leeward; but
- there seems to be no corresponding difference in the productions
- of these two halves of the archipelago.
-
- The only light which I can throw on this remarkable difference
- in the inhabitants of the different islands, is, that
- very strong currents of the sea running in a westerly and
- W.N.W. direction must separate, as far as transportal by the
- sea is concerned, the southern islands from the northern
- ones; and between these northern islands a strong N.W. current
- was observed, which must effectually separate James
- and Albemarle Islands. As the archipelago is free to a
- most remarkable degree from gales of wind, neither the
- birds, insects, nor lighter seeds, would be blown from island
- to island. And lastly, the profound depth of the ocean between
- the islands, and their apparently recent (in a geological
- sense) volcanic origin, render it highly unlikely that they
- were ever united; and this, probably, is a far more important
- consideration than any other, with respect to the geographical
- distribution of their inhabitants. Reviewing the facts
- here given, one is astonished at the amount of creative force,
- if such an expression may be used, displayed on these small,
- barren, and rocky islands; and still more so, at its diverse
- yet analogous action on points so near each other. I have
- said that the Galapagos Archipelago might be called a satellite
- attached to America, but it should rather be called a
- group of satellites, physically similar, organically distinct,
- yet intimately related to each other, and all related in a
- marked, though much lesser degree, to the great American
- continent.
-
- I will conclude my description of the natural history of
- these islands, by giving an account of the extreme tameness
- of the birds.
-
- This disposition is common to all the terrestrial species;
- namely, to the mocking-thrushes, the finches, wrens, tyrant-
- flycatchers, the dove, and carrion-buzzard. All of them are
- often approached sufficiently near to be killed with a switch,
- and sometimes, as I myself tried, with a cap or hat. A gun
- is here almost superfluous; for with the muzzle I pushed a
- hawk off the branch of a tree. One day, whilst lying down,
- a mocking-thrush alighted on the edge of a pitcher, made of
- the shell of a tortoise, which I held in my hand, and began
- very quietly to sip the water; it allowed me to lift it from
- the ground whilst seated on the vessel: I often tried, and
- very nearly succeeded, in catching these birds by their legs.
- Formerly the birds appear to have been even tamer than at
- present. Cowley (in the year 1684) says that the "Turtledoves
- were so tame, that they would often alight on our hats
- and arms, so as that we could take them alive, they not fearing
- man, until such time as some of our company did fire at
- them, whereby they were rendered more shy." Dampier
- also, in the same year, says that a man in a morning's walk
- might kill six or seven dozen of these doves. At present,
- although certainly very tame, they do not alight on people's
- arms, nor do they suffer themselves to be killed in such large
- numbers. It is surprising that they have not become wilder;
- for these islands during the last hundred and fifty years have
- been frequently visited by bucaniers and whalers; and the
- sailors, wandering through the wood in search of tortoises,
- always take cruel delight in knocking down the little birds.
- These birds, although now still more persecuted, do not
- readily become wild. In Charles Island, which had then
- been colonized about six years, I saw a boy sitting by a well
- with a switch in his hand, with which he killed the doves
- and finches as they came to drink. He had already procured
- a little heap of them for his dinner, and he said that he had
- constantly been in the habit of waiting by this well for the
- same purpose. It would appear that the birds of this
- archipelago, not having as yet learnt that man is a more
- dangerous animal than the tortoise or the Amblyrhynchus,
- disregard him, in the same manner as in England shy birds, such
- as magpies, disregard the cows and horses grazing in our fields.
-
- The Falkland Islands offer a second instance of birds
- with a similar disposition. The extraordinary tameness of
- the little Opetiorhynchus has been remarked by Pernety,
- Lesson, and other voyagers. It is not, however, peculiar to
- that bird: the Polyborus, snipe, upland and lowland goose,
- thrush, bunting, and even some true hawks, are all more or
- less tame. As the birds are so tame there, where foxes,
- hawks, and owls occur, we may infer that the absence of all
- rapacious animals at the Galapagos, is not the cause of their
- tameness here. The upland geese at the Falklands show, by
- the precaution they take in building on the islets, that they
- are aware of their danger from the foxes; but they are not
- by this rendered wild towards man. This tameness of the
- birds, especially of the waterfowl, is strongly contrasted with
- the habits of the same species in Tierra del Fuego, where for
- ages past they have been persecuted by the wild inhabitants.
- In the Falklands, the sportsman may sometimes kill more
- of the upland geese in one day than he can carry home;
- whereas in Tierra del Fuego it is nearly as difficult to kill
- one, as it is in England to shoot the common wild goose.
-
- In the time of Pernety (1763), all the birds there appear
- to have been much tamer than at present; he states that the
- Opetiorhynchus would almost perch on his finger; and that
- with a wand he killed ten in half an hour. At that period
- the birds must have been about as tame as they now are at
- the Galapagos. They appear to have learnt caution more
- slowly at these latter islands than at the Falklands, where
- they have had proportionate means of experience; for besides
- frequent visits from vessels, those islands have been at
- intervals colonized during the entire period. Even formerly,
- when all the birds were so tame, it was impossible by Pernety's
- account to kill the black-necked swan -- a bird of
- passage, which probably brought with it the wisdom learnt
- in foreign countries.
-
- I may add that, according to Du Bois, all the birds at
- Bourbon in 1571-72, with the exception of the flamingoes
- and geese, were so extremely tame, that they could be caught
- by the hand, or killed in any number with a stick. Again,
- at Tristan d'Acunha in the Atlantic, Carmichael [6] states that
- the only two land-birds, a thrush and a bunting, were "so
- tame as to suffer themselves to be caught with a hand-net."
- From these several facts we may, I think, conclude, first, that
- the wildness of birds with regard to man, is a particular
- instinct directed against _him_, and not dependent upon any
- general degree of caution arising from other sources of
- danger; secondly, that it is not acquired by individual birds
- in a short time, even when much persecuted; but that in the
- course of successive generations it becomes hereditary. With
- domesticated animals we are accustomed to see new mental
- habits or instincts acquired or rendered hereditary; but with
- animals in a state of nature, it must always be most difficult
- to discover instances of acquired hereditary knowledge. In
- regard to the wildness of birds towards man, there is no way
- of accounting for it, except as an inherited habit:
- comparatively few young birds, in any one year, have been
- injured by man in England, yet almost all, even nestlings, are
- afraid of him; many individuals, on the other hand, both at the
- Galapagos and at the Falklands, have been pursued and
- injured by man, yet have not learned a salutary dread of
- him. We may infer from these facts, what havoc the introduction
- of any new beast of prey must cause in a country,
- before the instincts of the indigenous inhabitants have
- become adapted to the stranger's craft or power.
-
- [1] The progress of research has shown that some of these birds,
- which were then thought to be confined to the islands, occur on
- the American continent. The eminent ornithologist, Mr. Sclater,
- informs me that this is the case with the Strix punctatissima
- and Pyrocephalus nanus; and probably with the Otus Galapagoensis
- and Zenaida Galapagoensis: so that the number of endemic birds
- is reduced to twenty-three, or probably to twenty-one. Mr.
- Sclater thinks that one or two of these endemic forms should be
- ranked rather as varieties than species, which always seemed to
- me probable.
-
- [2] This is stated by Dr. Gunther (Zoolog. Soc. Jan 24th,
- 1859) to be a peculiar species, not known to inhabit any other
- country.
-
- [3] Voyage aux Quatre Iles d'Afrique. With respect to the
- Sandwich Islands, see Tyerman and Bennett's Journal, vol. i.
- p. 434. For Mauritius, see Voyage par un Officier, etc.,
- part i. p. 170. There are no frogs in the Canary Islands
- (Webb et Berthelot, Hist. Nat. des Iles Canaries). I saw
- none at St. Jago in the Cape de Verds. There are none at
- St. Helena.
-
- [4] Ann. and Mag. of Nat. Hist., vol. xvi. p. 19.
-
- [5] Voyage in the U. S. ship Essex, vol. i. p. 215.
-
- [6] Linn. Trans., vol. xii. p. 496. The most anomalous fact on
- this subject which I have met with is the wildness of the small
- birds in the Arctic parts of North America (as described by
- Richardson, Fauna Bor., vol. ii. p. 332), where they are said
- never to be persecuted. This case is the more strange, because
- it is asserted that some of the same species in their winter-
- quarters in the United States are tame. There is much, as Dr.
- Richardson well remarks, utterly inexplicable connected with the
- different degrees of shyness and care with which birds conceal
- their nests. How strange it is that the English wood-pigeon,
- generally so wild a bird, should very frequently rear its young
- in shrubberies close to houses!
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XVIII
-
- TAHITI AND NEW ZEALAND
-
- Pass through the Low Archipelago -- Tahiti -- Aspect --
- Vegetation on the Mountains -- View of Eimeo -- Excursion into
- the Interior -- Profound Ravines -- Succession of Waterfalls --
- Number of wild useful Plants -- Temperance of the Inhabitants --
- Their moral state -- Parliament convened -- New Zealand -- Bay
- of Islands -- Hippahs -- Excursion to Waimate -- Missionary
- Establishment -- English Weeds now run wild -- Waiomio --
- Funeral of a New Zealand Woman -- Sail for Australia.
-
-
- OCTOBER 20th. -- The survey of the Galapagos Archipelago
- being concluded, we steered towards Tahiti
- and commenced our long passage of 3200 miles. In
- the course of a few days we sailed out of the gloomy and
- clouded ocean-district which extends during the winter far
- from the coast of South America. We then enjoyed bright
- and clear weather, while running pleasantly along at the
- rate of 150 or 160 miles a day before the steady trade-wind.
- The temperature in this more central part of the Pacific is
- higher than near the American shore. The thermometer in
- the poop cabin, by night and day, ranged between 80 and
- 83 degs., which feels very pleasant; but with one degree or two
- higher, the heat becomes oppressive. We passed through
- the Low or Dangerous Archipelago, and saw several of
- those most curious rings of coral land, just rising above the
- water's edge, which have been called Lagoon Islands. A
- long and brilliantly white beach is capped by a margin of
- green vegetation; and the strip, looking either way, rapidly
- narrows away in the distance, and sinks beneath the horizon
- From the mast-head a wide expanse of smooth water can be
- seen within the ring. These low hollow coral islands bear
- no proportion to the vast ocean out of which they abruptly
- rise; and it seems wonderful, that such weak invaders are
- not overwhelmed, by the all-powerful and never-tiring waves
- of that great sea, miscalled the Pacific.
-
- November 15th. -- At daylight, Tahiti, an island which
- must for ever remain classical to the voyager in the South
- Sea, was in view. At a distance the appearance was not
- attractive. The luxuriant vegetation of the lower part could
- not yet be seen, and as the clouds rolled past, the wildest
- and most precipitous peaks showed themselves towards the
- centre of the island. As soon as we anchored in Matavai
- Bay, we were surrounded by canoes. This was our Sunday,
- but the Monday of Tahiti: if the case had been reversed,
- we should not have received a single visit; for the injunction
- not to launch a canoe on the sabbath is rigidly obeyed.
- After dinner we landed to enjoy all the delights produced
- by the first impressions of a new country, and that country
- the charming Tahiti. A crowd of men, women, and children,
- was collected on the memorable Point Venus, ready to
- receive us with laughing, merry faces. They marshalled
- us towards the house of Mr. Wilson, the missionary of the
- district, who met us on the road, and gave us a very friendly
- reception. After sitting a very short time in his house, we
- separated to walk about, but returned there in the evening.
-
- The land capable of cultivation, is scarcely in any part
- more than a fringe of low alluvial soil, accumulated round
- the base of the mountains, and protected from the waves of
- the sea by a coral reef, which encircles the entire line of
- coast. Within the reef there is an expanse of smooth water,
- like that of a lake, where the canoes of the natives can ply
- with safety and where ships anchor. The low land which
- comes down to the beach of coral-sand, is covered by the
- most beautiful productions of the intertropical regions. In
- the midst of bananas, orange, cocoa-nut, and bread-fruit
- trees, spots are cleared where yams, sweet potatoes, and
- sugar-cane, and pine-apples are cultivated. Even the brush-wood
- is an imported fruit-tree, namely, the guava, which
- from its abundance has become as noxious as a weed. In
- Brazil I have often admired the varied beauty of the
- bananas, palms, and orange-trees contrasted together; and
- here we also have the bread-fruit, conspicuous from its large,
- glossy, and deeply digitated leaf. It is admirable to behold
- groves of a tree, sending forth its branches with the vigour
- of an English oak, loaded with large and most nutritious
- fruit. However seldom the usefulness of an object can
- account for the pleasure of beholding it, in the case of these
- beautiful woods, the knowledge of their high productiveness
- no doubt enters largely into the feeling of admiration. The
- little winding paths, cool from the surrounding shade, led
- to the scattered houses; the owners of which everywhere
- gave us a cheerful and most hospitable reception.
-
- I was pleased with nothing so much as with the inhabitants.
- There is a mildness in the expression of their countenances
- which at once banishes the idea of a savage; and
- intelligence which shows that they are advancing in
- civilization. The common people, when working, keep the upper
- part of their bodies quite naked; and it is then that the
- Tahitians are seen to advantage. They are very tall, broad-
- shouldered, athletic, and well-proportioned. It has been
- remarked, that it requires little habit to make a dark skin
- more pleasing and natural to the eye of an European than
- his own colour. A white man bathing by the side of a
- Tahitian, was like a plant bleached by the gardener's art
- compared with a fine dark green one growing vigorously in
- the open fields. Most of the men are tattooed, and the ornaments
- follow the curvature of the body so gracefully, that
- they have a very elegant effect. One common pattern, varying
- in its details, is somewhat like the crown of a palm-tree.
- It springs from the central line of the back, and gracefully
- curls round both sides. The simile may be a fanciful one,
- but I thought the body of a man thus ornamented was like
- the trunk of a, noble tree embraced by a delicate creeper.
-
- Many of the elder people had their feet covered with
- small figures, so placed as to resemble a sock. This fashion,
- however, is partly gone by, and has been succeeded by others.
- Here, although fashion is far from immutable, every one
- must abide by that prevailing in his youth. An old man
- has thus his age for ever stamped on his body, and he cannot
- assume the airs of a young dandy. The women are tattooed
- in the same manner as the men, and very commonly on their
- fingers. One unbecoming fashion is now almost universal:
- namely, shaving the hair from the upper part of the head,
- in a circular form, so as to leave only an outer ring. The
- missionaries have tried to persuade the people to change this
- habit; but it is the fashion, and that is a sufficient answer
- at Tahiti, as well as at Paris. I was much disappointed in
- the personal appearance of the women: they are far inferior
- in every respect to the men. The custom of wearing a white
- or scarlet flower in the back of the head, or through a small
- hole in each ear, is pretty. A crown of woven cocoa-nut
- leaves is also worn as a shade for the eyes. The women
- appear to be in greater want of some becoming costume even
- than the men.
-
- Nearly all the natives understand a little English -- that is,
- they know the names of common things; and by the aid of
- this, together with signs, a lame sort of conversation could
- be carried on. In returning in the evening to the boat, we
- stopped to witness a very pretty scene. Numbers of children
- were playing on the beach, and had lighted bonfires
- which illumined the placid sea and surrounding trees;
- others, in circles, were singing Tahitian verses. We seated
- ourselves on the sand, and joined their party. The songs
- were impromptu, and I believe related to our arrival: one
- little girl sang a line, which the rest took up in parts,
- forming a very pretty chorus. The whole scene made us
- unequivocally aware that we were seated on the shores of an
- island in the far-famed South Sea.
-
- 17th. -- This day is reckoned in the log-book as Tuesday
- the 17th, instead of Monday the 16th, owing to our, so far,
- successful chase of the sun. Before breakfast the ship was
- hemmed in by a flotilla of canoes; and when the natives
- were allowed to come on board, I suppose there could not
- have been less than two hundred. It was the opinion of
- every one that it would have been difficult to have picked out
- an equal number from any other nation, who would have
- given so little trouble. Everybody brought something for
- sale: shells were the main articles of trade. The Tahitians
- now fully understand the value of money, and prefer it to
- old clothes or other articles. The various coins, however, of
- English and Spanish denomination puzzle them, and they
- never seemed to think the small silver quite secure until
- changed into dollars. Some of the chiefs have accumulated
- considerable sums of money. One chief, not long since,
- offered 800 dollars (about 160 pounds sterling) for a small
- vessel; and frequently they purchase whale-boats and horses at
- the rate of from 50 to 100 dollars.
-
- After breakfast I went on shore, and ascended the nearest
- slope to a height of between two and three thousand feet.
- The outer mountains are smooth and conical, but steep; and
- the old volcanic rocks, of which they are formed, have been
- cut through by many profound ravines, diverging from the
- central broken parts of the island to the coast. Having
- crossed the narrow low girt of inhabited and fertile land,
- I followed a smooth steep ridge between two of the deep
- ravines. The vegetation was singular, consisting almost
- exclusively of small dwarf ferns, mingled higher up, with
- coarse grass; it was not very dissimilar from that on some
- of the Welsh hills, and this so close above the orchard of
- tropical plants on the coast was very surprising. At the
- highest point, which I reached, trees again appeared. Of
- the three zones of comparative luxuriance, the lower one
- owes its moisture, and therefore fertility, to its flatness;
- for, being scarcely raised above the level of the sea, the water
- from the higher land drains away slowly. The intermediate
- zone does not, like the upper one, reach into a damp and
- cloudy atmosphere, and therefore remains sterile. The
- woods in the upper zone are very pretty, tree-ferns replacing
- the cocoa-nuts on the coast. It must not, however, be
- supposed that these woods at all equal in splendour the
- forests of Brazil. The vast numbers of productions, which
- characterize a continent, cannot be expected to occur in
- an island.
-
- From the highest point which I attained, there was a good
- view of the distant island of Eimeo, dependent on the same
- sovereign with Tahiti. On the lofty and broken pinnacles,
- white massive clouds were piled up, which formed an island
- in the blue sky, as Eimeo itself did in the blue ocean. The
- island, with the exception of one small gateway, is completely
- encircled by a reef. At this distance, a narrow but well-
- defined brilliantly white line was alone visible, where the
- waves first encountered the wall of coral. The mountains
- rose abruptly out of the glassy expanse of the lagoon, included
- within this narrow white line, outside which the heaving
- waters of the ocean were dark-coloured. The view was
- striking: it may aptly be compared to a framed engraving,
- where the frame represents the breakers, the marginal paper
- the smooth lagoon, and the drawing the island itself. When
- in the evening I descended from the mountain, a man, whom
- I had pleased with a trifling gift, met me, bringing with him
- hot roasted bananas, a pine-apple, and cocoa-nuts. After
- walking under a burning sun, I do not know anything more
- delicious than the milk of a young cocoa-nut. Pine-apples
- are here so abundant that the people eat them in the same
- wasteful manner as we might turnips. They are of an excellent
- flavor -- perhaps even better than those cultivated in
- England; and this I believe is the highest compliment which
- can be paid to any fruit. Before going on board, Mr. Wilson
- interpreted for me to the Tahitian who had paid me so adroit
- an attention, that I wanted him and another man to accompany
- me on a short excursion into the mountains.
-
- 18th. -- In the morning I came on shore early, bringing
- with me some provisions in a bag, and two blankets for myself
- and servant. These were lashed to each end of a long
- pole, which was alternately carried by my Tahitian companions
- on their shoulders. These men are accustomed thus
- to carry, for a whole day, as much as fifty pounds at each
- end of their poles. I told my guides to provide themselves
- with food and clothing; but they said that there was plenty
- of food in the mountains, and for clothing, that their skins
- were sufficient. Our line of march was the valley of Tiaauru,
- down which a river flows into the sea by Point Venus.
- This is one of the principal streams in the island, and its
- source lies at the base of the loftiest central pinnacles,
- which rise to a height of about 7000 feet. The whole island
- is so mountainous that the only way to penetrate into the
- interior is to follow up the valleys. Our road, at first, lay
- through woods which bordered each side of the river; and
- the glimpses of the lofty central peaks, seen as through an
- avenue, with here and there a waving cocoa-nut tree on one
- side, were extremely picturesque. The valley soon began to
- narrow, and the sides to grow lofty and more precipitous.
- After having walked between three and four hours, we
- found the width of the ravine scarcely exceeded that of the
- bed of the stream. On each hand the walls were nearly vertical,
- yet from the soft nature of the volcanic strata, trees
- and a rank vegetation sprung from every projecting ledge.
- These precipices must have been some thousand feet high;
- and the whole formed a mountain gorge far more magnificent
- than anything which I had ever before beheld. Until
- the midday sun stood vertically over the ravine, the air felt
- cool and damp, but now it became very sultry. Shaded by a
- ledge of rock, beneath a facade of columnar lava, we ate our
- dinner. My guides had already procured a dish of small
- fish and fresh-water prawns. They carried with them a
- small net stretched on a hoop; and where the water was
- deep and in eddies, they dived, and like otters, with their
- eyes open followed the fish into holes and corners, and thus
- caught them.
-
- The Tahitians have the dexterity of amphibious animals
- in the water. An anecdote mentioned by Ellis shows how
- much they feel at home in this element. When a horse was
- landing for Pomarre in 1817, the slings broke, and it fell
- into the water; immediately the natives jumped overboard,
- and by their cries and vain efforts at assistance almost
- drowned it. As soon, however, as it reached the shore, the
- whole population took to flight, and tried to hide themselves
- from the man-carrying pig, as they christened the horse.
-
- A little higher up, the river divided itself into three little
- streams. The two northern ones were impracticable, owing
- to a succession of waterfalls which descended from the
- jagged summit of the highest mountain; the other to all
- appearance was equally inaccessible, but we managed to ascend
- it by a most extraordinary road. The sides of the
- valley were here nearly precipitous, but, as frequently happens
- with stratified rocks, small ledges projected, which were
- thickly covered by wild bananas, lilaceous plants, and other
- luxuriant productions of the tropics. The Tahitians, by
- climbing amongst these ledges, searching for fruit, had
- discovered a track by which the whole precipice could be scaled.
- The first ascent from the valley was very dangerous; for it
- was necessary to pass a steeply inclined face of naked rock,
- by the aid of ropes which we brought with us. How any
- person discovered that this formidable spot was the only
- point where the side of the mountain was practicable, I cannot
- imagine. We then cautiously walked along one of the
- ledges till we came to one of the three streams. This ledge
- formed a flat spot, above which a beautiful cascade, some
- hundred feet in height, poured down its waters, and beneath,
- another high cascade fell into the main stream in the valley
- below. From this cool and shady recess we made a
- circuit to avoid the overhanging waterfall. As before, we
- followed little projecting ledges, the danger being partly
- concealed by the thickness of the vegetation. In passing
- from one of the ledges to another, there was a vertical wall
- of rock. One of the Tahitians, a fine active man, placed
- the trunk of a tree against this, climbed up it, and then by
- the aid of crevices reached the summit. He fixed the ropes
- to a projecting point, and lowered them for our dog and
- luggage, and then we clambered up ourselves. Beneath the
- ledge on which the dead tree was placed, the precipice must
- have been five or six hundred feet deep; and if the abyss
- had not been partly concealed by the overhanging ferns and
- lilies my head would have turned giddy, and nothing should
- have induced me to have attempted it. We continued to
- ascend, sometimes along ledges, and sometimes along knife-
- edged ridges, having on each hand profound ravines. In
- the Cordillera I have seen mountains on a far grander
- scale, but for abruptness, nothing at all comparable with this.
- In the evening we reached a flat little spot on the banks
- of the same stream, which we had continued to follow, and
- which descends in a chain of waterfalls: here we bivouacked
- for the night. On each side of the ravine there were great
- beds of the mountain-banana, covered with ripe fruit. Many
- of these plants were from twenty to twenty-five feet high,
- and from three to four in circumference. By the aid of
- strips of bark for rope, the stems of bamboos for rafters,
- and the large leaf of the banana for a thatch, the Tahitians
- in a few minutes built us an excellent house; and with
- withered leaves made a soft bed.
-
- They then proceeded to make a fire, and cook our evening
- meal. A light was procured, by rubbing a blunt pointed
- stick in a groove made in another, as if with intention of
- deepening it, until by the friction the dust became ignited.
- A peculiarly white and very light wood (the Hibiscus tiliareus)
- is alone used for this purpose: it is the same which
- serves for poles to carry any burden, and for the floating
- out-riggers to their canoes. The fire was produced in a few
- seconds: but to a person who does not understand the art,
- it requires, as I found, the greatest exertion; but at last, to
- my great pride, I succeeded in igniting the dust. The
- Gaucho in the Pampas uses a different method: taking an
- elastic stick about eighteen inches long, he presses one end
- on his breast, and the other pointed end into a hole in a piece
- of wood, and then rapidly turns the curved part, like a
- carpenter's centre-bit. The Tahitians having made a small fire
- of sticks, placed a score of stones, of about the size of
- cricket-balls, on the burning wood. In about ten minutes the
- sticks were consumed, and the stones hot. They had previously
- folded up in small parcels of leaves, pieces of beef,
- fish, ripe and unripe bananas, and the tops of the wild arum.
- These green parcels were laid in a layer between two layers
- of the hot stones, and the whole then covered up with
- earth, so that no smoke or steam could escape. In about
- a quarter of an hour, the whole was most deliciously cooked.
- The choice green parcels were now laid on a cloth of
- banana leaves, and with a cocoa-nut shell we drank the
- cool water of the running stream; and thus we enjoyed our
- rustic meal.
-
- I could not look on the surrounding plants without admiration.
- On every side were forests of banana; the fruit
- of which, though serving for food in various ways, lay in
- heaps decaying on the ground. In front of us there was an
- extensive brake of wild sugar-cane; and the stream was
- shaded by the dark green knotted stem of the Ava, -- so famous
- in former days for its powerful intoxicating effects. I
- chewed a piece, and found that it had an acrid and unpleasant
- taste, which would have induced any one at once to
- have pronounced it poisonous. Thanks to the missionaries,
- this plant now thrives only in these deep ravines, innocuous to
- every one. Close by I saw the wild arum, the roots of which,
- when well baked, are good to eat, and the young leaves
- better than spinach. There was the wild yam, and a liliaceous
- plant called Ti, which grows in abundance, and has a soft
- brown root, in shape and size like a huge log of wood: this
- served us for dessert, for it is as sweet as treacle, and with
- a pleasant taste. There were, moreover, several other wild
- fruits, and useful vegetables. The little stream, besides its
- cool water, produced eels, and cray-fish. I did indeed admire
- this scene, when I compared it with an uncultivated one in
- the temperate zones. I felt the force of the remark, that
- man, at least savage man, with his reasoning powers only
- partly developed, is the child of the tropics.
-
- As the evening drew to a close, I strolled beneath the
- gloomy shade of the bananas up the course of the stream.
- My walk was soon brought to a close, by coming to a waterfall
- between two and three hundred feet high; and again
- above this there was another. I mention all these waterfalls
- in this one brook, to give a general idea of the inclination
- of the land. In the little recess where the water fell, it did
- not appear that a breath of wind had ever blown. The thin
- edges of the great leaves of the banana, damp with spray,
- were unbroken, instead of being, as is so generally the case,
- split into a thousand shreds. From our position, almost
- suspended on the mountain side, there were glimpses into the
- depths of the neighbouring valleys; and the lofty points of
- the central mountains, towering up within sixty degrees of
- the zenith, hid half the evening sky. Thus seated, it was
- a sublime spectacle to watch the shades of night gradually
- obscuring the last and highest pinnacles.
-
- Before we laid ourselves down to sleep, the elder Tahitian
- fell on his knees, and with closed eyes repeated a long
- prayer in his native tongue. He prayed as a Christian should
- do, with fitting reverence, and without the fear of ridicule
- or any ostentation of piety. At our meals neither of the men
- would taste food, without saying beforehand a short grace.
- Those travellers who think that a Tahitian prays only when
- the eyes of the missionary are fixed on him, should have
- slept with us that night on the mountain-side. Before morning
- it rained very heavily; but the good thatch of banana-
- leaves kept us dry.
-
- November 19th. -- At daylight my friends, after their
- morning prayer, prepared an excellent breakfast in the same
- manner as in the evening. They themselves certainly partook
- of it largely; indeed I never saw any men eat near so
- much. I suppose such enormously capacious stomachs must
- be the effect of a large part of their diet consisting of fruit
- and vegetables, which contain, in a given bulk, a comparatively
- small portion of nutriment. Unwittingly, I was the
- means of my companions breaking, as I afterwards learned,
- one of their own laws, and resolutions: I took with me a
- flask of spirits, which they could not refuse to partake of;
- but as often as they drank a little, they put their fingers
- before their mouths, and uttered the word "Missionary."
- About two years ago, although the use of the ava was prevented,
- drunkenness from the introduction of spirits became
- very prevalent. The missionaries prevailed on a few good
- men, who saw that their country was rapidly going to ruin,
- to join with them in a Temperance Society. From good
- sense or shame, all the chiefs and the queen were at last
- persuaded to join. Immediately a law was passed, that no
- spirits should be allowed to be introduced into the island,
- and that he who sold and he who bought the forbidden
- article should be punished by a fine. With remarkable justice,
- a certain period was allowed for stock in hand to be
- sold, before the law came into effect. But when it did, a
- general search was made, in which even the houses of the
- missionaries were not exempted, and all the ava (as the
- natives call all ardent spirits) was poured on the ground.
- When one reflects on the effect of intemperance on the
- aborigines of the two Americas, I think it will be acknowledged
- that every well-wisher of Tahiti owes no common debt
- of gratitude to the missionaries. As long as the little island
- of St. Helena remained under the government of the East
- India Company, spirits, owing to the great injury they had
- produced, were not allowed to be imported; but wine was
- supplied from the Cape of Good Hope. It is rather a striking
- and not very gratifying fact, that in the same year
- that spirits were allowed to be sold in Helena, their use was
- banished from Tahiti by the free will of the people.
-
- After breakfast we proceeded on our Journey. As my object
- was merely to see a little of the interior scenery, we
- returned by another track, which descended into the main
- valley lower down. For some distance we wound, by a most
- intricate path, along the side of the mountain which formed
- the valley. In the less precipitous parts we passed through
- extensive groves of the wild banana. The Tahitians, with
- their naked, tattooed bodies, their heads ornamented with
- flowers, and seen in the dark shade of these groves, would
- have formed a fine picture of man inhabiting some primeval
- land. In our descent we followed the line of ridges; these
- were exceedingly narrow, and for considerable lengths steep
- as a ladder; but all clothed with vegetation. The extreme
- care necessary in poising each step rendered the walk fatiguing.
- I did not cease to wonder at these ravines and
- precipices: when viewing the country from one of the knife-
- edged ridges, the point of support was so small, that the
- effect was nearly the same as it must be from a balloon. In
- this descent we had occasion to use the ropes only once, at
- the point where we entered the main valley. We slept under
- the same ledge of rock where we had dined the day before:
- the night was fine, but from the depth and narrowness of the
- gorge, profoundly dark.
-
- Before actually seeing this country, I found it difficult
- to understand two facts mentioned by Ellis; namely, that
- after the murderous battles of former times, the survivors
- on the conquered side retired into the mountains, where a
- handful of men could resist a multitude. Certainly half
- a dozen men, at the spot where the Tahitian reared the old
- tree, could easily have repulsed thousands. Secondly, that
- after the introduction of Christianity, there were wild men
- who lived in the mountains, and whose retreats were unknown
- to the more civilized inhabitants
-
- November 20th. -- In the morning we started early, and
- reached Matavai at noon. On the road we met a large party
- of noble athletic men, going for wild bananas. I found that
- the ship, on account of the difficulty in watering, had moved
- to the harbour of Papawa, to which place I immediately
- walked. This is a very pretty spot. The cove is surrounded
- by reefs, and the water as smooth as in a lake. The
- cultivated ground, with its beautiful productions, interspersed
- with cottages, comes close down to the water's edge.
- From the varying accounts which I had read before reaching
- these islands, I was very anxious to form, from my own
- observation, a judgment of their moral state, -- although such
- judgment would necessarily be very imperfect. First impressions
- at all times very much depend on one's previously
- acquired ideas. My notions were drawn from Ellis's "Polynesian
- Researches" -- an admirable and most interesting
- work, but naturally looking at everything under a favourable
- point of view, from Beechey's Voyage; and from that of
- Kotzebue, which is strongly adverse to the whole missionary
- system. He who compares these three accounts will, I think,
- form a tolerably accurate conception of the present state of
- Tahiti. One of my impressions which I took from the two
- last authorities, was decidedly incorrect; viz., that the
- Tahitians had become a gloomy race, and lived in fear of the
- missionaries. Of the latter feeling I saw no trace, unless,
- indeed, fear and respect be confounded under one name.
- Instead of discontent being a common feeling, it would be
- difficult in Europe to pick out of a crowd half so many merry
- and happy faces. The prohibition of the flute and dancing
- is inveighed against as wrong and foolish; -- the more than
- presbyterian manner of keeping the sabbath is looked at in
- a similar light. On these points I will not pretend to offer
- any opinion to men who have resided as many years as I
- was days on the island.
-
- On the whole, it appears to me that the morality and
- religion of the inhabitants are highly creditable. There are
- many who attack, even more acrimoniously than Kotzebue,
- both the missionaries, their system, and the effects produced
- by it. Such reasoners never compare the present state with
- that of the island only twenty years ago; nor even with that
- of Europe at this day; but they compare it with the high
- standard of Gospel perfection. They expect the missionaries
- to effect that which the Apostles themselves failed to do.
- Inasmuch as the condition of the people falls short of
- this high standard, blame is attached to the missionary, instead
- of credit for that which he has effected. They forget,
- or will not remember, that human sacrifices, and the power
- of an idolatrous priesthood -- a system of profligacy
- unparalleled in any other part of the world -- infanticide a
- consequence of that system -- bloody wars, where the conquerors
- spared neither women nor children -- that all these have been
- abolished; and that dishonesty, intemperance, and licentiousness
- have been greatly reduced by the introduction of Christianity.
- In a voyager to forget these things is base ingratitude; for
- should he chance to be at the point of shipwreck on some
- unknown coast, he will most devoutly pray that the lesson of
- the missionary may have extended thus far.
-
- In point of morality, the virtue of the women, it has been
- often said, is most open to exception. But before they are
- blamed too severely, it will be well distinctly to call to mind
- the scenes described by Captain Cook and Mr. Banks, in
- which the grandmothers and mothers of the present race
- played a part. Those who are most severe, should consider
- how much of the morality of the women in Europe is owing
- to the system early impressed by mothers on their daughters,
- and how much in each individual case to the precepts of
- religion. But it is useless to argue against such reasoners; --
- I believe that, disappointed in not finding the field of
- licentiousness quite so open as formerly, they will not give
- credit to a morality which they do not wish to practise, or to a
- religion which they undervalue, if not despise.
-
- Sunday, 22nd. -- The harbour of Papiete, where the queen
- resides, may be considered as the capital of the island: it is
- also the seat of government, and the chief resort of shipping.
- Captain Fitz Roy took a party there this day to hear divine
- service, first in the Tahitian language, and afterwards in our
- own. Mr. Pritchard, the leading missionary in the island,
- performed the service. The chapel consisted of a large airy
- framework of wood; and it was filled to excess by tidy, clean
- people, of all ages and both sexes. I was rather disappointed
- in the apparent degree of attention; but I believe my
- expectations were raised too high. At all events the appearance
- was quite equal to that in a country church in England.
- The singing of the hymns was decidedly very pleasing, but
- the language from the pulpit, although fluently delivered, did
- not sound well: a constant repetition of words, like "tata
- ta, mata mai," rendered it monotonous. After English service,
- a party returned on foot to Matavai. It was a pleasant
- walk, sometimes along the sea-beach and sometimes under
- the shade of the many beautiful trees.
-
- About two years ago, a small vessel under English colours
- was plundered by some of the inhabitants of the Low Islands,
- which were then under the dominion of the Queen of Tahiti.
- It was believed that the perpetrators were instigated to this
- act by some indiscreet laws issued by her majesty. The
- British government demanded compensation; which was acceded
- to, and the sum of nearly three thousand dollars was
- agreed to be paid on the first of last September. The Commodore
- at Lima ordered Captain Fitz Roy to inquire concerning
- this debt, and to demand satisfaction if it were not
- paid. Captain Fitz Roy accordingly requested an interview
- with the Queen Pomarre, since famous from the ill-treatment
- she had received from the French; and a parliament was
- held to consider the question, at which all the principal chiefs
- of the island and the queen were assembled. I will not attempt
- to describe what took place, after the interesting account
- given by Captain Fitz Roy. The money, it appeared,
- had not been paid; perhaps the alleged reasons were rather
- equivocal; but otherwise I cannot sufficiently express our
- general surprise at the extreme good sense, the reasoning
- powers, moderation, candour, and prompt resolution, which
- were displayed on all sides. I believe we all left the meeting
- with a very different opinion of the Tahitians, from what we
- entertained when we entered. The chiefs and people resolved
- to subscribe and complete the sum which was wanting;
- Captain Fitz Roy urged that it was hard that their private
- property should be sacrificed for the crimes of distant
- islanders. They replied, that they were grateful for his
- consideration, but that Pomarre was their Queen, and that they
- were determined to help her in this her difficulty. This
- resolution and its prompt execution, for a book was opened
- early the next morning, made a perfect conclusion to this
- very remarkable scene of loyalty and good feeling.
-
- After the main discussion was ended, several of the chiefs
- took the opportunity of asking Captain Fitz Roy many intelligent
- questions on international customs and laws, relating
- to the treatment of ships and foreigners. On some
- points, as soon as the decision was made, the law was issued
- verbally on the spot. This Tahitian parliament lasted for
- several hours; and when it was over Captain Fitz Roy invited
- Queen Pomarre to pay the Beagle a visit.
-
- November 25th. -- In the evening four boats were sent for
- her majesty; the ship was dressed with flags, and the yards
- manned on her coming on board. She was accompanied by
- most of the chiefs. The behaviour of all was very proper:
- they begged for nothing, and seemed much pleased with Captain
- Fitz Roy's presents. The queen is a large awkward
- woman, without any beauty, grace or dignity. She has only
- one royal attribute: a perfect immovability of expression
- under all circumstances, and that rather a sullen one. The
- rockets were most admired, and a deep "Oh!" could be
- heard from the shore, all round the dark bay, after each
- explosion. The sailors' songs were also much admired; and
- the queen said she thought that one of the most boisterous
- ones certainly could not be a hymn! The royal party did
- not return on shore till past midnight.
-
- 26th. -- In the evening, with a gentle land-breeze, a course
- was steered for New Zealand; and as the sun set, we had a
- farewell view of the mountains of Tahiti -- the island to which
- every voyager has offered up his tribute of admiration.
-
- December 19th. -- In the evening we saw in the distance
- New Zealand. We may now consider that we have nearly
- crossed the Pacific. It is necessary to sail over this great
- ocean to comprehend its immensity. Moving quickly onwards
- for weeks together, we meet with nothing but the
- same blue, profoundly deep, ocean. Even within the
- archipelagoes, the islands are mere specks, and far distant one
- from the other. Accustomed to look at maps drawn on a
- small scale, where dots, shading, and names are crowded
- together, we do not rightly judge how infinitely small the
- proportion of dry land is to water of this vast expanse.
- The meridian of the Antipodes has likewise been passed; and
- now every league, it made us happy to think, was one league
- nearer to England. These Antipodes call to one's mind old
- recollections of childish doubt and wonder. Only the other
- day I looked forward to this airy barrier as a definite point
- in our voyage homewards; but now I find it, and all such
- resting-places for the imagination, are like shadows, which
- a man moving onwards cannot catch. A gale of wind lasting
- for some days, has lately given us full leisure to measure
- the future stages in our homeward voyage, and to wish
- most earnestly for its termination.
-
- December 21st. -- Early in the morning we entered the Bay
- of Islands, and being becalmed for some hours near the
- mouth, we did not reach the anchorage till the middle of the
- day. The country is hilly, with a smooth outline, and is
- deeply intersected by numerous arms of the sea extending
- from the bay. The surface appears from a distance as if
- clothed with coarse pasture, but this in truth is nothing but
- fern. On the more distant hills, as well as in parts of the
- valleys, there is a good deal of woodland. The general tint
- of the landscape is not a bright green; and it resembles the
- country a short distance to the south of Concepcion in Chile.
- In several parts of the bay, little villages of square tidy
- looking houses are scattered close down to the water's edge.
- Three whaling-ships were lying at anchor, and a canoe every
- now and then crossed from shore to shore; with these
- exceptions, an air of extreme quietness reigned over the
- whole district. Only a single canoe came alongside. This,
- and the aspect of the whole scene, afforded a remarkable,
- and not very pleasing contrast, with our joyful and boisterous
- welcome at Tahiti.
-
- In the afternoon we went on shore to one of the larger
- groups of houses, which yet hardly deserves the title of a
- village. Its name is Pahia: it is the residence of the
- missionaries; and there are no native residents except servants
- and labourers. In the vicinity of the Bay of Islands, the
- number of Englishmen, including their families, amounts to
- between two and three hundred. All the cottages, many of
- which are white-washed and look very neat, are the property
- of the English. The hovels of the natives are so diminutive
- and paltry, that they can scarcely be perceived from a distance.
- At Pahia, it was quite pleasing to behold the English
- flowers in the gardens before the houses; there were
- roses of several kinds, honeysuckle, jasmine, stocks, and
- whole hedges of sweetbrier.
-
- December 22nd. -- In the morning I went out walking; but
- I soon found that the country was very impracticable. All
- the hills are thickly covered with tall fern, together with
- a low bush which grows like a cypress; and very little
- ground has been cleared or cultivated. I then tried the
- sea-beach; but proceeding towards either hand, my walk
- was soon stopped by salt-water creeks and deep brooks. The
- communication between the inhabitants of the different
- parts of the bay, is (as in Chiloe) almost entirely kept up
- by boats. I was surprised to find that almost every hill which
- I ascended, had been at some former time more or less
- fortified. The summits were cut into steps or successive
- terraces, and frequently they had been protected by deep
- trenches. I afterwards observed that the principal hills inland
- in like manner showed an artificial outline. These are
- the Pas, so frequently mentioned by Captain Cook under the
- name of "hippah;" the difference of sound being owing to
- the prefixed article.
-
- That the Pas had formerly been much used, was evident
- from the piles of shells, and the pits in which, as I was
- informed, sweet potatoes used to be kept as a reserve. As
- there was no water on these hills, the defenders could never
- have anticipated a long siege, but only a hurried attack for
- plunder, against which the successive terraces would have
- afforded good protection. The general introduction of firearms
- has changed the whole system of warfare; and an exposed
- situation on the top of a hill is now worse than useless.
- The Pas in consequence are, at the present day, always built
- on a level piece of ground. They consist of a double stockade
- of thick and tall posts, placed in a zigzag line, so that every
- part can be flanked. Within the stockade a mound of earth is
- thrown up, behind which the defenders can rest in safety, or
- use their fire-arms over it. On the level of the ground
- little archways sometimes pass through this breastwork,
- by which means the defenders can crawl out to the stockade
- and reconnoitre their enemies. The Rev. W. Williams, who
- gave me this account, added, that in one Pas he had noticed
- spurs or buttresses projecting on the inner and protected
- side of the mound of earth. On asking the chief the use
- of them, he replied, that if two or three of his men were
- shot, their neighbours would not see the bodies, and so be
- discouraged.
-
- These Pas are considered by the New Zealanders as very
- perfect means of defence: for the attacking force is never
- so well disciplined as to rush in a body to the stockade, cut
- it down, and effect their entry. When a tribe goes to war,
- the chief cannot order one party to go here and another
- there; but every man fights in the manner which best pleases
- himself; and to each separate individual to approach a stockade
- defended by fire-arms must appear certain death. I
- should think a more warlike race of inhabitants could not
- be found in any part of the world than the New Zealanders.
- Their conduct on first seeing a ship, as described by Captain
- Cook, strongly illustrates this: the act of throwing volleys
- of stones at so great and novel an object, and their defiance
- of "Come on shore and we will kill and eat you all," shows
- uncommon boldness. This warlike spirit is evident in many
- of their customs, and even in their smallest actions. If a
- New Zealander is struck, although but in joke, the blow
- must be returned and of this I saw an instance with one
- of our officers.
-
- At the present day, from the progress of civilization, there
- is much less warfare, except among some of the southern
- tribes. I heard a characteristic anecdote of what took place
- some time ago in the south. A missionary found a chief and
- his tribe in preparation for war; -- their muskets clean and
- bright, and their ammunition ready. He reasoned long on
- the inutility of the war, and the little provocation which
- had been given for it. The chief was much shaken in his
- resolution, and seemed in doubt: but at length it occurred
- to him that a barrel of his gunpowder was in a bad state, and
- that it would not keep much longer. This was brought forward
- as an unanswerable argument for the necessity of immediately
- declaring war: the idea of allowing so much good
- gunpowder to spoil was not to be thought of; and this settled
- the point. I was told by the missionaries that in the
- life of Shongi, the chief who visited England, the love of
- war was the one and lasting spring of every action. The
- tribe in which he was a principal chief had at one time been
- oppressed by another tribe from the Thames River. A
- solemn oath was taken by the men that when their boys
- should grow up, and they should be powerful enough, they
- would never forget or forgive these injuries. To fulfil this
- oath appears to have been Shongi's chief motive for going
- to England; and when there it was his sole object. Presents
- were valued only as they could be converted into arms;
- of the arts, those alone interested him which were connected
- with the manufacture of arms. When at Sydney, Shongi,
- by a strange coincidence, met the hostile chief of the Thames
- River at the house of Mr. Marsden: their conduct was civil
- to each other; but Shongi told him that when again in New
- Zealand he would never cease to carry war into his country.
- The challenge was accepted; and Shongi on his return fulfilled
- the threat to the utmost letter. The tribe on the
- Thames River was utterly overthrown, and the chief to
- whom the challenge had been given was himself killed.
- Shongi, although harbouring such deep feelings of hatred
- and revenge, is described as having been a good-natured
- person.
-
- In the evening I went with Captain Fitz Roy and Mr.
- Baker, one of the missionaries, to pay a visit to Kororadika:
- we wandered about the village, and saw and conversed with
- many of the people, both men, women, and children. Looking
- at the New Zealander, one naturally compares him with
- the Tahitian; both belonging to the same family of mankind.
- The comparison, however, tells heavily against the New
- Zealander. He may, perhaps be superior in energy, but
- in every other respect his character is of a much lower
- order. One glance at their respective expressions, brings
- conviction to the mind that one is a savage, the other a
- civilized man. It would be vain to seek in the whole of
- New Zealand a person with the face and mien of the old
- Tahitian chief Utamme. No doubt the extraordinary manner
- in which tattooing is here practised, gives a disagreeable
- expression to their countenances. The complicated but
- symmetrical figures covering the whole face, puzzle and mislead
- an unaccustomed eye: it is moreover probable, that the deep
- incisions, by destroying the play of the superficial muscles,
- give an air of rigid inflexibility. But, besides this, there is
- a twinkling in the eye, which cannot indicate anything but
- cunning and ferocity. Their figures are tall and bulky; but
- not comparable in elegance with those of the working-
- classes in Tahiti.
-
- But their persons and houses are filthily dirty and offensive:
- the idea of washing either their bodies or their clothes
- never seems to enter their heads. I saw a chief, who was
- wearing a shirt black and matted with filth, and when asked
- how it came to be so dirty, he replied, with surprise, "Do
- not you see it is an old one?" Some of the men have shirts;
- but the common dress is one or two large blankets, generally
- black with dirt, which are thrown over their shoulders in a
- very inconvenient and awkward fashion. A few of the principal
- chiefs have decent suits of English clothes; but these
- are only worn on great occasions.
-
- December 23rd. -- At a place called Waimate, about fifteen
- miles from the Bay of Islands, and midway between the
- eastern and western coasts, the missionaries have purchased
- some land for agricultural purposes. I had been introduced
- to the Rev. W. Williams, who, upon my expressing a wish,
- invited me to pay him a visit there. Mr. Bushby, the British
- resident, offered to take me in his boat by a creek, where I
- should see a pretty waterfall, and by which means my
- walk would be shortened. He likewise procured for me a
- guide.
-
- Upon asking a neighbouring chief to recommend a man, the
- chief himself offered to go; but his ignorance of the value
- of money was so complete, that at first he asked how many
- pounds I would give him, but afterwards was well contented
- with two dollars. When I showed the chief a very small
- bundle, which I wanted carried, it became absolutely necessary
- for him to take a slave. These feelings of pride are
- beginning to wear away; but formerly a leading man would
- sooner have died, than undergone the indignity of carrying
- the smallest burden. My companion was a light active man,
- dressed in a dirty blanket, and with his face completely
- tattooed. He had formerly been a great warrior. He appeared
- to be on very cordial terms with Mr. Bushby; but at
- various times they had quarrelled violently. Mr. Bushby
- remarked that a little quiet irony would frequently silence
- any one of these natives in their most blustering moments.
- This chief has come and harangued Mr. Bushby in a hectoring
- manner, saying, "great chief, a great man, a friend
- of mine, has come to pay me a visit -- you must give him
- something good to eat, some fine presents, etc." Mr. Bushby
- has allowed him to finish his discourse, and then has quietly
- replied by some answer such as, "What else shall your slave
- do for you?" The man would then instantly, with a very
- comical expression, cease his braggadocio.
-
- Some time ago, Mr. Bushby suffered a far more serious
- attack. A chief and a party of men tried to break into his
- house in the middle of the night, and not finding this so easy,
- commenced a brisk firing with their muskets. Mr. Bushby
- was slightly wounded, but the party was at length driven
- away. Shortly afterwards it was discovered who was the
- aggressor; and a general meeting of the chiefs was convened
- to consider the case. It was considered by the New Zealanders
- as very atrocious, inasmuch as it was a night attack, and
- that Mrs. Bushby was lying ill in the house: this latter
- circumstance, much to their honour, being considered in all
- cases as a protection. The chiefs agreed to confiscate the
- land of the aggressor to the King of England. The whole
- proceeding, however, in thus trying and punishing a chief
- was entirely without precedent. The aggressor, moreover,
- lost caste in the estimation of his equals and this was
- considered by the British as of more consequence than the
- confiscation of his land.
-
- As the boat was shoving off, a second chief stepped into
- her, who only wanted the amusement of the passage up and
- down the creek. I never saw a more horrid and ferocious
- expression than this man had. It immediately struck me
- I had somewhere seen his likeness: it will be found in
- Retzch's outlines to Schiller's ballad of Fridolin, where two
- men are pushing Robert into the burning iron furnace. It
- is the man who has his arm on Robert's breast. Physiognomy
- here spoke the truth; this chief had been a notorious
- murderer, and was an arrant coward to boot. At the point
- where the boat landed, Mr. Bushby accompanied me a few
- hundred yards on the road: I could not help admiring the
- cool impudence of the hoary old villain, whom we left lying
- in the boat, when he shouted to Mr. Bushby, "Do not you
- stay long, I shall be tired of waiting here."
-
- We now commenced our walk. The road lay along a
- well beaten path, bordered on each side by the tall fern,
- which covers the whole country. After travelling some
- miles, we came to a little country village, where a few hovels
- were collected together, and some patches of ground cultivated
- with potatoes. The introduction of the potato has
- been the most essential benefit to the island; it is now much
- more used than any native vegetable. New Zealand is
- favoured by one great natural advantage; namely, that the
- inhabitants can never perish from famine. The whole
- country abounds with fern: and the roots of this plant, if
- not very palatable, yet contain much nutriment. A native
- can always subsist on these, and on the shell-fish, which are
- abundant on all parts of the sea-coast. The villages are
- chiefly conspicuous by the platforms which are raised on
- four posts ten or twelve feet above the ground, and on
- which the produce of the fields is kept secure from all
- accidents.
-
- On coming near one of the huts I was much amused by
- seeing in due form the ceremony of rubbing, or, as it ought
- to be called, pressing noses. The women, on our first approach,
- began uttering something in a most dolorous voice;
- they then squatted themselves down and held up their faces;
- my companion standing over them, one after another, placed
- the bridge of his nose at right angles to theirs, and commenced
- pressing. This lasted rather longer than a cordial
- shake of the hand with us, and as we vary the force of the
- grasp of the hand in shaking, so do they in pressing. During
- the process they uttered comfortable little grunts, very
- much in the same manner as two pigs do, when rubbing
- against each other. I noticed that the slave would press
- noses with any one he met, indifferently either before or
- after his master the chief. Although among the savages, the
- chief has absolute power of life and death over his slave,
- yet there is an entire absence of ceremony between them.
- Mr. Burchell has remarked the same thing in Southern Africa,
- with the rude Bachapins. Where civilization has
- arrived at a certain point, complex formalities soon arise
- between the different grades of society: thus at Tahiti all
- were formerly obliged to uncover themselves as low as the
- waist in presence of the king.
-
- The ceremony of pressing noses having been duly completed
- with all present, we seated ourselves in a circle in the
- front of one of the-hovels, and rested there half-an-hour.
- All the hovels have nearly the same form and dimensions,
- and all agree in being filthily dirty. They resemble a cow-
- shed with one end open, but having a partition a little way
- within, with a square hole in it, making a small gloomy
- chamber. In this the inhabitants keep all their property,
- and when the weather is cold they sleep there. They eat,
- however, and pass their time in the open part in front. My
- guides having finished their pipes, we continued our walk.
- The path led through the same undulating country, the whole
- uniformly clothed as before with fern. On our right hand
- we had a serpentine river, the banks of which were fringed
- with trees, and here and there on the hill sides there was a
- clump of wood. The whole scene, in spite of its green colour,
- had rather a desolate aspect. The sight of so much fern
- impresses the mind with an idea of sterility: this, however,
- is not correct; for wherever the fern grows thick and breast-
- high, the land by tillage becomes productive. Some of the
- residents think that all this extensive open country originally
- was covered with forests, and that it has been cleared by fire.
- It is said, that by digging in the barest spots, lumps of the
- kind of resin which flows from the kauri pine are frequently
- found. The natives had an evident motive in clearing the
- country; for the fern, formerly a staple article of food,
- flourishes only in the open cleared tracks. The almost entire
- absence of associated grasses, which forms so remarkable a
- feature in the vegetation of this island, may perhaps be
- accounted for by the land having been aboriginally covered
- with forest-trees.
-
- The soil is volcanic; in several parts we passed over
- shaggy lavas, and craters could clearly be distinguished on
- several of the neighbouring hills. Although the scenery is
- nowhere beautiful, and only occasionally pretty, I enjoyed
- my walk. I should have enjoyed it more, if my companion,
- the chief, had not possessed extraordinary conversational
- powers. I knew only three words: "good," "bad," and
- "yes:" and with these I answered all his remarks, without
- of course having understood one word he said. This, however,
- was quite sufficient: I was a good listener, an agreeable
- person, and he never ceased talking to me.
-
- At length we reached Waimate. After having passed over
- so many miles of an uninhabited useless country, the sudden
- appearance of an English farm-house, and its well-dressed
- fields, placed there as if by an enchanter's wand, was
- exceedingly pleasant. Mr. Williams not being at home, I received
- in Mr. Davies's house a cordial welcome. After drinking tea
- with his family party, we took a stroll about the farm. At
- Waimate there are three large houses, where the missionary
- gentlemen, Messrs. Williams, Davies, and Clarke, reside;
- and near them are the huts of the native labourers. On an
- adjoining slope, fine crops of barley and wheat were standing
- in full ear; and in another part, fields of potatoes and clover.
- But I cannot attempt to describe all I saw; there were large
- gardens, with every fruit and vegetable which England produces;
- and many belonging to a warmer clime. I may instance
- asparagus, kidney beans, cucumbers, rhubarb, apples,
- pears, figs, peaches, apricots, grapes, olives, gooseberries,
- currants, hops, gorse for fences, and English oaks; also many
- kinds of flowers. Around the farm-yard there were stables,
- a thrashing-barn with its winnowing machine, a blacksmith's
- forge, and on the ground ploughshares and other tools: in
- the middle was that happy mixture of pigs and poultry, lying
- comfortably together, as in every English farm-yard. At the
- distance of a few hundred yards, where the water of a little
- rill had been dammed up into a pool, there was a large and
- substantial water-mill.
-
- All this is very surprising, when it is considered that five
- years ago nothing but the fern flourished here. Moreover,
- native workmanship, taught by the missionaries, has effected
- this change; -- the lesson of the missionary is the enchanter's
- wand. The house had been built, the windows framed, the
- fields ploughed, and even the trees grafted, by a New Zealander.
- At the mill, a New Zealander was seen powdered
- white with flower, like his brother miller in England. When
- I looked at this whole scene, I thought it admirable. It was
- not merely that England was brought vividly before my
- mind; yet, as the evening drew to a close, the domestic
- sounds, the fields of corn, the distant undulating country
- with its trees might well have been mistaken for our fatherland:
- nor was it the triumphant feeling at seeing what Englishmen
- could effect; but rather the high hopes thus inspired
- for the future progress of this fine island.
-
-
- Several young men, redeemed by the missionaries from
- slavery, were employed on the farm. They were dressed in
- a shirt, jacket, and trousers, and had a respectable appearance.
- Judging from one trifling anecdote, I should think
- they must be honest. When walking in the fields, a young
- labourer came up to Mr. Davies, and gave him a knife and
- gimlet, saying that he had found them on the road, and did
- not know to whom they belonged! These young men and
- boys appeared very merry and good-humoured. In the evening
- I saw a party of them at cricket: when I thought of the
- austerity of which the missionaries have been accused, I was
- amused by observing one of their own sons taking an active
- part in the game. A more decided and pleasing change was
- manifested in the young women, who acted as servants within
- the houses. Their clean, tidy, and healthy appearance, like
- that of the dairy-maids in England, formed a wonderful
- contrast with the women of the filthy hovels in Kororadika.
- The wives of the missionaries tried to persuade them not to
- be tattooed; but a famous operator having arrived from the
- south, they said, "We really must just have a few lines on
- our lips; else when we grow old, our lips will shrivel, and we
- shall be so very ugly." There is not nearly so much tattooing
- as formerly; but as it is a badge of distinction between the
- chief and the slave, it will probably long be practised. So
- soon does any train of ideas become habitual, that the
- missionaries told me that even in their eyes a plain face looked
- mean, and not like that of a New Zealand gentleman.
-
- Late in the evening I went to Mr. Williams's house, where
- I passed the night. I found there a large party of children,
- collected together for Christmas Day, and all sitting round
- a table at tea. I never saw a nicer or more merry group; and
- to think that this was in the centre of the land of cannibalism,
- murder, and all atrocious crimes! The cordiality and
- happiness so plainly pictured in the faces of the little circle,
- appeared equally felt by the older persons of the mission.
-
- December 24th. -- In the morning, prayers were read in
- the native tongue to the whole family. After breakfast I
- rambled about the gardens and farm. This was a market-
- day, when the natives of the surrounding hamlets bring their
- potatoes, Indian corn, or pigs, to exchange for blankets,
- tobacco, and sometimes, through the persuasions of the
- missionaries, for soap. Mr. Davies's eldest son, who manages a
- farm of his own, is the man of business in the market. The
- children of the missionaries, who came while young to the
- island, understand the language better than their parents,
- and can get anything more readily done by the natives.
-
- A little before noon Messrs. Williams and Davies walked
- with me to a part of a neighbouring forest, to show me the
- famous kauri pine. I measured one of the noble trees, and
- found it thirty-one feet in circumference above the roots.
- There was another close by, which I did not see, thirty-three
- feet; and I heard of one no less than forty feet. These trees
- are remarkable for their smooth cylindrical boles, which run
- up to a height of sixty, and even ninety feet, with a nearly
- equal diameter, and without a single branch. The crown
- of branches at the summit is out of all proportion small to
- the trunk; and the leaves are likewise small compared with
- the branches. The forest was here almost composed of the
- kauri; and the largest trees, from the parallelism of their
- sides, stood up like gigantic columns of wood. The timber
- of the kauri is the most valuable production of the island;
- moreover, a quantity of resin oozes from the bark, which is
- sold at a penny a pound to the Americans, but its use was
- then unknown. Some of the New Zealand forest must be
- impenetrable to an extraordinary degree. Mr. Matthews
- informed me that one forest only thirty-four miles in width,
- and separating two inhabited districts, had only lately, for
- the first time, been crossed. He and another missionary,
- each with a party of about fifty men, undertook to open a
- road, but it cost more than a fortnight's labour! In
- the woods I saw very few birds. With regard to animals,
- it is a most remarkable fact, that so large an island, extending
- over more than 700 miles in latitude, and in many parts
- ninety broad, with varied stations, a fine climate, and land
- of all heights, from 14,000 feet downwards, with the exception
- of a small rat, did not possess one indigenous animal.
- The several species of that gigantic genus of birds, the
- Deinornis seem here to have replaced mammiferous quadrupeds,
- in the same manner as the reptiles still do at the Galapagos
- archipelago. It is said that the common Norway rat, in
- the short space of two years, annihilated in this northern
- end of the island, the New Zealand species. In many places
- I noticed several sorts of weeds, which, like the rats, I was
- forced to own as countrymen. A leek has overrun whole
- districts, and will prove very troublesome, but it was imported
- as a favour by a French vessel. The common dock
- is also widely disseminated, and will, I fear, for ever remain
- a proof of the rascality of an Englishman, who sold the seeds
- for those of the tobacco plant.
-
- On returning from our pleasant walk to the house, I dined
- with Mr. Williams; and then, a horse being lent me, I returned
- to the Bay of Islands. I took leave of the missionaries
- with thankfulness for their kind welcome, and with feelings
- of high respect for their gentlemanlike, useful, and
- upright characters. I think it would be difficult to find
- a body of men better adapted for the high office which
- they fulfil.
-
- Christmas Day. -- In a few more days the fourth year of
- our absence from England will be completed. Our first
- Christmas Day was spent at Plymouth, the second at St.
- Martin's Cove, near Cape Horn; the third at Port Desire,
- in Patagonia; the fourth at anchor in a wild harbour in the
- peninsula of Tres Montes, this fifth here, and the next, I
- trust in Providence, will be in England. We attended divine
- service in the chapel of Pahia; part of the service being
- read in English, and part in the native language. Whilst at
- New Zealand we did not hear of any recent acts of cannibalism;
- but Mr. Stokes found burnt human bones strewed
- round a fire-place on a small island near the anchorage; but
- these remains of a comfortable banquet might have been
- lying there for several years. It is probable that the moral
- state of the people will rapidly improve. Mr. Bushby mentioned
- one pleasing anecdote as a proof of the sincerity of
- some, at least, of those who profess Christianity. One of
- his young men left him, who had been accustomed to read
- prayers to the rest of the servants. Some weeks afterwards,
- happening to pass late in the evening by an outhouse, he saw
- and heard one of his men reading the Bible with difficulty
- by the light of the fire, to the others. After this the party
- knelt and prayed: in their prayers they mentioned Mr.
- Bushby and his family, and the missionaries, each separately
- in his respective district.
-
- December 26th. -- Mr. Bushby offered to take Mr. Sulivan
- and myself in his boat some miles up the river to Cawa-
- Cawa, and proposed afterwards to walk on to the village of
- Waiomio, where there are some curious rocks. Following
- one of the arms of the bay, we enjoyed a pleasant row, and
- passed through pretty scenery, until we came to a village,
- beyond which the boat could not pass. From this place a
- chief and a party of men volunteered to walk with us to
- Waiomio, a distance of four miles. The chief was at this
- time rather notorious from having lately hung one of his
- wives and a slave for adultery. When one of the missionaries
- remonstrated with him he seemed surprised, and said
- he thought he was exactly following the English method.
- Old Shongi, who happened to be in England during the
- Queen's trial, expressed great disapprobation at the whole
- proceeding: he said he had five wives, and he would rather
- cut off all their heads than be so much troubled about one.
- Leaving this village, we crossed over to another, seated on
- a hill-side at a little distance. The daughter of a chief, who
- was still a heathen, had died there five days before. The
- hovel in which she had expired had been burnt to the ground:
- her body being enclosed between two small canoes, was
- placed upright on the ground, and protected by an enclosure
- bearing wooden images of their gods, and the whole was
- painted bright red, so as to be conspicuous from afar. Her
- gown was fastened to the coffin, and her hair being cut off
- was cast at its foot. The relatives of the family had torn
- the flesh of their arms, bodies, and faces, so that they were
- covered with clotted blood; and the old women looked most
- filthy, disgusting objects. On the following day some of the
- officers visited this place, and found the women still howling
- and cutting themselves.
-
- We continued our walk, and soon reached Waiomio. Here
- there are some singular masses of limestone, resembling
- ruined castles. These rocks have long served for burial
- places, and in consequence are held too sacred to be approached.
- One of the young men, however, cried out, "Let
- us all be brave," and ran on ahead; but when within a hundred
- yards, the whole party thought better of it, and stopped
- short. With perfect indifference, however, they allowed us
- to examine the whole place. At this village we rested some
- hours, during which time there was a long discussion with
- Mr. Bushby, concerning the right of sale of certain lands.
- One old man, who appeared a perfect genealogist, illustrated
- the successive possessors by bits of stick driven into the
- ground. Before leaving the houses a little basketful of
- roasted sweet potatoes was given to each of our party; and
- we all, according to the custom, carried them away to eat
- on the road. I noticed that among the women employed in
- cooking, there was a man-slave: it must be a humiliating
- thing for a man in this warlike country to be employed in
- doing that which is considered as the lowest woman's work.
- Slaves are not allowed to go to war; but this perhaps can
- hardly be considered as a hardship. I heard of one poor
- wretch who, during hostilities, ran away to the opposite
- party; being met by two men, he was immediately seized;
- but as they could not agree to whom he should belong, each
- stood over him with a stone hatchet, and seemed determined
- that the other at least should not take him away alive. The
- poor man, almost dead with fright, was only saved by the
- address of a chief's wife. We afterwards enjoyed a pleasant
- walk back to the boat, but did not reach the ship till late in
- the evening.
-
- December 30th. -- In the afternoon we stood out of the
- Bay of Islands, on our course to Sydney. I believe we were
- all glad to leave New Zealand. It is not a pleasant place.
- Amongst the natives there is absent that charming simplicity
- which is found in Tahiti; and the greater part of the English
- are the very refuse of society. Neither is the country itself
- attractive. I look back but to one bright spot, and that is
- Waimate, with its Christian inhabitants.
-
-
-
- CHAPTER XIX
-
- AUSTRALIA
-
- Sydney -- Excursion to Bathurst -- Aspect of the Woods -- Party
- of Natives -- Gradual Extinction of the Aborigines -- Infection
- generated by associated Men in health -- Blue Mountains -- View
- of the grand gulf-like Valleys -- Their origin and formation --
- Bathurst, general civility of the Lower Orders -- State of
- Society -- Van Diemen's Land -- Hobart Town -- Aborigines all
- banished -- Mount Wellington -- King George's Sound --
- Cheerless Aspect of the Country -- Bald Head, calcareous casts
- of branches of Trees -- Party of Natives -- Leave Australia.
-
-
- JANUARY 12th, 1836. -- Early in the morning a light air
- carried us towards the entrance of Port Jackson. Instead
- of beholding a verdant country, interspersed with
- fine houses, a straight line of yellowish cliff brought to our
- minds the coast of Patagonia. A solitary lighthouse, built of
- white stone, alone told us that we were near a great and
- populous city. Having entered the harbour, it appears fine
- and spacious, with cliff-formed shores of horizontally
- stratified sandstone. The nearly level country is covered with
- thin scrubby trees, bespeaking the curse of sterility.
- Proceeding further inland, the country improves: beautiful
- villas and nice cottages are here and there scattered along the
- beach. In the distance stone houses, two and three stories high,
- and windmills standing on the edge of a bank, pointed out to us
- the neighbourhood of the capital of Australia.
-
- At last we anchored within Sydney Cove. We found the
- little basin occupied by many large ships, and surrounded by
- warehouses. In the evening I walked through the town, and
- returned full of admiration at the whole scene. It is a most
- magnificent testimony to the power of the British nation.
- Here, in a less promising country, scores of years have done
- many more times more than an equal number of centuries
- have effected in South America. My first feeling was to
- congratulate myself that I was born an Englishman. Upon
- seeing more of the town afterwards, perhaps my admiration
- fell a little; but yet it is a fine town. The streets are
- regular, broad, clean, and kept in excellent order; the houses
- are of a good size, and the shops well furnished. It may be
- faithfully compared to the large suburbs which stretch out from
- London and a few other great towns in England; but not even near
- London or Birmingham is there an appearance of such rapid
- growth. The number of large houses and other buildings just
- finished was truly surprising; nevertheless, every one
- complained of the high rents and difficulty in procuring a
- house. Coming from South America, where in the towns every man
- of property is known, no one thing surprised me more than
- not being able to ascertain at once to whom this or that
- carriage belonged.
-
- I hired a man and two horses to take me to Bathurst, a
- village about one hundred and twenty miles in the interior,
- and the centre of a great pastoral district. By this means I
- hoped to gain a general idea of the appearance of the country.
- On the morning of the 16th (January) I set out on my excursion.
- The first stage took us to Paramatta, a small country
- town, next to Sydney in importance. The roads were excellent,
- and made upon the MacAdam principle, whinstone having
- been brought for the purpose from the distance of several
- miles. In all respects there was a close resemblance to England:
- perhaps the alehouses here were more numerous. The iron gangs,
- or parties of convicts who have committed here some offense,
- appeared the least like England: they were working in chains,
- under the charge of sentries with loaded arms.
-
- The power which the government possesses, by means
- of forced labour, of at once opening good roads throughout
- the country, has been, I believe, one main cause of the early
- prosperity of this colony. I slept at night at a very
- comfortable inn at Emu ferry, thirty-five miles from Sydney,
- and near the ascent of the Blue Mountains. This line of
- road is the most frequented, and has been the longest inhabited
- of any in the colony. The whole land is enclosed
- with high railings, for the farmers have not succeeded in
- rearing hedges. There are many substantial houses and good
- cottages scattered about; but although considerable pieces of
- land are under cultivation, the greater part yet remains as
- when first discovered.
-
- The extreme uniformity of the vegetation is the most
- remarkable feature in the landscape of the greater part of
- New South Wales. Everywhere we have an open woodland,
- the ground being partially covered with a very thin pasture,
- with little appearance of verdure. The trees nearly all
- belong to one family, and mostly have their leaves placed in
- a vertical, instead of as in Europe, in a nearly horizontal
- position: the foliage is scanty, and of a peculiar pale green
- tint, without any gloss. Hence the woods appear light and
- shadowless: this, although a loss of comfort to the traveller
- under the scorching rays of summer, is of importance to the
- farmer, as it allows grass to grow where it otherwise would
- not. The leaves are not shed periodically: this character
- appears common to the entire southern hemisphere, namely,
- South America, Australia, and the Cape of Good Hope. The
- inhabitants of this hemisphere, and of the intertropical
- regions, thus lose perhaps one of the most glorious, though
- to our eyes common, spectacles in the world -- the first
- bursting into full foliage of the leafless tree. They may,
- however, say that we pay dearly for this by having the land
- covered with mere naked skeletons for so many months. This is
- too true but our senses thus acquire a keen relish for the
- exquisite green of the spring, which the eyes of those living
- within the tropics, sated during the long year with the gorgeous
- productions of those glowing climates, can never experience.
- The greater number of the trees, with the exception
- of some of the Blue-gums, do not attain a large size;
- but they grow tall and tolerably straight, and stand well
- apart. The bark of some of the Eucalypti falls annually, or
- hangs dead in long shreds which swing about with the wind,
- and give to the woods a desolate and untidy appearance. I
- cannot imagine a more complete contrast, in every respect,
- than between the forests of Valdivia or Chiloe, and the
- woods of Australia.
-
- At sunset, a party of a score of the black aborigines passed
- by, each carrying, in their accustomed manner, a bundle of
- spears and other weapons. By giving a leading young man a
- shilling, they were easily detained, and threw their spears for
- my amusement. They were all partly clothed, and several
- could speak a little English: their countenances were good-
- humoured and pleasant, and they appeared far from being
- such utterly degraded beings as they have usually been
- represented. In their own arts they are admirable. A cap being
- fixed at thirty yards distance, they transfixed it with a spear,
- delivered by the throwing-stick with the rapidity of an arrow
- from the bow of a practised archer. In tracking animals or
- men they show most wonderful sagacity; and I heard of several
- of their remarks which manifested considerable acuteness.
- They will not, however, cultivate the ground, or build
- houses and remain stationary, or even take the trouble of
- tending a flock of sheep when given to them. On the whole
- they appear to me to stand some few degrees higher in the
- scale of civilization than the Fuegians.
-
- It is very curious thus to see in the midst of a civilized
- people, a set of harmless savages wandering about without
- knowing where they shall sleep at night, and gaining their
- livelihood by hunting in the woods. As the white man has
- travelled onwards, he has spread over the country belonging
- to several tribes. These, although thus enclosed by one common
- people, keep up their ancient distinctions, and sometimes
- go to war with each other. In an engagement which
- took place lately, the two parties most singularly chose the
- centre of the village of Bathurst for the field of battle. This
- was of service to the defeated side, for the runaway warriors
- took refuge in the barracks.
-
- The number of aborigines is rapidly decreasing. In my
- whole ride, with the exception of some boys brought up by
- Englishmen, I saw only one other party. This decrease, no
- doubt, must be partly owing to the introduction of spirits, to
- European diseases (even the milder ones of which, such as
- the measles, [1] prove very destructive), and to the gradual
- extinction of the wild animals. It is said that numbers of
- their children invariably perish in very early infancy from
- the effects of their wandering life; and as the difficulty of
- procuring food increases, so must their wandering habits
- increase; and hence the population, without any apparent
- deaths from famine, is repressed in a manner extremely
- sudden compared to what happens in civilized countries,
- where the father, though in adding to his labour he may injure
- himself, does not destroy his offspring.
-
- Besides the several evident causes of destruction, there
- appears to be some more mysterious agency generally at
- work. Wherever the European has trod, death seems to pursue
- the aboriginal. We may look to the wide extent of the
- Americas, Polynesia, the Cape of Good Hope, and Australia,
- and we find the same result. Nor is it the white man alone
- that thus acts the destroyer; the Polynesian of Malay extraction
- has in parts of the East Indian archipelago, thus driven
- before him the dark-coloured native. The varieties of man
- seem to act on each other in the same way as different species
- of animals -- the stronger always extirpating the weaker. It
- was melancholy at New Zealand to hear the fine energetic
- natives saying that they knew the land was doomed to pass
- from their children. Every one has heard of the inexplicable
- reduction of the population in the beautiful and healthy island
- of Tahiti since the date of Captain Cook's voyages: although
- in that case we might have expected that it would have been
- increased; for infanticide, which formerly prevailed to so
- extraordinary a degree, has ceased; profligacy has greatly
- diminished, and the murderous wars become less frequent.
-
- The Rev. J. Williams, in his interesting work, [2] says, that
- the first intercourse between natives and Europeans, "is
- invariably attended with the introduction of fever, dysentery,
- or some other disease, which carries off numbers of the people."
- Again he affirms, "It is certainly a fact, which cannot
- be controverted, that most of the diseases which have raged
- in the islands during my residence there, have been introduced
- by ships; [3] and what renders this fact remarkable is,
- that there might be no appearance of disease among the crew
- of the ship which conveyed this destructive importation."
- This statement is not quite so extraordinary as it at first
- appears; for several cases are on record of the most malignant
- fevers having broken out, although the parties themselves,
- who were the cause, were not affected. In the early
- part of the reign of George III., a prisoner who had been
- confined in a dungeon, was taken in a coach with four constables
- before a magistrate; and although the man himself
- was not ill, the four constables died from a short putrid
- fever; but the contagion extended to no others. From these
- facts it would almost appear as if the effluvium of one set
- of men shut up for some time together was poisonous when
- inhaled by others; and possibly more so, if the men be of
- different races. Mysterious as this circumstance appears to
- be, it is not more surprising than that the body of one's
- fellow-creature, directly after death, and before putrefaction
- has commenced, should often be of so deleterious a quality,
- that the mere puncture from an instrument used in its
- dissection, should prove fatal.
-
- 17th. -- Early in the morning we passed the Nepean in a
- ferry-boat. The river, although at this spot both broad and
- deep, had a very small body of running water. Having
- crossed a low piece of land on the opposite side, we reached
- the slope of the Blue Mountains. The ascent is not steep,
- the road having been cut with much care on the side of a
- sandstone cliff. On the summit an almost level plain extends,
- which, rising imperceptibly to the westward, at last attains
- a height of more than 3000 feet. From so grand a title as
- Blue Mountains, and from their absolute altitude, I expected
- to have seen a bold chain of mountains crossing the country;
- but instead of this, a sloping plain presents merely an
- inconsiderable front to the low land near the coast. From
- this first slope, the view of the extensive woodland to the
- east was striking, and the surrounding trees grew bold and
- lofty. But when once on the sandstone platform, the scenery
- becomes exceedingly monotonous; each side of the road is
- bordered by scrubby trees of the never-failing Eucalyptus
- family; and with the exception of two or three small inns,
- there are no houses or cultivated land: the road, moreover,
- is solitary; the most frequent object being a bullock-waggon,
- piled up with bales of wool.
-
- In the middle of the day we baited our horses at a little
- inn, called the Weatherboard. The country here is elevated
- 2800 feet above the sea. About a mile and a half from this
- place there is a view exceedingly well worth visiting. Following
- down a little valley and its tiny rill of water, an
- immense gulf unexpectedly opens through the trees which
- border the pathway, at the depth of perhaps 1500 feet.
- Walking on a few yards, one stands on the brink of a vast
- precipice, and below one sees a grand bay or gulf, for I know
- not what other name to give it, thickly covered with forest.
- The point of view is situated as if at the head of a bay, the
- line of cliff diverging on each side, and showing headland
- behind headland, as on a bold sea-coast. These cliffs are
- composed of horizontal strata of whitish sandstone; and
- are so absolutely vertical, that in many places a person
- standing on the edge and throwing down a stone, can see it
- strike the trees in the abyss below. So unbroken is the line
- of cliff, that in order to reach the foot of the waterfall,
- formed by this little stream, it is said to be necessary to go
- sixteen miles round. About five miles distant in front,
- another line of cliff extends, which thus appears completely
- to encircle the valley; and hence the name of bay is justified,
- as applied to this grand amphitheatrical depression. If we
- imagine a winding harbour, with its deep water surrounded
- by bold cliff-like shores, to be laid dry, and a forest to
- spring up on its sandy bottom, we should then have the
- appearance and structure here exhibited. This kind of view was
- to me quite novel, and extremely magnificent.
-
-